Documenti di Didattica
Documenti di Professioni
Documenti di Cultura
Bidding Document
for
Procurement of Plant for Design, Supply, Installation, Testing and
Commissioning of Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line and
Loharpatti 132/33/11 kV Substation
VOLUME I OF III
December, 2019
Abbreviations
TECHNICAL BID
PROCUREMENT OF WORKS
Procurement of
" Procurement of Plant for Design, Supply, Installation, Testing and
Commissioning of Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line
and Loharpatti 132/33/11 kV Substation "
PART II REQUIREMENTS
Minimum Average Annual Construction Turnover of the best 3 years within the last 10
years: USD 6.6 Million.
Minimum Work experience of similar size and nature: Participation as contractor,
management contractor, or subcontractor, in at least two (2) contracts within the last 10
years, each with a value of at least USD 7.1 Million that has been successfully or is
substantially completed and that are similar to the proposed works. The similarity herein
means and requires design, supply, installation, testing and commissioning of 110 kV or
above voltage level transmission line or 110 kV or above voltage level substation or both
combined in a single contract.
The Bidder shall have successfully executed as a prime contractor, management
contractor, or subcontractor for: (i) design, supply, installation, testing and
commissioning of at least 1 (one) transmission line contract of 110 kV or above voltage
level on self-supported lattice towers. The line length of transmission line shall not be less
than 20 km; and (ii) design, supply, installation, testing and commissioning, of at least 1
(one) substation contract of 110 kV or above voltage level with power transformer
capacity not less than 30 MVA.
3. Eligible Bidders may obtain further information and inspect the Bidding Documents at the
office of
Table of Clauses
A. General ..................................................................................................................................1-14
1. Scope of Bid ...........................................................................................................................1-14
2. Source of Funds......................................................................................................................1-14
3. Fraud and Corruption .............................................................................................................1-14
4. Eligible Bidders......................................................................................................................1-14
5. Eligible Materials, Equipment and Services...........................................................................1-14
B. Contents of Bidding Document .........................................................................................14-15
6. Sections of Bidding Document............................................................................................ 14-15
38. Employer’s Right to Accept Any Bid, and to Reject Any or All Bids ................................ 27-30
F. Award of Contract..............................................................................................................30-32
39. Award Criteria..................................................................................................................... 30-32
40. Letter of Intent to Award the Contract/ Notification of Award ........................................... 30-32
A. General
1. Scope of Bid 1.1 In connection with the Invitation for Bids indicated in the Bid Data Sheet (BDS),
the Employer, as indicated in the BDS, issues this Bidding Document for the
procurement of Works as specified in Section 5 (Works Requirements). The
name, identification, and number of Contracts of the International Competitive
Bidding (ICB) are provided in the BDS.
(a) the term “in writing” means communicated in written form and delivered
against receipt;
(b) except where the context requires otherwise, words indicating the singular
also include the plural and words indicating the plural also include the
singular; and
2. Source of Funds 2.1 GoN Funded: In accordance with its annual program and budget, approved by
the GoN, the implementing agency indicated in the BDS plans to apply a
portion of the allocated budget toward the cost of the project named in the BDS.
The GoN intends to apply a portion of the allocated budget to eligible payments
under the contract(s) for which this Bidding Document is issued.
Or
Public Entities' own Resource Funded: In accordance with its annual program and
budget, approved by the public entity, the implementing agency indicated in the
BDS plans to apply a portion of the allocated budget to eligible payments under the
contract(s) for which this Bidding Document is issued.
Or
DP Funded: The GoN has applied for or received financing (hereinafter called
“funds”) from the Development Partner (hereinafter called “the DP”) indicated
in the BDS toward the cost of the project named in the BDS. The GoN intends
to apply a portion of the funds to eligible payments under the contract(s) for
which this Bidding Document is issued.
2.2 DP Funded: Payment by the DP will be made only at the request of the GoN and
upon approval by the DP in accordance with the terms and conditions of the
financing agreement between the GoN and the DP (hereinafter called the “Loan
Agreement”), and will be subject in all respects to the terms and conditions of
that Loan Agreement. No party other than the GoN shall derive any rights from
the Loan Agreement or have any claim to the funds.
3. Fraud and 3.1 The Government of Nepal (GoN) requires that the procuring entities as well as
Corruption bidders, suppliers, and contractors and their sub-contractors under GoN/DP-
financed contracts, shall adhere to the highest standard of ethics during the
(a) defines, for the purposes of this provision, the terms set forth below as
follows:
(b) will reject bid(s) if it determines that the bidder has, directly or
through an agent, engaged in corrupt, fraudulent, collusive, coercive,
or obstructive practices in competing for the contract in question;
3.2 The Bidder shall not carry out or cause to carry out the following acts with an
intention to influence the implementation of the procurement process or the
procurement agreement :
3.3 PPMO on the recommendation of the Employer may blacklist a Bidder for a
period of one (1) to three (3) years for its conduct including the following
grounds and seriousness of the act committed by the bidder:
3.4 A bidder declared blacklisted and ineligible by the GoN, Public procurement
Monitoring Office (PPMO) and/or the DP in case of DP funded project, shall be
ineligible to bid for a contract during the period of time determined by the GoN,
PPMO and/or the DP.
3.5 The Contractor shall permit the GoN/DP to inspect the Contractor’s accounts
and records relating to the performance of the Contractor and to have them
audited by auditors appointed by the GoN/DP, if so required by the GoN/DP.
3.6 DP Funded: In pursuance of the fraud and corruption policy, the DP.
(a) will reject a Bid if it determines that the bidder recommended for award
has directly or through an agent, engaged in corrupt, fraudulent,
collusive, coercive, or obstructive practices in competing for the contract
in question;
(b) will cancel the portion of the loan/ credit/ grant allocated to a contract if
it determines at any time that representative(s) of the GoN or of a
beneficiary of the fund engaged in corrupt, fraudulent, collusive, or
coercive practices during the procurement or the execution of that
contract, without the GoN having taken timely and appropriate action
satisfactory to the DP to address such practices when they occur.
3.7 A bidder declared blacklisted and ineligible by the GoN, Public Procurement
Monitoring Office (PPMO) and/or the DP in case of DP funded project, may be
ineligible to bid for a contract during the period of time determined by the GoN,
PPMO and/or the DP.
4. Eligible Bidders 4.1 A Bidder may be a natural person, private entity, or government-owned entity—
subject to ITB 4.5—or any combination of them in the form of a Joint Venture
(JV) under an existing agreement, or with the intent to constitute a legally-
enforceable joint venture. In the case of a JV:
(a) all partners shall be jointly and severally liable for the execution of the
Contract in accordance with the Contract terms. Maximum number of JV
and other provision for JV shall be as per specified in the BDS. The
qualification requirement of the parties to the JV shall be as specified in
Section 3; Evaluation and qualification Criteria, and
(b) the JV shall nominate a Representative who shall have the authority to
conduct all business for and on behalf of any and all the parties of the JV
during the bidding process and, in the event the JV is awarded the
Contract, during Contract execution.
4.2 A Bidder, and all parties constituting the Bidder, shall have the nationality of
Nepal or any country or eligible countries mentioned in the BDS. A Bidder shall
be deemed to have the nationality of a country if the Bidder is a citizen or is
constituted, or incorporated, and operates in conformity with the provisions of
the laws of that country. This criterion shall also apply to the determination of
the nationality of proposed sub Contractors or suppliers for any part of the
Contract including related services.
4.3 A Bidder shall not have a conflict of interest. A Bidder found to have a conflict
of interest shall be disqualified. A Bidder may be considered to be in a conflict
of interest with one or more parties in this bidding process, if:
(b) they receive or have received any direct or indirect subsidy from any of
them; or
(c) they have the same legal representative for purposes of this bid; or
(d) they have a relationship with each other, directly or through common third
parties, that puts them in a position to have access to information about or
influence on the Bid of another Bidder, or influence the decisions of the
Employer regarding this bidding process; or
(e) a Bidder participates in more than one bid in this bidding process.
Participation by a Bidder in more than one Bid will result in the
disqualification of all Bids in which the party is involved. However, this
does not limit the inclusion of the same sub Contractor in more than one bid;
or
(g) a Bidder or any of its affiliates has been hired (or is proposed to be hired) by
4.5 Enterprises owned by GoN shall be eligible only if they can establish that they
are legally and financially autonomous and operate under commercial law, and
that they are not a dependent agency of the GoN.
4.6 Bidders shall provide such evidence of their continued eligibility satisfactory to
the Employer, as the Employer shall reasonably request.
4.7 In case a prequalification process has been conducted prior to the bidding
process, this bidding is open only to prequalified Bidders.
4.9 Domestic Bidder shall be eligible only if the bidder has obtained Permanent
Account Number (PAN) and Value Added Tax (VAT) Registration Certificate(s)
and Tax Clearance Certificate or proof of submission of income return as stated
in BDS from the Inland Revenue Office. Foreign bidder shall be eligible only if
the bidder submits the documents indicated in the BDS at the time of bid
submission and a declaration to submit the document(s) indicated in the BDS at
the time of contract agreement.
5. Eligible Materials, 5.1 The materials, equipment and services to be supplied under the Contract shall
Equipment and have their origin in any source countries as defined in ITB 4.2 above and all
Services expenditures under the Contract will be limited to such materials, equipment,
and services. At the Employer’s request, Bidders may be required to provide
evidence of the origin of materials, equipment and services.
For purposes of ITB 5.1 above, “origin” means the place where the materials and
equipment are mined, grown, produced or manufactured, and from which the
services are provided. Materials and equipment are produced when, through
manufacturing, processing, or substantial or major assembling of components, a
commercially recognized product results that differs substantially in its basic
characteristics or in purpose or utility from its components.
6. Sections of Bidding 6.1 The Bidding Document consist of Parts I, II, and III, which include all the
Document Sections indicated below, and should be read in conjunction with any Addenda
issued in accordance with ITB 8.
PART II Requirements
6.2 The Invitation for Bids issued by the Employer is not part of the Bidding
Document.
6.3 The Employer is not responsible for the completeness of the Bidding Document
and their Addenda, if they were not obtained directly from the source stated by
the Employer in the Invitation for Bids.
6.4 The Bidder is expected to examine all instructions, forms, terms, and
specifications in the Bidding Document. Failure to furnish all information or
documentation required by the Bidding Document may result in the rejection of
the bid.
7. Clarification of 7.1 A prospective Bidder requiring any clarification of the Bidding Document shall
Bidding Document, contact the Employer in writing at the Employer’s address indicated in the BDS
Site Visit, Pre-Bid or raise any question or curiosity during the pre-bid meeting if provided for in
Meeting accordance with ITB 7.4. The Employer shall be required to make available as
soon as possible the answer to such question or curiosity in writing to any
request for clarification, provided that such request is received as mentioned in
BDS. The Employer shall forward copies of its response to all Bidders who have
acquired the Bidding Document in accordance with ITB 6.3, including a
description of the inquiry but without identifying its source. Should the
Employer deem it necessary to amend the Bidding Document as a result of a
request for clarification, it shall do so following the procedure under ITB 8 and
ITB 22.2.
7.2 The Bidder is encouraged to visit and examine the Site of Works and its
surroundings and obtain for itself, on its own risk and responsibility, all
information that may be necessary for preparing the bid and entering into a
Contract for construction of the Works. The costs of visiting the Site shall be at
the Bidder’s own expense.
7.3 The Bidder and any of its personnel or agents will be granted permission by the
Employer to enter upon its premises and lands for the purpose of such visit, but
only upon the express condition that the Bidder, its personnel, and agents will
release and indemnify the Employer and its personnel and agents from and
against all liability in respect thereof, and will be responsible for death or
personal injury, loss of or damage to property, and any other loss, damage, costs,
and expenses incurred as a result of the inspection.
7.5 The Bidder is requested, as far as possible, to submit any questions in writing, to
reach the Employer as mentioned in BDS.
7.6 Minutes of the pre-bid meeting, including the text of the questions raised,
without identifying the source, and the responses given, together with any
responses prepared after the meeting, will be transmitted promptly to all Bidders
who have acquired the Bidding Document in accordance with ITB 6.3. Any
modification to the Bidding Document that may become necessary as a result of
the pre-bid meeting shall be made by the Employer exclusively through the issue
of an addendum pursuant to ITB 8 and not through the minutes of the pre-bid
meeting.
7.7 Non attendance at the pre-bid meeting will not be a cause for disqualification of
a Bidder.
8. Amendment of 8.1 At any time prior to the deadline for submission of bids, the Employer may
Bidding Document amend the Bidding Document by issuing addenda.
8.2 Any addendum issued shall be part of the Bidding Document and shall be
communicated in writing to all who have obtained the Bidding Document from
the Employer in accordance with ITB 6.3.
8.3 To give prospective Bidders reasonable time in which to take an addendum into
account in preparing their bids, the Employer may, at its discretion, extend the
deadline for the submission of bids, pursuant to ITB 22.2.
C. Preparation of Bids
9. Cost of Bidding 9.1 The Bidder shall bear all costs associated with the preparation and submission of
its Bid, and the Employer shall in no case be responsible or liable for those
costs, regardless of the conduct or outcome of the bidding process.
10. Language of Bid 10.1 The Bid, as well as all correspondence and documents relating to the bid
exchanged by the Bidder and the Employer, shall be written in the language
specified in the BDS. Supporting documents and printed literature that are part
of the Bid may be in another language provided they are accompanied by an
accurate translation of the relevant passages in the language specified in the
BDS, in which case, for purposes of interpretation of the Bid, such translation
shall govern.
11. Documents 11.1 The Bid shall comprise two envelopes submitted simultaneously, one called the
Comprising the Technical Bid containing the documents listed in ITB 11.2 and the other the
Bid Price Bid containing the documents listed in ITB 11.3, both envelopes
enclosed together in an outer single envelope.
(e) Written confirmation authorizing the signatory of the Bid to commit the
Bidder, in accordance with ITB 20.2;
(h) In the case of a bid submitted by a JV, the JV agreement, or letter of intent
to enter into a JV including a draft agreement, indicating at least the parts of
the Works to be executed by the respective partners; and
(i) any other required documents, which is not against the provision of
Procurement Act/Regulation/Directives and Standard Bidding Document
issued by PPMO as specified in the BDS.
11.4 The Bidder is solely responsible for the authenticity of the documents submitted
by the Bidder.
12. Letter of Bid and 12.1 The Letter of Technical Bid and Priced Bid, Schedules, and all documents listed
Schedules under Clause 11, shall be prepared using the relevant forms in Section 4
(Bidding Forms), if so provided. The forms must be completed without any
alterations to the text, and no substitutes shall be accepted. All blank spaces shall
be filled in with the information requested.
13. Alternative Bids 13.1 Unless otherwise indicated in the BDS, alternative bids shall not be considered.
13.2 When alternative times for completion are explicitly invited, a statement to that
effect will be included in the BDS, as will the method of evaluating different
times for completion.
13.3 When specified in the BDS pursuant to ITB 13.1, and subject to ITB 13.4 below,
Bidders wishing to offer technical alternatives to the requirements of the
Bidding Document must first price the Employer’s design as described in the
Bidding Document and shall further provide all information necessary for a
complete evaluation of the alternative by the Employer, including drawings,
design calculations, technical specifications, breakdown of prices, and proposed
construction methodology and other relevant details.
13.4 When specified in the BDS, Bidders are permitted to submit alternative
technical solutions for specified parts of the Works. Such parts will be identified
in the BDS and described in Section 5 (Employer’s Requirements). The method
for their evaluation will be stipulated in Section 3 (Evaluation and Qualification
Criteria).
14. Bid Prices and 14.1 The prices and discounts quoted by the Bidder in the Letter of Price Bid and in
Discounts the Schedules shall conform to the requirements specified below.
14.2 The Bidder shall submit a Price bid for the whole of the works described in ITB
1.1 by filling in prices for all items of the Works, as identified in Section 4
(Bidding Forms). In case of Unit Rate Contracts, the Bidder shall fill in rates and
prices for all items of the Works described in the Bill of Quantities. Items
against which no rate or price is entered by the Bidder will not be paid for by the
Employer when executed and shall be deemed covered by the rates for other
items and prices in the Bill of Quantities.
14.3 The price to be quoted in the Letter of Price Bid shall be the total price of the
Bid, excluding any discounts offered.
14.4 Unconditional discounts, if any, and the methodology for their application shall be
quoted in the Letter of Price Bid, in accordance with ITB 12.1.
14.5 If so indicated in ITB 1.1, bids are invited for individual Contracts or for any
combination of Contracts (packages). Bidders wishing to offer any price
reduction for the award of more than one Contract shall specify in their bid the
price reductions applicable to each package, or alternatively, to individual
Contracts within the package. Price reductions or discounts shall be submitted in
accordance with ITB 14.3, provided the bids for all Contracts are submitted and
opened at the same time.
14.6 Unless otherwise provided in the BDS and the Conditions of Contract, the prices
quoted by the Bidder shall be fixed. If the prices quoted by the Bidder are
subject to adjustment during the performance of the Contract in accordance with
the provisions of the Conditions of Contract, the Bidder shall furnish the indices
and weightings for the price adjustment formulae in the Table of Adjustment
Data in Section 4 (Bidding Forms) and the Employer may require the Bidder to
justify its proposed indices and weightings.
14.7 The bidder is subject to local taxes such as VAT, social charges or income taxes
on nonresident international personnel, and also duties, fees, levies on amounts
payable by the employer under the Contract. All duties, taxes, and other levies
payable by the Contractor under
the Contract, or for any other cause, as of the date 30 days prior to the deadline
for submission of bids, shall be included in the rates and prices and the total bid
15. Currencies of Bid 15.1 The unit rates and the prices shall be quoted by the bidder entirely in Nepalese
and Payment currency if not otherwise specified in the BDS.
15.2 Bidders shall indicate the portion of the bid price that corresponds to expenditures
incurred in Nepalese currency in the Schedule of Payment Currencies included in
Section 4 (Bidding Forms).
15.3 Bidders expecting to incur expenditures in other currencies for inputs to the Works
supplied from outside the Employer’s country and wishing to be paid accordingly
may indicate up to three convertible foreign currencies included in daily
publication of Nepal Rastra Bank foreign currency exchange rate in the Schedule
of Payment Currencies included in Section 4 (Bidding Forms).
15.4 The rates of exchange to be used by the bidder for currency conversion during
bid preparation shall be the selling rates for similar transactions prevailing on
the date 30 days prior to the deadline for submission of bids published by Nepal
Rastra Bank. Bidders should note that for the purpose of payments, the
exchange rates confirmed by Nepal Rastra Bank as the selling rates prevailing
30 days prior to the deadline for submission of bids shall apply for the duration
of the Contract so that no currency exchange risk is borne by the bidder.
15.6 Bidders may be required by the Employer to clarify their foreign currency
requirements, and to substantiate that the amounts included in the unit rates and
prices and shown in the Schedule of Payment Currencies are reasonable and
responsive to ITB 15.3 above, in which case a detailed breakdown of its foreign
currency requirements shall be provided by the Bidder.
15.7 Bidders should note that during the progress of the Works, the foreign currency
requirements of the outstanding balance of the Contract Price may be adjusted by
agreement between the Employer and the Contractor in order to reflect any
changes in foreign currency requirements for the Contract, in accordance with
Sub-Clause 14.15 of the Conditions of Contract. Any such adjustment shall be
effected by comparing the percentages quoted in the bid with the amounts already
used in the Works and the Contractor's future needs for imported items.
16. Documents 16.1 The Bidder shall furnish a Technical Proposal including a statement of work
Comprising the methods, equipment, personnel, schedule and any other information as stipulated
Technical Proposal in Section 4 (Bidding Forms), in sufficient detail to demonstrate the adequacy of
the Bidders’ proposal to meet the work requirements and the completion time.
17. Documents 17.1 To establish its qualifications to perform the Contract in accordance with
Establishing the Section 3 (Evaluation and Qualification Criteria) the Bidder shall provide the
Qualifications of information requested in the corresponding information sheets included in
the Bidder Section 4 (Bidding Forms).
17.2 Domestic Bidders, individually or in joint ventures, applying for eligibility for
domestic preference shall supply all information required to satisfy the criteria
for eligibility as described in ITB 34 if margin of preference for domestic
bidders is applicable in accordance with ITB 34.
18. Period of Validity 18.1 Bids shall remain valid for the period specified in the BDS after the bid
of Bids submission deadline date prescribed by the Employer. A bid valid for a shorter
period shall be rejected by the Employer as non responsive.
18.2 In exceptional circumstances, prior to the expiration of the bid validity period, the
Employer may request Bidders to extend the period of validity of their Bids. The
request and the responses shall be made in writing. If a bid security is requested in
accordance with ITB 19, it shall also be extended 30 days beyond the deadline of the
extended validity period. A Bidder may refuse the request without forfeiting its bid
security. A Bidder granting the request shall not be required or permitted to modify
its Bid and to include any additional conditions against the provisions specified in
Bid Documents.
19. Bid Security 19.1 The Bidder shall furnish as part of its bid, in original form, a bid security as
specified in the BDS. In case of e-submission of bid, the Bidder shall upload
scanned copy of Bid security letter at the time of electronic submission of the bid.
The Bidder accepts that the scanned copy of the Bid security shall, for all purposes,
be equal to the original. The details of original Bid Security and the scanned copy
submitted with e-bid should be the same otherwise the bid shall be non-responsive.
19.2 The bid security shall be, at the Bidder’s option, in any of the following forms:
19.3 The bid security issued by any foreign Bank outside Nepal must be counter
guaranteed by a Commercial Bank or Financial Institution eligible to issue Bank
Guarantee as per prevailing Law in Nepal.
19.4 Any bid not accompanied by an enforceable and substantially compliant bid
security, if required in accordance with ITB 19.1, shall be rejected by the
Employer as nonresponsive. In case of e- Submission, if the scanned copy of an
acceptable Bid Security letter is not uploaded with the electronic Bid then Bid shall
be rejected.
19.5 The bid security of unsuccessful Bidders shall be returned within three days,
once the successful bidder has furnished the required performance security and
signed the Contract Agreement pursuant to ITB 41.1 and ITB 42.1.
19.7 The Bid Security of a JV shall be in the name of the JV that submits the bid. If
the JV has not been legally constituted at the time of bidding, the Bid Security
shall be in the names of all future partners as named in the letter of intent
mentioned in ITB 4.1.
20. Format and 20.1 The Bidder shall prepare one original of the documents comprising the bid as
Signing of Bid described in ITB 11 and clearly mark it “ORIGINAL”. Alternative bids, if
permitted in accordance with ITB 13, shall be clearly marked
“ALTERNATIVE”. In addition, the Bidder shall submit copies of the bid in the
number specified in the BDS, and clearly mark each of them “COPY.” In the
event of any discrepancy between the original and the copies, the original shall
prevail.
In case of e-submission of bid, the Bidder shall submit his bid electronically
in PDF or web forms files as specified in ITB Clause 21.1(b), If a Bidder
submits both the electronic bid and a bid in hard copy within the bid submission
deadline, then the submitted Bids shall be accepted for evaluation provided that the
facts and figures in hard copy confirm to those in electronic bid. If there is any major
discrepancy in fact and figures in the electronic bid and bid in hard copy, it shall be
treated as two separate bids from one Bidder and both the Bids shall be
disqualified, as per ITB Clause 4.3 (e).
20.2 The original and all copies of the bid shall be typed or written in indelible ink
and shall be signed by a person duly authorized to sign on behalf of the Bidder.
This authorization shall consist of a written confirmation as specified in the BDS
and shall be attached to the bid. The name and position held by each person
signing the authorization must be typed or printed below the signature. All pages
of the bid, except for unamended printed literature, shall be signed or initialed
by the person signing the bid.
21. Sealing and 21.1 Bidders may always submit their bids by mail or by hand or by courier. When so
Marking of Bids specified in the BDS, bidders shall have the option of submitting their bids
electronically. Procedures for submission, sealing and marking are as follows:
i. Bidders shall enclose the original of the Technical Bid, and the original of the
Price Bid and each copy of the Technical Bid and Price Bid, including
alternative bids, if permitted in accordance with ITB 13, in separate sealed
envelopes, duly marking the envelopes as: “ORIGINAL TECHNICAL
BID”,“ORIGINAL PRICE BID”, “ALTERNATIVE BID” and “COPY OF
TECHNICAL BID” and “COPY OF PRICE BID”. These envelopes containing
the original and the copies shall then be enclosed in one single envelope.
ii. The inner and outer envelopes shall:
(aa) bear the name and address of the Bidder;
(bb) be addressed to the Employer as provided in BDS 22.1;
(cc) bear the specific identification of this bidding process indicated in
BDS 1.1;
(dd) The outer envelope and the inner envelope containing Technical Bid
shall bear a warning not to open before the time and date for the opening
of Technical Bid in accordance with ITB 25.1.
iii. The inner envelope containing the Price Bid shall bear a warning not to open
until advised by the Employer in accordance with ITB 25.7
iv. If all envelopes are not sealed and marked as required, the Employer
will assume no responsibility for the misplacement or premature opening
of the bid.
(b) Electronic Bid Submission Procedures : Bidders submitting Bids electronically
shall follow the electronic bid submission procedure specified in this clause as
follows:
i. For e-submission, the bidder is required to register in the e-GP portal
https://www.bolpatra.gov.np for downloading and submitting the bid
electronically.
ii. Interested bidders may either purchase the bidding documents from the
employer's office as specified in the invitation for bid (IFB) or bidders
registered in the e-GP portal of PPMO may download the bidding document
from http://www.bolpatra.gov.np after login. If bidders choose to download
the bidding document and submit the bid electronically, then the cost of the
bidding document shall be deposited as specified in IFB. In addition,
electronic scanned copy (.pdf format) of the bank deposit voucher/cash
receipt should also be submitted along with the electronic bid files.
iii. The bidder shall then prepare/fill the documents and forms included in the
issued bid documents or the downloaded bid documents from the e-GP
portal of PPMO - http://www.bolpatra.gov.np as applicable. The required
documents and forms shall be prepared in PDF form and/or shall be filled
in the web forms in the e-GP system as specified below:
Technical Bid:
Price Bid;
Note:
a) Bidders (all partners in case of JV) should verify/update their profile
documents as appropriate for the specific bid before submitting their bid
electronically.
iv) The Bidder shall then upload the PDF bid files and submit the complete bid online
through e-GP portal of PPMO- http://www.bolpatra.gov.np within the specified
date and time.
v) Bidders are advised to download the bid submission report to ensure that all the
documents/ files are up to date and complete.
vi) The Bidder / Bid shall meet the following requirements and conditions for e-
submission of bids;
aa) The e-submitted bids must be readable through open standards interfaces.
Unreadable and or partially submitted bid files shall be considered incomplete
and rejected for further bid evaluation.
bb) In addition to electronically submitted PDF files/web forms, the Bidder shall
be required to submit original bid security letter/ documents and clarifications
as specified in ITB Clause 27. If a bidder does not submit the original Bid
security letter and requested documents and or clarifications within the
specified time limit then the bid shall not be considered for further evaluation.
cc) If major discrepancy is found between the electronically submitted PDF bid
files and the documents/ clarifications provided by the Bidder as per ITB
Clause 27, then the bid shall not be considered for further evaluation.
dd) The facility for submission of bid electronically through e-submission is to
promote transparency, non-discrimination, equality of access, and open
competition in the bidding process. The Bidders are fully responsible to use
the e- submission facility properly in e-GP portal of PPMO-
http://www.bolpatra.gov.np as per specified procedures and in no case the
Employer shall be held liable for Bidder's inability to use this facility.
ee) When a bidder submits electronic bid through the PPMO e-GP portal, it is
assumed that the bidder has prepared the bid by studying and examining the
complete set of the Bidding documents including specifications, drawings and
conditions of contract.
ff) Bidders who submit electronic bid should deposit the bidding document fee as
specified in IFB and upload the scan copy (in pdf format) of the deposit
voucher at the time of bid submission. The deposited amount shall be verified
by the Employer during the bid evaluation process. The submitted Bid shall be
non-responsive and shall not be evaluated if the cost for bidding document is
not deposited as specified in the IFB.
22. Deadline for 22.1 Bids must be received by the Employer at the address and no later than the date
In case of e-submission, the standard time for e-submission is Nepal Standard Time
as set out in the server. The e-procurement system will accept the e-submission of
bid from the date of publishing of notice and will automatically not allow the e-
submission of bid after the deadline for submission of bid.
22.2 The Employer may, at its discretion, extend the deadline for the submission of
bids by amending the Bidding Document in accordance with ITB 8, in which
case all rights and obligations of the Employer and Bidders previously subject to
the deadline shall thereafter be subject to the deadline as extended.
23. Late Bids 23.1 The Employer shall not consider any bid that arrives after the deadline for
submission of bids, in accordance with ITB 22. Any bid received by the
Employer after the deadline for submission of bids shall be declared late,
rejected, and returned unopened to the Bidder.
24. Withdrawal, and 24.1 A Bidder may withdraw, or modify its bid after it has been submitted either in
Modification of hard copy or by e-submission. Procedures for withdrawal or modification of
Bids submitted bids are as follows:
24.2 Bids requested to be withdrawn in accordance with ITB 24.1 shall be returned
unopened to the Bidders after completion of the bid opening.
24.3 Bidder may submit request for withdrawal or modification only one time.
24.4 No bid may be withdrawn if the bid has already been modified.
24.6 In case of hard copy bid, no bid may be withdrawn if the bid has already been
modified; except in case of any modification or correction in bid document by
procuring entity.
24.7 Request for withdrawal or modification must be made through the same medium
of submission. Request for withdrawal or modifications through different medium
shall not be considered.
24.8 The following provisions apply for withdrawal or modification of the Bids:
(i) In case of bids submitted in hard copy no bid shall be withdrawn or
modified in the interval between 24 hours prior to the deadline for
submission of bids and the expiration of the period of bid validity
specified by the Bidder on the Letter of Bid or any extension thereof.
25. Bid Opening 25.1 The Employer shall open the bids in public at the address, date and time specified
in the BDS in the presence of Bidders` designated representatives and anyone who
choose to attend. Then the Employer shall segregate the Technical Bid and Price
Bid separately. The Price Bids will remain unopened and will be held in custody
of the Employer until the specified time of their opening. If the Technical Bid
and Price Bid are submitted together in one inner envelope, the Employer may
reject the entire Bid.
25.2 The Employer shall download the e-submitted Bid files. The e-procurement
system allows the Employer to download the e-submitted bid files (report) only
after bid opening date and time after login simultaneously by at least two members
of the Bid opening committee.
25.3 After downloading the each e-bid, electronically submitted Technical Bid shall
be opened at first in the same time and date as specified above. Electronic Bids
shall be opened one by one and read out. The e-submitted technical bids must be
readable through open standards interfaces. Unreadable and or partially
submitted bid files shall be considered incomplete.
25.4 Thereafter, envelopes marked “WITHDRAWAL” shall be opened and read out
and the envelope with the corresponding Bid shall not
be opened, but returned to the Bidder. No bid withdrawal shall be permitted
unless the corresponding withdrawal notice contains
a valid authorization to request the withdrawal and is read out
at bid opening. Next, envelopes marked “MODIFICATION”
shall be opened and read out with the corresponding bid. No
Technical Bid and/or Price Bid modification shall be permitted unless the
corresponding modification notice contains a valid authorization to request
the modification and is read out and recorded at bid opening. Only the Technical
Bid, both Original as well as Modification, are to be opened, read out, and
recorded at the opening. Price Bids, both Original and Modification, will remain
unopened in accordance with ITB 25.1.
25.5 All other envelopes holding the Technical Bid shall be opened one at a time,
reading out: the name of the Bidder; whether there is a modification; the presence
of a bid security and any other details as the Employer may consider appropriate.
Only Technical Bids read out and recorded at bid opening shall be considered for
evaluation. No bid shall be rejected at opening of Technical Bids except for late
25.6 The Employer shall prepare a record of the opening of Technical Bids that shall
include, as a minimum: the name of the Bidder and whether there
is a withdrawal, or modification; and
the presence or absence of a bid security. The Bidders’ representatives who are
present shall be requested to sign the record. The omission of a Bidder’s signature
on the record shall not invalidate the contents and effect of the record.
25.7 At the end of the evaluation of the Technical Bids, the Employer will invite
bidders who have submitted substantially responsive Technical Bids and who
have been determined as being qualified for award to attend the opening of the
Price Bids. The date, time, and location of the opening of Price Bids will be
advised in writing by the Employer. Bidders shall be given reasonable notice for
the opening of Price Bids.
25.8 The Employer will notify Bidders in writing who have been rejected on the
grounds of their Technical Bids being substantially nonresponsive to the
requirements of the Bidding Document and return their Price Bids unopened.
25.9 The Employer shall conduct the opening of Price Bids of all Bidders who
submitted substantially responsive Technical Bids, in the presence of Bidders`
representatives who choose to attend at the address, on the date, and time
specified by the Employer. The Bidder’s representatives who are present shall be
requested to sign a register evidencing their attendance.
25.10 All envelopes containing Price Bids shall be opened one at a time and the
following read out and recorded:
Only Price Bids, discounts, modifications, and alternative offers read out and
recorded during the opening of Price Bids shall be considered for evaluation.. No
Bid shall be rejected at the opening of Price Bids.
25.11 The Employer shall prepare a record of the opening of Price Bids that shall
include, as a minimum, the name of the Bidder, the Bid Price (per lot if
applicable), any discounts, modifications and alternative offers. The Bidders’
representatives who are present shall be requested to sign the record. The
omission of a Bidder’s signature on the record shall not invalidate the contents
and effect of the record.
26. Confidentiality 26.1 Information relating to the examination, evaluation, comparison, and post
qualification of bids and recommendation of Contract award, shall not be
disclosed to Bidders or any other persons not officially concerned with such
process until information on Contract award is communicated to all Bidders.
26.2 Any attempt by a Bidder to influence the Employer in the evaluation of the bids or
26.3 Notwithstanding ITB 26.2, from the time of bid opening to the time of Contract
award, if any Bidder wishes to contact the Employer on any matter related to the
bidding process, it may do so in writing.
27. Clarification of 27.1 To assist in the examination, evaluation, and comparison of the Technical and
Bids Price Bids, and qualification of the Bidders, the Employer may, at its
discretion, ask any Bidder for a clarification of its Bid. Any clarification
submitted by a Bidder that is not in response to a request by the Employer shall not
be considered. The Employer’s request for clarification and the response shall be in
writing. No change in the substance of the Technical Bid or prices in the Price Bid
shall be sought, offered, or permitted, except to confirm the correction of arithmetic
errors discovered by the Employer in the evaluation of the Price Bids. In case of e-
submission of bid, upon notification from the employer, the bidder shall also submit
the original of documents comprising the Technical and Price Bid as per ITB 11 for
verification of submitted documents for acceptance of the e-submitted bid.
27.2 If a Bidder does not provide clarifications of its bid by the date and time set in
the Employer’s request for clarification, its bid may be rejected.
28. Deviations, 28.1 During the evaluation of bids, the following definitions apply:
Reservations, and
Omissions a) “Deviation” is a departure from the requirements specified in the Bidding
Document;
29. Determination of 29.1 The Employer’s determination of a bid’s responsiveness is to be based on the
Responsiveness contents of the bid itself, as defined in ITB11.
29.2 A substantially responsive Technical Bid is one that meets the requirements of the
Bidding Document without material deviation, reservation, or omission. A material
deviation, reservation, or omission is one that,
29.3 The Employer shall examine the technical aspects of the Bid submitted in
accordance with ITB 16, Technical Proposal, in particular, to confirm that all
requirements of Section 5 (Works Requirements) have been met without any
material deviation, reservation or omission.
29.5 In case of e-submission bids, the Employer evaluates the bid on the basis of the
information in the electronically submitted bid files. If the Bidder cannot
substantiate or provide evidence to establish the information provided in e-
submitted bid through documents/ clarifications as per ITB Clause 27, the bid
shall not be considered for further evaluation.
29.6 In Case, a corruption case is being filed to Court against the Natural Person or Board
of Director of the firm/institution /company or any partner of JV, such Natural
Person or Board of Director of the firm/institution /company or any partner of JV
such bidder’s bid shall be excluded from the evaluation, if public entity receives
instruction from Government of Nepal.
29.7 Except in case of e-submission, the Financial Bid of the bidder, which is evaluated as
substantially non-responsive in technical bid, shall be returned to the respective
bidders.
30. Nonconformities, 30.1 Provided that a bid is substantially responsive, the Employer may waive any
Errors, and nonconformities in the bid that do not constitute a material deviation, reservation or
Omissions omission.
30.2 Provided that a Technical Bid is substantially responsive, the Employer may
request that the Bidder submit the necessary information or documentation,
within a reasonable period of time, to rectify nonmaterial nonconformities in the
Technical Bid related to documentation requirements. Requesting information or
documentation on such nonconformities shall not be related to any aspect of the
Price Bid. Failure of the Bidder to comply with the request may result in the
rejection of its bid.
30.3 Provided that a Technical bid is substantially responsive, the Employer shall
rectify quantifiable nonmaterial nonconformities related to the Bid Price. To this
effect, the Bid Price may be adjusted, for comparison purposes only, to reflect
the price of a missing or non-conforming item or component. The adjustment
shall be made using the methods indicated in Section 3 (Evaluation and
Qualification Criteria).
30.5 If the value of such non-conformities is found to be more than fifteen percent of the
quoted amount of the bidder on account of minor discrepancies pursuant to ITB
30.4, such bid shall be considered ineffective in substance and shall not be involved
in evaluation.
31. Qualification of
31.1 The Employer shall determine to its satisfaction during the evaluation of
the Bidder
Technical Bids whether Bidders meet the qualifying criteria specified in Section 3
(Evaluation and Qualification Criteria).
32. Correction of 32.1 During the evaluation of Price Bids, the Employer shall correct arithmetical
Arithmetical errors on the following basis:
Errors
(a) only for unit price Contracts, if there is a discrepancy between the unit price
and the total price that is obtained by multiplying the unit price and quantity,
the unit price shall prevail and the total price shall be corrected, unless in the
opinion of the Employer there is an obvious misplacement of the decimal
point in the unit price, in which case the total price as quoted shall govern
and the unit price shall be corrected;
(c) if there is a discrepancy between words and figures, the amount in words
shall prevail, unless the amount expressed in words is related to an
arithmetic error, in which case the amount in figures shall prevail subject to
(a) and (b) above.
32.2 If the Bidder that submitted the lowest evaluated bid does not accept the
correction of errors, its bid shall be disqualified and its bid security may be
forfeited.
33. Conversion to 33.1 For evaluation and comparison purposes, the currency (ies) of the bid shall be
Single Currency converted into a single currency as specified in the BDS.
34. Domestic 34.1 Unless otherwise specified in the BDS, a domestic preference shall be a factor
Preference in bid evaluation.
35. Subcontractors 35.1 The Employer may permit subcontracting for certain specialized works as
indicated in Section 3. When subcontracting is permitted by the Employer, the
specialized sub-contractor’s experience shall be considered for evaluation.
Section 3 describes the qualification criteria for sub-contractors.
36.2 To evaluate a Price bid, the Employer shall consider the following:
(a) the bid price, excluding Value Added Tax , Provisional Sums, and the provision,
if any, for contingencies in the Summary Bill of Quantities, for Unit Rate
Contracts, or Schedule of Prices for lump sum Contracts, but including Day
work items, where priced competitively;
(b) price adjustment for correction of arithmetic errors in accordance with ITB
32;
(c) price adjustment due to discounts offered in accordance with ITB 14.4;
(d) converting the amount resulting from applying (a) to (c) above, if relevant,
to a single currency in accordance with ITB 33;
36.3 The estimated effect of the price adjustment provisions of the Conditions of
Contract, applied over the period of execution of the Contract, shall not be taken
into account in bid evaluation.
36.4 If this Bidding Document allows Bidders to quote separate prices for different
Contracts, and to award multiple Contracts to a single Bidder, the methodology
to determine the lowest evaluated price of the Contract combinations, including
any discounts offered in the Letter of Bid, is specified in Section 3 (Evaluation
and Qualification Criteria).
36.5 If the bid for an Unit Rate Contract, which results in the lowest Evaluated Bid
Price is seriously unbalanced or front loaded or extremely low in the opinion of
the Employer, the Employer may require the Bidder to produce detailed price
analysis for any or all items of the Bill of Quantities, to demonstrate the internal
consistency of those prices with the construction methods and schedule
proposed. After evaluation of the price analysis, taking into consideration the
schedule of estimated Contract payments, the Employer may require that the
amount of the performance security be increased at the expense of the Bidder as
mentioned in BDS to protect the Employer against financial loss in the event of
default of the successful Bidder under the Contract or may consider the bid as
non-responsive.
36.6 In case of e-submission bids, the Employer evaluates the bid on the basis of the
information in the electronically submitted bid files. If the Bidder cannot
substantiate or provide evidence to establish the information provided in e-
submitted bid through documents/ clarifications as per ITB Clause 27, the bid
shall not be considered for further evaluation.
36.7 In Case, a corruption case is being filed to Court against the Natural Person or
Board of Director of the firm/institution /company or any partner of JV, such
Natural Person or Board of Director of the firm/institution /company or any
partner of JV such bidder’s bid shall be excluded from the evaluation, if public
entity receives instruction from Government of Nepal.
37. Comparison of 37.1 The Employer shall compare all substantially responsive bids in accordance with
Bids ITB 36.2 to determine the lowest evaluated bid.
38. Employer’s Right 38.1 The Employer reserves the right to accept or reject any bid, and to annul the
to Accept Any Bid, bidding process and reject all bids at any time prior to Contract award, without
and to Reject Any thereby incurring any liability to Bidders. In case of annulment, all bids
or All Bids submitted and specifically, bid securities, shall be promptly returned to the
Bidders.
F. Award of Contract
39. Award Criteria 39.1 The Employer shall award the Contract to the Bidder whose offer has been
determined to be the lowest evaluated bid and is substantially responsive to the
40. Letter of Intent to 40.1 The Employer shall notify the concerned Bidder whose bid has been selected in
Award the accordance with ITB 39.1 within seven days of the selection of the bid, in writing
Contract/ that the Employer has intention to accept its bid and the information regarding the
Notification of name, address and amount of selected bidder shall be given to all other bidders
Award who submitted the bid.
40.2 If no bidder submits an application within a period of seven days of the notice
provided under ITB 40.1, the Employer shall, accept the bid selected in accordance
with ITB 39.1 and Letter of Acceptance shall be communicated to the selected
bidder prior to the expiration of period of Bid validity, to furnish the performance
security and sign the contract within fifteen days.
40.3 At the same time, the Employer shall affix a public notice on the result of the
award on its notice board and may make arrangements to post the notice into its
website, if it has; and if it does not have, into the website of the Public
Procurement Monitoring Office, identifying the bid and lot numbers and the
following information: (i) name of each Bidder who submitted a Bid; (ii) bid prices
as read out at Bid Opening; (iii) name and evaluated prices of each Bid; (iv) name of
bidders whose bids were rejected and the reasons for their rejection; and (v) name of
the winning Bidder, and the Price it offered, as well as the duration and summary
scope of the Contract awarded.
40.4 In Case, a corruption case is being filed to Court against the Natural Person or Board
of Director of the firm/institution /company or any partner of JV, such Natural
Person or Board of Director of the firm/institution /company or any partner of JV
such bidder’s bid shall be excluded from the evaluation, if public entity receives
instruction from Government of Nepal.
41. Performance 41.1 Within Fifteen (15) days of the receipt of Letter of Acceptance from the
Security Employer, the successful Bidder shall furnish the performance security in
accordance with the Conditions of Contract, as specified below from
Commercial Bank or Financial Institution eligible to issue Bank Guarantee as per
prevailing Law in Nepal using Sample Form for the Performance Security
included in Section 9 (Contract Forms), or another form acceptable to the
Employer. The performance security issued by any foreign Bank outside Nepal
must be counter guaranteed by Commercial Bank or Financial Institution eligible to
issue Bank Guarantee as per prevailing Law in Nepal.
ii) For the bid price of the bidder selected for acceptance is more than 15 (fifteen)
percent below of the cost estimate, the performance security amount shall be
determined as follows:
The Bid Price and Cost Estimate shall be inclusive of Value Added Tax.
the annulment of the award and forfeiture of the bid security. In that event the
Employer may award the Contract to the next lowest evaluated Bidder whose
offer is substantially responsive and is determined by the Employer to be
qualified to perform the Contract satisfactorily. In such case, the award process
shall be repeated according to ITB 40.
42. Signing of 42.1 The Employer and the successful Bidder shall sign the Contract Agreement
Contract within the period as stated ITB 41.1.
42.2 Within thirty (30) days from the date of issuance of notification pursuant to ITB
40.1 unsuccessful bidders may request in writing to the Employer for a debriefing
seeking explanations on the grounds on which their bids were not selected. The
Employer shall promptly respond in writing to any unsuccessful Bidder who,
requests for debriefing.
42.3 If the bidder whose bid has been accepted fails to sign the contract as stated ITB 42.1,
the Public Procurement Monitoring Office shall blacklist the bidder on
recommendation of the Public Entity.
43. Complain and 43.1 If a Bidder is dissatisfied with the Procurement proceedings or the decision made
Review by the Employer in the intention to award the Contract, it may file an application
to the Chief of the Public Entity (Employer) within Seven (7) days of providing
the notice under ITB 40.1 by the Public Entity, for review of the proceedings
stating the factual and legal grounds.
43.2 Late application filed after the deadline pursuant to ITB 43.1 shall not be
processed.
43.3 The chief of Public Entity(Employer) shall, within five (5) days after receiving the
application, give its decision with reasons, in writing pursuant to ITB 43.1:
The decision of the chief of Public Entity shall be final for the Bid amount ,less
than Rupees Twenty Million (NRs. 20,000,000).
43.4 If the Bidder is not satisfied with the decision given in accordance with ITB 43.3, or
the decision is not given within five (5) days of receipt of application pursuant to ITB
43.1, it can, within seven (7) days of receipt of such decision, file an application to
the Review Committee of the GoN, stating the reason of its disagreement on the
decision and furnishing the relevant supporting documents. The application may be
sent by hand, by post, by courier, or by electronic media at the risk of the Bidder
itself.
43.5 Late application filed after the deadline pursuant to ITB 43.4 shall not be
processed
43.6 Within three (3) days of the receipt of application from the Bidder, pursuant
to ITB 43.4, the Review Committee shall notify the concerning Public Entity
to furnish its procurement proceedings, pursuant to ITB 43.3.
43.7 Within three (3) days of receipt of the notification pursuant to ITB 43.6, the
Public Entity shall furnish the copy of the related documents to the Review
Committee.
43.8 The Review Committee, after inquiring from the Bidder and the Public Entity, if
needed, shall give its decision within one (1) month of the receipt of the
application filed by the Bidder, pursuant to ITB 43.4.
43.9 The Bidder, filing application pursuant to ITB 43.4, shall have to furnish a cash
amount or Bank guarantee from Commercial Bank or Financial Institution
eligible to issue Bank Guarantee as per prevailing Law equivalent to one
percent (1%) of its quoted amount with the validity period of at least ninety (90)
days from the date of the filing of application pursuant to ITB 43.4.
43.10 If the claim made by the Bidder pursuant to ITB 43.4 is justified, the Review
Committee shall return the security deposit pursuant to ITB 43 to the applicant,
within seven (7) days of such decision made.
A. General
ITB 1.1 The name of the ICB is: "Procurement of Plant for Design, Supply, Installation,
Testing and Commissioning of Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line and
Loharpatti 132/33/11 kV Substation"
The identification number of the ICB is: ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
The number and identification of lots comprising this ICB is: None
ITB 2.1 The name of the Project is: Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
ITB 4.1 (a) Maximum number of partner in a joint venture shall be : 3 (three)
ITB 4.2 Eligible countries: All countries are eligible unless otherwise restricted by the
Government of Nepal (GoN).
ITB 4.9 Tax Clearance Certificate or Proof of submission of income return for: Last Fiscal year
2075/76.
The foreign bidder shall declare to submit the following documents at the time of contact
agreement:
But, Resident foreign bidder shall submit PAN/VAT certificate and tax clearance
certificate or proof of submission of Income Return for last fiscal year 2075/76.
Volume I:
Invitation for Bids (IFB)
Volume II
Section 5: Employer's work requirements and drawings
Volume III
Section 6: Bill of Quantities (BOQ)
ITB 7.1 For clarification purposes only, the Employer’s address is:
Attention:
C. Preparation of Bids
ITB 11.2 (i) The Bidder shall submit with its Technical Bid the following additional documents:
4. Work Completion Certificate (on the letter head of the End-User) for all relevant Projects
completed in the last 10 years with contact person’s address and Tel. no.
8. Test Certificate for major items as mentioned in Section III Evaluation and Qualification
Criteria
If a foreign bidder has engaged a Nepalese agent, it will be required to give the following
details in its bid as per the format enclosed in the Bidding Documents:
iii) The fixed amount of remuneration for the agent included in the offer;
The agency commission shall be indicated in the space provided for in the Price Schedule and
will be paid to the Bidder's agent in Nepal in Nepalese Rupees using the Nepal Rastra Bank
(NRB) Exchange (Buying) Rate ruling on the date of notification of award and shall not be
subject to any escalation or any further exchange variations.
ITB 11.3 (b) In accordance with ITB 12 and ITB 14, the following schedules shall be submitted with the
bid, including the priced Bill of Quantities for Unit Rate Contracts and Schedule of Prices
for lump sum contracts: None
ITB 11.3 (d) The Bidder shall submit with its bid the following additional documents: None
ITB 13.4 Alternative technical solutions shall be permitted for the following parts of the Works:
“Not Applicable”.
ITB 14.6 The prices quoted by the Bidder “shall not be” subject to adjustment.
ITB 15.1 The unit rates and the prices shall be quoted by the bidder entirely in:
It is further instructed,
(a) Price Schedule No. 1 (Plant and Equipment including mandatory spare parts supplied
from abroad)
The prices shall be quoted either in the currency of Nepalese Rupees (NRs.) or
foreign currency (USD) only.
(b) Price Schedule No. 2 (Plant and Equipment including mandatory spare parts supplied
from within Employer’s Country)
(c) Price Schedule No 3 (Local transportation, Insurance, and Other Incidental Service
including port clearance etc)
The prices shall be quoted either in the currency of Nepalese Rupees (NRs.) or
foreign currency (USD) only.
ITB 18.1 The bid validity period shall be: One Hundred Twenty (120) days.
ITB 19.1 The Bidder shall furnish a bid security, from Commercial Bank or Financial Institution
eligible to issue Bank Guarantee as per prevailing Law with a minimum of NRs.
26,500,000 or USD 230,000, which shall be valid for 30 days beyond the validity period
of the bid
ITB 19.2 (b) Bid security shall be in the form of unconditional bank guarantee.
ITB 20.1 Bidders shall have only the option of submitting their bids - electronically (in uploadable
format). No bid shall be accepted by mail or by hand or by courier.
The electronic bid submission procedures shall be as per latest e-GP Guidelines of PPMO.
ITB 20.2 The written confirmation of authorization to sign on behalf of the Bidder shall indicate:
(a) Power of attorney duly notarized in favor of person signing the bid; and
(b) In the case of Bids submitted by an existing or intended JV, an undertaking signed by all
ITB 21.1 There is no provision of hard copy submission. Therefore, hard copy is not required. The bids
submitted electronically are considered as original. However, if required as per ITB 27, the
Bidder shall be required to submit original Bid Security letter/documents and other
clarifications as required.
Price Bid:
*Bidder shall get pdf format of BOQ in Bid document uploaded by Employer. They have to
fill it as per instruction, put name, signature designation stamp on it and upload it as Price Bid
with letter of Price Bid..
ITB 22.1 For bid submission purposes only, the Employer’s address is: No hard copy submission
permitted.
Date: February 10, 2020, 12:00 hrs. (Noon) (server time of PPMO)
ITB 33.1 The currency that shall be used for bid evaluation and comparison purposes to convert all
bid prices if permitted and expressed in various currencies into a single currency is:
Nepalese Rupees
The source of exchange rate shall be: Nepal Rastra Bank
The date for the exchange rate shall be: 30 days prior to the deadline for submission of
bids.
ITB 36.5 The amount of the performance security be increased by Eight (8) percent of the quoted bid
price.
Table of Criteria
1. Evaluation ....................................................................................................................................3-3
2. Qualification.................................................................................................................................3-5
2.1.3 UN Eligibility......................................................................................................................3-5
2.7 Subcontractors/Manufacturers..........................................................................3-13
1. Evaluation
In addition to the criteria listed in ITB 36.2 (a) – (f) the following criteria shall apply:
The Bidder shall give information about his past performance by stating in his Bid the names of the
countries in which he has accomplished, within the last ten years, similar Work, by indicating the
year, type of Work, quantity and Contract number.
The Bidder shall state in his Bid the full names and addresses, telephone, fax numbers of the Clients
and the names of the Contact person.
For the purpose of verifying the information and data submitted by the Bidder, NEA reserves the
right to collect necessary information from these Clients.
"Not Applicable"
"Not Applicable"
"Not Applicable"
(a) For application of domestic preference, all responsive bids shall first be classified into the
following two categories:
(i) Category I: Bids offered by domestic contractors (domestic bidder firms, intuitions, or
company either in single or in joint venture (all partners)) ; and
(ii) Category II: Bids offered by International firms, intuitions or company or collaboration with
domestic firms, intuitions, company
(b) The lowest evaluated bid of each category shall then be determined by comparing all evaluated
bids in each category among themselves.
(c) Such lowest evaluated bids shall next be compared with each other and if, as a result of this
comparison, a bid from Category I is found to be the lowest, it shall be selected for the award of
contract.
(d) If, however, as a result of the comparison under (c) above, the lowest bid is found to be from
Category II, it shall be further compared with the lowest evaluated bid from Category I. For the
purpose of this further comparison only an upward adjustment (domestic preference) shall be
made to the lowest evaluated bid price of Category II by adding an amount equal to Five(5%)
of the bid price. If, after such comparison, the Category I bid is determined to be the lowest, it
shall be selected for the award of contract; if not, the lowest evaluated bid from Category II shall
be selected.
The plant and equipment covered by this bidding are required to be shipped, installed and the
successful completion of the Facilities shall have to be completed within 24 months from the
effective date of the Contract. Bidders are required to base their prices on the time schedule given in
Appendix 4 to the Form of Contract Agreement (Time Schedule) or, where no time schedule is
given in Appendix 4, on the Completion date(s) given above. No credit will be given to earlier
completion. Bids offering completion beyond the named period will be rejected. Bidder shall
also consider provision of work program stated in GCC clause 18 to base their prices.
Performance Guarantee
The performance figures quoted on Technical Data Sheet Technical Data Sheet (also called
General Technical Particulars) and/or Functional Guarantee Form shall be guaranteed within
the tolerances permitted by relevant standards listed under section of General Technical
Specifications, and shall become a part of the successful Tenderer's Contract. In case of loss
capitalization, no tolerance shall be permitted for the guaranteed value.
The transformer will be rejected if losses exceed the guaranteed value by an amount
in excess of the following:
2. Qualification
2.1 Eligibility
No conflicts of interest in must meet existing or must meet not Letter of Bid
accordance with ITB Sub- requirement intended JV requirement applicable
Clause 4.3. must meet
requirement
Applicant required to meet must meet existing or must meet not Forms
conditions of ITB Sub- requirement intended JV requirement applicable ELI -1, ELI
Clause 4.5. must meet - 2 with
requirement attachments
Not having been declared must meet existing or must meet not Application
ineligible by Development requirement intended JV requirement applicable Submission
Partner, as described in must meet Sheet
ITB Sub-Clause 4.4. requirement
2.1.4 UN Eligibility
Not having been declared must meet existing or must meet not Letter of
ineligible based on a requirement intended JV requirement applicable Bid
United Nations resolution must meet
or Employer’s country law, requirement
as described in ITB Sub-
Clause 4.7.
a. Domestic Bidders must meet existing or must meet not PAN and
Bidder required to requirement intended requirement applicable VAT
meet JV must registrati
conditions meet on
of ITB Sub- requireme certificat
Clause 4.9. nt e
All pending litigation shall be must meet not must meet not Form LIT –
treated as resolved against the requirement applicable requirement applicable 1
Applicant and so shall in total by itself or by itself or
not represent more than 50% as partner as partner
percent of the Applicant’s net to past or to past or
worth. existing JV existing JV
Note:
The Employer reserves the right to verify the pending litigation with respective
department.
All
Each One
Partners
Partner Partner
Combined
Submission of audited must meet not must meet not Form FIN -
balance sheets and income requirement applicable requirement applicable 1 with
statements, for the last three attachments
(3) years to demonstrate the
current soundness of the
applicant’s financial position.
As a minimum, a Bidder's net
worth calculated as the
difference between total
assets and total liabilities
should be positive.
Minimum average annual must meet must meet must meet must meet Form FIN
construction turnover of requirement requirement 25% 40% –2
USD 6.6 Million, calculated
of the of the
as total certified payments
requirement requirement
received for contracts in
progress or completed,
within best three years out
of last ten fiscalyears.
Using Forms FIN - 3 in must meet must meet must meet must meet Form FIN
Section IV (Bidding Forms) requirement requirement 25% 40% –3
the Bidder must demonstrate
of the of the
access to, or availability of,
requirement requirement
financial resources in the
form of “Lines of Credit”,”
the following cash-flow
requirement, USD 1.6
Million
Note:
Bidders shall fill the forms as mentioned above but notarized copy of the audit report
is mandatory to verify the forms. The audited balance sheet must have the sign of the
auditor with the stamp of the firm. For e-submission of bids, Xeroxed copy of audit
report is not advised to be uploaded, bidders are to upload the original audit report.
The Cover page of the Auditor’s information and Contact Address (Phone no. & the
mail address) shall be present.
If the Turnover submitted by the bidder is in the name of a Joint Venture in the past,
the bidder must submit the Joint Venture Agreement (notarized in case of Hard Copy
bid, original scanned Copy for e-submission), stating the % of JV for the calculation
of the turnover of the respective bidder.
For the Line of Credit the letter from the bank must be unconditional.
Due to limitations on file size for the e-submission bidders are requested to submit
only the necessary & related files to qualify the above conditions.
2.4 Experience
Criteria Compliance Requirements Documents
Submission
Joint Venture
Requirements
Single
Requirement All
Entity Each One
Partners
Partner Partner
Combined
Experience under construction must meet not must meet not Form EXP
contracts in the role of requirement applicable requirement applicable -1
contractor, subcontractor, or
management contractor for at
least the last Five (5) years
prior to the applications
submission deadline.
Participation as contractor, must meet must meet not not Form EXP -
management contractor, or requirement requirement applicable applicable 2(a)
subcontractor, in at least Two
(2) contracts within the last 10
years, each with a value of at
least USD 7.1 Million that
have been successfully or are
substantially completed and
that are similar to the proposed
works. The similarity herein
means and requires design,
supply, installation, testing
and commissioning of 110 kV
or above voltage level
transmission line or 110 kV or
above voltage level substation
or both combined in a single
contract.
In case the participation was in
form of joint venture,
Documents establishing the
works/financial
proportionality of each partner
must be included.
Note: Substantial completion of the projects here shall mean the 80% completion of total scope of
works in all respect (technical as well as financial) and is applicable for the ongoing projects only.
For the above or other must meet must meet must execute not Form EXP-
contracts executed during all all as a prime applicable 2(b)
the period stipulated in requirements contractor,
requirements
2.4.2(a) above, a management
contractor, or
minimum construction
subcontractor
experience in the
for:
following key activities:
at least one
The Bidder shall have transmission
successfully executed as a line of 110 kV
prime contractor, or above
management contractor, or voltage level
subcontractor for: with line length
not less than 4
i. design, supply,
km
installation,
testing and or
commissioning, at least one
of at least 1 (one) substation of
transmission line 110 kV or
contract of 110 above voltage
kV or above level with
transformer
voltage level on
capacity not
self-supported
less than 6
lattice towers.
MVA.
The line length of
transmission line
shall not be
less than 20 km;
and
ii. design, supply,
installation,
testing and
commissioning,
of at least 1 (one)
substation
contract of 110
kV or above
voltage level with
power
transformer
capacity not less
than 30 MVA.
Note:
To substantiate the above qualification, the Bidder (in case of JV all JV partners) must submit
certificate from clients (end-user certificates) for all number of projects specified as above. A failure
or omission of submitting the certificates at the first instance is considered a minor, nonmaterial
omission and shall be subject to clarification. The Bidder will be required to submit all the
necessary and relevant documents within the stipulated time.
Bidder can submit same experience certificate for both clause 2.4.2(a) and 2.4.2(b) if it satisfies both
conditions as stated above.
2.5 Personnel
The Bidder must demonstrate that it has the personnel for the key positions that meet the
following Requirements:
In case the bidder proposes to consider Personnel that may be spared from committed/ongoing
contracts for evaluation, the bidder shall provide details of personnel which will be spared from
such committed/ongoing contracts based on the physical progress at the date of bid submission.
The details so submitted by the bidder and the physical progress of the ongoing contracts only the
spared personnel shall be taken into the consideration during evaluation. The Bidder shall
provide details of the proposed personnel and their experience records in the relevant
Information Forms included in Section 4 (Bidding Forms).
Should the proposed personnel be determined to be unacceptable, the Bid will not be
rejected but the Bidder will be required to propose an acceptable substitute personnel
meeting the proposed requirement above within the stipulated time.
2.6 Equipment
The Bidder must demonstrate that it has the key equipment listed hereafter:
1. Theodolite 2 Nos
2. DGPS 1 set
3. Concrete Mixture 2 Nos
In case the Bidder proposes to consider Equipment that may be spared from
committed/ongoing contracts for evaluation, the Bidder shall provide details of Equipment
which will be spared from committed/ongoing contracts clearly demonstrating the
availability of such equipment with respect to the physical progress of the ongoing contracts
on the date of bid submission. Based on the details so PS submitted by the Bidder, only the
spared equipment proposed for the contract shall be considered for evaluation.
In case of equipment to be leased/hired the same procedures as mentioned above shall apply.
The Bidder must demonstrate that it has the required equipment and bidder shall provide
details of the proposed equipment in the relevant information forms included in Section 4
(Bidding Forms).
The Bidder/Lease Owner shall be solely responsible for the data provided. However, this
shall not limit the right of employer to verify the authenticity of submitted information.
The Bidder shall provide further details of proposed items of equipment using the relevant
Form in Section 4 (Bidding Forms). Should the proposed equipment be determined to be
unacceptable, the Bid will not be rejected but the Bidder will be required to propose an
acceptable substitute equipment meeting the proposed requirement above within the
stipulated time.
Table of Forms
Letter of Technical Bid ............................................................................................................... 2
Letter of Price Bid ...................................................................................................................... 4
Schedules .................................................................................................................................... 5
Bill of Quantities [Unit Rate Contract] .............................................................................. 5
Schedules of Prices [Lump Sum Contract] ........................................................................ 5
Tables of Adjustment Data ......................................................................................................... 6
Bid Security ................................................................................................................................ 6
Technical Proposal Format ......................................................................................................... 9
1. Personnel............................................................................................................................... 10
Form PER – 1: Proposed Personnel ................................................................................ 10
Form PER – 2: Resume of Proposed Personnel .............................................................. 11
2.Equipment.............................................................................................................................. 12
3. Site Organization ................................................................................................................... 13
4. Method Statement.................................................................................................................. 13
5. Mobilization Schedule ............................................................................................................ 13
6. Construction Schedule ........................................................................................................... 13
7. Schedule of Subcontractors ................................................................................................... 13
8. Others (insert additional requirement if applicable] ............................................................. 13
Bidder’s Qualification............................................................................................................... 14
Form ELI – 1: Bidder’s Information Sheet ....................................................................... 15
Form ELI - 2: JV Information Sheet ................................................................................ 16
Form LIT - 1: Pending Litigation ..................................................................................... 17
Form FIN - 1: Financial Situation .................................................................................... 18
Form FIN - 2: Average Annual Construction Turnover .................................................... 19
Form FIN – 3: Financial Resources ................................................................................. 20
Form EXP – 1: General Construction Experience ............................................................ 23
Form EXP – 2 (a): Specific Construction Experience ....................................................... 24
Form EXP – 2 (b): Specific Construction Experience in Key Activities ............................. 26
Manufacturer's Authorization ................................................................................................... 28
Functional Guarantee.....................................................................................................29
Date: ..................................
Bidding No.: ..................................
Invitation for Bid No.: ..................................
To:.......................................................................................................................................................
(a) We have examined and have no reservations to the Bidding Documents, including Addenda issued in
accordance with Instructions to Bidders (ITB) Clause 8;
(b) We offer to execute in conformity with the Bidding Documents the following Works:
.................................................................................................................................................
(c) Our bid shall be valid for a period of . . . .insert validity period as specified in ITB 18.1. . . days from
the date fixed for the bid submission deadline in accordance with the Bidding Documents, and it
shall remain binding upon us and may be accepted at any time before the expiration of that period;
(d) If our bid is accepted, we commit to obtain a performance security in accordance with the Bidding
Document;
(e) Our firm, including any subcontractors or suppliers for any part of the Contract, have nationalities
from eligible countries or any countries [insert the nationality of the Bidder, including that of all
parties that comprise the Bidder if the Bidder is a consortium or association, and the
nationality of each Subcontractor and Supplier]; and meet the requirements of ITB 3.7, &3.8 ,
(f) We, including any subcontractors or suppliers for any part of the contract, do not have any conflict of
interest in accordance with ITB 4.3;
(g) We are not participating, as a Bidder or as a subcontractor, in more than one bid in this bidding
process in accordance with ITB 4.3, other than alternative offers submitted in accordance with ITB
13;
(h) Our firm, its affiliates or subsidiaries, including any Subcontractors or Suppliers for any part of the
contract, has not been declared ineligible by the law of Nepal or official regulations or by
Development Partner (if applicable) or by an act of compliance with a decision of the United Nations
Security Council;
(i) We are not a government owned entity/We are a government owned entity but meet the requirements
of ITB 4.5;1
(j) We understand that this bid, together with your written acceptance thereof included in your
notification of award, shall constitute a binding contract between us, until a formal contract is
prepared and executed;
(k) Commissions or gratuities, if any, paid or to be paid by us to agents relating to this bid, and to
contract execution if we are awarded the contract, are listed below:
Name and address of agents Amount and Purpose of commission or
currency gratuity
1.
2.
(l) We declare that, we including any subcontractors or suppliers for any part of the contract do not have
any conflict of interest in the proposed procurement proceedings and we have not been blacklisted as per
ITB 3.4 and punished for an offense relating to the concerned profession or business.
(m) We agree to permit the Employer/DP or its representative to inspect our accounts and records and other
documents relating to the bid submission and to have them audited by auditors appointed by the
Employer.
(n) If our Bid is accepted, we commit to mobilizing key equipment and personnel in accordance with the
requirements set forth in Section 3 (Evaluation and Qualification Criteria) and our technical
proposal, or as otherwise agreed with the Employer.
(o) We declare that we are solely responsible for the authenticity of the documents submitted by us. The
document and information submitted by us are true and correct. If any document/information given is
found to be concealed at a later date, we shall accept any legal actions by the Employer.
Name ..................................................................................................................................................
In the capacity of ...............................................................................................................................
Signed ................................................................................................................................................
Duly authorized to sign the Bid for and on behalf of .........................................................................
Date ....................................................................................................................................................
1
Use one of the two options as appropriate.
Schedules
Bill of Quantities [Unit Rate Contract]
Schedules of Prices [Lump Sum Contract]
Bid Security
Bank Guarantee
Bank’s Name, and Address of Issuing Branch or Office
(On Letter head of the Commercial bank or any Financial Institution eligible to issue Bank Guarantee
as per prevailing Law)
We have been informed that . …………. .[insert name of the Bidder] (hereinafter called “the Bidder”)
intends to submit its bid (hereinafter called “the Bid”) to you for the execution of …………... name of
Contract . …………… under Invitation for Bids No. ……………… (“the IFB”).
Furthermore, we understand that, according to your conditions, bids must be supported by a bid guarantee.
At the request of the Bidder, we…………………. . name of Bank. ……………….. hereby irrevocably undertake to
pay you any sum or sums not exceeding in total an amount of . . ………...amount in figures ………………………. (.
………….. .amount in words ……………….) upon receipt by us of your first demand in writing accompanied
by a written statement stating that the Bidder is in breach of its obligation(s) under the bid conditions, because the
Bidder:
(a) has withdrawn or modifies its Bid during the period of bid validity specified by the Bidder in the Form of Bid; or
(b) does not accept the correction of errors in accordance with the Instructions to Bidders
(hereinafter “the ITB”); or
(c) having been notified of the acceptance of its Bid by the Employer during the period of bid validity, (i) fails or
refuses to execute the Contract Agreement, or (ii) fails or refuses to furnish the performance security, in
accordance with the ITB.
(d) is involved in fraud and corruption in accordance with the ITB
This guarantee will remain in force up to and including the date ………number…………days after the deadline for
submission of Bids as such deadline is stated in the instructions to Bidders or as it may be extended by the Employer,
notice of which extension(s) to the Bank is hereby waived. Any demand in respect of this guarantee should reach the
Bank not letter than the above date.
This Bank guarantee shall not be withdrawn or released merely upon return of the original guarantee by the Bidder
unless notified by you for the release of the guarantee.
This guarantee is subject to the Uniform Rules for Demand Guarantees, ICC Publication No. 758.
Note:
The bid security of ………..……………. has been counter guaranteed by the Bank ……..………... ...…… on
…………... .................................................. ...……..………. (Applicable for Bid Security of Foreign Banks).
Contract No:
Name of Contract :
To:
Signature Signature
1. Personnel
2. Equipment
3. Site Organization
4. Method Statement
5. Mobilization Schedule
6. Construction Schedule
7. Schedule of Sub Contractors
8. Others
1. Personnel
Bidders should provide the names of suitably qualified personnel to meet the specified requirements for each of
the positions listed in Section 3 (Evaluation and Qualification Criteria). The data on their experience should be
supplied using the Form below for each candidate.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
The Bidder shall provide all the information requested below. Fields with asterisk (*) shall be used for
evaluation.
Position*
Personal Information Name Date of Birth
Professional qualifications
Present employment Name of employer
Address of employer
Telephone Contact (manager/personnel officer)
Fax E-mail
Job title Years with present employer
Summarize professional experience over the last twenty years in reverse chronological order. Indicate particular technical
and managerial experience relevant to the project.
Note:
In case of e-submission the Resume of Proposed Personnel shall be submitted on notification by the Employer as per ITB
27.
2.Equipment
The Bidder shall provide adequate information to demonstrate clearly that it has the capability to meet the requirements
for the key equipment listed in Section III (Evaluation and Qualification Criteria). A separate Form shall be prepared
for each item of equipment listed, or for alternative equipment proposed by the Bidder. The Bidder shall provide all
the information requested below, to the extent possible. Fields with asterisk (*) shall be used for evaluation.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Total Nos. of Equipment under the No. of Equipment Nos. of Equipment proposed
Equipment Type and
No. ownership of lease/hire provider engaged/committed for other to be leased/hired for this
Characteristics
works contract
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Type of Equipment*
The following information shall be provided only for equipment not owned by the Bidder.
Address of owner
Fax Email
Note:
In case of e-submission the “Agreements” shall be submitted on notification by the Employer as per
ITB 27.1
3. Site Organization
The Bidder shall show here in an Organogram format the organization of his site personnel
showing clearly designated duties and responsibilities and the chain of command throughout the
structure. Included in the chart shall be the names of respective personnel.
4. Method Statement
The Bidder shall provide here a brief description of how the Works are to be undertaken. The
description shall indicate how each activities are to be undertaken.
5. Mobilization Schedule
The Bidder shall provide here a general description of the arrangements and methods which he
proposes to adopt for the execution of the Works which shall include but not be limited to:-
i) Mobilization period including periods required for establishing the Contractor’s offices,
workshops etc. and the facilities required for the Engineer and his staff.
ii) Sources of Contractor’s equipment and mobilization periods for items of plant.
6. Construction Schedule
The Bidder shall provide here his proposed programme for construction of the Works within the
Time for Completion. The programme shall be presented in the form of a bar chart showing main
construction activities with Milestones. Associated groups of construction equipment shall be
listed.
7. Schedule of Subcontractors
The bidder shall enter in the following table a list of the sections and appropriate value of the work
for which he proposes to use subcontractors, together with the names and addresses of the proposed
subcontractors. The bidder shall also enter a statement of similar works previously executed by the
proposed subcontractors, including description, location and value of work, year completed, and
name and address of the employer/engineer.
Item Description of work Approximate value Name and address Statement of similar works
Nos. (US$ or equivalent) of Subcontractor executed
Notwithstanding such information the bidder, if awarded the Contract, shall remain entirely and solely
responsible for the satisfactory completion of the Works.
Bidder’s Qualification
To establish its qualifications to perform the contract in accordance with Section 3 (Evaluation and
Qualification Criteria) the Bidder shall provide the information requested in the corresponding Information
Sheets included hereunder.
Bidder’s Information
Bidder’s country of
constitution
Bidder’s authorized
representative
(name, address, telephone
numbers, fax numbers, e-mail
address)
1. In case of single entity, articles of incorporation or constitution of the legal entity named above, in accordance with
ITB 4.1 and 4.2.
2. Authorization to represent the firm or JV named in above, in accordance with ITB 20.2.
3. In case of JV, letter of intent to form JV or JV agreement, in accordance with ITB 4.1.
4. In case of a government-owned entity, any additional documents not covered under 1 above required to comply
with ITB 4.5.
JV Partner’s or
Subcontractor’s legal name
JV Partner’s or
Subcontractor’s country of
constitution
JV Partner’s or
Subcontractor’s year of
constitution
JV Partner’s or
Subcontractor’s legal address
in country of constitution
JV Partner’s or
Subcontractor’s authorized
representative information
Pending Litigation
No pending litigation in accordance with Criteria 2.2 of Section 3 (Evaluation and Qualification Criteria)
Pending litigation in accordance with Criteria 2.2 of Section 3 (Evaluation and Qualification Criteria)
Value of Value of
Pending Claim Pending Claim
Year Matter in Dispute
in US$ as a Percentage
Equivalent of Net Worth
Total Assets
Total Liabilities
Net Worth
Current Assets
Current Liabilities
Total Revenues
Attached are copies of financial statements (balance sheets including all related notes, and income
statements) for the last two to five years, as indicated above, complying with the following
conditions.
All such documents reflect the financial situation of the Applicant or partner to a JV, and not
sister or parent companies.
Historic financial statements must be audited by a certified accountant.
Historic financial statements must be complete, including all notes to the financial statements.
Historic financial statements must correspond to accounting periods already completed and
audited (no statements for partial periods shall be requested or accepted).
Note: Attested Financial reports, including balance sheets, profit and loss statements and auditors reports
for the last 5 years should be attached.
In case of e-submission the attachments should not be uploaded but shall be submitted on notification by the
Employer as per ITB 27.
The information supplied should be the Annual Turnover of the Bidder or each member of a JV in terms of the
amounts billed to clients for each year for work in progress or completed in NRs or in US Dollars in case of
foreign bidders at the rate of exchange at the end of the period reported.
Specify proposed sources of financing, as “lines of credit”, available to meet the total construction cash flow
demands of the subject contract or contracts as indicated in Section III (Evaluation and Qualification Criteria).
Financial Resources
Note: The letter from the Bank must be in the prescribed format and stated details/terms and conditions as per the
Bid Forms “Letter of Commitment for Bank’s Undertaking for Line of Credit”
A = Average Annual Turnover of best three years out of last ten fiscal years.
B = Annual Value of the existing commitments and works (ongoing) to be completed, calculated from FIN-5.
A, in B, in Bid Capacity,
SN Name of Bidder Pan No.
Million Million in Million
Signature of Bidder
Bidders and each partner to a JV should provide information on their current commitments on all contracts that have been awarded, or for which a letter of intent or acceptance has been
received, or for contracts approaching completion, but for which an unqualified, full completion certificate has yet to be issued.
Signature of Bidder
# The Outstanding Works means Contract Price (excluding Vat) minus Work Evaluated by Employer till the reference date. Bidder shall have to submit the
relevant documentary evidence to substantiate the facts/figures.
(e) (a)
Note 1: “B” shall be calculated as : B ( f ) x12 , If (f) is less than 12, then value of (f) shall be taken as 12.
Note 2: If Initial or Revised Contract Date is run out with respect to Date of Invitation of Bid, the Estimated Time in Month to Complete the outstanding works
shall be taken equal to 12 months.
If partner in a JV or
subcontractor, specify
Percent of Total Amount
participation of total contract
amount
Employer’s Name
Address
Telephone/Fax Number
E-mail
If partner in a JV or
subcontractor, specify
Percent of Total Amount
participation of total contract
amount
Employer’s Name
Address
Telephone Number
Fax Number
E-mail
WHEREAS
We [insert complete name of the manufacturer or manufacturer’s authorized agent], who are official manufacturers
or agent authorized by the Manufacturer of [insert type of goods manufactured], having factories at [insert full
address of manufacturer’s factories], do hereby authorize [insert complete name of the bidder] to submit a bid the
purpose of which is to provide the following goods, manufactured by us [insert name and/or brief description of the
goods], and to subsequently negotiate and sign the Contract.
We hereby extend our full guarantee and warranty in accordance with Clause 27 of the General Conditions of
Contract, with respect to the goods offered by the above firm.
Duly authorized to sign this Authorization on behalf of [insert complete name of the manufacturer]
--Note--
The bidder shall require the manufacturer to fillout this form in accordance with the instructions indicated. This letter of
authorization should be signed by a person with the proper authority to sign documents that are binding on the manufacturer. The
bidder shall include it in its bid, if so indicated in the BDS.
The Bidder shall furnish guaranteed No Load, Full Load and the Cooler Fan Loss (if applicable) value at rated full
load capacity of the Transformer along with the Technical Bid for all rating of the Power and Station Transformers.
Failure to submit the loss figures may result in rejection of the Bid.
Total Losses
Table of Contents
A. Contract and Interpretation 4
1. Definitions ............................................................................................................................................................ 4
2. Contract Documents ............................................................................................................................................. 6
3. Interpretation ........................................................................................................................................................ 6
4. Communications......................................................................................................................................................... 8
5. Law and Language................................................................................................................................................ 8
6. Fraud and Corruption............................................................................................................................................ 8
B. Subject Matter of Contract 9
7. Scope of Facilities ................................................................................................................................................ 9
8. Time for Commencement and Completion .......................................................................................................... 9
9. Contractor’s Responsibilities................................................................................................................................ 9
10. Employer’s Responsibilities ............................................................................................................................... 10
C. Payment 11
11. Contract Price ..................................................................................................................................................... 11
12. Terms of Payment............................................................................................................................................... 12
13. Securities ............................................................................................................................................................ 12
14. Taxes and Duties ................................................................................................................................................ 13
D. Intellectual Property 13
15. License/Use of Technical Information ............................................................................................................... 13
16. Confidential Information .................................................................................................................................... 14
E. Execution of the Facilities 14
17. Representatives................................................................................................................................................... 14
18. Work Program .................................................................................................................................................... 16
19.Subcontracting.......................................................................................................................................................... 17
20. Design and Engineering...................................................................................................................................... 17
21. Procurement........................................................................................................................................................ 19
22. Installation .......................................................................................................................................................... 20
23. Test and Inspection ............................................................................................................................................. 26
24. Completion of the Facilities................................................................................................................................ 27
1. Definitions 1.1 The following words and expressions shall have the meanings hereby
assigned them:
“Contract” means the Contract Agreement entered into between the Employer
and the Contractor, together with the Contract Documents referred to therein;
they shall constitute the Contract, and the term “the Contract” shall in all such
documents be construed accordingly.
“Contract Documents” means the documents listed in Article 1.1 (Contract
Documents) of the Contract Agreement (including any amendments thereto).
“GCC” means the General Conditions of Contract.
“SCC” means the Special Conditions of Contract.
“day” means calendar day.
“year” means 365 days.
“month” means calendar month.
“Party” means the Employer or the Contractor, as the context requires.
“Employer” means the person named as such in the SCC and includes the
legal successors or permitted assigns of the Employer.
“Project Manager” means the person appointed by the Employer in the
manner provided in GCC Subclause 17.1 (Project Manager) hereof and named
as such in the SCC to perform the duties delegated by the Employer.
“Contractor” means the person(s) named as Contractor in the Contract
Agreement, and includes the legal successors or permitted assigns of the
Contractor.
“Contractor’s Representative” means any person nominated by the Contractor
and approved by the Employer in the manner provided in GCC Subclause
17.2 (Contractor’s Representative and Construction Manager) hereof to
perform the duties delegated by the Contractor.
“Construction Manager” means the person appointed by the Contractor’s
2. Contract 2.1 Subject to Article 1.2 (Order of Precedence) of the Contract Agreement, all
Documents documents forming part of the Contract (and all parts thereof) are intended to
be correlative, complementary and mutually explanatory. The Contract shall
be read as a whole.
3. Interpretation 3.1 In the Contract, except where the context requires otherwise,
(a) words indicating one gender include all genders;
(b) words indicating the singular also include the plural and words
indicating the plural also include the singular;
(c) provisions including the word “agree,” “agreed,” or “agreement”
require the agreement to be record in writing;
(d) the word “tender” is synonymous with “bid,” “tenderer” with
“Bidder,” and “tender documents” with “Bidding Documents;” and
(e) “written” or “in writing” means handwritten, typewritten, printed or
electronically made, and resulting in a permanent record.
The marginal words and other headings shall not be taken into consideration
in the interpretation of these Conditions.
3.2 Incoterms
Unless inconsistent with any provision of the Contract, the meaning of any
trade term and the rights and obligations of parties thereunder shall be as
prescribed by Incoterms.
“Incoterms” means international rules for interpreting trade terms published
by the International Chamber of Commerce (latest edition), 38 Cours Albert
1er, 75008 Paris, France.
3.3 Entire Agreement
Subject to GCC Subclause 16.4 hereof, the Contract constitutes the entire
agreement between the Employer and Contractor with respect to the subject
matter of Contract and supersedes all communications, negotiations, and
agreements (whether written or oral) of parties with respect thereto made prior
to the date of Contract.
3.4 Amendment
No amendment or other variation of the Contract shall be effective unless it is
in writing, is dated, expressly refers to the Contract, and is signed by a duly
authorized representative of each party hereto.
3.5 Independent Contractor
The Contractor shall be an independent contractor performing the Contract. The
Contract does not create any agency, partnership, joint venture, or other joint
relationship between the parties hereto. Subject to the provisions of the
Contract, the Contractor shall be solely responsible for the manner in which
the Contract is performed. All employees, representatives, or Subcontractors
engaged by the Contractor in connection with the performance of the Contract
shall be under the complete control of the Contractor and shall not be deemed
to be employees of the Employer, and nothing contained in the Contract or in
any subcontract awarded by the Contractor shall be construed to create any
contractual relationship between any such employees, representatives, or
Subcontractors and the Employer.
3.6 Non-Waiver
3.6.1 Subject to GCC Subclause 3.6.2 below, no relaxation, forbearance,
delay, or indulgence by either party in enforcing any of the terms and
conditions of the Contract or the granting of time by either party to
the other shall prejudice, affect, or restrict the rights of that party
under the Contract, nor shall any waiver by either party of any breach
of Contract operate as waiver of any subsequent or continuing breach
of Contract.
3.6.2 Any waiver of a party’s rights, powers, or remedies under the
Contract must be in writing, must be dated, and signed by an
authorized representative of the party granting such waiver, and must
specify the right and the extent to which it is being waived.
3.7 Severability
If any provision or condition of the Contract is prohibited or rendered invalid
or unenforceable, such prohibition, invalidity, or unenforceability shall not
affect the validity or enforceability of any other provisions and conditions of
the Contract.
3.8 Country of Origin
“Origin” means the place where the plant and component parts thereof are
mined, grown, produced, or manufactured, and from which the services are
provided. Plant components are produced when, through manufacturing,
processing, or substantial or major assembling of components, a commercially
recognized product results that is substantially in its basic characteristics or in
purpose or utility from its components.
4. Communications 4.1 Wherever these Conditions provide for the giving or issuing of approvals,
certificates, consents, determinations, notices, requests, and discharges, these
communications shall be
(a) in writing and delivered against receipt; and
(b) delivered, sent, or transmitted to the address for the recipient’s
communications as stated in the Contract Agreement.
When a certificate is issued to a Party, the certifier shall send a copy to the
other Party. When a notice is issued to a Party, by the other Party or the
Project Manager, a copy shall be sent to the Project Manager or the other
Party, as the case may be.
5. Law and 5.1 The Contract shall be governed by and interpreted in accordance with laws of
Language the country specified in the SCC.
5.2 The ruling language of the Contract shall be that stated in the SCC.
5.3 The language for communications shall be the ruling language unless
otherwise stated in the SCC.
6. Fraud and 6.1 If the Employer determines that the Contractor and/or any of its personnel, or
Corruption its agents, or its Subcontractors, sub-consultants, services providers, suppliers
and/or their employees has engaged in corrupt, fraudulent, collusive coercive,
or obstructive practices, in competing for or in executing the Contract, then
the Employer may, after giving 14 days’ notice to the Contractor, terminate
the Contractor's employment under the Contract and expel him from the Site,
and the provisions of Clause 42 shall apply as if such expulsion had been
made under Sub-Clause 42.2.1 (c).
For the purposes of this Sub-Clause,
(i) “corrupt practice” is the offering, giving, receiving or soliciting,
directly or indirectly, of anything of value to influence improperly the
actions of another party;
(ii) “fraudulent practice” is any act or omission, including a
misrepresentation, that knowingly or recklessly misleads, or attempts
to mislead, a party to obtain a financial or other benefit or to avoid an
obligation;
(iii) “collusive practice” is an arrangement between two or more parties
designed to achieve an improper purpose, including to influence
improperly the actions of another party;
(iv) “coercive practice” is impairing or harming, or threatening to impair
or harm, directly or indirectly, any party or the property of the party to
influence improperly the actions of a party;
(v) “obstructive practice” is
(aa) deliberately destroying, falsifying, altering or concealing of evidence
material to the investigation or making false statements to
investigators in order to materially impede a GoN investigation into
allegations of a corrupt, fraudulent, coercive or collusive practice;
and/or threatening, harassing or intimidating any party to prevent it
from disclosing its knowledge of matters relevant to the investigation
or from pursuing the investigation, or
(bb) acts intended to materially impede the exercise of the GoN’s
inspection and audit rights provided for under Sub-Clause 9.6.
8. Time for 8.1 The Contractor shall commence work on the Facilities within the period
Commencement and specified in the SCC and without prejudice to GCC Subclause 26.2 hereof, the
Completion Contractor shall thereafter proceed with the Facilities in accordance with the
time schedule specified in the Appendix 4 (Time Schedule) to the Contract
Agreement.
8.2 The Contractor shall attain Completion of the Facilities or of a part where a
separate time for Completion of such part is specified in the Contract, within
the time stated in the SCC or within such extended time to which the
Contractor shall be entitled under GCC Clause 40 hereof.
9. Contractor’s 9.1 The Contractor shall design, manufacture, including associated purchases
Responsibilities and/or subcontracting, install, and complete the Facilities in accordance with
the Contract. When completed, the Facilities should be fit for the purposes for
which they are intended as defined in the Contract.
9.2 The Contractor confirms that it has entered into this Contract on the basis of a
proper examination of the data relating to the Facilities, including any data as
to boring tests provided by the Employer, and on the basis of information that
the Contractor could have obtained from a visual inspection of the Site if
access thereto was available and of other data readily available to it relating to
the Facilities as of the date 30 days prior to bid submission. The Contractor
acknowledges that any failure to acquaint itself with all such data and
information shall not relieve its responsibility for properly estimating the
difficulty or cost of successfully performing the Facilities.
9.3 The Contractor shall acquire and pay for all permits, approvals, and/or
licenses from all local, state, or national government authorities or public
service undertakings in the country where the Site is located, which such
authorities or undertakings require the Contractor to obtain in its name and
which are necessary for the performance of the Contract, including, without
limitation, visas for the Contractor’s and Subcontractor’s personnel and entry
permits for all imported Contractor’s Equipment. The Contractor shall acquire
all other permits, approvals, and/or licenses that are not the responsibility of
the Employer under GCC Subclause 10.3 hereof and that are necessary for the
performance of the Contract.
9.4 The Contractor shall comply with all laws in force in the country where the
Facilities are to be implemented. The laws will include all local, state,
national, or other laws that affect the performance of the Contract and bind
upon the Contractor. The Contractor shall indemnify and hold harmless the
Employer from and against any and all liabilities, damages, claims, fines,
penalties, and expenses of whatever nature arising or resulting from the
violation of such laws by the Contractor or its personnel, including the
Subcontractors and their personnel, but without prejudice to GCC Subclause
10.1 hereof.
9.5 Any plant and services that will be incorporated in or be required for the
Facilities and other supplies shall have their origin as specified under GCC
Clause 1 (Country of Origin). Any Subcontractors retained by the Contractor
shall be from a country as specified in GCC Clause 1 (Country of Origin).
9.6 The Contractor shall permit GON/DP to inspect the Contractor’s accounts and
records relating to the performance of the Contractor and to have them audited
by auditors appointed by GON/DP, if so required by GON/DP.
9.7 If the Contractor is a joint venture or consortium of two or more persons, all
such persons shall be jointly and severally bound to the Employer for the
fulfillment of the provisions of the Contract and shall designate one of such
persons to act as a leader with authority to bind the joint venture or
consortium. The composition or the constitution of the joint venture or
consortium shall not be altered without the prior consent of the Employer.
9.8 Protection of the Environment
(a) The Contractor shall take all reasonable steps to protect the environment
(both on and off the Site) and to limit damage and nuisance to people and
property resulting from pollution, noise, and other results of his
operations.
(b) The Contractor shall ensure that emissions, surface discharges, and
effluent from the Contractor’s activities shall not exceed the values stated
in the Specification or prescribed by applicable Laws.
10. Employer’s 10.1 All information and/or data to be supplied by the Employer as described in the
Responsibilities Appendix (Scope of Works and Supply by the Employer) to the Contract
Agreement shall be deemed to be accurate, except when the Employer
expressly states otherwise.
10.2 The Employer shall be responsible for acquiring and providing legal and
physical possession of the Site and access thereto, and for providing
possession of and access to all other areas reasonably required for the proper
execution of the Contract, including all requisite rights of way, as specified in
the Appendix (Scope of Works and Supply by the Employer) to the Contract
Agreement. The Employer shall give full possession of and accord all rights
of access thereto on or before the date(s) specified in that Appendix.
10.3 The Employer shall acquire and pay for all permits, approvals, and/or licenses
from all local, state, or national government authorities, or public service
undertakings in the country where the Site is located which (a) such
authorities or undertakings require the Employer to obtain in the Employer’s
name, (b) are necessary for the execution of the Contract, including those
required for the performance by both the Contractor and the Employer of their
respective obligations under the Contract, and (c) are specified in the
Appendix (Scope of Works and Supply by the Employer) to the Contract
Agreement.
10.4 If requested by the Contractor, the Employer shall use its best endeavors to
assist the Contractor in obtaining in a timely and expeditious manner all
permits, approvals, and/or licenses necessary for the execution of the Contract
from all local, state, or national government authorities, or public service
undertakings that such authorities or undertakings require the Contractor or
Subcontractors or the personnel of the Contractor or Subcontractors, as the
case may be, to obtain.
10.5 Unless otherwise specified in the Contract or agreed upon by the Employer
and the Contractor, the Employer shall provide sufficient, properly qualified
operating and maintenance personnel; shall supply and make available all raw
materials, utilities, lubricants, chemicals, catalysts, other materials and
facilities; and shall perform all work and services of whatsoever nature,
including those required by the Contractor to properly carry out Pre-
commissioning, Commissioning, and Guarantee Tests, all in accordance with
the provisions of the Appendix (Scope of Works and Supply by the
Employer) to the Contract Agreement at or before the time specified in the
program furnished by the Contractor under GCC Subclause 18.2 hereof and in
the manner thereupon specified or as otherwise agreed upon by the Employer
and the Contractor.
10.6 The Employer shall be responsible for the continued operation of the Facilities
after Completion, in accordance with GCC Subclause 24.8, and shall be
responsible for facilitating the Guarantee Test(s) for the Facilities, in
accordance with GCC Subclause 25.2.
10.7 All costs and expenses involved in the performance of the obligations under
this GCC Clause 10 shall be the responsibility of the Employer, except those
incurred by the Contractor with respect to the performance of Guarantee
Tests, in accordance with GCC Subclause 25.2.
10.8 In the event that the Employer shall be in breach of any of his obligations
imposed by the Contract, then the additional cost reasonably incurred by the
Contractor in consequence thereof shall be added to the Contract Price.
C. Payment
11. Contract Price 11.1 The Contract Price shall be as specified in Article 2 (Contract Price and Terms
of Payment) of the Contract Agreement.
11.2 Unless an adjustment clause is provided for in the SCC, the Contract Price
shall be a firm lump sum not subject to any alteration, except in the event of a
12. Terms of Payment 12.1 The Contract Price shall be paid as specified in Article 2 (Contract Price and
Terms of Payment) of the Contract Agreement and in the Appendix (Terms
and Procedures of Payment) to the Contract Agreement, which also outlines
the procedures to be followed in making application for and processing
payments.
12.2 No payment made by the Employer herein shall be deemed to constitute
acceptance by the Employer of the Facilities or any part(s) thereof.
12.3 In the event that the Employer fails to make any payment by its respective due
date or within the period set forth in the Contract, the Employer shall pay to
the Contractor interest on the amount of such delayed payment at the rate(s)
shown in the Appendix (Terms and Procedures of Payment) to the Contract
Agreement for the period of delay until payment has been made in full,
whether before or after judgment or arbitrage award.
12.4 The currency or currencies in which payments are made to the Contractor
under this Contract shall be specified in the Appendix (Terms and Procedures
of Payment) to the Contract Agreement, subject to the general principle that
payments will be made in the currency or currencies in which the Contract
Price has been stated in the Contractor’s bid.
14. Taxes and Duties 14.1 Except as otherwise specifically provided in the Contract, the Contractor shall
bear and pay all taxes, duties, levies, and charges assessed on the Contractor,
its Subcontractors, or their employees by all municipal, state, or national
government authorities in connection with the Facilities in and outside of the
country where the Site is located.
14.2 Notwithstanding GCC Subclause 14.1 above, the Employer shall bear and
promptly pay all customs and import duties as well as other local taxes like,
e.g., a value-added tax (VAT), imposed by the law of the country where the
Site is located on the Plant specified in Price Schedule No. 1 and that are to be
incorporated into the Facilities.
14.3 If any tax exemptions, reductions, allowances, or privileges may be available
to the Contractor in the country where the Site is located, the Employer shall
use its best endeavors to enable the Contractor to benefit from any such tax
savings to the maximum allowable extent.
14.4 For the purpose of the Contract, it is agreed that the Contract Price specified in
Article 2 (Contract Price and Terms of Payment) of the Contract Agreement is
based on the taxes, duties, levies, and charges prevailing at the date 30 days
prior to the date of bid submission in the country where the Site is located
(hereinafter called “Tax” in this GCC Subclause 14.4). If any rates of Tax are
increased or decreased, a new Tax is introduced, an existing Tax is abolished,
or any change in interpretation or application of any Tax occurs in the course
of the performance of Contract, which was or will be assessed on the
Contractor, Subcontractors, or their employees in connection with
performance of the Contract, an equitable adjustment of the Contract Price
shall be made to fully take into account any such change by addition to the
Contract Price or deduction therefrom, as the case may be, in accordance with
GCC Clause 36 hereof.
D. Intellectual Property
15. License/Use of 15.1 For the operation and maintenance of the Plant, the Contractor hereby grants
Technical a non-exclusive and nontransferable license (without the right to sublicense)
Information to the Employer under the patents, utility models, or other industrial property
rights owned by the Contractor or by a third party from whom the Contractor
has received the right to grant licenses thereunder, and shall also grant to the
Employer a nonexclusive and nontransferable right (without the right to
sublicense) to use the know-how and other technical information disclosed to
the Employer under the Contract. Nothing contained herein shall be
16. Confidential 16.1 The Employer and the Contractor shall keep confidential and shall not, without
Information the written consent of the other party hereto, divulge to any third party any
documents, data or other information furnished directly or indirectly by the
other party hereto in connection with the Contract, whether such information
has been furnished prior to, during, or following termination of the Contract.
Notwithstanding the above, the Contractor may furnish to its Subcontractor(s)
such documents, data, and other information it receives from the Employer to
the extent required for the Subcontractor(s) to perform its work under the
Contract, in which event the Contractor shall obtain from such
Subcontractor(s) an undertaking of confidentiality similar to that imposed on
the Contractor under this GCC Clause 16.
16.2 The Employer shall not use such documents, data, and other information
received from the Contractor for any purpose other than the operation and
maintenance of the Facilities. Similarly, the Contractor shall not use such
documents, data, and other information received from the Employer for any
purpose other than the design, procurement of Plant, construction, or such
other work and services as are required for the performance of the Contract.
16.3 The obligation of a party under GCC Sub clauses 16.1 and 16.2 above,
however, shall not apply to that information, which
(a) now or hereafter enters the public domain through no fault of that party;
(b) can be proven to have been possessed by that party at the time of
disclosure and which was not previously obtained, directly or indirectly,
from the other party hereto; and
(c) otherwise lawfully becomes available to that party from a third party
that has no obligation of confidentiality.
16.4 The above provisions of this GCC Clause 16 shall not in any way modify any
undertaking of confidentiality given by either of the parties hereto prior to the
date of the Contract in respect of the Facilities or any part thereof.
16.5 The provisions of this GCC Clause 16 shall survive termination, for whatever
reason, of the Contract.
by the Contractor. The Project Manager shall represent and act for the
Employer at all times during the performance of the Contract. All notices,
instructions, orders, certificates, approvals, and all other communications
under the Contract shall be given by the Project Manager, except as herein
otherwise provided.
All notices, instructions, information, and other communications given by the
Contractor to the Employer under the Contract shall be given to the Project
Manager, except as herein otherwise provided.
17.2 Contractor’s Representative and Construction Manager
17.2.1 If the Contractor’s Representative is not named in the Contract, then
within 14 days of the Effective Date, the Contractor shall appoint the
Contractor’s Representative and shall request the Employer in writing
to approve the person so appointed. If the Employer makes no
objection to the appointment within 14 days, the Contractor’s
Representative shall be deemed to have been approved. If the
Employer objects to the appointment within 14 days giving the reason
therefor, then the Contractor shall appoint a replacement within 14
days of such objection, and the foregoing provisions of this GCC
Subclause 17.2.1 shall apply thereto.
17.2.2 The Contractor’s Representative shall represent and act for the
Contractor at all times during the performance of the Contract and
shall give to the Project Manager all the Contractor’s notices,
instructions, information, and all other communications under the
Contract.
All notices, instructions, information, and all other communications
given by the Employer or the Project Manager to the Contractor under
the Contract shall be given to the Contractor’s Representative or, in its
absence, its deputy, except as herein otherwise provided.
The Contractor shall not revoke the appointment of the Contractor’s
Representative without the Employer’s prior written consent, which
shall not be unreasonably withheld. If the Employer consents thereto,
the Contractor shall appoint some other person as the Contractor’s
Representative, pursuant to the procedure set out in GCC Subclause
17.2.1.
17.2.3 The Contractor’s Representative may, subject to the approval of the
Employer which shall not be unreasonably withheld, at any time
delegate to any person any of the powers, functions and authorities
vested in him or her. Any such delegation may be revoked at any time.
Any such delegation or revocation shall be subject to a prior notice
signed by the Contractor’s Representative, and shall specify the
powers, functions, and authorities thereby delegated or revoked. No
such delegation or revocation shall take effect unless and until a copy
thereof has been delivered to the Employer and the Project Manager.
Any act or exercise by any person of powers, functions and authorities
so delegated to him or her in accordance with this GCC Subclause
17.2.3 shall be deemed to be an act or exercise by the Contractor’s
Representative.
17.2.4 From the commencement of installation of the Facilities at the Site
until Completion, the Contractor’s Representative shall appoint a
suitable person as the Construction Manager. The Construction
Manager shall supervise all work done at the Site by the Contractor
19.Subcontracting 19.1 The Appendix 5 (List of Major Items of Plant and Services and List of
Approved Subcontractors) to the Contract Agreement specifies major items
of plant and services and a list of approved Subcontractors against each item,
including manufacturers. Insofar as no Subcontractors are listed against any
such item, the Contractor shall prepare a list of Subcontractors for such item
for inclusion in such list. The Contractor may from time to time propose any
addition to or deletion from any such list. The Contractor shall submit any
such list or any modification thereto to the Employer for its approval in
sufficient time so as not to impede the progress of work on the Facilities.
Such approval by the Employer for any of the Subcontractors shall not relieve
the Contractor from any of its obligations, duties, or responsibilities under the
Contract.
19.2 The Contractor shall select and employ its Subcontractors for such major
items from those listed in the lists referred to in GCC Sub clause 19.1.
19.3 For items or parts of the Facilities not specified in the Appendix (List of
Major Items of Plant and Services and List of Approved Subcontractors for
Major Items) to the Contract Agreement, the Contractor may employ such
Subcontractors as it may select, at its discretion.
19.4 Each subcontract shall include provisions which would entitle the Employer
to require the sub-contract to be assigned to the Employer under GCC 19.5 (if
and when applicable), or in event of termination by the Employer under GCC
42.2.
19.5 If a Sub-contractor's obligations extend beyond the expiry date of the relevant
Defects Liability Period and the Project Manager, prior to that date, instructs
the Contractor to assign the benefits of such obligations to the Employer, then
the Contractor shall do so.
The provision of this GCC Subclause 21.2.2 shall apply to any item
supplied to remedy any such shortage or default or to substitute for any
defective item, or shall apply to defective items that have been
repaired.
21.2.3 The foregoing responsibilities of the Contractor and its obligations of
care, custody, and control shall not relieve the Employer of liability for
any undetected shortage, defect, or default, nor place the Contractor
under any liability for any such shortage, defect or default whether
under GCC Clause 27 or under any other provision of Contract.
21.3 Transportation
21.3.1 The Contractor shall at its own risk and expense transport all the
materials and the Contractor’s Equipment to the Site by the mode of
transport that the Contractor judges most suitable under all the
circumstances.
21.3.2 Unless otherwise provided in the Contract, the Contractor shall be
entitled to select any safe mode of transport operated by any person to
carry the materials and the Contractor’s Equipment.
21.3.3 Upon dispatch of each shipment of materials and the Contractor’s
Equipment, the Contractor shall notify the Employer by telex, cable,
facsimile, or electronic means, of the description of the materials and
of the Contractor’s Equipment, the point and means of dispatch, and
the estimated time and point of arrival in the country where the Site is
located, if applicable, and at the Site. The Contractor shall furnish the
Employer with relevant shipping documents to be agreed upon
between the parties.
21.3.4 The Contractor shall be responsible for obtaining, if necessary,
approvals from the authorities for transportation of the materials and
the Contractor’s Equipment to the Site. The Employer shall use its
best endeavors in a timely and expeditious manner to assist the
Contractor in obtaining such approvals, if requested by the Contractor.
The Contractor shall indemnify and hold harmless the Employer from
and against any claim for damage to roads, bridges, or any other traffic
facilities that may be caused by the transport of the materials and the
Contractor’s Equipment to the Site.
21.4 Customs Clearance
The Contractor shall, at its own expense, handle all imported materials and
Contractor’s Equipment at the point(s) of import and shall handle any
formalities for customs clearance, subject to the Employer’s obligations under
GCC Subclause 14.2, provided that if applicable laws or regulations require
any application or act to be made by or in the name of the Employer, the
Employer shall take all necessary steps to comply with such laws or
regulations. In the event of delays in customs clearance that are not the fault
of the Contractor, the Contractor shall be entitled to an extension in the Time
for Completion, pursuant to GCC Clause 40.
of security, safety of the Facilities, gate control, sanitation, medical care, and
fire prevention.
22.5 Opportunities for Other Contractors
22.5.1 The Contractor shall, upon written request from the Employer or the
Project Manager, give all reasonable opportunities for carrying out
the work to any other contractors employed by the Employer on or
near the Site.
22.5.2 If the Contractor, upon written request from the Employer or the
Project Manager, makes available to other contractors any roads or
ways the maintenance for which the Contractor is responsible,
permits the use by such other contractors of the Contractor’s
Equipment, or provides any other service of whatsoever nature for
such other contractors, the Employer shall fully compensate the
Contractor for any loss or damage caused or occasioned by such
other contractors in respect of any such use or service, and shall pay
to the Contractor reasonable remuneration for the use of such
equipment or the provision of such services.
22.5.3 The Contractor shall also so arrange to perform its work as to
minimize, to the extent possible, interference with the work of other
contractors. The Project Manager shall determine the resolution of
any difference or conflict that may arise between the Contractor and
other contractors and the workers of the Employer in regard to their
work.
22.5.4 The Contractor shall notify the Project Manager promptly of any
defects in the other Contractors’ work that come to its notice, and
that could affect the Contractor’s work. The Project Manager shall
determine the corrective measures, if any, required to rectify the
situation after inspection of the Facilities. Decisions made by the
Project Manager shall be binding on the Contractor.
22.6 Emergency Work
If, by reason of an emergency arising in connection with and during the
execution of the Contract, any protective or remedial work is necessary as a
matter of urgency to prevent damage to the Facilities, the Contractor shall
immediately carry out such work.
If the Contractor is unable or unwilling to do such work immediately, the
Employer may do or cause such work to be done as the Employer may
determine is necessary in order to prevent damage to the Facilities. In such
event the Employer shall, as soon as practicable after the occurrence of any
such emergency, notify the Contractor in writing of such emergency, the work
done and the reasons therefor. If the work done or caused to be done by the
Employer is work that the Contractor was liable to do at its own expense under
the Contract, the reasonable costs incurred by the Employer in connection
therewith shall be paid by the Contractor to the Employer. Otherwise, the cost
of such remedial work shall be borne by the Employer.
22.7 Site Clearance
22.7.1 Site Clearance in Course of Performance
In the course of carrying out the Contract, the Contractor shall keep
the Site reasonably free from all unnecessary obstruction, store, or
remove any surplus materials, clear away any wreckage, rubbish, or
temporary works from the Site, and remove any Contractor’s
23. Test and 23.1 The Contractor shall at its own expense carry out at the place of manufacture
Inspection and/or on the Site all such tests and/or inspections of the Plant and any part of
the Facilities as are specified in the Contract.
23.2 The Employer and the Project Manager or their designated representatives
shall be entitled to attend the aforesaid test and/or inspection, provided that the
Employer shall bear all costs and expenses incurred in connection with such
attendance including, but not limited to, all traveling and board and lodging
expenses.
23.3 Whenever the Contractor is ready to carry out any such test and/or inspection,
the Contractor shall give a reasonable advance notice of such test and/or
inspection and of the place and time thereof to the Project Manager. The
Contractor shall obtain from any relevant third party or manufacturer any
necessary permission or consent to enable the Employer and the Project
Manager or their designated representatives to attend the test and/or
inspection.
23.4 The Contractor shall provide the Project Manager with a certified report of the
results of any such test and/or inspection.
If the Employer or Project Manager or their designated representatives fails to
attend the test and/or inspection, or if it is agreed between the parties that such
persons shall not do so, then the Contractor may proceed with the test and/or
inspection in the absence of such persons, and may provide the Project
Manager with a certified report of the results thereof.
23.5 The Project Manager may require the Contractor to carry out any test and/or
inspection not required by the Contract, provided that the Contractor’s
reasonable costs and expenses incurred in the carrying out of such test and/or
inspection shall be added to the Contract Price. Further, if such test and/or
inspection impede the progress of work on the Facilities and/or the
Contractor’s performance of its other obligations under the Contract, due
allowance will be made in respect of the Time for Completion and the other
obligations so affected.
23.6 If any Plant or any part of the Facilities fails to pass any test and/or inspection,
the Contractor shall either rectify or replace such Plant or part of the Facilities
and shall repeat the test and/or inspection upon giving a notice under GCC
Subclause 23.3.
23.7 If any dispute or difference of opinion shall arise between the parties in
connection with or arising out of the test and/or inspection of the Plant or part
of the Facilities that cannot be settled between the parties within a reasonable
period of time, it may be referred to an Dispute Board for determination in
accordance with GCC Subclause 45.3.
23.8 The Contractor shall afford the Employer and the Project Manager, at the
Employer’s expense, access at any reasonable time to any place where the
Plant are being manufactured or the Facilities are being installed, in order to
inspect the progress and the manner of manufacture or installation, provided
that the Project Manager shall give the Contractor a reasonable prior notice.
23.9 The Contractor agrees that neither the execution of a test and/or inspection of
Plant or any part of the Facilities, nor the attendance by the Employer or the
Project Manager, nor the issue of any test certificate pursuant to GCC
Subclause 23.4, shall release the Contractor from any other responsibilities
under the Contract.
23.10 No part of the Facilities or foundations shall be covered up on the Site without
the Contractor carrying out any test and/or inspection required under the
Contract. The Contractor shall give a reasonable notice to the Project Manager
whenever any such parts of the Facilities or foundations are ready or about to
be ready for test and/or inspection; such test and/or inspection and notice
thereof shall be subject to the requirements of the Contract.
23.11 The Contractor shall uncover any part of the Facilities or foundations, or shall
make openings in or through the same as the Project Manager may from time
to time require at the Site, and shall reinstate and make good such part or parts.
If any parts of the Facilities or foundations have been covered up at the Site
after compliance with the requirement of GCC Subclause 23.10 and are found
to be executed in accordance with the Contract, the expenses of uncovering,
making openings in or through, reinstating, and making good the same shall be
borne by the Employer, and the Time for Completion shall be reasonably
adjusted to the extent that the Contractor has thereby been delayed or impeded
in the performance of any of its obligations under the Contract.
24. Completion of the 24.1 As soon as the Facilities or any part thereof has, in the opinion of the
Facilities Contractor, been completed operationally and structurally and put in a tight
and clean condition as specified in the Employer’s Requirements, excluding
minor items not materially affecting the operation or safety of the Facilities,
the Contractor shall so notify the Employer in writing.
24.2 Within 7 days after receipt of the notice from the Contractor under GCC
Subclause 24.1, the Employer shall supply the operating and maintenance
personnel specified in the Appendix (Scope of Works and Supply by the
Employer) to the Contract Agreement for Pre-commissioning of the Facilities
or any part thereof.
Pursuant to the Appendix (Scope of Works and Supply by the Employer) to
the Contract Agreement, the Employer shall also provide, within the said 7-
day period, the raw materials, utilities, lubricants, chemicals, catalysts,
facilities, services, and other matters required for Pre-commissioning of the
Facilities or any part thereof.
24.3 As soon as reasonably practicable after the operating and maintenance
personnel have been supplied by the Employer and the raw materials, utilities,
lubricants, chemicals, catalysts, facilities, services, and other matters have
been provided by the Employer in accordance with GCC Subclause 24.2, the
Contractor shall commence Pre-commissioning of the Facilities or the relevant
part thereof in preparation for Commissioning, subject to GCC Subclause
25.5.
24.4 As soon as all works in respect of Pre-commissioning are completed and, in
the opinion of the Contractor, the Facilities or any part thereof is ready for
Contractor.
25.5.4 When the Contractor is notified by the Project Manager that the plant
is ready for Pre-commissioning, the Contractor shall proceed without
delay in performing all the specified activities and obligations under
the contract.
27. Defect Liability 27.1 The Contractor warrants that the Facilities or any part thereof shall be free
from defects in the design, engineering, materials, and workmanship of the
Plant supplied and of the work executed.
27.2 The Defect Liability Period shall be 540 days from the date of Completion of
the Facilities (or any part thereof) or 1 year from the date of Operational
Acceptance of the Facilities (or any part thereof), whichever first occurs,
unless specified otherwise in the SCC pursuant to GCC Subclause 27.10.
If during the Defect Liability Period any defect should be found in the design,
engineering, materials, and workmanship of the Plant supplied or of the work
executed by the Contractor, the Contractor shall promptly, in consultation and
agreement with the Employer regarding appropriate remedying of the defects,
and at its cost, repair, replace, or otherwise make good as the Contractor shall
determine at its discretion, such defect as well as any damage to the Facilities
caused by such defect. The Contractor shall not be responsible for the repair,
replacement, or making good of any defect or of any damage to the Facilities
arising out of or resulting from any of the following causes:
(a) improper operation or maintenance of the Facilities by the Employer,
(b) operation of the Facilities outside specifications provided in the
Contract, or
(c) normal wear and tear.
27.3 The Contractor’s obligations under this GCC Clause 27 shall not apply to:
(a) any materials that are supplied by the Employer under GCC Subclause
21.2, are normally consumed in operation, or have a normal life shorter
than the Defect Liability Period stated herein;
(b) any designs, specifications or other data designed, supplied, or
specified by or on behalf of the Employer or any matters for which the
Contractor has disclaimed responsibility herein; or
(c) any other materials supplied or any other work executed by or on
behalf of the Employer, except for the work executed by the Employer
under GCC Subclause 27.7.
27.4 The Employer shall give the Contractor a notice stating the nature of any such
defect together with all available evidence thereof, promptly following the
discovery thereof. The Employer shall afford all reasonable opportunity for
the Contractor to inspect any such defect.
27.5 The Employer shall afford the Contractor all necessary access to the Facilities
and the Site to enable the Contractor to perform its obligations under this
GCC Clause 27.
The Contractor may, with the consent of the Employer, remove from the Site
any Plant or any part of the Facilities that are defective if the nature of the
defect, and/or any damage to the Facilities caused by the defect, is such that
repairs cannot be expeditiously carried out at the Site.
27.6 If the repair, replacement or making good is of such a character that it may
affect the efficiency of the Facilities or any part thereof, the Employer may
give to the Contractor a notice requiring that tests of the defective part of the
Facilities shall be made by the Contractor immediately upon completion of
such remedial work, whereupon the Contractor shall carry out such tests.
If such part fails the tests, the Contractor shall carry out further repair,
replacement or making good, as the case may be, until that part of the
Facilities passes such tests. The tests shall be agreed upon by the Employer
and the Contractor.
27.7 If the Contractor fails to commence the work necessary to remedy such defect
or any damage to the Facilities caused by such defect within a reasonable time
(which shall in no event be considered to be less than 15 days), the Employer
may, following notice to the Contractor, proceed to do such work, and the
reasonable costs incurred by the Employer in connection therewith shall be
paid to the Employer by the Contractor or may be deducted by the Employer
from any monies due the Contractor or claimed under the Performance
Security.
27.8 If the Facilities or any part thereof cannot be used by reason of such defect
and/or making good of such defect, the Defect Liability Period of the
Facilities or such part, as the case may be, shall be extended by a period equal
to the period during which the Facilities or such part cannot be used by the
28. Functional 28.1 The Contractor guarantees that during the Guarantee Test, the Facilities and
Guarantees all parts thereof shall attain the Functional Guarantees specified in the
Appendix (Functional Guarantees) to the Contract Agreement, subject to, and
upon the conditions therein specified.
28.2 If, for reasons attributable to the Contractor, the minimum level of the
Functional Guarantees specified in the Appendix (Functional Guarantees) to
the Contract Agreement are not met either in whole or in part, the Contractor
shall at its cost and expense make such changes, modifications, and/or
additions to the Plant or any part thereof as may be necessary to meet at least
the minimum level of such Guarantees. The Contractor shall notify the
Employer upon completion of the necessary changes, modifications, and/or
additions, and shall request the Employer to repeat the Guarantee Test until
the minimum level of the Guarantees has been met. If the Contractor
eventually fails to meet the minimum level of Functional Guarantees, the
Employer may consider termination of the Contract, pursuant to GCC
Subclause 42.2.2.
28.3 If, for reasons attributable to the Contractor, the Functional Guarantees
specified in the Appendix (Functional Guarantees) to the Contract Agreement
are not attained either in whole or in part, but the minimum level of the
Functional Guarantees specified in the said Appendix to the Contract
Agreement is met, the Contractor shall, at the Contractor’s option, either
(a) make such changes, modifications, and/or additions to the Facilities or
any part thereof that are necessary to attain the Functional Guarantees
at its cost and expense, and shall request the Employer to repeat the
Guarantee Test or
(b) pay liquidated damages to the Employer in respect of the failure to
meet the Functional Guarantees in accordance with the provisions in
the Appendix (Functional Guarantees) to the Contract Agreement.
28.4 The payment of liquidated damages under GCC Subclause 28.3, up to the
limitation of liability specified in the Appendix (Functional Guarantees) to the
Contract Agreement, shall completely satisfy the Contractor’s guarantees
under GCC Subclause 28.3, and the Contractor shall have no further liability
whatsoever to the Employer in respect thereof. Upon the payment of such
liquidated damages by the Contractor, the Project Manager shall issue the
Operational Acceptance Certificate for the Facilities or any part thereof in
respect of which the liquidated damages have been so paid.
29. Patent Indemnity 29.1 The Contractor shall, subject to the Employer’s compliance with GCC
Subclause 29.2, indemnify and hold harmless the Employer and its employees
and officers from and against any and all suits, actions, or administrative
proceedings, claims, demands, losses, damages, costs, and expenses of
whatsoever nature, including attorney’s fees and expenses, which the
Employer may suffer as a result of any infringement or alleged infringement
of any patent, utility model, registered design, trademark, copyright, or other
intellectual property right registered or otherwise existing at the date of the
Contract by reason of (a) the installation of the Facilities by the Contractor or
the use of the Facilities in the country where the Site is located, and (b) the
sale of the products produced by the Facilities in any country.
Such indemnity shall not cover any use of the Facilities or any part thereof
other than for the purpose indicated by or to be reasonably inferred from the
Contract, any infringement resulting from the use of the Facilities or any part
thereof, or any products produced thereby in association or combination with
any other equipment, plant, or materials not supplied by the Contractor,
pursuant to the Contract Agreement.
29.2 If any proceedings are brought or any claim is made against the Employer
arising out of the matters referred to in GCC Subclause 29.1, the Employer
shall promptly give the Contractor a notice thereof, and the Contractor may at
its own expense and in the Employer’s name conduct such proceedings or
claim and any negotiations for the settlement of any such proceedings or
claim.
If the Contractor fails to notify the Employer within 30 days after receipt of
such notice that it intends to conduct any such proceedings or claim, then the
Employer shall be free to conduct the same on its own behalf. Unless the
Contractor has so failed to notify the Employer within the 30-day period, the
Employer shall make no admission that may be prejudicial to the defense of
any such proceedings or claim.
The Employer shall, at the Contractor’s request, afford all available assistance
to the Contractor in conducting such proceedings or claim, and shall be
reimbursed by the Contractor for all reasonable expenses incurred in so doing.
29.3 The Employer shall indemnify and hold harmless the Contractor and its
employees, officers, and Subcontractors from and against any and all suits,
actions or administrative proceedings, claims, demands, losses, damages,
costs, and expenses of whatsoever nature, including attorney’s fees and
expenses, which the Contractor may suffer as a result of any infringement or
alleged infringement of any patent, utility model, registered design,
trademark, copyright, or other intellectual property right registered or
otherwise existing at the date of the Contract arising out of or in connection
with any design, data, drawing, specification, or other documents or materials
provided or designed by or on behalf of the Employer.
G. Risk Distribution
31. Transfer of 31.1 Ownership of the Plant (including spare parts) to be imported into the country
Ownership where the Site is located shall be transferred to the Employer upon loading on
to the mode of transport to be used to convey the Plant from the country of
origin to that country.
31.2 Ownership of the Plant (including spare parts) procured in the country where
the Site is located shall be transferred to the Employer when the Plant are
brought on to the Site.
31.3 Ownership of the Contractor’s Equipment used by the Contractor and its
Subcontractors in connection with the Contract shall remain with the
Contractor or its Subcontractors.
31.4 Ownership of any Plant in excess of the requirements for the Facilities shall
revert to the Contractor upon Completion of the Facilities or at such earlier
time when the Employer and the Contractor agree that the Plant in question are
no longer required for the Facilities.
31.5 Notwithstanding the transfer of ownership of the Plant, the responsibility for
care and custody thereof together with the risk of loss or damage thereto shall
remain with the Contractor pursuant to GCC Clause 32 (Care of Facilities)
hereof until Completion of the Facilities or the part thereof in which such Plant
are incorporated.
32. Care of Facilities 32.1 The Contractor shall be responsible for the care and custody of the Facilities or
any part thereof until the date of Completion of the Facilities pursuant to GCC
Clause 24 or, where the Contract provides for Completion of the Facilities in
parts, until the date of Completion of the relevant part, and shall make good at
its own cost any loss or damage that may occur to the Facilities or the relevant
part thereof from any cause whatsoever during such period. The Contractor
shall also be responsible for any loss or damage to the Facilities caused by the
Contractor or its Subcontractors in the course of any work carried out, pursuant
to GCC Clause 27. Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Contractor shall not be
liable for any loss or damage to the Facilities or that part thereof caused by
reason of any of the matters specified or referred to in paragraphs (a), (b) and
(c) of GCC Subclauses 32.2 and 38.1.
32.2 If any loss or damage occurs to the Facilities or any part thereof or to the
Contractor’s temporary facilities by reason of
(a) insofar as they relate to the country where the Site is located, nuclear
reaction, nuclear radiation, radioactive contamination, pressure wave
caused by aircraft or other aerial objects, or any other occurrences that
an experienced contractor could not reasonably foresee, or if reasonably
foreseeable could not reasonably make provision for or insure against,
insofar as such risks are not normally insurable on the insurance market
and are mentioned in the general exclusions of the policy of insurance,
including War Risks and Political Risks, taken out under GCC Clause
34 hereof; or
(b) any use or occupation by the Employer or any third party other than a
Subcontractor, authorized by the Employer of any part of the Facilities;
or
(c) any use of or reliance upon any design, data, or specification provided
or designated by or on behalf of the Employer, or any such matter for
33. Loss of or 33.1 Subject to GCC Subclause 33.3, the Contractor shall indemnify and hold
Damage to harmless the Employer and its employees and officers from and against any
Property; and all suits, actions, or administrative proceedings, claims, demands, losses,
Accident or damages, costs, and expenses of whatsoever nature, including attorney’s fees
Injury to and expenses, in respect of the death or injury of any person or loss of or
Workers; damage to any property other than the Facilities whether accepted or not,
Indemnification arising in connection with the supply and installation of the Facilities and by
reason of the negligence of the Contractor or its Subcontractors, or their
employees, officers, or agents, except any injury, death, or property damage
caused by the negligence of the Employer, its contractors, employees, officers,
or agents.
33.2 If any proceedings are brought or any claim is made against the Employer that
might subject the Contractor to liability under GCC Subclause 33.1, the
Employer shall promptly give the Contractor a notice thereof and the
Contractor may at its own expense and in the Employer’s name conduct such
proceedings or claim and any negotiations for the settlement of any such
proceedings or claim.
If the Contractor fails to notify the Employer within 30 days after receipt of
such notice that it intends to conduct any such proceedings or claim, then the
Employer shall be free to conduct the same on its own behalf. Unless the
Contractor has so failed to notify the Employer within the 30-day period, the
Employer shall make no admission that may be prejudicial to the defense of
any such proceedings or claim.
The Employer shall, at the Contractor’s request, afford all available assistance
to the Contractor in conducting such proceedings or claim, and shall be
reimbursed by the Contractor for all reasonable expenses incurred in so doing.
33.3 The Employer shall indemnify and hold harmless the Contractor and its
employees, officers, and Subcontractors from any liability for loss of or
damage to property of the Employer, other than the Facilities not yet taken
over, that is caused by fire, explosion, or any other perils, in excess of the
amount recoverable from insurances procured under GCC Clause 34, provided
that such fire, explosion, or other perils were not caused by any act or failure of
the Contractor.
33.4 The party entitled to the benefit of an indemnity under this GCC Clause 33
shall take all reasonable measures to mitigate any loss or damage which has
occurred. If the party fails to take such measures, the other party’s liabilities
shall be correspondingly reduced.
34. Insurance 34.1 To the extent specified in the Appendix (Insurance Requirements) to the
Contract Agreement, the Contractor shall at its expense take out and maintain
in effect, or cause to be taken out and maintained in effect, during the
performance of the Contract, the insurances set forth below in the sums and
with the deductibles and other conditions specified in the said Appendix. The
identity of the insurers and the form of the policies shall be subject to the
approval of the Employer, who should not unreasonably withhold such
approval.
(a) Cargo Insurance During Transport
Covering loss or damage occurring while in transit from the
Contractor’s or Subcontractor’s works or stores until arrival at the Site,
to the Plant (including spare parts therefor) and to the Contractor’s
Equipment.
(b) Installation All Risks Insurance
Covering physical loss or damage to the Facilities at the Site, occurring
prior to Completion of the Facilities, with extended maintenance
coverage for the Contractor’s liability in respect of any loss or damage
occurring during the Defect Liability Period while the Contractor is on
the Site for the purpose of performing its obligations during the Defect
Liability Period.
(c) Third Party Liability Insurance
Covering bodily injury or death suffered by third parties including the
Employer’s personnel, and loss of or damage to property occurring in
connection with the supply and installation of the Facilities.
(d) Automobile Liability Insurance
Covering use of all vehicles used by the Contractor or its
Subcontractors, whether or not owned by them, in connection with the
execution of the Contract.
(e) Workers’ Compensation
In accordance with the statutory requirements applicable in any country
where the Contract or any part thereof is executed.
(f) Employer’s Liability
In accordance with the statutory requirements applicable in any country
where the Contract or any part thereof is executed.
(g) Other Insurances
Such other insurances as may be specifically agreed upon by the parties
hereto as listed in the Appendix (Insurance Requirements) to the
Contract Agreement.
34.2 The Employer shall be named as co-insured under all insurance policies taken
out by the Contractor pursuant to GCC Subclause 34.1, except for the Third
give any release or make any compromise with the insurer without the prior
written consent of the Employer. With respect to insurance claims in which the
Contractor’s interest is involved, the Employer shall not give any release or
make any compromise with the insurer without the prior written consent of the
Contractor.
35. Unforeseen 35.1 If, during the execution of the Contract, the Contractor shall encounter on the
Conditions Site any physical conditions other than climatic conditions, or artificial
obstructions that could not have been reasonably foreseen prior to the date of
the Contract Agreement by an experienced contractor on the basis of
reasonable examination of the data relating to the Facilities including any data
as to boring tests, provided by the Employer, and on the basis of information
that it could have obtained from a visual inspection of the Site if access thereto
was available, or other data readily available to it relating to the Facilities, and
if the Contractor determines that it will in consequence of such conditions or
obstructions incur additional cost and expense or require additional time to
perform its obligations under the Contract that would not have been required if
such physical conditions or artificial obstructions had not been encountered,
the Contractor shall promptly, and before performing additional work or using
additional Plant or Contractor’s Equipment, notify the Project Manager in
writing of
(a) the physical conditions or artificial obstructions on the Site that could
not have been reasonably foreseen;
(b) the additional work and/or Plant and/or Contractor’s Equipment
required, including the steps which the Contractor will or proposes to
take to overcome such conditions or obstructions;
(c) the extent of the anticipated delay; and
(d) the additional cost and expense that the Contractor is likely to incur.
On receiving any notice from the Contractor under this GCC Subclause 35.1,
the Project Manager shall promptly consult with the Employer and Contractor
and decide upon the actions to be taken to overcome the physical conditions or
artificial obstructions encountered. Following such consultations, the Project
Manager shall instruct the Contractor, with a copy to the Employer, of the
actions to be taken.
35.2 Any reasonable additional cost and expense incurred by the Contractor in
following the instructions from the Project Manager to overcome such physical
conditions or artificial obstructions referred to in GCC Subclause 35.1 shall be
paid by the Employer to the Contractor as an addition to the Contract Price.
35.3 If the Contractor is delayed or impeded in the performance of the Contract
because of any such physical conditions or artificial obstructions referred to in
GCC Subclause 35.1, the Time for Completion shall be extended in accordance
with GCC Clause 40.
36. Change in Laws 36.1 If, after the date 30 days prior to the date of Bid submission, in the country
and Regulations where the Site is located, any law, regulation, ordinance, order or by-law
having the force of law is enacted, promulgated, abrogated, or changed, which
shall be deemed to include any change in interpretation or application by the
competent authorities, that subsequently affects the costs and expenses of the
Contractor and/or the Time for Completion, the Contract Price shall be
correspondingly increased or decreased, and/or the Time for Completion shall
be reasonably adjusted to the extent that the Contractor has thereby been
affected in the performance of any of its obligations under the Contract.
37. Force Majeure 37.1 “Force Majeure” shall mean any event beyond the reasonable control of the
Employer or of the Contractor, as the case may be, and which is unavoidable
notwithstanding the reasonable care of the party affected, and shall include,
without limitation, the following:
(a) war, hostilities, or warlike operations whether a state of war be declared
or not, invasion, act of foreign enemy and civil war;
(b) rebellion, revolution, insurrection, mutiny, usurpation of civil or military
government, conspiracy, riot, civil commotion, and terrorist acts;
(c) confiscation, nationalization, mobilization, commandeering or
requisition by or under the order of any government or de jure or de
facto authority or ruler or any other act or failure to act of any local state
or national government authority;
(d) strike, sabotage, lockout, embargo, import restriction, port congestion,
lack of usual means of public transportation and communication,
industrial dispute, shipwreck, shortage or restriction of power supply,
epidemics, quarantine, and plague;
(e) earthquake, landslide, volcanic activity, fire, flood or inundation, tidal
wave, typhoon or cyclone, hurricane, storm, lightning, or other
inclement weather condition, nuclear, and pressure waves or other
natural or physical disaster; and
(f) shortage of labor, materials, or utilities where caused by circumstances
that are themselves Force Majeure.
37.2 If either party is prevented, hindered, or delayed from or in performing any of
its obligations under the Contract by an event of Force Majeure, then it shall
notify the other in writing of the occurrence of such event and the
circumstances thereof within 14 days after the occurrence of such event.
37.3 The party who has given such notice shall be excused from the performance or
punctual performance of its obligations under the Contract for so long as the
relevant event of Force Majeure continues and to the extent that such party’s
performance is prevented, hindered, or delayed. The Time for Completion shall
be extended in accordance with GCC Clause 40.
37.4 The party or parties affected by the event of Force Majeure shall use
reasonable efforts to mitigate the effect thereof upon its or their performance of
the Contract and to fulfill its or their obligations under the Contract, but
without prejudice to either party’s right to terminate the Contract under GCC
Subclauses 37.6 and 38.5.
37.5 No delay or nonperformance by either party hereto caused by the occurrence of
any event of Force Majeure shall
(a) constitute a default or breach of the Contract; or
(b) give rise to any claim for damages or additional cost or expense
occasioned thereby, subject to GCC Subclauses 32.2, 38.3 and 38.4
if and to the extent that such delay or nonperformance is caused by the
occurrence of an event of Force Majeure.
37.6 If the performance of the Contract is substantially prevented, hindered, or
delayed for a single period of more than 60 days or an aggregate period of
more than 120 days on account of one or more events of Force Majeure during
the currency of the Contract, the parties will attempt to develop a mutually
satisfactory solution, failing which either party may terminate the Contract by
giving a notice to the other, but without prejudice to either party’s right to
terminate the Contract under GCC Subclause 38.5.
37.7 In the event of termination pursuant to GCC Subclause 37.6, the rights and
obligations of the Employer and the Contractor shall be as specified in GCC
Subclauses 42.1.2 and 42.1.3.
37.8 Notwithstanding GCC Subclause 37.5, Force Majeure shall not apply to any
obligation of the Employer to make payments to the Contractor herein.
38. War Risks 38.1 “War Risks” shall mean any event specified in paragraphs (a) and (b) of GCC
Subclause 37.1 and any explosion or impact of any mine, bomb, shell, grenade,
or other projectile, missile, munitions or explosive of war, occurring or existing
in or near the country (or countries) where the Site is located.
38.2 Notwithstanding anything contained in the Contract, the Contractor shall have
no liability whatsoever for or with respect to
(a) destruction of or damage to Facilities, Plant, or any part thereof;
(b) destruction of or damage to property of the Employer or any third party;
or
(c) injury or loss of life
if such destruction, damage, injury or loss of life is caused by any war risks,
and the Employer shall indemnify and hold the Contractor harmless from and
against any and all claims, liabilities, actions, lawsuits, damages, costs,
charges, or expenses arising in consequence of or in connection with the same.
38.3 If the Facilities or any Plant or Contractor’s Equipment or any other property
of the Contractor used or intended to be used for the purposes of the Facilities
shall sustain destruction or damage by reason of any war risks, the Employer
shall pay the Contractor for
(a) any part of the Facilities or the Plant so destroyed or damaged to the
extent not already paid for by the Employer and so far as may be
required by the Employer, and as may be necessary for completion of
the Facilities;
(b) replacing or making good any Contractor’s Equipment or other property
of the Contractor so destroyed or damaged; and
(c) replacing or making good any such destruction or damage to the
Facilities or the Plant or any part thereof.
If the Employer does not require the Contractor to replace or make good any
such destruction or damage to the Facilities, the Employer shall either request a
change in accordance with GCC Clause 39, excluding the performance of that
part of the Facilities thereby destroyed or damaged or, where the loss,
destruction, or damage affects a substantial part of the Facilities, shall
terminate the Contract, pursuant to GCC Subclause 42.1.
If the Employer requires the Contractor to replace or make good on any such
destruction or damage to the Facilities, the Time for Completion shall be
extended in accordance with GCC 40.
38.4 Notwithstanding anything contained in the Contract, the Employer shall pay
the Contractor for any increased costs or incidentals to the execution of the
Contract that are in any way attributable to, consequent on, resulting from, or
in any way connected with any war risks, provided that the Contractor shall as
soon as practicable notify the Employer in writing of any such increased cost.
38.5 If during the performance of the Contract any war risks shall occur that
financially or otherwise materially affect the execution of the Contract by the
Contractor, the Contractor shall use its reasonable efforts to execute the
Contract with due and proper consideration given to the safety of its and its
Subcontractors’ personnel engaged in the work on the Facilities, provided,
however, that if the execution of the work on the Facilities becomes impossible
or is substantially prevented for a single period of more than sixty (60) days or
an aggregate period of more than one hundred and twenty (120) days on
account of any war risks, the parties will attempt to develop a mutually
satisfactory solution, failing which either party may terminate the Contract by
giving a notice to the other.
38.6 In the event of termination pursuant to GCC Subclauses 38.3 or 38.5, the rights
and obligations of the Employer and the Contractor shall be specified in GCC
Subclauses 42.1.2 and 42.1.3.
notify the Contractor with details of when the Contractor can expect a
decision.
If the Employer decides not to proceed with the Change for whatever
reason, it shall, within the said period of 14 days, notify the Contractor
accordingly. Under such circumstances, the Contractor shall be
entitled to reimbursement of all costs reasonably incurred by it in the
preparation of the Change Proposal, provided that these do not exceed
the amount given by the Contractor in its Estimate for Change
Proposal submitted in accordance with GCC Subclause 39.2.2.
39.2.7 If the Employer and the Contractor cannot reach agreement on the
price for the Change, an equitable adjustment to the Time for
Completion, or any other matters identified in the Change Proposal,
the Employer may nevertheless instruct the Contractor to proceed with
the Change by issue of a “Pending Agreement Change Order.”
Upon receipt of a Pending Agreement Change Order, the Contractor
shall immediately proceed with effecting the Changes covered by such
Order. The parties shall thereafter attempt to reach agreement on the
outstanding issues under the Change Proposal.
If the parties cannot reach agreement within 60 days from the date of
issue of the Pending Agreement Change Order, then the matter may be
referred to the Dispute Board in accordance with the provisions of
GCC Subclause 45.3.
39.3 Changes Originating from Contractor
39.3.1 If the Contractor proposes a Change pursuant to GCC Subclause
39.1.2, the Contractor shall submit to the Project Manager a written
“Application for Change Proposal,” giving reasons for the proposed
Change and including the information specified in GCC Subclause
39.2.1.
Upon receipt of the Application for Change Proposal, the parties shall
follow the procedures outlined in GCC Subclauses 39.2.6 and 39.2.7.
However, should the Employer choose not to proceed, the Contractor
shall not be entitled to recover the costs of preparing the Application
for Change Proposal.
40. Extension of Time 40.1 The Time(s) for Completion specified in the SCC shall be extended if the
for Completion Contractor is delayed or impeded in the performance of any of its obligations
under the Contract by reason of any of the following:
(a) any Change in the Facilities as provided in GCC Clause 39;
(b) any occurrence of Force Majeure as provided in GCC Clause 37,
unforeseen conditions as provided in GCC Clause 35, or other
occurrence of any of the matters specified or referred to in paragraphs
(a), (b) and (c) of GCC Subclause 32.2;
(c) any suspension order given by the Employer under GCC Clause 41
hereof or reduction in the rate of progress pursuant to GCC Subclause
41.2; or
(d) any changes in laws and regulations as provided in GCC Clause 36; or
(e) any default or breach of the Contract by the Employer, or any activity,
act or omission of the Employer, or the Project Manager, or any other
contractors employed by the Employer; or
(f) any other matter specifically mentioned in the Contract; or
(g) any delay on the part of a sub-contractor, provided such delay is due to
a cause for which the Contractor himself would have been entitled to an
extension of time under this Subclause
by such period as shall be fair and reasonable in all the circumstances and as
shall fairly reflect the delay or impediment sustained by the Contractor.
40.2 Except where otherwise specifically provided in the Contract, the Contractor
shall submit to the Project Manager a notice of a claim for an extension of the
Time for Completion, together with particulars of the event or circumstance
justifying such extension as soon as reasonably practicable after the
commencement of such event or circumstance. As soon as reasonably
practicable after receipt of such notice and supporting particulars of the claim,
the Employer and the Contractor shall agree upon the period of such
extension. In the event that the Contractor does not accept the Employer’s
estimate of a fair and reasonable time extension, the Contractor shall be
entitled to refer the matter to a Dispute Board, pursuant to GCC Subclause
45.3.
40.3 The Contractor shall at all times use its reasonable efforts to minimize any
delay in the performance of its obligations under the Contract.
In all cases where the Contractor has given a notice of a claim for an extension
of time under GCC 40.2, the Contractor shall consult with the Project Manager
in order to determine the steps (if any) which can be taken to overcome or
minimize the actual or anticipated delay. The Contractor shall there after
comply with all reasonable instructions, which the Project Manager shall give
in order to minimize such delay. If compliance with such instructions shall
cause the Contractor to incur extra costs and the Contractor is entitled to an
extension of time under GCC 40.1, the amount of such extra costs shall be
added to the Contract Price.
41. Suspension 41.1 The Employer may request the Project Manager, by notice to the Contractor,
to order the Contractor to suspend performance of any or all of its obligations
under the Contract. Such notice shall specify the obligation of which
performance is to be suspended, the effective date of the suspension and the
reasons therefor. The Contractor shall thereupon suspend performance of such
obligation, except those obligations necessary for the care or preservation of
the Facilities, until ordered in writing to resume such performance by the
Project Manager.
If, by virtue of a suspension order given by the Project Manager, other than by
reason of the Contractor’s default or breach of the Contract, the Contractor’s
performance of any of its obligations is suspended for an aggregate period of
more than 90 days, then at any time thereafter and provided that at that time
such performance is still suspended, the Contractor may give a notice to the
Project Manager requiring that the Employer shall, within 30 days of receipt of
the notice, order the resumption of such performance or request and
subsequently order a change in accordance with GCC Clause 39, excluding the
performance of the suspended obligations from the Contract.
If the Employer fails to do so within such period, the Contractor may, by a
further notice to the Project Manager, elect to treat the suspension, where it
affects a part only of the Facilities, as a deletion of such part in accordance
with GCC Clause 39 or, where it affects the whole of the Facilities, as
termination of the Contract under GCC Subclause 42.1.
41.2 If
(a) the Employer has failed to pay the Contractor any sum due under the
Contract within the specified period, has failed to approve any invoice
or supporting documents without just cause pursuant to the Appendix
(Terms and Procedures of Payment) to the Contract Agreement, or
commits a substantial breach of the Contract, the Contractor may give a
notice to the Employer that requires payment of such sum, with interest
thereon as stipulated in GCC Subclause 12.3, requires approval of such
invoice or supporting documents, or specifies the breach and requires
the Employer to remedy the same, as the case may be. If the Employer
fails to pay such sum together with such interest, fails to approve such
invoice or supporting documents or give its reasons for withholding
such approval, or fails to remedy the breach or take steps to remedy the
breach within 14 days after receipt of the Contractor’s notice; or
(b) the Contractor is unable to carry out any of its obligations under the
Contract for any reason attributable to the Employer, including but not
limited to the Employer’s failure to provide possession of or access to
the Site or other areas in accordance with GCC Subclause 10.2, or
failure to obtain any governmental permit necessary for the execution
and/or completion of the Facilities,
then the Contractor may by 14 days’ notice to the Employer suspend
performance of all or any of its obligations under the Contract, or reduce the
rate of progress.
41.3 If the Contractor’s performance of its obligations is suspended, or the rate of
progress is reduced pursuant to this GCC Clause 41, then the Time for
Completion shall be extended in accordance with GCC Subclause 40.1, and
any and all additional costs or expenses incurred by the Contractor as a result
of such suspension or reduction shall be paid by the Employer to the
Contractor in addition to the Contract Price, except in the case of suspension
order or reduction in the rate of progress by reason of the Contractor’s default
or breach of the Contract.
41.4 During the period of suspension, the Contractor shall not remove from the Site
any Plant, any part of the Facilities or any Contractor’s Equipment, without the
prior written consent of the Employer.
42. Termination 42.1 In no case, the contractor shall terminate the contract unilaterly, without duly
notifying the Employer.
42.2 The Employer may terminate the Contract at any time if the contractor :
a) does not commence the work as per the Contract,
b) abandons the work without completing,
c) fails to achieve progress as per the Contract.
42.3 The Employer or the Contractor may terminate the Contract if the other party
causes a fundamental breach of the Contract.
42.4 Fundamental breaches of Contract shall include, but shall not be limited to, the
following :
a) The Contractor uses the advance payment for matters other than the
contractual obligations,
b) the Contractor stops work for 30 days when no stoppage of work is shown
on the current Program and the stoppage has not been authorized by the
Project Manager;
c) the Project Manager instructs the Contractor to delay the progress of the
Works, and the instruction is not withdrawn within 30 days;
43. Assignment 43.1 Neither the Employer nor the Contractor shall, without the express prior
written consent of the other party which consent shall not be unreasonably
withheld, assign to any third party the Contract or any part thereof, or any
right, benefit, obligation or interest therein or thereunder, except that the
Contractor shall be entitled to assign either absolutely or by way of charge any
monies due and payable to it or that may become due and payable to it under
the Contract.
event or circumstance.
The Contractor shall keep such contemporary records as may be necessary to
substantiate any claim, either on the Site or at another location acceptable to
the Project Manager. Without admitting the Employer’s liability, the Project
Manager may, after receiving any notice under this Subclause, monitor the
record keeping and/or instruct the Contractor to keep further contemporary
records. The Contractor shall permit the Project Manager to inspect all these
records, and shall (if instructed) submit copies to the Project Manager.
Within 42 days after the Contractor became aware (or should have become
aware) of the event or circumstance giving rise to the claim, or within such
other period as may be proposed by the Contractor and approved by the
Project Manager, the Contractor shall send to the Project Manager a fully
detailed claim, which includes full supporting particulars of the basis of the
claim and of the extension of time and/or additional payment claimed. If the
event or circumstance giving rise to the claim has a continuing effect,
(a) this fully detailed claim shall be considered as interim;
(b) the Contractor shall send further interim claims at monthly intervals,
giving the accumulated delay and/or amount claimed, and such further
particulars as the Project Manager may reasonably require; and
(c) the Contractor shall send a final claim within 30 days after the end of
the effects resulting from the event or circumstance, or within such
other period as may be proposed by the Contractor and approved by the
Project Manager.
Within 42 days after receiving a claim or any further particulars supporting a
previous claim, or within such other period as may be proposed by the Project
Manager and approved by the Contractor, the Project Manager shall respond
with approval, or with disapproval and detailed comments. He may also
request any necessary further particulars, but shall nevertheless give his
response on the principles of the claim within such time.
Each payment certificate shall include such amounts for any claim as have
been reasonably substantiated as due under the relevant provision of the
Contract. Unless and until the particulars supplied are sufficient to
substantiate the whole of the claim, the Contractor shall only be entitled to
payment for such part of the claim as he has been able to substantiate.
The Project Manager shall agree with the Contractor or estimate: (i) the
extension (if any) of the Time for Completion (before or after its expiry) in
accordance with GCC Clause 40, and/or (ii) the additional payment (if any) to
which the Contractor is entitled under the Contract.
The requirements of this Subclause are in addition to those of any other
Subclause, which may apply to a claim. If the Contractor fails to comply with
this or another Subclause in relation to any claim, any extension of time
and/or additional payment shall take account of the extent (if any) to which
the failure has prevented or prejudiced proper investigation of the claim,
unless the claim is excluded under the second paragraph of this Subclause.
In the event that the Contractor and the Employer cannot agree on any matter
relating to a claim, either party may refer the matter to the Dispute Board
pursuant to GCC 45 hereof.
45. Disputes and 45.1 The Employer and the Contractor shall attempt to settle amicably by direct
Arbitration negotiation any disagreement or dispute arising between them under or in
connection with the Contract.
45.2 Any dispute between the Parties as to matters arising pursuant to this Contract
which cannot be settled amicably within thirty (30) days after receipt by one
Party of the other Party‘s request for such amicable settlement may be
referred to Arbitration within 30 days after the expiration of amicable
settlement period.
45.3 In case of arbitration, the arbitration shall be conducted in accordance with the
arbitration procedures published by the Nepal Council of Arbitration
(NEPCA) at the place given in the SCC.
Table of Clauses
1. Definitions………………………………………….………………………………..2
5. Law and Language……………………………………………………..……2
7. Scope of Facilities.....................................................................................................
8. Time for Commencement and Completion………………………………………….
9. Contractor’s Responsibility…………………………………………………………..2
11. Contract Price…………………………………………………………………………3
13. Securities ………………………………………………………………………………………3
14. Taxes and Duties………………………………………………………………………..……..3
15. Licenses / Use of Technical Information…………………….…………………….…..……..5
19. Subcontracting…….……………………………………………….……………….…..……..5
20. Design and Engineering………………………….……………………………..….…..……...5
21. Procurement……………………………………………………………………..….…..……...6
22. Installation………………………………………………………………………..….…….…...6
23. Tests and Inspections………………………………………………………………………….8
24. Completion of Facilities…………………………………………………………………….…9
25. Commissioning and Operational Acceptance……………………………………………….9
26. Completion Time Guarantee…………………………………………………………………9
27. Defect Liability………………………………………………………………………………..
31. Transfer of Ownership………………………………………………………………………10
32. Care of Facilities……………………………………………………………………………..10
33. Loss of Damage………………………………………………………………………………10
34. Insurance……………………………………………………………………………………..10
36. Change in Laws and Regulations………………………………………………………...…10
37. Force Majeure………………………………………………………………………………..10
39. Change in the Facilities…………………………………………………………………...…10
40. Extension of Time for Completion………………………………………………………….11
41. Suspension……………………………………………………………………………………11
45. Dispute and Arbitration……………………………………………………………………..11
46. Construction of the Contract Document…………………………………………………....11
7.Scope of Facilities 7.3 The Contractor shall ensure the availability of spare parts for the supplied
items for a minimum period of five (5) years from the operational
acceptance by the Employer.
8.Time for 8.1 The Contractor shall commence work on the Facilities within 15 days
Commencement and from the Effective Date for determining Time for Completion as specified
Completion in the Contract Agreement.
8.2 The Time for Completion of the whole of the Facilities shall be 24
months from the Effective Date as described in the Contract Agreement.
The Employer warrants that neither the data nor the information supplied in the
Bidding Document regarding the soil and general conditions on the site show the
complete range of conditions which may be encountered on the Site.
10. Employer’s
Responsibilities The Contractor shall be deemed to have inspected and examined the Site and
made such investigation as he considered necessary before submitting his bid.
11.Contract Price 11.2 The Contract Price will not be adjusted, this is firm price contract.
13. Securities 13.3.1 The Contractor shall deliver the Performance Security of amount as
per ITB 41.1, ITB 36.5 (if any others) of Bidding Document to the
Employer within fifteen (15) days after receiving the Letter of Acceptance,
and shall, send a copy to the Employer. The Performance Security shall be
denominated in the types and proportions of currencies in which the
Contract Price is payable. The Contractor shall notify the Project Manager
when providing the Performance Security to the Employer.
13.3.2 The performance security shall be in the form of the Bank Guarantee
(Unconditional) attached hereto in Section IX, Contract Forms. The
Performance Security shall be issued by registered Commercial Bank or
Financial Institution eligible to issue Bank Guarantee as per prevailing Law
in Nepal, or a foreign bank counter guaranteed by Commercial Bank or
Financial Institution eligible to issue Bank Guarantee as per prevailing Law
in Nepal. The performance security as required by the clause 13.3.1 above,
shall be valid for period covering entire contract execution period and any
extension thereof, defect liability period plus one month.
13.3.3 The performance security shall not be reduced on the date of the
Operational Acceptance.
13.3.4 Add the following new Sub-Clause:
“In case of award of the Contract to a Joint Venture, the performance
security shall be submitted in the name of the Joint Venture and not in the
name of the Lead Partner or any Partner(s) of the Joint Venture alone”
13.3.5 Add the following new Sub-Clause:
The Bidder shall offer the warranty for 10 years for all the OLTC installed
as per this Contract from the date of commissioning of the works. To cover
the warranty the Contractor shall issue a separate Bank Guarantee to the
Employer with the sum amount of 7% of the total quoted price (CIP) of
each Power Transformer before obtaining the Operational Acceptance
Certificate (as per GCC 25.3). The Employer shall issue the Operational
Acceptance Certificate only after this Bank Guarantee is submitted by the
Contractor as the guarantee is mandatory for Operational handover from
Contractor to the Employer. The Guarantee shall be in the format
acceptable to the Employer and shall be issued by any registered "A" class
commercial Bank in Nepal, or a foreign bank counter guaranteed by any
registered "A" class commercial Bank in Nepal. The Project Manager
reserves right to forfeit the performance security guarantee (prepared as per
clause 40.1 of ITB) if no separate guarantee for OLTC is provided by the
Contractor as stated above
15.Licenses / Use of Add the following second paragraph under Sub-clause 15.2.
Technical Information The Employer shall however shall have the right to reproduce any or all
drawings, documents and other materials furnished to the Employer for the
purpose of the Contract and in addition, if required, for operation and
maintenance.
17. Representatives 17.2.4 Add the following at the end of this Sub- Clause
The application of permission of leaving the site/Country by the
Construction Manager shall be submitted to Project Manager, NEA for
approval.
19.Subcontracting Add the following paragraph at the end of this sub Clause
“The Contactor is not encouraged to add or the delete the list finalized
during the contract signing unless special circumstance which is not in the
control of the contractor is evidenced. If such situation arise, the
qualification requirement of the manufacturer of the major items and sub-
contractor of the major civil work, shall be as that stipulated in “Part I,
“Evaluation and Qualification Requirement” of the bidding document.
20.Design and 20.1.1 Add the following paragraph at the end of this sub Clause
Engineering The Contractor shall provide detail condition and specification or parameters
taken under consideration for design of the transmission line and substation
and its cost shall be deemed to be included in the contract price”
20.1.2 Delete this sub clause.
20.3.2 Change “14 days” to 21 days in both paragraph of this sub clauses.
22.Installation 22.1.1 Add the following at the end of the second paragraph:
The checking of any setting-out by the Employer shall not relieve the
Contractor of his responsibility for the accuracy thereof.
22.1.3 Add the following Sub Clause:
Expatriate personnel engaged for work in Nepal may require work
permit issued by the Nepalese Authorities. The Contractor shall be
responsible for applying and obtaining such permits. Such applications
shall be made in good time so as to enable the completion of the work
in accordance with the approved Work Program. The Employer will
assist the Contractor to obtain the permit.
22.2 Labor
22.2.5 Working Hours
(a) Normal working hours are :The Contractor shall be responsible for
following the normal working hours to specific location and rules
22.2.7 Health and Safety
(d) The Contractor shall throughout the contract (including the Defect
Liability Period):
(i) conduct Information, Education and Consultation Communication (IEC)
campaigns, at least every other month, addressed to all the Site staff and
labor (including all the Contractor's employees, all Sub-Contractors and
Employer’s and Project Manager’s employees, and all truck drivers and
crew making deliveries to Site for construction activities) and to the
immediate local communities, concerning the risks, dangers and impact,
and appropriate avoidance behaviour with respect to of Sexually
Transmitted Diseases (STD)—or Sexually Transmitted Infections (STI)
in general and HIV/AIDS in particular;
(ii) provide male or female condoms for all Site staff and labor as
appropriate; and
(iii) Provide for STI and HIV/AIDS screening, diagnosis, counselling and
referral to a dedicated national STI and HIV/AIDS program, (unless
otherwise agreed) of all Site staff and labor.
The Contractor shall include in the program to be submitted for the
23.Tests and Inspections 23.2 Add the following at the end of this Sub-Clause:
The Employer and the Project Manager or their designated
representatives shall be entitled to attend at his own cost to witness the
tests for all the equipments as specified in the Section 5- Employers
Requirements (Technical Specifications) at Manufacturer’s/Contractor's
factory.
23.3 Supplementing Sub Clause 23.3
The Contractor shall intimate the Project Manager the detailed program
about the tests and/or inspection and of the place and time thereof at
least fifteen (15) days in advance in case of domestic supplies & thirty
(30) days in advance in case of foreign supplies.
23.4 Supplementing Sub-Clause GC 23.4
The Contractor shall provide the Project Manager with a certified report
of the results of any such test and/or inspection within fifteen (15) days
after completion of tests"
23.6 Add the following at the end of this Sub-Clause:
All costs incurred by the Employer including all travelling and board
and lodging expenses by the repetition of the tests or false call for tests
shall be borne by the Contractor pursuant to GCC Sub-Clause 23.2. Any
delay in delivery due to retest or false call shall not constitute a release
of the Contractor from his responsibilities for delay.
23.12 Add the following sub clause
Type Test
The Bidders shall have to furnish copies of type test certificate of all the
equipment/material supplied against this specification for the tests
carried out during last ten years. If the successful bidder fails to submit
the type test reports, type test would be conducted by the contractor in
the presence of authorized representative of the Employer at no
additional cost implications to the Employer.
23.13 Add the following sub clause
Routine Tests
These tests would be conducted on raw materials and other finished
materials in accordance with provisions of internationally accepted
Standards. Proper record of all Routine tests has to be maintained and
made available to the Employer on demand.
24.Completion of 24.2 Add the following paragraph at the end of this clause:
Facilities If Appendix to the Contract Agreement titled “Scope of Works and
Supply by the Employer “ does not specify the personnel and other
necessary materials required for the Pre-commissioning the facilities,
the supply and management of same shall be the responsibility of the
Contractor. The Contractor is responsible for providing the Pre-
commissioning training to the NEA staffs if so requested by NEA and
the cost for the same shall be deemed to have been included in the Price
Schedule. The maximum number of NEA, Staffs to receive the pre-
commissioning training from the contractor shall be 10 (ten).
24.8 Delete this Sub-Clause in its entirety and replace by the following:
The issue of the completion certificate does not relieve the Contractor
from his responsibilities for the care and custody of the Facilities or the
relevant parts thereof together with the risk of loss or damage thereto.
25.Commissioning and 25.1.2 Add "if so specified in corresponding Appendix (Scope of Works and
Operational Acceptance Supply by the Employer)" at the end of the paragraph.
25.2.2 The Guarantee Test of the Facilities shall be successfully completed
within 7 days from the date of Completion.
25.3.1(e) Add the following new Sub-Clause:
Six (6) sets of as built drawings, operating and maintenance manuals
and CD's, USB drives etc. as per Technical Specifications of the
Bidding Documents are furnished.
25.3.3 Change "seven (7) days" to "twenty one (21) days"
25.3.4 Change "seven (7) days" to "twenty one (21) days"
26.Completion Time 26.2 Applicable rate for liquidated damages: 0.05% of Contract Price per day
Guarantee of delay. Maximum deduction for liquidated damages: 10% of Contract
Price
26.3 No bonus will be given for earlier Completion of the Facilities or part
thereof.
27.Defect Liability 27.2 Delete first paragraph of the Sub-Clause and replace with the
following:
The Defect Liability period shall be twelve (12) months from the date of
Operational Acceptance.
27.8 Add the following paragraph at the end of this Sub-Clause: Upon
correction of the defects in the Facilities or any part thereof by
repair/replacement, such repair/replacement shall have the Defect
Liability Period extended by a period of twelve (12) months from the
time such repair/replacement of the Facilities or any part thereof.
27.9 Change “Completion" in line 5 of the Sub Clause to "Operational
Acceptance"
27.10 The critical components covered under the extended defect liability
are transmission line towers and power transformers, the period
shall be 2 years.
30. Limitation of 30.1 (b) The multiplier of the Contract Price is: One
Liability
31. Transfer of 31.1 Add "and upon endorsement of the dispatch documents in favor of the
Ownership Employer." at the end of this Sub-Clause.
31.5 In the 4th line, replace "Completion of the Facilities" by "Operational
Acceptance of the Facilities".
33. Loss of Damage 33.1 Add "and defective design, material or workmanship of the contractor"
after "the supply and installation of the Facilities".
34. Insurance 34.1(c) Add “including property of the Employer” after the word “property”.
36. Change in Laws and 36.1 Add the following after " obligation under the Contract." in this Sub-
Regulations Clause:
However, these adjustments would be restricted to direct transactions
between the Employer and the Contractor and not on procurement of raw
materials, intermediary components, etc. by the Contractor.
37. Force Majeure 37.6 Replace "either party may terminate." in line 5-7 by "the dispute will be
resolved in accordance with GC Clause 45." in this Sub-Clause.
37.7 Delete this Sub-Clause in its entirety.
39. Change in the 39.1.2 Interchange the words “Employer” and “Project Manager” in lines 2
Facilities and 3 in this Sub-Clause.
39.2.2 Delete this Sub-Clause in its entirety and replace with the following:
“Upon instruction from the Project Manager, the Contractor shall
prepare the ‘Change Proposal’ without any cost to the Employer”.
39.2.5 Replace "shall withdraw the proposed Change and shall notify the
Contractor in writing thereof." at the end of the first paragraph by "and
the Contractor shall agree on specific rates for valuation of the Change."
in this Sub-Clause.
39.4 Add this new Sub-Clause as follows:
The scope of work under the package shall be as per the Volume -II
“Employer’s Requirement” of Bidding Documents. The quantity
variation applicable for the existing scope shall be generally as per the
following.
The Employer reserves the right to increase or decrease the quantity of
different items of the specified goods and services to the extent of
fifteen percent (15%) of the revised contract price pursuant to the GC
Clause 11.1, by way of suitable amendment to the Contract, without any
change in unit rate/price and/or other terms and conditions of the
Contract. However, the quantities of individual items of goods and
services may vary up to any extent.
40. Extension of Time for 40.2 Delete “as soon as reasonably practicable …… circumstance.” and
Completion replace with “within 21 days of the identification of the event of such
change known to the Contractor”.
41. Suspension 41.1 Replace “request” by “instruct” in the line 1 of the first Paragraph.
41.5 Add this new Sub-Clause as follows:
If the Contractor chooses not to treat prolonged suspension as an
omission or termination, the Employer shall, upon request of the
Contractor, take over the responsibility for protection, storage, security
and insurance of the suspended work and of the plant which has been
delivered to the Site and which is affected by suspension and the risk of
loss or damage thereto shall thereupon pass to the Employer. After receipt
of permission or an order to proceed, the Contractor shall after due notice
to the Project Manager examine the works and the Plant affected by the
suspension. The Contractor shall make good any deterioration or defect in
or loss of the Facilities that may have occurred during the suspension.
Cost properly incurred by the Contractor, which would not have incurred
but for the suspension shall be added to the Contract Price together with
profit. The Contractor shall not be entitled for costs incurred in making
good any deterioration, defect, or loss caused by faulty workmanship or
materials or by the Contractor’s failure to take the measures such as
protect and secure and insure against any deterioration, loss or damage
during suspension.
42. Termination 42.4 (h) The maximum number of days is: 200
45.Disputes and 45.3 The place of arbitration shall be: Kathmandu, Nepal
Arbitration
Add this new Clause SCC 46.1 The Contract will be signed in three (3) originals and the Contractor shall
46(Supplementing to be provided with one signed original and the other will be retained by the
GCC) Employer.
Construction of the 46.2 The Contractor shall provide free of cost to the Employer all the
Contract Document engineering data, drawing and descriptive materials submitted with the
bid, in at least three (3) copies to form a part of the Contract immediately
after Notification of Award.
46.3 Subsequent to signing of the Contract, the Contractor at his own cost shall
provide the Employer with at least six (6) true copies of Contract
Agreement within thirty (30) days after signing of the Contract.
Table of Forms
Appendix 5 List of Major Items of Plant and Services and List of Approved Subcontractors ...................... 26
Letter of Intent
[on letterhead paper of the Employer]
. . . . . . . date. . . . . . .
This is to notify you that, it is our intention to award the contract ………. dated …….…….. for execution
of the . . . . . . . . .name of the contract and identification number, as given in the Contract Data/SCC to
you as your bid price . . . . . . . . .amount in figures and words in Nepalese Rupees/US$ ………………. as
corrected and modified in accordance with the Instructions to Bidders is hereby selected as substantially
responsive lowest evaluated bid.
CC:
[Insert name and address of all other Bidders, who submitted the bid]
Letter of Acceptance
[on letterhead paper of the Employer]
. . . . . . . date. . . . . . .
This is to notify that your Bid dated . . . . date . . . . for execution of the . . . . . . . . . .name of the contract
and identification number, as given in the Contract Data/SCC . . . . . . . . . . for the Contract price of the
equivalent of [amount in figures and words in the currency…….………….], as corrected in accordance
with the Instructions to Bidders is hereby accepted by our Agency..
You are hereby instructed to contact this office to sign the formal contract agreement within 15 days. As per
the Conditions of Contract, you are also required to submit Performance Security, as specified in SCC,
consisting of a Bank Guarantee in the format included in Section 9 (Contract Forms) of the Bidding
Document.
The Employer shall forfeit the bid security, in case you fail to furnish the Performance Security and to sign
the contract within specified period.
Contract Agreement
reimburse the Contractor are given in the Appendix (Terms and Procedures of
Payment) hereto.
Article 3. Effective Date 3.1 Effective Date (Reference GC Clause 1)
The Effective Date from which the Time for Completion of the Facilities shall
be counted is the date when all of the following conditions have been fulfilled:
(a) This Contract Agreement has been duly executed for and on behalf of
the Employer and the Contractor;
(b) The Contractor has submitted to the Employer the performance security
and the advance payment guarantee;
(c) The Employer has paid the Contractor the advance payment.
Each party shall use its best efforts to fulfill the above conditions for which it
is responsible as soon as practicable.
The Time of Completion of the Facilities shall be determined from the date of
advance payment or after forty-five (45) days from the signing of the
Contract, whichever is earlier. The day on which the Employer sends payment
recommendation to the Bank shall be considered the date of payment.
3.2 If the conditions listed in article 3.1 above, are not fulfilled within two (2)
months from the date of this Contract notification because of reasons not
attributable to the Contractor, the Parties shall discuss and agree on an
equitable adjustment to the Contract Price and the Time for Completion
and/or other relevant conditions of the Contract.
Article 4. 4.1 The address of the Employer for notice purposes, pursuant to GC 4.1 is:
Communications Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project;
Grid Development Department,
Transmission Directorate,
Nepal Electricity Authority
Kharipati, Bhaktapur
Tel.: +977 1 6616697
Fax: +977 1 6616697
Email: loharpatti132kv@nea.org.np
4.2 The address of the Contractor for notice purposes, pursuant to GC 4.1 is:
________________________.
Article 5. Appendices 5.1 The Appendices listed in the attached List of Appendices shall be deemed to
form an integral part of this Contract Agreement.
5.2 Reference in the Contract to any Appendix shall mean the Appendices attached
hereto, and the Contract shall be read and construed accordingly.
IN WITNESS WHEREOF the Employer and the Contractor have caused this Agreement to be duly executed by
their duly authorized representatives the day and year first above written.
[Signature]
[Title]
in the presence of
[Signature]
[Title]
in the presence of
APPENDICES
Appendix 1 Term and Procedures of Payment
Appendix 2 Price Adjustment
Appendix 3 Insurance Requirements
Appendix 4 Time Schedule
Appendix 5 List of Major Items of Plant and Installation Services and List of Approved Subcontractors
Appendix 6 Scope of Works and Supply by the Employer
Appendix 7 List of Documents for Approval or Review
Appendix 8 Functional Guarantees
Appendix -1
Terms and Procedures of Payment
In accordance with the provisions of GCC Clause 12 (Terms of Payment), the Employer shall pay the Contractor in
the following manner and at the following times, based on the Price Breakdown given in the section on Price
Schedules. Payments will be made in the currencies quoted by the Bidder unless otherwise agreed between the
parties. Applications for payment in respect of part deliveries may be made by the Contractor as work proceeds.
Ten percent (10%) of the total CIP amount as an advance payment against receipt of invoice and an
irrevocable advance payment security for the equivalent amount made out in favor of the Employer. The
advance payment security may be reduced in proportion to the value of the plant and mandatory spare
parts delivered to the site, as evidenced by shipping and delivery documents.
Forty Percent (40%) of the total or pro rata CIP amount upon Incoterms “CIP”, upon delivery to the carrier
within forty-five (45) days after receipt of following invoice and documents through irrevocable letter of
credit (LC) opened in favor of Contractor’s bank:
i) 6 copies of contractor’s invoice certified by the Employer showing contract no. goods
description, quantity, unit price and total amount.
ii) Payment Authorization as per the specified format duly signed by the authorized official.
iii) Original and 6 copies of negotiable, clean, on-board bill of lading marked freight prepaid
and 6 copies of non-negotiable bill of lading.
iv) 6 copies of Detailed Packing list identify contents of each package.
v) Insurance Policy/Certificate.
vi) Manufacturer’s / supplier’s warranty certificate.
vii) Dispatch authorization issued by the employer with the factory inspection report.
viii) Certificate of origin.
Thirty percent (30%) of the total or pro rata CIP or amount upon Incoterms “CIP,” upon delivery of plant
and equipment (including mandatory spare parts) to the Site and issuance of delivery certificate by the
Employer's engineer within forty five (45) days after receipt of invoice through irrevocable letter of credit
opened in favor of Contractor’s bank.
Fifteen percent (15%) of the total or pro rata CIP or amount upon issue of the Completion Certificate,
within 45 days after receipt of invoice.
Five percent (5%) of the total or pro rata CIP or amount upon completion of defect liability period, within
45 days after receipt of invoice.
Schedule No. 2 - Plant (including Mandatory Spare Parts) Supplied from within Employer's
country
Ten percent (10%) of the total EXW amount as an advance payment against receipt of invoice, and an
irrevocable advance payment security for the equivalent amount made out in favor of the Employer. The
advance payment security may be reduced in proportion to the value of the plant and equipment
including mandatory spare parts shall be delivered to the site, as evidenced by shipping and delivery
documents.
Seventy percent (70%) of the total or pro rata EXW amount upon Incoterms “Ex-Works,” upon delivery of
plant and equipment (including mandatory spare parts) to the site and issuance of delivery certificate by
the Employer within forty five (45) days after receipt of invoice through direct payment.
Fifteen percent (15%) of the total or pro rata EXW amount upon issuance of the Completion Certificate,
within 45 days after receipt of invoice.
Five percent (5%) of the total or pro rata EXW amount upon completion of defect liability period, within 45
days after receipt of invoice.
Ten percent (10%) of the total quoted amount as an advance payment against receipt of invoice, and an
irrevocable advance payment security for the equivalent amount made out in favor of the Employer. The
advance payment security may be reduced in proportion to the value of the plant and mandatory spare
parts delivered to the site, as evidenced by delivery documents.
Eight percent (80%) of the total or pro rata quoted amount upon delivery of goods at site within forty five
(45) days after receipt invoice with Delivery Completion Certificate (DCC) issued by the Employer.
Five percent (5%) of the total or pro rata quoted amount upon issue of the Completion Certificate, within
45 days after receipt of invoice.
Five percent (5%) of the total or pro rata quoted amount upon completion of defect liability period, within
45 days after receipt of invoice.
Note: For the release of final five percent (5%) retention amount in respect of above Schedules; the
Contractor shall submit the documentary evidence of compliance with the taxation requirements of the
Government of Nepal.
(B)Payment Procedures:
The procedures to be followed in applying for certification and making payments shall be as
follows:
The procedures to be followed in applying for certification and making payments are as explained in
above respectiveparas. The Employer shall make payments promptly within forty five (45) days of
submission of an invoice by the Contractor.
Payment of Taxes & duties:
Provisions in GCC 14 shall apply in respect to Taxes & Duties.
Additional Sub-Clause for Submission of Bills for Payment:
i. All Payments for the works in part or full shall be based upon measurements or
otherwise as per the Contract. Immediately after execution of foundation of any
structure or otherwise, but before filling the trench or foundation, the Contractor
shall take and record measurements in presence of the authorized representatives of
the Employer.
ii. All Measurements recorded in a Measurement Book (MB) issued by the Employer
should be signed with date by the Contractor and the Employer.
iii. The Value of work executed shall be determined by the Employer.
iv. The Contractor seeking any payment shall submit the bills with the relevant MBs
and other requisite documents, duly signed by the site representatives of the
Employer, to the Employer. The Employer will then verify the bills and approve
for release of payment.
Note: No interest shall be paid on delayed payment in terms of GCC sub-clause 12.3
Appendix 2
Price Adjustment
(Please refer to Price Bid)
NOT APPLICABLE
Appendix 3
Insurance Requirements
(*) Excess 5% of claimed amount subject to minimum of NRs. 20,000 or its equivalent for Normal and NRs.
80,000 or its equivalent for act of God perils and collapse.
(b) Installation All Risks Insurance
Covering physical loss or damage to the Facilities at the Site, occurring prior to completion of the Facilities, with an
extended maintenance coverage for the Contractor’s liability in respect of any loss or damage occurring during the
defect liability period while the Contractor is on the Site for the purpose of performing its obligations during the
defect liability period.
(*) Excess 5% of claimed amount subject to minimum of NRs. 10,000 or its equivalent for Normal and NRs. 30,000
or its equivalent for testing period.
NRs. 1,000,000 or
its equivalent as in Third Party Commencement of Final Acceptance
(b) above Personnel work
NRs. 1,000,000 or
its equivalent as in Employer’s Commencement of Final Acceptance
(b) above Property work
Appendix 4
Time Schedule
4.1 Description of Facilities: Procurement of Plant Design, Supply, Installation, Testing and Commissioning of
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line and Loharpatti 132/33/11 kV Substation.
Name of Facilities Completion Time Completion date
required by the guaranteed
Employer from the by the bidder from the
Effective Date Effective Date
Appendix 5
List of Major Items of Plant and Services and List of Approved
Subcontractors
Appendix 6
Scope of Works and Supply by the Employer
The following personnel, facilities, works, and supplies will be provided or supplied by the Employer, and the
provisions of GCC Clauses 10, 21, and 24 shall apply as appropriate.
All personnel, facilities, works, and supplies will be provided by the Employer in good time so as not to delay the
performance of the Contractor, in accordance with the approved Time Schedule and Program of Performance
pursuant to GCC Subclause 18.2.
Unless otherwise indicated, all personnel, facilities, works, and supplies will be provided free of charge to the
Contractor.
None
None-except as noted
None
None
Appendix 7
List of Documents for Approval or Review
Pursuant to GC Sub-Clause 20.3.1, the Contractor shall prepare, or cause its Subcontractor to prepare, and present
to the Project Manager in accordance with the requirements of GC Sub-Clause 18.2 (Program of Performance), the
following documents for
A. Approval
As mentioned in the relevant chapter/Section of the Technical Specifications of the Bidding documents and
the following
a. Names of manufacturers
b. Location of factory of manufacture of principal items of equipments
c. Names of subcontractors
d. List of drawings to be submitted for approval
e. Temporary connections and safety
f. Programme of Manufacturer quality plan and inspection, testing procedures and testing methods
g. All kinds of test reports
h. Geographic location of routine Tests
i. Corrosion protection and painting
j. Right of Way clearance details
k. Line route survey and foundation soil investigation
l. Aggregate and grading of aggregates
m. Use of admixtures, concrete mixing, steel reinforcement and formwork
n. Stringing procedures and methods of conductor/OPGW and machine for the works
o. Marking and labeling of equipment
p. Any other documents as desired by the Employer
B. Review:
As mentioned in the relevant chapter/Section of the Technical Specifications of the Bidding documents and
the following
a. Designed and calculation procedures for each component forming part of the Plant
b. All drawings prepared by the Contractor
c. Operations and maintenance instructions
d. Procedure for Test on Completion
e. Protection calculation / recalculation and setting.
f. Any other documents as desired by the Employer
Note:
Bidder shall furnish the exhaustive list, which shall be discussed and finalized for incorporation into the Contract
Agreement.
Appendix 8
Functional Guarantees
Performance Security
We have been informed that . . . . . name of the Contractor. . . . . (hereinafter called "the Contractor") has
entered into Contract No. . . . . . reference number of the Contract. . . . . dated . . . . . . . .with you, for the
execution of . . . . . . name of contract and brief description of Works. . . . . (hereinafter called "the Contract").
Furthermore, we understand that, according to the conditions of the Contract, a performance guarantee is
required.
At the request of the Contractor, we . . . . . name of the Bank. . . . . hereby irrevocably undertake to pay you
any sum or sums not exceeding in total an amount of . . . . . name of the currency and amount in figures*. . . . . . (. .
. . . amount in words. . . . . ) such sum being payable in Nepalese Rupees, upon receipt by us of your first
demand in writing accompanied by a written statement stating that the Contractor is in breach of its
obligation(s) under the Contract, without your needing to prove or to show grounds for your demand or the
sum specified therein.
This guarantee shall expire, no later than the . . . . . Day of . . . . . . . . . . , . . . . . . **, and any demand for
payment under it must be received by us at this office on or before that date.
............................
Seal of Bank and Signature(s)
Note: All italicized text is for guidance on how to prepare this demand guarantee and shall be deleted
from the final document.
* The Guarantor shall insert an amount representing the percentage of the Contract Price specified in
the Contract in Nepalese Rupees.
** Insert the date thirty days after the end of Defect Notification Period. The Employer should note that
in the event of an extension of the time for completion of the Contract, the Employer would need to
request an extension of this guarantee from the Guarantor. Such request must be in writing and must be
made prior to the expiration date established in the guarantee. In preparing this guarantee, the Employer
might consider adding the following text to the form, at the end of the penultimate paragraph: “The
Guarantor agrees to a one-time extension of this guarantee for a period not to exceed [six months], in
response to the Employer’s written request for such extension, such request to be presented to the
Guarantor before the expiry of the guarantee”.
The maximum amount of this guarantee shall be progressively reduced by the amount of the advance
payment repaid by the Contractor as indicated in copies of interim statements or payment certificates which
shall be presented to us. This guarantee shall expire, at the latest, upon our receipt of a copy of the interim
payment certificate indicating that eighty (80) percent of the Contract Price has been certified for payment,
or on the . . . day of . . . . . . . , . . . . .**, whichever is earlier. Consequently, any demand for payment under
this guarantee must be received by us at this office on or before that date.
............................
Seal of Bank and Signature(s)
Note: All italicized text is for guidance on how to prepare this demand guarantee and shall be deleted
from the final document.
* The Guarantor shall insert an amount representing the amount of the advance payment in Nepalese
Rupees of the advance payment as specified in the Contract.
** Insert the date Thirty days after the expected completion date. The Employer should note that in the
event of an extension of the time for completion of the Contract, the Employer would need to request an
extension of this guarantee from the Guarantor. Such request must be in writing and must be made prior
to the expiration date established in the guarantee. In preparing this guarantee, the Employer might
consider adding the following text to the form, at the end of the penultimate paragraph: “The Guarantor
agrees to a one-time extension of this guarantee for a period not to exceed [six months], in response to the
Employer’s written request for such extension, such request to be presented to the Guarantor before the
expiry of the guarantee”
Bidding Document
for
Procurement of Plant for Design, Supply, Installation, Testing and
Commissioning of Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line and
Loharpatti 132/33/11 kV Substation
VOLUME II OF III
December, 2019
PART II REQUIREMENTS
SECTION 5 - WORKS REQUIREMENTS (WRQ)
(Scope of Supply of Plant and Services, Specifications, Drawings
and Supplementary Information)
Drawings
CHAPTER – 1
PROJECT SPECIFIC REQUIREMENT
1 General
Government of Nepal and Nepal Electricity Authority intend to construct about 20 km 132
kV double circuit transmission line with CARDINAL conductor from existing Dhalkebar
substation to Loharpatti, two numbers of 132 kV bay extensions at Dhalkebar and a new
132/33/11 kV substation at Loharpatti under Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission
Line Project.
2 Intent of the Specifications
This part of the specification is intended to cover the design, engineering, manufacture,
inspection and testing, packaging, forwarding to site, unloading, erection, testing,
commissioning, performance testing and handing over of all associated ancillaries and
auxiliaries.
This specification shall be read and construed in conjunction with the drawings and
annexure to determine the scope of work and terminal points. The quantities shown on
drawings and annexure are indicative. Any variation arising during detailed engineering
stage will be taken into account by the Bidder without any extra cost and time to the
Employer.
Bidder shall be responsible for providing all material, equipment and services, specified or
otherwise which are required to complete the scope and fulfill the intent of ensuring
efficiency, operability, maintainability and the reliability of the complete work covered
under this specification. It is not the intent to specify completely herein, all aspects of design
and construction of equipment. Nevertheless, the equipment shall conform in all respects to
high standards of engineering, design and workmanship and shall be capable of performing
continuous commercial operation, in a manner acceptable to Employer, who will interpret
the meaning of the specification, drawings, requirements of operation, maintenance
redundancy etc. and shall have a right to reject or accept any work or material which in his
assessment is not complete to meet the requirements of this specification and/or applicable
International standards mentioned elsewhere in the specification.
Bidder is requested to carefully examine and understand the specifications and seek
clarifications, if required, to ensure that they have understood the specifications. The
bidder's offer should clearly bring out the technical deviation and commercial deviation (If
any) that the Bidder is taking. No other clarification, interpretation and assumption shall be
considered for evaluation. In the event of conflict between the requirements of any two
clauses of this specification or requirements of different codes/standards, the more stringent
requirement shall govern, unless confirmed otherwise by the Employer in writing before the
award of this contract, based on a written request from the bidder for such a clarification.
However, if the bidder feels that, in his opinion, certain features brought out in his offer are
superior to what has been specified, these may be highlighted separately.
Bidder may also make alternate offers provided such offers are superior in his opinion, in
which case, adequate technical information, operating feedback data, etc. shall be enclosed
with the offer, to enable the Employer to assess the superiority and reliability of the
alternatives offered. In case of each alternate offer, its implications on the performance,
guaranteed efficiency etc, shall be clearly brought out for the Employer to make an overall
assessment. In any case, the base offer shall necessarily be in line with the specifications.
Whenever a material or article is specified or described by the name of a particular brand,
manufacturer or trade mark, the specific items shall be understood as established type/make,
meets functional requirement and of required quality. Other manufacturer’s products may
also be considered provided sufficient information is furnished so as to enable the Employer
to determine that the products are proven and equivalent or superior to those named.
3 Scope of Works
The scope of works covering design, engineering, procurement, inspection & testing at
manufacturer’s works, supply, insurance, receipt at site, storage and preservation at site, site
transportation, construction, erection, commissioning, trial operation, handing over to
Employer, guarantee all equipment, spares and material, catalogues, drawings, documents
and services including lubricants, transformer oil, consumables for the proposed 132/33/11
kV substation at Loharpatti, bay extensions at Dhalkebar and 132 kV transmission line from
Dhalkebar to Loharpatti of all mechanical, electrical and civil, structural & architectural
works on turnkey basis.
The Contractor shall be fully responsible for supply, installation, testing and
commissioning of Substation Automation system, necessary for complete operation with the
NEA SCADA system. Fiber Optic based communication system to be supplied under this
Contract shall be compatible with the existing ones and the Contractor shall be fully
responsible for complete interfacing between the existing and the new system. The
interfacing works include the integration of the relevant data (associated with the scope of
this work) into the SINAUT Spectrum of the Load Dispatch Center by necessary
addition/modification and parameterization.
The scope of work shall include but not limited to the following:
Detailed survey and check survey including route alignment and profiling, right of way
identification and clearance, tower spotting, optimization of tower locations, soil resistivity
measurement, geotechnical investigation.
Complete engineering services for the project including basic & detailed engineering, design
philosophy, operation philosophy, submission of technical parameters, characteristic curves,
capability curves, etc of equipment and material for Employer’s approval.
Prototype testing of towers at manufacturing plant of the Contractor.
Any study through which the capacity and rating of equipment offered shall be proved for
the main & on analysis of site location and attitude.
Submission of manuals, engineering & construction drawings, design basis reports,
optimization study reports, design calculations, quality assurance plans, testing procedures,
operation and maintenance manuals, commissioning procedures, etc.
Obtaining of any consents, licenses and approvals from relevant statutory authorities, other
than those obtained by the Employer and required as per law. The scope of Bidder also
covers extending necessary assistance wherever logically required to enable Employer to
obtain the requisite approval.
Quality assurance of all work related to scope of work of the Bidder.
Submission of schedule of work from zero date to handing over to Employer complete plant
and equipment in the form of chart, ‘S’-curve; write up etc for Employer’s approval.
Submission of monthly progress reports, photographs, graphs etc for engineering, supply,
construction and commissioning for all major works with suggestions and plans for making
up back log if any for review of Employer. To attend meetings, review, discussion etc for
resolving all issues.
Submission of shipping schedule of equipment and material from country of origin up to
receipt at site for off shore supply and ex-works to site for on-shore supply matching with
schedule of work for approval of Employer.
Manufacture, fabrication, quality control, shop testing of equipments and material after
approval of required technical data and drawings by Employer. To furnish notice to
Employer for inspection.
Packing, forwarding, shipment and transportation (including port handling and custom
clearance) from the manufacturer’s works to site. Comprehensive marine/transit-cum-
storage-cum-erection insurance coverage of all equipment from Nepal Border / ex-works to
project site till the equipment supplied is taken over by Employer. Preservation of all
equipment during transportation till testing and commissioning stage.
Hiring of a suitable storing area which shall be approved by the Employer,
Receipt at site, unloading, movement to proper storage, carriage to storage area / interim /
final foundation location, security, preservation and conservation of equipment at the site.
Erection and construction including supply of construction material and labour complete for
structural and including all temporary enabling works, cabling, testing, start-up, successful
trial operation and performance guarantee testing of the plant as indicated under the
specifications and tender documents.
Performance Guarantee of the plant.
Supply of spares parts.
Supply any other equipment including special tools & tackles, for operation, capital
maintenance
Supply of all manuals covering erection and commissioning, performance testing, operation,
preservation, and capital maintenance including supply of as-built drawings and services
required for satisfactory completion of the project.
Supply of all construction consumables, e.g., welding electrodes, cleaning agents, diesel oil
as well as materials required for temporary supports, scaffolding, storage tanks, illumination
as necessary.
Deployment of all skilled and unskilled manpower required for erection, commissioning,
testing, etc, supervision of erection, commissioning, testing etc for services to be rendered.
Deployment of all erection tools & tackles, adequate number and capacity of cranes,
construction machinery, transportation vehicles, and all other implements in adequate
number, capacity and size. Any other tools, tackles and resources required to complete the
contract with required quality and with the schedule.
Training of Employer’s personnel as specified.
Arrangement of construction power and construction water at site.
Any other activity not listed above but required for safe and trouble free operation of the
substation and transmission line shall be deemed to have been included in the Bidder’s scope.
3.1 Major Equipment and Works
The following list of the major plant items and systems shall be included in the Bidder’s
scope of work. This list is not exhaustive and is without prejudice to the more fundamental
responsibility of the Bidder for completeness of whole works.
3.1.1 132 kV Transmission Line
a) Conductors and Accessories
Line Conductor (ACSR – CARDINAL) and accessories
Optical fibre ground wire (OPGW) and accessories
Insulator, Hardware Fittings and other accessories
b) Tower and Tower Accessories
All types of transmission line towers (total 4 types - DA, DB, DC, DD) including
bolts, nuts and washers, hangers, D-shackles and
All types of tower accessories like phase plate, circuit plate, number plate, danger
plate, anti-climbing device, bird guard, aviation signals, painting of towers etc.
c) Foundations
Classification of foundations for different soil conditions for different type of towers
and casting of foundation for tower footings including stub setting
d) Grounding of each towers
e) Other items not specified above but required to complete the transmission line as per
technical specifications, Bid Forms & Price Schedules.
1. 132 kV bays 06
2. 33 kV bays 04
3. 11 kV bays 1 Lot
The contractor shall also supply necessary BCU for monitoring and control of
auxiliary supply including operation of Isolators associated with Auxiliary
transformer.
l) For proposed 132 kV Dhalkebar Loharpatti D/C Lines, Digital Protection Coupler (2
Nos. at each end, i.e. 2 Nos. at Dhalkebar and 2 Nos. at Loharpatti) shall be used for
protection application. Each DPC shall be equipped with 4 commands. The above DPC shall
have communication port matching to that being provided in the FO communication SDH
panel and all accessories, cabling etc .required to interface with SDH telecommunication
terminal equipment (located in the Control Room) for its commissioning is in present scope
of Project. 48 volt power supply cable, Control Cable from DPC to relay panel shall be laid
as per location of DPC panel. The specification for the digital protection coupler shall be as
per Annexure I.
m) Telecommunication Equipments shall be installed at Dhalkebar and Loharpatti
Substations.
n) Air Conditioning System
o) LT switchgear (AC/DC Distribution boards).
p) Batteries & Battery Chargers
q) 600 V grade Power & Control cables along with complete accessories. Auxiliary
Power supply and control cables from control room / switchyard panel room and RTCC
panel to common marshalling box of transformer/reactor are also in present scope of work.
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two envelope
Chapter 1 - Project Specific Requirement Page 1-6
Deviation
Tower Type Typical Use
Angle
Altitude up to
1,000 m
DB 2 deg.-15 deg a) Tension Tower with Angle deviation from 2 to
15 deg.
b) Section tower
c) To be designed for anti- cascading condition.
DC 15 deg.-30 deg a) Tension Tower with Angle deviation from 15
to 30 deg
b) Tension tower for uplift forces resulting from a
uplift span as per weight span specified in
Schedule-A4, Section-10.
c) To be designed for anti-cascading condition.
DD/DDE 30 deg.-60 deg a) Tension tower Angle deviation from 30 to 60
deg.
b) Tension towers for uplift forces resulting from
an uplift spam as per weight span specified in
Schedule-A4, Section-10.
c) Complete Dead end with 0 to 15 deg
deviation on both sides.
d) For river crossing anchoring with longer wind
span with 0 deg deviation on crossing span
side and 0 to 30 deg deviations on other
side.
Towers for altitude up to 1,000 m shall be designed based on the requirement BIL and
Ground Clearances applicable up to altitude of 1,000 m.
5 Insulators
Composite long rod insulator made of HT-Silicon Rubber shall be used for 132 kV
transmission line.
The bidder shall offer composite long rod insulators of suitable core diameter to meet
specified Electro Mechanical strength requirements of 90 kN for suspension string and
160 kN for tension string. Bidder shall submit the overall string length and other details
with the Bid.
6 Ground Clearances
In view of the above, ground clearances for 132 kV transmissions line shall be as mentioned below.
7 Site Survey
The information in this section is given solely for the general assistance to Bidders. No
responsibility for it will be accepted, nor will any claim based on this Clause be considered.
The Bidder is advised to survey the sites covered under this Contract to acquaint himself
with site conditions. The Contractor shall be responsible for surveying; detailed check survey,
geo technical investigation including measurement of soil resistivity at the precise locations as
required for foundation and other design of the substation.
The Contractor shall locate, and record on the construction drawings, all interfacing utility lines
or other obstructions. Damage to existing installations shall be repaired by the Contractor at his
expense.
Contractor shall make the arrangement of water and power supply for construction work.
b) General guidance to the Contractor for all negotiations with the Authorities in Nepal
The Contractor shall agree to make no claim for anticipated profits or for alleged losses
because of any difference between the quantities actually furnished and installed and the
estimated quantities after the detailed and check survey and approve by the Employer.
In the course of detail survey, tower staking; installation of special tower (other than the
tower type specified in the schedule) or modification on the cross-arm may be found
necessary. In such case the Contractor shall conduct design related works without any
additional cost to the Employer. Payment for the special tower and the modified cross-arm
will be made at the unit rate of the tower material (weight) used.
10 Expected Life Cycle
Life expectancy of the following items shall be as given below:
Long rod insulator: min. 20 years
Optical terminal equipment: min. 10 years
The Contractor shall submit certificate from independent laboratory for the life expectancy
above material equipment or the manufacturer shall provide any other reliable document to
prove the life expectancy.
hours after notification by the Employer to do so, the Employer reserves the right to perform
the work and the cost thereof will be deducted from payment due to the Contractor.
d) The Contractor shall be responsible for the arrangement of electricity supply for
construction and any other purposes at his own cost.
e) The complete design (unless specified otherwise in specification elsewhere) and detailed
engineering shall be done by the Contractor based on conceptual tender drawings. Drawings
enclosed with tender drawings are for information only. Drawings shall be developed by the
contractor as per his design and has to be approved by the project office.
f) The Contractor shall be responsible to select and verify the route, mode of transportation and
make all necessary arrangement with the appropriate authorities for the transportation of the
equipment. The dimension of the equipment shall be such that when packed for
transportation, it will comply with the requirements of loading and clearance restrictions for
the selected route. It shall be the responsibility of the contractor to coordinate the
arrangement for transportation of the Transformers for all the stages from the
manufacturer’s work to site.
g) The conditions of roads, capacity of bridges, culverts etc. in the route shall also be assessed
by the bidders. The scope of any necessary modification/extension/ improvement to existing
road, bridges, culverts etc. shall be included in the scope of the bidder. The contractor shall
carry out the route survey along with the transporter and submit the detail proposal and
methodology for transportation of transformers for approval of Employer within three
months from the date of award.
h) The Contractor shall also be responsible for the overall co-ordination with
internal/external agencies; project management, training of Owner’s manpower, loading,
unloading, handling, moving to final destination for successful erection, testing and
commissioning of the substation/switchyard.
i) Design of substation and its associated electrical & mechanical auxiliaries systems includes
preparation of single line diagrams and electrical layouts including layout arrangement for
foundation layout, cable trench layout, earth mat layout, erection key diagrams, electrical
and physical clearance diagrams, design calculations for earthing and lightening protection
system (including Direct Stroke Lighting Protection), control and protection schematics,
wiring and termination schedules, civil designs (as applicable) and drawings, air
conditioning system, indoor/outdoor lighting/illumination and other relevant drawings &
documents required for engineering of all facilities within the fencing to be provided under
this contract, are covered under the scope of the Contractor.
j) Any other items not specifically mentioned in the specification but which are required for
erection, testing and commissioning and satisfactory operation of the substation are deemed
to be included in the scope of the specification unless specifically excluded.
k) Employer has standardized its technical specification for various equipments and works for
different voltage levels. Items, which are not applicable for the scope of this package as per
schedule of quantities described in Schedules of Rate sand Prices, the technical specification
for such items should not be referred to.
l) The Quantities listed in the Schedule of Prices represent the estimated quantities for
Tender purpose only. The Contractor shall carryout detail design and shall submit final bill
of quantity for approval within 120 days from the signing of contract or 60 days after
effective date of contract. The actually required quantity may vary from the quantity as
listed in price schedule. The Contractor shall agree to make no claim for anticipated profits
or for alleged losses because of any difference between the quantities actually
furnished and installed and the estimated quantities as indicated in the price schedule at the
original quoted unit prices within the total price variations limit of +/- 15% as per the tender
conditions.
13.3 The fault level of all equipment to be supplied under present scope shall be as indicated
below:
3 11 kV 25 kA for 3 Sec
Note :
1. The above parameters are applicable for installations up to an altitude of 1000m above
mean sea level. For altitude exceeding 1000m, necessary altitude correction factor shall
be applicable as per IEC or part thereof. Bidders shall furnish the suitable value after
taking altitude correction factor in Chapter Technical Data Sheet (Guaranteed Technical
Particulars) separately for each items as applicable.
2. The insulation and RIV levels of the equipments shall be as per values given in the
respective chapter of the equipments.
Major technical parameters of bushings / hollow column / support insulators are given
below:
14 SCHEDULE OF QUANTITIES
The requirement of various items/equipments and civil works are indicated in Bid price
Schedules.
All equipments/items and civil works for which bill of quantity has been indicated in BOQ
(Bill of Quantity) shall be payable on unit rate basis/quoted rate basis. During actual
execution, any variation in such quantities shall be payable as per relevant clauses
incorporated in Letter of award.
Wherever the quantities of items/works are indicated in LS/Lot/Set, the bidder is required to
estimate the quantity required for entire execution and completion of works and
incorporate their price in respective Bid price schedules. For erection hardware items,
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two envelope
Chapter 1 - Project Specific Requirement Page 1-15
Bidders shall estimate the total requirement of the works and indicate module-wise lump
sum price bay wise and include the same in relevant Bid price schedules. For module
identification, Bidder may refer typical drawings enclosed with the specifications. Any
material/works for the modules not specifically mentioned in the description in BOQ, as
may be required shall be deemed to be included in the module itself.
The detailed bill of quantities of the mandatory spares is as per BOQ. Bidder should include
all such items in the bid proposal sheets, which are not specifically mentioned but are
essential for the execution of the contract. Item which explicitly may not appear in various
schedules and required for successful commissioning of substation shall be included in the
bid price and shall be provided at no extra cost to Employer.
15.1 Single line diagram and general arrangements drawings are enclosed with the bid
documents for reference, which shall be further engineered by the bidder.
15.2 The reference drawings, which form a part of the specifications, are given at drawings
section. The bidder shall maintain the overall dimensions of the substation, phase to earth
clearance, phase to phase clearance and sectional clearances.
The enclosed drawings give the basic scheme, layout of substation, substation buildings,
associated services etc. In case of any discrepancy between the drawings and text of
specification, the requirements of text shall prevail in general. However, the Bidder is
advised to get these clarified from Employer.
15.3 The auxiliary transformers of rating 1 50 KVA shall be used to feed the substation
auxiliaries.
The 150 KVA, 33/0.4 kV auxiliary transformers shall be located outdoor in a suitable
location. These auxiliary transformers should not be used for construction power supply
purpose. The detailed scheme is shown in the single line diagram.
In case of any discrepancy between Chapter 1- PSR, Chapter 2- GTR and other technical
specifications on scope of works, Chapter 1 - PSR shall prevail over all other chapters.
In case of any discrepancy between Chapter 2- GTR and individual chapters for
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two envelope
Chapter 1 - Project Specific Requirement Page 1-16
17 SPARES
Mandatory Spares
The Mandatory Spares shall be included in the bid proposal by the bidder. The prices of
these spares shall be given by the Bidder in the relevant schedule of BOQ and shall be
considered for evaluation of bid. It shall not be binding on the Employer to procure all of
these mandatory spares.
The bidder is clarified that no mandatory spares shall be used during the commissioning of
the equipment. Any spares required for commissioning purpose shall be arranged by the
Contractor. The unutilized spares if any brought for commissioning purpose shall be taken
back by the contractor.
The bidder shall include in his proposal the supply of all special tools and tackles required
for operation and maintenance of equipment. The special tools and tackles shall only cover
items which are specifically required for the equipment offered and are proprietary in
nature. However a list of all such devices should be indicated in the relevant schedule
provided in the BOQ. In addition to this the Contractor shall also furnish a list of special
tools and tackles for the various equipment in a manner to be referred by the Employer
during the operation of these equipment. The scope of special tools and tackles are to be
decided during detail engineering and the list of special tools and tackles, if any shall be
finalized.
19 SPECIFIC REQUIREMENT
a. The Bidders are advised to visit substation site and line route and acquaint
themselves with existing facilities, the topography, infrastructure, etc.
b. The bidder shall be responsible for safety of human and equipment during the
working. It will be the responsibility of the Contractor to coordinate and obtain Electrical
Inspector's clearance before commissioning. Any additional items, modification due to
observation of such statutory authorities shall be provided by the Contractor at no extra cost
to the Employer.
The Contractor shall arrange all T&P (such as necessary supports, cranes, ladders,
platforms etc.) for erection, testing & commissioning of the system at his own cost.
Further, all consumables, wastage and damages shall be to the account of contractor.
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two envelope
Chapter 1 - Project Specific Requirement Page 1-17
The 132, 33, 11 kV bays under present scope at the substation shall be integrated by the
contractor into existing SCADA system of Siemens ‘SINAUT Spectrum”(version 4.3.2)
installed at Master Station i.e. Nepal Electricity Authority Load Dispatch Centre (located at
Siuchatar, Kathmandu). The integration shall include all hardware and software required at
the Control Centre as well as necessary data base, display generation and upgrades for
proposed control and monitoring of station and Network Analysis. The above activities shall
be carried out as appropriate, in all of the stations viz. The manufacturers of the existing
SCADA system are:-
The details of RTU installed at existing substations and Data acquisition principles (types of
analogue/digital data) for control, monitoring of substation is enclosed at Annexure III.
The existing communication protocol used for SCADA at LDC Kathmandu is IEC 101/104.
For the present scope of work, RTU are not envisaged and the Data for SCADA purpose
shall be obtained from the Substation Automation System (based on IEC 61850) using
Gateway port with communication protocol IEC 101/104 as per requirement being
provided at the substations under present scope of contract.
The scope of work for supply, installation of Optical Line Termination Equipment, Digital
Multiplexer, hardware accessories etc at substations, LDC Katmandu and its integration
work (at LDC Kathmandu) for onward transmission of Data and Voice communication up
to LDC Kathmandu is included in the contract.
e. In Chapter 2 GTR and other Technical specifications, the term “Purchaser” and/or
“Employer” may be read as “Owner”.
The training shall be provided to Employer’s personnel in the field of erection, testing,
operation and maintenance at each substation site as per following:-
h. The civil construction drawing for above shall be developed by the contractor during
detail engineering.
i. For illumination in switchyard panel room average Lux level at ground level shall be 300
lux. The lighting fixtures for switchyard lighting shall be mounted on LMs wherever LMs
are provided. Where LMs are not available, the fixtures may be mounted on Gantry
structures or on lighting poles to be provided by the contractor. All the lighting fixtures, Air
condition, ceiling Fans etc to be installed at substation shall be energy efficient
(low power consumption).
j. The Frequency range for the earthquake spectra shall be as per IEC-62271- 300 for Circuit
Breaker.
k. Transmission line side insulator String (including Hardware) i.e. tension insulator on the line
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two envelope
Chapter 1 - Project Specific Requirement Page 1-19
side of the take off gantry for 132 and 33 KV lines termination is under the present scope of
specification.
l. One number portable fire extinguisher (CO2 type) of 4.5 kg shall be provided for each
switchyard panel room as per Bid proposal sheet (BOQ).
m. The Contractor shall provide AC/DC feeders for complete future bays also as per single line
diagram in addition to bays under present scope.
o. Non CFC refrigerant shall be utilized for Air conditioning system, offered for buildings is
under the scope of contract.
p. The distance protection relays to be supplied for 132 kV lines should have feature of load
encroachment blinder to safeguard the protection trip during heavy load condition.
q. Separate protection relay (IED) shall be provided for 132 kV Class Transformer
directional over current and earth fault relay (for both HV & LV side). Inbuilt function in
any other protection IED/BCU is not acceptable.
r. In the Substation automation system, each AIS shall be monitored individually per phase
basis. In case it is not possible to monitor in one BCU, the contractor shall supply
additional BCU for the monitoring without any additional cost implication to NEA.
s. For supply of SF6 Gas, the contractor shall obtain necessary license from the concerned
statuary authorities in Nepal. The contractor shall comply with all the legal & statuary
requirements as per the local laws for importing, handling & storage of SF6 gas in Nepal.
For this purpose NEA shall extend necessary assistance (documentation etc) for obtaining
such clearance & licenses, however the complete responsibility for submitting the
application and co-ordination with authorities shall be in the scope of contractor.
Annexture –I
1.0 Digital protection coupler for protection signaling through optical fibre cable system.
1.1 The Digital protection signalling equipment is required to transfer the trip commands
from one end of the line to the other end in the shortest possible time with adequate
security and dependability. It shall also monitor the healthiness of the link from one
end to the other and give alarms in case of any abnormality. The protection
signaling equipment shall have a proven operating record in similar application over
EHV systems and shall operate on 48V DC (+10%, -10%). It shall provide minimum
four commands. These commands shall be suitable for direct tripping, Inter tripping
and Blocking protection schemes of EHV lines.
The protection signalling equipment shall communicate to the remote end with
separate optical fibre cores maximum 2 cores. It shall provide suitable interfaces for
protective relays, which operate at 110V DC. Power supply points shall be immune to
electromagnetic interface.
The high speed digital protection signalling equipment shall be designed and provided
Bidder shall quote for protection signalling equipment suitable for 4 commands with
separate trip counters for transmit and receive. With regard to trip counters alternate
arrangement .i.e. Laptop along with software & all accessories to download events
including carrier receipt and transmit shall be acceptable. Laptop for the above shall be
supplied at each substation under substation package.
Reports of the following tests as per clause 9.2 of Chapter 2-GTR shall be submitted for
approval for protection signaling equipment and relays associated with the protection
signaling equipment and interface unit with protective relay units, if any.
a) Security
b) Dependability
c) Jitter
d) Recovery time
e) Transmission time f)
Alarm functions
g) Temperature and Humidity tests (As per IEC 68-2)
- Dry heat test (50°C for 8 hours)
- Low temperature test (-5°C for 8 hours)
- Damp heat test (40°C/95%RH for 8 hours)
All the above tests at i, ii & iii (except temperature & humidity tests) shall be as per
IEC 60834-1 and the standards mentioned therein.
iv) Relays
a) Impulse voltage withstand test as per IEC 60255.
b) High frequency disturbance test as per IEC 60255.
Input: Contact
Rated voltage 250 volts DC
Rating:
Maximum
: current rating 5 amps
Output: Contact
: Rating:
Rated voltage 250 volts DC
:
vi) Alarm contact
Annexure-II
Specification for Revenue Meter & Metering (Instrument) Transformer
1. General
The units shall be suitable for operating in Outdoor environment and shall be
manufactured by International Reputed ISO 9001 Company
2. Energy Meter
ANNEXURE-III
The Load Dispatch Centre (LDC) at Kathmandu controls and monitors the network of
Integrated Nepal Power System (INPS) via RTUs and SAS located at its various substations.
Manufacturers of existing SCADA system are:
LDC facilities: SIEMENS, Germany
RTU facilities: ABB, Germany
1.2 Data acquisition principles for existing Substation
The existing substations are provided with RTU& SAS for interfacing of the following
supervisory controls and data acquisitions:
Remote Control
Remote control of all 132/33kV circuit breakers.
Status indications
Status indications of all 132kV circuit breakers, busbar and line isolators.
The existing communication protocol used for SCADA at LDC Kathmandu is IEC 101. For
the present scope of work no RTU is envisaged and the Data for SCADA purpose shall be
obtained from the Substation Automation System (based on IEC 61850) using Gateway port
with communication protocol IEC 101/104 as per requirement being provided at Nawalpur
Substation under present contract. The details of substation automation systems are included
in the separate chapter Substation Automation.
All 132kV Line feeders and 132kV and 33kV Transformer feeders.
Single phase current measurements for all 33kV lines participating in load shedding Scheme.
CHAPTER-2
1. FOREWORD
1.1 The provisions under this chapter are intended to supplement general technical
requirements (GTR) for the materials, equipments and services covered under other
chapters of tender documents and are not exclusive.
2. GENERAL REQUIREMENT
2.1 The contractor shall furnish catalogues, engineering data, technical information, design
documents, drawings etc., fully in conformity with the technical specification during
detailed engineering.
2.2 It is recognized that the Contractor may have standardized on the use of certain
components, materials, processes or procedures different from those specified herein.
Alternate proposals offering similar equipment based on the manufacturer’s standard
practice will also be considered provided such proposals meet the specified designs,
standard and performance requirements and are acceptable to Employer.
2.3 Equipment furnished shall be complete in every respect with all mountings, fittings,
fixtures and standard accessories normally provided with such equipment and/or needed
for erection, completion and safe operation of the equipment as required by applicable
codes though they may not have been specifically detailed in the Technical
Specifications unless included in the list of exclusions. Materials and components not
specifically stated in the specification and bid price schedule but which are necessary
for commissioning and satisfactory operation of the switchyard / substation unless
specifically excluded shall be deemed to be included in the scope of the specification
and shall be supplied without any extra cost. All similar standard components/parts of
similar standard equipment provided, shall be inter-changeable with one another.
3. STANDARDS
3.1 The works covered by the specification shall be designed, engineered, manufactured,
built, tested and commissioned in accordance with Standards and the Acts, Rules, Laws
and Regulations of Nepal or Acceptable International Standards. Any details not
specifically covered by these standards and specifications shall be subject to approval of
the Employer.
3.2 The equipment to be furnished under this specification shall conform to latest issue with
all amendments (as on the date of bid opening) of standard specified under Annexure-A
of this chapter, unless specifically mentioned in the specification.
3.3 The Bidder shall note that standards mentioned in the specification are not mutually
exclusive or complete in themselves, but intended to complement each other.
3.4 The Contractor shall also note that list of standards presented in this specification is not
complete. Whenever necessary the list of standards shall be considered in conjunction
with specific IEC or equivalent international standard.
3.5 When the specific requirements stipulated in the specifications exceed or differ than
those required by the applicable standards, the stipulation of the specification shall take
precedence.
3.6 Other internationally accepted standards which ensure equivalent or better performance
than that specified in the standards specified under Annexure-A / individual chapters for
various equipments shall also, be accepted, however the salient points of difference
shall be clearly brought out in the Additional information schedule of the bid along with
English language version of such standard. The equipment conforming to standards
other than specified under Annexure-A/ individual chapters for various equipments shall
be subject to Employer’s approval.
4.6.2 Major technical parameters of bushings / hollow column / support insulators are given
below:
132kV, 33kV & 11kV System
S.N. Parameters 132 kV 33kV 11kV
(a) Max. System voltage Um(kV) 145 36 12
(b) Impulse withstand voltage (dry & wet) + 650 + 170 + 75
(kVp)
(c) Power frequency withstand voltage (dry and 275 75 28
wet) (kV rms)
(d) Total creepage distance (min) (mm) 3625 900 265
The Contractor shall submit detailed drawings, instructions and maintenance books, and
parts lists with recommended stock quantities for the equipment and accessories furnished,
prepare and submit detailed engineering, design and construction drawings pertaining to all
civil, structural, architectural and electrical equipment and installations of132kV
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two envelope
Chapter 2-General Technical Requirement Page 2-5
transmission line and Substation. The drawings to be furnished by the Contractor shall
include, but not be limited, to the following:
a) Work Schedule (Master Network) Plan.
b) Drawing deliverable Schedule.
c) Detailed and check survey report including profile drawings showing ground clearance and
tower locations (as applicable).
d) Soil Investigation report including ground resistivity measurement.
e) Tower schedule and foundation classification for individual tower locations (as applicable).
f) Bill of Quantity of Towers and Foundations
g) Design Basis Report
h) Tower design and structural drawing including bill of materials.
i) Foundation design and working drawings/excavation Plan.
j) Tower footing grounding drawing.
k) Stub and stub-setting (template) drawings.
l) Stringing procedure and stringing chart.
m) Tower accessories drawings like danger plate, name plate etc.
n) Quality plans for fabrication and site activities including Quality System.
o) Sub-vendors approval.
p) Drawings and datasheets of Line Conductors.
q) Drawings and datasheets of OPGW
r) Technical Catalogues
s) Instruction Manuals for Erection, Testing and Commissioning
t) Operation and Maintenance Manuals.
u) General Documentations
- Monthly Progress Report
- QA/QC Documentation including MQP and FQP for all Equipment & systems
- Testing and commissioning procedure of each equipment
5.2 The list of drawings/documents which are to be submitted to the Employer shall be
discussed and finalized by the Employer at the time of award.
The Contractor shall necessarily submit all the drawings/ documents unless anything is
waived.
5.3 The Contractor shall submit 4 (four) sets of drawings / design documents /data / detailed
bill of quantity and 3 (three) sets of test reports for the approval of the Employer. The
contractor shall also submit the softcopy of the above documents in addition to
hardcopy.
5.4 Drawings
5.4.1 All drawings submitted by the Contractor shall be in sufficient detail to indicate the
type, size, arrangement, material description, Bill of Materials, weight of each
component, break-up for packing and shipment, dimensions, internal & the external
connections, fixing arrangement required and any other information specifically
requested in the specifications.
5.4.2 Drawings submitted by the Contractor shall be clearly marked with the name of the
Employer, the unit designation, the specifications title, the specification number and the
name of the Project. Employer/Consultant has standardized few drawings/documents of
various make including type test reports which can be used for all projects having
similar requirements and in such cases no project specific approval (except for list of
applicable drawings along with type test reports) is required. However, distribution
copies of standard drawings / documents shall be submitted as per provision of the
contract. All titles, noting, markings and writings on the drawing shall be in English. All
the dimensions should be in SI units.
5.4.3 The review of these data by the Employer will cover only general conformance of the
data to the specifications and documents, interfaces with the equipment provided under
the specifications, external connections and of the dimensions which might affect
substation layout. This review by the Employer may not indicate a thorough review of
all dimensions, quantities and details of the equipment, materials, any devices or items
indicated or the accuracy of the information submitted. This review and/or approval by
the Employer shall not be considered by the Contractor, as limiting any of his
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two envelope
Chapter 2-General Technical Requirement Page 2-7
responsibilities and liabilities for mistakes and deviations from the requirements,
specified under these specifications and documents.
5.5 All manufacturing and fabrication work in connection with the equipment prior to the
approval of the drawings shall be at the Contractor’s risk. The Contractor may make any
changes in the design which are necessary to make the equipment conform to the
provisions and intent of the Contract and such changes will again be subject to approval
by the Employer. Approval of Contractor’s drawing or work by the Employer shall not
relieve the contractor of any of his responsibilities and liabilities under the Contract.
5.6 All engineering data submitted by the Contractor after final process including review
and approval by the Employer shall form part of the Contract Document and the entire
works performed under these specifications shall be performed in strict conformity,
unless otherwise expressly requested by the Employer in Writing.
5.7 Drawings and Documents Submission Schedule
The Contractor shall submit the drawings and data to the Employer for approval in the
following manner and designated deadlines.
NOTE :
(1) The contractor may please note that all resubmissions must incorporate all
comments given in the earlier submission by the Employer or adequate
justification for not incorporating the same must be submitted failing which the
submission of documents is likely to be returned.
(2) All drawings should be submitted in softcopy form, however substation design
drawings like SLD, GA, all layouts etc. shall also be submitted in AutoCAD
Version. SLD, GA & layout drawings shall be submitted for the entire substation
in case of substation extension also.
(3) The instruction Manuals shall contain full details of drawings of all equipment
being supplied under this contract, their exploded diagrams with complete
instructions for storage, handling, erection, commissioning, testing, operation,
trouble shooting, servicing and overhauling procedures.
(4) If after the commissioning and initial operation of the substation, the instruction
manuals require any modifications/ additions/changes, the same shall be
incorporated and the updated final instruction manuals shall be submitted by the
Contractor to the Employer.
(5) The Contractor shall furnish to the Employer catalogues of spare parts.
(6) All As-built drawings/documents shall be certified by site indicating the changes
before final submission.
5.8 Drawings: Titles, scales and Sizes
All drawings shall be prepared using AutoCAD software version 2000 or later only.
Drawings, which are not compatible to AutoCAD software version 2000 or later, shall not
be acceptable. After final approval all the drawings shall be submitted to the Employer in
USB flash drive.
Each drawing submitted by the Contractor shall be clearly marked with the name of the
Employer, the specification title, the specification number and the name of the Project. All
titles, noting, markings and writings on the drawing shall be in English. All the dimensions
should be to the scale and in S.I. units.
The title of the drawing, Contract Number, the signature of the Contractor's engineer and the
date shall appear in the bottom right-hand corner of each drawing in the following format:
Nepal Electricity Authority
(Government of Nepal Undertaking)
Grid Development Department
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Contract No…….
Item No…….
Brief Description ……………
In general the scales of the drawings shall be 1:200. The Contractor, however, can prepare
and submit drawing in any other appropriate scales with the prior approval of the Employer.
The Contractor shall use any one of the following sizes for the preparation of drawings as
appropriate:
A0 841 x 1189 mm (33.11 x 46.81 in)
A1 594 x 841 mm (33.39 x 33.11 in)
A2 420 x 594 mm (16.54 x 23.39 in)
A3 297 x 420 mm (11.69 x 16.54 in)
A4 210 x 297 mm (8.27 x 11.69 in)
The approval of the documents and drawings by the Employer shall mean that the Employer is
satisfied that:
a) The Contractor has completed the part of the Works covered by the subject document (i.e.
confirmation of progress of work).
b) The Works appear to comply with requirements of Specifications.
In no case the approval by the Employer of any document does imply compliance with
technical requirements or the absence of errors in such documents.
If errors are discovered any time during the validity of the contract, then the Contractor shall
be responsible for consequences.
Neither the review nor lack of review of any drawing, calculation or data shall waive any of
the Specifications or Contract drawings, or responsibility for correctness of the drawings,
calculations or data. Defective work, materials, and equipment may be rejected
notwithstanding conformance with drawings, calculation and data reviewed by the
Employer/Consultant. The Employer shall have the right to require the Contractor to make
any changes in the design which may be necessary, to make the apparatus/works conform to
the requirements and intent of the Specifications, with no additional cost to the Employer.
Approval of the Contractor's drawings (including cases of un-noticed/un-known deviations)
shall not in any way relieve the Contractor of any part of his obligation to meet all the
requirements of the Contract or of the responsibility for the correction of the drawings. The
ultimate responsibility of meeting all the requirements of the technical specifications and
fulfill contractual obligations shall rest on the Contractor.
Any drawings changed by the Contractor during the development of his design after review
by the Employer shall be submitted for approval.
The work shall be performed by the Contractor strictly in accordance with these drawings and
no deviation shall be permitted without the written approval of the Employer, if so required.
All manufacturing, fabrication and erection work under the scope of Contractor, prior to the
approval of the drawings shall be at the Contractor’s risk. The contractor may incorporate any
changes in the design, which are necessary to conform to the provisions and intent of the
contract and such changes will again be subject to approval by the Employer.
5.10 Improvements
The Employer or the Contractor may propose changes in the specification and if the parties
agree upon any such changes and the cost implication, the specification shall be modified
accordingly.
5.11 Design Co-ordination
Wherever, the design is in the scope of Contractor, the Contractor shall be responsible for
the selection and design of appropriate material/item to provide the best co-coordinated
performance of the entire system. The basic design requirements are detailed out in this
Specification. The design of various components, sub-assemblies and assemblies shall be so
done that it facilitates easy field assembly and maintenance.
5.12 Design Review Meeting
The contractor will be called upon to attend design review meetings with the Employer
during the period of Contract. The contractor shall attend such meetings at his own cost at
the Corporate Office of the Employer or at mutually agreed venue as and when required.
Such review meeting will be held generally four times in a year or as and when required.
5.13 Quality Control
The Contractor shall provide and maintain a quality control program to ensure compliance
with quality standards of the Technical Specifications. Within 30 days from the effective
date of the Contract, the Contractor shall furnish to the Employer his complete quality
control procedures, manual, and a description of the quality control organization in required
number of copies.
The Employer/Consultant will monitor the Contractor's methods, procedures and processes
for compliance with the quality control program and the quality standards of these
Specifications. Failure of the Contractor to effectively maintain the quality control program
throughout all phases of the work will be considered a failure to execute the work with the
diligence required by the Contract documents.
5.14 Employer's Supervision
To eliminate delays and avoid disputes and litigation to the Contract, all matters and
questions shall be resolved in accordance with the provisions of this document.
The manufacturing of the product shall be carried out in accordance with the specifications.
The scope of the duties of the Employer, pursuant to the contract, will include but not be
limited to the following.
a) Interpretation of all the terms and conditions of these Documents and Specifications.
b) Review and interpretation of all the Contractor's drawings, engineering data etc.
c) Witness or authorize his representative to witness tests at the manufacturer's works or at site,
or at any place where work is performed under the contract.
d) Inspect, accept or reject any equipment, material and work under the Contract, in accordance
with the Specifications.
e) Issue certificate of acceptance and/or progressive payment and final payment certificate.
f) Review and suggest modification and improvement in completion schedules from time to
time, and
g) Supervise the Quality Assurance Program implementation at all stages of the works.
6.1.2 Incase where the equipment, materials or components are indicated in the specification
as “similar” to any special standard, the Employer shall decide upon the question of
similarity. When required by the specification or when required by the Employer the
Contractor shall submit, for approval, all the information concerning the materials or
components to be used in manufacture. Machinery, equipment, materials and
components supplied, installed or used without such approval shall run the risk of
subsequent rejection, it being understood that the cost as well as the time delay
associated with the rejection shall be borne by the Contractor.
6.1.3 The design of the Works shall be such that installation, future expansions, replacements
and general maintenance may be undertaken with a minimum of time and expenses.
Each component shall be designed to be consistent with its duty and suitable factors of
safety, subject to mutual agreements. All joints and fastenings shall be devised,
constructed and documented so that the component parts shall be accurately positioned
and restrained to fulfill their required function. In general, screw threads shall be
standard metric threads. The use of other thread forms will only be permitted when
prior approval has been obtained from the Employer.
6.1.4 Whenever possible, all similar part of the Works shall be made to gauge and shall also
be made interchangeable with similar parts. All spare parts shall also be
interchangeable and shall be made of the same materials and workmanship as the
corresponding parts of the Equipment supplied under the Specification. Where feasible,
common component units shall be employed in different pieces of equipment in order to
minimize spare parts stocking requirements. All equipment of the same type and rating
shall be physically and electrically interchangeable.
6.1.5 All materials and equipment shall be installed in strict accordance with the
manufacturer’s recommendation(s). Only first-class work in accordance with the best
modern practices will be accepted. Installation shall be considered as being the erection
of equipment at its permanent location. This, unless otherwise specified, shall include
unpacking, cleaning and lifting into position, grouting, levelling, aligning, coupling of
or bolting down to previously installed equipment bases/foundations, performing the
alignment check and final adjustment prior to initial operation, testing and
commissioning in accordance with the manufacturer’s tolerances, instructions and the
Specification. All factory assembled rotating machinery shall be checked for alignment
and adjustments made as necessary to re-establish the manufacturer’s limits suitable
guards shall be provided for the protection of personnel on all exposed rotating and / or
moving machine parts and shall be designed for easy installation and removal for
maintenance purposes. The spare equipment(s) shall be installed at designated locations
and tested for healthiness.
6.1.6 The Contractor shall apply oil and grease of the proper specification to suit the
machinery, as is necessary for the installation of the equipment. Lubricants used for
installation purposes shall be drained out and the system flushed through where
necessary for applying the lubricant required for operation. The Contractor shall apply
all operational lubricants to the equipment installed by him.
6.2 Provisions for Exposure to Hot and Humid climate
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two envelope
Chapter 2-General Technical Requirement Page 2-14
Outdoor equipment supplied under the specification shall be suitable for service and
storage under tropical conditions of high temperature, high humidity, heavy rainfall and
environment favorable to the growth of fungi and mildew. The indoor equipments
located in non-air conditioned areas shall also be of same type.
6.2.1 Space Heaters
6.2.1.1 The heaters shall be suitable for continuous operation at 230V as supply voltage. On-off
switch and fuse shall be provided.
6.2.1.2 One or more adequately rated thermostatically connected heaters shall be supplied to
prevent condensation in any compartment. The heaters shall be installed in the
compartment and electrical connections shall be made sufficiently away from below the
heaters to minimize deterioration of supply wire insulation. The heaters shall be suitable
to maintain the compartment temperature to prevent condensation.
6.2.1.3 Suitable anti condensation heaters with the provision of thermostat shall be provided.
6.2.2 Fungi Static Varnish
Besides the space heaters, special moisture and fungus resistant varnish shall be applied
on parts which may be subjected or predisposed to the formation of fungi due to the
presence or deposit of nutrient substances. The varnish shall not be applied to any
surface of part where the treatment will interfere with the operation or performance of
the equipment. Such surfaces or parts shall be protected against the application of the
varnish.
6.2.3 Ventilation opening
Wherever ventilation is provided, the compartments shall have ventilation openings with
fine wire mesh of brass to prevent the entry of insects and to reduce to a minimum the
entry of dirt and dust. Outdoor compartment openings shall be provided with shutter
type blinds and suitable provision shall be made so as to avoid any communication of
air/dust with any part in the enclosures of the Control Cabinets, Junction boxes and
Marshalling Boxes, panels etc.
6.2.4 Degree of Protection
The enclosures of the Control Cabinets, Junction boxes and Marshalling Boxes, panels
etc. to be installed shall provide degree of protection as detailed here under:
a) Installed out door: IP- 55
b) Installed indoor in air conditioned area: IP-31
c) Installed in covered area: IP-52
d) Installed indoor in non air conditioned area where possibility of entry of water is
limited: IP-41.
e) For LT Switchgear (AC & DC distribution Boards): IP-52
The degree of protection shall be in accordance with IEC-60947 (Part-I) / IEC-60529.
Type test report for degree of protection test, shall be submitted for approval.
9.4 The Contractor shall give the Employer /Inspector fifteen (15) days written notice for on-
shore and six (6) weeks notice for off-shore material being ready for joint testing including
contractor and Employer. Such tests shall be to the Contractor’s account except for the
expenses of the Inspector. The Employer /inspector, unless witnessing of the tests is
virtually waived, will attend such tests within fifteen (15) days of the date of which the
equipment is notified as being ready for test/inspection, failing which the Contractor may
proceed alone with the test which shall be deemed to have been made in the Inspector’s
presence and he shall forthwith forward to the Inspector duly certified copies of tests in
triplicate.
9.5 The Employer or Inspector shall, within fifteen (15) days from the date of inspection as
defined herein give notice in writing to the Contractor, of any objection to any drawings and
all or any equipment and workmanship which in his opinion is not in accordance with the
Contract. The Contractor shall give due consideration to such objections and shall either
make the modifications that may be necessary to meet the said objections or shall confirm in
writing to the Employer /Inspector giving reasons therein, that no modifications are
necessary to comply with the Contract.
9.6 When the factory tests have been completed at the Contractor’s or Sub-Contractor’s works,
the Employer/inspector shall issue a certificate to this effect within fifteen (15) days after
completion of tests but if the tests are not witnessed by the Employer /Inspector, the
certificate shall be issued within fifteen (15) days of receipt of the Contractor’s Test
certificate by the Engineer/Inspector. Failure of the Employer /Inspector to issue such a
certificate shall not prevent the Contractor from proceeding with the Works. The completion
of these tests or the issue of the certificate shall not bind the Employer to accept the
equipment should, it, on further tests after erection, be found not to comply with the
Contract. The equipment shall be dispatched to site only after approval of test reports and
issuance of CIP by the Employer.
9.7 In all cases where the Contract provides for tests whether at the premises or at the works of
the Contractor or of any Sub-Contractor, the Contractor except where otherwise specified
shall provide free of charge such items as labor, materials, electricity, fuel, water, stores,
apparatus and instruments as may be reasonably demanded by the Employer /Inspector or
his authorized representative to carry out effectively such tests of the equipment in
accordance with the Contract and shall give facilities to the Employer /Inspector or to his
authorized representative to accomplish testing.
9.8 The inspection by Employer and issue of Inspection Certificate thereon shall in no way limit
the liabilities and responsibilities of the Contractor in respect of the agreed quality assurance
program forming a part of the Contract.
9.9 The Employer will have the right of having at his own expenses any other test(s) of
reasonable nature carried out at Contractor’s premises or at site or in any other place in
addition of aforesaid type and routine tests, to satisfy that the material comply with the
specification.
9.10 The Employer reserves the right for getting any field tests not specified in respective chapters
of the technical specification conducted on the completely assembled equipment at site. The
testing equipments for these tests shall be provided by the Employer.
9.11 The contractor has to involve a reputed independent third party inspection agency for the
Factory tests as per the specification in Chapter 3 and IEC standard at the testing laboratory
of Transformer Manufacturer before dispatch of the power transformers supplied under
this Contract. The factory tests shall be carried out in presence of reputed independent third
party inspector and NEA personnel. The involvement days of third party inspector/s shall not
be less than 10 days.
Bidders have to propose the name of reputed independent third party inspection agency
along with their bid. All the cost of Factory tests as per the specification and IEC standard
and the cost of independent third party inspector/s shall be borne by the contractor.
10.0 TESTS
10.1 Pre-commissioning Tests
On completion of erection of the equipment and before charging, each item of the
equipment shall be thoroughly cleaned and then inspected jointly by the Employer and
the Contractor for correctness and completeness of installation and acceptability for
charging, leading to initial pre-commissioning tests at Site. The list of pre-
commissioning tests to be performed are given in respective chapters and shall be
included in the Contractor’s quality assurance programme.
10.2 Commissioning Tests
10.2.1 The available instrumentation and control equipment will to be used during such tests and
the Employer will calibrate, all such measuring equipment and devices as far as
practicable.
10.2.2 Any special equipment, tools and tackles required for the successful completion of the
Commissioning Tests shall be provided by the Contractor, free of cost.
10.2.3 The specific tests requirement on equipment have been brought out in the respective
chapters of the technical specification.
10.3 The Contractor shall be responsible for obtaining statutory clearances from the
concerned authorities for commissioning the equipment and the switchyard. However
necessary fee shall be reimbursed on production of requisite documents.
availability of Railway wagon sizes should be taken into account. The Contractor shall
be responsible for any loss or damage during transportation, handling and storage due to
improper packing. Any demurrage, wharfage and other such charges claimed by the
transporters, railways etc. shall be to the account of the Contractor. Employer takes no
responsibility of the availability of the wagons.
11.2 All coated surfaces shall be protected against abrasion, impact, discolouration and any
other damages. All exposed threaded portions shall be suitably protected with either a
metallic or a non-metallic protecting device. All ends of all valves and pipings and
conduit equipment connections shall be properly sealed with suitable devices to protect
them from damage.
- Coating thickness
- Uniformity of zinc
- Adhesion test
- Mass of zinc coating
12.2.6 Galvanised material must be transported properly to ensure that galvanised surfaces are
not damaged during transit. Application of zinc rich paint at site shall not be allowed.
12.3 PAINTING
12.3.1 All sheet steel work shall be degreased, pickled, phosphated in accordance with the
relevant international standard. All surfaces, which will not be easily accessible after
shop assembly, shall beforehand be treated and protected for the life of the equipment.
The surfaces, which are to be finished painted after installation or require corrosion
protection until installation, shall be shop painted with at least two coats of primer. Oil,
grease, dirt and swaf shall be thoroughly removed by emulsion cleaning. Rust and scale
shall be removed by pickling with dilute acid followed by washing with running water,
rinsing with slightly alkaline hot water and drying.
12.3.2 After phosphating, thorough rinsing shall be carried out with clean water followed by
final rinsing with dilute dichromate solution and oven drying. The phosphate coating
shall be sealed with application of two coats of ready mixed, stoving typ zinc chromate
primer. The first coat may be “flash dried” while the second coat shall be stoved.
12.3.3 After application of the primer, two coats of finishing synthetic enamel paint shall be
applied, each coat followed by soving. The second finishing coat shall be applied after
inspection of first coat of painting.
12.3.4 The exterior and interior colour of the paint in case of new substations shall preferably
be RAL 7032 for all equipment, marshalling boxes, junction boxes, control cabinets,
panels etc. unless specifically mentioned under respective chapters of the equipments.
Glossy white colour inside the equipments /boards /panels/junction boxes is also
acceptable. The exterior colour for panels shall be matching with the existing panels in
case of extension of a substation. Each coat of primer and finishing paint shall be of
slightly different shade to enable inspection of the painting. A small quantity of
finishing paint shall be supplied for minor touching up required at site after installation
of the equipments.
12.3.5 In case the Bidder proposes to follow his own standard surface finish and protection
procedures or any other established painting procedures, like electrostatic painting etc.,
the procedure shall be submitted alongwith the Bids for Employer’s review & approval.
12.3.6 For aluminium casted surfaces, the surface shall be with smooth finish. Further, in case
of aluminium enclosures the surface shall be coated with powder (coating thickness of
60 microns) after surface preparation for painting.
During storage of material regular periodic monitoring of important parameters like oil
level / leakage, SF6 / Nitrogen pressure etc. shall be ensured by the contractor.
information only. The Contractor shall submit to the Employer every week a report
detailing all the receipts during the weeks. However, the Contractor shall be solely
responsible for any shortages or damages in transit, handling and/or in storage and
erection of the equipment at Site. Any demurrage, wharfage and other such charges
claimed by the transporters, railways etc. shall be to the account of the Contractor.
13.7 The Contractor shall be fully responsible for the equipment/material until the same is
handed over to the Employer in an operating condition after commissioning. Contractor
shall be responsible for the maintenance of the equipment/material while in storage as
well as after erection until taken over by Employer, as well as protection of the same
against theft, element of nature, corrosion, damages etc.
13.8 Where material / equipment is unloaded by Employer before the Contractor arrives at
site or even when he is at site, Employer by right can hand over the same to Contractor
and there upon it will be the responsibility of Contractor to store the material in an
orderly and proper manner.
13.9 The Contractor shall be responsible for making suitable indoor storage facilities, to store
all equipment which requires indoor storage.
13.10 The words ‘erection’ and ‘installation’ used in the specification are synonymous.
13.11 Exposed live parts shall be placed high enough above ground to meet the requirements
of electrical and other statutory safety codes.
13.12 The design and workmanship shall be in accordance with the best engineering practices
to ensure satisfactory performance throughout the service life. If at any stage during the
execution of the Contract, it is observed that the erected equipment(s) do not meet the
above minimum clearances as given in clause 4.7.1 the Contractor shall immediately
proceed to correct the discrepancy at his risks and cost.
13.13 Equipment Bases
A cast iron or welded steel base plate shall be provided for all rotating equipment which
is to be installed on a concrete base unless otherwise agreed to by the Employer. Each
base plate shall support the unit and its drive assembly, shall be of a neat design with
pads for anchoring the units, shall have a raised lip all around, and shall have threaded
drain connections.
14.0 TOOLS AND TACKLES
The Contractor shall supply with the equipment one complete set of all special tools and
tackles for the erection, assembly, dis-assembly and maintenance of the equipment.
However, these tools and tackles shall be separately, packed and brought on to Site.
15.0 AUXILIARY SUPPLY
15.1 The sub-station auxiliary supply is normally met through a system indicated under
chapter “Electrical & Mechanical Auxiliaries” having the following parameters. The
auxiliary power for station supply, including the equipment drive, cooling system of
any equipment, air-conditioning, lighting etc shall be designed for the specified
Parameters as under. The DC supply for the instrumentation and PLCC system shall
also conform the parameters as indicated in the following.
Normal Variation in Frequency in Phase/W Neutral
Voltage Voltage HZ ire connection
400V +5 50 + 2.5% 3/4 Wire Solidly Earthed.
230V +5 50 + 2.5% 1/2 Wire Solidly Earthed.
110V 95V to 120V DC - Isolated 2 wire
System
48V _ DC _ 2 wire
system (+)
earthed
17.2 Necessary clamps and connectors shall be supplied for all equipment and connections.
The requirement regarding external corona and RIV as specified for any equipment
shall include its terminal fittings. If corona rings are required to meet these requirements
they shall be considered as part of that equipment and included in the scope of work.
17.3 Where copper to aluminum connections are required, bi-metallic clamps shall be used,
which shall be properly designed to ensure that any deterioration of the connection is
kept to a minimum and restricted to parts which are not current carrying or subjected to
stress.
17.4 Low voltage connectors, grounding connectors and accessories for grounding all
equipment as specified in each particular case, are also included in the scope of Work.
17.5 No current carrying part of any clamp shall be less than 10 mm thick. All ferrous parts
shall be hot dip galvanised. Copper alloy liner of minimum 2 mm thickness shall be cast
integral with aluminum body or 2 mm thick bi-metallic strips shall be provided for Bi-
metallic clamps.
17.6 All casting shall be free from blow holes, surface blisters, cracks and cavities. All sharp
edges and corners shall be blurred and rounded off.
17.7 Flexible connectors, braids or laminated straps made for the terminal clamps for bus
posts shall be suitable for both expansion or through (fixed/sliding) type connection of
4" IPS AL. tube as required. In both the cases the clamp height (top of the mounting pad
to centre line of the tube) should be same.
17.8 Clamp shall be designed to carry the same current as the conductor and the temperature
rise shall be equal or less than that of the conductor at the specified ambient
temperature. The rated current for which the clamp/connector is designed with respect
to the specified reference ambient temperature, shall also be indelibly marked on each
component of the clamp/connector, except on the hardware.
17.9 All current carrying parts shall be designed and manufactured to have minimum contact
resistance.
17.10 Clamps and connectors shall be designed to be corona controlled.
17.11 Tests
17.11.1 Clamps and connectors should be type tested as per NEMA CC1/ Equivalent
International Standard and shall also be subjected to routine tests as per NEMA CC1/
Equivalent International Standard. Following type test reports shall be submitted for
approval as per clause 9.2 above except for sl. no.(ii) & (iii) for which type test once
conducted shall be applicable (i.e. the requirement of test conducted within last ten
years shall not be applicable).
i) Temperature rise test (maximum temperature rise allowed is 35°C over 50°C
ambient)
ii) Short time current test
For junction boxes of smaller sizes such as lighting junction box, manual operated earth
switch mechanism box etc., plug socket, heater and illumination is not required to be
provided.
18.9 All control switches shall be of MCB/rotary switch type and Toggle/piano switches
shall not be accepted.
18.10 Positive earthing of the cabinet shall be ensured by providing two separate earthing
pads. The earth wire shall be terminated on to the earthing pad and secured by the use of
self etching washer. Earthing of hinged door shall be done by using a separate earth
wire.
18.11 The bay marshalling kiosks shall be provided with danger plate and a diagram showing
the numbering/connection/feruling by pasting the same on the inside of the door.
18.12 a) The following routine tests along with the routine tests as per IEC 60529/
Equivalent International Standard shall also be conducted:
i) Check for wiring
ii) Visual and dimension check
b) The enclosure of bay marshalling kiosk, junction box, terminal box shall conform
to IP-55 as per IEC 60529/ Equivalent International Standard including
application of, 2.0 KV rms for 1 (one) minute, insulation resistance and functional
test after IP-55 test.
19.7 The terminal blocks shall have locking arrangement to prevent its escape from the
mounting rails.
19.8 The terminal blocks shall be fully enclosed with removable covers of transparent, non-
deteriorating type plastic material. Insulating barriers shall be provided between the
terminal blocks. These barriers shall not hinder the operator from carrying out the
wiring without removing the barriers.
19.9 Unless otherwise specified terminal blocks shall be suitable for connecting the
following conductors on each side.
a) All circuits except Minimum of two of 2.5 sq mm
CT/PT circuits copper flexible.
b) All CT/PT circuits Minimum of 4 nos. of 2.5 sq mm
copper flexible.
19.10 The arrangements shall be in such a manner so that it is possible to safely connect or
disconnect terminals on live circuits and replace fuse links when the cabinet is live.
19.11 At least 20 % spare terminals shall be provided on each panel/cubicle/box and these
spare terminals shall be uniformly distributed on all terminals rows.
19.12 There shall be a minimum clearance of 250 mm between the First/bottom row of
terminal block and the associated cable gland plate for outdoor ground mounted
marshalling box and the clearance between two rows of terminal blocks shall be a
minimum of 150 mm.
19.13 The Contractor shall furnish all wire, conduits and terminals for the necessary
interphase electrical connections (where applicable) as well as between phases and
common terminal boxes or control cabinets.
19.14 All input and output terminals of each control cubicle shall be tested for surge withstand
capability in accordance with the relevant IEC Publications, in both longitudinal and
transverse modes. The Contractor shall also provide all necessary filtering, surge
protection, interface relays and any other measures necessary to achieve an impulse
withstand level at the cable interfaces of the equipment.
20.3.1 Each panel shall be provided with necessary arrangements for receiving, distributing,
isolating and fusing of DC and AC supplies for various control, signalling, lighting and
space heater circuits. The incoming and sub-circuits shall be separately provided with
miniature circuit breaker / switchfuse units. Selection of the main and Sub-circuit fuse
ratings shall be such as to ensure selective clearance of sub-circuit faults. Potential
circuits for relaying and metering shall be protected by HRC fuses.
20.3.2 All fuses shall be of HRC cartridge type conforming to relevant International Standard
mounted on plug-in type fuse bases. Miniature circuit breakers with thermal protection
and alarm contacts will also be accepted. All accessible live connection to fuse bases
shall be adequately shrouded. Fuses shall have operation indicators for indicating blown
fuse condition. Fuse carrier base shall have imprints of the fuse rating and voltage.
d) Motors when started with the driven equipment imposing full starting torque
under the supply voltage conditions specified under Clause 15.0 shall be capable
of withstanding at least two successive starts from cold condition at room
temperature and one start from hot condition without injurious heating of winding.
The motors shall also be suitable for three equally spread starts per hour under the
above referred supply condition.
e) The locked rotor withstand time under hot condition at 110% of rated voltage
shall be more than starting time with the driven equipment of minimum
permissible voltage by at least two seconds or 15% of the accelerating time
whichever is greater. In case it is not possible to meet the above requirement, the
Bidder shall offer centrifugal type speed switch mounted on the motor shaft which
shall remain closed for speed lower than 19% and open for speeds above 19% of
the rated speed. The speed switch shall be capable of withstanding 120% of the
rated speed in either direction of rotation.
22.4 Running Requirements:
a) The maximum permissible temperature rise over the ambient temperature of 50
degree C shall be within the limits specified in relevant International Standard (for
3 - phase induction motors) after adjustment due to increased ambient temperature
specified.
b) The double amplitude of motor vibration shall be within the limits specified in
relevant International Standard. Vibration shall also be within the limits specified
by the relevant standard for the driven equipment when measured at the motor
bearings.
c) All the induction motors shall be capable of running at 80% of rated voltage for a
period of 5 minutes with rated load commencing from hot condition.
22.5 TESTING AND COMMISSIONING
An indicative list of tests is given below. Contractor shall perform any additional test
based on specialties of the items as per the field Q.P./Instructions of the equipment
Contractor or Employer without any extra cost to the Employer. The Contractor shall
arrange all instruments required for conducting these tests along with calibration
certificates and shall furnish the list of instruments to the Employer for approval.
(a) Insulation resistance.
(b) Phase sequence and proper direction of rotation.
(c) Any motor operating incorrectly shall be checked to determine the cause and the
conditions corrected.
the design and drawings for all type of foundations for the towers shall also be
developed by the contractor, in sequence, suiting the project requirement.
The provisional quantities of fabricated & galvanized steel towers as per specifications
requirement, foundation type and their numbers, quantity of various line materials and
other items are given in appropriate Price Schedule of the bid documents. However, the
work shall be executed as per approved construction drawings and project requirement.
The various item of work is described very briefly in the appropriate Price Schedule.
The various items of the Price Schedule shall be read in conjunction with the
corresponding sections in the Technical Specifications including amendments and,
additions, if any. The Bidder’s rates shall be based on the description of activities in the
Price Schedule as well as necessary operations detailed in these Technical
Specifications.
The Unit rates quoted shall include minor details which are obviously and fairly
intended, and which may not have been included in these documents but are essential
for the satisfactory completion of the various works.
The unit rate quoted shall be inclusive of all plant equipment, men, material skilled and
unskilled labor etc. essential for satisfactory completion of various works.
All measurements for payment shall be in S.I. units (International System of units).
Lengths shall be measured in meters corrected to two decimal places. Areas shall be
computed in square meters & volume in cubic meters rounded off to two decimals.
All the raw materials such as steel, zinc for galvanizing, reinforcement steel and cement
for tower foundation, coke and salt for tower earthing etc. bolts, nuts, washers, D-
shackles, hangers, links, danger plates, phase plates, number plates. Circuit Plates, anti-
climbing device, bird guards, etc., required for tower manufacturing and erection shall
be included in the Contractor’s scope of supply. Bidder shall clearly indicate in the
offer, the sources from where they propose to procure the raw materials and the
components.
The entire stringing work of conductor and OPGW shall be carried out by tension
stringing technique. The contractor shall indicate in their offer, the sets of tension
stringing equipment he is having in his possession and the sets of stringing equipment
he would deploy exclusively for this project which under no circumstance shall be less
than the number and capacity requirement indicated in Qualifying Requirements for
Bidder. However, the Bidder having requisite experience has freedom to use helicopter
for stringing. The Bidder intending to use helicopter shall furnish detailed description of
the procedure, type & number of helicopter & accessories etc., to be deployed for
stringing operation.
In the hilly/mountainous terrain or in thick forest areas, the Contractor may carry out
stringing work by manual method with approval of the Employer. The Contractor shall
deploy appropriate tools /equipment /machinery to ensure that the stringing operation is
23.2 LT Switchgear
23.2.1 The Manufacturer who's LT Switchgear is offered should be a
manufacturer of LT Switchboards of the type and rating being offered. He
should have designed, manufactured, tested and supplied at least 50 nos.
draw out circuit breaker panels, out of which at least 5 nos. should have
been with relay and protection schemes with current transformer.
They should have also manufactured at least 50 nos MCC panels
comprising of MCCBs (ie Moulded Case Circuit Breakers) modules of the
type offered which should be in successful operation as on originally
Scheduled date of bid opening.
23.2.2 The Switchgear items (such as circuit breakers, fuse switch units, contactors
etc.), may be of his own make or shall be procured from reputed manufacturers and
of proven design. At least one hundred circuit breakers of the make and type being
offered shall be operating satisfactory as on originally Scheduled date of bid
opening.
23.3 Fire Fighting System
The bidder or his sub-vendor should have designed, supplied, tested and installed
the fire fighting equipments for fire protection system of the each type described in
BOQ shall comply to International Standard code (FOC, LONDON or NFPA, USA
etc).
a) Discharge of cement slurry, garbage and other solid wastes generated by the construction
activities and workforce should be avoided where possible.
b) Chemical and other hazardous materials should be dumped safely far away from the water
bodies.
c) Disposal material of substation should be carried out within the acquired land for substation.
The waste materials of the substation shall be minimized to avoid for separate land for disposal.
24.2 Biological Environment
None
a) Control of adverse socio interactions between local communities and construction work force.
b) Awareness program regarding health and safety of substation.
c) Awareness program for workforce.
d) Insurance against health and safety.
24.4 Employment
Priority shall be given to the local project affected people while hiring workers and labors during
construction of the project. Nepal being a signatory to the International Convention against Child
Labor, the Contractor shall not employ child Labor in construction.
ANNEXURE - A
LIST OF SPECIFICATIONS
GENERAL STANDARDS AND CODES
CIRCUIT BREAKERS
IEC-62271-100 - High-voltage switchgear and controlgear - Part 100:
Alternating current circuit-breakers
IEC-62271-101 - High-voltage switchgear and controlgear - Part 101:
Synthetic testing
IEC-62155 - Hollow pressurized and unpressurized ceramic and glass
insulators for use in electrical equipment with rated voltages
greater than 1 000 V
IEC-62271-110 - High-voltage switchgear and controlgear - Part 110:
Inductive load switching
Battery Charger
DIESEL ENGINES
ASME Power Test Code - Internal combustion engine PTC-17
- Codes of Diesel Engine Manufacturer’s Association, USA
PIPING VALVES & SPECIALITIES
BS:5150 - Specification for cast iron gate valves
PG Test Procedures
NFPA-13 - Standard for the installation of sprinkler system
NFPA-15 - Standard for water spray fixed system for the fire protection
NFPA-12A - Standard for Halong 1301 Fire Extinguishing System
NFPA-72E - Standard on Antomatic Fire Detectors
NFPA-12 - Standard on Carbon dioxide extinguisher systems
Electrical generating and distributing stations code of practice
Steel structures
ANSI-B18.2.1 - Inch series square and Hexagonal bolts and screws
ANSI-B18.2.2 - Square and hexagonal nuts
ANSI-G8.14 - Round head bolts
ASTM-A6 - Specification for General Requirements for rolled steel plates,
shapes, sheet piling and bars of structural use
ASTM-A36 - Specifications of structural steel
ASTM-A47 - Specification for malleable iron castings
ASTM-A143 - Practice for safeguarding against embilement of Hot
Galvanized structural steel products and procedure for
detaching embrilement
ASTM-A242 - Specification for high strength low alloy structural steel
ASTM-A283 - Specification for low and intermediate tensile strength carbon
steel plates of structural quality
ASTM-A394 - Specification for Galvanized steel transmission tower bolts
and nuts
ASTM-441 - Specification for High strength low alloy structural
manganese vanadium steel.
ASTM-A572 - Specification for High strength low alloy colombium-
Vanadium steel of structural quality
AWS D1-0 - Code for welding in building construction welding inspection
AWS D1-1 - Structural welding code
ANNEXURE-B
List of Drawings/Documents
NOTE: The above list of drawing/document is only illustrative and not exhaustive.
The contractor shall submit drawings/documents as per requirement of
Technical specification.
CHAPTER-3
PRELIMINARY WORKS
The Employer has studied several alternatives for the route alignment of the said transmission line
and selected a route alignment. The Contractor shall be responsible for undertaking detailed check
survey of that selected route alignment.
The Employer has completed Initial Environmental Examination (IEE) study. The Contractor shall
be responsible for compliance with the finding / recommendation of IEE study reports in totality.
The proposed 132kV Transmission double circuit line with ACSR Cardinal Conductor is passing
through plain terrain of Dhanusha and Mahottari districts. The variation of attitude of the terrain
ranges below 1000m above MSL. Hence it is envisaged to adopt 132kV (650 kV peak BIL) level
tower located up to 1,000m attitude for the proposed 132kV Transmission line.
Strip plans and longitudinal profile sections of ground prepared by the employer as listed below are
attached in drawings with this specification.
For some practical reason such as change in topography due to construction of some new object in
the line route, to avoid heavy afforestation or to avoid abolishment of houses under the line in some
section of the line route minor modifications may require. Therefore, the Contractor along with the
Employer shall examine the angle points and fix them within 60 days from Contract signing date.
Immediately after that the Contractor shall carryout detailed check survey and prepare Strip plans
and longitudinal profile sections of that section at scales horizontal 1:2,000 and a vertical scale of
1:200 or 1:400 as appropriate.
The Contractor shall study the plan and profile and locate the intermediate tower location. The
contractor shall fix the type of towers for each location and submit for Employer’s approval both
132kV level towers located upto 1000m attitude for the proposed 132kV Transmission line (i) three
copies of profile drawings (ii) two sets of sag templates showing the sag in still air at maximum
temperature of the conductor along with sag calculations, the ground clearance line and the line
showing the sag in still air at minimum temperature of the conductor (iii) tower schedule indicating
tower number, tower type, insulator type, tower type, line angle, span length, elevation of tower
spot, leg extensions, dampers, etc.
For construction purpose the transmission line shall be divided in three sections. Considering the
importance of the line sections, works related to each of the sections shall be completed within the
set mile stone date.
The quantities given in the Price Schedule are provisional only and the Contractor shall finalise the
quantities after the tower and foundation selection. Any delay in tower selection works will not be
held as a valid reason for lack of progress in manufacture and construction and the Contractor will
be expected to commence manufacture and construct the line even though the final quantities are
not known until a later stage.
The Contractor shall perform all necessary survey work which consists of determination, checking
and lay out the accurate centre of line and elevation of all the reference points, based on the key
map and plan and profile drawings. Furthermore, the Contractor shall check the minimum clearance
of conductor crossing the existing highways, major waterways, power and telecommunication lines,
etc.
The tower to be erected shall comprise of Basic body and body extensions as provided in the Price
Schedule, if for some reason the body extensions are not sufficient or require some modification in
the body extension part, the Contractor shall make necessary changes with the prior approval of the
Employer. The Contractor shall not be entitled to claim for any materials furnished or work
performed in this respect.
During check survey, the Contractor shall assess and design works required to be undertaken for the
protection of the foundations.
The check survey work shall be performed by qualified and experienced personnel and supervised
by qualified surveyor. Not less than 15 days prior to commencement of work, the Contractor shall
submit qualification of surveyors, work program and list of surveying equipment for the three
sections of the proposed transmission Line and obtain approval of the Employer.
Following points shall also be considered during tower staking and preparation of tower schedule.
a. Road Crossing
At all important road crossings, the tower shall be fitted with double suspension or tension insulator
strings depending on the type of tower but the ground clearance at the roads under maximum
conductor design temperature and in still air shall be such that even with conductor broken in
adjacent span, ground clearance of the conductor from the road surfaces will not be less than the
values specified at Schedule A-3, Section-11 for 132 KV lines. At all national highways crossing
span will not be more than as basic span specified in schedule A.4 (Support Types and Design
Spans) item no. 2.
b. River Crossings
In case of Major River crossings which are more than 500 meter towers shall be of suspension type
and the anchor towers on either side of the main river crossing shall be DD type tower. Clearance
required by navigation authority shall be provided. For non-navigable river, clearance shall be
reckoned with respect to highest flood level (HFL). In case of river crossing with a span up to 500
meter normal tower spotting procedure as detailed in schedule A-3, Section-11 (Minimum
Clearance).
Where this line is to cross over another line of the same voltage or lower voltage, DA type tower
with suitable extensions (if necessary) shall be used. Provisions to prevent the possibility of its
coming into contact with other overhead lines shall be made in accordance with the directions of the
Employer. All the works related to the above proposal shall be deemed to be included in the scope
of the Contractor except if modifications are required to line below, in which case, the conditions to
be agreed upon. The minimum clearance while crossing the lines up to 132 kV shall be3500 mm as
given in schedule A-3, Section-11 (Minimum Clearance).
The angle of crossing shall be as near to 90 degree possible. However, deviation to the extent of 30
degree may be permitted under exceptionally difficult situations.
When the angle of crossing has to be below 60 degree, the matter will be referred to the authority in
charge of the telecommunication System. On a request from the Contractor, the permission of the
telecommunication authority may be obtained by the Employer.
Also, in the crossing span, power line support will be as near the telecommunication line as
possible, to obtain increased vertical clearance between the wires.
Payment: Payment for the contract item, Detailed Check Survey and Staking, will be made at the
unit price bid based on horizontal distance measurement. Therefore, in the schedule the unit bid
price shall include full compensation for all costs incurred in furnishing all materials, equipment
and labor and other operations related to the scope of work of survey as specified before.
Land Schedule
The land schedule of the given line route will be prepared by the Contractor. The Employer shall
assist the Contractor to the extent possible. The Contractor will identify the exact plot number and
area of the land required for the tower foundations.
The necessary right of way for the lines to enable the Contractor to carry out stringing and erection
will be obtained by the Employer.
The Contractor will not be reimbursed for waiting time caused by delay in obtaining right of way
unless he has established on site in advance of obtaining right of way. Where partial right of way
only is granted, the Contractor shall program his work accordingly.
The Contractor shall make all necessary arrangements for the access roads with the land owners
before going onto private land, but if any difficulty should arise, the Contractor shall promptly
inform the Employer. Such arrangements shall be at least one month in advance of the desired
access date to allow time to clear any difficulties. The Employer shall be kept informed of all
negotiations and successful arrangements.
At any early stage of the Contract the Contractor shall arrange all proposed points of access and
after the approval of the Employer shall prepare maps for submission to the Employer for the
settlement of way leave arrangements. No other access shall be used without the prior consent of the
Employer.
It shall be clearly understood by the Contractor that the cost of construction of access roads and
delivery of construction material to erection points shall be deemed to be included in the bid price
and the Contractor shall have no claim whatsoever to extra payment for construction and
maintenance of access as may be required.
g. Clearing
General
The Contractor shall be responsible for clearance of the foundation site. Clearing shall include
removal and disposal of all tress, bushes, down timber, tree roots, debris, indicated structures and
other obstructions from the areas to be occupied by permanent works of the contract, and as
indicated on the drawings, specified herein and as directed by the Employer at tower foundation site
and the access. The Contractor shall also be responsible for removal of creeping vines and all
vegetation on all existing towers from the base to the top. The cost of this work shall be included in
the Bid price. The Employer shall however be responsible for the clearance of the right of way for
the transmission line as regards trees and houses.
Protection
The Contractor shall be responsible for prevention of damage to structures and other objects which
are not included in the clearing work. No objects of any kind outside the indicated limits of the
work shall be removed or damaged. Existing utilities which are not specifically included in the
work shall be protected by the Contractor. The Contractor shall be responsible for employment of
safe methods of demolition and clearing.
Notices
Before construction commences, the Contractor shall give to the Employer not less than seven days'
notice that support positions have been pegged and are available for inspection.
Before the Contractor commences work he shall obtain from the Employer a way leave schedule
giving details of any special requirements of the occupiers or Employer concerned.
When the Contractor is about to carry out erection of the conductors along or across power,
telegraph or telephone lines, or public roads he shall give the requisite notice to the appropriate
authorities of the date and time which he proposes to perform the work and shall send a duplicate
copy of each notice to the Employer. The Contractor shall construct trestles for such line or road
crossings. No separate payment shall be made for such works.
The Contractor shall at all times during the execution of the Works ensure compliance with all such
reasonable requirements of the occupier or Employer as are brought to the Contractor's notice by
the Employer.
Damage
The Contractor shall take all reasonable precautions to avoid damage to land, property, roads, crops,
fences, walls, gates, etc., and shall ensure that the work is adequately supervised so that unavoidable
damage is reduced to the minimum. The Contractor will be liable for all damage arising by or in
consequence of the works except unavoidable damage to crops and shall pay compensation or make
good at the option of the Employer. The Contractor shall remove all soil and surplus material after
erection.
The Contractor will be responsible for payment necessary for agreed passage over private roads,
where arrangements have been made by the Contractor.
The Contractor will be responsible for notifying the Employer of all instances of damage to crops
which in the opinion of the Contractor are unavoidable. In the event of such notification not being
received by the Employer, Employer may at his discretion refuse to consider any claim by the
Contractor for compensation resulting there from.
Crossing of obstacles
The Contractor shall make all necessary arrangement and take all necessary precautions where the
route crosses buildings, power lines, orchards, gardens or other obstacles or ground over which
erection cannot be carried out in the normal manner.
Where the local authorities or other public undertaking affected deem it necessary to make
provision for the protection of their employees or property or of the public, or for the assistance of
traffic, the cost of such provision shall be borne by the Contractor.
The provision of special scaffolding for purposes of effecting crossings of the route over roads,
railways, rivers, telegraph and telephone lines or other similar obstructions as the Employer and/ or
the Contractor may consider necessary shall be the Contractor's responsibility and all cost of such
special crossings shall be borne by the Contractor.
Adequate provision shall be made by the Contractor to prevent the straying or damage to livestock
during the execution of the Contract Works and until permanent reinstatement of fences, walls,
hedges, gates and the like is completed, the Contractor shall be held responsible for any loss or
damage due to failure to comply with the above requirements.
Payment
No separate payment shall be made for clearing, cutting and special scaffolding arrangements and
access road. Therefore, the Contractor shall include all the cost in the unit bid for construction of
foundation, stringing or tower erection.
2. Soil Test
Scope
This specification covers all the work required for geotechnical investigation and preparation of a
detailed report. The work shall include mobilization of necessary equipment, providing necessary
engineering supervisors and technical personnel skilled and unskilled labor and other as required, to
carry out field investigations and test, laboratory tests and analysis and interpretation of data and
results, preparation of a detailed soil report including recommendations and providing technical
services as and when called for by the Employer. The investigation method shall be as described
herein or any other methods approved by Employer giving the same information as needed to
ensure that soil parameters are sufficient for reliable foundation design. The location for the geo-
technical investigation shall be approved by the employer.
Purpose
The purpose, in brief, of the proposed geotechnical investigation, is to ascertain the type of sub-strata
such as soil, rock etc., their characteristics and their suitability for the structures proposed to be built
and to decide on the choice of the type of foundation to be adopted for the type and magnitude of
envisaged loading. All the tests that are considered necessary in the opinion of the Employer for this
purpose shall be conducted. Any additional tests/works change in the number and type of specified
tests revision in the diameter, depth of bore holes, samples to be collected etc. shall be carried out as
directed by the Employer.
Calibration of equipment
The Contractor shall ensure that all the equipment/instruments are properly calibrated, at the start of the
work, to reflect actual values. If so demanded by the Employer, the Contractor shall have the
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 3 – Preliminary Works Page 3-7
instruments tested at an approved laboratory at his cost and the test reports shall be submitted to the
Employer. If the Employer desires to witness such tests, the Contractor shall arrange for the same at his
own cost.
Field work
a. General
It is essential that personnel on this work of geotechnical investigation and laboratory testing should
have the appropriate experience. The entire investigation shall be supervised by a suitably qualified
and experienced engineer or engineering geologist. All field and laboratory work shall be executed
by experienced technicians.
The Contractor shall have on site all required survey instruments as determined by the Employer to
carry out the work accurately according to Specification and Drawings. All the specified locations for
boreholes and field tests shall be set out at site by the Contractor. At each location of bore-hole, and
other field tests the Contractor shall establish the ground level prior to commencing of the boring
operation. The ground level shall be related to an established bench mark.
b. Method of boring
Boring in soil
In soil strata, boring may be carried out by auger or percussion tools or by method approved by the
Employer or Employer's representative. Bentonite slurry or mud circulation process can also be
used if permitted. However, for those boreholes, where water samples are to be collected for
chemical analysis, bentonite slurry or mud circulation method shall not be used or shall be restricted
as directed by the Employer or Employer's representative. The diameter of the boreholes, unless
stated otherwise shall be such as to permit collection of undisturbed samples of 90mm diameter.
Where necessary boreholes shall be cased and whenever a borehole is cased, the bottom of the casing
shall always be maintained within 150mm of the bottom of the borehole. The casing shall never be in
advance of the bottom of borehole during undisturbed sampling or standard penetration tests.
Borehole depth
All the boreholes shall be sunk to a depth of 10m and 30m as per requirement at field.
c. Sampling
Sequence of sampling
The general sequence of sampling adopted shall be such as to obtain alternatively undisturbed samples
at every 1.5 meter intervals and at every significant change of stratum. Undisturbed sample wherever
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 3 – Preliminary Works Page 3-8
possible, shall be collected at every 3.0 meters interval and at every identifiable change of soil
formation. Likewise disturbed samples, as obtained in the standard split spoon, shall be collected by
conducting the standard penetration test at every 3.0 meters interval and at the significant change of
soil stratum.
The material from the cutting shoe of the thin walled sampler and from the split spoon sampler of the
standard penetration test can be treated as disturbed sample, but will not be paid for separately. All
disturbed samples collected shall be placed without delay in an air-tight jar of not less than 0.4kg
nominal size and each sample shall fill the jar as far as possible.
Larger disturbed samples may be required to be collected from trial pits or excavations. Each of
such samples should be at least 10 kg. Such samples shall be sealed into heavy duty polythene bags
immediately on collection.
Water samples
Contractor shall take water samples from boreholes, whenever directed by the Employer, before
addition of water to the hole. If this is not possible prior to collection the water level in the borehole
shall be lowered by about 0.5m, water allowed to rise by seepage through walls of bore hole and
then water sample collected.
No water sample shall be taken when bentonite slurry or mud has been circulated in the borehole. The
method of sampling shall be such as to ensure that the sample is not contaminated by rain water,
surface water etc. The quantity of sample to be collected is about 1 liter and shall be stored only in
approved airtight, clean container. Water samples should be tested as soon as possible after collection.
Numbering of samples
The Contractor shall assign a reference number to each soil and water sample taken from the borehole.
this number shall be unique for that borehole and shall be in order of depth below ground level.
Labeling of samples
All samples shall be clearly labeled indicating job number, borehole number sample number, date of
sampling, brief description of samples, type of sample, elevation of sample etc. and in case of
undisturbed samples, the top and bottom of samples shall also be clearly labeled. Each such label shall
be pasted on the container and shall also be included in the container.
Transporting and storing of samples
The Contractor shall store properly all the samples at the site till they are transported to his laboratory
for testing. All rock cores and samplers with undisturbed soil samples shall be placed in order of their
occurrence in strong wooden boxes, suitably partitioned and provided with hinged wooden covers, so
that the samples are not damaged during transit by impact or improper handling. To minimize
disturbance during shipment samplers containing undisturbed soil samples shall be packed with wood
dust or similar other resilient material and as directed by the Employer or Employer's representative
The Contractor shall transport all samples to his testing laboratory as quickly as possible and test the
samples. Samples shall be transported by air, if the stipulated completion period so warrants. All
unused and excess samples after testing should be retained and safely stored by Contractor till three
months after the end of submission of the report.
f. Field tests
Standard penetration test (SPT)
Unless directed otherwise by the Employer or Employer's representative, the Contractor shall carry out
standard penetration test at 1.0 meter intervals and at every noticeable change of soil formation and as
per the procedure in IS/BS or ANSI. The finest test shall generally begin at 1.0m depth unless an
undisturbed sample is collected at that depth, and further test at 2.0m, 3.0m, 4.0 m, 5.0m , 6.0m, and so
on depths shall be done.
For conducting the test, the bottom of borehole shall be cleaned properly and the spoon shall be
properly and centrally seated in position in the borehole. The derive weight assembly shall consist of a
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 3 – Preliminary Works Page 3-11
driving head of 65kg weight with 75cm free fall. It shall be ensured that the energy of falling weight is
not reduced by friction between the drive weight and guides or between rope and winch drum.
Standard connecting rods shall be used.
The test shall be stopped (When the test is not conducted in weathered/Soft rock) when the total blow
count including seating drive reaches 120. The corresponding penetration shall be noted. If the total
penetration is more than the seating penetration of 15cm, a breakup of blow count for 15cm seating
penetration and for the remaining portion of penetration shall also be given
Laboratory tests
a. General
All the laboratory testing shall be performed by qualified and experienced personnel, familiar with and
having access to equipment and facilities for the accurate determination of data necessary for
requirements under this specification.
b. Independent laboratory
The Employer reserves the right to have the samples tested in an independent laboratory. If the
Contractor is directed to get the samples tested in an independent laboratory, he shall be paid only the
actual cost of such tests.
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 3 – Preliminary Works Page 3-12
The Employer or Employer's representative will direct Contractor on samples to be tested and on type
of test to be conducted. The Employer or Employer's representative is not bound to furnish this
information at the beginning of the investigation itself but shall instruct the Contractor at appropriate
time during the course of the investigation. In case of clayed soil triaxial compression test on
undisturbed soil samples shall be carried out.
d. Standards for testing
The Contractor shall test the samples as per the relevant BS, ANSI or directed by the Employer.
e. Access to the laboratory
The Employer shall have the right of access to Contractor's Laboratory or other Laboratory where
tests have been arranged to be carried out during the progress of this investigation.
f. Submission test data and results
The Contractor shall submit when demanded by the Employer preliminary copy of the data and the
computed results tests he has conducted. However, the final report shall contain all the experimental
data and the results as stated below in Article 4.2.7.
Formal report
a. General
The Contractor shall submit his report in two separate volumes. Volume I shall be the main body of the
report containing geological history of the Site summarized test data, observations, conclusions and
recommendations. Volume II shall be in the form of appendix and shall contain actual field and
laboratory observations, calculations of test results, supporting calculations for the recommendations
made etc. Initially, the Contractor shall submit these volumes to the Employer in a draft form.
b. Route plan
A route plan showing location of all boreholes, trail pits, etc. shall be presented in the report.
c. Bore logs
A true cross-section of all boreholes, trial pits showing thickness, position and classification of each
soil stratum found between top surface and bottom of the hole shall be submitted. The various tests
conducted and recovered from every soil and rock stratum shall be clearly against that stratum.
A record in full of every trial pit or incomplete boring with appropriate explanations, shall be reported
in the same manner as the completed pits or boreholes.
d. Ground water
All available data on ground water conditions shall be presented separately and shall be identified by
borehole number and sampling dates and timing of observations, showing clearly the number of
observation made in a particular safe.
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 3 – Preliminary Works Page 3-13
e. Test results
The recommendations shall be based on observations and test results and shall encompass theoretical
as well practical considerations for foundations for the types of structures envisaged. The Contractor
shall acquaint himself with the type of structures proposed.
Recommendations shall include but not be limited to the following:
- A brief geological description including that of faults, folds, etc. if any on the basis of
published literature.
- Seismic history including a brief description of previous earthquakes, giving time, period,
magnitude, ground acceleration, epicenter, damage done etc.
- Recommendation for class of concrete to be used for foundations vis-a-vis deleterious effect of
ground water/soil chemicals concrete and steel.
Payment
Payment for the contract item, Soil Test, will be made at the unit price bid i.e. as per no. of locations.
Therefore, in the schedule the unit bid price shall include full compensation for all costs incurred in
furnishing all materials, equipment, technical services, labor and other operations related to the scope
of work of soil test as specified before.
3. Measurement of Ground Resistance
The Contractor is required to perform ground resistance test at every support location. Method of
measurement, tools and instruments shall be submitted to the Employer for approval.
The measurement of ground resistance shall be performed at every meter depth from ground surface
to the specified depth or to maximum depth of sub-soil tests except where ground resistance value
of 10 ohms or less is obtained at any adjacent levels, no further measurement is required.
The Contractor may use drilling rod(s) of sub-soil test equipment during performing the sub-soil
test as earth electrodes for measuring the ground resistance.
The Contractor shall recommend the type of earth electrodes in accordance with the results of
ground resistance obtained. Selection of earth electrode type shall be suitable for each structure and
its particular site conditions. The data obtained shall be prepared in an approved form and submitted
to the Employer.
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 3 – Preliminary Works Page 3-14
Payment
Payment for the contract item measurement of ground resistance will be made at the unit price bid.
Therefore in the schedule the unit bid price shall include full compensation for all cost incurred in
furnishing all equipment and labor related to "Measurement of Ground Resistance".
CHAPTER-4
TRANSMISSION LINE TOWERS
1. General
The scope of work comprises of Design, prototype testing, Supply and erection of self-supporting steel
lattice double circuit towers for 20 km long 132 kV transmission line from Dhalkebar to Loharpatti.
The towers shall be self-supporting, hot dip galvanized, latticed steel type & designed to carry the
line conductors with necessary insulators, shield wires and all fittings under all loading conditions.
Outline diagram of double circuit towers are enclosed with the Specification. Please refer to
drawing attached.
2. Design Spans
The design shall provide for basic, wind and weight spans given in Schedule A.4. of Chapter 10.
The term basic span shall mean the horizontal distance between centers of the adjacent towers on
ground level.
The term wind span shall mean half the sum of adjacent horizontal spans lengths supported on any
one support.
The term weight span shall mean the equivalent length of the weight of conductor supported at any
one support at maximum temperature in still air.
3. Conductor and OPGW Clearances
For all supports the clearances from conductors, arc horns, jumper loops and all live metal to the
structure or grounded steel work shall not be less than those specified in Schedule A.3. of Chapter
10. Where uplift condition occurs at tension tower positions, details should be provided to show that
the above requirements are not infringed.
The length of angle structure cross-arm shall be such as to ensure that the distances between
conductors from straight-line structures are maintained in plain normal conductors.
For 132 kV towers carrying deviation angles up to 30° cross arms shall generally be so proportioned
that live metal clearances of 1600 mm are maintained under all conditions without the use of jumper
suspension insulators. Jumper suspension insulator strings must be used on tension structures with
deviation angle of 30° or more. However, for tension structures with deviation angle below 30°,
suspension insulator strings should be used on locations where sufficient clearance of the jumpers is
not available with the structure without any additional cost to the Employer.
Sr. No Type of insulator Swing in Min. live metal
string deg. clearance in mm
Altitude upto (+)1000m
1 Single suspension Nil 1530
insulator string 15 1530
30 1370
45 1220
60 1070
2 Jumper( without Nil 1530
The minimum ground clearances from the bottom conductor shall not be less than for the following
Altitudes at the maximum Sag conditions i.e. at max. temperature and still air:
7100mm upto Altitude (+)1000m,
However, to achieve the above clearance the height of tower has been increased in the following
manner:
a) An allowance of 500 mm shall be provided to account for errors in stringing.
b) Conductor creep shall be compensated by over tensioning the conductor at temperature of
o
21 C lower than the stringing temperature for ACSR Cardinal.
Further, the tension for the earth wires and power conductors shall be so co-ordinated that the sag of
earth wire shall be at least 20% less than that of power conductors under all temperature loading
conditions.
The phase distance: the minimum distance between testing point at insulators shall set as per
standard practice at IEC or any other standards. Allowance shall be made for increasing or
decreasing the length and varying the arrangement of all terminal tower cross arms to enable span
connections to be made in any desire phase sequence.
Where obstructions of other types are met requiring special clearance, the clearance shall be
approved by the Employer. If any factors likely to cause infringement of clearance become apparent
the Contractor shall inform the Employer immediately.
Clearance between phases: The distance between conductors belonging to different circuits shall be
1.20 times the distance belonging to the same circuit. However, the distance shall not be less than
3.0 m.
4. Extensions
The towers for ACSR Cardinal Conductor lines shall be designed for adding +3m, +6m, +9m body
extensions for maintaining adequate ground clearance without reducing the specified factor of
safety in any manner. All above extension provisions to normal towers shall be treated as part of
normal tower only.
In order to expedite the project and to reduce leveling, grading and protection works in undulating
terrain leg extension of some towers may be required subjected to the approval of Employer.
Payment for these leg extensions will be done on weight basis based on unit rate quoted by the
bidder.
5. Tower Design
Type of
towers Upto Altitude (+)1000m
Minimum Maximum
Values Values
(meter) (meter)
DA 5.4 6.0
DB 6.2 7.0
DC 7.2 8.0
DD/DE 8.2 9.0
As substantial portion of Transmission Line traverses through hilly area, the maximum and
minimum weight span under Normal Condition and Broken Wire Condition for Angle Towers shall
be based as per CBIP Publication No 323 Tower Manual.
5.3 Sag Tension
The sag tension calculation for conductor and earth wire shall be made in accordance with the
relevant provision of IS 5613 (Part-2/Sec-I) -1985 of the following load conditions. Appropriate
drag co-efficient and gust response factors (Corresponding to Terrain Cat-II) shall be considered for
accounting the wind pressure.
Ref. Cl.No. 10.3 of IS802 Towers upto + 1000m attitude
(DA1, DB1, DC1, DD1/DE1)
In addition all the standard conditions for Sag Tension calculation as per IS 802 and CBIP Manual
shall be considered as per good Industries practice.
5.4 Preliminary design
The preliminary design of the towers including suspension and tension tower design shall be
prepared at the start of the project which shall be sound in engineering and economical in design.
The preliminary design shall consist of all the necessary item/ components required to complete the
tower to be erected. This preliminary design shall be presented to the Employer with the line
diagram for approval. Necessary changes, as per Employer shall be incorporated to the design by
the Contractor if necessary, without additional financial implication, and should not affect the
period of completion of the project.
The line diagram which is approved by the Employer shall be released for detailed design and for
preparation of shop drawing. This approval in any way does not make the Contractor free from its
obligation to the safety of the structure Tower Loadings.
5.5 Wind Load
The Transmission line is traversing in wind Zone: 4 as per IS 802 and the corresponding wind
velocity is 47 m/s. This wind speed is applicable upto height of 10m at every day temperature of 32
deg C corresponding to 3 second peak gust wind. As this transmission line is traversing plain
terrain, terrain roughness factor, K2 =1.08, corresponding to terrain Cat-I shall be adopted.
However the Gust Response factors corresponding to Terrain –II for conductors, earthwire, Tower
and Insulator shall be adopted for accounting the wind pressure.
The above base wind speeds shall be applicable for Double circuit towers. The corresponding
Design Wind Pressure on towers, conductors and insulators shall be obtained from the relation
Pd=0.6V2 as follows:
6. Loads on Towers
Loads shall be computed for the following considerations as per IS: 802 (Part I/ Sec1): latest &
CBIP publication No: 323, Manual on Transmission Lines and technical specification
i) Classification of Loads
- Security Conditions
Transverse Loads
Vertical Loads
Longitudinal Loads
Narrow front wind load ( for Suspension Towers only DA1, DA2)
- Safety Conditions
Transverse Loads
Vertical Loads
Longitudinal Loads
Vertical Loads
i) Load of 150kg to be considered acting at each cross-arm as a provision for weight of
lineman with tools
ii) Load of 350kg to be considered acting at the tip of Cross-arms
iii) Erection load of 1000kg at each lifting point located a distance of 600mm from tip of
cross-arm
iv) All bracing and redundant members of the towers which are horizontal or inclined up
to 15˚ from horizontal shall be designed to with stand an ultimate vertica l loads of
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 4 – Transmission Line Towers Page 4-8
Longitudinal Loads
These loads shall be taken as under
i) For normal conditions – These loads for dead end towers shall be considered as
corresponding to mechanical tension of conductor / ground wire at everyday temperature
and no wind.
ii) For broken wire conditions
a) Suspension Towers – Longitudinal load per conductor and ground wire shall
be considered as 1000kg and 500kg respectively.
b) Tension Towers - Longitudinal load equal to twice the sagging tension
(sagging tension shall be taken as 50 percent of tension at everyday
temperature and no wind) for wires under stringing and 1.5 times the
sagging tension for all intact wires (stringing completed).
c)
6.3 Broken wire criteria
Broken wire conditions as applicable to double circuit towers during the design of towers:
Small (0 0 -150) and Medium angle tension towers (150 -- 300) ( DB, DC)
Any two phases broken on the same side and same span or anyone phase and one ground wire
broken on the same side and same span whichever combination is more stringent for a particular
member.
Large angle tension towers (300-600) and dead end towers ( DD, DE)
Any three phase broken on the same side and same span or any two phases and one ground wire
broken on the same side and same span whichever combination is more stringent for a particular
member.
6.4 Anti-cascading checks
All Tension towers shall be checked for anti-cascading/sectional considerations with all conductors
and ground wire intact only on one side of the tower
Transverse Loads
These loads shall be taken under NIL wind condition.
Vertical Loads
These loads shall be the sum of weight of conductor/ground wire as per weight span of intact
conductor/ground wire, weight of insulator strings and accessories.
Longitudinal Load
These loads shall be pull of conductor/ground wire at everyday temperature and NIL wind applied
simultaneously at all points on one side with zero degree line deviation
Provided that the ultimate tension under everyday temperature and 100% design wind pressure, or
minimum temperature and 36% design wind pressure does not exceed 50% of the ultimate tensile
strength of the conductor/ground wire.
i. If steel with minimum guaranteed yield strength is used for fabrication of tower, the
estimated loads shall be increased by a factor of 1.02.
ii. If steel with minimum guaranteed yield strength is not used for fabrication of tower, the
estimated loads shall be increased by a factor of 1.05. In addition to the provision (i) above.
In determining the slenderness ratios for various members’ suitable provisions shall be taken into
consideration for various types of end connections, eccentricity of load transfer in the
memberseffective length of members as per the CBIP Manual guideline Annexure-12 and 13.
b) Bolted Joint
In case where the bolt and structural member are of different materials, the lowest of the ultimate
strength of bolt and structural member governs the breaking strength of the joint.
c) Framing
The angle between any two members common to a joint of a trussed frame shall preferably be
greater than 200 and never less than 150 due to un-certainty of stress distribution between two
closely spaced members.
d) Gusset Plates
Minimum thickness of gusset shall be 2mm more than the lattice it connects only in case when the
lattice is directly connected on the gusset outside the leg member. In no case gusset shall be less
than 5mm in thickness
e) Minimum Thickness of Members
Leg Members : 5mm
Other Members : 4mm
f) Minimum size of Members : ISA 45x45x4mm
g) Minimum Width of Flange
Minimum flange widths for bolts of different diameter are given as under:
The Loading trees for Reliability , Security , Safety conditions of all towers shall be prepared and
ensure the proposed tower geometry satisfying all essential electrical clearances before design
of the tower.
The unsupported length of stub between chimney and the last bracing connection to the leg should
also be checked for combined direct and bending stresses and an additional cleat of required
suitable size be provided . The supporting calculations shall also be provided. The design of stub
& foundation cleats shall be designed as per the CBIP manual & ASCE 10-97, ASCE-52 .
The structural assembly drawing should be prepared according to IS 696 and IS 962. The drawing
shall show the complete design dimensions, member length, slope factors or triangles, section sizes,
bend lines, gauge lines, diameter, length and number of bolts, spacers, washers, sizes of gusset
plates, position of holes etc., and relative location of various members.
Sufficient number of elevation, cross section and plan view should be presented to clearly indicate
the details of joints and arrangement of members.
All members should be clearly shown and respective identification mark allotted to each member.
The drawing should be drawn to scale large enough to convey the information adequately.
All connection should be detailed to minimize eccentricity of connections. Due consideration
should be given to the additional stresses introduced in the member on account of eccentricity of
connection.
Dimension of all members and on a member the distances such as hole – to – hole, length, gauge
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 4 – Transmission Line Towers Page 4-12
free from kinks, twists or bends. All holes shall be made with sharp tools and shall be clean cut
without torn or ragged edge. The fabrication shall be in strict accordance with the shop drawings
prepared by the Contractor and approved by the Employer or the Employer's Representative.
Structural materials shall be straight and cleaned of all rust and dirt before laid out or worked in any
manner. Shearing and cutting shall be performed carefully. Manually guided cutting torches shall
not be used.
All bolt holes in steel members shall be punched, sub-punched, reamed or drilled before
galvanizing. Holes shall be drilled instead of being punched if the thickness of the metal exceeds the
diameter of the hole. All holes shall be clean-cut and without torn or ragged edges. All holes shall
be cylindrical and perpendicular to the member.
The diameter of the finished bolt hole shall not be greater than the normal diameter of the bolt plus
1.5mm. Plugging, welding or slotting of mispunched, misreamed or misdrilled holes will not be
permitted. The holes shall be located accurately so that when the members are in position the holes
will be lined up before being bolted.
6.10.4 Member fabrication-galvanising
All galvanizing shall be carried out by the hot dip process and shall conform in all respects with BS
729.
All surface defects in the steel including cracks surface laminations, laps and folds shall be removed
in accordance with BS 4360/IS 2629/ IS 209/IS2633. All drilling, cutting, welding, forming and
final, fabricationsof unit members and assemblies shall be completed before the structures are
galvanised. The surface of the steelwork to be galvanised shall be free from welding slag, paint, oil,
grease and similar contaminants.
The preparation for galvanising and the galvanising itself shall not distort or adversely affect the
mechanical properties of the material.
For all parts other than steel wires the coating shall consist of at least 610 grams of zinc per square
meter of surface and be not less than 0.086mm in thickness for steel members thickness equals to or
more than 5mm.
At least 460 grams of zinc per square meter and 0.065mm for thickness of members less than 5mm.
On removal from the galvanising bath the resultant coating shall be smooth continuous free from
gross surface imperfections such as bare, spits, lumps, blisters and inclusions of flux, ash or dross.
During off loading and erection of supports the use of nylon or braided slings shall be used.
Galvanized steel work which is to be stored in the works or on site shall be stacked so as to provide
adequate ventilation to all surfaces to avoid wet storage staining.
Small areas of the galvanized coating damaged in any way shall be restored in accordance with the
requirements of item 1.7 of General technical specifications.
Tests on samples shall be carried out to BS 729/IS 4759/IS6745/IS14394.
6.10.5 Bolts and nuts
No bolt of diameter less than 16mm shall be used. No screwed threads shall form part of shearing
plane between members.
When in position all bolts or screwed rods shall project through the corresponding nuts by at least
one full thread but such projection shall not exceed 10mm.
Bolts shall be galvanized after thread cutting to the same specified coating weight as specified in
BS 729/IS1367/IS1368/IS12427 /IS14394
Spring washers shall confirm to IS3063 and pack & plain washers confirm IS6821.
Nuts and heads of all bolts shall be hexagonal.
All bolts, nuts and washers shall be hot dip galvanised and subsequently centrifuged (according to
BS 729). Nuts shall be tapped after galvanising and the threads oiled to permit the nuts to be finger
turned on the bolt for the full depth of the nut.
All bolts supplied for this contract will be provided with one nut and one spring washer of approved
design. Taper washers and packers are to be fitted where necessary.
After fixing, bolt heads, washers and nuts shall receive two coats of zinc rich paint. Only one type
of bolt for the whole project, either mild steel or high tension steel will be permitted in order to
prevent inadvertent misuse. The Contractor shall state clearly which type of bolt his designs are
based upon.
The Contractor will instruct his supplier to select two samples of each type of bolt and nut to be
used on the Contract and send these samples to the Employer or the Employer's Representative for
approval within one month of the date of issuing the order. The Employer or the Employer's
Representative will then reject bolt consignments, which in his opinion fall in any respect below the
standard of samples submitted and approved.
6.10.6 Aeronautical Sign on Steel Towers
The Contractor shall paint the steel towers in the vicinity of airports or aviation route in accordance
with the following stipulations:
Painting of steel towers shall be applied on all surfaces of steel members after erection works have
been completed. No painting shall be done in cold, damp, foggy or dusty atmospheres or started
when the weather forecast indicates such conditions for the day. Prior to painting, the Contractor
shall submit a painting plan including the quality of paint and the division of painting for the
approval of the Employer.
The color of the paint shall be yellowish-red and white alternately in strips from the top of the
tower. Painting shall be applied in four coats including prime coat. The primer paint shall be zinc
dust-zinc oxide/ metal primer.
6.10.7 Bird Guards
To prevent birds perching immediately above the suspension insulator string of suspension and/ or
tension towers and fouling the same with dropping, suitable bird guards shall be provided at cross
arm tips of all suspension towers. The bird guard arrangement shall be such that it shall either
prevent bird from perching in position where they are liable to cause the damages or ensure that if
birds do perch, dropping will fall clear of the insulator string.
Payment for the contract item, "Line tower" including any required painting, will be made at the
unit bid price per tower type bid. For supply, the tower is divided into Basic body and Body
extension. For Erection the unit price shall include all cost incurred in transportation and erection of
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 4 – Transmission Line Towers Page 4-15
a complete tower. Therefore, in the Price Schedule, the unit bid price shall include full
compensation for all the costs incurred in furnishing all materials, equipment, labors and all other
operational related to tower design, fabrication delivery etc. as specified.
6.11 Tower Earthing
6.11.1 General
In addition to the mechanical OPGW termination requirement, all steel towers shall be fitted with
separate earth bonds for OPGW continuity and the Contractor shall provide all necessary
connecting facilities.
All the four legs of the tower shall be connected to the earth through electrode as shown in attached
Drawing.
The footing resistance shall be measured by the Contractor and approved by the Employer or the
Employer's Representative for every tower prior to the stringing of the OPGW. The maximum
footing resistance to the general mass of earth shall be 10 Ohms.
Steel towers need not be fitted with a separate earth bond and earthing continuity throughout the
support will therefore depend upon surface contact between members.
All towers shall be provided with means for connecting an additional earthing device as required by
the Employer or the Employer's Representative. Holes are to be provided in all supports near
ground level to take bolts for earth lead connections.
All legs of every tower shall be equipped with galvanized steel wire and cast into the foundation
concrete to be readily available for the connection of additional earth electrodes in the event of the
initial footing resistance exceeding 10 ohms. Bidder's rates for the structures shall include for such
additional works.
Galvanized steel rods shall be driven where necessary in sufficient number to ensure the combined
structure footing and earth electrode resistance does not exceed 10 Ohms. Where it is necessary to
drive more than one earth electrode at any support, the locations shall be to the approval of the
Employer or the Employer's Representative. All earth electrodes shall be electrically bonded
together using galvanized steel wire.
The tops of all electrodes shall be at least 500 mm below the surface of the normal reinstated
ground level.
Connection of earth wires to the structure stub-angles shall be by bolting. Bidders shall submit
details of their proposals in this regard.
6.11.2 Payment for Grounding Materials
Payment for grounding materials shall be made at the unit price bid. Therefore, in the Price
Schedule, the unit bid price shall include full compensation for all the costs incurred in furnishing
all materials, equipment, labors and other operational related to the scope of work of earthing as
specified. Each set shall mean one complete set for each tower footing.
6.12 Danger, Phase and Number Plate
All structures shall be equipped with a suitable framework mounted immediately above the
anti-climb device level, to accommodate a danger plate and support- number plate in a conspicuous
position. One plate is to be supplied for every tower, except for phase identification plates, which
shall be supplied for angle towers only.
All terminal structures shall be equipped with additional frameworks, mounted immediately above
the anti-climb device level, to accommodate a set of three phase color plates.
All plates shall be affixed to the framework by means of galvanized bolts, nuts and lockouts.
Washers should be of such material and so positioned that damage to the enamel will be prevented.
The height for fixing these accessories shall not be more than 4.5m above the ground level. The
corners of the number, danger & circuit plate shall be rounded off to remove sharp edges. All plates
shall be manufactured from mild steel sheet with vitreous enameled finish. The letters figures and
the conventional skull and bones of danger plates shall conform to IS:2551-1963 and shall be in a
signal red on the front of the plate. A detail drawing for such plates shall be prepared by Contractor
subject to the Employer's approval.
Line color-coded vitreous enamel identification plates should be fitted to the climbing legs of every
structure in accordance with line color code scheme to be supplied to the successful Bidder. Each
plate shall be approximately 70mm wide and shall be applied one immediately below the anti-climb
device, one halfway up the towers and one immediately below the lowest crossarm.
6.12.2 Payment for Plates
Payment for danger, phase and number plates shall be made at the unit price bid. Therefore, in the
Price Schedule, the unit bid price shall include full compensation for all the costs incurred in
furnishing all materials, equipment, labors and other operational related to the scope of work as
specified.
6.13 Final Design and Design Drawing
The detailed design shall be prepared in line with the approved line diagram, which shall be
submitted to the Employer required number of copies.
The tower accessories drawings like name plate, danger plate, phase plate, anti-climbing device,
step bolt, D-shackle etc. shall also be prepared by the Contractor and shall be submitted to the
Employer required number of copies along with the soft copies in CD. These drawings shall be
prepared in A4 size sheet only.
Once the design is approved, the approved design drawing shall be submitted to Employer in four
copies, along with one soft copy. The overall responsibility of fabricating tower for its correctness
lies with the Bidder only, and should ensure that all the tower members can be fitted without any
undue strain on them.
6.13.1 Shop drawing
The shop drawings shall be prepared based on the approved design drawing. Shop drawing should
contain complete information necessary for fabrication of the component parts of the structure.
These drawings should clearly show the member size, length and marks, hole positions, gauge lines,
bend lines, edge distances, amount of chipping and notching etc.
For gusset fabrication, separate individual item wise template can be made to facilitate gusset
fabrication as well as inspection. In case of member to be bent, shop drawing should indicate the
provision for variation in length. At the design/ drawing stage itself, drawing should indicate that
the degree of bend given in any member such that neither flange width nor thickness shall vary
beyond permissible limits.
Items requiring steep bending may be cut and welded as per approved welding procedure.
At the time of proto stage/ tower testing itself specific bend gauge and template to locate the holes
after bending must be established for the items to be bent.
6.13.2 Bill of Material
Bill of material for each type of tower and extensions required should be prepared separately. This
should indicate grade of steel ( like high tensile steel , mild steel etc.), mark numbers, section sizes,
member’s lengths, their calculated weights, type & number of bolts, nuts and washer and their sizes,
total quantities and structural drawing members.
Marking
Each individual member shall have an erection mark conforming to the component number given to
it in the fabrication drawings. This mark shall be made with marking dies of 16 mm size before
galvanizing and shall be legible after galvanizing.
A-BB-CC-DDD
Steel work should be temporarily erected in horizontal or vertical so that accuracy of the member
can be checked before testing the towers or commencing mass fabrication as applicable. The proto
assembly is done on the basis of approved structural shop drawings of towers, all body extensions,
stubs & templates for all types of towers.
6.14 Testing of Towers
6.14.1 General
Testing of tower generally serves as guide to good tower design and therefore shall not be
considered as requisite proof test for all towers. The test shall be conducted on full scale prototype
galvanized tower as per the approved loading schedules and rigging diagram. The members
constituting the prototype shall be of same grade of steel as specified in the design and fabrication
shall conform to the provision stipulated in IS 802 (Part – II). The tower shall be tested on rigid
foundation.
The test tower shall successfully withstand the ultimate loads specified for various conditions.
6.14.2 Leg Anchorage
The tower shall be erected vertically on rigid foundation with as much unbraced portion of the stub
protruding above ground level as provided in the drawing.
6.14.3 Calibration of Measuring Instruments
All measuring instruments shall be calibrated in a systemic manner with the help of standard
weights. The calibration shall, before commencing the test on each tower, be done upto the
maximum anticipated load to be applied during testing. Calibration curves for the instrument to be
used during testing shall be drawn by the testing authorities and the test loads shall be suitably
corrected with the help of these curves.
Calibration of load cells shall be done with Universal Testing Machine (UTM) or by using standard
weights. The UTM in turn shall be calibrated once in every six months or periodically as per advice
of the supplier of UTM.
6.14.4 Types of Tests
o Bolt-Slip Test
o Load Tests
Load shall be applied according to approved rigging diagram through normal wire attachments,
angles, or bent [plates. U bolt/ D shackle or swinging brackets (hangers) may be used in the test
tower if desired by theEmployer, provided that satisfactory and safe rigging is attained.
The various type of loads, transverse, vertical and longitudinal shall be applied in such a way that
there is no impact loading on the tower due to jerk from the winches.
Loading cases (values, direction and points of application of loads) shall be determined by the
Bidder and get approved form the Employer before applying to the test towers.
6.14.6 Loads and Deflection Measurement
All loads shall be measured through a suitable arrangement of strain devices or by using weights.
Positioning of strain devices shall be such that the effect of pulley friction is eliminated. In case the
pulley friction cannot be avoided the same shall be measured by means of standard weight and
accounted for in the test loads.
Tower deflection under loads shall be measured by suitable procedure at the top cross arm level on
the front side of the transverse and longitudinal faces or front and rear side of the transverse faces.
Deflection reading shall be recorded for the 'before load', ' load on' and 'load off' conditions.
Bolt slip test – In bolt slip test, the test loads upto 50% of Ultimate Normal Condition (Reliability
Condition) Loads are gradually applied and kept constant for 1 minute at these loads and then the
loads are released gradually.
The initial and final reading on the scale before application and after the release of loads
respectively shall be taken with the help of theodolite. The difference between these readings gives
the value of the bolt slip.
Normal load/ broken wire load tests – All loads shall be applied gradually upto the ultimate design
loads in the following steps and shall be released in the similar manner:
25%
50%
75%
90%
95%
100%
6.14.8 Observation Periods
Under normal and broken wire load tests, the tower shall be kept under observation for sign of
failure for one minute (excluding the time for adjustment of loads) for all intermediate steps of
loading upto and including 95 % of ultimate design loads.
For normal as well as broken wire tests, the tower shall be kept under observation for five minutes
after it is loaded upto 100 percent ultimate loads.
While the loading operations are in progress, the tower shall be constantly watched, and is it shows
any tendency of failure anywhere, the loading shall be immediately stopped, released and then the
entire tower shall be inspected. The reloading shall be started only after the corrective measures are
taken.
6.14.9 Recording
The deflection of the tower shall be recorded at each intermediate and final stage of normal loads/
broken wire load test by means of a theodolite and graduated scale.
6.14.10Destruction Test
If the Employer desired so, destruction test for the tower shall be carried out.
Destruction test shall be carried out under normal condition or broken wire condition as agreed
between the Employer and the Bidder.
All the provision of the specification and IS 802 for normal broken wire conditions shall be
applicable to destruction tests of Double circuit towers during the design of towers.
Material Procurement
Proto Manufacture
Assembly of Tower
Mass Fabrication
Marking
Galvanising
Bundling
Dispatch
6.17 Packing
Angle section shall be wire bundled.
Cleat angles, gusset plates, brackets, fillet plate, hanger and similar loose pieces shall be tied and
bolted together in multiples or securely wired through holes. Bolts, nuts washers and other
attachments shall be packed in double gunny bags accurately tagged in accordance with the
contents. The packing shall be properly done to avoid losses & damages during transit. Each
bundle or package shall be appropriately marked.
6.18 Standards
The design, manufacturing, fabrication, galvanizing, testing, erection procedure and materials used
for manufacture and erection of towers, design and construction of foundations shall conform to the
following Indian Standards (IS) / International Standards which shall mean latest revisions, with
amendments / changes adopted and published, unless specifically stated otherwise in the
Specification. In the event of supply of material conforming to Standards other than specified, the
Bidder shall confirm in his bid that these Standards are equivalent to those specified. In case of
award, salient features of comparison between the Standards proposed by the Bidder and those
specified in this document will be provided by the Contractor to establish their equivalence.
The material and services covered under these specifications shall be performed as per requirements
of the relevant standard code referred hereinafter against each set of equipment and services. Other
internationally acceptable standards which ensure equal or higher performance than those specified
shall also be accepted.
Sl. Indian Title Internationally
No. Standards recognized
(IS)
Standards /
Guides
1992
27. IS: 6639- Hexagon Bolts for Steel Structure. ASTM A394
1990 CSA B334
28. IS: 6745- Method for Determination of weight ASTM A90
1990 of Zinc coated iron and Steel Articles.
29. IS: 8500- Specification for Weldable Structural
1992 Steel (Medium & High Strength
Qualities)
30. IS: 10238- Step Bolts for Steel Structures
1989
31. IS: 12427- Bolts for Transmission Line Towers
1988
32. IS:4091-1979 Code of practice for design and
construction of foundation for
transmission line between tower &
poles.
33. IS:5358 Specification for hot dip galvanized
coating and fastners
34. IS: 7215- Specification for tolerance for
1992 fabrication of steel structures
CHAPTER-5
TOWER FOUNDATION AND CIVIL WORKS
1. General
The Contractor shall furnish all materials, equipment and labour and perform all operations required
for the design and construction of all of the concrete foundations as shown on the drawings and
other relevant civil works, as specified herein and as evidently necessary to complete the work.
Before start of design of foundation, successful bidder shall carry out geotechnical investigation
during detailed/check survey of Transmission Line route primarily consists of laying trial bore-
holes (normally up to10 meter and 30 meter below natural ground level) at the required tower
locations or as directed by the Employer to have a fair idea of soil type/nature and subsoil water
position. If the soil characteristics are changing rapidly or soil up to 10.0 meter is very weak, the
depth of bore-hole be increased beyond 10.0 meters so as to know the soil properties/type below the
foundation. The bore log data containing information such as position of sub-soil water table, soil
strata, the crop pattern in the agricultural fields where the foundation is to be laid and the suitability
for founding the required foundation, shall be submitted to the Employer for according approval for
“Classification of foundation” at each location.
2. Foundation Design
2.1 General
The foundation for tower structure plays an important role in the safety and satisfactory
performance of the structure as it transmits the load from the structure to the soil. Therefore, the
foundation shall be so designed to carry the entire load as required, with sufficient factor of safety
as recommended by the Code of practices.
The foundation in various types of soils shall be designed to suit the soil conditions of particular
type, from the recommendation of the geotechnical investigation report, which has to be approved
by the Employer.
Several types of foundations are used for different type of transmission towers and different types of
soil. The foundation should be strong and stable, and able to take care of all the loads like dead
load, live load, wind loads, seismic load, erection loads etc., causing vertical thrust, uplift as well as
horizontal reaction.
The quantity of foundations in every type given in the Price Schedule is provisional only and may
vary as per the result of the detail soil test.
Foundations should be designed for a working life of 50 years and Bidders should comply in full
with the requirements of these specifications in establishing his design. In all locations, all
steelwork, whether part of the tower or part of the stub-angle foundations shall be completely
encased in concrete to ensure a cover of 100mm from any part of the stub leg or tower from a point
300 mm above ground down to the base of the main foundation block. All Stubs shall have cleats
designed to carry the entire stub load.
The Contractor shall design at least one foundation for each of the foundation types specified on the
bid drawings for all types oftowers used in the line to produce an economical family drawings and
calculation for the approval of the Employer or Employer's representative before commencement of
construction. Upon completion of detail soil test, the Contractor shall select the most economical
foundation subject to the approval of the Employer or Employer's representative. The general
foundation design parameters are given in Schedule A. 13 and Conceptual Drawing is given in
Dwg. section.
2.2 Submittal
The Contractor shall submit for each type of foundation one set of design calculations, detail
drawings and reinforcing steel and concrete schedules to the Employer or Employer's representative
for review and comment before construction commences. Review of the foundation designs by the
Employer or Employer's representative in no way relieves the Contractor from his responsibility for
an adequate foundation design, even though this specification sets forth the basic foundation design
criteria. Upon receiving the Employer's or Employer's representative's comments, the Contractor
shall submit to the Employer required number of sets, electronic copy and prints of drawings of
all foundation details, including reinforcing steel schedules on drawing sheet sizes, form, heading,
etc., as required by the Employer for record.
2.3 Structural Design of Foundation
It comprises the design of chimney and the design of base slab / pyramid / block. Structure design
of chimney shall be suitable for maximum bending moments due to side thrust in transverse and
longitudinal directions combined with uplift (tension), down thrust (compression). The combined
uplift and bending shall determine the requirement of longitudinal reinforcement in the chimney.
The stub angle shall be embedded in the chimney to its full depth and anchored to the bottom slab /
pyramid. The chimney shall be designed considering the passive resistance of soil leaving 500mm
from ground level.
Design of foundation based on stub embedded in the chimney for required development length
alone and the same is not taken to bottom of the foundation, is not permitted.
a) Structural Design of Base Slab
The base slab in RCC foundation may be single stepped or uniform. The design of concrete
foundation shall be done as per Limit – state method of design given in IS: 456.
b) Criteria for Structural Design of Foundation
(a) Isolated identical footings shall be provided for each leg of the tower.
(b) All foundations shall be designed so as to satisfy and meet the following requirements:
i) The chimney of the foundation shall at least be 400 mm square providing a minimum
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 5 – Tower Foundation and Civil Works Page 5-3
clear concrete cover of not less than 100 mm over any part of the stub angle in case
of dry foundations and at least 450 mm square with minimum clear concrete cover of
not less than 150 mm over any part of the stub angle in case wet, fully submerged
foundations.
ii) The chimney top shall extend 500 mm (Minimum) above ground level and coping
shall be up to 50 mm below the joint between the bottom bracing and the leg
members.
iii) In all foundations, a lean concrete sub-base having a thickness of 100 mm and of size
equal the concrete pyramid base/RCC shall be provided under structural concrete.
The lean concrete shall be of grade M-10 (1:3:6) conforming to IS: 456-2000. The
lean concrete sub-base provided under the footings shall not be considered in the
structural calculations.
iv) The embedded end of the stub angle shall have a 150 mm thick clear concrete cover
up to the top of the lean concrete sub-base in the case of dry foundations and a 200
mm thick clear concrete cover in the case of wet, partially submerged and fully
submerged foundations.
v) The depth of foundation below ground level shall not be more than 3.0m.
vi) The centroidal axis of the stub shall coincide with axis of the chimney and pass
through the centre of the footing base. The design of the foundation shall take into
account the additionalforces resulting from eccentricity introduced due to non-
compliance of above requirements.
viii) The slab type isolated RCC foundations shall also satisfy and meet the following
requirements:
The structural design of foundations shall be strictly in accordance with IS:
456-2000 and other relevant IS codes.
The design of RCC foundations shall be carried out by Limit state method in
accordance with IS:456-2000.
The minimum thickness of footing slab at chimney perimeter shall not be less
than 300 mm.
The minimum thickness of footing slab at the edges shall not be less than 150
mm as specified in IS:456-2000.
In the design of the footing slabs, actual soil pressure under the footing shall
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 5 – Tower Foundation and Civil Works Page 5-4
The magnitudes of each of type of load depend on the type of tower and configuration of the
transmission lines.
4. Sandy soil
(a) with clay content 0-5% 10 1440 25,000
Unless specified otherwise, design and details shall comply with the latest published editions of BS
/IS 6403, IS456, IS 1786, CBIP Tower manual or with other standard specifications provided they
are of equal or higher standard where such standard exists with accepted national or international
good practice. Support foundation designs as detailed in the specification which in the opinion of
the Employer or Employer's representative do not demonstrate an acceptable type of foundation for
the type of soil condition so described will be rejected.
2.6 Foundation type
In some section of the proposed transmission line, water level of terrain is high. In such cases the
foundation is to be designed for fully submerged condition. If required by the Employer, the
Contractor shall construct embankments for tower sites where footings are located in standing water
of sloughs, pot holes and marshes. No separate payments shall be made for such embankments.
Reinforced cement concrete footing shall be used for all types of normal towers / extension towers
in conformity with the present day practices followed in the country and the specifications laid
herein. All the four footings of the tower and their extensions, if any shall be similar irrespective of
down thrust and uplift.
Foundation includes supply of materials such as cement, fine and coarse aggregates, water,
reinforcement steel and binding wire etc. Rates quoted for foundations shall include all items of
work relating to supply and installation of foundations such as form work, excavation and back
filing with good soil, compaction, stub setting, shoring & timbering etc. where ever required,
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 5 – Tower Foundation and Civil Works Page 5-6
placing of reinforcement in position, concreting and all other works related for completion of
foundation.
2.7 Classification of Foundations
o where cohesionless pure sand or negligible cohesion sand mixed with soil are met in dry
condition and The water table is below foundation base
o Which are in surface water for long periods with water penetration not exceeding one meter
below the ground level e.g. the paddy field.
o When the top layer of soil upto 1.5 m is black cotton/loose silty sandy soil and there after it
is normal dry cohesive soil.
To be used at locations
o where sub - soil water table is met at less than 0.75 m below the ground level and the soil is
normal and cohesive.
o To be used at locations where soil is cohesive having inorganic clay exceeding 15%, not
necessarily black in colour, which shrinks when dry and swells when wet, resulting in
differential movement. For designing foundations, for such locations, the soil is to be
considered submerged in nature.
o Fully submerged top layer consists of partly black cotton/ loose silty sandy soilfollowed by
ordinary fine grained soil strata.
In places, where soft rock, the decomposed or fissured rock, hard gravel, kankar, limestone, laterite
or any other hard soil strata , which can be excavated using normal tools with out blasting and the
water table is met at 1.5 meter or more below ground level
In case the undercut type foundation is to be used for fissured rock locations.
The additional strength obtainable from under cut provision will not be considered in the design of
foundation.
e) Hard Rock Foundation
The locations where chiseling, drilling and blasting is required for excavation, hard rock type
foundations are to be used. For these locations, rock anchoring by providing anchor bars
embedded into the grouted anchor holes to resist uplift forces. For design purpose, rock level shall
be considered at ground level and no over burden soil weight shall be considered for resisting the
uplift. In case of weathered rock / out crop rock, the first half meter rock from the surface will not
be considered for design purpose.
In addition to the above, depending on the site conditions other types of foundations shall also be
provided by the Bidder, suitable for intermediate conditions under the above classifications to affect
more economy.
2.8 Footings
The foundation shall be designed to carry maximum shear loads below ground level, that is, the stub
legs are not to be considered as reinforcement. Allowance shall be made for the loss of uplift
resistance due to overlap of frusta where applicable. Uplift foundations shall be cast against
undisturbed soil for a minimum height of 250mm and 50mm lean concrete.
For the purpose of bidding the Bidder shall design each type of foundation with the value of soil
bearing capacity as stated in Foundation Application Schedule.
These are only reference values and are taken from similar type of soil location from near by site.
After award of contract the Contractor shall carry out detail soil test of support site and shall design
each type of support foundation accordingly. No extra payment will be made for change in the
quantity of concrete/rebar and other associated works due to change in design parameters.
2.8.2 Pile Foundation
This type of foundation is usually adopted when soil is very weak and has very poor bearing
capacity or foundation has to be located in filled up soil or tower are to be erected in the land which
is prone to flash flood. Piles are long and slender members which transfer load to the deeper soil or
rock of high bearing capacity avoiding the shallow soil of low bearing capacity.
The piles should be cast in place fast setting concrete which should have 28 day cubical
compressive strength of 210 kg/sq.cm.
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 5 – Tower Foundation and Civil Works Page 5-8
The rock which cannot be excavated using normal tools and require chiseling, drilling and blasting
are classified as hard rock. These include hard sand stone, quartzite, granite, basalt, marble etc.
The foundation in hard rock shall be designed to carry maximum shear loads below ground level,
that is, the stub legs are not to be considered as reinforcement. Allowance shall be made for the loss
of uplift resistance due to overlap of frusta where applicable. The footing should be safe against
overturning. In case if it is unsafe against overturning, appropriate measures (e.g. counter weight)
should be provided.
2.9 Stub Angle Anchor
Tower Stub angles shall be of galvanized steel and shall have cross-sectional area of not less than
the structure leg member to which it will be attached. The stub angle shall not be included in the
calculation of the steel reinforcement requirements against bending and tension forces in concrete
foundation design.
Only those holes in the stub which have been previously punched and galvanized at the
manufactures works will be used for the attachment of cleats. Site drilling will not be permitted.
2.9.2 Stub setting template
- Stub leveling
- Stub rake
No concreting shall be commenced before the stub setting is approved by the Employer or
Employer's representative. After the completion of Works all the template sets shall be handed over
to Employer. No extra payment for the design, manufacturing and delivery for the templates shall
be claimed by the Contractor.
3 Excavation and Backfilling
3.1 Scope
This specification covers the general requirements of earthwork in excavation in different materials,
filling back around foundations, conveyance and disposal of surplus spoils or stacking them
properly as shown on the drawings and as directed by the Employer or Employer's representative
and all operations covered within the intent and purpose of this specification.
3.2 General
a. The Contractor shall furnish all tools, plants, instruments, qualified supervisory personnel,
labor, materials, any temporary works, consumable, and everything necessary, whether or not
such items are specifically stated herein, for completion of the job in accordance with
specification requirements.
b. The Contractor shall carry out the check survey of the site before excavation and set properly
all lines and establish levels for foundations.
c. The excavation shall be done to correct lines and levels. This shall also include, where required,
proper shoring to maintain excavations and also the furnishing, erecting and maintaining of
substantial barricades on ground excavated areas and warning lamps at night for ensuring
safety.
d. The item also includes for dumping of excavated materials in regular heaps, bunds, riprap with
regular slopes as directed by the Employer or Employer's representative, within the lead
specified and leveling the same so as to provide natural drainage. Rock/Soil excavated shall be
stacked properly as directed by the Employer or Employer's representative. As a rule, all softer
material shall be laid along the center of the heaps, the harder and more weather resisting
materials forming the casing on the sides and the top. Rock shall be stacked separately.
e. Clearing
The area to be excavated/filled shall be cleared of trees, plants, logs, stumps, bush, vegetation, rubbish,
slush etc. and other objectionable matter. If any roots or stumps of trees are met during excavation,
they shall also be removed. The materials so removed shall be burnt or disposed off as directed by the
Employer. Where earthfill is intended, the area shall be stripped of all loose/soft patches, topsoil
containing objectionable matter/materials before filling commences.
f. Precious object, relics, objects of archeological importance
All gold, silver, oil, mineral, archeological and other findings of importance, trees cut or other materials
of any description and all precious stones, coins, treasures, relics, antiquities and other similar things
which may be found in or upon the site shall be the property of the Employer and Contractor shall duly
preserve the same to the satisfaction of the Employer and from time to time deliver the same to such
person or persons as the Employer may from time to time authorize or appoint to receive the found
goods.
g. The Contractor shall excavate earth, rock, stumps and all other materials encountered as
required for construction of each foundation. The Contractor shall place all suitable excavated
material in backfill or in graded embankment in the immediate area at structures. Materials
found to be unsuitable for foundation backfill or grading shall be wasted and disposed at
Contractor's own cost.
h. The Contractor shall excavate each foundation hole to the nominal excavation depth for the
applicable foundation type except in case where the material being excavated is not capable of
supporting 0.5 kg/sq.cm.
i. At the nominal excavation depth, the foundation shall be carefully graded to a level plane and
all loose or disturbed material shall be removed. The foundation excavation shall then be
examined by the Contractor and a final determination will be made on the foundation type to be
used.
j. Excavations shall be maintained in a clean, safe and sound condition until completion of the
foundation construction and shall be diked to prevent flooding by surface runoff. Suitable
pumping equipment shall be provided and used to dewater excavations so that all installation
work and backfilling is performed in the dry state. Any previously prepared foundation bearing
surface that is softened by water runoff or otherwise contaminated before placement of the
structure foundation shall be excavated and replaced at the Contractor's expense.
k. Those excavations where the base is unstable, lies below groundwater level, or has been over
excavated, the Contractor shall furnish and place a layer of crushed stone, or selected backfill,
or borrow to stabilize the base for placement of foundation materials. No extra payment shall
be done for over-excavation and backfilled crushed stone layer.
l. Topsoil and excavated material that is suitable for backfill around the foundations shall be
stockpiled separately for use in backfill. Material that is unsuitable for backfill shall be disposed
of. The stockpiles shall be sloped to drain and shall be protected from rainfall or other elements,
which render the material unsuitable for backfill.
m. Backfill shall be placed in not greater than 20cm lifts before compaction. Each lift shall b
thoroughly compacted before the following lift is placed. Pneumatic or equivalent tampers shall
be used on cohesive materials; vibratory compactors shall be used on non-cohesive materials.
Compaction shall achieve a density at least equal to that of the surrounding undisturbed earth.
Large stones or rock fragments may be used in the backfill provided they do not interfere with
proper compaction. Particles larger than 25 cm shall be placed not nearer than 0.5 m of the
structure and at least 1.0m below ground surface.
n. Rock particles larger than 10 cm shall not be in contact with the concrete.
o. Following completion of 75 percent of the compacted backfill portion, the remaining backfill
and topsoil shall be placed and the topsoil mounded 30 cm above the ground surface and sloped
to drain. Compaction of this material will not be required. Before final acceptance of the
Works, the Contractor shall refill any locations that settle below the surface of the surrounding
ground.
p. Earth is defined as material which shall include all kinds of soil containing gravel, sand, silt,
moorum or shingle, gravel, clay, loam, peat, ash, etc. which can generally be excavated with
the aid of shovels and pick axes. This shall also include embedded rock boulders not longer
than one meter in any direction and not more than 200 mm in any of the other two directions.
q. Rock is defined as material which shall include rock, boulders, shale, chalk, slate, hard mica,
schist, laterite and all other materials which in the opinion of the Employer is rock and can be
removed with picks, hammer, wedges, crowbars, pneumatic breaking equipment and blasting.
This category shall also include excavation in macadam and tarred roads and pavements.
For selection of rock type foundation for any tower location, the characteristics of rock shall be
thoroughly investigated by the Contractor. Disintegrated rock or other types of rock such as
soluble limestone, soft shale, slate, hard pan and organic rocks may not be suitable for
construction of rock foundation.
s. All loose boulders, semidetached rocks (along with earthy mounds) not directly in the
excavation area but so close to the area to be excavated as to be liable, in the opinion of the
Employer, to fall or endanger the workman, equipment or the Works, shall be stripped off and
removed away from the area of the works. Any material not requiring removal as contemplated
in the work, but which in the opinion of the Employer is likely to become loose or unstable
later, shall also be promptly and satisfactorily removed as directed by the Employer.
t. Payment: No separate or direct payment will be made to the Contractor for preparation of site,
excavation, and backfill and rock excavation of tower foundation. All costs of soil and rock
excavation incurred in connection therewith shall be included in the unit bid prices for the
construction of the various foundation types.
However, payment for the excavation and backfilling for foundation protection such as stone
masonry work, removing unsafe boulders and earthwork near the foundation site, construction of
embankment and stripping ground to obtain ground clearance between earth and conductor will be
made at unit price bid specified in the Price Schedule. Therefore in the Price Schedule the unit bid price
shall include full compensation for all costs incurred in furnishing all materials and labor and
other operation costs.
4 Dewatering
4.1 Scope
This specification covers the general requirements of dewatering during excavations in general.
a. All excavations shall be kept free of water. Grading in the vicinity of excavations shall be
controlled to prevent surface water running into excavated areas.
The Contractor shall remove by pumping or other means approved by the Employer or
Employer's representative any water inclusive of rainwater and subsoil water accumulated in
excavation and keep all excavations/trenches free of water required for further work.
Method of pumping shall be approved by the Employer or Employer's representative; but in
any case, the pumping arrangement shall be such that there shall be no movement of subsoil or
blowing-in due todifferential head of water during pumping. Pumping arrangements shall be
adequate to ensure no delays in construction.
b. When there is a continuous inflow of water and quantum of water to be handled is
considered in the opinion of the Employer as large, well- point system- single stage or
multistage shall be adopted. The Contractor shall submit to the Employer his scheme of
well-point system including the stages, the spacing number and diameter of well points,
headers, etc., and the number, capacity and location of pumps for approval.
c. Payment: No separate or direct payment will be made to the Contractor for dewatering of
tower foundation and any other foundation works. All costs incurred in connection therewith
shall be included in the unit bid prices for the construction of the various foundations and
other civil works.
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 5 – Tower Foundation and Civil Works Page 5-13
5 Timber Shoring
5.1 Scope
This specification covers the general requirements of timber shoring for open excavations for
structure foundation.
a. Close timbering shall be done by completely covering the sides of the pits generally with
short, upright members called polling boards. These shall be of minimum 25 cm x 4-cm
sections or as directed by the Employer or Employer's representative.
The boards shall generally be placed in position vertically side by side without any
gap on each side of the excavation and shall be secured by horizontal walling of strong
wood at maximum 1.2 meters spacing, strutted with bellies or as directed by the Employer
or Employer's representative. The length of the bellies struts shall depend on the excavation
and supported by vertical walling, which in turn shall be suitably strutted. The lowest boards
supporting the sides of the trench or pit shall remain exposed, so as to render the earth liable
to slip out.
b. Timber shoring shall be 'close' or 'open' type, depending on the nature of soil and the depth
of pit. The type of timbering shall be as approved by the Employer. It shall be the
responsibility of Contractor to take all necessary steps to prevent the sides of excavations,
pits, etc., from collapsing.
c. Timber shoring may be required to keep the sides of excavations vertical to ensure safety of
adjoining structures or to limit the slope of excavations, or due to space restrictions or for
other reasons. Such shoring shall be carried out, except in an emergency, only under
instruction from the Employer.
d. Payment: No separate payment will be made to the Contractor for timber shoring. All costs
incurred in connection therewith shall be included in the unit bid prices for the construction
of the various foundation types and other civil works.
6 Select Borrow
a. Where the material excavated for the foundation is unsuitable for backfill or is required for
construction of embankment, the Contractor shall provide and compact select borrow.
Excavated material shall be disposed at the Contractor's own expense.
b. Material for select borrow shall be well-graded bank-run gravel, relatively free from clay,
loam or vegetation matter and with no stones over 10 cm in maximum dimensions, or
materials of equivalent strength and characteristics. Representative sample from proposed
borrow sources shall be submitted to the Employer for approval of the borrow source.
Approval of borrow source shall not mean automatic approval of all materials obtained from
that source.
c. The Contractor shall, at his option, use areas approved by the Employer or Employer's
representative for production of select borrow or at his own expense, make arrangements for
obtaining select borrow at other sources.
d. The select borrow shall be placed and compacted as specified for the backfill in Article 3.3
Excavation and Backfilling.
e. Payment: No separate payment will be made to the Contractor for select borrow required for
back filling tower foundation. Hence, all costs incurred in connection therewith shall be
included in the unit bid prices for the construction of the various foundation types and other
civil works.
7 Foundation Construction
All materials and labor required for the construction of foundations shall be furnished by the
Contractor.
a. The Contractor will be required to remove and replace at his expense any materials
incorporated in the work that do not conform to these specifications.
b. The Contractor shall furnish without any extra cost all materials the Employer require for
testing. The cost of the tests shall be borne by the Contractor.
c. The final selection of the type of foundation footing to be actually constructed for each
particular structure will be done by the Contractor after the results of the sub soil tests and shall
be subject to the approval of the Employer.
Measurement for payment for the Contract item, Foundations, shall be on the basis of the actual
number of each type leg of structure foundations constructed by the Contractor. The additional
concrete and rebar required by the special foundation aside from the foundation schedule shall be
paid as per the unit rates of the foundation protection works for concrete and re-bars.
7.2.1 Payment
Payment for the contract item, “Foundation” except for pile foundation, will be made at the unit price
per tower, such unit price shall include full compensation for all costs incurred in furnishing all
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 5 – Tower Foundation and Civil Works Page 5-15
materials, equipment and labor and all other operations related to Foundation design and construction,
including but not limited to:
a. Performing detail foundation design and preparation of construction drawings.
b. Supply and transporting all foundation materials such as concrete, reinforcement, etc to the job
site.
g. Lean concrete
Payment for the pile foundation will be made at the the unit price per set of pile foundation for single
tower, such unit price shall include full compensation for all costs incurred in furnishing all materials,
equipment and labor and all other operations related to Foundation design and construction, including
but not limited to:
a. Performing detail foundation design and preparation of construction drawings.
b. Supply and transporting all foundation materials such as concrete, reinforcement, etc to the job
site.
g. Formworks
The price schedule includes the rates per set of pile foundation for 12m and 16 m underground length
of the pile. In case the actual underground length differs from the given length of the pile, payment will
be made by interpolating or extrapolating with the quoted rate.
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 5 – Tower Foundation and Civil Works Page 5-16
b. ACI refers to the latest edition of publications of American Concrete Institute, P.O. Box 19150,
Redford Station, and Detroit, Michigan 48219.
c. BIS referrers to the latest ,Bureau of Indian Standard ManakBhawan, 9. Bahadur Shah
ZafarMarg, New Delhi India.
b. Bag - Wherever used in these specifications, bag will be understood to mean 50-kg bag of
Portland cement. Concrete shall be composed of cement, sand, coarse aggregate, water and
admixtures, if required, all well mixed and brought to the proper consistency.
7.2.4 Concrete
The Contractor shall design and test concrete mixes, which have 28-day cubicle compressive strength
of 210 kg/sq.cm.
a. At least one month prior to the placement of any concrete, the Contractor shall make a set of
test concrete compressive strength test cubes for each design mix under field conditions. The
test cubes shall be made and tested in accordance with the applicable standards.
b. The concrete mix shall be of such proportions as to produce a plastic and workable mix which
will not separate during the placing and will finish well without using excessive quantities of
mixing water. Addition of water to compensate for stiffening of concrete before placing will
not be permitted. Uniformity in concrete consistency from batch to batch will be required.
c. After the test results are known for the field condition test cubes, the Contractor shall submit
these result to the Employer or Employer's representative and the Employer or Employer's
representative will notify the Contractor of the approval of test results and the acceptable design
mixes.
d. When placing concrete in hot weather, the recommendations of the American Concrete
Institute's publication "Recommended Practice for Hot Weather Concreting"(ACI 605) or
equivalent shall be followed insofar as the Employer or Employer's representative may direct.
Concrete to be placed under water shall be deposited by tremie, and only after it has
been determined by the Employer or Employer's representative that placing of concrete in an
unwatered excavation cannot be practically accomplished by any other means. The tremie will
not be allowed to drop below the level of water outside. Under no circumstances will concrete
be allowed to drop through water within the tremie.
The tremie shall be watertight and sufficiently large to permit a free flow of concrete.
The bottom of the tremie shall be as near to the surface against which the concrete is to be
placed as practicable and the tremie shall not be raised until seal has been established by the
concrete sufficiently to prevent the entry of water of the tremie. The discharge of the tremie
shall be kept submerged in concrete at sufficient depth so as to maintain an adequate seal
during underwater placement. Placing of concrete shall proceed without interruption until
underwater placing in the foundation has been accomplished. As placing of concrete under
water progresses, the Contractor shall remove water displaced by the concrete when the top of
the concrete being placed by tremie reaches the elevation of the water table level; no further
placement by tremie shall be performed.
f. The concrete used as lean concreteor base concrete shall be as mentioned on
respectivedrawings.Theaggregatesizeshallbe40mmnominal.Baseconcrete
shallbewellcompacted. Thetopsurfaceofbaseconcreteshallbeleveledbefore placing the
reinforcement.
g. During excavation, if excavation exceeds the required depthor if any loose pocket of
earthismet belowthe baseoffooting,thenthelooseearthshallberemovedor
excavationdepthbeincreasedtillnormalhardsoilismetaspersatisfactionofthe
Employer.Thisextradepthshallbefilledwithleanconcrete.Noextra shall be paid on account
ofthis extraexcavation and lean concrete.
i. The Water Cement ratio shall be minimum 0.50 and maximum 0.55.
j. Forvolumetricuseofingredientsforconcretemix,thecontractoralongwiththeMix
Design shall intimate the size ofmeasuring boxes along with the Mix design.
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 5 – Tower Foundation and Civil Works Page 5-18
k. Thenominalof MixDesignshallnotabsolvethecontractorfromtheresponsibilityof
achievingtherequiredstrength,workabilityetc. duringactualexecution.Incaseof failureof
concretesamples,theworkdoneisliableto berejected.In suchcasethe
contractorshallrecastthefoundationat thesamelocationbydismantlingtherejected foundation or
ata near by location as directed by the Employer. Incase ofhoney
combing,thecontractorshalldothepressuregroutingasdirectedandto thefull
satisfactionoft h e Employer.Theconstructionofnewfoundationinplaceofrejectedone and
pressure grouting if done shallbe withoutany extra payment.
l. Thewaterusedformixingconcreteandforcuringpurposeshallbefresh, cleanand
freefromoils,acidsandalkalis, organicmaterialsorotherdeleterioussubstance.
Potablewaterisgenerallypreferred.Saltishorbrackishwatershallnotbeused. Water used shall
conform to clause 5.4 of IS 456.
In locations where conditions do not require high sulphate resistance, cement shall conform to the
requirements of ASTM C150 Type T or equivalent( IS263, IS8112,IS12269)
a. In locations where, in the opinion of the Employer or Employer's representative, the conditions
require the use of high sulphate resistance cement, cement conforming to the requirements of
ASTM C150 Type V or equivalent shall be used. No extra payment will be made to the
Contractor for the use of high sulphate resistance cement.
b. The aggregates shall consist of clean, natural material or, subject to the approval of the
Employer or Employer's representative, manufactured aggregates may be used.
c. Aggregates shall be separated into sand and coarse aggregate before being used. The Employer
or Employer's representative will permit no pit or crusher run materials without prior approval.
d. Natural fine aggregate or sand shall be graded within the following limits and the fineness
module be between 2.5 and 2.8 as per IS 383:
Sieve size
Amounts Finer than
Laboratory (U.S Std. Each weight Percent
Sieve)
3/8 (9.5mm) 100
4 -4.75 95 to 100
8 (2.36mm) 80 to 100
16 (1.18mm) 50 to 85
30 (600 micron) 25 to 60
50 (300 micron) 10 to 30
100 (150 micron) 2 to 10
Natural coarse aggregate shall be graded within the following limits, depending upon the clear spacing
between reinforcing bars.
7.2.6 Slump
All concrete used shall have a slump of maximum 120mm and minimum 75mm at the time of placing.
The water cement ratio shall be determined by consideration of the specified strength, the water
reducing admixtures, the slump required for proper placement, air entraining requirements the available
and maximum allowable aggregate size and its specific gravity, and the amount of water carried on the
aggregates.
The slumps and maximum sizes of aggregate as well as, the computation of trail mixes shall be as
described in the America concrete Institute Recommended Practice for Selected Proportions for
concrete (ACI 613).
Cement and aggregates shall be stored at the Site of the work in such manner as to prevent
deterioration or intrusion of foreign matter in Contractor’s own cost. Special care shall be taken in
storing cement to keep it thoroughly dry at all times.
a. Cement that has been caked in storage is still usable only if, when pressed between the thumb
and fingers, it powders readily. Otherwise, its use will not be permitted.
b. When reinforcing steel is delivered to the job in advance of the Contractor's requirements, the
Contractor shall provide suitable protection in order to prevent excessive rust developing on the
reinforcing steel as it will be Contractor's responsibility to remove the excessive rust.
Before any concrete mixing is begun, all equipment for mixing, transporting and debris shall be
cleaned of all dirt and debris. All dirt and debris shall also be removed from the places to be occupied
by the concrete.
a. All mechanical equipment shall be checked before starting a concrete pour to ascertain whether
or not it is in good operating condition and if not shall be tuned-up, or repaired, or replaced to
the satisfaction of the Employer or Employer's representative. Also the stock of construction
material (cement, aggregate and sand) shall be checked before starting the concreting work to
ascertain whether or not it is in sufficient quantity for one foundation work.
b. When a foundation location is ready for concrete placement, the Employer shall be notified at
least 24 hours prior to concreting so that he may inspect to assure that the excavation is free of
water, mud and debris; that the bottom surface of the excavation is well leveled and compacted;
and where required, a crushed stone sub-base has been placed; that the reinforcing steel is
properly secured in place; and that the formwork is properly braced.
c. Rock surfaces shall be as flat as possible and projecting ridges shall be leveled off before the
concrete is placed or spaces between the ridges shall have been previously filled with concrete
to form a horizontal surface.
d. The Contractor shall see that all material that is to be embedded in the concrete has been placed
before the concrete is placed. The Contractor shall be responsible for the accurate location of all
embedded materials. Any work inaccurately or improperly set shall be relocated and reset at the
Contractor's expense.
e. All batching components of the concrete shall be accurately measured. Measuring on a weight
basis is preferred, however, measuring on a volume basis will be allowed as long as careful
controls are maintained. Weight measurements shall be made using standard batching
equipment for large quantities and wheelbarrow scales for small quantities. Volume
measurements shall be made in batching boxes. The batching boxes shall be as large as is
practical.
f. The batch mixer shall be rotated at a speed recommended by the manufacturer and mixing shall
be continued for at least one and one-half (1-1/2) minutes after all materials are in the mixer,
unless the size of the batch is over 1.2 cu.m., when additional mixing time shall be required as
advised by the Employer. A mechanically-operated batch mixer shall be used for mixing unless
otherwise approved by the Employer.
g. The tempering of concrete which has partially hardened, that is, remixing with or without
additional cement, aggregate or water, will not be permitted.
h. Concrete shall be conveyed from the mixer to the place of final deposit within 30 minutes by
methods which will prevent the segregation or loss of the materials. After 30 minutes of mixing
the concrete shall be rejected and replaced by fresh concrete without any extra cost to the
Employer.
i. Equipment for chuting, pumping and pneumatically conveying concrete shall be of such size
and design as to ensure a practically continuous flow of concrete at the delivery end without
separation of the materials. The chutes shall never be on a slope that is steeper than two vertical
to three horizontal. Conveying equipment shall not have any aluminum parts that come in
contact with the concrete.
j. When the concrete is to be placed on hard rock or other concrete, after the existing surface has
been properly cleaned and otherwise prepared, the existing surface is to be wetted until it is
saturated. The first batch of concrete placed shall be a grout obtained by omitting the coarse
aggregate from the mix and reducing the water as required. The grout shall be evenly spread on
the water-saturated surface and then the concrete shall be deposited continuously and as rapidly
as practicable.
k. The concreting shall be carried on at such a rate that the concrete is at all time plastic and flows
readily into the spaces between the bars and so that each successive layer properly bonds with
its predecessor. Successive layers shall be placed within 15 minutes of the preceding layer.
l. When placing foundations with drops over 2 meters, hoppers and trunks must be provided of a
size to allow for proper placing.
Not less than four hoppers of any size shall be available and used, if requested, and a sufficient
number of sections of trunk shall be furnished to reach within 500 mm of the bottom of the
foundation.
m. The concrete shall be compacted during and after depositing by vibration. The concrete shall be
thoroughly worked around embedded materials.
n. All concrete must be consolidated by means of internal vibration except where the Employer
has given written permission to use some other method of consolidation. The type and make of
vibrator must have a speed of at least 6,000 vibrations per minute (VPM) when the machine is
being supplied at its rated voltage, air pressure, etc. The Contractor shall at his own expense,
furnish sufficient transformers, compressors, etc. of approved type to operate all vibrators at the
voltage, pressure, etc., specified by the manufacturer.
o. The Contractor shall always have at least two vibrators in operating condition at the location of
the concrete placement.
The Contractor shall make one set of concrete compressive strength test cubes for each structure or as
directed by the Employer or Employer's representative. There shall be three cubes to a set and the
cubes shall be made in accordance with ASTM C31. Only one cube shall be made from any one batch
containing less the 1/2 cubic meters of concrete. The Contractor shall also make one set of concrete
compressing strength test cube for each new batch of cement purchased two week before using that
cement.
After the cubes have aged at least 24 hours in the field, the Contractor shall deliver them to a location
designated by the Employer where they will be tested in accordance with ASTM C39/IS 516. If two of
the cubes tested at 28-day tests indicate a compressive strength of 210kg/sq.cm (3,000 psi ) or more,
the remaining cubes shall be discarded. If the 28-day compressive strength indicates a compressive
strength of less than 210kg/sq.cm., the Employer or Employer's representative will determine what
remedial measures are necessary and the Contractor shall perform the remedial measures at his own
expense. The remedial measures may include, but are not limited to, the replacement of the entire
foundation.
7.2.9 Concrete formwork
Forms shall be used, wherever necessary, to confine the concrete for structures and shape it to the
required lines, or to insure against contamination of the concrete by materials caving or sloughing from
adjacent surfaces left by excavation.
a. Forms shall have sufficient strength to withstand the pressure resulting from placement and
vibration of the concrete, and shall be maintained rigidly in position. Forms shall be sufficiently
tight to prevent loss of mortar from the concrete. Molding strips shall be placed in the corners
of forms so as to produce chamfered edges on permanently exposed concrete surfaces. All
exposed surfaces may be formed with any material of adequate strength and tightness to hold
the wet concrete in proper position and prevent the loss of mortar.
b. If plywood or steel forms are not readily available, the Contractor with Employer's special
recommendation may substitute wood planking provided exposed surfaces are rubbed to
remove ridges on exposed surfaces.
c. The Contractor shall provide templates, which firmly hold the stub angles within 10 mm of the
horizontal side setting dimensions and within 5 mm of the required elevation during the placing
of the concrete. Details of the templates shall be submitted to the Employer or Employer's
representative at least one month before the commencement of any foundation construction.
The bottom portion of the structure may be used for this purpose providing that adequate
cribbing and bracing are supplied for support.
d. Before concrete is placed, the surfaces of all forms shall be oiled with a form oil that effectively
prevents sticking and will not stain the concrete surfaces. For wood forms, form oil shall
consist of straight, refined, pale paraffin mineral oil. For steel forms, form oil shall consist of
refined mineral oil compound.
e. Forms shall be removed only when the strength of the concrete is such that form removal will
not result in cracking, spelling, or breaking of edges of surfaces, or other damage to the
concrete. Usually formwork shall be removed after 48 hours from concreting times. Any
concrete damaged by form removal or otherwise shall be repaired immediately without any
extra cost to the Employer.
a. The exposed top surfaces of all concrete foundation piers shall be slightly sloped to prevent the
accumulation of water.
b. Immediately after the removal of forms, the holes left by form tie rod fasteners shall be filled
with mortar and all damaged or defective concrete shall be repaired or removed and replaced to
the satisfaction of the Employer or Employer's representative. Improperly consolidated
concrete shall be removed by chipping, and the chipped openings or recesses shall be of such
depth and shape as required by the Employer or Employer's representative to insure that the
patching material placed in the openings or recesses will be thoroughly keyed and bonded to
the concrete. "Dry pack" mortar shall be used for filling relatively deep required for the
replacement of defective concrete where surface dimensions of the chipped openings or
recesses are relatively large. The depth of chipped recesses for concrete patches shall extend at
least 25 mm beyond the nearest reinforcing steel.
c. To ensure proper curing, all concrete shall be kept moist for a period of at least 10 days. Burlap
or an equivalent material or a curing compound shall be applied over exposed concrete
surfaces. The burlap shall be kept moist at all times. If the foundation is backfilled before the
one-week curing time has elapsed, the burlap protection shall remain on the exposed projection.
Membrane curing compound shall be applied uniformly by spray, leaving no pinholes or gaps, at a
rate not to exceed 4.91 square meter per liter. The curing compound shall be applied after finishing
operations are completed and surface moisture has disappeared. If forms are removed prior to 7
days after placing the concrete, the uncovered surfaces shall be coated with the curing compound as
specified herein.
a. Foundation shall not be backfilled before they have been inspected to see that they are free
from surface defects and voids, or that the defects and voids have been properly repaired.
b. The foundations shall not be subjected to any loads in addition to those existing at the time of
the placing of the foundation concrete until the curing period has elapsed.
7.2.12 Payment
No separate or direct payment will be made to the Contractor for concrete, lean concrete, tests, curing,
form works for foundations. All costs incurred in connection therewith shall be included in price
schedule in the unit bid price for the construction of the various types of tower foundation.
7.2.13 Torsteel Reinforcing Bar
All torsteel-reinforcing bars shall conform to the requirements of Grade fe-415 (IS :1786) and shall be
fabricated in accordance with the "Manual of Standard Practice" of the Concrete Reinforcing Steel
Institute.
a. Mill scale, rust, oil and mud shall be removed from reinforcing steel by firm rubbing with
burlap or equivalent treatment before the reinforcing steel is placed.
b. The minimum center-to-center distance between parallel bars shall be two and one-half (2-1/2)
times the diameter of the bars. In no case shall the clear spacing between bars be less than 25
mm nor less than one and one-third (1-1/3) times the maximum size of coarse aggregate.
c. All torsteel-reinforcing bars shall have a protective concrete cover of not less than:
- 50 mm - on the bottoms of footings and on any surface of concrete that will be exposed
to salt water.
d. Torsteel reinforcing bar shall be accurately located and shall be secured in position by the use
of annealed iron wire of no less than No.16 gauge, and shall be supported in a manner that will
keep the reinforcement away from the exposed concrete surfaces. Concrete blocks shall be used
to support the reinforcing steel in the foundation mat; broken stones or wooden blocks shall not
be used for supporting the reinforcing steel.
7.2.14 Payment
No separate or direct payment will be made to the Contractor for reinforcement bars of tower
foundation. All costs incurred in connection therewith shall be included in the unit bid price for the
construction of the various foundation types.
8 Foundation Protection Works
The Contractor shall suggest for foundation protection works where needed. The Employer will
evaluate and give instruction for the protection design. The Contractor shall design the protection work
and submit design of such protection works for Employer's or Engineer’s approval.
8.1 Random rubble stone masonry including excavation (1:5 cement concrete)
The stone shall be hand placed with uncoursed close joints to the lines and grades as designed. The
rubble stone shall be placed with 1:5 cement mortar after having joints thoroughly moistened. The
surface joints shall be finished with 1:3 cement mortar.
After completion of masonry wall, it shall be cured with water for more than 10 hrs.
Weep-holes with Perforated Poly Vinyl Choride (PVC) pipes of 10 cm in diameter shall be made in
each 2 sq.m. of slope surface of the masonry wall or as required by site conditions. The upper surface
of the masonry wall shall be finish smooth with concrete. The perforated pipe shall be extended at least
30 cm both ends from the stone masonry wall & in the backfilling end the perforated PVC shall be
covered with gravel at least 30 cm in all-around.
The sides of the stone masonry wall should be backfilled, compacted and leveled as directed by
Engineer.
Payment:
Measurement for payment of Random rubble stone masonry works shall be made on the basis of actual
placed volume of stone masonry in cubic meters. Payment shall be made for the number of cubic
meters measured as provided at the unit price specified in the schedule. The unit price shall include all
labor, tools and equipment, materials including furnishing, transporting and placing the materials,
installation of PVC pipes, excavation, gravel packing and all other cost necessary for the performance
and completion of the work
8.2 Stone bound in galvanizing wire netting including excavation
The standard type gabion shall be a flexible hot dip galvanized gabion of the type and size specified
below. It is made of wire mesh of the type and size and selvedge as specified in the following:
- The mesh shall be hexagonal woven mesh with the joints formed by twisting each pair of wires
through three and half turns.
- The size of mesh shall conform to the standard specification issued by the factory and shall be
not greater than 1/3 of the smallest stone filled in the gabion.
- All wire used in the fabrication of the gabions and in the wiring operations during construction
shall be "Mild steel wire", i.e. wire having average tensile strength of 44 kg/sq.mm.
- The diameter of the wire used in the fabrication of the netting shall be at least 3.0 mm
depending on the design requirement.
- All wires used in the fabrication of the gabions and in the wiring operations during construction
shall be hot dip galvanized.
All edges of the standard gabions including end panels and the diaphragms, if any, shall be
mechanically selvedge in such a way as to prevent unraveling of the mesh and to develop the full
strength of the mesh. The wire used for the selvedge shall have a diameter greater than that of the wire
used to form the mesh. Wire having a diameter of 3.0 mm and the selvedge wire shall have diameter
equal to or greater than 3.9 mm.
The stone for the gabion shall be taken from the quarry or river deposit material or as approved by the
Employer or Employer's representative. The rock shall be of compact, firmly-bound and uniformly
grain texture and absolutely weather-resistance, shall not have cracks, holes, laminations or detrimental
materials. The stone blocks shall be of natural irregular cubical shape. The thin sliced blocks shall not
be accepted. The size of stone shall be at least 10 cm.
The sides of the gabion wall should be backfilled, compacted and leveled as directed by Engineer.
The standard gabion shall have following dimension:
Length : 2.0 meter
Width : 1.0 meter
Height : 1.0 meter
Sufficient lacing and connecting wire shall be supplied with the gabions for all the wiring operations to
be carried out in the construction of the gabion work. The quantity of such wire is estimated to be 8%
of the gabion supplied. The 2.4 mm lacing wire shall be used for the gabion made of wire gauge 3.0
mm.
Payment:
Measurement for payment of gabion works shall be made on the basis of actual placed volume of
gabions in cubic meters. Payment shall be made for the number of cubic meters measured as provided
at the unit price specified in the schedule. The unit price shall include all labour, equipment, materials,
backfilling with compaction and all other cost necessary for the performance and completion of the
works.
8.3 M15 Concrete Nominal Mix 1:2:4 for top seal cover: P.C.C.
Top of the gabion wall and stone masonry wall shall be sealed with M15 concrete cover. The thickness
of the cover shall be minimum 75mm or as directed by Employer’s representative.
Payment:
Measurement for payment of “M15 Concrete Nominal Mix 1:2:4 for top seal cover” works shall be
made on the basis of actual placed volume of Concrete in cubic meters. Payment shall be made for the
number of cubic meters measured as provided at the unit price specified in the schedule. The unit price
shall include all labour, equipment, materials and all other cost necessary for the performance and
completion of the works.
8.4 Slope Cutting and revetment works:
This section covers the cutting of slopes where sufficient electrical ground clearance of the line is not
available. After slope cutting, revetment wall shall be constructed as directed by Engineer. Back
filling of the revetment wall shall be done with leveling.
Payment:
Measurement for payment of “Slope cutting and revetment Works” works shall be made on the basis
of actual cut volume of slopes in cubic meters. Payment shall be made for the number of cubic meters
measured as provided at the unit price specified in the schedule. The unit price shall include all labour,
equipment, materials, revetment walls and all other cost necessary for the performance and completion
of the works.
CHAPTER-6
LINE CONDUCTOR
1 General
The scope of work comprises of supply and stringing of ACSR "Cardinal" conductor for 132 kV
transmission line from Dhalkebar to Lohapatti.
2 Conductor Specification
All conductors shall be of aluminium conductor steel reinforced (ACSR) construction and shall be
manufactured in strict conformity with BS 215 Part 2. Bidders must offer conductor from reputable and
experienced manufacturers with not less than five years manufacturing experience and the
manufacturers shall possess manufacturing and testing facilities for producing the offered conductor at
the time of bidding.
The steel core and the first layer of aluminium of ACSR conductors shall be greased. The grease shall
be of neutral type and at a temperature of 100-degree centigrade. The grease shall neither flow within
nor extrude from the conductor. The grease shall retain its properties as resistance to oxidization and
chemical stability at all service temperatures.
The outermost layer of all conductors shall be stranded with right hand lay.
The correct tension must be maintained on the stranding machine when spinning the cable to avoid the
possibility of bird caging during stringing. Any conductor not complying may be rejected at the
discretion of the Employer.
The purity of the aluminium shall be the highest commercially available and not less than 99.5%, the
copper content not exceeding 0.04%. The Contractor shall submit certificates of analysis giving the
percentage and nature of any impurities in the metal from which the wires are made. Aluminium wires
shall be made to BS 2627 and steel wires to BS 4565.
Precautions shall be taken during the manufacture, storage and erection of steel-cored aluminium
conductors to prevent the possibility of contamination by copper or other materials, which may
adversely affect the aluminium. The manufacture of steel-cored aluminium conductors shall be carried
out in a portion of the factory specially set aside for such purposes. Machinery previously used in the
manufacture of copper or copper bearing conductors shall not be used for the manufacture of these
aluminium or steel wires.
2.1 Conductor drum lengths
Conductors shall be supplied on drums of approved construction and the drums shall be securely
battened to protect the conductor. Drum battens shall not be removed until the drum is properly
mounted at the drum station on the line and battens shall be immediately refitted to the drum if any
surplus conductor is left thereon.
Each drum shall be marked with length and size of the conductor and in addition, the conductor
manufacturing batch number shall be inscribed on the drum. Empty drums shall become the property
of the Employer and be returned by the Contractor to the Employer's stores nominated by the
Employer. The maximum length of conductor shall not exceed 2 km per drum.
2.2 Creep of ACSR-conductors
When stringing ACSR-conductors the creep shall be adopted into account. A suitable method is for
stringing the conductor to a higher tension. This is expressed as a temperature difference corresponding
to the estimated creep.
Unless more reliable data is available, the temperature difference for Cardinal-conductor as may be
used.
2.3 Details of ACSR Conductors
The ACSR Conductor shall generally conform to BS: 215(Part-2) /IS: 398 (Part-II) except where
otherwise specified herein.
The details of the ACSR CARDINAL Conductor are tabulated below:
1.0 Designation as per BS-215(Part-2)
2.0 Stranding and wire diameter 54/3.38 mm Aluminium +7/3.38 mm
steel
3.0 Number of Strands
3.1 Steel core 1
3.2 1st steel layer 6
3.3 1st Aluminium layer 12
3.4 2nd Aluminium layer 18
3.5 3rd Aluminium layer 24
4.0 Sectional area of Aluminium 484.5 sq. mm
5.0 Total sectional area 547.3 sq. mm
6.0 Overall diameter 30.42 mm
7.0 Approximate mass 1833 (Kg/ KM)
8.0 Calculated D.C. resistance at 20 ® C 0.05979 Ohm/KM
9.0 Minimum UTS 15,381 kg
10.0 Modulus of Elasticity 7,036 kg/Sq mm
11.0 Co-efficient of Linear Expansion 19.3 x 10-6 per 0C
12.0 Standard Un jointed length on reel 2,000 m
joist shall be made by cold pressure butt-welding and shall be such that no two such joints are within
15 metres of each other in the complete stranded conductor.
b) Steel Wires
There shall be no joint of any kind in the finished wire entering into the manufacture of the strand nor
strand joint or strand splices in any length of the complete stranded steel core of the conductor.
2.5 Materials
The Aluminium strands shall be hard drawn from electrolyticaluminium rods having a purity of not
less than 99.5% and a copper content not exceeding 0.04%. They shall have the same properties and
characteristics as prescribed in IEC:889-1987.
The steel wire strands shall be drawn from high carbon steel wire rods produced by either the acid or
basic open hearth process, the electric furnace process, or the basic oxygen process and shall conform
to the following requirements as to the chemical composition:
Element % composition
Carbon 0.50 to0.85
Manganese 0.50 to1.10
Phosphorus Not more than 0.035
Sulphur Not more than 0.045
Silicon 0.10 to0.35
The steel wire stands shall have the same properties and characteristics as proscribed for regular
strength steel wire in IEC:888-1987..
The zinc used for galvanizing shall be electrolytic high grade Zinc of 99.95% purity. It shall conform
to and satisfy all the requirements of IS:209.
2.6 Packing
The conductor shall be supplied in non-returnable, strong, wooden drums provided with lagging of
adequate strength, constructed to protect the conductor against all damage and displacement during
transit, storage and subsequent handling and stringing operations in the field. The Supplier shall be
responsible for any loss or damage during transportation handling and storage due to improper packing.
The drums shall generally conform to IS: 1778, except as otherwise specified hereinafter.
The drums shall be suitable for wheel mounting and for letting off the conductor under a minimum
controlled tension of the order of 5 KN.
The general outline of the drum for conductor shall be as in the annexed drawings. The Bidder should
submit their proposed drum drawings along with the bid.
For conductor, one standard length shall be wound on each drum.
All wooden components shall be manufactured out of seasoned soft wood free from defects that may
materially weaken the component parts of the drums. Preservative treatment shall be applied to the
entire drum with preservatives of a quality which is not harmful to the conductor.
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 6 – Line Conductor Page 6-4
The flanges shall be of two ply construction with each ply at right angles to the adjacent ply and nailed
together. The nails shall be driven from the inside face flange, punched and then clenched on the outer
face. The thickness of each ply shall not vary by more than 3mm from that indicated in the figure.
There shall be at least 3 nails per plank of ply with maximum nail spacing of 75mm. Where a slot is cut
in the flange to receive the inner end of the conductor the entrance shall be in line with the periphery of
the barrel.
The wooden battens used for making the barrel of the conductor shall be of segmental type. These shall
be nailed to the barrel supports with at least two nails. The battens shall be closely butted and shall
provide a round barrel with smooth external surface. The edges of the battens shall be rounded or
chamfered to avoid damage to the conductor.
Barrel studs shall be used for the construction of drums. The flanges shall be holed and the barrel
supports slotted to receive them. The barrel studs shall be threaded over a length on either end,
sufficient to accommodate washers, spindle plates and nuts for fixing flanges at the required spacing.
Normally, the nuts on the studs shall stand protruded of the flanges. All the nails used on the inner
surface of the flanges and the drum barrel shall be counter sunk. The ends of barrel shall generally be
flushed with the top of the nuts.
The inner cheek of the flanges and drum barrel surface shall be painted with bitumen based paint.
Before reeling, card board or double corrugated or thick bituminized water-proof bamboo paper shall
be secured to the drum barrel and inside of flanges of the drum by means of a suitable commercial
adhesive material. After reeling the conductor, the exposed surface of the outer layer of conductor
shall be wrapped with water proof thick bituminized bamboo paper to preserve the conductor from dirt,
grit and damage during transport and handling.
A minimum space of 75 mm for conductor shall be provided between the inner surface of the external
protective tagging and outer layer of the conductor.
Each batten shall be securely nailed across grains as far as possible to the flange, edges with at least 2
nails per end. The length of the nails shall not be less than twice the thickness of the battens. The nails
shall not protrude above the general surface and shall not have exposed sharp, edges or allow the
battens to be released due to corrosion.
The nuts on the barrel studs shall be tack welded on the one side in order to fully secure them. On the
second end, a spring washer shall be used.
A steel collar shall be used to secure all barrel studs. This collar shall be located between the washers
and the steel drum and secured to the central steel plate by welding.
Outside the protective lagging, there shall be minimum of two binder consisting of hoop
iron/galvanized steel wire. Each protective lagging shall have two recesses to accommodate the
binders.
The conductor ends shall be properly sealed and secured on the side of one of the flanges to avoid
loosening of the conductor layers during transit and handling.
As an alternative to wooden drum Bidder may also supply the conductors in non-returnable painted
steel drums. After preparation of steel surface according to IS: 9954, synthetic enamel paint shall be
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 6 – Line Conductor Page 6-5
applied after application of one coat of primer. Wooden/Steel drum will be treated at par for evaluation
purpose and accordingly the Bidder should quote in the package.
2.7 Marking
Each drum shall have the following information stencilled on it in indelible ink along with other
essential data:
- Contract/Award letter number.
- Name and address of consignee.
- Manufacturer’s name and address.
- Drum number
- Size of conductor
- Length of conductor in meters
- Arrow marking for unwinding
- Position of the conductor ends
- Distance between outer-most Layer of conductor and the inner surface of lagging.
- Barrel diameter at three locations & an arrow marking at the location of the measurement.
- Number of turns in the outer most layer.
- Gross weight of drum after putting lagging.
- Tear weight of the drum without lagging.
- Net weight of the conductor in the drum.
- Material Inspection & Clearance certificate No.
- The above should be indicated in the packing list also.
2.8 Verification of Conductor Length
The Employer (NEA) reserves the right to verify the length of conductor in any conductor drum to be
supplied by contractor.
3 Tests
The following acceptance and routine tests and tests during manufacture shall be carried outon the
conductor . For the purpose of this clause, the following shall apply.
Acceptance tests shall mean those tests which are to be carried out on samples taken from each lot
offered for pre-despatch inspection, for the purpose of acceptance of that lot.
Routine tests shall mean those tests, which are to be carried out on each strand/ spool/length of the
conductor to check requirements which are likely to vary during production.
Tests during manufacture shall mean those tests, which are to be carried out during the process of
manufacture and end inspection by the manufacture to ensure the desired quality of the end product to
be supplied by him.
For all acceptance tests, the acceptance values shall be the values guaranteed by the bidder in the
guaranteed technical particulars of his proposal or the acceptance value specified in this specification,
whichever is more stringent for that particular test.
Note: All the tests except (j) shall be carried out on Aluminium and steel strands after stranding only.
3.3 Routine tests
a) Check to ensure that the joints are as per specification.
b) Check that there are no cuts, fins etc. on the strands.
c) Check that drums areas per specification.
d) All acceptance test as mentioned above to be carried out on each coil.
3.4 Tests during manufacture
a) Chemical analysis of zinc used for galvanizing
b) Chemical analysis of aluminum used for making aluminum strands
CHAPTER-7
INSULATOR AND ACCESSORIES
Note: The bidder shall offer composite long rod insulators of suitable core dia to meet specified
E&M strength requirements. Bidder shall submit the overall string length and other details withthe
Bid.
Pin and Cap shall be designed to transmit the mechanical stresses and develop uniform mechanical
strength in the insulator. The cap shall be circular with the inner and outer surfaces concentric, of such
design that it will not yield or distort under load conditions.
The design shall be such as to permit easy removal of replacement of either insulator units or fittings
under the live line conditions.
3 Security Clip
Security clip for use with ball and socket coupling shall be of R-shaped hump type which shall provide
positive locking of the coupling as per IS: 2486-(Part-Ill)/IEC: 372. The legs of the security clips shall
be spread after installation to prevent complete withdrawal from the socket. The locking device should
be resilient, corrosion resistant and of suitable mechanical strength. There shall be no risk of the
locking device being displaced accidentally or being rotated when in position. Under no circumstances
shall locking device allow separation of insulator units or fittings.
The hole for the security clip shall be countersunk and the clip shall be of such design that the eye of
clip may be engaged by a hot line clip puller to provide for disengagement under energized conditions.
The force required to pull the security clip into its unlocked position shall not be less than 50N (5 kg)
or more than 500N (50 kg).
4 Ball and Socket Designation
The dimensions of the balls and sockets shall be of 16 mm designation for 90 kN & 20 mm designation
for 160 kN disc insulator in accordance with the standard dimensions stated in IS: 2486 - (Part -
II)/IEC:120.
5 Dimensional Tolerance of Composite Insulators
The tolerances on all dimensions e.g. diameter, length and creepage distance shall be allowed as
follows:
± (0.04d+1.5) mm when d≤300 mm.
± (0.025d+6) mm when d>300 mm.
Where, d being the dimensions in millimeters for diameter, length or creepage distance as the case may
be.
However, no negative tolerance shall be applicable to creepage distance.
6 Interchangeability
The composite long rod insulators inclusive of the ball and socket fittings shall be of standard design
suitable for use with the hardware fittings of any make conforming to relevant Indian/IEC Standards.
7 Corona and RI Performance
All surfaces must be clean, smooth, without cuts, abrasions or projections. No part shall be subjected to
excessive localized pressure. The insulator metal parts shall be so designed and manufactured that it
shall not generate any Radio Interference beyond specified limit and not produce any noise generating
corona formation under the operating conditions.
8 Maintenance
The long rod insulators offered shall be suitable for employment of hot line maintenance technique so
that usual hot line operation can be carried out with ease, speed and safety.
All insulators shall be designed to facilitate cleaning and insulators shall have the minimum practical
number of sheds and grooves. All grooves shall be so proportioned that any dust deposit can be
removed without difficulty either by wiping with a cloth or by remote washing under live line
condition.
9 Materials
9.1 Core
It shall be a glass-fiber reinforced (FRP rod) epoxy resin rod of high strength. Glass fibers and resin
shall be optimized. The rod shall be electrical grade corrosion resistant (ECR), boron free glass and
shall exhibit both high electrical integrity and high resistance to acid corrosion.
9.2 Housing & Weathersheds
The FRP rod shall be covered by a seamless sheath of a HT-silicone rubber compound of a thickness of
minimum 3mm. The housing & weathersheds should have silicon content of minimum 30% by weight.
It should protect the FRP rod against environmental influences, external pollution and humidity. It shall
be extruded or directly molded on the core. The interface between the housing and the core must be
uniform and without voids. The strength of the bond shall be greater than the tearing strength of the
polymer. The manufacturer shall follow non-destructive technique (N.D.T.) to check the quality of
jointing of the housing interface with the core. The technique being followed with detailed procedure
and sampling shall be furnished along with the bid. The details for this shall be finalized during
detailed engineering and finalization of MQP.
The weathersheds of the insulators shall be of alternate shed profile. The weathersheds shall be
vulcanized to the sheath (extrusion process) or molded as part of the sheath (injection moulding
process) and free from imperfections. The vulcanization for extrusion process shall be at high
temperature and for injection moulding shall be at high temperature & high pressure. Any seams / burrs
protruding axially along the insulator, resulting from the injection moulding process shall be removed
completely without causing any damage to the housing. The track resistance of housing and shed
material shall be class 1A4.5 according to IEC60587. The strength of the weathershed to sheath
interface shall be greater than the tearing strength of the polymer. The composite insulator shall be
capable of high pressure washing.
9.3 End Fittings
End fittings transmit the mechanical load to the core. They shall be made of malleable cast iron
spheroid graphite or forged steel. They shall be connected to the rod by means of a controlled
compression technique. The manufacturer shall have in-process Acoustic emission arrangement or
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 7 – Insulators and Accessories Page 7-4
some other arrangement to ensure that there is no damage to the core during crimping. This verification
shall be in-process and done on each insulator. The gap between fitting and sheath shall be sealed by a
flexible silicone rubber compound. The system of attachment of end fitting to the rod shall provide
superior sealing performance between housing and metal connection. The sealing must be humidity
proof and durable with time.
9.4 Grading Rings
Grading rings shall be used at both ends of each composite insulator unit for reducing the voltage
gradient on and within the insulator and to reduce radio and TV noise to acceptable levels. The size and
placement of the metallic grading rings shall be designed to eliminate dry band arcing/corona cutting/
exceeding of permissible electrical stress of material. The bidder shall furnish calculations along with
the proposed placement and design of corona ring in support of the above. Grading rings shall be
capable of installation and removal with hot line tools without disassembling any other part of the
insulator assembly.
The supply of grading rings shall be in the scope of the composite insulator supplier.
10 Workmanship
All the material shall be of the latest design and conform to the best modern practices adopted in the
extra high voltage field. Suppliers shall offer only such insulators as are guaranteed by him to be
satisfactory and suitable for Transmission lines specified and will give continued good service.
The design, manufacturing process and material control at various stages shall be such as to give
maximum working load, highest mobility, best resistance to corrosion, good finish and elimination of
sharp edges and corners to limit corona and radio interference.
The design of the insulators shall be such that stresses due to expansion and contraction in any part of
the insulator shall not lead to deterioration.
The core shall be sound and free of cracks and voids that may adversely affect the insulators.
Weather sheds shall be uniform in quality. They shall be clean, sound, smooth and free from gross
defects and excessive flashing at parting lines.
End fittings shall be free from cracks, seams, shrinks, air holes and rough edges. End fittings should be
effectively, sealed to prevent moisture ingress, effectiveness of sealing system must be supported by
test documents. All surfaces of the metal parts shall be perfectly smooth with the projecting points or
irregularities which may cause corona. All load bearing surfaces shall be smooth and uniform so as to
distribute the loading stresses uniformly.
All ferrous parts shall be hot dip galvanized to give a minimum average coating of Zinc equivalent to
600 gm/sq.m and shall be in accordance with the requirement of IS:2629 and shall satisfy the tests
mentioned in IS:2633. The zinc used for galvanizing shall be of Grade Zn 99.95 as per IS: 209. The
zinc coating shall be uniform, adherent, smooth, reasonably bright, continuous and free from
imperfections such as flux, ash, rust stains, bulky white deposits and blisters. The galvanized metal
parts shall be guaranteed to withstand at least six successive dips each lasting for one (1) minute
duration under the standard preece test. The galvanizing shall be carried out only after any machining.
11 Equipment Marking
Each Composite Long Rod Insulator shall be legibly and indelibly marked with the trade mark of the
manufacturer, name of Employer and month & year of manufacture. The guaranteed combined
mechanical and electrical strength shall be indicated in kilo Newton followed by the word ‘kN’ to
facilitate easy identification and to ensure proper use.
For porcelain insulator, the marking shall be on porcelain. The marking shall be printed, not impressed
and shall be applied before firing. For toughened glass insulators the marking shall be on the metal
parts.
One 10 mm thick ring or 20 mm thick spot of suitable quality of paint shall be marked on the cap end
fitting of each composite long rod insulator of particular strength for easy identification of the type of
insulator. The paint shall not have any deteriorating effect on the insulator performance. Following
codes shall be used as identification mark:
For 90 kNLong rod : Orange
For 120 kNLong rod : Yellow
For 160 kNLong rod : Green
12 Bid Drawings
The Bidder shall furnish full description and illustration of the material offered.
The Bidder shall furnish along with the bid the outline drawing (6 copies) of each insulator unit
including a cross sectional view of the insulator shell. The drawing shall include but not limited to the
following information:
a) Long rod diameter and ball to ball spacing with manufacturing tolerances
b) Minimum Creepage distance with positive tolerance
c) Protected creepage distance
d) Eccentricity of the long rod unit
e) Axial run out
f) Radial run out
g) Unit mechanical and electrical characteristics
h) Size and weight of ball and socket parts
i) Weight of composite long rod units
j) Materials
k) Identification mark
l) Manufacturer's catalogue number
After placement of award, the Contractor shall submit full dimensioned insulator drawings containing
all the details, in four (4) copies to Employer for approval. After getting approval from Employer and
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 7 – Insulators and Accessories Page 7-6
successful completion of all the type tests, the Supplier shall submit 10 more copies of the same
drawing to the Employer for further distribution and field use at Employer's end.
After placement of award the Contractor shall also submit fully dimensioned insulator crate drawing
for different type of insulators.
13 Tests
13.1 Type Tests
The equipment should be offered type tested. The Bidder shall submit type test reports as specified in
section-2 of this specified along with the bid.
On the complete composite Long Rod Insulator String with Hardware Fittings
(a) Power frequency voltage withstand test with corona control IEC:383-1993/
rings/grading ring and arcing horns under wet condition Annexure A
(b) Switching surge voltage withstand test under wet condition IEC:383-1993
(c) Impulse voltage withstand test under dry condition IEC:383-1993
(d) Corona and RIV test under dry condition Annexure-A
(e) Mechanical Strength test Annexure-A
(f) Vibration test Annexure-A
(g) Salt-fog pollution withstand test Annexure-A
All the type test given above shall be conducted on Single ‘I’ suspension, Single Tension, Double
tension, Double ’I’ suspension insulator string along with hardware fittings.
On Composite Insulator Units
(a) Tests on interfaces and connections of metal fittings (Tests to be IEC: 61109
performed on the same samples in the sequence given below)
i. Dry power frequency voltage test
ii. Sudden load release test
iii. Thermal mechanical test
iv. Water immersion test
v. Steep front impulse voltage test
vi. Dry power frequency voltage test
(b) Assembled core load time test IEC: 61109
i. Determination of the average failing load of the core of the
assembled unit
ii. Control of the slope of the strength time curve of the
insulator
In the event of failure of the sample to satisfy the acceptance test(s) specified in above, the retest
procedure shall be as per clause 7.6 of IEC 61109.
The Employer also reserves the right to conduct all the tests mentioned in this specification at his own
expense on the samples drawn from the site at Supplier's premises or at any other test centre. In case of
evidence of non compliance, it shall be binding on the part of the Supplier to prove the compliance of
the items to the technical specifications by repeat tests or correction of deficiencies or replacement of
defective items, all without any extra cost to the Employer.
13.9 Co-ordinate for testing
The Contractor/ Supplier shall have to co-ordinate testing of insulators with hardware fittings to be
supplied by other Supplier and shall have to guarantee overall satisfactory performance of the
insulators with the hardware fittings.
13.10 Guarantee
The Contractor/ Supplier of insulators shall guarantee overall satisfactory performance of the insulators
with the hardware fittings.
13.11 Test Reports
Copies of type test reports shall be furnished in at least six (6) copies along with one original. One copy
shall be returned duly certified by the Employer only after which the commercial production of the
concerned material shall start.
Copies of acceptance test reports shall be furnished in at least six (6) copies. One copy shall be returned
duly certified by the Employer, only after which the material shall be dispatched.
Record of routine test reports shall be maintained by the Supplier at his works for periodic inspection
by the Employer’s representative.
Test certificates of test during manufacture shall be maintained by the Supplier. These shall be
produced for verification as and when desired by the Employer.
13.12 Inspection
The Employer’s representative shall at all times be entitled to have access to the works and all places of
manufacture, where insulator, and its component parts shall be manufactured and the representatives
shall have full facilities for unrestricted inspection of the Supplier’s and sub-Supplier’s works, raw
materials, manufacture of the material and for conducting necessary test as detailed herein.
The material for final inspection shall be offered by the Supplier only under packed condition.
The Employer shall select samples at random from the packed lot for carrying out acceptance tests.
Insulators shall normally be offered for inspection in lots not exceeding 2000 nos. for disc insulator.
The lot should be homogeneous and should contain insulators manufactured in 3-4 consecutive weeks.
The Supplier shall keep the Employer informed in advance of the time of starting and the progress of
manufacture of material in their various stages so that arrangements could be made for inspection.
No material shall be dispatched from its point of manufacture before it has been satisfactorily inspected
and tested unless the inspection is waived off by the Employer in writing. In the latter case also the
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 7 – Insulators and Accessories Page 7-10
material shall be dispatched only after satisfactory testing for all tests specified herein have been
completed.
The acceptance of any quantity of material shall be no way relieve the Supplier of his responsibility for
meeting all the requirements of the specification and shall not prevent subsequent rejection, if such
material are later found to be defective.
14 Packing and Marking
All insulators shall be packed in suitable PVC/ plastic tubes/any other suitable packing along with
temporary wrap-on shields/shrouds for each insulator unit. The packing shall provide protection against
rodent. The shields/shrouds shall be for protection during transport and for preventing bird pecking
during erection. Further, the shields/shrouds shall be made of opaque, weather proof material of
adequate strength and shall be colour coded. The shields/shrouds shall have smaller diameter than the
insulator to stay in place against winds & weather and shall be designed so as to leave only the end
fittings exposed for attachment of insulator to tower and line hardware until line construction is
complete. The shield/shroud shall have suitable pull off loop for easy detachment just prior to charging
of the line without causing any damage to the insulator. The bidderSupplier shall furnish detailed
design of the packing and shield/shroud along with attachment and detachment procedure in this
regard. For marine transportation, crates shall be palleted.
The packing shall be of sufficient strength to withstand rough handling during transit, storage at site
and subsequent handling in the field.
Suitable cushioning, protective padding, or dunnage or spacers shall be provided to prevent damage or
deformation during transit and handling.
The Supplier shall guarantee the adequacy of the packing and shall be responsible for any loss or
damage during transportation, handling, storage and installation due to improper packing.
All packing cases shall be marked legibly and correctly so as to ensure safe arrival at their destination
and to avoid the possibility of goods being lost or wrongly dispatched on account of faulty packing and
faulty or illegible markings. Each case/crate shall have all the markings stenciled on it in indelible ink.
15 Standards
The insulator strings and its components shall conform to the following lndian/ International Standards
which shall mean latest revision, with amendments/changes adopted and published, unless specifically
stated otherwise in the Specification.
In the event of supply of insulators conforming to standards other than specified, the Bidder shall
confirm in his bid that these standards are equivalent to those specified. In case of award, salient
features of comparison between the standards proposed by the Bidder and those specified in this
document will be provided by the Supplier to establish equivalence.
system shall be suitable to maintain constant tension on each sub-conductors throughout the duration of
the test. Vibration dampers shall not be used on the test span. Both the sub-conductors shall be
vertically vibrated simultaneously at one of the resonance frequencies of the insulators string (more
than 10 Hz) by means of vibration inducing equipment. The peak to peak displacement in mm of
vibration at the antinode point, nearest to the string, shall be measured and the same shall not be less
than 1000/f1.8 where f is the frequency of vibration in cycles/sec. The insulator string shall be vibrated
for not less than 10 million cycles without any failure. After the test the insulators shall be examined
for looseness of pins and cap or any crack in the cement. The hardware shall be examined for
looseness, fatigue failure and mechanical strength test. There shall be no deterioration of properties of
hardware components and insulators after the vibration test. The insulators shall be subjected to
Mechanical performance test followed by mechanical strength test as per relevant standards.
1.5 Salt-fog pollution withstand test
This test shall be carried out in accordance with IEC : 60507. The salinity level for composite long rod
insulators shall be 160 Kg/m3 NACL.
2.0 Composite Long rod Insulator Units
2.1 Brittle Fracture Resistance Test
Assembled core load time test with container that contains1n-HNO3 concentric acid that is applied at
the naked rod. The rod should be held at 80% of SML for the duration of the test.
The rod should not fail within the 96 hour test duration
2.2 Recovery of Hydrophobicity Test
(1) The surface of selected samples shall be cleaned with isopropyl alcohol. Allow the surface
to dry and spray with water. Record the HC classification. Dry the sample surface.
(2) Treat the surface with corona discharges to destroy the hydrophobicity. This can be done
utilizing a high frequency corona tester, Holding the electrode approximately 3mm from the
sample surface, slowly move the electrode over an area approximately 1” x 1”. Continue
treating this area for 2 – 3 minutes, operating the tester at maximum output.
(3) Immediately after the corona treatment, spray the surface with water and record the HC
classification. The surface should be hydrophilic, with an HC value of 6 or 7. If not, dry the
surface and repeat the corona treatment for a longer time until an HC of 6 or 7 is obtained.
Dry the sample surface.
(4) Allow the sample to recover and repeat the hydrophobicity measurement at several time
intervals. Silicone rubber should recover to HC 1 – HC 2 within 24 to 48 hours, depending
on the material and the intensity of the corona treatment.
2.3 Silicone content test
Minimum content of silicone as guaranteed by supplier shall be verified through FT-IR spectroscopy &
TGA analysis or any other suitable method mutually agreed between Employer & Supplier in Quality
Assurance Programme.
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 7 – Insulators and Accessories Page 7-14
CHAPTER-8
OPTICAL GROUND WIRE (OPGW)
1 General
The scope of work comprise of supply, installation, testing and commissioning of Optical Fiber
Ground Wire (OPGW), including necessary accessories for fiber termination and splicing, for 20
km long Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line.
Bidders shall offer the OPGW and their accessories from reputed manufacturer. The contractor shall
ensure complete supervision by competent technical personnel(s) of the OPGW manufacturer
during installation, testing and commissioning of the whole OPGW system in totality under the
project. The supervision shall also include the on-site training to the Employer's Representative(s).
2 Technical Requirements
The optical fiber ground wire (OPGW) shall have supporting cross section of 68 mm2. The ground
wire of the 132 kV line shall be a steel wire (or Aluminium clad steel wire) with an OPGW
Composite Fiber Optic communication cable in the center. The Optical Fiber Cable, containing 24
single-mode optical fibers shall be embedded loosely inside the protective tube. The protective tube
shall be of aluminum alloy or stainless steel. Both fiber optic and stranding part of OPGW shall
comply with this Specification, and with the following standards:
Single mode fibers ITU-T (former CCITT) G. 652
Optical fiber cables IEC 60793-1 & 2
IEC 1089/91, IEC 60889/87
Stranding part IEC 60104/87; BS 3242
The earth wire shall be suitable for the climatic conditions with no attenuation changes or negative
effects on the cable, and compatible with the stringing condition of the phase conductor. Under no
condition shall the OPGW sag exceed the conductor sag.
The optical fiber shall be made of germanium doped silica glass or pure silica glass. It shall have a
primary coating made of silicone or similar material with physical and mechanical properties at
least those of silicone (acrylic or similar).
The tube shall be made of suitable material sufficiently strong to hold its shape and provide
protection for the optical fibers against deformation and friction. The strength member of the fiber
optic cable shall provide protection against buckling, kinking and strain. The material to be used
shall be fiber reinforced plastic.
The direction of lay of the outer layer of strands shall be right hand. Lay ratio of any layer shall be
not greater than the lay ratio of the layer immediately beneath it. The make up of ground wire shall
be such that the strand shall remain and shall not twist when the conductor is cut. The earth wire
shall be manufactured so that no twisting occurs when subjected to axial loads, i.e. when unrolling
and stringing.
All wires used in the manufacture of the earth wire shall be free from protrusion, sharp edges,
abrasion and any other imperfections.
No jointing of the aluminium clad steel wires shall be permitted.
There shall be no joints or splices in any optical fiber in any reel length of the complete optical
cable.
The creep characteristic of the finished earth wire shall be of virtually unvarying uniformity.
Optical fibers
All fiber installed as a part of this Contract shall have a minimum life of 30 years from the date of
final acceptance.
The OPGW shall include minimum 24 fibers. The main optical characteristics of the OPGW are
shown in the Appendix (Schedule 8A).
The other characteristics of the OPGW shall be as follows:
Attenuation
The attenuation coefficient for wavelengths between 1285 nm and 1330 nm shall not exceed the
attenuation coefficient at 1310 nm by more than + 0.05 dB/km.
The attenuation coefficient for wavelengths between 1535 and 1565 shall not exceed the attenuation
coefficient at 1550 mm by more than + 0.05 dB/km. The attenuation of the fiber shall be distributed
uniformly throughout its length such that there are no point discontinuities in excess of 0.1 dB.
The cable shall consist of single mode dual-window color coded optical fibers. There shall be no
factory splices within the cable structure.
3 Optical Fiber Identification
Color-coding is essential for identifying individual optical fibers and groups of optical fibers.
Individual optical fibers within a fiberunit and fiber units will be identifiable using a color-coding
scheme. The color-coding system shall be discernible throughout the design life of the cable.
Each cable shall be traceable of each fiber back to the original fiber manufacture's fiber number and
parameters of the fiber.
If more than the specified numbers of fibers are included in any cable, the cable manufacturer shall
test the spare fibers and any defective fibers shall be suitably bundled, tagged and identified at the
factory by the fiber manufacturer.
4 Buffer Tube
Loose tube buffer construction shall be applied. A buffer for protection from physical damage shall
surround the individually coated optical fiber(s) during fabrication, installation and performance of
the cable. The fiber coating and buffer shall be strippable for splicing and termination. The inside
diameter of the buffer tube shall be of appropriate size to allow free movement of the fibers during
cable Contraction or elongation resulting from thermal, tensile or vibration loads.
Buffer tubes shall besleeved over multiple fibers forming a fiber unit. A fiber unit may consist of up
to 6 fibers, individually identifiable utilizing the color code in conformance with EIA 359 A.
5 Optical Fiber Termination and Splicing
Suitable splice boxes (enclosures) shall be provided to encase the optical cable ends and fusion
splices in protective, moisture and dust free environment. The splice boxes shall be designed for the
storage and protections of a minimum of 12 fibers cables and provide access through locked doors.
Fiber-optic cable of adequate length shall be provided so that all splicing can be performed at
ground level at the towers. All splicing and necessary material shall be included in the price
schedule presented by the Contractor.
6 Outdoor Splice Boxes
Splice boxes provided by the Contractor for outdoor use shall be suitable for use with the cable type
provided as part of this Contract. The splice boxes shall be appropriate for mounting on steel
structures and accommodate pass-through splicing and fiber terminations.
The splice box, including organizer/ splice trays, shall be designed to seal and protect the fiber cable
splices from the environment defined in this specification and it shall provide easy access for any
maintenance function.
All splice boxes shall be of metal construction that are clean and smooth finished, treated to resist
rust, accommodate the storage of a minimum of 3 meters of coiled fiber and allow easy access to
the splice trays. In addition there shall be a steel frame to coil up about 10 meters of OPGW outside
the protection box.
7 Test
The testing must be done by recognized equipment and it shall be possible to produce a
computerized print out from the computer and the software, all of which (lap top computer, printer
and software) must be included in the testing, commissioning or installation unit prices.
There are different test series to assure the quality of OPGW:
OPGW tests shall be in accordance with applicable standards or agreements between Employer and
Contractor / manufacturer.
As a general rule the tests will be performed according IEC 60794-4-10.However, if necessary tests
can be done according to IEEE Std1138.
8 Maintenance
To maintain the cable the Contractor shall propose suitable equipment and necessary training for the
Employer personnel to execute the work.
9 Joints
Number of Joints shall be kept to a minimum. Approved equipment and methods must be used to
test the cable from both ends.
10 Particular Requirement for OPGW Earth Wire fittings and accessories
The associated fittings and other accessories have to satisfy the specific function of OPGW and
fiber optics requirements for a total integrity of their components. The best way to achieve these
goals shall be in application of suitable performed products. A brief description of the accessories is
as follows:
armor grip suspension clamp (aluminum alloy hyper formed armor rods and suspension
clamp);
associated hardware for earth wire suspension:
Flexible grounding loop connection.
b. Tension Assembly: The tension assembly shall consists of:
c. Vibration Dampers
Dampers where necessary, shall be of Stockbridge type installed complete with the armor rods of
the size suitable to the earth wire size.
The fiber optic splice closure allows clamping of the cables to be spliced. It shall have following
characteristics:
The splice capacity for minimum 12 single-mode fibers from metal free optical cable with
loose tube construction;
waterproof housing of the closure aluminum or stainless steel construction with protection class
IP 65 of IEC 60529;
box and cable glands tightened by sealing compound.
Installation height shall be 1.5 m above the anti-climbing devices of the towers.
The fiber optic splice closure allows termination of OPGW on the substation gantry and interface
with the underground fiber optic cable leading into the control building. It shall have the following
characteristics:
the cable glands for accepting of one metal free optical cables with minimum 12 single-mode
fibers and loose tube construction;
waterproof housing of the closure aluminum or stainless steel construction with protection class
IP 65 of IEC 60529;
box and cable glands tightened by sealing compound.
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 8 – OPGW Page 8-6
CHAPTER-9
ERECTION, STRINGING AND MISCELLANEOUS WORKS
Throughout the course of support erection the Contractor shall ensure that unbraced members are
adequately supported by stays or guys or temporary struts prior to being braced.
The bracing of all four sides of the support shall be completed before guys are removed and before
any erection of a higher section of the tower is commenced.
In no case the tower structure shall be erected until seven days after completing the foundation
concrete work, and until proper backfilling and compaction.
The Contractor shall notify the Employer two weeks before the supports are ready for inspection.
The inspection and correction of defects if any shall be complete before the start of the stringing
operation.
Damaged galvanizing shall be repaired on site by galvanizing paint and as specified in accordance
with Article 1.7 of General Technical Specification.
All bolts and nuts below the anti-climbing device shall be properly punched such as to provide
safety against opening of the nut-bolts even with the wrench set. The punched area shall
immediately be coated with zinc paint.
1.1 Payment
Payment for the contract item Steel tower erection will be made at the unit price bid "Erection of
tower with its body and body extensions". Therefore in the schedule the unit bid price shall include
full compensation for all cost incurred in furnishing all materials, tools, labours etc. for erection
work related to this item.
2 Conductors Stringing
At least 3 months before conductor stringing commences, the Contractor shall submit to the
Employer a detailed account of his proposed stringing procedure which should include details of
temporary support stays and compensation for initial stretch and long term creep of the conductors.
Full use shall be made of maximum conductor lengths in order to reduce the number of mid span
joints to a minimum.
There shall not be more than one joint per conductor in any one span, and tension joints shall not be
less than 15 meters from any conductor clamp. No tension joints shall be used:
In section of less than 3 spans between tensions supports.
In spans over navigable rivers, buildings, power lines, telecommunication lines, public roads
and in any span subject to special way leave conditions or in any adjacent span.
Conductor repair sleeves shall not be used without the permission of the Employer or Employer's
representative.
The conductors, joints and clamps shall be erected using the approved tools and in such a manner
that no bird-caging, over tensioning of individual wires or layers or other deformation or damage to
the conductors occurs. Clamps or other devices used in erection shall be of approved design and
shall allow no relative movement of strands or layers of the conductors.
The Contractor shall keep a record of all conductor joints giving the location, the date of assembly
and the name of the lineman responsible for the jointing. Where records of joints made by a
particular lineman show a repeated performance below that required, the Contractor shall cease to
employ the lineman on jointing operations and shall immediately replace him with other qualified
personnel.
Phase conductors and OPGW shall be erected with such sags that everyday temperature in still air
and 20 degree C temperature with maximum wind pressure, the final tensions shall provide factors
of safety on the ultimate tensile strength of the conductor. The Contractor shall submit erection and
final sag and tension charts for each type of conductor. These charts shall plot inter-related curves
of tensions against equivalent span lengths, and actual span lengths against sags, at temperatures of
00 C, 200C, 320C, 400C, 600C and 800C in still air conditions, and shall show details of conductor
size, conductor breaking load, and conditions of loading.
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 9 – Erection, Stringing and Miscellaneous Works Page 9-3
In calculating the sags and tensions, allowance shall be made for the elasticity and coefficients of
expansion of the conductor materials.
The term "final tension" shall mean the tension existing in a line conductor, for any given condition
of loading after sufficient period in service to allow for "bedding down" stretch and creep to take
place. For purposes of calculating creep allowance this shall be taken as ten years from erection.
The "equivalent span" method shall be used, in which the tension in any section length is that
which would apply to a single span equal to the square root of the length arrived at by dividing the
sum of the cubes of the individual span lengths, in the section considered, by their sum. The
calculated tensions at the time of initial erection shall be increased by an approved amount to allow
for settling of the conductors, other means may be adopted subject to the approval of the Employer
or Employer's representative.
At the end of the guarantee period the specified ground clearance plus the conductor cree-page
allowance shall not be infringed, in addition, the sag of any phase conductors in the same span.
Where required by the Employer, prior to the issue of the Operational Acceptance Certificate, the
Contractor shall be responsible for checking that the relative sags of the conductors are within the
specified tolerance. Such checks shall be carried out at selected point along the route as required by
the Employer. Clearances between conductors and ground and between jumpers and structures shall
be checked by the Contractor during erection and before handing over the line.
The Contractor shall provide dynamometers, sighting boards and levels suitably mounted for
clamping to support steelworks and other approved apparatus necessary for the proper checking of
the work. When required by the Employer, dynamometers shall be tested and if necessary
recalibrate at the Contractor's expense.
During the progress of the work, the Contractor shall record on approved schedules the particulars
of the sagging of conductors on each section of the route. These schedules shall show the support
numbers of the section, individual span lengths, the equivalent span, the design and erection sags,
together with the mean actual sag of the phase conductor as well as the temperature, and the dates of
the stringing and checking. At the end of the Contract six sets of these schedules shall be handed to
the Employer.
Blocks for running out conductors shall be of approved type and shall be robust and full running.
The wheel of the running out block shall have a diameter of not less than 20 times the outside
diameter of the conductor and shall be fabricated from aluminum.
The Contractor shall provide as a minimum sufficient running blocks commensurate with stringing
the longest section of the project.
Jumper-loops shall be cut to length such that the loop arcs at the points of departure from
tension-clamp are naturally tangential to the tension -clamp departure angle.
All conductor, connections and clamps shall be treated with approved jointing grease to prevent
galvanic corrosion between dissimilar metals and to inhibit aluminum surface oxidization.
After the line conductors have been finally tensioned to their correct sags, the Contractor shall erect
vibration dampers at the recommended distance from the conductor clamps.
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 9 – Erection, Stringing and Miscellaneous Works Page 9-4
The Contractor shall identify the spans where aeronautical signs on the earth wire may need.
However instruction from the Employer to put such signs at any span shall be fulfilled without any
additional cost to the Employer.
Payment
Payment for the contract item conductor stringing will be made at the unit price bid "Stringing of
Conductor". Therefore in the schedule the unit bid price shall include full compensation for all cost
incurred in furnishing all materials, equipment and labor for installation of insulators strings,
jumpers, hardware, stringing and any other related works to this item. No additional payment will
be made for any restringing and rearrangement of the existing circuit necessitated by the
interconnection of the existing line with the Tee-off tower for the new line. Measurement for the
payment shall be based on the conductor km calculated by addition of the horizontal distance
between towers.
Shutdown
For the stinging work of the lines, the Contractor shall request the Employer for the shutdown of
existing transmission and/or distribution lines, where necessary, at least 15 days in advance. The
request letter or form shall include the place of work and duration of shutdown needed. The period
of shutdown shall be as minimum as possible. The Employer has right to decrease the justified
period of shutdown, if requested period of shutdown by Contractor is excessive and to shift the date
of shutdown.
The Contractor shall complete the work, during the shutdown within the stipulated time
period. If the Contractor fails to complete the work within the stipulated time limit, the
Employer will claim the amount of money arising from the loss of energy not transmitted or
distributed.
CHAPTER-10
TECHNICAL SCHEDULE
1 Schedule A.1
System and Line Data
2 Schedule A.2
Design Data
Wind Load
3 Schedule A.3
Minimum clearances
The followings are the minimum clearances between live conductors and other objects, which
correspond to the maximum conductor sag conditions at different altitude zones.
MINIMUM
CLEARANCES
(IN METER)
ITEM DESCRIPTION IN NORMAL
CONDITION
Altitude ≤
1,000m
1. Normal ground for pedestrians only 7.1
2. Residential areas 7.1
3. Roads and streets 8.0
4. Highways 8.0
5. To metal clad or roofed buildings or 5.0
building or structures upon which a man
may stand
6. Power lines ( above or below) 3.5
7. Telecommunication lines 3.5
8. River and other areas 7.1
For other objects not listed in the Schedule the requirements for minimum clearances shall comply
also with NESC (NATIONAL ELECTRIC SAFETY CODE).
Approximately 0.5m shall be added to the clearance values above to allow for survey and drawings
errors.
Crossing of houses, huts and other objects with soft roofing is not allowed.
4 Schedule A.4
TOWER TYPES
5 Schedule A.5
TOWER OUTLINE CONFIGURATION
Refer to drawing
6 Schedule A.6
FACTOR OF SAFETY
MINIMUM
ITEM DESCRIPTION FACTOR OF
SAFETY
1. Tower Foundations
1.1 All types of suspension(DA) and small angle(DB) 1.1
towers
1.2 All types of other tension towers (DC, DD, DE) 1.2
2. Conductors and Insulators
2.1 Conductors based on ultimate tensile strength 2.5
2.2 Conductors based on ultimate tensile strength at still 4.5
air every –day temperatures
2.3 Compete insulator strings and fittings on minimum 3.3
breaking load of insulator
2.4 Dead end compression clamps and compression 0.95
splices based on conductor ultimate tensile strength
3. Ground Wires
3.1 Ground wire based on earth wire ultimate tensile 2.5
strength
3.2 Ground wire at still air everyday temperature based 5.0
on earth wire ultimate tensile strength
3.3 Complete tension assembly at ground wire maximum 4.0
working tension
3.4 Complete suspension assembly at maximum vertical 4.0
load
7 Schedule A.7
TOWER PARTICULARS
8 Schedule A.8
TOWER MEMBERS PARTICULARS
The minimum thickness and diameter of material used in members and bolts shall be as follows:
carrying stress
5. Diameter of bolts for redundant mm 16
members without calculated
stress
6. Gusset plates mm 6
7. Stub angles mm 8
9 Schedule A.9
LONG ROD POLYMERIC INSULATORS
The minimum thickness and diameter of material used in members and bolts shall be as follows:
10 Schedule A.10
LINE CONDUCTOR
10 Schedule A.11
OPTICAL FIBER GROUND WIRE (OPGW)
9. Fiber attenuation at
9.1 1310 nm at 20oC max. dB/km 0.4
9.2 1550 nm at 20oC max. dB/km 0.25
10. Attenuation deviation at 1310 dB/km 0.1 (within -450C
nm and 1550 nm to 800C)
11. Standards
11.1 Aluminium alloy wires IEC 104 type A
11.2 Aluminium clad steel wire IEC 1232
11.3 Cable construction IEC 1089
11.4 Optical Unit ITU-T (former CCIT) G 652
12 Schedule A.12
MATERIAL FOR TOWER GROUNDING
13 Schedule A.13
FOUNDATION APPLICATION SCHEDULE
DB
DC
DD/DDE
14 Schedule A.14
INSEPTION TESTS AT MANUFACTURE’S PLANT
CHAPTER - 11
POWER TRANSFORMERS
1 General
This specification covers the design, manufacture, assembly, shop test, supply, delivery,
installation field test and commissioning of the power transformer complete with all
accessories, fittings and auxiliary equipment for efficient and trouble-free operation as
specified herein under.
The Bidder shall submit type test report, valid ISO 9001 certificate, necessary technical
brochures, sales record, design calculations, layout and detailed drawings for the
transformers to verify compliance with the Specification. In particular, the Bidder shall
include dimensioned layout and section drawings and weight for those parts which influence
the space availability in switchyard for transformers, transformer pits (oil soaking and waste
oil-water), transportation routes, cable trenches, fencing/walls, fire walls etc.
The equipment specified in this Section shall conform to the latest edition of the appropriate
IEC standards are applicable and/or other recognized international standards. In particular
the following standards:
Any material and equipments not specifically stated in this specification but which are
necessary for satisfactory operation of the equipment shall be deemed to be included unless
specifically excluded and shall be supplied without any extra cost.
2 Design Requirement
The transformer shall be connected to three phase 50Hz system of 132kV, 33kV and 11kV
systems as specified for 132/11kV, 22.5MVA and 132/33kV, 30MVA Power Transformers.
The transformers shall be located at the altitude of 500 m above mean sea level.
The transformer shall be installed outdoor in a hot, humid atmosphere. The transformer shall
be oil immersed and designed for the cooling system as specified in Technical Particular.
The transformer shall be capable of operating continuously at its rated output without
exceeding the temperature rise limits as specified in Technical Particular.
The transformer windings shall be designed to withstand short circuit stresses at its terminal
with full voltage maintained behind it for a period as per IEC- 60076.
The transformer shall be capable of continuous operation at the rated output under the
following conditions:
The transformer shall be capable of delivering its rated output at any tap position.
The transformer shall be free from annoying hum and vibration when in operation even at 10
% higher voltage over the rated voltage. The noise level shall be in accordance with
respective IEC standards.
The transformer shall be designed and constructed so as not to cause any undesirable
interference in radio or communication circuits.
The transformer shall be designed to take care of third harmonics not to exceed 2% of
fundamental frequency. However, tertiary winding shall be provided on transformers with
capacity 50 MVA and above.
All nuts bolts and pins shall be locked except those which are external to the transformer. If
bolts and nuts are so placed as to be inaccessible by means of ordinary spanners, suitable
special spanners shall be provided along with the transformer.
Labels shall be provided for all apparatus like relays, switches, fuses, etc., housed in any
cubicle or marshaling kiosks. These shall be of in-corrodible material with matt/satin finish
and permanent lettering. Labels mounted on black surface shall have white letters & danger
notices shall have red lettering on a white background. The labels shall be secured by means
of brass screws or rust protected steel screws.
The proper & complete tightening of the nuts of the coil clamping bolts must be ensured by
the manufacturers. The tightening of the nuts to the designed value and that the nuts of all
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 11 – Power Transformer Page 11-3
the coils clamping bolts are tightened to same extent, should be carried out with torque
spanners.
3 Construction Features
3.1 Tank
The tank shall be of all welded construction and fabricated from sheet steel of adequate
thickness. All seams shall be properly welded to withstand requisite impact during short
circuit without distortion. All welding shall be stress relieved and strong enough to allow the
lifting of complete transformer with oil by means of a crane or jacks and transported to site
without over-straining the joints etc. The base shall be so designed as to allow the
transformer to be moved by skidding without any injury.
The main tank body shall be capable of withstanding a vacuum of 100.64 KN/m2 (760mm
of Hg.)
Stiffener of structural steel for general rigidity shall reinforce the tank wall. The tank shall
have sufficient strength to withstand mechanical shock during transportation and vacuum
filling in the field without any deformation.
The tank cover shall be bolted on to the tank with weatherproof, hot oil resistant, resilient
gasket in between for complete oil tightness. If gasket is compressible, metallic stops shall
be provided to prevent over compression. Bushings, turrets, cover of access holes and other
devices shall be designed to prevent any leakage of water into or oil from the tank. The tank
cover shall also be provided with two (2) nos. of grounding pads and connected separately to
tank grounding pads.
The transformer tank shall be provided with four sets of bi-directional flanged wheels for
rolling the transformer parallel to either direction of center line on rail. Mounting rails and
anti-earthquake device shall also be provided.
All heavy removable parts shall be provided with mounting rails along with eye bolt for ease
of handling and necessary lugs and shackles shall be provide to enable the whole
transformer to be lifted by a crane or other means. Manholes of sufficient size shall be
provided for access to leads, windings, bottom terminals of bushings and taps.
steels of low lamination thickness especially suitable for transformer core. The coils shall be
manufactured from electrolytic copper of suitable grade. They should be properly insulated
and stacked.
The transformer should be so designed that the working flux density should not exceed 1.57
Tesla at normal voltage, frequency.
All insulating material shall be of proven design. Coils shall be so insulated, that impulse
and power frequency voltage-stresses are minimum.
Coil assembly shall be suitably supported between adjacent sections by insulating spacers
and barriers. Bracing and other insulation used in the assembly of the winding shall be
arranged to ensure a free circulation of the oil and to reduce the hot spot of the winding.
The core shall be rigidly clamped and/or bolted to ensure adequate mechanical strength and
to prevent injury from vibrations or short circuit stresses. The bolts used in the assembly of
the core shall be suitably insulated and the clamping structure shall be constructed that the
eddy currents will be minimum.
All leads from the windings to the terminal board and bushings shall be rigidly supported to
prevent injury from vibration or short circuit stresses. Guide tube shall be used where
practicable.
The core shall be provided with Lugs suitable for lifting the complete core and coil assembly
of transformer. The Core & coil shall be fixed in the tank such that its shifting will not occur
when the transformer is moved or when a short circuit occurs.
The supporting frame work of the core shall be so designed as to avoid the presence of
pockets which would prevent complete draining of oil from the tank through the drain valve.
The frame work and clamping arrangement shall be earthed by connecting to the tank body
through a copper strip.
The insulation of core to bolts and core to clamp plates shall be able to withstand a voltage
of 2 KV RMS for one minute.
Core and windings shall be capable of withstanding shocks during transport, installation,
service and adequate provision shall be made to prevent movement of core and winding
relative to tank during these conditions.
3.3 Tappings
On-load taps as specified in Technical Particular shall be provided on the high voltage
winding of the transformer.
The transformer shall be capable of operation at rated output at any tap position provided the
primary voltage does not vary by more than 10% of the rated voltage corresponding to the
normal tap.
The winding including the tapping arrangement shall be designed to maintain the
electromagnetic balance between H.V. and L.V. winding at all voltage ratios.
3.4 On-Load Tap Changer
The on-load tap-changer (OLTC) to be equipped in the transformers and associated control
gear shall be from MR Germany or ABB Sweden or equivalent.
The continuous current rating of the tap changer shall be based on connected winding rating
and shall have liberal and ample margin. Lower rated tap changers connected in parallel are
not acceptable.
The tap changing mechanism shall be located in oil filled compartment separated from the
main tank by suitable oil tight barrier. The oil in OLTC compartment shall have its own
separate oil preservation system complete with conservator, Buchholz relay/ oil surge relay,
breather, shut-off valves, oil level gauge, gas vent etc. However, one segregated
compartment of the main conservator tank may be utilized for OLTC oil preservation.
The on-load tap changing equipment shall have the provision for mechanical and electrical
control from local position and electrical control from remote position. For local mechanical
operation, the operating handle shall be brought outside the tank for operation from floor
level with provision to lock the handle in each tap position. Remote electrical operation shall
have parallel operation mode and AUTO-MANUAL selection at remote location. When
selected AUTO, the tap changing gear shall maintain steady voltage within practical limit on
the transformer secondary bus from which the reference shall be taken within the range of
number of taps provided. It shall not respond to transient variation of voltage due to grid
disturbance, or system faults.
The required voltage relay shall not be sensitive to frequency variation and shall be suitable
for sensing voltage from the secondary of potential transformer mounted on LV side. The
secondary of potential transformer shall be 110V. The Bidder shall furnish detail of tap
changing mechanism, wiring and schematic connections.
The tap changer shall be provided with over-current protection in order to prevent the tap-
change operation during a short circuit, which would too greatly stress the contacts of the
diverter switch. Three instantaneous and self-reset over-current relays shall be provided and
the function of protection shall be arranged as follows:
a. Whenever over current occurs, the control circuit for commanding OLTC motor operation
shall be blocked by the normally close contacts of the over current relays.
b. If during tap change over current occurs, the OLTC motor circuit shall be blocked through
the mechanical cam switch, which is close from the very beginning to the very end of every
tap change operation and the normally open contacts of the over current relays. The stop
action of the motor shall be made through the motor brake contractor.
The design of the tap changing equipment shall be such that the mechanism will not stop in
any intermediate position. However, if the mechanism through faulty operation does stop in
an intermediate position, the transformer without injury must carry full load. The
mechanical position indicator shall be equipped in the motor drive cubicle. The motor shall
be designed to be of step control, which in any case the operation shall be of step by step.
The voltage-regulating relay shall be supplied together with the timer and under voltage
relay. The signal order from the voltage regulating relay to execute the tap changer
operation, when the regulating voltage is out of the voltage regulating level, shall be
designed to be delayed by the adjustable timer. If the control voltage falls abnormally, the
movement of the tap changer shall be locked by the contact of the under voltage relay, even
if the contacts of the voltage-regulating relay are working. The voltage regulating relay shall
be approved manufacturer.
The control circuit of the transformer shall be completely designed and provision shall be
made for parallel operation with another transformer. MASTER-FOLLOWER operation
mode shall be provided.
The following accessories, control and selector switches and other necessary accessories
shall be furnished.
PREVENTION OF ACIDITY: The design and all materials and process used in the
construction of the transformers shall be such as to reduce to a minimum the risk or the
development of acidity in the oil. Special measures, such as nitrogen sealing or the use of
inhibited oils shall be resorted to.
Particular attention shall be paid to deliver the oil at site free from moisture and of uniform
quality throughout in non-returnable steels drums. The quantity of oil for first filling of each
transformer shall be stated in tender along-with trade mark of the oil to be supplied. Use of
inhibitors in oil shall not be resorted to 10% extra oil of the total quantity of oil shall be
supplied along with the transformer.
The conservator tank with air cell shall be mounted on a bracket fixed on the tank.
The conservator tank may be provided with two compartments, one for the main transformer
tank while the other is for the OLTC compartment. The partition barrier shall be provided so
that OLTC oil shall not be mixed up with transformer oil under any circumstances. One
compartment shall be connected with the main transformer tank by pipes through double
float Buchholz Relay (gas operated relay) with valves at both ends. The other compartment
shall be connected with OLTC compartment by pipes through single float Buchholz
Relay/oil surge relay with valves at both ends.
The oil connections from the transformer tank to the conservator shall be at rising angle of 3
to 9 degrees to the horizontal up to Buchholz relay.
Using a flexible urethane air cell shall prohibit contact of the oil in the compartment for the
main tank with atmosphere. The conservator shall be provided with oil preservation system,
which should be suitable either to remove moisture continuously from air entering the air
space with which they are connected or may not allow direct contact of atmospheric air with
oil during operation, in addition to silica gel-breather.
Both compartments shall be provided with their own breather, filler cap and drain plug.
Each compartment of the conservator shall be provided with dial type level indicator visible
from the ground level and fitted with low oil-level alarm contact. Plain oil level gauge shall
also be provided to each compartment.
The above winding temperature indicator shall be provided with necessary contacts to take
care of the following.
One set of oil temperature indicator with maximum reading pointer and electrically separate
sets of contacts for alarm and trip shall be mounted locally so as to be readable at a standing
height from ground level.
All contacts should be accessible on removal of the cover adjustable to scale. It shall also be
possible to move the pointers by hand for checking the operation of contacts and associated
equipment.
3.8 Buchholz Relay (Gas Operated Relay - For Conservator Type of Oil Preservation)
The Buchholz Relay shall be provided with two floats and two pairs of electrically separate
contacts - one pair for alarm and the other pair for tripping.
Buchholz Relay shall be provided with the facility for testing by injection of air by hand
pump and with cock for draining and venting of air. The relay shall be provided with a test
cock to take a flexible connection for checking relay operation.
Above relay shall be stable during change in oil or gas pressure due to change in ambient
temperature and/ or loading.
The bushing shall be located so as to provide adequate electrical clearances between phases
and also between phase and ground as per relevant standards.
All bushings shall be porcelain type and shall be furnished complete with terminal
connectors of adequate capacity including arcing horns. The porcelain used in bushings shall
be homogeneous, nonporous, uniformly glazed to brown color and free from blisters, burns
and other defects.
Stresses due to expansion and contraction in any part of the bushing shall not lead to
deterioration.
Liquid/oil-filled bushings for 36 kV and above shall be equipped with liquid level indicators
and means for sampling and draining the liquid. The angle of inclination to vertical shall not
exceed 30 degree.
Oil in oil-filled bushings shall meet the requirement of the transformer oil standards
specified.
Bushings rated for 72.5 kV and above shall be of the oil-filled condenser type with a central
tube and draw-in conductor which shall be connected to the connector housed in the helmet
of the bushings. The pull through lead shall be fitted with a gas bubble deflector. Condenser
type bushings shall be equipped with following in addition to requirements indicated
elsewhere.
a. Provision for testing capacitance and loss angle (tan δ) without disconnecting main leads
The marshaling box shall have the following but not limited to them
h. Wiring and termination individually of the following trip contacts for remote trip and trip
alarm
Cubicle illumination lamp with door switch and space heater with thermostat and ON-OFF
switch shall be provided.
3.14 Painting
Painting works shall be as specified in Technical Requirements under section in General
Technical Specifications.
Tap changing gear shall be suitable for operation of 400V 10%, 3 phase, 4 wire, 50Hz,
AC.
The tap changing and cooler control supply voltage shall be 400/230V, 50Hz AC.
The manufacturer/bidder shall co-ordinate with illumination system supplier for his
requirement of 63A convenience outlet(s) and its location in outdoor switchyard for
purification of transformer oil during maintenance etc.
The transformer shall be provided with neutral bushing current transformer to be used for
earth fault protection in High/Low Voltage sides.
Current transformer rating and accuracy class shall be as per Technical Particular and shall
be designed to withstand the electromagnetic stresses developed during short circuit.
The current transformer secondary leads shall be wired up to a separate disconnecting type
terminal block within the marshaling box. The terminal blocks shall be complete with
shorting links.
Fan motors shall be of totally enclosed design and control equipment shall include a circuit
breaker with thermal and magnetic trip for each group of fans, contactors with overload
protection, and selector switch for MANUAL-AUTOMATIC operation.
The dimension of remote tap changer control panel shall be match with transformer control
panel.
5 Tests
5.1 Routine Tests
On completion, each transformer shall be subjected to the following Routine Tests. As far as
practical, the procedure of IEC 60076 shall be followed.
The ON-LOAD tap changer shall be tested in accordance with the relevant IEC standard.
The bodies of all valves and pipe works shall withstand a hydraulic pressure of 20 psig for
15 minutes. The testing medium shall be insulating oil as per IEC Publication 296.
If the inspection is waived, the routine, special and design test certificates of the transformer
as well as miscellaneous equipment shall be furnished for approval before the dispatch of
the equipment from the factory.
a. Construction inspection
b. Insulation oil test for
- Dielectric strength
- Acidity contain
- Dissolved gas analysis
These tests shall be conducted in the laboratory of the Employer at the Employer’s approved
rate at the cost of the contractor.
c. Measurement of insulation resistance
d. Ratio tests
e. Polarity tests
f. Tap change operation test, etc.
g. Magnetizing balance test
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 11 – Power Transformer Page 11-16
After manufacturer of the transformers, losses will be measured during factory inspection
test at manufacturer premises. If any of the losses are found to be more than the guaranteed
losses by the bidder in Technical Data Sheet (Guaranteed Technical Particulars), the bidder
will be panelized at the rate mentioned above.
6.2 Guaranteed Values Not Reached
If the individual losses of a power transformer as measured during test exceeds the values
guaranteed in the Bid, then for each kilowatt of losses in excess of the losses guaranteed, an
amount at the rates of twice the rates of specified in clause 3.6.1 for no load losses and load
losses shall be deducted from the Contract Price of the successful Bidder.
7 Performance Guarantee
The performance figures quoted on Technical Data Sheet shall be guaranteed within the
tolerances permitted by relevant standards listed under section of General Technical
Specifications, and shall become a part of the successful Bidder's Contract. In case of loss
capitalization, no tolerance shall be permitted for the guaranteed value. The transformer will
be rejected, if the measured no-load and load losses (excluding fan loss) exceed the
guaranteed value by over 15 % provided that the total losses do not exceed 10% as specified.
a. Outline dimensional drawing showing the general arrangement, indicating the space
required for:
- Cable termination arrangement
- Wheel base dimension & detail
Any other relevant data, drawing and information necessary for review of the items under
Clause No. 3.8.2 whether specifically mentioned or not, shall be furnished along with these
information.
9 Name Plate
Each transformer shall be provided with a nameplate of weather resistant material fitted in a
visible position showing but not limited to the following items:
a. Kind of transformer
b. Manufacturing standard
c. Manufacturer's name
d. Year of manufacture
e. Manufacturer's serial number
f. Number of phases and frequency
g. Rated power
h. Rated voltages and currents
i. Connection symbol (Vector group)
j. Percentage impedance at normal, highest and lowest taps at max. base MVA
k. Type of cooling
l. Total weight
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 11 – Power Transformer Page 11-18
10 Spares
The spare parts shall be provided in required quantities as listed in the Price Schedule.
Further spare-parts as recommended by the manufacturer shall also be included in the Price
Schedule.
11 Transportation
The core and coils shall be completely dried before shipment and assembled with tank and
with oil or dry nitrogen depending upon the size of the transformers. In order to facilitate
handling and shipping, as many external accessories as practical, including bushings, shall
be removed and replaced by special shipping covers. The Contractor shall give special
attention to the limitation of bridge capacity in Nepal and make necessary transportation
arrangements accordingly.
Bushings, radiators and other accessories, which may be affected by moisture, shall be
packed in moisture proof containers.
12 Transformer accessories
Each transformer furnished under this specification shall be equipped with the following:
a. Oil conservator with air cell having two compartments each with filler caps and drain plugs.
b. Two sets of Silica Gel breathers with connecting pipe and oil seal.
c. Air release plug.
d. Double float Buchholz Relay with electrically separate trip and alarm contacts for
transformer tank.
e. Two Nos. of shut-off valves at both sides of each Buchholz Relay.
f. Mechanically operated self-resetting type pressure relief device with visible operation
indicator and trip contact.
g. 150 mm Dial Magnetic Oil Level Gauge with low level alarm contact.
h. Direct Reading Plain Oil Level Gauge.
i. 150 mm Dial Oil Temperature Indicator with maximum reading pointer and individually
adjustable electrically separate sets of contact for alarm and trip.
j. 150 mm Dial Winding Temperature Indicator with individually adjustable electrically
separate sets of contact for two stage cooler control, alarm and trip with detector element
complete with heating coil, CT's etc.
k. Drain valve with threaded adapter.
l. Sample valve (top and bottom).
m.Filter valves with threaded adapter (top and bottom).
n. Cover lifting eyes.
o. Jacking pads, hauling and lifting lugs.
p. Bi-directional flanged wheels.
q. Rails.
r. Clamping device with nuts and bolts for clamping the transformer on foundation rails.
s. Ladder with safety device for access to the transformer top and Buchholz Relay.
t. Ground pads each with two (2) nos. tapped holes, bolts and washer for transformer tank,
radiator bank and cable-end box grounding.
u. Rating plate and terminal marking plate.
v. Marshaling box for housing control equipment and terminal connections.
w. Any other standard accessories including arcing horns, as required.
The transformer shall be equipped with on-line monitoring device and shall be compatible
with SCADA system.
CHAPTER – 12
1 General
This specification covers the design, manufacture, assembly, shop test, supply, delivery,
installation works, field test and commissioning of outdoor type disconnecting switches
complete with all accessories for efficient and trouble free operation as specified herein
under.
The Bidder shall submit type-test reports, valid ISO 9001 Certificates, necessary
technical brochures, as well as detailed drawings showing layout, section, various
clearances in conformity with relevant standards with his tender to verify compliance
with the requirement of these Specifications.
The equipment specified in this Section shall conform to the latest edition of the
appropriate IEC specifications and/or other recognized international standards. In
particular:
Any material and equipments not specifically stated in this specification but which are
necessary for satisfactory operation of the equipment shall be deemed to be included
unless specifically excluded and shall be supplied without any extra cost.
2 Design Requirements
The disconnecting switches shall be used for the 50Hz, 3 phase system. Earth switches
shall be provided on disconnecting switches wherever called for. Complete
disconnecting switches with all the necessary items for successful operation shall be
supplied.
The equipment shall be installed outdoor. All equipment, accessories and wiring shall be
provided with sub-tropical finish to prevent fungus growth.
The maximum temperature rise in any part of the equipment at specified rating shall not
exceed the permissible limits as stipulated in relevant standards.
The rated peak short circuit current or the rated short time current carried by the
disconnecting switches & earth switches shall not cause;
The disconnecting switches shall be center break or center rotating for 33 kV and center
break for 132 kV with contact blades moving through horizontal plane.
The rating, the accessories to be furnished and the schedule of equipment are detailed in
Technical Particular below.
The disconnecting switch shall be able to carry the rated current continuously and rated
short circuit current for one second without exceeding the temperature.
The disconnecting switches shall be capable of withstanding the dynamic and thermal
effects of maximum possible short circuit current.
In case of disconnecting switch with grounding switch, the grounding switch shall be
capable of making to a dead short circuit without damage of the equipment or
endangering operator. It shall be provided with and interlocking with the corresponding
disconnecting switch so that the earth switches can be operated only when the
disconnecting switches is open and vice versa.
The earthing Switches shall be capable of discharging trapped charges of the associated
lines. Disconnecting switches and earth switches shall be able to bear on the terminals
the total forces including wind loading and electro-dynamic forces on the attached
conductor without impairing reliability or current carrying capacity.
3 Construction Features
The 3-pole disconnecting switches shall be gang-operated type so that all the poles make
and break simultaneously.
All current carrying parts shall be of non-ferrous metal or alloy. Bolts, screws and pins
shall be provided with lock washers. Keys or equivalent locking facilities, if provided on
current carrying parts, shall be made of copper silicon alloy or equivalent. The live parts
shall be designed to eliminate sharp joints, edges and other corona producing surfaces.
All metal parts shall be of such material and treated in such a way as to avoid rust,
corrosion and deterioration due to atmospheric conditions. Ferrous parts shall be hot-dip
galvanized.
Bolts, nuts, pins, etc. shall be provided with appropriate locking arrangement such as
lock nuts, spring washers, key, etc.
Bearing housing shall be weatherproof with provision for lubrication. The design,
however, shall be such as not to require frequent lubrication.
All bearings in the current path shall be shorted by flexible copper conductor of adequate
size (minimum – 150 mm2) to allow the specified fault current through it without injury.
The design of linkages and gears shall be such so as to allow one man to operate the
handle with ease for disconnecting switches and earth switch.
The contacts shall have sufficient area and pressure to withstand the electromagnetic
stresses developed during short circuit without excessive heating liable to pitting or
welding.
Contacts shall be adjustable to allow for wear, shall be easily replaceable and shall have
minimum movable parts and adjustments.
The moving blade shall be made of electrolytic-copper/aluminum tube for center rotating
type disconnecting switch. Rotating feature of the blade at the end of tube travel for
contact wiping shall be provided.
Arcing horns shall be provided to divert the arc from main contacts to the separating
horns after the main contacts have opened. Arcing horns shall be renewable type.
The porcelain used for insulators shall be manufactured by wet process and shall be
homogenous and free from cavities and other flaws.
Caps and pins shall be of the highest quality malleable iron or forged steel and smoothly
galvanized.
The terminals of the disconnecting switch shall be provided with terminal connectors.
4 Operating Mechanism
The operating mechanism for 33 kV disconnecting switch shall be manual. The operating
handle shall be such that it can be operated easily from standing height from ground
level. Grounding of handle through copper flexible conductor of adequate size shall be
provided.
The control shall be such that the disconnecting switch can be opened or closed from
local as well as remote. LOCAL/REMOTE selector switch and OPEN/STOP/CLOSE
push buttons shall be provided at the local "Mechanism Box" for local electrical
operation. The LOCAL/REMOTE selector switch shall be lockable type.
Starters, relays and limit switches shall be provided as required for operation, indication
and interlocks. All electrical controls shall be suitable for 110V DC.
The disconnecting switch shall be provided with a minimum number of eight (8)
normally closed and eight (8) normally open electrically separated (Voltage free)
auxiliary contacts for system interlock in addition to the auxiliary contacts required for
its own indication and operational requirements so as to have a trouble free operation of
the system. The contacts shall be convertible type so that normally open contact may be
converted to normally closed contact and vice-versa at site. The auxiliary contacts shall
be suitable for 0.5A, 110V DC inductive breaking duty.
All auxiliary contacts shall be wired up to terminal block in local mechanism box. All
auxiliary contacts shall be silver plated and shall have positive wiping action when
closing.
The auxiliary contacts shall be adjustable type to suit the following requirements.
a) Signaling of "closed position" shall not take place unless main power contacts have
reached a position so that rated normal and short time current can be carried safely.
b) Signaling of "open position" shall not take place unless the main power contacts are at a
safe isolating distance.
The operating device, auxiliary switches and all other devices shall be housed in a
weatherproof box of sheet steel / aluminum alloy construction. The enclosure protection
of the mechanism box shall be IP-55W as per IEC. The thickness of the sheet steel shall
be at least 2mm. In the case of aluminum alloy, the operating box shall be of robust
design. The box shall have gasket-hinged door with lock and key. The box shall be
suitable for fixing on disconnecting switch steel structure. A 4mm thick removable gland
plate shall be provided at the bottom of the box for cable entry. The box shall be
mounted at a safe working clearance from the live parts of switches.
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two envelope
Chapter 12-Isolator Page 12-5
Thermostat-controlled space heater with ON-OFF switches rated 230V, 1 phase, 50Hz
shall be provided to prevent condensation within the mechanism box.
Where grounding Switches are specified these shall include the complete operating
mechanism and auxiliary contacts. The grounding Switches shall form an integral part of
the disconnecting switches and shall be mounted on the base frame of the disconnecting
switches. Grounding Switches shall be suitable for local operation only. The grounding
Switches shall be constructional interlocked with the disconnecting switches so that the
grounding Switches can be operated only when disconnecting switches is open and vice
versa.
The grounding switch shall be capable of withstanding the electrical and mechanical
stresses developed by a short circuit current specified in Appendix. The cross-section of
the flexible copper connection between rotating shaft and structure shall be capable to
allow specified fault through it without injury but of minimum size 150 mm2.
Arrangement shall be provided to padlock the grounding switch in open and closed
positions.
The operating handle shall be such that it can be operated easily from standing height
from ground level. Grounding of handle through copper flexible conductor of adequate
size shall be provided.
Each grounding switch shall be provided with four (4) normally closed and four (4)
normally open contacts for remote indication and interlocking purpose.
All the auxiliary contacts and interlocking coils shall be housed in a mechanism box. The
box shall be suitable for fixing on grounding switch steel structure. A 4mm thick
removable gland plate shall be provided at the bottom of the box for cable entry.
Auxiliary contacts shall be suitable for 0.5A, 110V DC inductive breaking duty.
5 Tests
a) Construction Inspection
b) Power frequency voltage dry test
c) Measurement of resistance of main circuit
d) Control and secondary wiring check tests
e) Mechanical operation test
The voltage drop across one complete phase of a switch shall be measured when carrying
rated current.
The Bidder shall submit type test report as specified in section-2 of this specification for
the disconnecting switch of the offered model along with the bid.
a) Construction inspection
b) Measurement of insulation resistance of main and auxiliary circuits
c) Mechanical operation test
d) Measurement of resistance of main contact
After award of Contract the Contractor shall submit the required number of copies of the
following drawings and data for approval of the Employer.
h) Any other relevant data, drawing and information necessary for review of the items
stated above.
7 Spare Parts
For each type of disconnecting switch, the spare parts shall be provided in required
quantities as listed in Price Schedule. Further spare parts as recommended by the
manufacturer shall also be included in the Price Schedule.
CHAPTER – 13
CIRCUIT BREAKERS
1 SCOPE
1.1 These specifications are intended to cover the design, engineering, manufacturing,
inspection and testing at manufacturer’s shop, packing, supply & delivery, storage,
transportation up to site, testing & commissioning of the outdoor type circuit breakers,
complete with motor operated spring charged/pneumatic operating mechanism,
unitized air compressed system, air receiver, gas monitoring instruments, operating
mechanism, terminal connectors, hot dip galvanized supporting structures with
foundation bolts/ copper piping/ connectors/ valves, cable glands inter connecting cables
complete with all materials, accessories and fittings, erection & maintenance tools &
tackles, mandatory spares as detailed in this specification.
1.2 The design and workmanship shall be in accordance with the best engineering practices
to ensure satisfactory performance throughout the service life.
1.3 Any material and equipments not specifically stated in this specification but which are
necessary for satisfactory operation of the equipment shall be deemed to be included
unless specifically excluded and shall be supplied without any extra cost.
2.2 Circuit breakers shall be offered from reputed & standard makes which shall be qualified
as per Section 3 EQC.
3 STANDARDS
The equipment specified in this Section shall conform to the latest edition of the
appropriate IEC specifications and/or other recognized international standards. In
particular:
4 DESIGN REQUIREMNET
The circuit breakers shall be suitable for 3 phase, 50 Hz. and shall be installed in
outdoor.
All equipment and accessories shall be provided with sub-tropical finish to prevent
fungus growth.
The maximum temperature rise in any part of the equipment at specified rating shall not
exceed the permissible limits as stipulated in relevant standards.
The support structure of circuit breaker shall be hot dip galvanized. Exposed hardware
items shall be hot dip galvanized or Electro-galvanized.
The rated peak short circuit current or the rated short time current carried by the
equipment shall not cause:
All auxiliary equipment shall be suitable for 3 phase-4 wires, 400V or single phase 230
V, 50 Hz system. All controls shall be suitable for 110V DC.
5 CONSTRUCTION FEATURES
The circuit breaker shall be outdoor, three-phase, (single-throw or), spring charged motor
operated, trip free in any position, complete with operating mechanism and supporting
structure.
The 145kV circuit breaker shall be SF6 gas type whereas the 36 kV circuit breaker shall
be Vacuum type.
The circuit breaker shall be capable of interrupting the steady state and transient
magnetizing current corresponding of power transformers.
The Breaker shall satisfactorily withstand the high stresses imposed on them during fault
clearing, load rejection and re-energisation of lines with trapped charges. The breaker
shall also withstand the voltages specified in the technical specification of this Section.
5.2 Contacts
The contacts shall be designed to have adequate thermal and current carrying capacity
for carrying full rated current without exceeding the allowable temperature rise as
specified by IEC standards. They shall be designed to have long life so that frequent
replacement or maintenance will be unnecessary. The surfaces of either of both moving
and stationary arcing-contacts that are exposed directly to the arc shall be faced with
suitable arc resisting material.
The gap between the open contacts shall be such that it can withstand at least the rated
phase to ground voltage for 8 hours at zero gauge pressure of SF6 gas due to the leakage.
The breaker should be able to withstand all dielectric stresses imposed on it in open
condition at lock out pressure continuously (i.e. 2 p.u. across the breaker continuously,
for validation of which a power frequency dielectric with stand test conducted for a
duration of at least 15 minutes is acceptable).
The tripping circuit mechanism and the closing control circuit mechanism shall each
have a nominal voltage rating of 110 volts DC. The tripping circuit shall operate
satisfactorily for a tripping operation over a voltage range of 70-110%. The closing
control circuit shall operate satisfactorily over a voltage range of 85-110%.
The mechanism shall be anti-pumping and trip free (as per IEC definition) under every
method of closing.
As long as power is available to the motor, a continuous sequence of the closing and
opening operations shall be possible. The motor shall have adequate thermal rating for
this duty.
After failure of power supply to the motor one close open operation shall be possible
with the energy contained in the operating mechanism.
Breaker operation shall be independent of the motor which shall be used solely for
charging the closing spring.
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 13 - Circuit Breaker Page 13-5
Each operating mechanism shall be provided with a spring charging motor with a
common control cabinet.
- The time required to charge the closing spring after the closing operation shall not
exceed 30 seconds.
- Under voltage alarm relay suitable for operation on DC circuit to permit remote
indication of loss of potential on the AC to the control gear.
- Spring charged indicator shall indicate the state of energy store in the spring. Indication
for fully charged spring shall be provided both at local and remote control panel.
- When closing springs are discharged after closing a breaker, closing springs shall be
automatically charged for the next operation and an indication of this shall be provided
in the local and remote control cabinet.
- Means shall be provided to prevent the operation of the mechanism when
maintenance work is being done. The mechanism shall be so arranged that emergency
manual charging and release of the spring is possible without electrical means. One (1)
CO-operation shall be possible after failure of supply.
Working parts of the mechanism shall be corrosion resisting material, bearings which
require grease shall be equipped with pressure type grease fittings. Bearing pin, bolts,
nuts and other parts shall be adequately pinned or locked to prevent loosening or
changing adjustment with repeated operation of the breaker.
The bidder shall furnish detailed operation and maintenance manual of the mechanism
along with the operation manual for the circuit breaker. The instruction manuals shall
contain exploded diagrams with complete storage, handling, erection, commissioning,
troubleshooting, servicing and overhauling instructions.
A local control switch connected with a remote-local selector switch shall be furnished
and wired in the control circuits of the breaker. The local control switch shall be
operative from within the operating cubicle only when the selector switch is in local
position.
5.12 Bushings
The bushings shall be of the porcelain gas filled, designed to have ample insulation,
mechanical strength and rigidity for the conditions under which they will be used.
6 ACCESSORIES
The Contractor shall furnish following accessories as an integral part of each circuit
breaker:
7 SPARE PARTS
For each type of circuit breaker, the spare parts shall be provided in required quantities
as listed in Price Schedule. Further spare parts as recommended by the manufacturer
shall also be included in the Price Schedule.
8 TESTS
8.1 Routine Tests
On completion, each circuit breaker shall be subjected to following routine tests. As far
as practical, the procedure of IEC shall be followed:
a) Construction Inspection
b) Leakage Test (for SF6 circuit breaker)
c) Operating Speed Check
d) Dielectric test
e) Control and secondary wiring check test
f) Mechanical operation test
g) Operating mechanism system check
h) Voltage withstand test on auxiliary circuits
i) Measurement of resistance of main circuit of each pole
j) Power frequency voltage withstand test on main circuit of each pole and the combination
of poles and breaker frame.
The Bidder shall submit type test report as specified in Chapter-2 of this specification for
the circuit breaker of the offered model along with the bid.
The contractor shall ensure that erection, testing and commissioning of circuit breaker
shall be carried out under the supervision of the circuit breaker manufacturer's
representative. The commissioning report shall be signed by the manufacturer’s
representative.
9 Performance Guarantee
The performance guarantee figures quoted on the schedule of Technical Data shall be
guaranteed within the tolerances permitted by relevant standard and will become a part
of successful Bidder's Contract.
After award of Contract the Contractor shall submit the required number of copies of the
following drawings and data for approval of the Employer.
11 Nameplate
Circuit breaker shall be provided with a nameplate of stainless steel material fitted in a
visible position. It shall show the following items as a minimum.
a) Circuit Breaker (Note: Circuit breaker and operating cubicle nameplates may be
combined)
- Manufacturer's name
- Manufacturer's serial number and type designation
- Year of manufacture
- Rated voltage, kV
- Rated insulation level, kV
- Rated frequency, Hz
- Rated nominal current, A
- Rated short circuit breaking current, kA
- Rated short circuit making current, kA
- Rated operating cycle (duty cycles)
- Rated short time current & duration, kA/s
- Rated operating sequence (duty cycles)
- Type of operating mechanism
- First pole to clear factor
- Rated interrupting time, cycles
- Rated operating pressure (SF6), kg/cm2
- Weight of circuit breaker, kg
- Parts list number
b) Operating cubicle (Note: Operating cubicles and circuit breaker nameplates may
be combined.)
- Manufacturer's name
- Manufacturer's serial number and type designation
- Year of manufacture
- Rated supply-voltage of closing and opening devices, V
- Rated supply-frequency of closing and opening devices, Hz
- Closing current, A
- Tripping current, A
- Rated supply-voltage of auxiliary circuits, V
- Rated supply-frequency of auxiliary circuits, Hz
- Parts list number
12 Special Tools
In addition to the tools, which are regularly furnished with such breakers, the Contractor
shall also supply all necessary special tools or equipment for assembling and
disassembling the breaker. The Contractor shall submit an itemized list of such
equipment in the Price Schedule.
CHAPTER – 14
SURGE ARRESTORS
1 General
This specification covers the design, manufacture, shop test, delivery, installation, field
test and commissioning of lightning arresters, complete with all accessories. The
equipment specified in this Section shall conform to the latest edition of the appropriate
IEC specifications and/or other recognized international standards. In particular:
The Bidder shall submit type-test reports, valid ISO 9001 Certificates, necessary
technical brochures, as well as detailed drawings showing layout, section, various
clearances in conformity with relevant standards with his tender to verify compliance
with the requirement of these Specifications.
2 Design Requirements
The lightning arresters shall be of heavy duty station class and gapless type without any
series or shunt gaps.
The lightning arresters shall be suitable for a nominal system of 3 phase, 50Hz solidly
grounded system. Lightning arresters shall be provided at entry points of the overhead
transmission lines and both HV & LV sides of the transformers.
The lightning arresters shall be station type / transformer-tank-mounted, gap less metal
oxide type of rated voltage of 120 kV for 132 kV systems, 30 kV for 33 kV systems and
9 kV for 11 kV systems. The nominal discharge current shall not be less than 10 kA. The
selection of Lightning arrester shall be done by the contractor based on insulation co-
ordination study without any additional cost to the Employer.
145 kV class arrester shall be capable for discharging energy equivalent to class 3 of IEC
for 145 kV systems on two successive operations.
The active part of the lightning arresters shall be accommodated in single stacked
porcelain insulators, which are suitably reinforced to prevent explosion of an arrester.
The duty cycle of CB installed in 132 kV System shall be O-0.3 sec-CO-3 min-CO. The
lightning Arrester shall be suitable for such circuit breaker duties in the system.
The technical features of the lightning arresters are given in Table below.
3 Constructional Features
The features and constructional details of surge arresters shall be in accordance with
requirement stipulated hereunder:
a) The non-linear blocks shall be of sintered metal oxide material. These shall be provided
in such a way as to obtain robust construction, with excellent mechanical and electrical
properties even after repeated operations.
b) The surge arresters shall be fitted with pressure relief devices suitable for preventing
shattering of porcelain housing and providing path for flow of rated fault currents in the
event of arrester failure. Details shall be furnished in the bids along with quality checks.
c) The outer insulator housing shall be so coordinated that external flashover will not occur
due to application of any impulse or switching surge voltage up-to the maximum design
value for arrester.
d) The end fittings shall be made of corrosion proof material and preferably be
nonmagnetic.
e) The name plate shall conform to the requirements of IEC incorporating the year of
manufacture.
f) The manufacturer shall submit Data for rejection rate of ZnO blocks during
manufacturing/operation for the past three years.
Self-contained discharge counters, suitably enclosed for outdoor use and requiring no
auxiliary or battery supply for operation shall be provided for each single pole unit along
with necessary connection. Suitable leakage current meters should also be provided.
The reading of milli ammeter and counters shall be visible through an inspection glass
panel. The terminals shall be robust and of adequate size and shall be so located that
incoming and outgoing connections are made with minimum possible bends.
Surge monitor consisting of discharge counters and mili ammeters should be suitable to
be mounted on support structure of the arrester and should be tested for IP66 degree of
protection. The standard supporting structure for Lightning arrester should be provided
with a mounting pad, for fixing the surge monitor. The surge monitor should be suitable
for mounting on this standard mounting pad. Also all nuts, bolts, washers etc. required
for fixing the surge monitor shall have to be supplied by the Contractor.
The arrangement for Surge Monitor enclosure fixing to the structure shall be at its
rear/bottom. Connection between the Surge Arrester base and Surge Monitor shall be
through a 2.0 m (minimum) long insulated copper rod/strip of at least 75 sq.mm cross
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS--076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 14 - Surge Arrestors Page 14-3
sectional area. The cable shall be terminated at rear/bottom side of the Surge Monitor.
The gaskets of the surge monitors shall be of Neoprene, Butyl or equivalent material.
5 TEST
a) Construction inspection
b) Measurement of reference voltage
c) Residual voltage test
d) Internal partial discharge test.
The Bidder shall submit type test report as specified in section-2 of this specification for
the Lightning arrester of the offered model along with the bid.
Contractor shall perform any additional test based on specialties of the items as per the
field Q.P./Instructions of the equipment Supplier or Employer without any extra cost to
the Employer. The Contractor shall arrange all instruments required for conducting these
tests along with calibration certificates and shall furnish the list of instruments to the
Purchaser for approval.
6 Drawings and Data
The following documents shall be furnished along with the bid:
The following drawings and data shall be furnished in required number of copies after
award of Contract for approval of Employer:
7 Name Plate
Each lightning arrester shall be provided with a nameplate of weather resistant material
fitted in a visible position showing the following items as a minimum:
a) Manufacturer's name
b) Manufacturer's serial number and type designation
c) Year of manufacture
d) Rated voltage
e) Nominal discharge current
8 TECHNICAL PARTICULARS
Surge Arrestor Technical Particulars for 132/33/11 kV Substation shall as follow:
TABLE-1.1
i. Type Heavy duty, station class, Gapless
Metal oxide, outdoor
ii. Arrestor rating (kV rms) 120 30 9
iii. Maximum Continuous Operating voltage 102 25 7.65
(kV rms)
iv. Lightning Impulse withstand voltage 650 170 75
(kVp)
v. Power Frequency Withstand Voltage 275 70 28
(kVrms)
vi. Standard Nominal Discharge Current 10 kA (8/20 micro impulse shape)
voltage at 10 kA (kVp)
x. Max. Lightening Impulse residual 330 90 25
voltage at 10 kA (kVp)
xi. Max. switching surge residual voltage at 280 63 21
1 kA (kVp)
xii. Partial discharge at 1.05 COV not 50pC
greater than
xiii. Max. discharge capability 5Kj/kV
corresponding to rated voltage
xiv. Low current long duration test value 2400 µs
xv. High current short duration test value 100kA
(4/10 µ second wave)
xvi. Minimum Corona Extinction Voltage 105 NA NA
(kVrms)
xvii. Maximum partial discharge at 50 pC
1.05*Continuous Over Voltage(COV)
xviii. Prospective symmetrical fault current for 31.5 25 18.4
pressure relief test for (0.2 sec) kA
xix. Creepage distance (mm) 3625 900 300
The above parameters are applicable for installations up to an altitude of 1000m above
mean sea level. For altitude exceeding 1000m, necessary altitude correction factor shall
be applicable as per IEC or part thereof.
CHAPTER – 15
INSTRUMENT TRANSFORMER
1 General
This specification covers the design, manufacture, assembly, shop test, supply, delivery,
installation, field test and commissioning of outdoor and indoor instrument transformers
as specified herein under.
The equipment specified in this Section shall conform to the latest edition of the
appropriate IEC specifications and/or other recognized international standards. In
particular:
The Bidder shall submit type-test reports, valid ISO 9001 Certificates, necessary
technical brochures, as well as detailed drawings showing layout, section, various
clearances in conformity with relevant standards with his tender to verify compliance
with the requirement of these Specifications.
2 Design Requirements
Instrument transformers shall be suitable for 50Hz, 3 phases with solidly grounded
neutral system.
Instrument transformers shall be installed outdoor/indoor in a hot and humid climate. All
equipment and accessories shall be provided with tropical finish to prevent fungus
growth.
Capacitor voltage transformers shall be provided with accessories suitable for carrier
equipment.
Burden of the instrument transformers stated herein is the minimum value required.
Where higher burden is required to suit the designs, the Contractor shall supply the same
without additional cost.
The instrument transformers shall be complete with its terminal box and a common
marshalling box for a set of 3 instrument transformers.
The external surface of instrument transformer, if made of steel, shall be hot dip
galvanized or painted.
3 Construction Features
3.1 General
The instrument transformers of 132 kV and 33 kV voltage level shall be oil-filled
construction and shall be designed for outdoor service and suitable for outdoor service
and vertical mounting on steel structures.
The core and coils of current transformer shall be mounted in a steel tank on the top of
the unit with the primary coil leads extending through insulated bushings for series or
multiple connections. A steel base shall support the high voltage bushing and tank. The
high voltage bushing shall be sealed to the tank and the base with oil-tight joints.
The capacitor voltage transformers shall be of high Capacitance with two nominal
voltage outputs of 110/√3 volts each. They must be suitable for revenue metering and
protection system.
The primary terminals of instruments shall include provisions for externally connecting
the primary winding. The secondary terminals shall be enclosed in a weatherproof
terminal box.
Polarity marks shall indelibly be marked on each instrument transformer and at the lead
terminals at the associated terminal block.
Porcelain bushings shall have adequate mechanical and electrical strength. The color of
porcelain shall be brown. It shall be in one piece without any metallic flange joint.
mm. Junction boxes shall be sized and arranged to provide easy access for external
cables and adequate space for internal wiring and installed equipment. Enclosure
protection class of the junction boxes shall be IP55W.
3.4 Terminations
a) Current Transformers
All current transformer secondary-winding terminals for each ratio shall be connected to
terminals on terminal blocks located in the junction boxes.
All CVTs' secondary terminals (for each core) shall be connected to terminals for each
ratio on terminal blocks located in the junction boxes.
4 Accessories
The following items shall be provided for each instrument transformer:
a) Nameplate
b) Oil level gauge
c) Oil valves or plugs
d) Power factor test terminals
e) Necessary terminal connections
f) Grounding terminals
g) Other necessary accessories
5 Tests
Test shall be performed as specified hereunder.
- Construction Inspection
- Verification of terminal markings
- Power frequency withstand test (primary & secondary)
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 15 - Instrument Transformer Page 15-4
Design tests
Each capacitive voltage transformer shall be subjected to following routine tests. As far
as practical, the procedure of IEC shall be followed:
- Construction Inspection
- Capacitance and dissipation factor measurement of the capacitor divider before and after
power frequency withstand voltage (dry) test
- Power frequency withstand voltage (dry) test for capacitor divider
- Dielectric tests for electromagnetic unit
- Ratio Test
- Accuracy tests
- Polarity check
- Applied and Induced over voltage test, etc.
Design Tests
Each voltage transformer shall be subjected to following routine tests. As far as practical,
the procedure of IEC shall be followed:
- Construction Inspection
- Verification of terminal marking
- Power frequency withstand test on primary winding
- Partial discharge measurement
- Power frequency withstand test on secondary winding
- Power frequency withstand test on between sections
- Ratio Test
- Determination of error
Design Tests
a. Construction inspection
b. Polarity check
c. Ratio test
d. Measurement of insulation resistance
The Bidder shall submit type test report as specified in section-2 of this specification for
the instrument transformers of the offered model along with the bid.
After award of Contract the Contractor shall submit the required number of copies of the
following drawings for approval of the Employer/ the Employer’s representative.
Table-1: Technical particulars of capacitor voltage transformers for 132 kV and inductive
voltage transformer for 33 kV
The above parameters are applicable for installations up to an altitude of 1000m above
mean sea level. For altitude exceeding 1000m, necessary altitude correction factor shall
be applicable as per IEC or part thereof.
CHAPTER - 16
BATTERY AND BATTERY CHARGER
1 General
This specification covers design, manufacture, assembly, factory test, supply, delivery,
installation, field test and commissioning of a stationary battery or batteries each complete with
battery charger, distribution board and control gear.
The Bidder shall submit type-test reports, valid ISO 9001 Certificates, necessary technical
brochures, sales records, as well as detailed drawings showing layout, section, various
clearances in conformity with relevant standards with his tender to verify compliance with
the requirement of these Specifications.
Two sets of batteries and two sets of battery chargers shall be provided for each of the
following voltage levels. The operation shall be such that each set of battery shall be
connected with two sets of chargers, out of which one set shall be for main supply and the
other as a backup (it should be online along with main supply and should act instantaneously
when main supply is inactive or offline).
110 V DC shall be used for control, protection and Automation.
- 48 V DC shall be used for Communication/SCADA systems.
It shall be ensured that the 110 V power supply system operates with both battery terminals
free of earth, whilst that for communications, 48 V DC system with positive earthed, to detect
faults on both the positive and negative poles.
48V Battery Charger shall consist of required numbers of MCB’s of adequate capacity for
supply of 48V DC supply required different panels loads.
2 Batteries
The Contractor shall offer maintenance free valve regulated lead-acid 110 V and 48 V
batteries. The batteries shall be assembled in heavy-duty-steel structure designed for easy
stack ability.
The battery cells shall be hermetically sealed, sturdy, weather proof and long lasting. The
safety valves, if provided shall be explosion free. All the cells shall be mounted on racks of
plastic-covered steel. More than 2 levels shall not be permitted. If the batteries are located
together in two rows, provide enough space for maintenance access along the two long
sides.
The arrangement of the rack shall be such as to allow easy access and adequate space for
normal maintenance in battery room.
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 16 - Battery and Battery Charger Page 16-2
All battery stands shall be suitably protected against corrosion and attack by the battery
electrolyte. Inter-cell connections shall be made of low resistance in a clean condition when
bolted and protected against corrosion.
The lowest rack for accommodating battery cells shall be at a minimum of 30 cm above
ground level.
Bidder shall select number of cells, float and Boost voltage to achieve following system
requirement:
The equipment shall be designed to operate within voltage limits specified below i.e. no
spurious operations or false controls shall be initiated. 48 V DC power supplied shall have
the following general characteristics:
The chargers for communications batteries shall be such that the phosphometric noise level
does not exceed the equivalent of 2 milli-volts at a frequency of 800 Hz after weighing in
accordance with CCIF, the charger output being at any point within its rating with the
battery connected.
The DC output of each main charger unit shall remain within the limits of +3% and -2%
under any of the following conditions:
The constant voltage charge level on a cell shall be 2.25 V or any other value recommended
by the offered battery manufacturer. The Battery charger output rating shall be 80 A and 120
A for 110 V charger and 40 A and 60 A for 48 V charger.
The equalizing and float voltage levels shall be adjustable and suitable for the range of
operating conditions recommended by the battery manufacturer.
The static direct voltage variation shall be maintained as specified over an ambient
temperature range of 0 to 45oC.
The end switching / dropper diodes, if required, to limit equipment over voltage during
equalizing charge shall be provided.
A voltmeter and charge and load ammeters on the front of the charger panels shall be
provided. Provisions of AC and DC, under voltage and DC earth fault alarms with local
indication (LED type indicator lamp) and separate electrically isolated contacts shall be
made in the control panel.
The charger shall be equipped with automatic switch to transfer from the floating voltage to
the equalizing voltage under the following conditions:
- When the voltage of the connected battery reaches the minimum prescribed value for a
time longer than one minute.
- Every 30 days.
A manual override switch for selection of float charge and equalizing charge for test
purposes shall also be provided.
An adjustable timer (6-24 hours) to determine the length of time the equalizing voltage shall
be provided.
The AC component through the battery of the delivered DC shall not exceed 1 A rms per 50
Ah of battery capacity. The superimposed alternating voltage component shall not exceed
2% of the peak values during continuous charge operation. This applies for the entire
frequency range.
The connection blocks for the connection of cables shall be of a minimum of 16 sq. mm. or
as required as per voltage drop calculation.
The float charging voltage shall be between 2.1 to 2.25 volts per cell or at any other voltage
recommended by the battery manufacturer. The battery charger shall have boost facility.
The boost-charging voltage shall be about 2.3 to 2.4 volts/cell or at any other voltage
recommended by the battery manufacturer.
The equipment shall be designed to facilitate cable entry from bottom. Removable plates
shall be furnished with compression type cable glands to make entry dust tight and no
weight is transferred on the terminal. The glands shall be suitable for terminating cable
armor. Compression type cable lugs as required shall be furnished for termination of power
and control cables.
Sufficient space shall be provided to avoid sharp bending and for easy connection. A
minimum space of 200 mm from the gland plate to the nearest terminal block shall be
provided.
All indicating instruments, control switches and indicating lamps shall be mounted on the
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 16 - Battery and Battery Charger Page 16-5
Each Charger shall be furnished completely wired upto power cable lugs and terminal
blocks and ready for external connections. The control wiring shall be carried out with PVC
insulated, 1.5 sq.mm stranded copper wires. Control terminals shall be suitable for
connecting two wires, with 2.5 sq.mm stranded copper conductors. All terminals shall be
numbered for ease of connections and identification. Each wire shall bear a ferrule or tag on
each end for identification. At least 20% spare terminals shall be provided for control
circuits.
The insulation of all circuits, except the low voltage electronic circuits shall withstand test
voltage of 2 KV AC for one minute.
The charger shall be complete with the standard accessories including but not limited to the
following.
4 Annunciation System
Audio-visual indications through bright LEDs shall be provided in all Chargers for the
following abnormalities:
a) AC power failure
b) Rectifier/chargers fuse blown.
c) Over voltage across the battery when boost charging.
d) Abnormal voltage (High/Low)
Any other annunciation if required. Potential free NO Contacts of above abnormal conditions
shall also be provided for common remote indication “CHARGER TROUBLE” in for future
use. Indication for charger in float mode and boost mode through indication lamps shall be
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 16 - Battery and Battery Charger Page 16-6
provided for chargers. A potential free contact for float/boost mode shall be provided for
external interlocks.
5 Tests
Type and routine tests at manufacturers' works and acceptance test at site shall be carried out on
the battery/battery chargers as per stipulations of latest standard of IEC.
a) General inspection.
b) Leakage test and internal short test for each cell.
a) Capacity test.
b) Efficiency test, etc.
The battery charger shall be subjected to the following tests at manufacturer's works:
a) Construction Inspection
b) Measurement on insulation resistance.
c) High voltage test.
d) Performance test.
e) Temperature rise test.
The following drawings and manuals shall be submitted by the successful Bidder for approval:
The board shall be metal clad, totally enclosed indoor floor mounted, and free-standing
cubicle type. Entry for incoming and outgoing cables shall be from bottom. Bus-bars
shall be made of tinned copper and insulated. The construction feature, pre-treatment,
painting and other aspects shall comply with specification covered for LT AC/DC board.
The frame shall be fabricated using suitable mild steel structural section or pressed and
shaped cold rolled sheet steel of thickness not less than 2.0 mm. The panel shall be
provided with circuits and components such as meters, relays, etc. as per the 110 V DC
single line diagram enclosed. Main bus bar shall be of high conductivity tinned copper of
uniform rectangular cross section provided with positive and negative bus bars of adequate
size. Components such as MCBs etc. shall be of reputed make with proven performance
record and suitable for DC application. The bus bars shall be insulated.
The DC distribution panel shall be complete with bus bars, input/output terminals, inter
panel connections, internal wiring, name and rating plates, mimic diagram (at the front of
the switchboard), earthing bus and space heaters etc. The terminals shall be of reputed
make and will be subject to approval of Employer.
In case of AC failure, DC board shall supply emergency light in the Control Room
building. Necessary devices for automatic change over for emergency lighting from AC to
DC supply complete with necessary relays, interlocking and indications etc. shall be
provided. Details shall be approved during engineering stage.
7.3 Earthing
An earth bus bar of 25 mm Copper Flat (to be got approved from Employer during
detailed engineering) shall be provided along the entire length of the switchboard at the
bottom. Two number earthing terminals connected to the earth bus bar shall be provided
on the external face of the board for connection to the earthing grid at the sub-station.
All outgoing & incoming feeders shall be through MCCB/MCB’s the isolating links shall
be provided before MCCB/MCB.
CHAPTER - 17
ILLUMINATION/LIGHTING SYSTEM
1 General
This chapter covers the scope and general description of the design, supply, installation,
testing and commissioning of illumination system, which shall be incorporated and
coordinated during the substation construction works. Illumination system design shall be
submitted for approval of the Employer.
The explanations and listings hereinafter are intended to give a general requirement of the
illumination design and installation and shall not be construed to be an itemized listing of
each element of works required. The Bidder shall be responsible for design and installation
of complete facilities, conforming in all respects to the relevant standards and to the details
and requirements of the specifications.
The Bidder shall submit test reports, valid ISO 9001 Certificates, necessary technical
brochures, as well as detailed drawings showing layout, section, various clearances in
conformity with relevant standards with his tender to verify compliance with the
requirement of these Specifications.
2 System Description
The lighting system shall comprise of the following:
a) AC Normal Lighting
AC lights will be connected to AC lighting panels. All the lights connected to the AC
lighting system in different areas will be connected to the main lighting distribution boards.
b) DC Emergency Lighting
A few DC emergency lighting fixtures operated on the 110 V DC system will be provided in
the strategic locations including, outdoor substation, Battery charger room, control room, 11
kV switchgear room, communication room so that the operating personnel can safely find
their way even during emergency of a total AC failure. These lights will be normally 'OFF'
and will be switched 'ON' automatically when under voltage occurs in the AC lighting panel.
Down light fixtures in false ceiling area and Bulkhead fixtures in non false ceiling area shall
be used.Control board shall be equipped with necessary contactors and timers to control
number of lighting fixtures in gang. Details shall be worked out to the satisfactory to the
employer.
The minimum lux level to average lux level ratio should not be less than 0.6 times of
average lux level specified (i.eEmin/Eav> 0.6). The maintenance factor for indoor
illumination design shall be considered as 0.8. The surface reflectance for ceiling/wall/floor
shall be 50/30/10.
Lighting in all indoor areas shall be done by CFL/LED & fluorescent energy efficient based
low power consumption luminaries and HPSV type for outdoor areas to achieve desired lux
level specified.
2.2 Receptacles
All receptacles shall be suitable for fixing on wall or column and complete with individual
switch.
Appropriate socket-outlet shall be installed near each Power and Distribution transformers
for connecting mobile oil treatment equipment.
General purpose and welding sockets outlets for maintenance shall be distributed in the
whole Substation area. The distance between two sockets shall not be greater than 30
meters.
RP Outdoor for oil filtration of 63A, 415V, Inter locked switch socket,
transformer receptacle
RI Indoor 5/15A, 240V, Receptacle 3-pin
type(Modular)
All switches and receptacles shall be flush type and shall be capable to carry a continuous
current to the rated capacity. Corresponding plug shall be furnished for every installed
receptacle plus 10 pieces for spares.
3 Description of Works
The illumination works shall consist of outdoor substation lighting, control building lighting
and roads lighting, lighting for gate post etc. All lighting fixtures shall energy efficient type.
The outdoor substation lighting shall consist of lighting of the area covered by substation
equipment, access road, and substation compound lighting.
Lighting fixture shall be of outdoor, flood light type, symmetrical beam spread of not less
than 2x30° with built-in ballast. The housing shall be die cast aluminium and the reflector
shall be high-grade aluminium. A cast aluminium doorframe shall be designed for easy
replacement of lamp. The front glass shall be heat & shock resistance with the gasket for jet
proof and dust proof sealing.
The lamps shall be of sodium vapour, 400/250 watts, 230 volts and shall have minimum
luminous flux of 20,000 lumens with 16,000 hour service life.
The ballast shall be high efficiency electronic type and shall be used with 400/250 watts
lamp, 230 volts, 50 hertz. The ballast shall be electrically designed to ensure very low
operating temperature and low wattage losses.
The wiring cable shall be of armoured single core, directly burial and shall be installed
underground or laid in the cable trench except those rising along the steel structures shall be
run in conduits.
The luminaire is based on CFL or HPSV. The street light poles of 8m height shall be steel
tubular poles complete with fixing brackets and junction boxes mounted 1 m above ground.
The galvanized sheet steel junction box for the street lighting pole shall be completely
weather proof conforming to IP: 55 poles with lockable door and with MCB. The terminal
shall be stud type and suitable for 2 nos. , 16 mm2cable and double compression
gland.Wiring from junction box at the bottom of the pole to the fixture at the top of the pole
shall be done by using 2.5 mm2copper cables.
Lighting Fixtures shall be outdoor, post top, bottom support with built in ballast. The
electrical unit shall be made of high-pressure die cast aluminium with non-corrosive finish
and shall contain a ballast, capacitor and lamp holder. The diffusing bowl shall be conical
and shall consist of spun aluminium canopy and white opal diffuser. The diffuser shall be
vandal-proof and shall be ultra violet radiation and heat resistance. The fixture shall be
rainproof and insect tight. All metal parts shall be made of non-corrosive material.
The lamp shall be of sodium vapour, 250 watts, 230 volts and shall have minimum luminous
flux of 11,000 lumens with 16,000 hour service life.
The ballast shall be of high efficiency electronic type and shall be used with 250 watts lamp,
230 volts, 50 hertz. The ballast shall be electrically designed to ensure very low operating
temperature and low wattage losses.
The wiring cable shall be of armored single core, directly buried and shall be installed
underground or laid in the cable trench except those rising along the steel structures shall be
run in conduits.
Unless described herein, the control building lighting design shall conform to Illuminating
Engineering Society, National Electrical Code and National Electrical Manufactures
Association Standard.
All normal lighting fixtures of control building shall be of CFL/LED type with granulated
acrylic diffuser complete with all accessories. All lighting fixtures installed on the ceiling
covered by false ceiling shall be recessed. Lighting fixtures shall conform to the Standard
for Electric Lighting Fixtures or other internationally accepted standards.
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 17 - Illumination/Lighting System Page 17-5
4 Lighting Panels
The lighting panel shall conform to NEMA Standard requirements. All over-current
protective devices shall be Moulded Case Circuit Breaker (MCCB) or Miniature Circuit
Breakers (MCB).
The outdoor control panel shall be galvanised or enamel painted steel cabinet, outdoor type.
The over current protective devices shall be of MCCB or MCB. The ON-OFF operation of
outdoor lighting shall be both manual and automatic control (with photo-switch). The
arrangement of lighting branch circuits shall be reliable and easy maintenance.
6 Grounding
All lighting panels, junction boxes, fixtures conduits etc. shall be grounded in compliance
with the provision of relevant standard or local statutory requirements.
All electrical equipment shall be effectively grounded. The ground wire shall not be less
than 1.5 mm2 copper for fixtures and 4 mm2 copper for Panel.
7 Information to be Furnish
After award of the contract the contractor shall submit detail design of the illumination
system. The fixtures shall be satisfactory to the Employer and shall be energy efficient.
The contractor shall submit detailed indoor and outdoor lighting calculation for reaching the
above Lux level including surface illumination diagram at varying equipment surface levels,
detailed drawing showing the lighting layout and lighting distribution wiring diagram,
receptacles, switches and lighting panels for Employer’s approval during detailed
engineering.
All rectification, repairs or adjustment work found necessary during inspection, testing and
commissioning shall be carried out by the bidder, without any extra cost to the Employer.
The Bidder along with the Employer shall measure the actual lux level in all the areas of the
substations to prove compliance to the specification.
8 Tests
The entire illumination system operation shall be tested on completion of the works in
presence of the Employer. The tests shall include but not limited to measurement of intensity
of light. During Test, if it is observed that illumination level in any area is lower than the
specified value, the contractor will rectify the same at his own cost.
CHAPTER - 18
POWER AND CONTROL CABLES
1 General
This specification covers the design, manufacture, factory test, supply, delivery, installation,
field-testing and commissioning of all Power, Control, Communication and Instrumentation
cables, cable terminations/sealing ends, necessary cable trays and accessories required for
the entire project.
The Contractor shall be responsible for estimating and supplying the quantity of various types
and sizes of the cables. In course of actual execution, if it is found that additional cross-
sections, types or quantities of cables for the transformer are required other than those indicated
in his proposal; the same shall be supplied without any additional charge to the employer.
The Contractor shall also supply cable termination kits for both ends of each cable without any
additional cost to the Employer unless stated otherwise in the Price Schedule.
Power cables for the 11kV, 33 kV and low-tension circuits shall be of single or multi-core
copper, cross-linked polyethylene (XLPE) insulated PVC sheathed type with suitable cable
ends. 11kV and 33 kV cables shall have metal shield or have semi-conducting tape and
tinned copper wire shielded as specified and as per specific requirements at various
locations.
Power cables will have a minimum cross section of 2.5 mm² for lighting and 4 mm² for
power. The main (incomer) cable to AC distribution panel shall be three & half (3.5) core
and not less than 150 mm2.
Conductor shall consist of stranded annealed copper wires. They shall comply with relevant
IEC publication.
Cables shall be flame retardant low smoke (FRLS) type designed to withstand all
mechanical, electrical and thermal stresses develop under steady state and transient
operating conditions.
Outer sheath shall be of PVC black in colour. Outer sheath of all the cables shall have the
following FRLS properties.
All cables shall meet the fire resistance requirement with cable installations made in
accordance with ‘Flammability Test’ and as per Category-B of IEC 332 Part -3.
Selection & sizing of power cables shall be based on the following considerations.
Cable lengths shall be considered to ensure that straight through cable joints are avoided.
b) Insulation
The electrically and thermally stable insulation shall be extruded onto the conductor so as to
prevent contamination and voids in the insulation.
c) Current Rating
The Contractor shall state the maximum continuous current rating and conditions of
installation for low voltage power cables.
d) Jacket
The cable core assembly shall be covered with a flame-retardative and moisture resistant
PVC jacket, which is free stripping from the insulation. The overall jacket shall be clean,
dry, and free of grease and shall be suitable for ink or paint application.
Anti-termite protection shall be applied to the cable and shall consist of either a
non-magnetic metallic barrier or layer of nylon sheathing.
e) Identification
Each cable shall have a printed legend on the overall jacket with the manufacturer's name,
voltage class, the number and size of conductors, type of insulation etc.
The colors for core identification and color sequence shall be in accordance with follows.
b) Conductor
Copper conductor shall be stranded circular non compacted cross section of minimum 2.5
sq.mm. The Contractor shall calculate the load of CT core considering all connected loads
and submit to the employer for approval. In case of CT burden constrain, CT circuit cable
cross sectional area shall be increased. In this case the Contractor shall supply and install the
cable required cross section area without any additional cost to the Employer.
c) Insulation
The electrically and thermally stable PVC insulation shall be extruded onto the conductor so
as to prevent contamination and voids in the insulation.
d) Assembly
Multi core conductor cables shall be assembled in accordance with applicable IEC
standards.
A flame-retardant binder tape may be used underneath the overall jacket of multi conductor
cables, if required, to achieve the desired flame retardant characteristics. Tapes, if used, shall
be non-hygroscopic.
e) Jacket
The cable core assembly shall be covered with a flame retardant and resistant jacket, which
is free stripping from the insulation.
The overall jacket shall be clean, dry, and free of grease and shall be suitable for ink or paint
application.
Cable jacketing and the interstices within the jacket shall be free of water. Evidence of water
shall be the ground for rejection of the cable.
Anti Termite Covering: Anti termite protection shall be applied to the cable and shall consist
of either a non magnetic metallic barrier or layer of nylon sheathing.
f) Identification
Each cable shall have a printed legend on the overall jacket, with the manufacturer's name,
voltage class, the number and size of conductors, and a unique number or code indicating
the production run or batch. The identification shall remain legible for the life of the cable.
5 Communication Cable
All cables and wiring shall have copper conductors and PVC insulation and shall comply
with IEC standards.
Each communication cable shall have not less than 20 percent or 4 spare twisted pairs
whichever is the greater. Cabling and wiring installations shall be arranged to minimize the
risk of fire and damages, which might be caused in the event of fire.
For telephone type cables, 2 conductor wires of not less than 0.6 mm diameter shall be used.
Where twin or quad make up is required in any cable, the cores shall be uniformly twisted
and the lays arranged such that cross talk is reduced to a minimum.
No conductor smaller than 32/0.2 mm (1 mm2), or having less than three strands, shall be
used for interconnecting the cables except in the case of telephone extensions. All cables
shall have insulation, which will withstand the highest temperature to be experienced in
service.
Each conductor of a multicore cable shall be readily identified by a numbered marker tape
or, in the case of telephone type cables, color coded insulation.
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 18 - Power and Control Cable Page 18-6
The tag shall be of aluminium with the number punched on it and securely attached to the
cable conduit by not less than two turns of 20 SWG Gl wire.
Conforming to IS: 280. Cable tags shall be of rectangular shape for power cables and of
circular shape for control cables.
Location of cables laid directly underground shall be clearly indicated with cable marker
made of galvanized iron plate. Location of underground cable joints shall be indicated with
cable marker with an additional inscription "Cable joints". The marker shall project 150 mm
above ground and shall be spaced at an interval of 30 meters and at every change in
direction. They shall be located on both sides of road and drain crossings.
Cable tags shall be provided on all cables at each end Gust before entering the equipment
enclosure), on both sides of a wall or floor crossing, ·on each duct/conduit entry and at
each end & turning point in cable tray/trench runs.
The Contractor shall tag/ferrule control cable cores at all terminations, as instructed by the
Employer. In panels where a large number of cables are to be terminated and cable
identification may be difficult, each core ferrule may include the complete cable number as
well.
Spare cores shall be similarly tagged with cable numbers and coiled up.
Double compression type nickel plated (coating thickness not less than 10 microns) brass
cable glands shall be provided by the Bidder for all power and control cables to provide dust
and weather proof terminations.
The cable glands shall conform to BIS: 6121. They shall comprise of heavy duty brass
casting, machine finished and nickel plated, to avoid corrosion and oxidation.
Cable lugs shall be tined copper solder less crimping type conforming to IS-8309 & 8394.
Bimetallic lugs shall be used depending upon type of cables used.
8 Installation of Cables
In general all power and control cables shall be in the cable trenches. In addition to the
above, for lighting purpose also, cable trench can be used in outdoor area as far as possible.
Cabling in the Switchgear/control room shall also be done on ladder type cable trays.
For cables laid in conduits in outdoor area, conduits of 50 mm nominal outside diameter of
class 4 as per IS 4985 shall be used, which shall be buried in the ground at a depth of
250mm below finish formation level. Separate PVC pipes shall be laid for control and power
cables. Cable pull boxes of adequate size shall be provided if required.
Power and control cables in the cable trench shall be laid in separate tiers. The order of
laying of various cables shall be as follows, for cables other than directly buried.
Single core cables in trefoil formation shall be laid with a distance of three times the
diameter of cable between trefoil center lines. Power cables from station transformer to main
ACDB shall be laid with a minimum center to center distance equal to twice the diameter of
the cable.
Power and control cables shall be securely fixed to the trays/supports with self-locking type
nylon ties with the interlocking facility at every 5 meter interval for horizontal run. Vertical
and inclined cable runs shall be secured with 25 mm wide and 2 mm thick aluminium strip
clamp at every 2m.
Where cables cross roads, drains, these shall be laid in reinforced spun concrete or steel
pipes buried at not less than one meter depth.
9 Cable Trays
Cable trays shall be used in control building and other areas within substation and within
cable trenches outside substation area. The cable trays shall be of GS sheet and minimum
thickness of sheet shall be2 mm. cable trays shall have 2.5 meter straight section and 150,
300 mm and 600 mm wide
Size of conduit for lighting shall be selected by the Bidder during detailed engineering.
For directly embedding in soil, the conduits shall be coated with an asphalt-base compound.
Concrete pier or anchor shall be provided wherever necessary to support the conduit rigidly
and to hold it in place.
Conduit shall be installed in such a way as to ensure against trouble from trapped
condensation.
FO cables shall be laid in galvanised steel (GS) conduits within cable trenches keeping
proper clearance with HV cables
11 Special Requirements
The Contractor shall be responsible for estimating and supplying the quantity of various
types and sizes of the cables. In course of actual execution, if it is found that additional cross
sections, types or quantities of cables are required for the completion of the specified works
the same shall be supplied without any additional charge to the employer.
Small cut piece lengths of cables will not be accepted. Cables up to 500 meters in length or
as approved by Employer shall be of one length shipped in a drum of adequate size. For
higher quantities, multiple lengths/drums may be shipped subject to the approval of
Employer.
13 Tests
Routine and Design Tests
Power cable shall be subjected to following routine tests. As far as practical, the procedure of
IEC shall be followed:
Design Test
The power cable design tests shall include following:
The Bidder shall submit type test report as specified in section-2 of this specification for the
offered power cable along with the bid.
Field Tests
After installation at Site, cables shall be subjected but not limited to the following tests:
a) Continuity test
b) Measurement of insulation resistance
c) DC dielectric test
14.1 General
The scope shall include the supply, laying, termination and testing of 11 kV and 33 kV
power cables between various cubicle/equipment at Loharpatti Substation and extension
works at Dhalkebar substation. The cables shall be supplied with necessary
terminations/sealing ends/accessories for the both connecting ends of each and every cable.
The scope shall include the supply, laying and connection of power cables for incoming
and outgoing feeders at Loharpatti Substation and extension works at Dhalkebar substation.
The cables shall be supplied with necessary terminations and accessories for both
connecting ends. This scope also includes supply and installation of 11 kV and 33 kV
lightning arrestors on the supporting structure.
The rated voltage of the power cables shall be 12 kV for 11 kV circuits and 36 kV for 33 kV.
The power cable shall be cross-linked polyethylene insulated (XLPE), screened and steel tape
armoured.
The XLPE insulated HV cable shall confirm to the requirements of IEC 60502-2 (applicable
clauses only) for construction and IEC 60840/IEC 62067 (as applicable) for testing. The
terminating accessories shall conform to IEC 60840/IEC62067 (as applicable). The offered
cables and its terminating accessories shall be compatible with each other.
The cable shall be suitable for laying underground buried installation with uncontrolled back
fill and chances of flooding by water and suitably designed by the addition of chemicals in
the outer sheath to be protected against rodent and termite attack.
They shall be designed to withstand all mechanical, electrical and thermal stresses under
steady state and transient operating conditions.
Progressive sequential marking of the length of cable in metres at every one metre shall be
provided on the outer sheath of the cable.
The cables shall have outer sheath of HDPE material. Repaired cables shall not be accepted.
Allowable tolerance on the overall diameter of the cables shall be plus or minus 2 mm.
a) Conductor
Conductor for power cable shall consist of stranded annealed copper wires. They shall
comply with IEC Publication.
b) Cable Rating
The current rating for the cable and conditions of installation shall be adequate for size of
the equipment power transformers, station service transformers and feeders.
The conductor and metallic sheath shall be designed to meet the requirement of the system
short circuit rating of 25KAfor 1 sec.
The maximum temperature for the power cables shall be less than the following values:
c) Anti-Termite Covering
Anti-termite protection applied to the cables and shall be black PVC suitable for the operating
temperature of cables and shall meet the requirements of IEC standard.
d) Outer Covering
The outer covering of the cable shall be extruded, continuous black PVC suitable for the
operating temperature of cable and shall meet the requirements of IEC standard.
e) Cable Drum
Cable drum shall be non-returnable and made of steel suitably protected against corrosion.
f) Jointing Accessories
Cables shall be installed in single lengths and straight-through jointing shall not be permitted.
g) Voltage Identification
The plastic covering shall be embossed with the name of the manufacturer, voltage class,
number, material and size of conductors, cross sections, types of insulations followed by:
h) Phase Identification
Phase identification for either triplex or multi-core conductor cable shall be in accordance with
the following:
Phase A ( R ) : Red
Phase B ( Y ) : Yellow
Phase C ( B ) : Blue
The construction of cable shall generally conform to the IEC standard and description
mentioned in this specification. Bidder may offer necessary layers such as separation tape,
binder tapes etc additionally as per their manufacturing practices for meeting required
performance of the offered cable. The bidder shall enclose with the bid, drawing showing
cross section of the cable.
The method of cable laying shall be designed by the Contractor to ensure highest security
and reliability during and after the installation. The cable installation shall be carried out by
the Contractor in accordance with the procedures approved.
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 18 - Power and Control Cable Page 18-13
At the opening in the civil structures from where the power cables are passing through in the
open, suitable sealing means like lean concreting shall be provided by the Contractor to keep
out ingress of water in the powerhouse etc. from outside.
The cost of all necessary termination/sealing ends shall be included in the price of the
cables.
14.4 Test
a) Routine Tests
The cables shall have passed the following routine tests and any other relevant routine tests
for cables at the manufacturer’s works. Routine test certificates shall be provided for the
cables for approval of the Employer/Engineer before shipment.
-Construction inspection
-Measurement of electrical resistance as per clause 14.2 (IEC 502)
-Partial discharge tests
-High voltage tests
-Insulation resistance tests
-Physical and aging tests for insulation and jackets.
b) Type Tests
The cables, related equipment and materials shall be type tested standard products of
competent manufacturers. Type test certificates shall be submitted to Employer.
Workshop tests shall be carried out in compliance with the certified QC plan and the
relevant IEC 62067 Standards.
Type tests (both electrical and non-electrical) after installation as per IEC 502, Section 3
article 16, 17 and 18; including the below noted tests; shall be carried out to prove the
general qualities and design of a given type of cable and for the purpose of acceptance of the
lot:
c) Special Tests
The cable shall be subjected to the following special tests as per clause 15 of IEC 502and
test certificates shall be provided.
- Conductor examination
- Check of dimension
- Electrical tests
- Hot set tests
The Bidder shall submit copy of type test reports from recognized testing laboratory for the offered
power cables along with the bid.
2) Field Tests
Field/site tests shall be carried out in compliance with the approved QC plan and the IEC
Standards. The following tests are the minimum requirement as applicable.
3) Test on Accessories
The bidder shall submit type test reports for all type tests as per IEC 60840:1999/ IEC62067
for owner’s acceptance.
15 Performance Guarantee
The performance figures quoted on schedule of Technical Data shall be guaranteed within
the tolerance permitted by relevant standards and shall become part of the Contract. In case
of failure of the cables to meet the guarantees, the Employer reserves the right to reject the
item. The Contractor shall have to rectify/replace the defect/defective part at no extra cost to
the Employer and without delaying the commissioning schedule.
CHAPTER – 19
AC DISTRIBUTION BOARD
1 SCOPE
1.1 These specifications are intended to cover the design, engineering,
manufacturing, inspection and testing at manufacturer’s works, packing,
supply & delivery, Testing & commissioning of 400 volts, 3 phase, 4
wire, AC distribution switch boards cubical in- door type complete with
all materials, accessories and fittings, erection & maintenance tools &
tackles, mandatory spares as detailed in this specification for 132/33/11
kV substation.
1.2 The design and workmanship shall be in accordance with the best
engineering practices to ensure satisfactory performance throughout the
service life.
1.3 Any material and equipment not specifically stated in this specification
but which are necessary for satisfactory operation of the equipment shall
be deemed to be included unless specifically excluded and shall be
supplied without any extra cost.
2 STANDARDS
2.1 The equipment covered by this specification shall confirm to the
provisions of the following IEC/International standards as amended up
to date except where specified otherwise in this specification.
The Equipment and material meeting the requirement of any other Indian
standards or internationally recognized standards which ensure a quality
equal or better than the standard mentioned above shall also be
acceptable. Where the equipment confirms to any other standards then
salient points of difference between the standards adopted and those
prescribed in these specifications shall be clearly brought out in the bid
and a copy of the applicable standards shall also be enclosed by the bidder
with the bid.
1.2 DESCRIPTION
2.1 The LT Distribution Board shall be fed from 150 KVA, 33/0.4 kV
distribution transformer.
2.2 Tentatively the following minimum feeders shall be required but not
limited from the AC Distribution Board, and each shall be suitably rated
as per requirement.
2.4 400 V AC switch board cubical type shall consist of feeders as above
and shall have MCB of rating and labeling as per system requirement.
It shall include bus-bar connections terminals, Cable glands and lugs.
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Technical Specification – AC Distribution Board
The aluminum bus-bar shall be designed for 630 Amps for phases and
400 Amp for neutral based current density of 85 Amp per sq. cm. The
bidder shall design the ratings of MCB/MCCBs’ which shall be
approved by purchaser. The above detail of outgoing feeders is
provisional and is subject to change during detailed engineering.
2.5 The A.C. Board shall be fitted with the following accessories:
1. 230 V, AC space heater with MCB and thermostat.
3 CONSTRUCTIONAL FEATURES
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Technical Specification – AC Distribution Board
h. Wiring inside the panel shall be carried out with 1100 V grade
PVC insulated stranded copper conductors of adequate size on
both ends of each wire engraved identification ferrules shall be
provided.
i. Bus bar shall be of copper adequately sized for the specified
continuous current rating such that the maximum temperature
of the bus bar and links does not exceed 750 C.
j. All MCBs /Isolators /switches etc. shall be flush mounted with
hinged door provided with locking arrangement and an inner
Bakelite sheet /fibre glass sheet shall be provided inside such
accidental contact.
k. Equipment mounted inside the panel shall be provided with
individual labels with equipment designation /rating. Front of the
panel shall be provided with label engraved with designation of
the panel as furnished by the purchaser. Label shall be made of
3 ply lamicold /engraved PVC having white letters on black
ground. Letter size shall be 4 mm minimum.
l. Terminal blocks shall be 1100 V grade clip on type, moulded
in melamine suitable for terminating incoming cable of suitable
size of stranded copper conductor and outgoing circuits of
approved sizes. All the terminals shall be shrouded, numbered
and provided with identification strip for the feeders.
m. MCB’s shall be current limiting type magnetic and thermal
release suitable for manual closing and automatic tripping under
fault condition single pole MCB’s shall have interrupting
capacity not less than 10 kA. MCB knob shall be marked with
ON/OFF indication. A trip free release shall be provided to
ensure tripping on fault even if the knob is held in on position to
avoid accidental contact. MCCB shall have adjustable setting,
O/L & S.C. releases.
n. Fuses if required shall be HRC cartridge type complete with fuses
fittings.
Fuses fittings shall incorporate fully insulated shrouded contacts.
Visible indication of operation of fuses shall be provided.
However, purchaser would not prefer to have fuses instead
MCB’s should be provided.
4 PAINTING
a. All sheet work shall be phosphate in accordance with following
procedure and in accordance with IS/IEC, code of practice for
phosphating iron and steel, with seven tank process.
b. Oil, grease and dirt shall be thoroughly removed by emulsion cleaning.
c. Rust and scale shall be thoroughly removed by emulsion cleaning.
d. Rust and scale shall be removed by pickling with dilute acid
followed by washing and running water rinsing with slightly
alkaline hot water and drying.
Bus bar system for LT station supply board shall be assembled and
fully tested and certified in accordance with relevant standards i.e. IS
:375 or BS : 5486 & IEC 439
The bus bars of LT station supply boards shall be of high conductivity
aluminum and of uniform rectangular cross section. The size of bus bar
shall be got approved from the purchaser before the procurement
/fabrication. The bus bars and supporting arrangements shall be
designed to withstand thermal and magnetic stresses corresponding to
10 kA fault level. All bus bars and metallic bus supports shall be
insulated by heat shrunk PVC sleeves with exceptional dielectric
properties to provide additional protection against accidental contact
and to prevent failure in the event of accidental presence of external
agents. Bus bars supports shall be arc resistant flame retardant,
porcelain type or sheet moulding compound having high insulation
resistance and de-moulding compound having high insulation
resistance and dielectric strength to avoid ground faults of bus due
to dust collection. At the bus- bar joints and tap-off points, removable
shrouds (sleeves) shall be provided. Temperature rise shall not exceed
the maximum allowable temperature for the equipment as specified in
relevant IS/IEC specification even under over load conditions and shall
be of sufficient size to limit the temperature rise not to exceed the
specified value in the applicable standard inside the enclosure. Ground
bus shall be provided at the bottom of each station supply board
throughout the entire length of the board. This bus shall be earthed
solidly by connecting to the main earthling system of the sub- station.
There should be provision for earthing at both ends of the switchboard
Lugs, bolts, nuts and spring washers shall be provided for earth
connection.
8.2 The RCCB shall be provided with test device for testing automatic
opening of the circuit breaker by an integral test device. The test device
shall be arranged for external operation in such a way that the protection
afforded by the cover or enclosure is not impaired.
8.3 The product of rated residual current (rated tripping current) in amperes
and the earth loop impedance in ohm should not exceed the value 50. The
RCCB shall be so chosen that the same has lowest suitable tripping
current.
10 FUSES
Generally fuses shall not be used anywhere. However if approved by
purchaser due to specific situation the fuses shall be of reputed make and
shall be HRC Cartridge type with minimum rupturing capacity of 10 kA.
The fusing factor shall be greater than 1.5 and shall be provided with
visible indicator for having operated. Fuses shall be dimensionally
interchangeable with any other compatible make and shall be so designed
to ensure non-deteriorating time current characteristics.
11 INTERNAL WIRING
The LTAC station supply board and the distribution boards shall be
supplied with complete internal wiring. The wiring shall be carried out
the 1100 V grade, PVC insulated. Stranded supper conductor cables of
adequate size shall be used to suit the rated circuit current. Engraved
identification ferrules, marked to correspond with the wiring diagram
shall be fitted at both ends of each wire. All wiring shall be terminated
on terminal blocks. Terminal blocks shall be one piece moulded and
suitable for 500 V. Stud type terminal blocks shall be used for higher
current rating. Terminals shall be adequately rated for the short circuit
current. Typically terminals of ‘Phoenix Contact’ make shall be provided
which shall be approved by purchaser during detailed engineering.
12 NAME PLATE
Name plate shall be made of non-rusting metal or engraved on PVC shall
be of size 50 mm x 20 mm indicating the feeder details and shall be
provided for all feeders for easy identification DB No. etc. shall be
provided.
14.1 All tests and inspection shall be made at the manufacturer's works
unless otherwise specifically agreed upon by the manufacturer and
purchaser at the time of placement of purchase order. The manufacturer
shall afford to the inspector representing the purchaser, all reasonable
facilities, without charge to satisfy them that the material being
furnished is in accordance with these specifications. The purchaser
reserves the right to get any component/material being used by the
manufacturer of the L.T. board tested from any recognized test house.
No material shall be dispatched without prior approval of the all the test
reports and certificates by the purchaser.
TABLE-1
TECHNICAL PARTICULARS
CHAPTER – 20
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
1 GENERAL
1.1 This specification covers supply, installation, testing and commissioning and handing over
to NEA of Air conditioning system for the control room building.
1.2 Air conditioning units for control room building shall be set to maintain the inside DBT at
24 o C ± 2oC and the air conditioning system for switch-yard panel rooms shall be set to
maintain DBT inside switch-yard panel rooms below 24oC.
1.3 Controllers shall be provided in Control room and Battery room for controlling and
monitoring the AC units in these rooms as detailed in clause no. 2.3.4.
1.4 Each switch-yard panel room shall be provided with temperature transducer to monitor the
temperature of the panel room. The Temperature transducer shall have the following
specification:
2.1 Air conditioning requirement of control room building shall be met using a combination of
following types Air Conditioning units as required.
2.2 Scope
The scope of the equipment to be furnished and services to be provided under the contract
are outlined hereinafter and the same is to be read in conjunction with the provision
contained in other sections/ clauses. The scope of the work under the contract shall be
deemed to include all such items, which although are not specifically mentioned in the bid
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 20 – Air Conditioning System Page 20-2
documents and/or in Bidder's proposal, but are required to make the equipment/system
complete for its safe, efficient, reliable and trouble free operation.
2.2.1 Required number of Cassette type split AC units of 3TR capacity each complete with air
cooled outdoor condensing unit having hermetically sealed compressor unit with cordless
remote controller.
2.2.2 Required number of High wall type split AC units of 2TR capacity each complete with
air cooled outdoor condensing unit having hermetically sealed compressor and high wall
type indoor evaporator unit with cordless remote controller.
2.2.3 Copper refrigerant piping complete with insulation between the indoor and outdoor units
as required.
2.2.4 First charge of refrigerant and oil shall be supplied with the unit.
2.2.5 GSS/Aluminium sheet air distribution ducting for distributing conditioned dehumidified
air along with supply air diffusers and return air grilles with volume control dampers and
necessary splitters etc., suitable fixtures for grilles/diffusers and supports for ducting
complete with insulation.
2.2.6 Local start/stop facility for local starting/ stopping of all electrical equipment/ drives.
2.2.7 All instruments and local control panels alongwith controls and interlock arrangements
and accessories as required for safe and trouble free operation of the units.
2.2.9 PVC drain piping from the indoor units upto the nearest drain point.
2.2.10 Supply and erection of Power and control cable and earthing.
The Cassette type AC units shall be complete with indoor evaporator unit, outdoor
condensing units and cordless remote control units.
2.3.1.1 Outdoor unit shall comprise of hermetically/ semi hermetically sealed compressors mounted
on vibration isolators, fans and copper tube aluminium finned coils all assembled in a sheet
metal casing. The casing and the total unit shall be properly treated and shall be
weatherproof type. They shall be compact in size and shall have horizontal discharge of air.
2.3.1.2 Indoor units shall be of 4-way, ceiling mounted cassette type. The indoor unit shall be
compact and shall have elegant appearance. They shall have low noise centrifugal blowers
driven by suitable motors and copper tube aluminium finned cooling coils. Removable and
washable polypropylene filters shall be provided. They shall be complete with multi
function cordless remote control unit with special features like programmable timer, sleep
mode etc.
2.3.1.3 Cooling capacity of 3TR AC units shall not be less than 36000 btu/hr. and their EER shall
not be less than 2.7.
2.3.2.1 The split AC units shall be complete with indoor evaporator unit, outdoor condensing units
and cordless remote control units.
2.3.2.2 Outdoor unit shall comprise of hermetically/semi hermetically sealed compressors mounted
on vibration isolators, propeller type axial flow fans and copper tube aluminium finned coils
all assembled in a sheet metal casing. The casing and the total unit shall be properly treated
and shall be weatherproof type. They shall be compact in size and shall have horizontal
discharge of air.
2.3.2.3 The indoor units shall be high wall type. The indoor unit shall be compact and shall have
elegant appearance. They shall have low noise centrifugal blowers driven by suitable
motors and copper tube aluminium finned cooling coils. Removable and washable
polypropylene filters shall be provided. They shall be complete with multi function
cordless remote control unit with special features like programmable timer, sleep mode
and soft dry mode etc.
2.3.2.4 Cooling capacity of 2TR AC units shall not be less than 22000 btu/hr. and shall have
energy efficiency rating of 3 star or above.
2.3.2.5 Controllers shall be provided in Control room and Battery room, one controller for each
room, to control and monitoring of AC units and shall have the following facilities;
Standby units shall come in to operation automatically when the running main unit
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 20 – Air Conditioning System Page 20-4
fails
Main and standby units shall be changed over periodically which shall be finalised
during detailed engineering.
Following alarms shall be provided:
2.4 Warranty
All compressors shall have minimum 5 years Warranty from the date of commissioning.
2.5.1 Each AC unit shall be complete with air cooled condensing unit with scroll compressor,
direct expansion type evapourating unit and microprocessor controller. AC units shall be
provided with free cooling arrangement. In free cooling mode, the refrigerant cycle of AC
unit shall be switched off and outside air (after filtration) shall be circulated inside the
conditioned space through the operation of dampers provided with suitable sensors. This
mode shall come into operation in the following conditions;
2.5.2 One of the air-conditioners shall be running at a time and shall maintain the required
temperature. On failure of the running air-conditioner, the other air-conditioner shall start
automatically. To ensure longer life of the system and to keep the AC units healthy, change
over of the standby unit shall be done periodically through the controller. Further, if inside
temperature of the room reaches 35oC due to any emergency condition, the standby air-
conditioner shall also start running to maintain the temperature less than 24 oC and system
shall generate an alarm for such a situation. After achieving this temperature, the standby
unit shall again shut off. However any hunting situation shall be reported. No heating or
humidification is envisaged for the air conditioning system inside the Switchyard panel
rooms.
2.5.3 Packaged AC units with free cooling shall be designed for high sensitive cooling with
sensible heat factor of 90% or above.
2.5.4 Each air conditioner shall be completely self-contained. All components of the units shall be
enclosed in a powder coated cabinet. The unit shall be assembled, wired, piped, charged
with refrigerant and fully factory tested as a system to ensure trouble free installation and
start up. Suitable isolation or other by-passing arrangement shall be provided such that any
unit/component could be maintained/ repaired without affecting the running standby unit.
2.5.5 The AC units shall be mounted on the wall and the maintenance of unit shall be possible
from outside the Switchyard panel room.
The compressor shall be very reliable, trouble free and long life i.e. hermetically sealed
Scroll type of reputed make suitable for continuous operation. Compressor should be
installed on vibration isolated mountings or manufacturers recommended approved
mounting. Valve shall be provided for charging/topping up of refrigerant. The bidder shall
furnish details of their compressor indicating the MTBF, life of compressor and continuous
run time of compressor without failure. The contractor shall also furnish details of all
accessories i.e. refrigeration system, evaporator coil, condenser coil, evaporator blower,
filter, cabinet, indoor supply and return grill etc. during detailed engineering.
2.6 Warranty
All compressors shall have minimum 5 years Warranty from the date of commissioning.
2.6.1 For owner’s remote monitoring purposes, necessary digital inputs shall be provided for ‘ON’
and ‘OFF’ condition of each compressor.
CHAPTER - 21
SUBSTATION STRUCTURES
1.1. SCOPE
1.1.1. These specifications are intended to cover the design, fabrication, trial assembly,
galvanizing, testing at manufacturer’s works, inspection before dispatch, packing,
transportation, storage and handling at site, erection etc. of substation galvanized steel
structures like towers/columns, lightening/lighting masts, beams, equipment supporting
structures etc. and any other structure which may be required for receiving the line with
all necessary accessories as required for successful commissioning of all substations as
per tentative layout drawings of these substations appended with these specifications
conforming to relevant Indian Standards/ equivalent International Standards.
1.1.2. The scope shall also include supply and installation of all types of galvanized structures
including bolts, nuts, plain/tapered/spring washers, step bolts, ladders, all necessary
inserts in concrete, gusset plates, base plates, foundation bolts, equipment mounting
bolts, structure earthing bolts, fixing plates, necessary angles& bolts for structure or
ground mounted marshaling kiosks/boxes(AC/DC Marshalling box & equipment
control cabinets) and any other item as required to complete the job.
1.1.3. It is the intent of the Employer to provide structures which allow interchangeability of
equipment at a later stage. Accordingly, Contractor is expected to design the equipment
support structures with the provision of stool. Stools shall be provided by the
Contractor between the equipment and its support structure to match the bus bar height.
The top of stool shall be connected to the equipment and the bottom of the stool shall
be connected to the Base support structure.
1.1.4. The connection of all structures to their foundations shall be with base plates and
embedded anchor/foundation bolts. All steel structures and anchor/foundation bolts,
fasteners (Nuts, bolts &w ashers) shall be fully galvanized as per relevant Indian
Standards / equivalent International Standards. The weight of the zinc coating shall be
at least 610 gram/m2for structural members as well as for anchor bolts and foundation
bolts. One additional nut shall be provided in each foundation bolt below the base plate
which may be used for the purpose of leveling.
1.1.5. Contractor shall provide suitable arrangement on the equipment supporting structures
wherever required to suit fixation of accessories such as marshalling boxes, MOM
boxes, Control Cabinets, Junction box, surge counter etc and incorporate the details in
the fabrication drawings of equipment supporting structures.
1.1.6. The lightening/lighting mast shall be designed suitably so as to have illumination
platforms for installing the luminaries to obtain prescribed/desired illumination
intensity.
1.1.7. The contractor shall furnish all materials, labor, plant and erection equipment required
for the completion of the job.
1.1.8. The line diagrams of all structures of 132kV and 33 kV substations shall be prepared by
the contractor based on their design during detailed engineering stage. The fabrication
drawings, proto corrected drawings along with Bill of Material (BOM) for all the
structures including equipment supporting structures shall be prepared by the contractor
during detailed engineering for submission to Employer for their approval. Support
structure for circuit breaker shall also be designed and supplied by the Equipment
Manufacturer or Contractor.
1.1.9. The Contractor shall be fully responsible for designing and detailing of the steel
structures as per these specifications, testing as per relevant Indian Standards/
equivalent International Standards and for their satisfactory performance. All
designs/drawings and details shall be subject to approval of the Employer/PMC who
shall have the right to instruct the contractor to make changes in designs/drawings and
details necessary to make the designs conform to these specifications and relevant
Indian Standards/ equivalent International Standards. The contractor shall be required:
(a) To submit the detailed design calculations for all steel structures including gantry
towers/columns, beams, lightening/lighting masts, equipment supporting
structures etc.required ateach substation as per the layout drawings,to be
developed by the Contractor and approved by the Employer,taking into
consideration all the applicable and prescribed loads.
(b) To submit designs and fabrications drawings of all structures including equipment
supporting structures required for each substation for the approval of Employer.
(c) Testing of structures as per relevant codes and standards.
(d) To furnish all materials, tools and plantsrequired for successful completion of job
whether specified or not.
(e) To suitably mark and transport all steel structures and accessories to the site and
their proper and safe storage at site.
(f) To carry out erection/assembling of all structures and accessories at site for the
purpose for which structures have been designed, fabricated and supplied.
1.1.10. The bidder shall quote lump sum price for all the substation structures including all
necessary hardware for installation and successful testing & commissioning thereof.
The rates to be quoted shall also include the fee for the preparation of designs,
design/fabrication drawings, furnishing the required number of copies of all design
&drawings including soft copies, manuals, supply of all materials, fittings & fixtures,
hardware, transportation charges, octopi &tolls, labour, freight insurance including
arranging all erection plant and equipment, etc and all temporary and permanent works
necessary for satisfactory completion of job in all respects.
1.4.4. The above list of Standards is not exhaustive but indicative only. All other relevant
International/Nepalese Standard not mentioned in the list shall also be applicable.
1.4.5. The equipment/materials meeting the requirement of any other Indian/Nepal standard
or equivalent International standards which ensure a quality equal or better than the
standard mentioned above shall also be acceptable.
1.4.6. Where any equipment/material conforms to any other standard other than mentioned
above is offered by the bidder, then the salient points of difference between the
standards adopted and those prescribed in these specifications shall be clearly
brought out in the bid and a copy of the applicable standards shall also be enclosed
by the bidder with his bid. It shall, however, be subject to the acceptance and the
approval of Employer.
1.5. MATERIALS & WORKMANSHIP
All materials used in the manufacture of the substation steel structures shall be of
tested and best quality conforming to relevant Indian standards and workmanship
shall be of the high order in accordance with best engineering practices.
The materials, for which no Indian/ Nepalese Standards exist, shall be in accordance
with any other International Standard subject to the approval of the Employer.
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 21 - Substation structure Page 21-7
1.5.2.2. Flat and tapered washers shall be mild steed conforming to relevant Indian Standard.
1.5.2.3. Spring washers conforming to IS: 3063 shall be provided.
1.5.2.4. Foundation bolts shall be of mild steel of Grade E250 (Designated Yield Strength
250 MPa) conforming to IS: 2062.
1.6. STORAGE OF MATERIAL
1.6.1. All materials shall be stored in such a manner so as to prevent deterioration and to
ensure the preservation of their quality and fitness for the work. Any material which
has deteriorated or has been damaged shall be removed from Contractor’s yard or
site stores immediately.
1.6.2. Steel sections for fabrication of structures shall be stored in separate stacks above
ground, section wise and length wise so that they can be easily inspected at any time.
1.6.3. Bolts, nuts and washers and other fastening materials shall be stored on racks off the
ground with a coating of suitable protective oil. These shall be stored in separate
gunny bags or compartments in accordance to diameter, length and quality.
1.7. GENERAL DESIGN REQUIREMENTS
1.7.1. The Contractor shall furnish the most economical design for substation steel
structures conforming to these specifications, relevant Indian Standards/ equivalent
International Standards and as per best engineering practices.
1.7.2. No welding shall be allowed in case of lattice structures except for connecting the
base plates & stiffeners to the legs of structures.
1.7.3. Except where otherwise specified or implied, the design, manufacturing, fabrication,
galvanizing etc of steel structures shall conform to the provisions of IS:802 (Part-
I/Sec-1)-1992, IS:802 (Part-I/Sec-2)-1995 and IS:802(Part-II)-1978.
1.7.4. Fully galvanized lattice type self-supporting steel structures with bolted connections
shall be provided for the main substation structures comprising gantry towers/
columns, beams, lightening/lighting masts etc.and shall be designed to carry the load
of conductors with the necessary insulators, earth wire, hardwareand all fittings &
fixtures, wind load, earthquake loads, short circuit forces etc. as applicable under
specified loading conditions. The gantry towers/columns and lightening/lighting
masts shall be connected to the foundation through base plate and foundation bolts.
The portion of anchor bolts above concrete level and 300 mm below concrete level
shall be galvanized.
1.7.5. The equipment supporting structures shall be lattice type as per the support
requirement of equipments and fully galvanized and shall be designed to carry the
weight of equipments, conductors, all fittings& fixtures, wind loads, earthquake
load, short circuit forces, operational loads etc. The equipment supporting structures
shall also be connected to the foundation through base plates and foundation bolts.
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 21 - Substation structure Page 21-9
The portion of foundation/anchor bolts projecting above concrete level and 300 mm
length below concrete level shall be galvanized.
1.7.6. Grounding of all steel structures shall be done as specified in these specifications.
1.7.7. Lightening masts shall cater to the station lighting purposes also. It shall be provided
with structural steel ladder within its base upto the highest platform. The ladder shall
be provided with safety cage. The platforms shall be provided at heights required for
mounting of lighting fixtures. Size of platforms shall be adequate for mounting a
minimum of four lighting fixtures on each side. Provision shall be made for tilting
the lighting fixtures to suitable angle. The platforms shall also have protection
railing.
1.7.8. While designing gantry towers/columns, beams, lightening/lighting masts, equipment
supporting structures etc., the Contractor shall ensure adequate electrical clearances
as specified in these specifications, relevant Indian Standards/ equivalent
International Standards and statuary rules and regulations of the country, whichever
is more stringent.
1.7.9. All the structures shall be so designed that only the rationalized ISI metric hot rolled
sections of tested quality conforming to IS: 2062 are used in fabrication of substation
steel structures.
1.7.10. The Contractor, while designing substation structures, shall use only such sizes of
steel sections which are easily procurable. If for any reason, the sections approved
are not easily procurable, it is the Contractor’s responsibility to procure the
alternative sizes which are satisfactory from the point of view of design, fabrication,
and galvanization and supply the same at no additional cost to the Employer.
1.7.11. The analysis of structures shall be done with well-established modern computer
software programme like STAAD PRO. The computer software programme to be
employed should have been prepared or approved by a recognized institution. The
contractor shall submit the particulars and name of the computer programme as well
as names of the customers to whom the substation steel structures have been supplied
based on the above computer programme and also the structures test results
providing the efficacy of the programme to the Employer for approval before taking
up the design.
1.7.12. All gantry towers and beams shall be designed as dead end structures i.e. all the
balancing conductors on one side of gantry shall be assumed broken. The Contractor
can rationalize the designs and reduce the varieties if it is economical. All gantry
towers and beams of same designation shall be interchangeable.
1.7.13. The base width of gantry towers and size of beams shall be so chosen so that there is
no hindrance to various electrical clearances.
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 21 - Substation structure Page 21-10
1.7.14. Hard copy of all designs along with soft copy of input files of the computer software
used for analysis of various structures (i.e. gantry towers & beams,
lightening/lighting masts, equipment supporting structures etc.) shall be submitted by
the contractor to Employer for approval. The contractor shall also submit manual
calculations, if required by the Employer, for verifying the analysis and design
results of the structures obtained using software. The Employer shall check the
design of structures submitted by the Contractor and if any modifications/changes are
necessitated consequent to the checking, the same shall be incorporated by the
Contractor without any additional cost to the Employer.
short circuit forces or earthquake loads whichever is more critical shall be combined
with loads under normal condition. The earthquake loads and wind loads shall not be
considered together i.e. one load shall be considered at a time.In both conditions, the
design of all structures shall be based on the assumption that stringing is done only
on one side i.e. all the three conductors broken on the other side.
1.8.5. Short Circuit Forces:Short circuit forces shall be estimated as specified in IEC 865
or relevant Indian Standard/ equivalent International Standard and shall be subject to
the approval of Employer. Short circuit forces shall be calculated considering a fault
level of 31.5KA for 132kV and 25KA for 33kV or as applicable and directed by the
Employer.
1.8.6. Wind Loads: Wind pressure on steel structures, rigid bus bar tubes, conductors,
ground/shield wires, insulatorstringsand other fittings/hardwareshall be considered as
per IS:802(Part-I/Sec-1)-1995 for specified wind zone.
1.8.7. Earthquake Forces:Earthquake/Seismic Forces shall be estimated as per IS:1893
for specified seismic zone. The appropriate inertia loadings on various structures
shall be assessed depending upon individual responses of the structures and as
stipulated in IS:1893. The vertical seismic co-efficient, where applicable,shall be
taken as half of the horizontal seismic co-efficient. In important structures wherever
there is a possibility of amplification of vertical seismic co-efficient, the stipulations
of IS:1893shall be followed.
1.8.8. Vertical Loads
1.8.8.1. The vertical loads shall comprise the following loads:
(i) Weight of rigid bus bar, conductor, shield wire, jumpersetc;
(ii) Weight of insulators, hardware and other fittings & fixtures;
(iii) Self-weight of structure and respective equipment;
(iv) Weight of underhung connectors where applicable; and
(v) Weight of man with tools at each conductor point or any location of structure
critical for a particular member.
1.8.8.2. The vertical loads due to the weight of bus bars, approach span conductors, shield
wires, insulator strings, equipment if supported on the beam/gantry towers shall be
considered in the design of beams &gantry towers/columns.
1.8.8.3. A provision of a load of 1500 N shall be made for a lineman with tools in the design
of substation structures. The weight of man with tools may also be assumed to act
anywhere on the horizontal members and members with inclination up to 150.
1.8.8.4. The self-weight of the beam shall be considered in the design of beams. In case of
the design of gantry towers, lightening/lighting mast, equipment supporting
structures, the weight of superincumbent portion of the structure shall be considered
in the design.
1.8.9. Conductor/ Wire Tension Loads
1.8.9.1. The maximum working tension for bus bars, conductors and shield wires shall be
considered as specified.
1.8.9.2. The loads due to wire tensions shall be calculated along and transverse to the beam
axis at the points of attachment of conductor/wires. In case of gantry towers and
lightening masts, the wire tensions shall be resolved in the direction of its adjacent
faces.
1.8.9.3. The worst condition of unbalanced conductors and shield wire loads, with all
balancing conductor/wire on the opposite side of the structure shall be assumed to be
broken for the design of structures.
1.8.10. Terminal Gantries
1.8.10.1. Terminal/line take off gantries shall be designed for a minimum conductor tension of
1.0 ton per phase for 132 kV and 0.50 ton for 33 kV or as per requirement whichever
is higher.
1.8.10.2. The distance between terminal gantry and dead end tower shall be taken as 75m for
132kV and 40 m for 33 kV switch yard or as actual whichever is more. The design of
these terminal gantries shall also be checked considering + 300 deviation of
conductor in both vertical and horizontal planes. For other gantries, the structural
layout requirements shall be adopted in the design.
1.8.10.3. The maximum stringing tensions in the approach spans shall be taken as per design
of dead end towers and actual site conditions.
1.8.11. COMBINATION OF LOADS
1.8.11.1. The combination of loads shall be made under the normal and abnormal conditions
for wind blowing either normal to beam (longitudinal direction) or parallel to beam
(transverse direction).In case of equipment supporting structures and stand alone
structures like lighting masts, wind shall be assumed acting normal to two adjacent
faces of structure, one at a time as well as in diagonal direction. Loads shall be
resolved into transverse, longitudinal and vertical directions for the purpose of
design. All balancing conductors/wires shall be considered broken on one side in
Normal Condition as well as in Abnormal Condition.
1.8.11.2. Normal Condition
(i) Wind loads on bus bars, conductors, shield wires, insulator string, jumpers,
other hardware, equipments, membersof structure etc.
(ii) Winds on approach span conductors and ground wire.
(iii) Unbalanced loads due to conductor/wire tensions considering all the
conductor/wires on one side being broken;
(iv) Deviation loads due to wire tensions;
(v) Dead loads of wires, insulators, hardware fittings, equipment,structural
members, weight of lineman with tools etc.
The above loads shall be resolved in transverse, longitudinal and vertical directions as
under:
(a) Wind Loads: Wind load on gantry towers, Lightening/Lighting Mast, beams,
bus bar, conductors, shielding wire, jumpers, connectors, insulators,
equipment, other hardware etc. with wind blowing either in Transverse or
Longitudinal direction;
(b) Transverse Loads: Component of Mechanical Tension due to conductor and
shielding wire deviation in Transverse direction;
(c) Longitudinal Loads: Component of Mechanical Tension due to conductor
and shielding wire deviation in Longitudinal direction;
(d) Vertical Loads: Load due to weight of conductor, shielding wire, insulator
strings, jumpers, connectors, accessories, self-weight of structure, component
of Mechanical Tension of conductor and shielding wire in vertical direction.
1.8.11.3. Abnormal Conditions
Either of the two conditions viz. short circuit condition or earthquake condition,
whichever is more stringent, shall be considered for the design of substation steel
structures as described below:
(a) Short Circuit Condition:Where short circuit loads are specified, these shall be
considered in addition to the combination of loads as stipulated in Normal
Condition.
(b) Earthquake Condition:Earthquake/Seismic forces as specifiedshall be
considered in addition to the combination of loads as stipulated in Normal
Condition excluding the wind loads.
1.8.11.4. Safety & Maintenance Condition:All bracing and redundant members of the gantry
towers, beams, lightening/lighting masts and equipment supporting structures which
are horizontal or inclined up to 150 from horizontal shall be designed to withstand an
ultimate vertical load of 1500 N considered acting at the center of the member
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 21 - Substation structure Page 21-14
independent of all other loads but including self weight of member. All gantry
towers, beams and masts shall also be designed to withstand an wire peak
independent of all other loads but considering self weight of structure. ultimate
vertical load of 1500 N as a weight of Lineman with tools and an additional load of
3500 N acting at each conductor attachment point of beam and earth
1.8.11.5. The Substation steel structures shall be designed for the most stringent combinations
of loadings as specified above in Normal and Abnormal conditions and checked
under safety & maintenance condition and shall be able to withstand these loads
without exceeding the minimum guaranteed yield stress of material as per
IS:802(Part-1/Sec-1)-1995 without any injury or permanent deflection.
1.8.12. Sag Tension Calculations
1.8.12.1. Sag tension calculations for conductor and shielding/ground wire shall be made for
the following combinations:
(i) Full wind pressure on conductor/ground wire at every day temperature;
(ii) 36 % of full design wind pressure on conductor/ground wire at minimum
temperature;
(iii) Every day temperature and nil wind (Initial condition);
(iv) 850 C temperature for ACSR conductor (950 C temperature in case of AAAC
0r AA conductor) and nil wind; and
(v) Minimum temperature and nil wind.
1.8.12.2. The sag of ground wire shall be maintained within 90% of the conductor sag. The
effect of insulator string on calculation of conductor sag shall also be considered.
1.8.12.3. Initial tension under every day temperature and ‘nil’ wind as applicable for
conductor/ground wire shall be such that maximum sag at maximum temperature is
within permissible limits keeping in view the electrical clearances required from
ground/ equipments / structures. Final sag shall be maintained considering the effect
of insulator string.
1.8.13. Computation of Wind Loads
1.8.13.1. The wind pressure shall be assumed as acting horizontally.
1.8.13.2. Wind Load shall be corresponding to Wind Zone 4 of IS:802 (Part-1/Section-1)-
1995. The relevant design parameters for Wind Zone 4 shall be as under:
(a) Basic wind speed ‘Vb’ = 47 m/s [which is peak gust velocity averaged over a
short time interval of about 3 seconds at mean height of 10 meter above
ground level in an open terrain (Terrain Category 2) and has been worked out
for a return period of 50 years]
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 21 - Substation structure Page 21-15
1.8.13.8. The direction of the wind shall be assumed so as to produce the maximum stress in
any member for the combination of wind loads and other loads. For this condition,
wind shall be assumed acting in two directions at right angles to each other and
critical wind load shall be considered for the design of structures. The diagonal wind
shall also be considered for standalone structures like equipment supporting
structures, lighting masts etc.
1.8.13.9. Substation Steel Structures shall be designed for the maximum tension in conductor
and shielding/ground wire (Normal) corresponding to any of the following conditions
whichever is more critical:
(i) Full design wind pressure and every day temperature;
(ii) 36% of full design wind pressure and minimum temperature.
Provided that the ultimate tension in wires under any of the above conditions does
not exceed 70% of ultimate tensile strength of conductor/ ground wire.
1.8.13.10. Wind Load on Structure:In order to determine the wind load on Gantry Tower,
Beam, Lightening/Lighting Masts, Equipment Supporting Structure,it shall be
divided into different panels having a height/length ‘h’. These panels are normally
taken between the intersections of the legs and bracings. For a lattice structures of
square cross section, the resultant wind load Fwt in Newton, for wind normal to the
panel, on a panel under consideration of height/length ‘h’ applied at the center of
gravity of this panel shall be as under:
Fwt= Pd x Cdt x Ae x Gt
Where
Pd= Design wind pressure in N/m2;
Cdt = Drag coefficient for panel under consideration against which the wind is
blowing. Values of Cdt for the different solidity ratio shall be as per Table-5 of
IS:802(Part-1/Sec-1)-1995.
Ae = Total net surface area of members in the panel under consideration projected
normal to the face in sq m.
Gt = Gust response factor, peculiar to the ground roughness and depends on the height
above ground. Values of Gtshall be as per Table-6 of IS:802(Part-1/Sec-1)-
1995.
1.8.13.11. Wind Load on Conductor, Ground/Shielding Wire and Jumpers etc: The load
due to wind on each conductor and ground/shielding wire, Fwc in Newton applied at
supporting point normal to the conductor/earth wire shall be determined by the
following expression:
Fwc= Pd x Cdc x L x d x Gc
Where:
Pd = Design wind pressure in N/m2;
Cdc = Drag coefficient, taken as 1.0 for conductor and 1.2 for earth wire;
L = Wind span, being sum of half the spans on either side of supporting
Structures, in meters;
d = Diameter of conductor/earth wire, in meters
Gc = Gust response factor, takes into account the turbulence of the wind and
the dynamic response of the conductor. Values of Gcshallas per Table-7
of IS:802 (Part-1/Sec-1)-1995 for the average height of conductor /
ground wire above ground.
The average height of conductor shall be taken up to clamping point of conductor less
two-third sag at minimum temperature and no wind. The average height of the
groundwireshall be taken up to clamping pointless two-third sag at minimum
temperature and ‘nil’ wind.
1.8.13.12. Wind Load on Insulator Strings: Wind load on insulator strings ‘F wi’ shall be
determined on insulator length from the attachment point to the center line of the
conductor in case of suspension insulators string and up to the end of clamp in case
of tension insulators string , in the direction of the wind as follows:
Fwi = CdixPd x Ai x Gi
Where,
Cdi = Drag coefficient of insulators taken as 1.2;
Pd = Design wind pressure in N/ m2;
Ai =Area of insulator string projected horizontally on a vertical plane parallel to the
axis of the string. In the absence of actual value, it may be taken as 50% of the
gross projected area of the cylinder with diameter equal to that of the insulator
skirt; and
Gi = Gust response factor, peculiar to the ground roughness and depends on the
height of insulator attachment point above ground. Values of Gi shall be as per
Table-6 of IS: 802 (Part-1/Sec-1)-1995.
1.8.14. Computation of Wires Tension Loads
1.8.14.1. The maximum tension (Normal) for conductors and shield wiresshall be based on
Sag Tension Calculations as per following conditions whichever is more stringent:
(i) Full design wind pressure on conductor / ground wire at every day temperature;
and
(ii) 36% of full design wind pressure on conductor / ground wire at minimum
temperature.
1.8.14.2. The maximum tension to be considered for the design of structures shall be subject to
the approval of the Employer.
1.8.14.3. The loads due to wire tensions shall be resolved along three perpendicular directions
to the beams and gantry towers and considered accordingly in the design.
1.8.14.4. The worst condition of unbalanced conductors and shielding wire loads, with all
balancing conductor/wire on the opposite side of the structure assumed broken shall
be considered for the design of structures.
1.8.15. Strength Factors Related to Quality
1.8.15.1. The design of substation steel structures shall be carried out in accordance with the
provisions covered in IS:802(Part-1/Sec-2)-1992. However, to account for the
reduction in strength due to dimensional tolerances of the structural sections, the
following strength factors shall be considered depending upon the yield strength of
steel:
(i) If steel with minimum guaranteed yield strength is used for fabrication of
substation structures, the estimated loads shall be increased by a factor of 1.02 to
account for dimensional tolerances.
(ii) If steel of minimum guaranteed yield strength is not used for fabrication of
substation structures, the estimated loads shall be increased by a factor of 1.05, in
addition to that mentioned in (i) above.
1.9.2. The structural design of pipe type equipment supporting structures shall be carried
out in accordance with IS: 806 ‘Code of Practice for Steel Tubes in General Building
Construction’.
1.9.3. Minimum Thickness of Members
1.9.3.1. The minimum thickness of angle section used in the design of substation steel
structures, unless otherwise specified elsewhere in this specification, shall be kept
not less than the following values:
(a) Main leg members of gantry towers, Beams, lightening/lighting masts, and
equipment supporting structures : 5 mm
(b) For all other members : 4 mm
(c) The thickness for gusset plate shall not be less than 6.0 mm. Where a gusset
plate is required to transmit stress, it shall not be less than thickness of the
thickest bracing member connected plus 2.0 mm.
1.9.4. Allowable Stress
1.9.4.1. Axial Stress in Tension
The estimated tensile stress on the net effective sectional area in various members
shall not exceed 250 N/mm2 for mild steel sections or the specified yield stress of
steel for high tensile steel sections (if proposed to be used in the fabrication of
substation steel structures and agreed to by Employer)as per IS: 2062-2011 or any
other equivalent to International Standards.
1.9.4.2. Axial Stress in Compression
(A) The estimated compressive stress in various members shall not exceed the
value given by the formulae in clause 5.2 of IS: 802 (Part-I/Sec-2). As per said
formula, the allowable unit stress Fa, in Mpa on the gross cross sectional area
of theaxially loaded compression members shall be calculated as under:
⁄
(a) = 1−1 2 ×
Where ≤
and,
×
(b) =
When ˃
Where,
Cc = π×√
(B) The formulae given in (A) above are applicable provided the largest width
thickness ratio ‘b/t’ is not more than the limiting value given by:
( )Lim = (210 )
Where
b = distance from edge of fillet to the extreme fibre in mm, and
t = thickness of flange in mm.
(C) Where the width to thickness ratio exceeds the limit given in (B),the formulae
given in (A)shall be used substituting for Fy the value Fcr given by:
. × ×
a) = 1.677 —
When ≤ ≤ 378/
And,
b) = 65550/( )
1.9.6.1. The estimated stresses in bolts shall not exceed the values given in IS:802 (Part-1/
Sec-2) which is reproducedin Table – 13.2 below.
TABLE – 13.2
ULTIMATE STRESSES IN BOLTS in MPa
Nature of stress Permissible Stress For Remarks
Bolts of Property Class 5.6
Shear Stress on Gross 310 For bolts in double shear, the area
Area of bolts to be assumed shall be twice the
area defined.For gross area of
bolts, refer item (a) below.
Bearing Stress on Gross 620 For the bolt area in bearing, see
Diameter of Bolts item (b) below
Axial Tensile Stress 250
1.9.6.2. Gross area and Bearing area of bolts shall be considered as under:
(a) Gross area of Bolt: For the purpose of calculating the shear stress, the gross area
of bolts shall be taken as the nominal area of the bolt.
(b) Bearing Area of Bolt:-It shall be taken as ‘dxt’ where ‘d’ is the nominal diameter
of the bolt and ‘t’ is the thickness of the thinner of the parts jointed.
(c) Where the material of bolt and the structural members are of different grades, the
bearing strength of the joint shall be governed by the lower of two.
1.9.7. Slenderness Ratio
1.9.7.1. Slenderness ratios of compression and redundant members shall be computed in
accordance with clause 6 of IS:802 (Part-1/sec-2) as reproduced in Table – 13.3
below:
Table – 13.3
Permissible Slenderness Ratio
Sl. No. Type of Members Value of KL/r
1. Compression Members
(i) Leg sections or joint members bolted in both faces at L/r
connections for ) 0 < L/r ≤120
(ii) Members with concentric loading at both ends of the L/r
unsupported panel for 0 < L/r ≤120
(iii) Member with concentric loading at one end and normal 30+0.75 L/r
framing eccentricity at the other end of the unsupported
1.9.7.2. For the values of ‘KL/r’ corresponding to 1(vi) and 1(vii) in above table, the
following procedure of evaluation shall be adopted:
(a) The restrained member must be connected to the restraining member with at
least two bolts.
(b) The restraining member must have a stiffness factor ‘I/L’ in the stress plane
(I=Moment of inertia and L=Length) that equals or exceeds the sum of the
stiffness factors in the stress plane of the restrained members that are connected
to it.
(c) Angle members connected by one leg should have the holes located as close to
the outstanding leg as feasible. Normal framing eccentricities at load transfer
connection imply that connection holes are located between the heel of the
angle and the center line of the framing leg.
1.9.7.3. In calculating the slenderness ratio of the members, the Length ‘L’ shall be the
distance between the intersections of the center of gravity lines at each end of the
member.
1.9.7.4. The following maximum limit of the effective slenderness ratio i.e. the ratio of
unsupported length of the section in any plane to the appropriate radius of gyration
shall not exceed value specified herein under:-
(a) For main leg members of gantry towers, beams, lightening/lighting masts, and
equipment supporting structures in compression : 120
(b) For the members having computed stresses : 200
(c) For redundant members : 250
(d) For members having axial tensile stress only : 400
1.9.8. Erection Stresses
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 21 - Substation structure Page 21-23
1.9.8.1. Where erection stresses combined with other possible co-existent stresses could
produce a working stress in any member above the permissible stress, such
additional strengthening of the member shall be affected or such other provision
made as is necessary to bring the stress within the permissible limit.
1.10.9. Spring washers shall be provided for insertion under all nuts. These washers shall be
electro-galvanized, positive lock type and 3.5mm in thickness for 16mm diameter
bolts.
1.10.10. To avoid bending stress in bolts or to reduce it to minimum, no bolt shall connect
aggregate thickness of members more than three times its diameter.
1.10.11. The bolt positions in assembled structures shall be as per approved structural
drawings. Bolts at the joints shall be so staggered that nuts shall be tightened with
spanners without fouling.
1.10.12. To ensure effective quality control during manufacturing process, the manufacturer
shall have in house testing facility for all tests like weight of zinc coating, shear
strength and other tests etc. The manufacturer should also have proper Quality
Assurance System which should be in line with the requirement of this specification
and IS: 14000 series Quality System Standard.
1.10.13. The bolt positions in assembled structures shall be as per IS: 5613(Part-3/Section-2)-
1989.
1.11. DESIGNS & DRAWINGS
1.11.1. After the award of contract, the contractor shall submit to the Employer, for his
approval, the detailed design calculations, drawings for each type of gantry tower,
beams, lightening/lighting masts and equipment supporting structures etc. The design
of structures shall be accompanied with the following drawings:
(a) Loading diagrams of structures; and
(b) Single line diagram of structures.
1.11.2. The contractor shall submit the following designs and also all necessary drawings as
may be required for approval of Employer:
(a) Design of gantry towers, beams, lighting/lightening masts, equipment
supporting structures etc.
(b) Design drawings of structures with the size of the various members and
location of joints etc.
(c) Detailed fabrication drawings indicating the erection mark assigned to various
sections, size of the members, details of joints, details of stringing points etc.
The details of joints, stringing points etc.shall be furnished separately in the
drawing on a larger scale.
(d) Four set of hard copies and soft copies of all the approved design
calculations, drawings and bill of materials.
(e) Results of any test as & when conducted and as required by the employer and
report thereof.
(f) Any other design or drawing or document as desired by Employer.
1.12. FABRICATION
Except where here-in-after modified, the details of fabrication shall, in general,
conform to IS: 802(Part-II), other relevant Indian Standards or equivalent
International Standards.
1.12.1. General Requirements
1.12.1.1. Members of the structures shall be fabricated as per the approved fabrication
drawings in accordance with the best engineering practice and shall conform to the
provisions of relevant Indian Standard/ or equivalent International Standard.
1.12.1.2. Structures shall be of bolted construction unless otherwise stated.Welding at any
point shall not be permitted except for connection of base plates& stiffeners with leg
member of structure.
1.12.1.3. No individual members shall be longer than 6000 mm.
1.12.1.4. The fabrication wastages, if any, shall not be paid for separately and deemed to be
included in quoting rates. Employer shall not accept any liability in connection with
wastage of steel during fabrication or otherwise.
1.12.1.5. Substitution, if any, of steel sections of the structures by higher sizes, due to non-
availability or on account of any other reasons, shall be to the Contractor’s account
without any liability to Employer.
1.12.1.6. All structural members, bolts, nuts and fittings shall be hot dip galvanized. Spring
Washers shall be Electro galvanized.
1.12.1.7. Normally bolted butt joint shall be used to connect the parts of structures. The
thickness of inside angle cleat shall not be less than that of the heavier member
connected.The lap splices may be used for connecting members of unequal thickness
and the inside angle of lap splices shall be rounded at the heel to fit the fillet of the
outside angle. All splices shall develop full stress in the members connected through
bolts.
1.12.1.8. Joints shall be so designed so as to avoid eccentricity, as far as possible. However
where the connections are such that the elimination of the guest plates and spacer
plates are not possible, the gusset/spacer plates may be used in conformity with
modern engineering practice.
1.12.1.9. Members of the structures shall be accurately fabricated, so that the same can be
assembled at site without any strain on members of structure or in bolts.
1.12.1.10. The Contractor during fabrication of structure members shall ensure that mild steel
and high tensile steel sections don’t get mixed up and as such identification mark
shall be embossed on each and every H.T. Steel section at the time of shearing of
members. The bidder in his bid shall clearly bring out the means proposed to be
adopted to identify the mild steel and high tensile steel sections during fabrication.
1.12.1.11. All members of the structures shall be cut to correct lengths and fabricated in
accordance with the shop drawings approved by the Employer. Welding of two or
more pieces to obtain the specified length of member shall not be allowed. Members
shall be straight to the permissible tolerances or better when required to ensure
proper fit before being laid off or worked and after galvanizing.
1.12.1.12. The use of fillers in the connections shall be avoided as far as possible. The diagonal
web members in tension may be connected entirely to the gusset plate where
necessary to avoid the use of fillers. Each diagonal shall be in one piece without
splices or centre gusset and it shall be connected at the point of intersection by one
or more bolts.
1.12.1.13. No angle member shall have its two leg flanges brought together by closing the
angle.
1.12.1.14. All parts of the structures shall be accessible for inspection and cleaning. Drain holes
shall be provided at all points where pockets or depressions are likely to hold water.
1.12.1.15. All similar parts of structures shall be made strictly interchangeable. No rough edges
shall be permitted anywhere throughout the work.
1.12.1.16. Structural members shall be so fabricated as to be bolted together easily at site.
Preference shall be given to the design with least number of parts and the one which
offers best facilities for transport, erection and maintenance. In designing the
structures for minimum number of parts, the Contractor shall not however employ
parts of such dimensions as will prove difficult to handle. The length of the longest
piece shall not exceed 6 meters.
1.12.1.17. Workmanship and finish shall correspond to the modern engineering practice. All
steel sections before any work is done on them, shall be carefully leveled,
straightened and made true by a method which shall not injure the material so that,
when assembled, the adjacent surfaces are in close contact.
1.12.2. Straightening
1.12.2.1. All steel sections, before any cutting is done, shall be carefully straightened and
made true by pressure. Hammering shall not be permitted for straightening or
flattening of members. All sheared edges shall be free from burrs and no rough
edges from shears shall be left. Straightening shall be so done that it does not injure
the material. Sharp bends shall be a cause for rejection.
1.12.3. Cutting
1.12.3.1. Cutting may be affected by shearing, cropping, sawing or by gas cutting by
mechanically controlled torch. Gas cutting by hand shall only be used when
specifically authorized in writing by the Employer. Shearing, cropping and gas
cutting shall be clean, square and free from distortions and burns, and should the
Employer find it necessary, the edges shall be ground afterwards by the Contractor
without any additional cost. The cut surfaces shall be clean, smooth, reasonably
square and free from any distortion. The cut edges of all plates shall be perfectly
straight and uniform throughout.
1.12.4. Bending
1.12.4.1. Mild steel angle sections of size upto 75x75mm (thickness up to and including 6.0
mm) shall be bent cold up to and including bend angles of 10 0. Mild steel angle
sections of size above 75x75mm (thickness upto and including 6.0 mm) and upto
and including 100x100mm (thickness upto 8.0 mm) may also be bent cold upto bend
angles of 50. All other angle sections and bend angles not covered above shall be
bent hot.
1.12.4.2. All plates upto 12.0 mm thickness shall be bent cold upto a maximum bend angle of
150. Hot bending shall be employed for greater bend angles and thicker plates. Bends
on all high tensile steel sections shall be done hot.
1.12.4.3. The bends shall be of even profile and free from any surface damages. All hot bent
material shall be air-cooled.
1.12.5. Holing
1.12.5.1. Holes for bolts in the members shall either be punched or drilled to jig but drilled
holes are preferred. Holes shall not be formed by flame cutting process. All burrs left
by punching or drilling shall be completely removed.
1.12.5.2. Members shall be straightened again after being punched and drilled.
1.12.5.3. Punching may be adopted for mild steel sections with thickness upto 16.0 mm. For
thicker sections, drilling shall be done.
1.12.5.4. The holes near the bend line of a bent member on both sides of bend line shall be
punched/drilled after bending and relative positions of those holes shall be
maintained with the use of proper templates/jigs and fixtures.
1.12.5.5. The limit of punching for high tensile Steel sections shall be indicated by the
contractor and shall be in accordance with relevant Indian Standard/ equivalent
International Standard.
1.12.5.6. Punched/drilled holes shall be at right angle to the surface and walls of holes shall be
parallel. Holes shall be perfectly circular unless specified otherwise in the approved
drawings.
1.12.6. Spacing of Bolts and Edge Distance
1.12.6.1. The minimum spacing of bolts and edge distances shall be as given Table – 13.4
below:
Table – 13.4
Spacing of Bolts and Edge Distance
Bolt Hole Minimum Minimum Edge Distance of Hole
Diameter Diameter Bolt Spacing Distance of Hole centre to
(mm) (mm) (mm) Centre to Rolled sheared or flame
or Sawn cut edge cut Edge
(mm) (mm)
16 17.5 40 20 23
20 21.5 48 25 28
24 25.5 60 33 38
16 3.5
20 4.0
24 4.5
1.12.8. Welding
1.12.8.1. The welding shall be done as per approved fabrication drawings which shall clearly
indicate various details of joints to be welded, type of weld, length & size of weld,
weather shop weld or site weld etc. Symbols for welding on erection and shop
drawings shall be according to IS: 813. Welding shall be done before galvanizing.No
welding after galvanizing shall be allowed.
1.12.8.2. Welding of structural steel shall be done by an electric arc process. The procedure to
be followed, materials, plant and equipment to be used and testing and inspection
procedures to be applied shall be to the satisfaction of the Employer/PMC and shall,
in general, conform to relevant Indian standards viz. IS: 816, IS: 823, IS: 814 and
Indian Standards Hand Book for metal arc welding.
1.12.8.3. All the welders to be employed for the job shall have to qualify the appropriate tests
laid down in IS: 1811 and IS: 817.
1.12.8.4. 100 per cent welds shall be inspected visually for external defects. Dimensions of
welds shall be checked. The length and size of weld shall be as per approved
fabrication drawings. It may be slightly over sized but shall not be under sized. The
profile of weld is affected by the position of the joint but it shall be uniform. In case
of butt and corner welds, the profile shall be convex and in case of submerged arc
fillet weld, it shall be slightly concave.
1.12.8.5. The welds shall have regular height and width of heads. The height and spacing of
ripples shall be uniform. The joints in the weld run where welding has been
recommended shall as far as possible be smooth and should not show any humps or
creaters in the weld surface. Welds shall be free from unfilled creaters on the
surface, under cuts, slag on the surface and visible cracks. After such inspection,
further radiographic/ultrasonic examination shall be undertaken if found necessary
and directed by the Employer. In case of any defect, the work shall be dismantled
and redone duly replacing the defective materials including basic members. Weld
gauges shall be used to measure the size of the welds.
1.12.9. Step Bolts & Ladders
1.12.9.1. Each gantry tower, lightening/lighting mast and equipment supporting structure shall
be provided with step bolts of not less than 16.0 mm diameter and 175 mm long,
spaced not more than 450 mm apart and extending from about 0.5 meter above the
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 21 - Substation structure Page 21-30
ground level to the top of the structure at two diagonally opposite legs. These shall
be provided as per IS: 5613 (Part-2/Sec-1)-1985
1.12.9.2. Each step bolts shall be provided with two nuts on one end to fasten the bolt securely
to the structure and button head at the other end to prevent the feet from slipping
away. The step bolts shall be capable of withstanding a vertical load not less than
1500 N.
1.12.10. ERECTION MARK
1.12.10.1. Each member of the structure shall have a unique erectionmark conforming to
component number given to it in the fabrication drawings. This mark shall be
punched with marking dies of 16 mm size before galvanizing and shall be legible
after galvanizing.
1.12.10.2. Erection Mark shall be in format A-BB-CC-DDD where:
A = Employer’s Code assigned by the Contractor – Alphabet;
BB = Contractor’s Mark – Numerical;
CC = Structure Type – Alphabet; and
DDD = Member Number assigned by the Contractor – Numerical
1.12.10.3. The proposal of Erection Mark shall be prepared by the Contractor and got approved
from Employer before starting any fabrication work.
1.12.11.7. The gap between the ends of two connected members in a butt splice shall not be
more than 6.0 mm and less than 4.0 mm.
1.12.12. Proto Types
1.12.12.1. The Contractor, after the approval of designs & fabrication drawings, offer the proto
type of the each structure for Employer’s inspection at his works or works of
manufacturer.
1.12.12.2. Before proceeding with the bulk fabrication of any of structure i.e. gantry towers,
beams, lightening/lighting masts and equipment supporting structures etc., the
Contractor shall fabricate and assemble in his works for inspection by the Employer
or his authorized representative, one structure of each type as finally approved by the
Employer for checking the fabrication accuracy and workmanship. The check
assembly shall be in a horizontal position. Proto assembly made on ground in
horizontal position shall be adequately supported to prevent distortion and
overstressing of members to ensure proper fit and shall be accomplished without
extraordinary effort to align bolt holes or to force pieces into position. For the check
assembly, bolts and nuts shall be not more than finger tight.
1.12.12.3. Any changes pointed out by Employer’s representative during inspection shall be
incorporated by the contractor.
1.13. GALVANIZING
1.13.1. All members of structures shall be fully galvanized. Galvanizing of the member of
the structures shall conform to IS: 2629-1966 and IS: 4759-1968. All galvanized
members shall withstand tests as per IS: 2633-1972.
1.13.2. For fasteners, the galvanizing shall conform to IS: 5358-1969.
1.13.3. The Galvanizing shall be done after all fabrication work is completed except that the
nuts may be tapped or re-run after galvanizing. Threads of bolts and nuts shall have a
neat fit and shall be such that they can be turned with finger throughout the length of
the threads of bolts and they shall be capable of developing full strength of the bolts.
1.13.4. Spring washers shall be electro-galvanized as per Grade 4 of IS: 1573-1970.
1.13.5. Pickling shall be carried out by immersing the steel members in an acid bath
containing either sulfuric or hydrochloric acid at a suitable concentration and
temperature. The concentration of the acid and temperature of the bath can be varied,
provided, the pickling time is adjusted accordingly. The pickling process shall be
completed by thoroughly rinsing with water, which should preferably be warm, so as
to remove the residual acid.
1.13.6. Galvanizing shall be carried out by hot dip process in a proper and uniformly heated
bath. It shall meet all the requirements, when tested in accordance with IS: 2633 –
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 21 - Substation structure Page 21-32
1.13.16. Members embedded in concrete shall be galvanized from the top to a point at least
300 mm below the proposed elevation of the concrete foundation. Utmost care shall
be taken in not galvanizing the portion to be embedded in concrete below this
stipulated level.
1.13.17. The Contractor shall furnish sufficient quantity of zinc paint of approved quality, free
of cost, for repairing damages of minor nature in galvanized surfaces in transit or
during handling.
1.15 QUANTITIES
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 21 - Substation structure Page 21-34
1.15.1 The quantities of substation structures including all hardware and accessories have
been specified as a LOT in Price Schedule. Bidders shall ensure that they quote for
full scope of work.
1.16 BILL OF MATERIALS
1.16.1 Based on the approved designs & fabrication drawings and after successful assembly
of proto type, the bill of materials shall be submitted separately for each type of
structure to the Employer for approval.
1.16.2 The bill of materials shall contain the erection mark of each member, dimensions,
weight and total weight. Weight of bolts, nuts & washers shall be indicated
separately. Total weight of the structure shall be indicated in the last page of bill of
materials.
1.16.3 At no stage, mass manufacture of structures shall be taken up without the clear
approval of prototype structure and bill of materials.
1.17 INSPECTION, TESTING & ACCEPTANCE CRITERIA
1.17.1 Employer/PMC or his representative shall have free access to manufacturer’s works
to satisfy that the fabrication is being done in accordance with the provisions of this
specification.
1.17.2 Unless otherwise specified, the inspection shall be conducted on the materials prior
to dispatch.
1.17.3 The tests as specified in this specification and/or in the relevant Indian Standard shall
be conducted on the material before dispatch.
1.17.4 The Contractor shall provide all materials, stores, labor, tools and plant, apparatus
and instruments, electricity, fuel, water, transport, accommodation etc. as may be
required by the Employer to carry out inspection and/or tests in accordance with this
specification.
1.17.5 The Contractor shall guarantee compliance with the provisions of this specification
and he shall carry out sampling and necessary tests in accordance with the relevant
Indian Standards and as supplemented herein at his own cost, unless otherwise
specified in the contract. The Contractor shall get the specimens tested in a
laboratory approved by the employer and submit to the employer three copies of the
test results within five days after completion of the test.
1.17.6 Only tested quality steel conforming to IS:2062 having mill test reports shall be used
in fabrication of structures.
1.17.7 All bolts, nuts and washers shall be procured from reputed manufacturers and shall
conform to the relevant Indian Standards.
1.17.8 The weight, thickness and uniformity of zinc coating on hot dipped galvanized
members shall be tested in accordance with IS: 2633 for ensuring the compliance
with the requirements specified in specification.
1.17.9 The finished surfaces of steel structures shall be visually examined for defects like
discolored patches, bare spots, unevenness of coating, spelter which is loosely
attached to the steel, globules, spiky deposits, blistered surface, flaking or peeling off
etc. There shall be no flaking or loosening when struck squarely with a chisel faced
hammer. The presence of any of these defects noticed on visual microscopic
inspection shall render the material liable to rejection.
1.17.10 Defects in galvanizing in certain members indicating presence of impurities in the
galvanizing bath in quantities larger than that permitted by the specifications, or lack
of quality control in any manner in the galvanizing plant shall render the entire
production in the relevant shift liable to rejection.
1.17.11 The galvanized steel member shall withstand minimum four, one minute dips in
copper sulfate solution as per IS: 2633.
1.17.12 Should any structure or part of a structure be found not to comply with any of the
provisions of this specification, the same shall be liable for rejection. No structure or
part of the structure, once rejected, shall be offered again, except in cases where the
employer considers the defects rectifiable. The employer may, at his discretion,
check the test results obtained at the Contractor’s works by independent tests at an
approved laboratory and should the items, so tested, be found to be unsatisfactory,
the same shall be rejected. The cost of tests shall be borne by the Contractor.
1.17.13 To ascertain the quality of the steel used, the Employer reserves the right to get the
material tested at an approved laboratory.
1.17.14 When all tests to be performed in the Contractor’s shop under the terms of this
contract have been successfully carried out, the steel work shall be accepted
forthwith and the employer shall issue an acceptance certificate, upon receipt of
which, the items shall be dispatched. No item shall be delivered unless an acceptance
certificate for the same has been issued. The satisfactory completion of prescribed
tests or the issue of the dispatch certificates shall not bind the employer to accept the
work, should it, on further tests before or after erection be found not in compliance
with the specification.
1.18 PACKING
1.18.1 The material shall be boxed or bundled for transport in the following manner:-
1.18.1.1 Angles shall be packed in bundles securely wrapped four times around at each end
and in the middle and at every meter with No.9 gauge galvanized steel wire with
ends twisted tightly. Gross weight of any bundle shall not exceed approximately 450
kg.
1.18.1.2 Cleat angles, brackets, fillet plates and similar small loose pieces shall be nested and
bolted together in multiples and securely wired together through holes, wrapped
round at least four times with No.9 gauge galvanized steel wire and ends twisted
tightly. Gross weight of each bundle shall not exceed approximately 70kg.
1.18.1.3 The correct quantity of bolts, nuts and washers plus 2.50 percent extra for each type
of gantry tower, beam, lighting/lightening mast, equipment supporting structure etc.
shall be packed in gunny bags, accurately & securely tagged in accordance with the
contents and a number of bags packed in wooden box tightly wrapped with 25 mm
wide x 18 gauge iron band stretched entirely around the box with end overlapping
atleast 150 mm. Gross weight of each box shall not exceed approximately 70 kg.
1.18.1.4 All packing shall be subject to the approval of the Employer, or his appointed
representatives.The packing shall be carried out with caution to protect the material
from moisture, salt or any impurities which may cause rusting or harmful effects.
The packages shall be new and sufficiently sturdy in construction to withstand
normal handling during transportation and at site.
1.18.2 MARKING OF PACKING
The packing shall be marked in the following manner:
1.18.2.1 The bundles and the packages shall be clearly marked with the consignee and
destination by indelible ink.
1.18.2.2 Erection mark of the members of gantry towers, beams, lighting/lightening mastsand
equipment supporting structures etcshall be indicated on the bundles or packages of
gusset plates, bolts & nuts, cleats etc.
1.19 SCHEDULE OF DEVIATIONS / VARIATIONS
1.19.1 If the bidder has any exceptions to any of the clauses laid down in this specification,
these shall be clearly stated in the schedule of deviations/variations (Technical or
Commercial). Otherwise, it shall be presumed that the bidder agrees to the provisions
of this specification and same shall be included in the award letter.
CHAPTER-22
CONTROL AND RELAY PANELS
1 GENERAL
1.1 This specification covers study, design, manufacture, assembly, factory test, supply,
delivery, installation, field test and commissioning of control and relay panels as
specified herein under.
1.2 It is not the intent to specify completely herein all details of design and construction of
equipment to be supplied. The major equipments to be supplied are specified in
Appendix, Bill of Material. However, the equipment supplied shall conform, in all
respects, to high standards of engineering, design and workmanship and be capable of
performing in continuous commercial operation up to Manufacturers’ guarantee.
1.3 The equipment shall be designed to be fail-safe for the possible failure of any major
circuit during the operation and shall provide a safeguard against possible surges,
fail-safe against disrupted signals due to outside interference that would normally be
associated with the cable communication lines and any other provisions necessary for the
different operation of the equipment.
1.4 The relays specified in the following articles are based on standard protection schemes
generally adopted in 132 kV substations of Employer’s Integrated Power System.
However, the Contractor shall carry out detail system study of protection system of
Integrated Power System with special regard to existing substations in the vicinity of the
proposed works. Based on this study, the Contractor shall design a relaying scheme for
the substations, prepare a detail relay schedule and recommend relay-setting values for
relay co-ordination with existing ones and make all necessary adjustments in the relay
settings of neighbouring substations as well.
1.5 The indication and annunciation schemes intended for existing substations shall be
compatible with the existing system as far as possible.
1.6 Manufacturers for control & Protection Equipment
All major protection relays shall be of static/numeric type. Relays shall be only from
short listed manufacturers.
2 Type of Panels
Simplex panel shall consist of a vertical front panel with equipment mounted thereon and
having wiring access from rear for control panels & front for relay/protection panels. In
case of panel having width more than 800mm, double leaf-doors shall be provided.
Doors shall have handles with either built-in locking facility or will be provided with
pad-lock.
Duplex panel shall be walk-in tunnel type comprising two vertical front and rear
panel sections connected back-on-back by formed sheet steel roof tie members and a
central corridor in between. The corridor shall facilitate access to internal wiring and
external cable connections. In case of number of duplex panels located in a row side by
side, the central corridor shall be aligned to form a continuous passage. Both ends of the
corridor shall be provided with double leaf doors with lift off hinges. Doors shall have
handles either with built-in locking facility or shall be provided with pad- locks. Separate
cable entries shall be provided for the front and rear panels. However, inter-connections
between front and back panels shall be by means of inter panel wiring at the top of the
panel.
3 CONSTRUCTIONAL FEATURES
3.1 Control and Relay Boards shall be simplex type or duplex type design as per
requirement. It is the responsibility of the Contractor to ensure that the equipment
specified and such unspecified complementary equipment required for completeness of
the protective/control schemes be properly accommodated in the panels without
congestion and if necessary, either add more number of panels or provide panels with
larger dimensions. No price increase at a later date on this account shall be allowed.
However, the width of panels that are being offered to be placed in existing switchyard
control rooms should be in conformity with the existing panels and space availability in
the control room.
3.2 Panels shall be completely metal enclosed and shall be dust, moisture and vermin
proofed. The enclosure shall provide a degree of protection not less than IP-31 in
accordance with IEC 60529 (Part-1).
3.3 Panels shall be free standing, floor mounting type and shall comprise structural frames
completely enclosed with specially selected smooth finished, cold rolled sheet steel of
thickness not less than 3 mm for weight bearing members of the panels such as base
frame, front sheet and door frames, and 2.0 mm for sides, door, top and bottom portions.
There shall be sufficient reinforcement to provide level transportation and installation.
3.4 All doors, removable covers of panels shall be gasketed all around with synthetic gaskets
Neoprene/EPDM. However, XLPE gaskets can also be used for fixing protective glass
doors. Ventilating louvers, if provided shall have screens and filters. The screens shall be
made of either brass or GI wire mesh
3.5 Design, materials selection and workmanship shall be such as to result in neat
appearance, inside and outside with no welds, rivets or bolt head apparent from outside,
with all exterior surfaces tune and smooth.
3.6 Panels shall have base frame with smooth bearing surface, which shall be fixed on the
embedded foundation channels/insert plates. Anti vibration strips made of shock
absorbing materials that shall be supplied by the contractor, which shall be placed
between panel & base frame.
3.7 Cable entries to the panels shall be from the bottom. Cable gland plate fitted on the
bottom of the panel shall be connected to earthing of the panel/station through a flexible
braided copper conductor rigidly.
3.8 Control/Relay panels, if required to incorporate the provisions for
SCADA/SAS as specified in the relevant chapter, shall be completely equipped and
wired with necessary devices/equipment for control and other signals to be used for such
systems. The detail requirements for SCADA/SAS system are furnished in the relevant
chapters of these Specifications.
3.9 MOUNTING
3.9.1 All equipment on and in panels shall be mounted and completely wired to the terminal
blocks ready for external connections. The equipment on front of panel shall be
mounted flush.
3.9.2 Equipment shall be mounted such that removal and replacement can be accomplished
individually without interruption of service to adjacent devices and are readily accessible
without use of special tools. Terminal marking on the equipment shall be clearly visible.
3.9.3 The Contractor shall carry out cut out, mounting and wiring of the free issue items
supplied by others which are to be mounted in his panel in accordance with the
corresponding equipment manufacturer's drawings. Cut outs if any, provided for future
mounting of equipment shall be properly blanked off with blanking plate.
3.9.4 The centre lines of switches, push buttons and indicating lamps shall not be less than 750
mm from the bottom of the panel. The centre lines of relays, meters and recorders shall
not be less than 450 mm from the bottom of the panel.
3.9.5 The centre lines of switches, push buttons and indicating lamps shall be matched to give
a neat and uniform appearance. Like wise the top lines of all meters, relays and
recorders etc. shall be matched.
3.9.6 No equipment shall be mounted on the doors.
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 22 - Control and Relay Panel Page 22-4
3.9.7 At existing station, panels shall be matched with other panels in the control room in
respect of dimensions, colour, appearance and arrangement of equipment (centre lines of
switches, push buttons and other equipment) on the front of the panel.
3.10.7 Contractor shall be solely responsible for the completeness and correctness of the
internal wiring and for the proper functioning of the connected equipments.
supply.
3.12 PAINTING
The painting shall be carried out as detailed in Chapter 2–GTR.
inscription separate name plate giving its function shall be provided for it. Switch shall
also have clear inscription for each position indication e.g. "Trip- Neutral-Close", "ON-
OFF", "R-Y-B-OFF" etc
3.14.6 All the panels shall be provided with name plate mounted inside the panel bearing LOA
No & Date, Name of the Substation & feeder and reference drawing number.
3.16 EARTHING
3.16.1 All panels shall be equipped with an earth bus securely fixed. Location of earth bus
shall ensure no radiation interference from earth systems under various switching
conditions of isolators and breakers. The material and the sizes of the bus bar shall be at
least 25 X 6 sq.mm copper with threaded holes at a gap of 50 mm with provision of bolts
and nuts for connection with cable armours and mounted equipment etc for effective
earthing. When several panels are mounted adjoining each other, the earth bus shall be
made continuous and necessary connectors and clamps for this purpose shall be included
in the scope of supply of Contractor. Provision shall be made for extending the earth bus
3.17.2.4 Digital voltage and frequency meters shall be of class: 0.5 and shall have digital display
of 5 and 4 digits respectively, with display size, not less than 25mm (height).
3.17.3 Transducers
3.17.3.1 Transducers (for use with Indicating Instruments and Telemetry/Data Communication
application) shall in general conform to IEC:688-1
3.17.3.2 The transducers shall be suitable for measurement of active power, reactive power,
voltage, current and frequency in three phase four wire unbalanced system.
3.17.3.3 The input to the transducers will be from sub-station current & potential transformers.
The output shall be in milli ampere D.C. proportional to the input & it shall be possible
to feed the output current directly to the telemetry terminal or indicating instruments.
3.17.3.4 The transducer characteristic shall be linear throughout the measuring range.
3.17.3.5 The transducer output shall be load independent.
3.17.3.6 The input & output of the transducer shall be galvanically isolated.
3.17.3.7 Each transducer shall be housed in a separate compact case and have suitable terminals
for inputs & outputs.
3.17.3.8 The transducers shall be suitably protected against transient high peaks of voltage &
current.
3.17.3.9 The transducer shall withstand indefinitely without damage and work satisfactorily at
120% of the rated voltage and 120% of the rated input current as applicable.
3.17.3.10 All the transducers shall have an output of 4-20 mA.
3.17.3.11 The response time of the transducers shall be less than 1 second.
3.17.3.12 The accuracy class of transducers shall be 1.0 or better for voltage/current transducer,
0.5 or better for watt/VAR transducer and 0.2 or better for frequency transducer.
3.17.3.13 The transducers shall have a low AC ripple on output less than 1%.
3.17.3.14 The transducer shall have dual output.
3.18.3 The annunciation facia shall be provided with translucent plastic window for alarm
point with approximate size of 35mm x 50mm. The facia plates shall be engraved in
black lettering with respective inscriptions. Alarm inscriptions shall be engraved on
each window in not more than three lines and size of the lettering shall not be less than
5 mm.
3.18.4 Each annunciation window shall be provided with two white lamps in parallel to
provide safety against lamp failure. Long life lamps shall be used. The transparency
of cover plates and wattage of the lamps provided in the facia windows shall be
adequate to ensure clear visibility of the inscriptions in the control room having high
illumination intensity (350 Lux), from the location of the operator's desk.
3.18.5 All Trip facia shall have red colour and all Non-trip facia shall have white colour.
3.18.6 The audible alarm shall be provided by Buzzer/ Hooter /Bell having different sounds
and shall be used as follows.
Hooter Alarm Annunciation
Bell Annunciation DC failure
Buzzer AC supply failure
3.18.7 Sequence of operation of the annunciator shall be as follows :
3.18.9 A separate voltage check relay shall be provided to monitor the failure of supply
(230V AC) to the scheme mentioned in Clause above. If the failure of supply exists for
more than 2 to 3 seconds, this relay shall initiate visual and audible annunciation.
Visual and audible annunciation for the failure of AC supply to the annunciation
system shall be provided and this annunciation shall operate on Annunciation DC and
buzzer shall sound.
3.18.10 The annunciation system described above shall meet the following additional
requirements :
a) The annunciation system shall be capable of catering to at least 20 simultaneous
signals at a time.
b) One set of the following push buttons shall be provided on each control panel:
Reset push button for annunciation system
Accept push button for annunciation system
Lamp test push button for testing the facia windows
c) One set of the following items shall be provided common for all the control panel
(not applicable for extension of substation) :
Flasher relay for annunciation system
Push button for Flasher test
Three Push buttons for test of all audible alarm systems
d) These testing circuits shall be so connected that while testing is being done, it shall
not prevent the registering of any new annunciation that may land during the test.
e) The annunciation shall be repetitive type and shall be capable of registering the
fleeting signal. Minimum duration of the fleeting signal registered by the system
shall be 15 milli seconds.
f) In case of static annunciator scheme, special precaution shall be taken to ensure
that spurious alarm condition does not appear due to influence of external
electromagnetic/ electrostatic interference on the annunciator wiring and switching
disturbances from the neighbouring circuits within the panels and the static
annunciator shall meet the high voltage susceptibility test , impulse voltage
withstand test , high frequency disturbance test– class III and fast transient
disturbance test –level III as per IEC 60255.
3.18.11 The annunciation system to be supplied for existing sub-stations shall be engineered as
an extension to the existing scheme.
3.19 SWITCHES
3.19.1 Control and instrument switches shall be rotary operated type with escutcheon plates
clearly marked to show operating position and circuit designation plates and suitable
for flush mounting with only switch front plate and operating handle projecting out.
3.19.2 The selection of operating handles for the different types of switches shall be as
follows :
carrying parts
3.19.8 The contact combination and their operation shall be such as to give completeness to
the interlock and function of the scheme.
3.19.9 The contact rating of the switches shall be as follows :
3.21.1 Position indicators of "SEMAPHORE" type shall be provided when specified as part
of the mimic diagrams on panels for indicating the position of circuit breakers,
isolating/earthing switches etc. The indicator shall be suitable for semi-flush mounting
with only the front disc projecting out and with terminal connection from the rear.
Their strips shall be of the same colour as the associated mimic.
3.21.2 Position indicator shall be suitable for DC Voltage as specified. When the supervised
object is in the closed position, the pointer of the indicator shall take up a position in
line with the mimic bus bars, and at right angles to them when the object is in the open
position. When the supply failure to the indicator occurs, the pointer shall take up an
intermediate position to indicate the supply failure.
3.21.3 The rating of the indicator shall not exceed 2.5 W.
3.21.4 The position indicators shall withstand 120% of rated voltage on a continuous basis.
applicable standards. Relays shall be suitable for flush or semi-flush mounting on the
front with connections from the rear.
3.23.2 All protective relays shall be of numerical type and communication protocol shall be
as per IEC 61850. Further, the test levels of EMI as indicated in IEC 61850 shall be
applicable to these relays.
3.23.3 All protective relays shall be in draw out or plug-in type/modular cases with proper
testing facilities. Necessary test plugs/test handles shall be supplied loose and shall be
included in contractor's scope of supply.
3.23.4 All AC operated relays shall be suitable for operation at 50 Hz AC Voltage operated
relays shall be suitable for 110 Volts VT secondary and current operated relays for 1
amp CT secondary. All DC operated relays and timers shall be designed for the DC
voltage specified, and shall operate satisfactorily between 80% and 110% of rated
voltage. Voltage operated relays shall have adequate thermal capacity for continuous
operation.
3.23.5 The protective relays shall be suitable for efficient and reliable operation of the
protection scheme described in the specification. Necessary auxiliary relays and
timers required for interlocking schemes for multiplying of contacts suiting contact
duties of protective relays and monitoring of control supplies and circuits, lockout
relay monitoring circuits etc. also required for the complete protection schemes
described in the specification shall be provided. All protective relays shall be provided
with at least two pairs of potential free isolated output contacts. Auxiliary relays and
timers shall have pairs of contacts as required to complete the scheme; contacts shall
be silver faced with spring action. Relay case shall have adequate number of terminals
for making potential free external connections to the relay coils and contacts, including
spare contacts.
3.23.6 Timers shall be of solid state type. Time delay in terms of milliseconds obtained by the
external capacitor resistor combination is not preferred and shall be avoided.
3.23.7 No control relay, which shall trip the power circuit breaker when the relay is de-
energised, shall be employed in the circuits.
3.23.8 Provision shall be made for easy isolation of trip circuits of each relay for the purpose
of testing and maintenance.
3.23.9 Auxiliary seal-in-units provided on the protective relays shall preferably be of shunt
reinforcement type. If series relays are used the following shall be strictly ensured:
(a) The operating time of the series seal-in-unit shall be sufficiently shorter than that of
the trip coil or trip relay in series with which it operates to ensure definite operation
of the flag indicator of the relay.
(b) Seal-in-unit shall obtain adequate current for operation when one or more relays
operate simultaneously.
(c) Impedance of the seal-in-unit shall be small enough to permit satisfactory operation
of the trip coil on trip relays when the D.C. Supply Voltage is minimum.
(d) Trip-circuit seal-in is required for all trip outputs, irrespective of the magnitude of
the interrupted current. The trip-circuit seal-in logic shall not only seal-in the trip
output(s), but also the relevant initiation signals to other scheme functions, (e.g.
initiate signals to the circuit-breaker failure function, reclosing function etc.), and the
alarm output signals.
(e) Two methods of seal-in are required, one based on the measurement of AC current,
catering for those circumstances for which the interrupted current is above a set
threshold, and one based on a fixed time duration, catering for those circumstances
for which the interrupted current is small (below the set threshold).
(f) For the current seal-in method, the seal-in shall be maintained until the circuit-
breaker opens, at which time the seal-in shall reset and the seal-in method shall not
now revert to the fixed time duration method. For this seal-in method, the seal-in
shall be maintained for the set time duration. For the line protection schemes, this
time duration shall be independently settable for single- and three-pole tripping.
(g) Seal-in by way of current or by way of the fixed duration timer shall occur
irrespective of whether the trip command originates from within the main protection
device itself (from any of the internal protection functions), or from an external
device with its trip output routed through the main protection device for tripping.
Trip-circuit seal-in shall not take place under sub-harmonic conditions (e.g. reactor
ring down).
3.23.10 The setting ranges of the relays offered, if different from the ones specified shall also
be acceptable if they meet the functional requirements.
3.23.11 Any alternative/additional protections or relays considered necessary for providing
complete effective and reliable protection shall also be offered separately. The accept-
ance of this alternative/ additional equipment shall lie with the OWNER.
3.23.12 All relays and their drawings shall have phase indications as R-Red, Y-yellow, B-blue
3.23.13 For numerical relays, the scope shall include the following:
a) Necessary software and hardware to up/down load the data to/from the relay
from/to the personal computer (PC) in the substation. The Contractor shall provide
PC and at least one laptop with core i7 processor, relays programming software
and necessary probes & cables for setting the numeric relays. No separate
payment will be provided for PC, laptop, software, probes, cables etc. All cost
involved for these items shall be included in the cost of control and relay panels.
b) The relay shall have suitable communication facility for future connectivity to
SCADA. The relay shall be capable of supporting IEC 61850 protocol.
c) In case of line protection and transformer protection, capacitor bank protection, the
features like fault recorder and event logging function as available including
available as optional feature in these relays shall be supplied and activated at no
extra cost to the owner. Also necessary software/ hardware for automatic uploading
to station HMI/DR work station (as applicable) shall be supplied. It is to be clearly
understood that these shall be in addition to Fault recorder function as specified at
clause no. 28.
times setting
have a variable setting range of 50-200% of rated current
have a characteristic angle of 30/45 degree lead
include hand reset flag indicators or LEDs
(d) earth fault element shall
have IDMT characteristic with a definite minimum time of 3.0 seconds at 10
times setting
have a variable setting range of 20-80% of rated current
have a characteristic angle of 45/60 degree lag
include hand reset flag indicators or LEDs
include necessary separate interposing voltage transformers or have internal
feature in the relay for open delta voltage to the relay.
The synchro check relay shall be provided for each 132 kV transmission line. This
relay shall allow the control scheme to close the line breaker only when:
The line is alive and the bus is dead
The line is dead and the bus is alive or
The line is in synchronism with the bus.
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 22 - Control and Relay Panel Page 22-21
- have a voltage check unit for closing order with a dead line and live
busbar, or dead busbar and live line
Necessary hardware and software, for automatic up-loading the data captured by
disturbance recorder to the personal computer (DR Work Station) available in the
substation, shall be included in the scope.
3.26.2 Over Fluxing Protection Relays shall
(a) operate on the principle of Voltage to frequency ratio and shall be phase to
phase connected
(b) have inverse time characteristics, matching with transformer over fluxing
withstand capability curve
(c) provide an independent 'alarm' with the time delay continuously adjustable
between 0.1 to 6.0 seconds at values of 'v/f' between 100% to 130% of rated
values
(d) tripping time shall be governed by 'v/f' Vs. time characteristics of the relay
(e) have a set of characteristics for Various time multiplier settings. The
maximum operating time of the relay shall not exceed 3 seconds and 1.5
seconds at 'v/f' values of 1.4 and 1.5 times, the rated values, respectively.
(f) have an accuracy of operating time, better than 10%
(g) have a resetting ratio of 95 % or better
3.29.1 The fault recorder shall be provided for transmission line and the fault recorder as in-
built feature of line distance relay is also acceptable provided the requirements of
following clauses are met.
3.29.2 Fault recorder shall be microprocessor based and shall be used to record the graphic
form of instantaneous values of voltage and current in all three phases, open delta
voltage & neutral current, open or closed position of relay contacts and breakers during
the system disturbances.
3.29.3 The Fault recorder shall consist of individual acquisition units, one for each feeder and
an Evaluation unit which is common for the entire Substation. Whenever, more than
one acquisition units are connected to an Evaluation unit, necessary hardware and
software shall also be supplied for on line transfer of data from all acquisition units to
Evaluation unit.
3.29.4 The acquisition unit is connected with evaluation unit being supplied as described in
chapter 17 sub-station automation through bus conforming to IEC 61850. In case of
extension sub-station which is equipped with Sub-station Automation System based on
IEC 61850, one set of evaluation software shall be supplied and loaded in existing
fault recorder evaluation unit. Automatic uploading of disturbance files from
acquisition unit to evaluation unit shall be done through existing station bus only
conforming to IEC 61850. Necessary configuration/updation including hardware if any
shall be in the scope of the contractor.
3.29.5 In case of extension of existing substation(s) which are without sub-station automation
system, one set of Evaluation unit shall be supplied for each substation where ever
disturbance recorders are required to be supplied along with necessary evaluation
software as specified above. The Evaluation unit shall consist of a desktop personal
computer (including at least 21” TFT colour monitor, mouse and keyboard) and
printer. The desktop PC shall have Pentium - IV processor or better and having a clock
speed 3.0 GHz or better. The hard disk capacity of PC shall not be less than 300 GB
and RAM capacity shall not be less than 3 GB
3.29.6 The evaluation unit hardware, for substations having SAS, shall be as described in
clause no. 4.0 of chapter sub-station automation system.
3.29.7 Fault recorder shall have atleast 8 analogue and 16 digital channels for each feeder.
3.29.8 Acquisition units shall acquire the Disturbance data for the pre fault and post fault
period and transfer them to Evaluation unit automatically to store in the hard disk. The
acquisition units shall be located in the protection panels of the respective feeders.
3.29.9 The acquisition unit shall be suitable for inputs from current transformers with 1A
rated secondary and capacitive voltage transformers with 63.5V (phase to neutral
voltage) rated secondary. Any device required for processing of input signals in order
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 22 - Control and Relay Panel Page 22-30
to make the signals compatible to the Fault recorder equipment shall form an integral
part of it. However, such processing of input signals shall in no way distort its
waveform.
3.29.10 The equipment shall be carefully screened, shielded, earthed and protected as may be
required for its safe functioning. Also, the Fault recorder shall have stable software,
reliable hardware, simplicity of maintenance and immunity from the effects of the
hostile environment of EHV switchyard which are prone to various interference
signals typically from large switching transients.
3.29.11 Necessary software for transferring the data automatically from local evaluation unit to
a remote station and receiving the same at the remote station through owner’s
OPGW/PLCC/VSAT/LEASED LINE shall be provided.
3.29.12 Evaluation software shall be provided for the analysis and evaluation of the recorded
data made available in the PC under WINDOWS environment. The Software features
shall include repositioning of analog and digital signals, selection and amplification of
time and amplitude scales of each analogue and digital channel, calculation of
MAX/MIN frequency, phase difference values, recording of MAX/MIN values etc. of
analogue channel, group of signal to be drawn on the same axis etc, listing and
numbering of all analogue and digital channels and current, voltage, frequency and
phase difference values at the time of fault/tripping. Also, the software should be
capable of carrying out Fourier /Harmonic analysis of the current and voltage wave
forms. The Disturbance records shall also be available in COMTRADE format (IEEE
standard- Common Format for Transient data Exchange for Power System)
3.29.13 The Evaluation unit shall be connected to the printer to obtain the graphic form of
disturbances whenever desired by the operator.
3.29.14 Fault recorder acquisition units shall be suitable to operate from 110V DC as available
at sub-station. Evaluation unit along with the printer shall normally be connected to
230V, single phase AC supply. In case of failure of AC supply, Evaluation unit and
printer shall be switched automatically to the station DC through Inverter of adequate
capacity which shall form a part of Fault recorder system. The inverter of adequate
capacity shall be provided to cater the requirement specified in chapter sub-station
automation clause no. 8.0 and DR evaluation unit.
3.29.15 The acquisition unit shall have the following features
(a) Facility shall exist to alarm operator in case of any internal faults in the
acquisition units such as power supply fail, processor / memory fail etc and
same shall be wired to annunciation system.
(b) The frequency response shall be 5 Hz on lower side and 250 Hz or better on
upper side.
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 22 - Control and Relay Panel Page 22-31
A4 size paper (500 sheets in each packet) suitable for printer shall be supplied.
3.29.17 Each Fault recorder shall have its own time generator and the clock of the time
generator shall be such that the drift is limited to +0.5 seconds/day, if allowed to run
without synchronisation. Further, Fault recorder shall have facility to synchronise its
time generator from Time Synchronisation Equipment having output of following
types
Voltage signal : (0-5V continuously settable, with 50m Sec. minimum pulse
duration)
Potential free contact (Minimum pulse duration of 50 m Sec.)
IRIG-B
RS232C
The recorder shall give annunciation in case of absence of synchronising within a
specified time.
3.29.18 Substations where Time Synchronisation Equipment is not available, time generator of
any one of the Fault recorders can be taken as master and time generators of other
Fault recorders and Event loggers in that station shall be synchronised to follow the
master.
3.30 DISTANCE TO FAULT LOCATOR shall
a) be electronic or microprocessor based type
b) be 'On-line' type
c) be suitable for breaker operating time of 2 cycles
d) have built-in display unit
e) the display shall be directly in percent of line length or kilometres without
requiring any further calculations
f) have an accuracy of 3% or better for the typical conditions defined for operating
timings measurement of distance relays.
g) The above accuracy should not be impaired under the following conditions:
presence of remote end infeed
predominant D.C. component in fault current
high fault arc resistance
severe CVT transients
h) shall have mutual zero sequence compensation unit if fault locator is to be used
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 22 - Control and Relay Panel Page 22-33
& have a separate time display unit to be mounted on the top of control panels having
display size of approx. 100 mm height.
CONTROL PANEL
Various types of control panels shall consist of the following
protection
8. Energy Meter 3 phase, 4 wire, ABT 1 No.
9. Cut-out and wiring with TTB for supplied energy meter 1 Set
The protection panel for 132/33 kV Transformer shall consist of the following equipments.
BCU for 132 kV Bay has been included in the BOQ of SAS.
The protection panel for 33/11 kV Transformer shall consist of the following
equipments.
33 kV 11 kV
Side Side
1 Transformer Differential protection scheme 1 No. Nil
2 Restricted Earth fault protection scheme 1 No. 1 No.
3 Directional back up over current and E/F Relay 1 Set Nil
With non-directional high set feature
4 Non-Directional back up over current and Nil 1 Set
E/F Relay with non-directional high set feature
(Part of 33kV BCU is acceptable)
5 Over fluxing protection scheme Nil 1 Set
6 Over load protection scheme 1 No. Nil
7 Three phase trip relays 2Nos. 2 Nos.
8 Trip supervision relay 2Nos. 2 Nos.
9 Scheme requirements including transformer Alarms Lot Lot
and trip function
10 Disturbance Recorder 1No. Nil
11 Revenue Energy meter (As per T.S. Chapter-1) 1No. 1 No.
The132 Bus Coupler cum Busbar Protection Panel shall consist of following:
The above protection schemes may be clubbed in Group-I/II as per clause no. 14.21
of technical specification. All the trip relays and auxiliary relays required for
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 22 - Control and Relay Panel Page 22-40
APPENDIX-A
Test programme for distance relays
General Comments:
1. These test cases are evolved from the report of working group 04 of study committee 34
(Protection) on evaluation of characteristics and performance of power system protection
relays and protective systems. For any further guidelines required for carrying out the tests,
reference may be made to the above document.
2. The test shall be carried out using network configuration and system parameters as shown in
the figure-1
3. All denotations regarding fault location, breakers etc are referred in figure –1
4. The fault inception angles are referred to R- N voltage for all types of faults
5. The fault inception angle is zero degree unless otherwise specified
6. Where not stated specifically, the fault resistance (Rf) shall be zero or minimum as possible
in simulator
7. Single pole circuit breakers are to be used
8. The power flow in double source test is 100 MW
System parameters
System voltage =132KV
CTR= 600/1
PTR = 132/110 (with CVT, the parameters of CVT model are shown in figure –2)
RELAY
C1 CVT C3
CT CT
XSA
XSB
C2 C4
SOURCE 1
BUS 1 SOURCE 2
BUS 2
FIGURE 1
Line parameters/km
Positive Sequence Resistance, (r1) = 0. 02897 Ω
Positive Sequence Reactance (x1) = 0.3072 Ω
Zero Sequence Resistance (r0) = 0.2597 Ω
Zero Sequence Reactance (x1) = 1.0223 Ω
Zero Sequence Mutual Resistance (rm) = 0.2281 Ω
Zero Sequence Mutual Reactance (xm) = 0.6221 Ω
Zero Sequence succeptance (bo) = 2.347 µ mho
Positive Sequence succeptance (b1) =3.630 µ mho
* Alternatively , the tests can be done with 10 Ω secondary impedance and source
impedance may accordingly be modified
CVT Model
C1
TUNING CIRCUIT ( Rl , Ll) DAMPING CIRCUIT (Ra ,La)
C2
LOAD(Rc)
CAPACITIVE DIVIDER
INTERMEDIATE TRANSFORMER
Figure-2
Sl Description Single source with short Single source Double source Double source
no line long line (20 with short with long single
(2 ) ) double line (2 line (20 )
)
Sl Description Single source with short Single source Double source Double source
no line long line (20 with short with long single
(2 ) ) double line (2 line (20 )
)
Sl Description Single source with short Single source Double source Double source
no line long line (20 with short with long single
(2 ) ) double line (2 line (20 )
)
Sl Description Single source with short Single source Double source Double source
no line long line (20 with short with long single
(2 ) ) double line (2 line (20 )
)
Sl Description Single source with short Single source Double source Double source
no line long line (20 with short with long single
(2 ) ) double line (2 line (20 )
)
fault at 2 location ( 0%
resistance and 68 % of line
length) X 1 fault
( RN with
Rf=13.75
ohm(sec) X 2
fault inception
angle (0°,90° ) =
4 cases
9 Operation at Tests to be done
evolving at 2 location (32
faults % and 0% of line
length) X 2 faults
(RN to RYN) x
in 2 timings (10
ms and 30 ms) X
2 load direction
(from A to B and
from B to A) = 16
cases
10 Fault Measure Measure Measure Measure fault Measure fault
locator fault fault fault location location for all location for all
function , in location location for for all cases cases under 2 cases under 2, 7
case the for all all cases under 1 and 2 and 6 and 9
same is cases under 1 and
offered as under 1 2
built in and 2
feature
CHAPTER – 23
SUBSTATION AUTOMATION SYSTEM AND SCADA INTEGRATION
1 GENERAL
1.1 The substation automation system shall be offered from a manufacturer who must
have designed, manufactured, tested, installed and commissioned substation
automation system which must be in satisfactory operation on 132 kV system or
higher for at least 2 (Two) years as on the date of bid opening.
The Bidder shall submit type-test reports, valid ISO 9001 Certificates, necessary
technical brochures, sales record as well as detailed drawings showing layout,
section in conformity with relevant standards with his tender to verify compliance
with the requirement of these Specifications.
1.2 The Substation Automation System (SAS) shall be installed to control and monitor
all the sub-station equipment from remote control centre (RCC) as well as from
local control centre.
1.3 Peripheral equipment like printers, display units, key boards, Mouse etc. shall enable
local station control via a PC by means of human machine interface (HMI) and
control software package, which shall contain an extensive range of supervisory
control and data acquisition (SCADA) functions. It shall include communication
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 23 - Substation Automation System and SCADA Integration Page 23-2
gateway, intelligent electronic devices (IED) for bay control and inter IED
communication infrastructure. An architecture drawing for SAS is enclosed.
1.4 The communication gateway shall facilitate the information flow with remote control
centres. The bay level intelligent electronic devices (IED) for protection and control
shall provide the direct connection to the switchgear without the need of interposing
components and perform control, protection, and monitoring functions.
2 SYSTEM DESIGN
The high-voltage apparatus within the station shall be operated from different
places:
Remote control centres
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 23 - Substation Automation System and SCADA Integration Page 23-4
Station HMI.
Local Bay controller IED (in the bays)
Operation shall be possible by only one operator at a time.
The operation shall depend on the conditions of other functions, such as
interlocking, synchrocheck, etc. (see description in”Bay level control functions”).
2.2.1.1 Select-before-execute
For security reasons the command is always to be given in two stages: selection of
the object and command for operation under all mode of operation except
emergency operation. Final execution shall take place only when selection and
command are actuated.
2.2.1.4 Self-supervision
Continuous self-supervision function with self-diagnostic feature shall be
included.
It shall also be possible to interconnect and derive input and output signals, logic
functions, using built-In functions, complex voltage and currents, additional
logics (AND-gates, OR gates and timers). (Multi-activation of these additional
functions should be possible).
Separate IEDs shall be provided for bay control function and bay protection function.
REMOTE mode
Control authority in this mode is given to a higher level (Remote Control Centre)
and the installation can be controlled only remotely. Control operation from lower
levels shall not be possible in this operating mode.
2.3.2.1 General
The protection functions are independent of bay control function. The protection
shall be provided by separate protection IEDs (numerical relays) and other
protection devices as per section Relay & Protection.
IEDs, shall be connected to the communication infrastructure for data sharing and
meet the real-time communication requirements for automatic functions. The data
presentation and the configuration of the various IEDs shall be compatible with
the overall system communication and data exchange requirements.
Event and disturbance recording function
Each IED should contain an event recorder capable of storing at least 200 time-
tagged events. The disturbance recorder function shall be as per detailed in
Chapter 15 – Control, Relay & Protection Panels.
The SAS shall also monitor the status of sub-station auxiliaries. The status and
control of auxiliaries shall be done through separate one or more IED and all alarm
and analogue values shall be monitored and recoded through this IED.
2.4.2 Measurements
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 23 - Substation Automation System and SCADA Integration Page 23-8
The SAS system shall be comprehensively self-monitored such that faults are
immediately indicated to the operator, possibly before they develop into serious
situations. Such faults are recorded as a faulty status in a system supervision
display. This display shall cover the status of the entire substation including all
switchgear, IEDs, communication infrastructure and remote communication links,
and printers at the station level, etc.
2.4.4.2.4 Event list
The event list shall contain events that are important for the control and monitoring
of the substation.
The event and associated time (with 1 ms resolution) of its occurrence has to be
displayed for each event.
The operator shall be able to call up the chronological event list on the monitor at
any time for the whole substation or sections of it.
A printout of each display shall be possible on the hard copy printer.
The events shall be registered in a chronological event list in which the type of
event and its time of occurrence are specified. It shall be possible to store all events
in the computer for at least one month. The information shall be obtainable also
from a printed event log.
Faults and errors occurring in the substation shall be listed in an alarm list and shall
be immediately transmitted to the control centre. The alarm list shall substitute a
conventional alarm tableau, and shall constitute an evaluation of all station alarms.
It shall contain unacknowledged alarms and persisting faults. The date and time of
occurrence shall be indicated.
The alarm list shall consist of a summary display of the present alarm situation.
Each alarm shall be reported on one line that contains:
The date and time of the alarm
The name of the alarming object
A descriptive text
The acknowledgement state.
Whenever an alarm condition occurs, the alarm condition must be shown on the
alarm list and must be displayed in a flashing state along with an audible alarm.
After acknowledgement of the alarm, it should appear in a steady (i.e. not flashing)
state and the audible alarm shall stop. The alarm should disappear only if the alarm
condition has physically cleared and the operator has reset the alarm with a reset
command. The state of the alarms shall be shown in the alarm list (Unacknowledged
and persistent, Unacknowledged and cleared, Acknowledged and persistent).
Filters for selection of a certain type or group of alarms shall be available as for
events.
2.4.4.2.6 Object picture
When selecting an object such as a circuit breaker or isolator in the single-line
diagram, the associated bay picture shall be presented first. In the selected object
picture, all attributes like
Type of blocking
Authority
Local / remote control
RSCC / SAS control
Errors
etc.,
shall be displayed.
be indicated. It shall be possible to select the time period for which the specific data
are kept in the memory.
Following printouts shall be available from the printer and shall be printed on
demand:
i. Daily voltage and frequency curves depicting time on X-axis and the
appropriate parameters on the Y-axis. The time duration of the curve is 24
hours.
ii. Weekly trend curves for real and derived analogue values.
iii. Printouts of the maximum and minimum values and frequency of occurrence
and duration of maximum and minimum values for each analogue parameter
for each circuit in 24 hr period.
iv. Provision shall be made for logging information about breaker status like
number of operation with date and time indications along with the current
value it interrupts (in both condition i.e. manual opening and fault tripping)
v. Equipment operation details shift wise and during 24 hours.
vi. Printout on adjustable time period as well as on demand for MW, MVAR,
Current, Voltage on each feeder and transformer as well as Tap Positions,
temperature and status of pumps and fans for transformers.
vii. Printout on adjustable time period as well as on demand system frequency
and average frequency.
viii. Reports in specified formats which shall be handed over to successful bidder.
The bidder has to develop these reports. The reports are limited to the formats
for which data is available in the SAS database.
The communication interface to the SAS shall allow scanning and control of defined
points within the substation automation system independently for each control
centre. The substation automation system shall simultaneously respond to
independent scans and commands from employer's control centres (RCC & RSCC).
The substation automation system shall support the use of a different communication
data exchange rate (bits per second), scanning cycle, and/or communication protocol
to each remote control centre. Also, each control centre’s data scan and control
commands may be different for different data points within the substation
automation system's database.
2.4.5.2 Remote Control Centre Communication Interface
The contractor shall provide redundant station HMI in hot standby mode. The servers
used in these work stations shall be of industrial grade.
It shall be capable to perform all functions for entire substation including future
requirements as indicated in the SLD. It shall use industrial grade components.
Processor and RAM shall be selected in such a manner that during normal operation
not more than 30% capacity of processing and memory are used. Supplier shall
demonstrate these features.
The capacity of hard disk shall be selected such that the following requirement
should occupy less than 50% of disk space:
1. Storage of all analogue data (at 15 Minutes interval)and digital data including
alarm , event and trend data for thirty(30) days,
2. Storage of all necessary software,
3. 20GB space for OWNER'S use.
Supplier shall demonstrate that the capacity of hard disk is sufficient to meet the
above requirement.
2.5.2 HMI (Human Machine Interface)
The VDU shall show overview diagrams (Single Line Diagrams) and complete
details of the switchgear with a colour display. All event and alarm annunciation
shall be selectable in the form of lists. Operation shall be by a user friendly function
keyboard and a cursor positioning device. The user interface shall be based on
WINDOWS concepts with graphics & facility for panning, scrolling, zooming,
decluttering etc.
The display units shall have high resolution and reflection protected picture screen.
High stability of the picture geometry shall be ensured. The screen shall be at least
21" diagonally in size and capable of colour graphic displays.
All reports and graphics prints shall be printed on laser printer. One dot matrix
printer shall be exclusively used for hourly log printing.
The mass storage unit shall be built-in to the Station HMI. All operational measured
values, and indications shall be stored in a mass-storage unit in form of DVD RW
The unit should support at least Read (48X), Write(24X), and Re-Write (10X)
operations, with Multi-Session capability. It should support ISO9660, Rockridge and
Joliet Filesystems. It should support formatting and use under the operating system
provided for Station HMI. The monthly back up of data shall be taken on disc. The
facility of back up of data shall be inherent in the software.
2.5.6 Switched Ethernet Communication Infrastructure:
The bidder shall provide the redundant switched optical Ethernet communication
infrastructure for SAS. One switch shall be provided to connect all IEDs for two
bays of 220kV yard to communication infrastructure. Each switch shall have at least
two spare ports for connecting bay level IEDs and one spare port for connecting
station bus.
The bay unit shall use industrial grade components. The bay level unit, based on
microprocessor technology, shall use numerical techniques for the calculation and
evaluation of externally input analogue signals. They shall incorporate select-before-
operate control principles as safety measures for operation via the HMI. They shall
perform all bay related functions, such as control commands, bay interlocking, data
acquisition, data storage, event recording and shall provide inputs for status
indication and outputs for commands. They shall be directly connected to the
switchgear. The bay unit shall acquire and process all data for the bay (Equipment
status, fault indications, measured values, alarms etc.) and transmit these to the other
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 23 - Substation Automation System and SCADA Integration Page 23-17
devices in sub-station automation system. In addition, this shall receive the operation
commands from station HMI and control centre. The bay unit shall have the capa-
bility to store all the data for at least 24 hours.
One number Bay level unit shall be provided for supervision and control of each 132
kV bay (a bay comprises of one circuit breaker and associated disconnector, earth
switches and instrument transformer). The Bay level unit shall be equipped with
analogue and binary inputs/outputs for handling the control, status monitoring and
analogue measurement functions. All bay level interlocks are to be incorporated in
the Bay level unit so as to permit control from the Bay level unit/ local bay mimic
panel, with all bay interlocks in place, during maintenance and commissioning or in
case of contingencies when the Station HMI is out of service.
The bay control unit to be provided for the bays shall be preferably installed in the
CB relay panel/feeder protection panel for respective bay.
The bay control unit for future bay (if required as per Chapter 1 – Project
Specification Requirement) shall be installed in a separate panel.
The Bay level unit shall meet the requirements for withstanding electromagnetic
interference according to relevant parts of IEC 61850. Failure of any single
component within the equipment shall neither cause unwanted operation nor lead to
a complete system breakdown.
The I/O modules shall form a part of the bay level unit and shall provide coupling to
the substation equipment. The I/O modules shall acquire all switchgear information
(i.e. data coming directly from the switchgear or from switchgear interlocking
devices) and transmit commands for operation of the switchgear. The measured
values of voltage and current shall be from the secondaries of instrument
transformers. The digital inputs shall be acquired by exception with 1 ms resolution.
Contact bouncing in digital inputs shall not be assumed as change of state
variable, alarm list, event list, modify interlocking logics etc. for additional
bays/equipment which shall be added in future.
The software package shall be structured according to the SAS architecture and
strictly divided in various levels. Necessary firewall shall be provided at suitable
points in software to protect the system. An extension of the station shall be possible
with lowest possible efforts. Maintenance, modification or an extension of
components of any feeder may not force a shut-down of the parts of the system
which are not affected by the system adaptation.
The contractor shall provide a network management system software for following
management functions:
a. Configuration Management
b. Fault Management
c. Performance Monitoring
This system shall be used for management of communication devices and other IEDs
in the system. This NMS can be loaded in DR work-station and shall be easy to use,
user friendly and menu based. The NMS shall monitor all the devices in the SAS and
report if there is any fault in the monitored devices. The NMS shall
(a) Maintain performance, resource usage, and error statistics for all managed
links and devices and present this information via displays, periodic
reports and on demand reports.
(b) Maintain a graphical display of SAS connectivity and device status.
(c) Issue alarms when error conditions occurs
(d) Provide facility to add and delete addresses and links
2.6.5 The contractor shall provide each software in two copies in CD to load into the system
in case of any problem related with Hardware/Communication etc.
3 TESTS
The substation automation system offered by the bidder shall be subjected to
following tests to establish compliance with IEC 61850 for EHV sub-station
equipment installed in sheltered area in the outdoor switchyard and specified ambient
conditions:
a. Power Input:
i. Auxiliary Voltage
ii. Current Circuits
iii. Voltage Circuits
iv. Indications
b. Accuracy Tests:
i. Operational Measured Values
ii. Currents
iii. Voltages
iv. Time resolution
c. Insulation Tests:
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 23 - Substation Automation System and SCADA Integration Page 23-20
i. Dielectric Tests
ii. Impulse Voltage withstand Test
d. Influencing Quantities
i. Limits of operation
ii. Permissible ripples
iii. Interruption of input voltage
e. Electromagnetic Compatibility Test:
i. 1 MHZ. burst disturbance test
ii. Electrostatic Discharge Test
iii. Radiated Electromagnetic Field Disturbance Test
iv. Electrical Fast transient Disturbance Test
v. Conducted Disturbances Tests induced by Radio Frequency Field
vi. Magnetic Field Test
vii. Emission (Radio interference level) Test.
viii. Conducted Interference Test
f. Function Tests:
i. Indication
ii. Commands
iii. Measured value Acquisition
iv. Display Indications
g. Environmental tests:
i. Cold Temperature
ii. Dry Heat
iii. Wet heat
iv. Humidity (Damp heat Cycle)
v. Vibration
vi. Bump
vii. Shock
The supplier shall submit a test specification for factory acceptance test (FAT) and
commissioning tests of the station automation system for approval. For the
individual bay level IED’s applicable type test certificates shall be submitted.
The manufacturing and configuration phase of the SAS shall be concluded by the
factory acceptance test (FAT). The purpose is to ensure that the Contractor has
interpreted the specified requirements correctly and that the FAT includes checking
to the degree required by the user. The general philosophy shall be to deliver a
system to site only after it has been thoroughly tested and its specified performance
has been verified, as far as site conditions can be simulated in a test lab. During FAT
the entire Sub-station Automation System including complete control and protection
system to be supplied under present scope shall be tested for complete functionality
and configuration in factory itself. The extensive testing shall be carried out during
If the complete system consists of parts from various suppliers or some parts are
already installed on site, the FAT shall be limited to sub-system tests. In such a case,
the complete system test shall be performed on site together with the site acceptance
test (SAT).
The hardware integration test shall be performed on the specified systems to be used
for Factory tests when the hardware has been installed in the factory. The operation of
each item shall be verified as an integral part of system. Applicable hardware
diagnostics shall be used to verify that each hardware component is completely
operational and assembled into a configuration capable of supporting software
integration and factory testing of the system. The equipment expansion capability
shall also be verified during the hardware integration tests. The vendor specifically
demonstrates how to add a device in future in SAS during FAT. The device shall be
from a different manufacturer than the SAS supplier.
Integrated system tests shall verify the stability of the hardware and the software.
During the tests all functions shall run concurrently and all equipment shall operate a
continuous 100 Hours period. The integrated system test shall ensure the SAS is free
of improper interactions between software and hardware while the system is
operating as a whole.
The site acceptance tests (SAT) shall completely verify all the features of SAS
hardware and software. The bidder shall submit the detailed SAT procedure and SAT
procedure shall be read in conjunction with the specification.
Operation of the system by the operator from the remote RCC or at the substation
shall take place via industry standard HMI (Human Machine interface) subsystem
consisting of graphic colour VDU, a standard keyboard and a cursor positioning
device (mouse).
The coloured screen shall be divided into 3 fields:
i) Message field with display of present time and date
ii) Display field for single line diagrams
iii) Navigation bar with alarm/condition indication
For display of alarm annunciation, lists of events etc a separate HMI View node shall
be provided.
All operations shall be performed with mouse and/or a minimum number of function
keys and cursor keys. The function keys shall have different meanings depending on
the operation. The operator shall see the relevant meanings as function tests
displayed in the command field (i.e. operator prompting). For control actions, the
switchgear (i.e. circuit breaker etc.) requested shall be selectable on the display by
means of the cursor keys. The switching element selected shall then appear on the
background that shall be flashing in a different color. The operator prompting shall
distinguish between:-
- Prompting of indications e.g. fault indications in the switchgear, and
- prompting of operational sequences e.g. execution of switching operations
The summary information displayed in the message field shall give a rapid display of
alarm/message of the system in which a fault has occurred and alarm annunciation
lists in which the fault is described more fully.
Each operational sequence shall be divided into single operation steps which are
initiated by means of the function keys/WINDOW command by mouse. Operator
prompting shall be designed in such a manner that only the permissible keys are
available in the command field related to the specific operation step. Only those
switching elements shall be accessed for which control actions are possible. If the
operation step is rejected by the system, the operator prompting shall be supported
by additional comments in the message field. The operation status shall be reset to
the corresponding preceding step in the operation sequence by pressing one of the
function keys. All operations shall be verified. Incorrect operations shall be indicated
by comments in the message field and must not be executed.
The offer shall include a comprehensive description of the system. The above
operation shall also be possible via WINDOWS based system by mouse.
source and should be used to drive 1No. each server/HMI/Gateway so that in case
any failure of DC power supply system is not affected.
3.4 DOCUMENTATION
The following documents shall be submitted for employer’s approval during detailed
engineering:
The following documentation to be provided for the system in the course of the
project shall be consistent, CAD supported, and of similar look/feel. All CAD
drawings to be provide in “dxf” format.
List of Drawings
Substation automation system architecture
Block Diagram
Guaranteed technical parameters, Functional Design Specification and
Guaranteed availability and reliability
Calculation for power supply dimensioning
I/O Signal lists
Schematic diagrams
List of Apparatus
List of Labels
Logic Diagram (hardware & software )
Control Room Lay-out
Test Specification for Factory Acceptance Test (FAT)
Product Manuals
Assembly Drawing
Operator’s Manual
Complete documentation of implemented protocols between various elements
Listing of software and loadable in CD ROM
Other documents as may be required during detailed engineering
Two sets of hard copy and Four sets of CD ROM containing all the as built
documents/drawings shall be provided.
a) SCADA data entry: this includes data entry of different components of the
substations, lines and other relevant components.
b) Creating Graphics: this includes creating graphics for substations, lines and other
relevant components, network map creation and integration with existing system, etc.
c) Data entry for Telecontrols Interface (TCI);
d) Testing and commissioning of the newly integrated SCADA system for its full
functioning; and
f) Network Application data entry required for network analysis.
For these purposes, the Contractor shall carry out necessary studies / investigations
of the existing system carefully, in full coordination with the Load Dispatch Centre,
and design / propose, install and integrate a suitable scheme/system to fulfill the
specified scope of works for teleprotection, SCADA, voice communication etc., as
required by NEA (Load Dispatch Centre).
The Supervisory Control and Data Acquisition (SCADA) System at the LDC
shall scan the new RTU/SASs utilizing the communication network.
The Contractor shall be responsible for the complete design, installation, wiring,
testing, commissioning and documentation of the RTU/SASs, including any required
new or parallel connections to NEA’s field equipment as described in this
Specification, including synchronization with the existing SCADA equipment.
New RTU/SASs at each substation shall be installed and interfacing of the following
supervisory controls shall be executed and data to be acquired shall be provided for:
Remote control
remote control of all 132 kV circuit breakers
remote control of all 33 kV, 11kv circuit breakers (off-control only for load
curtailment)
Status indications
status indication of all 132 kV circuit breakers
status indication of all 132 kV bus bar and line isolators
status indication of all 33 kV line feeders
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 23 - Substation Automation System and SCADA Integration Page 23-25
Alarms
all 132 kV kV main protection trip indications (MPT)
all 132 kV kV backup protection trip indications (BPT)
one grouped alarm summarizing all causes that prevent operation of a circuit breaker
(Circuit Breaker Fault Alarm, CBF)
one grouped alarm summarizing all faults not affecting operation of a circuit breaker
(Bay Fault Alarm, BFA)
single indication for operation of auto re-closure relay for 132 kV transmission lines
(ARO)
transformer alarms:
"temperature alarm" (oil and winding temperature as grouped alarm)
"temperature trip" (oil and winding temperature as grouped alarm)
"Buchholz alarm" (tank and OLTC as grouped alarm)
"Buchholz trip" (tank and OLTC as grouped alarm)
"general alarm" (all other alarms except the above as one grouped alarm)
"general trip" (all other alarms except the above as one grouped alarm)
for all 132 kV and 33 kV, 11kV bus bars a voltage status alarm (BVS)
general station alarms and warnings
Station Urgent Fault (SUF)
Station None-urgent Fault (SNF)
RTU alarm (RTU)
Communication Equipment Alarm (COM)
Station Control Disabled (SCD), etc.
A table summarizing the alarms to be acquired by LDC from each type of bay in the
132/33/11 kV network is shown in Table 10.1.
Measurements
Bus bar voltages (separate for each bus bar and section) of all 132 kV bus bars.
active / reactive power for
All 132 kV line feeders.
all 132 kV transformer feeders
all 132/33 kV transformers feeding into the distribution networks
(at secondary side)
Single phase current measurements for all 33, 11 kV lines participating in the load
shedding scheme.
In analogue measurands, the information to the RTU is given in the form of an analogue
current supplied by the output of an analog measuring transducer.
The analog signals shall be converted to digital mode by an analog-to-digital converter,
to which the inputs are connected. All inputs of a module shall be measured within one
cycle, regardless of the number of inputs in use. Thus new points can be added to the
RTU without reprogramming.
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 23 - Substation Automation System and SCADA Integration Page 23-27
Analog measurements shall be transmitted to the master station with 16 bits or 16 bits +
sign bit.
The Contractor shall design and arrange a training programme at the manufacturer's
premises for the SAS for two concerned NEA personnel so as to make them competent
enough to operate and maintain the proposed equipment/system. The overview of such
programme shall be proposed by the prospective Contractor along with its technical
proposal. The cost of this training shall be included in the overall bid price.
Annexure-I
List of Analogue and Digital Inputs
Basic Monitoring requirements are:
- Switchgear status indication
- Measurements (U, I, P, Q, f)
- Event
- Alarm
- Winding temperature of transformers & reactors
- ambient temperature
- Status and display of 400V LT system, 110V & 48V DC system
- Status of display of Fire protection system and Air conditioning system.
- Acquisition of all counters in PLCC panels through potential free contacts
from PLCC or independently by counting the receive/send commands.
- Acquisition of alarm and fault record from protection relays
- Disturbance records
- Monitoring the state of batteries by displaying DC voltage, charging current
and load current etc.
- Tap-position of Transformer
List of Inputs
The list of input for typical bays is as below:-
Analogue inputs
i) For line
Current R phase
Y phase
B phase
Voltage R-Y phase
Y-B phase
B-R phase
ii) For transformer/reactor
Current R phase
Y phase
B phase
WTI (for transformer and reactor)
Tap position (for transformer only)
Current R phase
Y phase
B phase
iv) Common
a) Voltage for Bus-I, Bus-II and Transfer bus wherever applicable
Voltage R-Y phase
Y-B phase
B-R phase
b) Frequency for Bus-I and Bus-II
c) Ambient temperature (switchyard)
d) Control Room Temperature.
e) LT system
i) Voltage R-Y, Y-B, B-R of Main Switch Board section-I
ii) Voltage R-Y, Y-B, B-R of Main Switch Board section-II
iii) Voltage R-Y, Y-B, B-R of Diesel Generator
iv) Current from LT transformer-I
v) Current from LT transformer-II
vi) Voltage of 110V DCDB-I
vii) Voltage of 110V DCDB-II
viii) Current from 110V Battery set-I
ix) Current from 110V Battery set-II
x) Current from 110V Battery charger-I
xi) Current from 110V Battery charger-I
xii) Voltage of 48V DCDB-I
xiii) Voltage of 48V DCDB-II
xiv) Current from 48V Battery set-I
xv) Current from 48V Battery set-II
xvi) Current from 48V Battery charger-I
xvii) Current from 48V Battery charger-I
Digital Inputs
The list of input for various bays/SYSTEM is as follows:
1. Line bays
i) Status of each pole of CB.
ii) Status of Isolator, Earth switch
iii) CB trouble
iv) CB operation/closing lockout
v) Pole discrepancy optd
vi) Trip coil faulty
vii) LBB optd
viii) Bus bar protn trip relay optd
ix) Main bkr auto recloser operated
x) Tie/transfer auto recloser operated
xi) A/r lockout
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 23 - Substation Automation System and SCADA Integration Page 23-30
3. Transformer bays
i) Status of each pole of CB, Isolator, Earth switch
ii) CB trouble
iii) CB operation/closing lockout
iv) Pole discrepancy optd
v) Trip coil faulty
vi) LBB optd
vii) Bus bar protn trip relay optd
viii) REF OPTD
ix) DIF OPTD
x) HV BUS CVT ½ FUSE FAIL
xi) OTI ALARM/TRIP
xii) PRD OPTD
xiii) BUCHOLZ TRIP
xiv) BUCHOLZ ALARM
xv) OIL LOW ALARM
xvi) Back-up impedance relay
xvii) 110V DC-I/II source fail
xviii) GR-A PROTN OPTD
xix) GR-B PROTN OPTD
4. Line/Bus Capacitor/Reactor bays (as applicable):
i) Status of each pole of CB, Isolator, Earth switch
ii) CB trouble
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 23 - Substation Automation System and SCADA Integration Page 23-32
The exact number and description of digital inputs shall be as per detailed
engineering requirement Apart from the above mentioned digital inputs, minimum of
200 inputs shall be kept for future use.
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 23 - Substation Automation System and SCADA Integration Page 23-33
Note:
1. The redundant managed bus shall be realized by high speed optical bus using
industrial grade components and shall be as per IEC 61850.
2. Inside the sub-station, all connections shall be realized as per IEC 61850 protocol.
3. For gateway, it shall communicate with Remote Supervisory Control Centre
(RSCC) on IEC 60870-5-101 protocol.
4. The printer as required shall be connected to station bus directly and can be
managed either from station HMI, HMI view node or disturbance recorder work
station.
5. The above layout is typical. However if any contractor offers slightly modified
architecture based on their standard practice without compromising the working,
the same shall be subject to approval during detailed engineering.
Annexure-II
List of IO Points to be transmitted to LDC
CHAPTER - 24
FIBRE OPTIC BASED COMMUNICATION EQUIPMENTS
This document describes the technical specifications for Communication Equipment which includes
Fibre Optic Terminal Equipment and Multiplexer Equipments for Establishment of Fibre Optic
Communication System under the contract. This specification describes the functional and
performance requirements of the system.
The broad scope of the procurement of this part include the survey, planning, design, engineering,
supply, transportation, insurance, delivery at site, unloading, handling, storage, installation,
termination, testing, training, and demonstration for acceptance, commissioning and documentation
for:
(i) SDH Equipment (STM-4 MADM upto 3 MSP Protected directions) along with
suitable optical line interfaces & tributary cards.
(ii) Local Craft Terminal (Laptop) with full operational programming software and
data cables.
(iii) All cabling, wiring, Digital Distribution Frame patch facilities, equipment MDF's
and interconnections to the supplied equipment at the defined interfaces.
(iv) MDF & DDF cross connects required to route and activate circuits.
(v) System integration of the supplied subsystems and also integration with existing
communication equipment such as SDH, MUX etc.
(vi) System integration of the supplied equipments (termination equipment system)
with existing equipments for seamless transmission of communication channel
(vii) Integration of supplied system with the User equipments such as RTU/SASs,
SCADA system, PLCC equipment etc.
(viii) Maintenance of the supplied system
All other associated works/items described in the technical specifications for a viable and fully
functional communication network.
1.2 General Requirements
The Contractor is encouraged to offer standard products and designs. However, the Contractor must
conform to the requirements and provide any special equipment necessary to meet the requirements
stated herein.
It should be noted that preliminary design information and bill of quantity (BoQ) specified in this
specifications are indicative only. The Contractor shall verify the design data during the site surveys
& detail engineering and finalise the BoQ as required for ultimate design & system performance.
The Bidder's proposal shall address all functional and performance requirements within this
specification and shall include sufficient information and supporting documentation in order to
determine compliance with this specification without further necessity for inquiries.
An analysis of the functional and performance requirements of this specification and/or site surveys,
design, and engineering may lead the Contractor to conclude that additional items are required that
are not specifically mentioned in this specification. The Contractor shall be responsible for
providing at no added cost to the Employer, all such additional items and services such that a viable
and fully functional communication equipment system is implemented that meets or exceeds the
capacity, and performance requirements specified. Such materials and services shall be considered
to be within the scope of the contract. To the extent possible, the Bidders shall identify and include
all such additional items and services in their proposal.
All equipment provided shall be designed to interface with existing equipment and shall be capable
of supporting all present requirements and spare capacity requirement identified in this
specification.
The communication equipment shall be designed and provisioned for expansions and
reconfigurations without impairing normal operation, including adding and removing circuits. The
offered items shall be designed to operate in varying environments. Adequate measures shall be
taken to provide protection against rodents, contaminants, pollutants, water & moisture, lightning &
short circuit, vibration and electro-magnetic interference etc.
The Bidders are advised to visit sites (at their own expense), prior to the submission of a proposal,
and make surveys and assessments as deemed necessary for proposal submission. The successful
bidder (Contractor) is required to visit all sites. The site visits after contract award shall include all
necessary surveys to allow the contractor to perform the design and implementation functions. The
Contractor shall inform their site survey schedule to the Employer well in advance. The site survey
schedule shall be finalised in consultation with the Employer. The Employer may be associated with
the Contractor during their site survey activities.
After the site survey, the Contractor shall submit to the Employer a survey report on each link and
site. This report shall include at least the following items:
(b) Proposed routing of power, earthing, signal cables and patch cords etc.
(c) Confirmation of adequacy of Space and AC/DC Power supply requirements
(d) Proposals for new rooms/buildings if required
(e) Identification of facility modifications if required
(f) Identify all additional items required for integration for each site/location.
The Contractor shall be responsible for synchronization of new communication equipment with
existing network utilizing the existing clock (if available). The Contractor shall make an assessment
of additional clock requirement for synchronization of the communication equipment.
The Contractor shall be responsible for all cables and wiring associated with the equipment
provided, both inside and outside buildings in accordance with technical specifications. The
Contractor shall also be responsible for determining the adequacy of the local power source for the
equipment and for wiring to it, with adequate circuit protective breakers. In addition, the Contractor
shall be responsible for shielding equipment and cabling to eliminate potential interference to or
from the equipment, and for earthing all cabinets and shields.
Contractor's obligations include, but are not limited to, the following:
(1) Site visits, and surveys, necessary to identify and provide all equipment needed to
implementation the network.
(2) Equipment Engineering and design specific to each location including review of, and
conformance with local environmental and earthing considerations.
(4) All cabling, wiring including supply, laying and termination etc of the cables, and
distribution frame at wideband nodes required for full interconnectivity and proper
operation of the telecommunications network including equipment supplied under this
package and the connectivity and interfacing of user equipment.
(5) Installation and integration of network management software, hardware and firmware
(as applicable).
(7) Engineering and technical assistance during the contract and warranty period.
(8) Implement all minor civil works and identify any major civil works i.e. expansion or
construction of rooms, trenches necessary for installation of proposed equipment and
provide the details of such work to the Employer.
(9) Factory and site testing of all hardware, software, and firmware provided.
(10) Provide documented evidence of satisfactory Type Test performance to the Employer
and if required by The Employer, conduct type test.
(11) Provide a Quality Assurance Plan, ensuring the Employer access to the manufacturing
process.
(12) Training of the Employer personnel.
(13) Hardware, software, and firmware maintenance, debugging, and support of the
equipment through final acceptance, and maintenance on all new equipment through
out the warranty period and for a period of six (6) years after warranty period.
(14) Availability of service, spare and expansion parts for the supplied items for the
designed life of the equipment or seven (7) years after the declaration of withdrawal of
equipment from production, whichever is earlier. However, the termination of
production shall not occur prior to Operational Acceptance of the system by the
Employer.
Detailed descriptions of the Contractor's obligations, in relation to individual items and services
offered, are delineated in other sections of this specification.
The Employer will provide the following items and services as part of this Project:
The following standards and codes shall be generally applicable to the equipment and works
supplied under this Contract:
Specifications and codes shall be the latest version, inclusive of revisions, which are in force at the
date of the contract award. Where new specifications, codes, and revisions are issued during the
period of the contract, the Contractor shall attempt to comply with such, provided that no additional
expenses are charged to the Employer without Employer's written consent.
In the event the Contractor offers to supply material and/or equipment in compliance to any
standard other than Standards listed herein, the Contractor shall include with their proposal, full
salient characteristics of the new standard for comparison.
In case values indicated for certain parameters in the specifications are more stringent than those
specified by the standards, the specification shall override the standards.
This section describes the Fibre Optic Communication network configuration and the
equipment characteristics for communication system to be installed under the project. The
sub-systems addressed within this section are:
The requirements described herein are applicable to and in support of network requirements.
The equipment supplied shall support existing network for Power system operational
requirements.
The security related requirements of the equipment shall be as per relevant agency and shall
be followed/complied by the vendor.
The manufacturer shall allow the Employer and/or its designated agencies to inspect the
hardware, software, design, development, manufacturing, facility and supply chain and
subject all software to a security/threat check any time during the supplies of equipment.
The contractor shall ensure that the supplied equipments have been got tested as per relevant
contemporary International Security Standards e.g. IT and IT related elements against
ISO/IEC 15408 standards, for Information Security Management System against ISO 27000
series Standards, Telecom and Telecom related elements against 3GPP security standards,
3GPP2 security standards etc. from any international agency/ labs of the standards e.g.
Common Criteria Labs in case of ISO/IEC 15408 standards until 31st March 2013. From 1st
April, 2013, the certification shall be got done from authorized and certified agency.
The Contractor shall also ensure that the equipment supplied has all the contemporary
security related features and features related to communication security as prescribed under
relevant security standards. A list of features, equipments, software etc. supplied and
implemented in the project shall be given for use by the Employer
In case of any deliberate attempt for a security breach at the time of procurement or at a later
stage after deployment/installation of the equipment or during maintenance, liability and
criminal proceedings can be initiated against the Contractor as per guidelines of Government
department.
2.2.1 Description
The fibre optic network shall be based on the Synchronous Digital Hierarchy (SDH) having
bit rate of STM-4 as indentified in the BOQ. The network shall consist of overhead fibre
optic links with a minimum bit rate of Synchronous Transport Module-1 (STM-4). The
Contractor can propose a system based on higher bit rate systems, if required, so as to meet
the link budget requirements or any other specification requirement. The detailed BOQ is
described in appendices.
The primary function of the communication network is to provide a highly reliable voice and
data communication system for grid operation in support of the
SCADA/EMS/RTU/SASs/PMUs. The communications support requirement for
SCADA/EMS/RTU/SASs/PMUs system is for low & high speed data, express voice
circuits and administrative voice circuits as defined in appendices. A brief summary of the
communication system requirements is as follows:
(c) The connectivity envisaged between RTU/SASs and Control Centre over TCP-IP
using Ethernet interface.
Required characteristics are defined and specified herein at the system level, subsystem
level, and equipment level.
The Contractor shall synchronize the existing equipments and all the new equipments under
the contract using existing Master clock, if available. The Contractor shall provide the
additional clocks as required under the set of clock indicated in BoQ. In addition to GPS
input reference, the synchronization clock must have provision to take INPUT reference
coming from other clock. The contractor shall submit the synchronisation plan as per
standard ITU-T G.811. All sync equipments proposed under this contract should meet ITU-
T G.811 criterion. The holdover quality of slave clock, if any, shall meet ITU-T G.812
standard requirements.
The Contractor shall provide system wide synchronization fully distributed throughout the
telecom network and connected to all equipments new & existing. The Contractor shall
submit the synchronization plan for the entire network meeting the requirement of ITU-T
G.803. The synchronization plan shall clearly indicate the requirement of additional clocks
with full justification.
The system equipment requiring “clock” shall be connected to the master clock using
external clocking. For this purpose, appropriate interfaces(s) in the transmission &
termination equipment being supplied and all other associated hardware shall be provided by
the Contractor.
To facilitate performance trending, efficient diagnosis and corrective resolution, the system shall
permit in-service diagnostic testing to be executed both locally and from remote locations,
manually and/or initiated under TMN control (if provided). Such testing shall not affect the
functional operation of the system.
2.2.3.3 System Upgradeability and Expandability
Equipment supplied shall be sized (though not necessarily equipped) to support system/
subsystem expansion to full capacity as provided by specified aggregate transmission rates.
Equipment units provisioned for equipped subunits shall be terminated at appropriate
patching facilities or termination blocks. Power supplies shall be sized for maximum
equipped system capacity.
The calculated availability of each fibre optic link (E1 to E1) shall be at least 99.999%. The
calculated availability is defined as the theoretical availability determined by a statistical
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 24 – Fibre Optic based Communication Equipments Page 24-9
All hardware, firmware and software delivered as part of the communications network shall
be field proven and at the most of current revision level. All modifications and changes
necessary to meet this requirement shall be completed prior to the start of the factory tests or
under special circumstances, on written approval by Employer, prior to the completion of
SAT.
Equipment supplied shall be sized and equipped with sufficient capacity to support BoQ and
configuration requirements as identified in the appendices. Each subsystem supplied shall be
sized (to be equipped as specified) to support full subsystem expansion.
The Contractor shall provide antivirus software along with all the computer
hardware/software which shall be upgraded periodically till the maintenance services
contract in the bid. Further, to meet all the specifications requirements during
implementation and maintenance, if upgrade in the hardware/software of supplied item is
required, the same shall be done by the contractor without any additional cost to the
Employer.
All fiber optic links up to 100 kms transmission line length shall be implemented by the
Contractor without repeaters. In order to meet the link budget requirement, the Contractor
shall provide all the necessary equipments only in the end stations. The contractor may
provide the optical amplifier, wave length translator, optical cards or high capacity SDH
equipment with suitable rack/subrack to meet the maximum distance limit. All the provided
equipments shall be monitored/managed by Craft Terminal.
The link budget calculations and equipment design shall be based on the specified fibre
parameters. The optical cables shall have Dual Window Single Mode (DWSM) fibres
conforming to ITU-T Recommendations G.652D and the major parameters of these optical
fibre(s) are defined in Table below.
Optical Fibre Characteristics
The fiber optic route lengths are as specified in appendices. The lengths specified in
Appendices are the transmission line route lengths; however the actual fiber cable length
shall exceed the route lengths on account of extra cable requirement due to sag, jointing &
splicing, approach cabling etc. For bidding purposes the Contractor may assume an
additional cable length of 5% of given route length + 1Km towards approach cable for
calculating the link length. The exact cable lengths shall be determined by the Contractor
during the survey. The same shall be used by the Contractor for final link design during the
detailed engineering of the project.
The Fibre Optic Transmission System (FOTS) is defined herein to include ETSI digital
optical line termination equipment. The FOTS shall be based on SDH technology. Minimum
aggregate bit rate shall be STM-4 equipped with 2 nos. of minimum 16 port E1 interface
card, two nos. of minimum 8 ports Ethernet interface (IEEE 802.3/IEEE 802.3u) card
supporting layer 2 switching as tributaries. The Ethernet interfaces shall support VLAN
(IEEE 802.1P/Q), spanning tree (IEEE 802.1D) quality of service. Protection scheme for
Ethernet traffic should be ERPS based (Ethernet ring protection scheme) as per ITU-T
G.8032.
The Contractor shall provide (supply and install) connectorised jumpers (patch cords) for
FODP-to-equipment and equipment-to-equipment connection. Two number spare jumpers
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 24 – Fibre Optic based Communication Equipments Page 24-12
shall be provided for each equipment connection. Fiber jumpers shall be of sufficient lengths
as to provide at least 0.5m of service loop when connected for their intended purpose.
It is the responsibility of contractor for Integration of SDH Equipment (Loharpatti SS) with
the existing SDH communication Network at Dhalkebar upto LDC. The details of existing
SDH equipments at Dhalkebar substation will be provided during detail engineering.
There is a requirement for different types of equipment under this project which are described
in this section. The Drawing is provided in the appendices. For the purpose of BOQ, the SDH
Equipment is considered to be divided in three parts i.e. Optical interface/SFP, Tributary
Cards (Electrical tributaries such as E1 & Ethernet 10/100/1000 Mbps) and Base Equipment
(Consisting of Common Cards, Control Cards, Optical base card, Power supply cards, sub-
rack, cabinet, other hardware and accessories required for installation of equipment i.e.
everything besides optical interface/SFP and tributary cards).
If bidder is offering equipment with multifunction cards such as cross-connect or control card
with optical interface/SFP or tributary interface, such type of multifunction card shall be
considered as Common control card and shall be the part of base equipment. In case optical
interface/SFP is embedded with control card, the adequate number of optical interface/SFPs
shall be offered to meet the redundancy requirements of the specifications. Further, control
card shall not be equipped with more than one optical interface/SFP and optical base card
shall not be equipped with more than two optical interface/SFPs.
The equipment shall be configurable either as Terminal Multiplexer (TM) as well as ADM
with software settings only.
Two fibre rings shall be implemented wherever the network permits. On linear sections of the
network, protected links using 4 fibres shall be implemented.
Service channels shall be provided as a function of the SDH equipment and shall be equipped
with Service Channel Muldems that shall provide at a minimum: One voice channel (order
wire) with analog interface (0.3 to 3.4 kHz) and one data channel. Both omnibus and selective
calling facilities shall be provided. There shall be a facility to extend the line system order-
wire to any other system or exchange lines on 2W/4W basis.
ISM (In Service Monitoring) circuitry shall be provided as a function of the SDH equipment.
Local visual alarm indicators shall be provided on the equipment, as a rack summary alarm
panel. Alarms shall be as per ITU-T Standards G.774, G.783 and G.784. Additionally, F2/Q2
interfaces for a local craftsperson terminal interface and remote equipment monitoring is
required.
The Equipment shall support collection of at least four (4) external alarms for monitoring and
control of station associated devices by the TMN.
2.3.1.5 Synchronisation
The equipment shall provide synchronisation as per Table given above. One 2MHz
synchronisation output from each equipment shall be provided.
The fibre optic link budget calculations shall be calculated based upon the following criteria:
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 24 – Fibre Optic based Communication Equipments Page 24-15
(1) Fibre attenuation: The fibre attenuation shall be taken to be the guaranteed maximum fibre
attenuation i.e. 0.21 dB/Km @1550nm and 0.35 dB/km @1310nm.
(2) Splice loss: Minimum 0.05 dB per splice. One splice shall be considered for every 3 kms.
(3) Connector losses: Losses due to connectors shall be considered to be minimum 1.0 dB per
link.
(4) Equipment Parameters: The equipment parameters to be considered for link budget
calculations shall be the guaranteed “End of Life (EOL)” parameters. In case, the End of Life
parameters are not specified for the SDH equipment, an End of Life Margin of at least 2 dB
shall be considered and a similar margin shall be considered for optical amplifiers.
(5) Optical path Penalty: An optical path penalty of at least 1 dB shall be considered to
account for total degradations due to reflections, inter symbol interference, mode partition
noise and laser chirp.
(6) Maintenance Margin: A maintenance margin of at least 2.5 dB/100Km shall be kept
towards cabling, repair splicing, cable ageing and temperature variations etc.
(7) Other losses: Other losses, if any required specifically for system to be supplied shall also
be suitably considered.
(8) Dispersion: The fibre dispersion shall be taken to be the guaranteed maximum dispersion
i.e. 18 ps/nm.Km @1550 nm & 3.5 ps/nm.km @ 1310 nm for DWSM fibres.
(9) Bit Error Rate: The link budget calculations shall be done for a BER of 10 -10.
The bidders shall determine the total link loss based on the above parameters and shall submit the
system design (including link budget calculations) for each category of fibre optic link during
detailed engineering.
For finalising the FOTS system design & BOQ, above methodology shall be adopted taking into
account fibre attenuation, dispersion and splice loss determined during the detailed engineering.
Accordingly, additions and deletions from the contract shall be carried out based on unit rates
indicated in the contract.
The Link performance for ES, SES and BER for the fibre optic links shall correspond to National
Network as defined in ITU-T G.826.
The Contractor shall be responsible for connectivity between the FODP and the SDH equipment.
The Contractor shall provide patch cords as per FODP types. The patch-cord length between the
FODP & equipment rack shall be suitably protected from rodents, abrasion, crush or mechanical
damage.
The Termination Equipment Subsystem is defined to include the equipment that interfaces (adapts)
the subscriber (user) to the Fibre Optic Transmission System (FOTS). A Functional description of
these equipments are as follows:
The transmission network node provides subscriber interface to the transmission network and/or
switching/routing. For clarity, the basic functions accomplished at the network nodal points, are
described briefly as follows:
Digital Drop-Insert and Branching Equipment shall be used to digitally interface a small number of
channels at spur locations without requiring successive D/A and A/D conversions of the throughput
channels.
The equipment shall also have an interface for external 2048 kHz synchronisation signal according
to ITU-T Recommendation G.703.
The Contractor shall be required to provide E-1 Drop & Insert Multiplexer and E-1 Channel Bank
primary multiplexing in compliance with the electrical input-output characteristics provided in
Table below.
Drop & Insert primary multiplexing in conformance with CEPT E-1 characteristics shall be
required at locations where the subscriber requirement is minimal. The drop and insertion of up to
thirty 64 Kbps channels supporting subscriber line units (SLU) shall be required at intermediate
locations. The Drop & Insert Muxes supplied shall be performance and card compatible with the
Channel Bank Equipment provided so that all Subscriber Line Interface cards are interchangeable.
User voice and data equipment interfacing requirements are defined at the subscriber line level.
Primary multiplexing in conformance with CEPT E-1 characteristics shall be used to provide first
order multiplexing of up to thirty 64 Kbps channels supporting Subscriber Line Units (SLUs).
For the purposes of the specification, the contractor shall provide cabling, wiring, DDF patching
facilities and MDFs interfacing to the wideband telecommunications system. Equipment and
material components for MDF, DDF and cabling are also part of this procurement. It shall be the
Contractor's responsibility to provide all cable support required for full supplied equipment
interconnection with the MDF and shall be in accordance with communications industry standard
practices and the requirements mentioned in the technical specifications.
All DDFs shall be sized and equipped to support the offered configuration of the provided
equipment. Independent Transmit and Receive patch jack assemblies (line and equipment) shall
provide for separate transmit and receive single-plug patching. Transmit and receive patch jack
assemblies shall be located side-by-side such that dual-plug patch cord assemblies may be used to
route both transmit and receive for the same circuit.
The Contractor shall make provision for cross connection of subscriber services to the subscribers
utilizing Krone type or equivalent and shall provide full connectivity up to and terminated on the
equipment side of the appropriate DDFs and line side of MDFs. The Contractor shall terminate on
the equipment side of patching facilities provided by other contracts and shall provide DSX type
patching facilities supporting aggregate bit streams (i.e. dataplexers and E-1 Channel Banks).
Separate Patch panels or MDFs shall be provided for Data and Voice. All cross connects shall be
accomplished utilizing one, two or three pair patch cords. Patch plugs are permissible for direct one-
to-one circuit "cut-thru".
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 24 – Fibre Optic based Communication Equipments Page 24-19
The Contractor has to supply Patch cords as described in BOQ. The Patch cord return loss shall be
equal to or better than 40 dB and insertion loss equal to or less than 0.5 dB.
The Contractor shall provide a Telecommunications Management Network System (TMN) for
operational support to the FOTS and associated Termination equipment subsystems. This TMN
shall provide the capability to monitor, reconfigure, and control elements of the telecommunications
network from a centralized location and at each node of the network where equipment is located.
This TMN system shall assist Employer/Owner in the operations and maintenance of the wideband
communication resources of the including detection of degraded circuits, system performance, the
diagnosis of problems, the implementation of remedial actions and the allocation or reallocation of
telecommunications resources and addition/deletion of network elements.
The contractor shall supply preferably a single TMN for all the NEs (Network Elements) such as
SDH equipment, Mux, Drop-Insert, DACS etc. In case a single TMN can not be provided for all the
NEs, the contractor may supply separate TMNs. Each of the offered TMN shall meet the
requirements indicated in this section. The bidder shall provide details of the offered TMN in the
bid.
The TMN design concept, functional and informational architecture and physical architecture, shall
be in compliance with ITU-T Recommendation M.3010. The offered TMN system shall be capable
of integration to other supplier’s Network Management System (NMS) upwardly through North
bound interfaces. The north bound interface in the EMS shall be CORBA/TMF-814 compliant.
a. Collection of Management data from all Network Elements (NEs) supplied under this
package. The minimum monitoring and control requirements for the communication
equipment shall be as defined in this section.
b. Processing of above management data by using processor(s) located at control Centre and
additional intermediate station processor(s), wherever required.
I) TMN system at LDC (including local operator console, if applicable) shall support
management of all equipments supplied and monitoring of the entire regional network
supplied under this package. At a minimum functions of Network management layer
(NML) and Element management layer (EML) as defined in CCITT M3010. The
detailed functions are listed in TS.
II) Monitoring and control of NEs using Craft Terminals as defined in this Section .
Configuration management is concerned with management, display, and control of the network
configuration. Minimum specific requirements that shall be satisfied include the following:
a. Provide tools to establish and maintain the backbone topology and configuration
information and provide graphical maps depicting the configurations.
c. Provide tools for planning, establishing, and changing the static equipment
configuration. Provide for changes to the equipment configuration in response to
equipment failures, planned upgrades, and operator requests to take equipment offline
for testing.
Fault management is concerned with detecting, diagnosing, bypassing, directing service restoration,
and reporting on all the backbone network equipment, systems, and links. Minimum specific
requirements that shall be satisfied include the following:
a. Display equipment status in a consistent fashion regardless of the source of the data on
a graphical topological, map-type display. Status shall be displayed through the use of
colours on links and nodes as well as through text.
b. Obtain status and detect faults through periodic polling, processing of unsolicited
alarms and error events, and periodic testing for connectivity.
d. Provide the capability to diagnose and isolate failures through analysis of error and
event reports and through the use of both on-line and off-line diagnostic tests and
display of monitored data.
e. The criteria for fail over shall be configurable as automatic fail over to redundant
equipment wherever possible and through operator-initiated actions where automatic
fail over is not possible. The status of fail over shall be reported to the NMS.
f. Track network equipment failure history.
a. Provide support for an operator to initiate, collect, and terminate performance metrics
under both normal and degraded conditions. For example, BER of each link, together
with other data measured at each node, shall be available on operator request (atleast
for SDH).
b. Monitor point to point & end to end signal quality and history. Provide operator
controls to monitor performance of specified events, measures, and resources (atleast
for SDH). Specifically provide displays to permit the operator to:
8. Provide graphical displays of point to point and end to end current performance
parameter values. Provide tabular displays of current, peak, and average values
for performance parameters.
9. Generate reports on a daily, weekly, monthly, and yearly basis containing system
statistics.
The TMN shall be provided with security features to limit access to monitoring and control
capabilities to only authorized personnel. One access level of System Administrator and at least
two levels of operator access shall be provided - read (view) only, and write (configure). The
system administrator shall be able to create, define and modify operators with different access
levels, network domains and perform all kind of maintenance and up gradation of the TMN system.
With "read only" access level, network parameters should only be viewed. Access to database
maintenance, command control and test functions shall be available with "write " access level.
Means shall be provided to ensure only one authorized user has write capability for a selected
domain of the network. It shall be possible to define multiple domains for purposes of monitoring
and control.
Human error and conflict detection are also required. Such errors and access violations shall be
reported to the offending user as error messages and warnings.
Communication requirements for TMN system have not been considered in Appendices and the
Contractor shall provide these as a part of TMN system. The Contractor shall provide all required
interface cards / devices, LAN, routers/bridges, channel routing, cabling, wiring etc. and interfacing
required for full TMN data transport.
The TMN data transport shall utilize the wideband communications transmission system service
channel in the overhead whenever possible. This will provide inherent critical path protection
Should the configuration requirements dictate multiple TMN station processors, the TMN Master
Station shall require bidirectional data transport with its station processor(s). This communications
interfacing shall be via critically protected data channels. It shall be the Contractor's responsibility
to provide for and equip all necessary critically protected TMN data channel support.
In case supervisory channels are not available, the Contractor shall provide suitable interfaces in
their supplied equipment for transport of TMN data. The Contractor shall also be responsible for
providing suitable channels with appropriate interfaces to transport the TMN data.
The NMS information of existing PDH & SDH system shall be transported through the new
communication network, wherever required, up to the NMS location. The NMS information of the
new SDH & PDH system being procured under the package shall be transported through the
existing communication network using 64 kbps/2Mpbs (G.703) interfaces. Any hardware required
for above interfacing shall be provided by the Contractor.
The bidders shall describe in the proposal the TMN data transport proposed to be used by the bidder
in detail including capacity requirements and various components/equipment proposed to be used.
Each equipment (SDH equipment, Mux, Drop/Insert and DACS etc.) on the fibre optic
communication network shall include provision for connecting a portable personal computer (PC)
to be known as craft terminal to support local commissioning and maintenance activities. Through
the use of this PC and local displays/controls, the operator shall be able to:
The craft terminal shall be connected to the interface available in the communication equipment.
Portable (laptop) computers (Craft terminals), each complete with necessary system and application
software to support the functions listed above, shall be supplied to the employer as per BOQ given
in the appendices.
The server/workstation and craft terminal shall have suitable processor(s) which shall be sufficient
to meet all the functional requirement and expansion capabilities stipulated in this specification.
Only reputed make like Dell, IBM, HP, Compaq make shall be supplied.
The server shall have minimum configuration of 3GHz for CISC based or 1.6GHz for RISC based
processor, 2GB RAM, DVD-ROM drive, redundant 80 GB internal Hard Disk Drive, 101-
Enhanced style keyboards, mouse, parallel, serial, USB(2.0) ports and hot swap redundant power
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 24 – Fibre Optic based Communication Equipments Page 24-25
supply. VDUs shall be 17" TFT active matrix color LCD with a minimum resolution of 1024 X
768. Appropriate network drive card shall also be provided wherever required. However, the
internal hard disk drive for the server shall be redundant and all the data shall be mirrored. Further,
the TMN software shall support data mirroring on redundant disk drives.
The workstation shall have minimum configuration of 2.4GHz for CISC or 1.4GHz for RISC
based processor, 1GB RAM, DVD-RW drive, 160 GB Hard Disk Drive, 101-Enhanced style
keyboards, mouse, parallel, serial and USB (2.0) ports. VDUs shall be 19" TFT active matrix color
LCD with a minimum resolution of 1024 X 768. Appropriate network drive card shall also be
provided wherever required.
CPU enclosures shall be desktop type and shall include available expansion slots except for the
Craft Terminal which shall be a laptop. The craft terminal shall have minimum configuration of 2.4
GHz, 2 GB RAM, 256 MB VRAM, DVD RW drive, 160 GB Hard Disk Drive, keyboard,
mouse/trackball etc., parallel, serial/USB (2.0) ports to accommodate printers, and Internal/external
Data/Fax modem and a battery back-up of at least 60 minutes. VDUs shall be 15" TFT active
matrix color LCD with a minimum resolution of 1024 X 768.
2.10.2 Peripherals and hardware
TMN system shall be provided with laser printer. The laser printer shall have a minimum print
speed of 17 pages per minute and a minimum resolution of 1200 x 1200 dpi. The laser printer shall
have parallel and LAN ports for connecting to TMN system.
The laser printer under this specification shall be black & white and include print enhanced
buffering to prevent loss of print data in the event of a print failure.
The Contractor shall provide operator consoles sized and equipped to support the subsystem(s)
furnished and in compliance with the specification. The console shall provide hardware interfacing
for the TMN users to the software operating support systems. At a minimum, a console shall
include the hardware similar to a workstation.
The TMN system shall use 220 volts 50 Hz A.C or -48 volt D.C as available at site for its operation
as available at site.
Due to various alternative design approaches, it is neither intended nor possible to specify all
software and firmware characteristics. It is the intent herein to provide design boundaries and
guidelines that help to ensure a demonstrated, integrated program package that is maintainable and
meets both hardware systems requirements and the customer's operational requirements.
2.11.1 Operating System Software
Operating system software shall be provided to control the execution of system programs,
application programs, management devices, to allocate system resources, and manage
communications among the system processors. The contractor shall make no modifications to the
OEM's operating system, except as provided as USER installation parameters.
A utility shall be provided to convert all reports into standard PC application formats such as excel.
All firmware and software delivered under this specification shall be the latest field proven version
available at the time of contract approval. Installed demonstration for acceptance shall be required.
All firmware provided shall support its fully equipped intended functional requirements without
additional rewrite or programming.
All software shall be easily user expandable to accommodate the anticipated system growth, as
defined in this specification. Reassembly recompilation or revision upgrades of the software or
components of the software, shall not be necessary to accommodate full system expansion.
Software provided shall be compliant with national and international industry standards.
2.11.5 Database(s)
The contractor shall develop all the databases for final wideband network following the global
acronyms for all stations. Database(s) to be provided shall contain all structure definitions and data
for the integrated functional requirements of TMN system.
TMN operator Groups shall share the same virtual database. This means that they shall share the
same database and database manager, whether or not physically separate databases are maintained.
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 24 – Fibre Optic based Communication Equipments Page 24-27
3.1 Inspection
Access to the Contractor's facilities during system manufacturing and testing and to any facility
where systems/ equipment are being produced/ tested/ integrated for the fibre optic communication
network, shall be available to the Employer. At all times the Employer shall have full facilities for
unrestricted inspection of such materials or equipment. To facilitate this, the Contractor shall submit
for the Employer approval, a comprehensive Quality Assurance Plan using ISO 9000 as a general
guideline. In addition, the Quality Assurance Plan shall satisfy the following:
(a) Sufficient office facilities, equipment, and documentation necessary to complete all
inspections and to verify that the equipment is being fabricated and maintained in
accordance with the Specification shall be provided by the Contractor to the Employer.
(c) Access to inspect the Contractor's standards, procedures, and records that are applicable
to the supplied equipment shall be provided to the Employer. Documents will be
inspected to verify that the Contractor has performed the required quality assurance
activities.
(d) The inspection rights described above shall also apply to sub Contractors who are
responsible for supplying major components described in this Specification. These
items shall be inspected and tested at the sub Contractor's factory by the Employer's
representatives prior to shipping this equipment to the Contractor's facility or directly to
the Employer.
(e) The above inspection rights shall also apply to sub Contractors supplying assemblies,
subassemblies and components. However, such items will normally be inspected and
tested by the Employer's representatives at the Contractor's site before acceptance.
comprehensive and verify all the features of the equipment to be tested. Test plans and test
procedures shall be modular to allow individual test segments to be repeated upon request.
The Contractor shall submit a Test Schedule for the Employer's approval within one (1) week after
the award of contract for Type Tests and three (3) months after the award of contract for all other
tests. The test schedule shall list the tests to be carried out, and the approximate test duration. The
test periods shall also be indicated in the PERT chart or equivalent for the work.
The Contractor shall give the Employer twenty one (21) days written notice of any material being
ready for testing. Fifteen days prior to the scheduled testing, the Employer shall provide written
notice to the Contractor of any drawings, equipment, material, or workmanship which, in the
Employer’s opinion, are not compliant to the specification. The Contractor shall give due
consideration to such objections, if valid, effecting the corrections as necessary or shall prove, in
writing, that said modifications are unnecessary for contract compliance.
4.1.1 Factory and Site Test Plans
A test plan for factory and site acceptance tests shall be submitted for approval, at least four (4)
weeks before the start of testing. The test plan shall be a single overview document that defines the
overall schedule and individual responsibilities associated with conducting the tests, documenting
the test results, and successfully completing the test criteria. Test Plans shall include, at a minimum,
the information contained in Table below.
Item: Description:
1. Test schedule
Test procedures for factory and site testing shall be submitted for the Employer approval at least
four (4) weeks before each individual test. Fully approved test procedures shall be submitted to the
Employer at least four weeks prior to the commencement of testing. Testing shall not commence
without approved test procedures. At a minimum, test procedures shall include the items listed in
Table below.
All test equipment and/or instruments shall bear calibration stickers indicating valid calibration on
and beyond the testing date. The time lapsed since last calibration shall not exceed the test
equipment/ jig manufacturer recommended calibration interval or the interval recommended in the
test lab’s internal quality procedures.
The Contractor shall ensure that all testing will be performed by qualified testing personnel well
experienced in performing such tests.
Item: Description:
4.
Purpose of each test segment
Item: Description:
List of test data to be supplied by the Contractor(s) and copies of any certified
11. data to be used
12. Format of test reports.
Item: Description:
3. Test title and reference to the appropriate section of the test procedures
4. Description of any special test conditions or special actions taken (Includes test-
case data).
5. Test results for each test segment including an indication of Passed, Conditional
Pass, Incomplete or Failed.
11. Attachments (including system logs, printouts, variances, hard copies of visual
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 24 – Fibre Optic based Communication Equipments Page 24-31
Item: Description:
test result displays, etc.)
All principle test records, test certificates and performance curves shall be supplied for all tests
carried out as proof of compliance with the specifications and/or each and every specified test.
These test certificates, records and performance curves shall be supplied for all tests, whether or not
they have been witnessed by the Employer within the specified duration after the completion of test.
Information given on such test certificates and curves shall be sufficient to identify the material or
equipment to which the certificates refer, and shall also bear the Contractor's reference and heading.
Any item or component which fails to comply with the requirements of this Specification in any
respect, at any stage of manufacture, test, erection or on completion at site may be rejected by the
Employer either in whole or part as considered necessary.
Material or components with defects of such a nature that do not meet the requirements of the
Specification by adjustment or modification shall be replaced by the Contractor at his own expense.
After adjustment or modification, the Contractor shall submit the items to the Employer for further
inspection and/or tests.
(a) SDH Equipment with all types of cards (optical card, Tributary card or any other
equipment as part of repeater less links)
(b) Primary Multiplexer & Drop – Insert Multiplexer with subscriber interface card
The type tests for SDH Equipment with all types of cards, Primary Multiplexer & Drop – Insert
Mux with subscriber interface card are described below:
4.2.1.1.1 Temperature and Humidity Tests
(1) Test Duration: The equipment is started up as soon as thermal equilibrium has been
reached and operated for sixteen (16) hours. Its performance is checked during the
test.
(3) Acceptance Criteria: No degradation of performance during and after the test.
(1) Test Duration: The equipment is started up as soon as thermal equilibrium has been
reached and operated for 72 hours. Its performance is checked during the test and
after the test as soon as the thermal equilibrium is reached at the room temperature
(Post-test).
(1) Test Duration: The equipment is started up as soon as thermal equilibrium has been
reached and operated for 96 hours. Its performance is checked during the test.
(2) Degree of Severity: As per operation to specification range.
(3) Acceptance Criteria: No degradation of performance during and after the test.
(1) Test Duration: The equipment is started up as soon as thermal equilibrium has been
reached and operated for 96 hours. Its performance is checked during the test and
after the test as soon as the thermal equilibrium is reached at the room temperature
(Post-test).
(1) Test Duration: The equipment is started up as soon as thermal equilibrium has been
reached and operated for 10 days. Its performance is checked during the test.
(2) Acceptance Criteria: The equipment shall meet the specified requirement and there
shall not be any degradation in BER.
The test procedure and acceptance criteria shall be as defined in IEC 60870-2-1.
1 Voltage
Yes Yes N/A N/A Table 11 of IEC
Fluctuations
60870-2-1: 1995
- Level : 1
2 Voltage dips and
Yes Yes N/A N/A
Interruptions
Table 12 of IEC
3 1.2/50 - 8/20 μs 60870-2-1: 1995
Yes Yes Yes N/A
surges - Level : 4
5 Damped oscillatory
waves Yes Yes Yes Yes
2 RF disturbance
voltages Yes Yes N/A N/A
CISPR 22
3 RF disturbance
currents N/A N/A N/A Yes
CISPR 22
4 RF radiated fields
CISPR 22 Yes
For the vibration response investigation (clause 8.1 of 60068-2-6), the test shall be carried out over
a sweep cycle under the same conditions as for the endurance test (described later), but the vibration
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 24 – Fibre Optic based Communication Equipments Page 24-37
amplitude and the sweep rate may be decreased below these conditions so that the determination of
the response characteristics can be obtained.
The endurance test conditions are selected according to the vibration withstand requirements.
Transportation tests shall be performed with the equipment packed according to the Contractor's
specifications.
The recommended severity shall be A = 294 m/s2, D = 18 ms. Three shocks per axis per direction
shall be applied to the equipment packed according to the Contractor's specifications.
Or Bump Test
This test could be performed as an alternative to Shock test or Free Fall test. The procedure is
defined in IEC 60068-2-29.
Equipment shall not be shipped to the Employer until required factory tests are completed
satisfactorily, all variances are resolved, full test documentation has been delivered to the Employer,
and the Employer has issued Material Inspection & Clearance Certificate (MICC). Successful
completion of the factory tests and the Employer approval to ship, shall in no way constitute final
acceptance of the system or any portion thereof. These tests shall be carried out in the presence of
the Employer's authorised representatives unless waiver for witnessing by Employer’s
representatives is intimated to the contractor.
Factory acceptance tests shall not proceed without the prior delivery to and approval of all test
documentation by the Employer.
The factory acceptance test shall demonstrate the technical characteristics of the equipment in
relation to this specifications and approved drawings and documents. List of factory acceptance
tests for Fibre Optic Transmission system, Termination Equipment Sub-system and NMS are given
in specified Tables in this section. This list of factory acceptance tests shall be supplemented by the
Contractor's standard FAT testing program. The factory acceptance tests for the other items shall be
proposed by the Contractor in accordance with technical specifications and Contractor's (including
Sub-Contractor's / supplier's) standard FAT testing program. In general the FAT for other items
shall include at least: Physical verification, demonstration of technical characteristics, various
operational modes, functional interfaces, alarms and diagnostics etc.
For Test equipment & clock, FAT shall include supply of proper calibration certificates,
demonstration of satisfactory performance, evidence of correct equipment configuration and
manufacturer’s final inspection certificate/ report.
Item Description:
3. Electrical interface tests which include: output and input jitter, bit error rate, pulse
shape, cable compensation, and line rate tolerance for the channel banks/low-level
multiplexers
Item Description:
6. Test of spare card slots and test of spare parts/modules/cards as per applicable
tests
The tests shall be exhaustive and shall demonstrate that the overall performance of the contract
works satisfies every requirement specified. At a minimum Site Acceptance Testing requirement for
Telecom equipment. is outlined in following section. This testing shall be supplemented by the
Contractor's standard installation testing program, which shall be in accordance with his quality
plan(s) for Telecom equipment installation.
During the course of installation, the Employer shall have full access for inspection and verification
of the progress of the work and for checking workmanship and accuracy, as may be required. On
completion of the work prior to commissioning, all equipment shall be tested to the satisfaction of
the Employer to demonstrate that it is entirely suitable for commercial operation.
4.4.1 Phases for Site Acceptance Testing
The SAT shall be completed in following phases:
In the installation test report, the Contractor shall include a list of all hardware or components
replaced or changed between the completion of factory tests and the start of field tests and show that
documentation and spare parts have been updated.
The minimal installation testing requirements for fiber optic transmission subsystem, Termination
equipment sub-system are provided in respective Tables in this section.
10% of the total links (Chosen by the Employer, generally to cover links from all configurations
used) shall be tested for a duration of 12 Hours. Rest of the links shall be tested for 1 Hour. In case
a link does not meet the performance requirements during 1 hour, then the duration of the test shall
be increased to 12 hours.
In case any link does not meet the performance requirements during 12 hour, then the cause of
failure shall be investigated and the test shall be repeated after rectifying the defects.
This phase of testing shall be conducted by the Contractor and witnessed by the Employer. Field
adjustments shall be made to meet established standard, however if the field adjustments fail to
correct the defects the equipments may be returned to the Contractor for replacement at his own
expense. In case any adjustments are required to be made during the interval of the test then the test
shall be repeated.
Prior to commencement of integrated testing the overall system shall be configured as required to
provide all the data and voice channel required to interconnect the various User’s interfaces. The
integrated testing for a batch shall include end-to-end testing of back-bone network included in that
batch. Integrated testing for last batch shall include testing of the entire back-bone. The intent of
integrated testing is to demonstrate that the equipment is operational end to end under actual
conditions, that all variances identified during factory and field installation and communications
testing have been corrected, and that the communication equipment is compatible with other
equipment at all locations. The Integrated System Test shall include all fibre optic transmission
equipment, termination equipment, the network management subsystem and other components.
Item: Description:
2. Station power supply input and equipment power supply (DC-DC converter)
output voltage measurements
6. Rack and local alarms: No alarms shall be present and all alarms shall be
demonstrated to be functional
Item: Description:
7. Channel performance
Item: Description:
The Contractor shall design and arrange a training programme at the manufacturer's
premises for the Fibre Optic Based Communication system for two concerned NEA
personnel so as to make them competent enough to operate and maintain the proposed
equipment/system. The overview of such programme shall be proposed by the prospective
contractor along with its technical proposal. The cost of this training shall be included in the
overall bid price.
CHAPTER – 25
LT TRANSFORMER
1.1 General
This specification covers the design, manufacture, assembly, shop test, supply, delivery,
installation, field testing and commissioning of the station service transformers complete
with all accessories, fittings and auxiliary equipment for efficient and trouble-free
operation as specified herein under. The Contractor shall undertake all the works
(complete supply and installation) relating to the connection of the station service
transformer to the HV/LV control and distribution panels.
The equipment specified in this Section of the Contract shall conform to the latest edition
of the appropriate IEC specifications and/or other recognized international standards. In
particular :
1.2.1 Tank
The station transformer shall be provided with a case of rigid construction, which shall
be oil-tight and gas-tight complete with oil preservation system. The tank shall be
capable of withstanding, without leakage or permanent distortion, a pressure 25%
greater than the maximum operating pressure resulting from the system of oil
preservation used. The tank cover shall be bolted and provided with suitable hand
holes. Two grounding pads complete with clamp type terminal connector shall be
provided on the tank wall near the base.
1.2.2 Core
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 25 – LT Transformer Page 25-2
Cores shall be constructed of high quality, non-aging, high permeability cold rolled
grain oriented silicon steel. The steel shall be in thin laminations. Both sides of each
sheet shall be insulated, with durable, rigidly clamped with positive locking devices to
ensure adequate mechanical strength to support the windings and reduce vibrations to
a minimum during operation. Cut type cores shall not be accepted.
1.2.3 Winding
The design, construction and treatment of winding shall give proper consideration to all
service factors. The complete assembly of core and coils shall be dried in a vacuum
sufficient to ensure elimination of air and moisture within the insulating structure.
After the drying process, the assembly shall be immediately impregnated with dry oil.
The windings of the transformer shall be fabricated of copper materials. Aluminum
winding materials shall not be accepted.
Each transformer shall be provided with an oil conservator complete with oil filter
flange or cap at the top.
The transformer shall be designed and constructed to withstand, without injury, the
mechanical and thermal stress produced by short-circuit current limited by the impedance
of the transformer only.
The insulating oil shall be refined mineral oil. Necessary quantity of oil for the
transformer shall be furnished by the Contractor.
1.7 Bushings
The bushings shall be made of homogeneous and well vitrified porcelain. The color of
the insulator shall be brown and the surface shall have polished glaze.
The 33 kV bushings shall have bolted terminal lugs suitable for terminating ACSR DOG
conductor.
The cable terminal box on the low voltage side shall consist bolted terminal lugs suitable
for terminating 95-150 sq. mm. stranded copper conductor cables.
The low voltage neutral bushings shall include a lug for terminating a 25 sq. mm. copper
earth wire in addition to the 95-150 sq. mm. copper conductor neutral circuit.
Average winding temperature rise above maximum ambient temperature (40 Deg C)
when carrying maximum continuous rated kVA shall not exceed 55 Deg C. The
temperature rise of the insulating oil shall not exceed 50 Deg C when measured near the
top of the main tank.
1.9 Accessories
- Lifting Lug
- Name plate
- Hand Hole
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 25 – LT Transformer Page 25-4
1.10 Tests
Upon completion the transformer shall be subjected to following routine tests. As far as
practical, the procedure of IEC shall be followed:
The Bidder shall submit copy of design test report from recognized testing laboratory for the
transformer of the offered model along with the bid.
For the protection of the station service transformer, high voltage (36 kV) current limiting
power fuse with suitable cartridge holder, outdoor mounting shall be provided in a safe
height. Cost of the power fuse its holder including installation shall be included in the
price of the station service transformer.
Gang operated single throw disconneting switch shall be provided for the transformer.
This switch shall be easily operable from ground and capable of disconnecting the
transformer.
APPENDIX 17-1
Description 33/0.4 kV
Transformer
1. Rated power 150 kVA
2. Rated voltage
-Primary 33 kV
-Secondary 400 / 230 V
4. Rated frequency 50 Hz
5. Connection
-Primary Delta
-Secondary Gnd. Wye
CHAPTER - 26
12 kV INDOOR SWITCHGEAR
1 General Requirements
The manufacturer, whose 12 kV Indoor switchgear panels are offered should have
designed, manufactured, type tested as per relevant IEC, supplied and commissioned the
Panels of similar rating. These Panels should have been in satisfactory operation for at
least two years as on the date of bid opening.
In addition to the requirements above, the Vacuum circuit breaker (VCB), CT, PT and
relays should have been designed, manufactured and type tested as per relevant IEC and
should have been in satisfactory operation for at least two years as on the date of bid
opening.
The equipment offered by the Bidder shall be complete in all respects. Any material and
component not specifically stated in this specification but which are necessary for
trouble free operation of the equipment and accessories specified in this specification
shall be deemed to be included unless specifically excluded. All such
equipment/accessories shall be supplied without any extra cost. Also all similar
components shall be interchangeable and shall be of same type and rating for easy
maintenance and low spare inventory.
Specific reference in this specification and documents to any Material by trade name,
make, or catalogue number shall be constructed as establishing quality and performance
requirements.
Contractor shall move all equipment into the respective rooms through the regular door
or openings specifically provided for this purpose. No parts of structure shall be utilized
to lift or erect any equipment without prior permission of Engineer.
Switchgear shall be installed on finished surfaces, concrete or steel sills. Contractor shall
be required to install and align any channels sills, which form part of foundations. Circuit
breaker trolley wheels shall move on channels, which shall form part of floor. The
channel length shall be minimum of 1 meter from the door of switchgear panel. Power
bus enclosure, ground and control splices of conventional nature shall be cleaned and
bolted together with torque wrench of proper size or by other approved means. Tape or
compound shall be spilled where called for in drawings. Contractor shall take utmost
care in handling instruments, relays and other delicate mechanisms. Wherever the
instruments, and relays are supplied loose along with switchgear, they shall be mounted
only after the associated switchgear panels have been erected and aligned. The blocking
materials, employed for safe transit of instrument and relays shall be removed after
ensuring that panels have been completely installed and no further movement of the
same would be necessary. Any damage shall be immediately reported to Engineer.
Foundation work for all switchgear panels will be carried out by contractor.
2 Switchgear panel
2.1 The switchgear boards shall have a single front, single tier, fully compartmentalized,
metal enclosed construction complying with IEC Standard, comprising of a row of free
standing floor mounted panels. Each circuit shall have a separate vertical panel with
distinct compartments for circuit breaker truck, cable termination, Main bus bars and
auxiliary control devices. The adjacent panels shall be completely separated by steel
sheets expect in busbar compartments where insulated barriers shall be provided to
segregate adjacent panels. However, manufacturer’s standard switchgear designs without
internal barriers in busbar compartment may also be considered.
2.2 The circuit breakers and Bus VTs shall be mounted on withdrawable trucks which shall
roll out horizontally from service position to isolated position.
2.3 For complete withdrawal from the panel, the truck shall rollout on the floor or shall roll
out on telescopic rails. In case the later arrangement is offered, suitable trolley shall be
provided by the Bidder for withdrawal and insertion of the truck from and into the panel.
2.4 The number of trolleys to be provided shall be as specified in clause 3.17. Testing of the
breaker shall be possible in isolated position by keeping the control plug connected.
2.5 The trucks shall have distinct SERVICE and ISOLATED positions. It shall be possible
to close the breaker compartment door in isolated position also, so that the switchgear
retains its specified degree of protection. While switchboard designs with doors for
breaker compartment would be preferred, standard designs of reputed switchgear
manufacturer's where the truck front serves as the compartment cover may also be
considered, provided the breaker compartment is completely sealed from all other
compartments and retains the IP-42 degree of protection in the Isolated position. In case
the later arrangement is offered, the Bidder shall explain how this sealing is achieved and
shall include blanking covers one for each size of panel per switchboard in his total bid
price.
2.6 The truck in any position SERVICE, ISOLATED or removed, and all doors and covers
closed. All doors, removable covers and glass windows shall be gasketted all round with
synthetic rubber or neoprene gaskets.
2.7 The bus VT/ relay compartments shall have degree of protection not less then IP:52 in
accordance with IEC-60529. However, remaining compartments shall be dust, moisture,
rodent and vermin proof, with degree of protection of IP:42. All louvers if provided,
shall have very fine brass or GI mesh screen. IPH-2 degree of protection as per IEC
standard to all live parts shall (whether isolated or removed from panel) even when the
breaker compartment door is open. Tight fitting garments/gaskets are to be provided at
all openings in relay compartment.
2.8 The switchgear construction shall be such that the operating personnel are not
endangered by breaker operation and internal explosions, and the front of the panels shall
be specially design to withstand these. Pressure relief device shall be provided in each
high voltage compartment of a panel, so that in case of a fault in a compartment, the
gases produced are safely vented out, thereby minimising the possibility of its spreading
to other compartments and panels. The pressure relief device shall not however reduce
the degree of' protection of panels under normal working conditions. The bidder shall
ensure satisfactory operation of pressure relief device in accordance with relevant IEC.
The test reports for internal arc fault test for all HT chambers shall be submitted.
2.9 Enclosure shall be constructed with rolled steel sections and cold rolled steel sheets of
atleast 2.0 mm thickness, Gland plates shall be 2.5mm thick made out of hot rolled or
cold rolled steel sheets and for non-magnetic material it shall be 3.0 mm.
2.10 The switchgear shall be cooled by natural air flow and cooling by any other method shall
not be accepted.
2.11 Total height of the switchgear panels shall not exceed 2450 mm. The height of switches,
pushbuttons and other hand operated devices shall not exceed 1800 mm and shall not be
less than 700 mm.
2.12 Necessary guide channels shall be provided in the breaker compartments for proper
alignment of plug and socket contacts when truck is being moved to SERVICE position.
A crank or level arrangement shall preferably be provided for smooth and positive
movement of, truck between Service and Isolated positions.
2.13 Safety shutters complying with IEC-298 shall be provided to cover up the fixed high
voltage contacts on busbar and cable sides when the truck is moved to ISOLATED
position. The shutters shall move automatically, through a linkage with the movement of
the truck. Preferably it shall however, be possible to open the shutters of busbar side and
cable side individually against spring pressure for testing purpose after defeating the
interlock with truck movement deliberately. It shall also be possible to padlock shutters
individually. In case, insulating shutters are provided, these shall meet the requirements
of Clause 3.102.1 Note-2 of IEC-298 and necessary tests are per IEC-298 Clause 5.103.1
shall be carried out. A clearly visible warning label "Isolate elsewhere before earthing"
shall be provided on the shutters of incoming and the connections which could be
energised from other end.
2.14 Switchgear construction shall have a bushing or other sealing arrangement between the
circuit breaker compartment and the busbar/cable compartments, so that there is no air
communication around the isolating contacts in the shutter area with the truck in service
position
2.15 The breaker and the auxiliary compartments provided on the front side shall have strong
hinged doors, busbar and cabling compartments provided on the rear side shall have
bolted compartment covers with self retaining bolts. Breaker compartment doors shall
have locking facility.
2.16 In the Service position, the truck shall be so secured that it is not displaced by short
circuit forces. Busbars, jumpers and other components of the switchgear shall also be
properly supported to withstand all possible short circuit forces corresponding to the
short circuit rating specified.
2.17 Suitable base frames made out of steel channels shall be supplied alongwith necessary
anchor bolts and other hardware for mounting of the switchgear panels. These shall be
dispatched in advance so that they may be installed and leveled when the flooring is
being done, welding of base frame to the insert plates as per approved installation
drawings. The bidder may offer panels with built in base frame ready for dispatch and
suitable for installation on indoor cable trenches.
2.18 The switchboard shall have the facility of extension on both sides. Adopter panels and
dummy panels required to meet the various bus-bar arrangement, cable/bus duct
termination and layouts shall be included in Bidder's scope of work.
3 Circuit breakers
3.1 The circuit breakers shall be of VCB type and shall comprise of three separate, identical
single pole interrupting units, operated through a common shaft by a sturdy operating
mechanism.
3.2 Circuit breakers shall be suitable for switching lines at any load.
3.3 Circuit breaker shall be restrike free, stored energy operated and trip free type. Motor
wound closing spring charging shall only be acceptable. An antipumping device shall be
provided for each breaker; even it has built-in mechanical anti-pumping features. An
arrangement of two breakers in parallel to meet a specified current rating shall not be
acceptable.
3.4 During closing, main poles shall not rebound objectionably and mechanism shall not
require adjustments. Necessary dampers shall be provided to withstand the impact at the
end of opening stroke.
3.5 Plug and socket isolating Contacts for main power circuit shall be silver plated, of self-
aligning type, of robust design and capable of withstanding the specified short circuit
currents. They shall preferably be shrouded with an insulating material. Plug and socket
contacts for auxiliary circuits shall also be silver plated, sturdy and of self -aligning type
having a high degree of reliability. Thickness of silver plating shall not be less than 10
microns.
3.6 All working part of the mechanism shall be of corrosion resisting material. Bearings
which require greasing shall be equipped with pressure type grease fittings. Bearing
pins, bolts, nuts and other parts shall be adequately secured and locked to prevent
loosening or change in adjustment due to repeated operation or change in adjustment due
to repeated operation of the breaker and the mechanism.
3.7 The operating mechanism shall be such that failure of any auxiliary spring shall not
prevent tripping and shall not lead to closing or tripping of circuit breaker. Failure of any
auxiliary spring shall also not cause damage to the circuit breaker or endanger the
operator.
3.8 Mechanical indicators shall be provided on the breaker trucks to indicate OPEN/
CLOSED conditions of the circuit breaker, and CHARGED/DISCHARGED conditions
of the closing spring. An operation counter shall also be provided. These may be visible
without opening the breaker compartment door.
3.9 The rated control supply voltage shall be as mentioned in Section-GTR. The closing coil
and spring charging motor shall operate satisfactorily at all values of control supply
voltage with specified variation mentioned in Section-GTR. The shunt trip coil shall
operate satisfactorily under all operating conditions of the circuit breaker up to its rated
short circuit breaking current at all values of control supply voltage between 70 and 110
percent of the rated voltage. The trip Coil shall be so designed that it does not get
energized when its healthiness is monitored by indicating lamps (Red) and trip coil
supervision relay.
3.10 The time taken for charging of closing spring shall not exceed 30 second. The spring
charging shall take place automatically preferably after a closing operation. Breaker
operation shall be independent of the spring charging motor, which shall only charge the
closing spring. Operating spring shall get charged automatically during closing
operation. As long as power supply is available to the charging motor a continuous
sequence of closing and opening operations shall be possible. One open-close-open
operation of the circuit breaker shall be possible after failure of power supply to the
motor.
3.11 Spring charging motors shall be capable of starting and charging the closing spring twice
in quick succession without exceeding acceptable Winding temperature when the control
supply voltage is any where between 85% and 110% of the rated voltage. The initial
temperature shall be as prevalent in the switchgear panel during full load operation with
50 deg. C ambient air temperature. The motor shall be provided with short circuit
protection.
3.12 Motor windings shall be provided with class E insulation or better. The insulation shall
be given tropical and fungicidal treatment for successful operation of the motor in a hot,
humid and tropical climate.
3.13 Circuit breaker may be provided with inter pole barriers of insulating materials, if the
same is standard design of the manufacturer. But use of inflammable materials like
Hylam shall not be acceptable.
4.1 The control switch located on the switchgear would normally be used for operation of
circuit breaker in service/isolated position, and for tripping it in an emergency.
4.2 The Bidder shall study the basic control scheme as proposed to be adopted and clearly
state in his bid the extent to which it can be complied with.
4.3 Facilities shall be provided for mechanical tripping of the breaker and for manual
charging of the stored energy mechanism for a complete duty cycle, in an emergency.
These facilities shall be accessible only after opening the compartment door.
4.4 Each panel shall have two separate limit switches, one for the Service position and the
other for isolated position. Each of these limit switches shall have at least four (4)
contacts which shall close in the respective positions
4.5 Auxiliary Contacts of breaker may be mounted in the fixed portion or in the
withdrawable truck as per the standard practice of the manufacturer, and shall be directly
operated by the breaker operating mechanism.
4.6 For Employer’s use six (6) normally open (NO) and six (6) normally closed (NC)
auxiliary contacts shall be provided for all feeder and shall be wired out to the terminal
blocks.
4.7 Contact multiplication, if necessary to meet the above contact requirement, shall be done
through suitable latch relay.
4.8 The contacts of all limit switches and all breaker/auxiliary contacts located on truck
portion and fixed portion shall be silver plated, rated to make, carry and break 1.0 Amp
220 V DC (Inductive) 10 Amps 230V AC. Contacts of control plug and socket, shall be
capable of carrying the above current continuously.
4.9 Movement of truck between SERVICE and ISOLATED positions shall be mechanically
prevented when the breaker is closed. An attempt to withdraw a closed breaker shall not
trip it.
4.10 Closing of the breaker shall be possible only when truck is either in ISOLATED or in
SERVICE position and shall not be possible when truck is in between. Further, closing
shall be possible only when the auxiliary circuits to breaker truck have been connected up,
and closing spring is fully charged.
4.11 Mechanical (Castle key) or a full proof electrical interlock shall be provided between the
isolator and associated circuit breaker such that the former cannot be operated unless the
later is open.
4.12 It shall be possible to easily insert breaker contactor of one feeder into any one of the
panel meant for same rating but at the same time shall be prevented from inserting it into
panels meant for a different type of rating.
4.13 Indicating lamps shall be provided in the panel front as brought out in Clause 2.11. It shall
be possible to easily make out whether the truck is in SERVICE or ISOLATED position
even when the compartment door is closed.
5.1 All busbar and jumper connections shall be of high conductivity aluminium/copper of
adequate size and the bus bar size calculation shall be submitted for approval. They shall
be adequately supported on insulators to withstand electrical and mechanical stresses due
to specified short circuit currents.
5.2 Busbar cross-section shall be uniform throughout the length of switchgear. Busbars and
other high voltage connection shall be sufficiently corona free at maximum working
voltage.
5.3 Contact surfaces at all joints shall be silver plated or properly cleaned and no oxide
grease applied to ensure an efficient and trouble free connection. All bolted joints shall
have necessary plain and spring washers. All connection hardware shall have high
corrosion resistance. Suitable bimetallic connectors shall be used for aluminium to
copper connections.
5.4 Busbar insulators shall be of arc and track resistant high strength, non-hygroscopic, non-
combustible type and shall be suitable to withstand stresses due to over-voltages, and
short circuit current. Busbar shall be supported on the insulators such that the conductor
expansion and contraction are allowed without straining the insulators. In case of
organic insulator partial discharge shall be limited to 100 picocoulomb at rated voltage
x1.1/3. Use of insulators and barriers of inflammable material such as Hylam shall not
be accepted.
5.5 Successful Bidder shall furnish calculation-establishing adequacy of busbar sizes for the
specified continuous and short time current ratings.
5.7 The temperature of the busbars and all other equipment, when carrying the rated current
continuously shall be limited as per the stipulations of relevant Standards, duly
considering the specified ambient temperature (50 deg. C). The temperature rise of the
horizontal and vertical busbars when carrying the rated current shall in no case exceed 55
deg. C for silver plated joints and 35 deg. C for all other type of joints. The temperature
rise at the switchgear terminals intended for external cable termination shall not exceed
35 deg. C. Further the switchgear parts handled by the operator shall not exceed a rise of
5 deg.
6.1 A galvanized steel earthing bus shall be provided at the bottom and shall extend through
out the length of each switch board. It shall be bolted/welded to the framework of each
panel and each breaker earthing contact bar.
6.2 The earth bus shall have sufficient cross section to carry the momentary short circuit and
short time fault currents to earth as indicated under switchgear parameters without
exceeding the allowable temperature rise.
6.3 Suitable arrangement shall be provided at each end of the earth bus for bolting to
earthing conductors. All joint splices to the earth bus shall be made through atleast two
bolts and taps by proper lug and bolt connection.
6.4 All non-current carrying metal work switchboard shall be effectively bonded to the earth
bus. Electrical continuity of the whole switchgear enclosure frame work and the truck
shall be maintained even after painting.
6.5 The truck and breaker frame shall get earthed while the truck is being inserted in the
panel and positive earthing of the truck and breaker contactor frame shall be maintained
in all positions i.e. SERVICE and ISOLATED as well as throughout the intermediate
travel. The truck shall also get and remain earthed when the control plug is connected
irrespective of its position.
6.6 All metallic cases of relays, instruments and other panel mounted equipment shall be
connected to earth by independent stranded copper wires of size not less than 2.5 sq.mm.
Insulation colour code of earthing wires shall be green. Earthing wires shall be
connected to terminals with suitable clamp connectors and soldering shall not be
acceptable. Looping of earth connections, which would result in loss of earth connection
to other devices, when a device is removed is not acceptable. However, looping of earth
connections between equipment to provide alternative paths of earth bus is acceptable.
6.7 VT and CT secondary neutral point earthing shall be at one plate only on the terminal
block. Such earthing shall be made through links so that earthing of one secondary
circuit may be removed without disturbing the earthing of other circuits.
6.8 Built-in /Trolley mounted earthing facilities for the busbars and outgoing incoming
connections shall be provided. However, there should be facility for alarm before
engagement of earthing contacts, in case of feeder/incomer being in energized condition.
Closing of the earthing switch if the associated circuit breaker truck is in Service
position.
Insertion of the breaker truck to Service position if earthing switch is in closed position.
Closing of the earth switch on a live connection. Three nos. voltage capacitive dividers
shall be provided on each phase of the section intended for earthing and three nos.
"RED' Neon lamps connected to these on the panel front for visual indication.
6.10 Energising and Earthed Section: Complete details of arrangement offered shall be included
in the bid describing the safety features and interlocks.
6.11 Earthing device shall have the short circuit withstand capability equal to that of associated
switchgear panel suitable number of auxiliary contacts of the earthing device shall be
provided for interlocking purpose.
6.12 All hinged doors shall be earthed through flexible earthing braid.
7 Painting
All sheet steel work shall be pretreated in tanks, in accordance with IEC standards.
Degreasing shall be done by alkaline cleaning. Rust and scale shall be removed by
pickling with acid. After pickling, the parts shall be washed in running water. Then
these shall be rinsed in slightly alkaline hot water and dried. The phosphated coating
shall be as per relevant IEC standards. The phosphated surface shall the rinsed and
passivated prior to application of stoved lead oxide primer coating. After primer
application, two coats of finishing synthetic enamel paint on panels shall be applied.
Each coat finishing shall be properly stoved. The paint thickness shall not be less than
50 microns. Finished parts shall be coated by peel able compound by spraying method to
protect, finished surfaces from scratches, grease dirts and oily spots during testing,
transportation, handling and erection. Electrostatic painting shall also be acceptable.
8 Instrument transformers
8.1 All current and voltage transformers shall be completely encapsulated cast resin
insulated type, suitable for continuous operation at the ambient temperature prevailing
inside the switchgear enclosure, when the switchboard is operating at its rated load and
the outside ambient temperature is 50 deg. C. The class of insulation shall be E or better.
8.2 All instrument transformers shall withstand the power frequency and impulse test voltage
specified for the switchgear assembly. The current transformer shall further have the
dynamic and short time rating at least equal to those specified for the associated
switchgear and shall safely withstand the thermal and mechanical stress produced by
maximum fault currents specified when mounted inside the switchgear for circuit breaker
modules.
8.3 The parameters of instrument transformer specified in this specification are tentative and
shall be finalised by the Employer in due course duly considering the actual burden of
various relays and other devices finally selected. In case the Bidder finds that the
specified ratings are not adequate for the relays and other devices offered by him he shall
offer instrument transformer of adequate ratings and shall bring out this fact clearly in
his bid.
8.4 All instrument transformers shall have clear indelible polarity markings. All secondary
terminals shall be wired to separate terminals on an accessible terminal block.
8.5 Current transformers may be multi or single core and shall be located in the cable
termination compartment. All voltage transformers shall be drawout type. The bus VTs
shall be housed in a separate panel on a truck so as to be fully withdrawable.
8.6 All voltage transformers shall have suitable HRC current limiting fuses on both primary
and secondary sides. Primary fuses shall be mounted on the withdrawable portion.
Replacement of the primary fuses shall be possible with VT truck in ISOLATED
position. The secondary fuses shall be mounted on the fixed portion and the fuses
replacement shall be possible without drawing out the VT, truck from Service position.
9.1 In addition to the requirements specified hereunder the relays, indicating instruments,
recorders, transducers, terminal blocks, Mimic diagram, Name Plates, switches,
indicating lamps, position indicators shall also meet the requirements of corresponding
clauses in Chapter Section Control and Relay Panels.
a) All relays and timers in protective circuits shall be flush mounted on panel front
with connections from the inside. They shall have transparent, dust tight cover,
removable from the front. They shall either have built-in test facilities, or shall be
provided with necessary test blocks and test switches located immediately below
each relay. The auxiliary relays and timers may be furnished in non-drawout
cases. The contact multiplying auxiliary relays if any may be located inside.
b) All relays and timers shall be rated for control supply voltage as mentioned in
Chapter – GTR with specified variation. Making, carrying and breaking current
ratings of their contacts shall be adequate for the circuits in which they are used.
Auxiliary seal in units if provided shall be of shunt reinforcing type.
c) The protective relays and timers shall have atleast two potential free output
contacts in addition to scheme requirement for owner’s use. Auxiliary relays shall
have contacts as required. Adequate number of terminals shall be available on the
relay cases for applicable relaying schemes.
d) The relay and timers used in protective circuits shall be of reputed makes and
proven types which have been in successful operation for atleast three (3) years
and shall be subject to Employer/EDUTC’s approval before procurement by the
Contractor.
11 kV Line Protection shall have three over current and one earth fault element which
shall be either independent or composite units and shall meet the following requirements
(i) have IDMT characteristic with definite minimum time of 3.0 sec at 10
times setting
(ii) have a variable setting range of 50-200% of rated current.
(i) have IDMT characteristic with definite minimum time of 3.0 sec at 10
times setting.
c) Master Trip Relay : Non directional over current and earth fault relays will be
wired to trip the master trip relay during faults Master Trip relay should conform
to the specification of Tripping Relay(86) as per section control and relay panel
and also the ratings of the output contacts shall be suitable for 11 kV circuit
breaker. This trip relay shall be electrical reset type.
10.1 Indicating instruments shall be flush mounted on panel front. The instruments shall be of
at least 96 mm square size and shall have an accuracy class of 1.5 or better. The covers
and cases of instruments and meters shall provide a dust and vermin proof construction.
Digital indication instruments are also acceptable.
10.2 Instruments and meters shall be factory calibrated to directly read the primary circuit
quantities. Means shall be provided for zero adjustment without dismantling the
instruments.
11 Switchgear Wiring
11.1 All Switchgear panels shall be supplied completely wired internally upto the terminal
block ready to receive external cabling. All inter cubicle wiring and connections
between panels of same switchboard including all bus wiring for AC and DC supplies
shall be provided by the Contractor.
11.2 All internal wiring shall be carried out with 650 V grade, single core, 1.5 sq.mm,
stranded copper wires having minimum of seven strands per conductor and colour coded,
PVC insulation. CT circuits shall be wired with 2.5 sq.mm. wires which otherwise are
similar to the above. Extra flexible wires shall be used for wiring between fixed and
moving parts such as hinged doors.
11.3 All wiring shall be properly supported neatly arranged, readily accessible and securely
connected to equipment, terminals and terminal blocks. Wiring troughs or gutters be
used for this purpose.
11.4 Internal wire terminals shall be made with solderless crimping type tinned copper lugs
which shall firmly grip the conductor. Insulation sleeves shall be provided over the
exposed parts of lugs.The lugs related to CT secondary circuit wiring shall be of hole
type.
11.5 Engraved core identification plastic ferrules marked to correspond with panel wiring
diagrams shall be fitted at both ends of each wire Number 6 and 9 shall not be used for
wire identification. Ferrules shall fit tightly on wires and shall not fall off when wire is,
disconnected from terminal. All wires directly connected to trip the circuit breaker shall
be distinguished by the addition of a red coloured unlettered ferrule.
11.6 Inter connection to adjacent panels shall be brought out to a separate set of terminal
blocks located near the slots or holes, meant for the interconnecting wires. Arrangement
shall permit neat layout and easy inter connections to adjacent panels at site and wires for
this purpose shall be provided by Contractor looped and bunched properly inside the
panels. The inter panel wires shall be cross ferruled i.e it shall have details of emanating
terminal and also where it is terminated.
11.7 Contractor shall be fully responsible for the completeness and correctness of the internal
wiring and for the proper functioning of the connected equipment.
11.8 The Contractor shall provide the necessary clamps wiring troughs etc. for all wiring in
side the switchgear enclosed including the power and control cables.
12.1 The Cable termination compartment shall receive the stranded copper conductor, XLPE
insulated, armoured, PVC jacketed, single core/three core unearthed/earthed grade power
cable(s).
12.2 A minimum clearance of about 600 mm shall be kept between the cable lug bottom ends
and gland plates for stress cone formation for XLPE cables. Interphase clearance in the
cable termination compartment shall be adequate to meet electrical and mechanical
requirement besides facilitating easy connections and disconnections of cables.
Dimensional drawing of cable connection compartment showing the location of lug,
glands, CTs, gland plates etc. and the electrical clearances available shall be submitted
for Employer approval during detailed engineering.
12.3 Cable termination compartment shall be complete with power terminals, power lugs and
associated hardware and removable undrilled gland plates. For all single core cables
gland plates shall be of nonmagnetic material.
12.4 Supply of the cable termination kit and cable terminations shall be in scope of contractor.
13.1 Each switchboard shall have a name plate for its identification. All enclosure-mounted
equipment shall be provided with individual engraved name plates for clear equipment
identification. Each unit panel shall be identified on front as well as backside by large
engraved name plates giving the distinct feeder description along with panel numbers.
Back side name plates shall be fixed in panel frame.
13.2 Name plate shall be of non-rusting metal or 3-ply lamicoid with white engraved lettering,
on black background. Inscriptions and lettering shall be subjected to Employer’s
approval.
13.3 Suitable stenciled paint mark shall be provided for identification of all equipment,
located inside the enclosure, as well as for door mounted equipment, from the backside
in addition to plastic sticker labels, if provided. These labels shall be located directly by
the side of the respective equipment, shall be clearly visible and shall not be hidden by
equipment wiring. Labels shall have device number as mentioned in wiring drawings.
Type of labels and fixing of labels shall be such that they are not likely to peel or fall off
during prolonged use.
14 11 kV Indoor Switchgear panels as per quantity and details given below shall be
offered:
15 Tests
The Bidder shall submit the type test reports of following type tests for approval of the
Employer for circuit breaker, circuit breaker panels, of each voltage class and current
rating:
1 Short circuit duty test on circuit breaker, mounted inside the panel offered.
2 Short time withstand test- on circuit breaker, mount inside panel offered.
3 Power frequency withstand test on breaker and panel.
4 Lightning impulse withstand test on breaker and panel.
6 Test to verify pressure relief devices operation of the panel. This shall be done
on one panel of each voltage class.
For all important components like instrument transformers, relays, instruments, switches,
bushings, wires, insulators, timers, annunciators, terminal blocks and fuses etc. the
contractor shall furnish satisfactory type test reports for Employer's approval. Such
reports shall cover all applicable type tests listed in relevant Standards, for all
components of type and rating being supplied.
16 Commissioning Checks/Tests
After installation of panels, power cables, Control wirings and connections, the
Contractor shall perform commissioning checks as listed below for proper operation of
switchgear/panels and correctness in all respects.
In addition the Contractor shall carry out all other checks and tests recommended by the
manufacturers.
General
12 Checks on spring charging motor, correct operation of limit switches and time of
charging.
13 All functional checks.
Current Transformers
Voltage Transformers
1 Insulation resistance
2 Ratio test on all cores.
3 Polarity test
4 Line connections as per connection diagram.
Cubicle Wiring
Relays
Meters
c) Rated Frequency 50 Hz
d) No of phases Three
o) Trip coil and closing coil voltage 220 V DC with variation indicated
in Section - GTR
Accuracy 0.5 3P
Note:
1. The ratings indicated for instrument transformer are tentative only and may
be changed to meet the requirements.
CHAPTER – 27
SWITCHYARD ERECTION
1.0 GENERAL
A. Supply of
The insulators for suspension and tension strings shall conform to IEC-60383 and
long rod insulators shall conform to IEC-60433. Insulator hardware shall conform to
equivalent international standard. Composite long rod insulator shall conform to
IEC: 61109.
a) Suspension and tension insulators shall be wet process porcelain with ball
and socket connection. Insulators shall be interchangeable and shall be
suitable for forming either suspension or tension strings. Each insulator shall
have rated strength markings on porcelain printed and applied before firing.
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 27 – Switchyard Erection Page 27-2
c) Glazing of the porcelain shall be uniform brown colour, free from blisters,
burrs and other similar defects.
It shall be made of toughened glass. Glass used for the shells shall be sound, free
from defects, flows bubbles, inclusions, etc and be of uniform toughness over its
entire surface. All exposed glass surfaces shall be smooth.
1.1.1.3 When operating at normal rated voltage there shall be no electric discharge between
conductor and insulator which would cause corrosion or injury to conductors or
insulators by the formation of substances due to chemical ion. No radio interference
shall be caused when operating at normal rated voltage.
1.1.1.4 The design of the insulator shall be such that stresses due to expansion and
contraction in any part of the insulator shall not lead to deterioration. All ferrous
parts shall be hot dip galvanized. The zinc used for galvanizing shall be of grade Zn-
99.95. The zinc coating shall be uniform, adherent, smooth, reasonably bright,
continuous and free from imperfections such as flux, ash, rust stains bulky white
deposits and blisters.
1.1.1.5 Bidder shall make available data on all the essential features of design including the
method of assembly of discs and metal parts, number of discs per insulator string
insulators, the manner in which mechanical stresses are transmitted through discs to
adjacent parts, provision for meeting expansion stresses, results of corona and
thermal shock tests, recommended working strength and any special design or
arrangement employed to increase life under service conditions.
1.1.1.6 Clamps for insulator strings and Corona Control rings shall be of aluminium alloy as
stipulated for clamps and connectors.
1.1.1.7 Insulator hardware shall be of forged steel. Malleable cast iron shall not be accepted
except for insulator disc cap. The surface of hardware must be clean, smooth,
without cuts, abrasion or projections. No part shall be subjected to excessive
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 27 – Switchyard Erection Page 27-3
localized pressure. The metal parts shall not produce any noise generating corona
under operating conditions.
1.1.1.8 The tension Insulator hardware assembly shall be designed for minimum 12000 kg
tensile load for below 765kV. Earth wire tension clamp shall be designed for
minimum 1000 kg tensile load with a for of safety of two (2).
1.1.1.9 The tension string assemblies shall be supplied alongwith suitable turn buckle. Sag
compensation springs if required may also be provided.
1.2.2 All constructional features specified at Clause 1.1.1 of this Chapter shall also apply
to the long rod insulator string.
1.3 Tests
In accordance with the stipulations of the specification, the suspension and tension
strings, insulator and hardware shall be subjected to the following type tests,
acceptance tests and routine tests:
1.3.1 Type Tests on Insulator Strings: The test reports for following type tests shall be
submitted for approval as per clause 9.0 of Chapter 2 - GTR.
a) Power frequency voltage withstand test with corona control rings under wet
condition as per IEC- 60383.
b) Lightning Impulse voltage withstand test with corona control rings under dry
condition as per IEC-60383
c) Voltage distribution test (Dry)
The voltage across each insulator unit shall be measured by sphere gap
method. The result obtained shall be converted into percentage. The voltage
across any disc shall not exceed 13% for 220KV suspension and tension
insulator strings, 20% and 22% for 132KV suspension and tension insulator
strings respectively.
e) Corona Extinction Voltage test (Dry) :- (As per Annexure – C)
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 27 – Switchyard Erection Page 27-4
The sample assembly when subjected to power frequency voltage shall have
a corona extinction voltage of not less than 156kV (rms) for 220kV line to
ground under dry condition. There shall be no evidence of Corona on any
part of the sample. The atmospheric condition during testing shall be
recorded and the test results shall be accordingly corrected with suitable
correction for as stipulated in IEC 60383.
f) RIV Test (Dry)
Under the conditions as specified under (e) above the insulator string
alongwith complete hardware fittings shall have a radio interference voltage
level below 1000 microvolts at 1 MHz when subjected to 50 Hz AC line to
ground voltage of 156kV for 220kV string under dry conditions. The test
procedure shall be in accordance with IEC 60437.
g) Mechanical strength test
The complete insulator string alongwith its hardware fitting excluding arcing
horn, corona control ring, grading ring, tension/suspension clamps shall be
subjected to a load equal to 50% of the specified minimum ultimate tensile
strength (UTS) which shall be increased at a steady rate to 67% of the
minimum UTS specified. The load shall be held for five minutes and then
removed. After removal of the load, the string components shall not show
any visual deformation and it shall be possible to dismantle them by hand.
Hand tools may be used to remove cotter pins and loosen the nuts initially.
The string shall then be reassembled and loaded to 50% of UTS and the load
shall be further increased at a steady rate till the specified minimum UTS and
held for one minute. No failure should occur during this period. The applied
load shall then be increased until the failing load is reached and the value
recorded.
Type test report for Thermal Mechanical Performance tests as per IEC -
60575, Clause 3 / IEC: 61109, clause 5.1 (for composite long rod insulators)
shall be submitted for approval as per clause 9.2 of Chapter 2 - GTR.
1.4 Parameters
For tension application, single insulator strings and for suspension purpose single
suspension insulator string shall be used for 132 kV system.
1.5.1.1 Contractor shall offer such composite insulators which have proven use under foggy/
humid operational conditions in polluted industrial environment combined with
smoke and dust particles. The Bidder shall furnish evidence in the form of
certification from the power utilities that the similar type of product supplied to them
had been performing satisfactory. The Bidder shall also submit certified test report
for an accelerated ageing test of 5000 hours such as that described in Appendix-C of
IEC-61109 or test at multiple stresses of 5000 hrs as described in annexure –B of
IEC-62217.
1.5.1.2 Insulators shall have sheds of the “open aerodynamic profile without any under ribs”
with good self-cleaning properties. Insulator shed profile, spacing projection etc.
shall be strictly in accordance with the recommendation of IEC-60815.
1.5.2 Ball and socket shall be 20 mm designation for 120 kN & 24 mm designation for 210
kN Insulators in accordance with the standard dimensions stated in IEC: 60120.
Insulators shall be interchangeable and shall be suitable for forming either
suspension or tension strings. Each insulator shall have rated strength markings on
each composite insulator rod unit. No negative tolerance shall be applicable to
creepage distance of composite insulators
1.5.3 All ferrous parts shall be hot dip galvanized to give a minimum average coating of
zinc equivalent to 610 gm/sq.m. and shall be in accordance with the latest edition of
equivalent International standard. The zinc used for galvanizing shall be of purity of
99.95%. The zinc coating shall be uniform, adherent, smooth, reasonably bright
continuous and free from imperfections such as flux, ash rust stains, bulky white
deposits and blisters. The galvanized metal parts shall be guaranteed to withstand at
least six successive dips each lasting for one (1) minute duration under the standard
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 27 – Switchyard Erection Page 27-9
preece test. The galvanizing shall be carried out only after any machining.
1.5.4 Materials
1.5.4.1 Core
It shall be a glass-fiber reinforced (FRP rod) epoxy resin rod of high strength. The
rod shall be resistant to hydrolysis. Glass fibers and resin shall be optimized. The
rod shall be electrical grade corrosion resistant (ECR), boron free glass and shall
exhibit both high electrical integrity and high resistance to acid corrosion.
End fittings transmit the mechanical load to the core. They shall be made of
malleable cast iron/ spheroidal graphite or forged steel. They shall be connected to
the rod by means of a controlled compression technique. The manufacturer shall
have in-process Acoustic emission arrangement or some other arrangement to ensure
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 27 – Switchyard Erection Page 27-10
that there is no damage to the core during crimping. This verification shall be in-
process and done on each insulator. The system of attachment of end fitting to the
rod shall provide superior sealing performance between housing and metal
connection. The gap between fitting and sheath shall be sealed by a flexible silicone
rubber compound. The sealing shall stick to both housing and metal end fitting. The
sealing must be humidity proof and durable with time.
End fittings shall have suitable provisions for fixing grading rings at the correct
position as per design requirements.
Grading rings shall be used at both ends of each composite insulator unit for
reducing the voltage gradient on and within the insulator and to reduce radio and TV
noise to acceptable levels. The size and placement of the metallic grading rings shall
be designed to eliminate dry band arcing/corona cutting/ exceeding of permissible
electrical stress of material.
The test reports for following type tests on long rod units, components, materials or
complete strings shall be submitted for approval as per clause 9.2 of Chapter 2 -
GTR.
1.5.2.1.1 On the complete composite Long Rod Insulator String with Hardware Fittings:-
a) Power frequency voltage withstand test with corona control rings/grading ring and
arcing horns (if provided) under wet condition as per IEC:60383-1993/
b) Switching surge voltage withstand test under wet condition as per IEC:60383-1993.
c) Impulse voltage withstand test under dry condition as per IEC:60383-1993
d) Corona and RIV test under dry condition.
The sample assembly when subjected to power frequency voltage shall have a
corona extinction voltage of not less than 156kV (rms) for 220kV line to ground
under dry condition. There shall be no evidence of Corona on any part of the sample.
The atmospheric condition during testing shall be recorded and the test results shall
be accordingly corrected with suitable correction for as stipulated in IEC 60383.
Under the conditions as specified above the insulator string alongwith complete
hardware fittings shall have a radio interference voltage level below 1000 microvolts
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 27 – Switchyard Erection Page 27-11
In the event of failure of the sample to satisfy the acceptance test(s) specified in 4.2
above, the retest procedure shall be as per IEC 61109.
(Wet)
6. Minimum Corona extinction kV (rms) NA
voltage at 50 Hz AC system under phase to
dry condition earth
7. Radio interference voltage at one Micro NA
MHz for phase to earth voltage of Volts
508 KV under dry condition.
8. Minimum creepage distance. mm 3625
9. Electromechanical strength of kN 120
Insulator Unit.
2.1.1 The details of the ACSR Bear conductors shall be as per the standard guaranteed
technical particulars as tabulated below:
2.1.2 The details of the ACSR WOLF conductors for 33 kV line shall be as per the
standard guaranteed technical particulars as tabulated below:
2.2 Workmanship
2.3.1 The finished conductor shall be smooth, comp, uniform and free from all imperfections
including kinks (protusion of wires), wire cross over, over riding, looseness (wire being
dislocated by finger/hand pressure and/or unusual bangle noise on tapping), material
inclusions, white rust, powder formation or black spot (on account of region with
trapped rain water etc.), dirt, grit etc.
2.3.2 All the Aluminium and steel strands shall be smooth, uniform and free from all
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 27 – Switchyard Erection Page 27-16
imperfections, such as spills and splits, diemarks, scratches, abrasions, etc., after
drawing.
2.3.3 The steel strands shall be hot dip galvanised and shall have a minimum zinc coating of
260 gms/sq.m. after stranding of the uncoated wire surface. The zinc coating shall be
smooth, continuous and of uniform thickness, free from imperfections and shall
withstand minimum three dips in standard Preece test. The finished strands and the
individual wires shall be of uniform quality and have the same properties and
chareristics as prescribed in ASTM designation: B 498-74.
2.3.4 The steel strands shall be preformed and post formed in order to prevent spreading of
strands in the event of cutting of composite core wire. Care shall be taken to avoid,
damages to galvanisation during pre-forming and post-forming operation.
2.3 Joints in Wires
There shall be no joint of any kind in the finished wire entering into the manufacture of
the strand. There shall also be no strand joints or strand splices in any length of the
completed stranded steel core of the conductor.
2.4 Tolerances
The manufacturing tolerances shall be as per relevant International standard.
2.5 Materials
2.5.1 Aluminium
The aluminium strands shall be hard drawn from electrolytic aluminium rods having
purity not less than 99.5% and a copper content not exceeding 0.04%.
2.5.2 Steel
The steel wire strands shall be drawn from high carbon steel wire rods and shall conform
to the following chemical composition:
Element % Composition
Carbon 0.50 to 0.85
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 27 – Switchyard Erection Page 27-17
2.5.3 Zinc
The zinc used for galvanising shall be electrolytic High Grade Zinc of 99.95% purity.
2.7 Tests :
2.7.1 The following type, acceptance & routine tests and tests during manufacturing shall be
carried out on the conductor.
NOTE:
All the above tests except test mentioned at (a) shall be carried out on aluminium and
steel strands after stranding only.
The Contractor shall offer material for selection of samples for type testing, only after
getting quality assurance plans approved from Owner’s Quality Assurance Department.
The sample shall be manufactured strictly in accordance with the Quality Assurance
Plan approved by Owner.
3.1.1 The contractor shall supply the earthwire as per the standard guaranteed technical
particulars enclosed in Annexure-B of the technical specification, Chapter 11 –
Switchyard Erection and separate approval is not required during detailed engineering.
Owner has also standardised the guaranteed technical particulars for the earthwire which
are enclosed in Annexure-B of the technical specification, Chapter 11 – Switchyard
Erection. The contractor shall supply the earthwire as per the standard guaranteed
technical particulars.
3.1.2 The basic details of the earth wire are tabulated below:
2. Strands
3.2 Workmanship
3.2.1 All steel strands shall be smooth, uniform and free from all imperfections, such as spills
and splits, die marks, scratches, abrasions and kinks after drawing and also after
stranding.
3.2.2 The finished material shall have minimum brittleness as it will be subjected to
appreciable vibration while in use.
3.2.3 The steel strands shall be hot dip qalvanised (and shall have minimum Zinc coating of
275 gms/sq.m) after stranding of the uncoated wire surface. The zinc coating shall be
smooth, continuous, of uniform thickness, free from imperfections and shall withstand
three and a half dips after stranding in standard Preece test. The steel wire rod shall be of
such quality and purity that, when drawn to the size of the strands specified and coated
with zinc, the finished strands shall be of uniform quality and have the same properties
and chareristics as prescribed in ASTM designation B498-74.
3.2.4 The steel strands shall be preformed and post formed in order to prevent spreading of
strands while cutting of composite earth wire. Care shall be taken to avoid damage to
galvanisation during preforming and postforming operation.
3.2.5 To avoid susceptibility towards wet storage stains (white rust), the finished material shall
be provided with a protective coating of boiled linseed oil.
There shall be no joint of any kind in the finished steel wire strand entering into the
manufacture of the earth wire. There shall be no strand joints or strand splices in any
length of the completed stranded earth wire.
3.4 Tolerances
3.5 Composition
3.5.1 Steel
The steel wire strands shall be drawn from high carbon steel rods and shall conform
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 27 – Switchyard Erection Page 27-20
Element % Composition
Carbon Not more than 0.55
Manganese 0.4 to 0.9
Phosphorous Not more than 0.04
Sulphur Not more than 0.04
Silicon 0.15 to 0.35
3.5.2 Zinc
The zinc used for galvanising shall be electrolytic High Grade Zinc of 99.95%
purity. It shall conform to and satisfy all the requirements of relevant international
standard.
3.7 TESTS
3.7.1 The following type, routine & acceptance tests and tests during manufacturing shall
be carried out on the earthwire.
In accordance with the stipulation of specification, the following type tests reports of
the earthwire shall be submitted for approval as per clause 9.2 of Chapter 2 - GTR.
a) UTS test
b) DC resistance test
The Contractor shall offer material for sample selection for type testing, only after
getting quality assurance programme approved by the Owner. The samples for type
testing shall be manufactured strictly in accordance with the Quality Assurance
Programme approved by the Owner.
4.1 General
The contractor shall supply the aluminium tubes as per the standard guaranteed
technical particulars enclosed in Annexure- B of the technical specification, Chapter
19 – Switchyard Erection and separate approval is not required during detailed
engineering.
Owner has also stardardised the guaranteed technical particulars for the aluminium
tube which are enclosed in Annexure- B of the technical specification, Chapter 19 –
Switchyard Erection. The contractor shall supply the aluminium tube as per the
standard guaranteed technical particulars.
4.3 Tests
In accordance with stipulations of the specification, Routine tests shall be conducted
on tubular bus conductors. Also the wall thickness and ovality of the tube shall be
measured. In addition to the above tests, 0.2% proof tests on both parent metal and
Aluminium tube after welding shall be conducted.
5.1.2 Porcelain used shall be homogeneous, free from lamination, cavities and other flaws
or imperfections that might affect the mechanical or dielectric quality and shall be
thoroughly vitrified, tough and impervious to moisture.
5.1.3 Glazing of the porcelain shall be of uniform brown in colour, free from blisters, burrs
and other similar defects.
5.1.4 The insulator shall have alternate long and short sheds with aerodynamic profile, the
shed profile shall also meet the requirements of IEC-60815 for the specified
pollution level.
5.1.5 When operating at normal rated voltage there shall be no electric discharge between
conductor and insulators which would cause corrosion or injury to conductors or
insulators by the formation of substance produced by chemical ion.
5.1.6 The design of the insulators shall be such that stresses due to expansion and
contraction in any part of the insulator shall not lead to deterioration.
5.1.7 All ferrous parts shall be hot dip galvanised. The zinc used for galvanising shall be
grade Zn 99.95. The zinc coating shall be uniform, adherent, smooth, reasonably
bright, continuous and free from imperfections such as flux ash, rust stains, bulky
white deposits and blisters. The metal parts shall not produce any noise generating
corona under the operating conditions.
5.1.8 a) Every bolt shall be provided with a steel washer under the nut so that part of
the threaded portion of the bolts is within the thickness of the parts bolted
together.
b) Flat washer shall be circular of a diameter 2.5 times that of bolt and of
suitable thickness. Where bolt heads/nuts bear upon the beveled surfaces they
shall be provided with square tapered washers of suitable thickness to afford
a seating square with the axis of the bolt.
c) All bolts and nuts shall be of steel with well formed hexagonal heads forged
from the solid and shall be hot dip galvanised. The nuts shall be good fit on
the bolts and two clear threads shall show through the nut when it has been
finally tightened up.
5.1.9 Bidder shall make available data on all the essential features of design including the
method of assembly of shells and metals parts, number of shells per insulator, the
manner in which mechanical stresses are transmitted through shells to adjacent parts,
provision for meeting expansion stresses, results of corona and thermal shock tests,
recommended working strength and any special design or arrangement employed to
increase life under service conditions.
5.2 Tests
In accordance with the stipulations of the specification, the post insulators shall be
subject to type, acceptance, sample and routine tests as per IEC-60168.
5.2.2 In accordance with the stipulation of specification, the following type tests reports of
the post insulators shall be submitted for approval as per clause 9.2 of Chapter 2 -
GTR.
5.3.2 If corona extinction voltage is to be achieved with the help of corona ring or any
other similar device, the same shall be deemed to be included in the scope of the
Contractor. Material of Corona ring shall be aluminium/aluminium alloy of 63401W
grade or equivalent.
6.1 GENERAL
This specification covers the design, supply, delivery, installation and testing of the
complete grounding system as described below.
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 27 – Switchyard Erection Page 27-26
6.2.1 The installation shall be complete in all respects for efficient and trouble free service.
All work shall be carried out in a first class neat workman like manner. Grounding
conductors shall be handled carefully to avoid kinking and cutting of the conductors
during laying and installation. All exposed ground conductors runs shall be taken in
a neat manner, horizontal, vertical and parallel to building walls or columns and shall
not be laid haphazardly.
6.2.2 For all connections made to equipment or to the structures, the grounding conductor,
connectors and equipment enclosures shall have good clean cont surfaces. Grounding
conductor connection to all electrical equipment, switchgear, transformers, motors,
panels, conduit system, equipment enclosures, cable trays, distribution boards,
equipment frames, bases, steel structure, etc. shall be by pressure type or bolting type
connectors.
6.2.3 All lap, cross and tee connections between two grounding conductors shall be made
by thermowelding process or compression type connector. The various joints shall
have adequate mechanical strength as well as necessary electrical conductivity not
less than that of the parent conductors of the joints. All accessories for grounding
installation shall be of quality and design approved by the Employer. The earthing
connection between earthing pad of equipment/structures shall be made by two
earthing leads.
6.2.4 Ground conductors, when crossing underground trenches, directly laid underground
pipe and equipment foundation, if any, shall be at least 300mm below the bottom
elevation of such trenches/pipes.
6.2.5 The maximum size of each grid of grounding mat shall not exceed 4X4 meters. The
terminals for connecting ground mat and equipment shall be terminated whenever
necessary. (The new grounding shall be bonded with existing grounding network.at
New Khimti Substations.
The main ground system shall consist of a grounding grid buried minimum 0.6 meter
below grade level. The grounding grid shall consist of copper flat conductor cable or
stranded copper wire of minimum size (cross sectional area) 120 sq. mm.
6.3.3 Risers
The risers shall consist of copper conductor of adequate size (but not less than 120
sq. mm.) connected at one end to the main ground mat and at the other end to the
equipment.
6.4.1 The Contractor shall measure the soil resistivity in presence of the Employer. Based
on the resistivity the contractor shall calculate the total length of buried ground
conductor, number of grounding electrode and their depth and spacing to achieve a
grounding system resistance of less than 1.0 (One) Ohm.
6.4.2 The Contractor shall calculate the cross-section considering the maximum fault level
of 31.5 kA.
6.4.3 The Contractor shall submit the details of calculations of the grounding system for
the Employer’s approval. The earthing system shall be of single earthing system for
the whole substation i.e. all earthings shall be connected to main earthing grid.
6.5 TESTS
The outdoor equipment of the substation and the substation building shall be
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 27 – Switchyard Erection Page 27-28
6.7 DRAWINGS
After award of the Contract, the Contractor shall furnish the grounding layout
drawing with dimensions showing the location of grounding grids, electrodes, test
link chambers and risers, backed up by necessary calculations for Employer's
approval. The work shall have to be started at site only after getting approval from
the Employer. If alteration is required for any work done before getting Employer's
approval, the same shall have to be done by the Contractor at no extra cost to the
Employer.
The brief description of the bus switching scheme, bus bar layout and equipment
connection to be adopted are indicated elsewhere in the specification. The bus bar
arrangements are shown in drgs enclosed with the bid documents.
7.1 The Contractor shall furnish supporting calculations where applicable for the bus
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 27 – Switchyard Erection Page 27-29
a) Fibre-stress
b) Cantilever strength of post insulators
c) Aeolain vibrations
d) Vertical deflection of bus bars
e) Short circuit forces in bundle conductor and spacer location for each span of
ACSR conductor stringing as per layout drawings.
7.1.1 The welds in the aluminium tubes shall be kept to the minimum and there shall not
be more than one weld per span. The procedure and details of welding shall be
subject to Owner’s approval. Material for welding sleeve shall be same as that of
Aluminium tube. Welding sleeve shall be of 600mm length
7.1.2 Corona bells shall be provided wherever the bus extends beyond the clamps and on
free ends, for sealing the ends of the tubular conductor against rain and moisture and
to reduce the electrostatic discharge loss at the end points. There shall be a small
drain hole in the corona bell. The material of Corona bell shall be Aluminium alloy
similar to that of clamps & connectors.
7.1.3 To minimise the vibrations in the aluminium tubes, damping conductor shall be
provided inside the aluminium tubes. For this purpose, the cut pieces of ACSR
conductor which otherwise are considered wastages, shall be used as damping
conductor.
7.1.4 Details of past experience of the persons proposed to be employed for Aluminium
tube welding and the test reports of the welded pieces to prove the electrical and
mechanical characteristics shall also be furnished along with the bid. Welding at site
shall be done by adopting a qualified procedure and employing qualified welders as
per ASME-Section IX.
8.1 The disposition of various bay equipments shall be as per single line diagrams and
layout drawings.
One no. of bay marshalling kiosk shall be provided for each 132 kV bay under
present scope. In addition to the requirements specified elsewhere in the
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 27 – Switchyard Erection Page 27-30
specification, the bay marshalling kiosk shall have two distinct compartments for the
following purpose:-
(i) To receive two incoming 400V, 3 phase, 63Amps, AC supply with auto
changeover and MCB unit and distribute minimum six outgoing 400V, 3
phase, 16 Amps AC supplies controlled by MCB.
(ii) To distribute minimum ten outgoing 230V, 10 Amps single phase supplies to
be controlled by MCB to be drawn from above 3 phase incomers.
(iii) 200 nos. terminal blocks in vertical formation for interlocking facilities for
substations without automation system.
(iv) Necessary Terminal Blocks for terminating cables from ACDB and
switchyard panel rooms.
9.1 For equipment interconnection, the surfaces of equipment terminal pads, Aluminium
tube, conductor & terminal clamps and connectors shall be properly cleaned. After
cleaning, cont grease shall be applied on the cont surfaces of equipment terminal
pad, Aluminium tube/conductor and terminal clamps to avoid any air gap in
between. Subsequently bolts of the terminal pad/terminal connectors shall be
tightened and the surfaces shall be cleaned properly after equipment interconnection.
9.2 Muslin or leather cloth shall be used for cleaning the inside and outside of hollow
insulators.
9.3 All support insulators, circuit breaker interrupters and other fragile equipment shall
preferably be handled with cranes having suitable booms and handling capacity.
9.4 Bending of Aluminum tube and compressed air piping if any should be done by a
bending machine and through cold bending only. Bending shall be such that inner
diameter of pipe is not reduced.
9.5 Cutting of the pipes wherever required shall be such as to avoid flaring of the ends.
Hence only a proper pipe cutting tool shall be used. Hack saw shall not be used.
9.7 Handling equipment, sling ropes etc. should be tested periodically before erection for
strength.
9.8 The slings shall be of sufficient length to avoid any damage to insulator due to
excessive swing, scratching by sling ropes etc.
10.0 STORAGE
10.1 The Contractor shall provide and construct adequate storage shed for proper storage
of equipments, where sensitive equipments shall be stored indoors. All equipments
during storage shall be protected against damage due to state of nature or accidents.
The storage instructions of the equipment manufacturer/Owner shall be strictly
adhered to.
11.1.1 Each cable and conduit run shall be tagged with numbers that appear in the cable and
conduit schedule.
11.1.2 The tag shall be of aluminium with the number punched on it and securely attached
to the cable conduit by not less than two turns of 20 SWG GI wire. Cable tags shall
be of rectangular shape for power cables and of circular shape for control cables.
11.1.3 Location of cables laid directly underground shall be clearly indicated with cable
marker made of galvanised iron plate.
11.1.4 Location of underground cable joints shall be indicated with cable marker with an
additional inscription “Cable joints”.
11.1.5 The marker shall project 150 mm above ground and shall be spaced at an interval of
30 meters and at every change in direction. They shall be located on both sides of
road and drain crossings.
11.1.6 Cable tags shall be provided on all cables at each end (just before entering the
equipment enclosure), on both sides of a wall or floor crossing, on each duct/conduit
entry and at each end & turning point in cable tray/trench runs. Cable tags shall be
provided inside the switchgear, motor control centres, control and relay panels etc.,
wherever required for cable identification, where a number of cables enter together
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 27 – Switchyard Erection Page 27-32
11.2.1 The Contractor shall provide embedded steel inserts on concrete floors/walls to
secure supports by welding to these inserts or available building steel structures.
11.2.2 The supports shall be fabricated from standard structural steel members.
11.2.3 Insert plates will be provided at an interval of 750 mm wherever cables are to be
supported without the use of cable trays, such as in trenches, while at all other places
these will be at an interval of 2000 mm.
11.3.1 The termination and connection of cables shall be done strictly in accordance with
cable and termination kit manufacturer’s instructions, drawing and/or as directed by
the Owner.
11.3.2 The work shall include all clamping, fittings, fixing, plumbing, soldering, drilling,
cutting, taping, heat shrinking (where applicable), connecting to cable terminal,
shorting and grounding as required to complete the job.
11.3.4 The equipment will be generally provided with undrilled gland plates for
cables/conduit entry. The Contractor shall be responsible for drilling of gland plates,
painting and touching up. Holes shall not be made by gas cutting.
11.3.6 The Contractor shall tag/ferrule control cable cores at all terminations, as instructed
by the Owner. In panels where a large number of cables are to be terminated and
cable identification may be difficult, each core ferrule may include the complete
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 27 – Switchyard Erection Page 27-33
11.3.7 Spare cores shall be similarly tagged with cable numbers and coiled up.
11.3.8 All cable entry points shall be sealed and made vermin and dust proof. Unused
openings shall be effectively closed.
11.3.9 Double compression type nickel plated (coating thickness not less than 10 microns)
brass cable glands shall be provided by the Contractor for all power and control
cables to provide dust and weather proof terminations.
11.3.10 They shall comprise of heavy duty brass casting, machine finished and nickel plated,
to avoid corrosion and oxidation. Rubber components used in cable glands shall be
neoprene and of tested quality. Cable glands shall be of approved make.
11.3.11 The cable glands shall also be suitable for dust proof and weather proof termination.
The test procedure, if required, has to be discussed and agreed to between Owner and
cable gland manufacturer.
11.3.12 If the cable-end box or terminal enclosure provided on the equipment is found
unsuitable and requires modification, the same shall be carried out by the Contractor,
as directed by the Owner.
11.3.14 Cable lugs shall be tinned copper solderless crimping type conforming to relevant
international standard. Bimetallic lugs shall be used depending upon type of cables
used.
11.4.1 Cable drums shall be unloaded, handled and stored in an approved manner and
rolling of drums shall be avoided as far as possible. For short distances, the drums
may be rolled provided they are rolled slowly and in proper direction as marked on
the drum.
12.1 The Contractor shall construct the cable trenches required for directly buried cables.
The scope of work shall include excavation, preparation of sand bedding, soil cover,
supply and installation of brick or concrete protective covers, back filling and
ramming, supply and installation of route markers and joint markers. The Bidder
shall ascertain the soil conditions prevailing at site, before submitting the bid.
12.2 The cable (power and control) between LT station, control room and fire lighting
pump house shall be laid in the buried cable trenches. In addition to the above, for
lighting purpose also, buried cable trench can be used in outdoor area.
12.3 Cable route and joint markers and RCC warning covers shall be provided wherever
required. The voltage grade of cables shall be engraved on the marker.
13.1 Cabling in the control room shall be done on ladder type cable trays for vertical runs
while cabling in switchyard area shall be done on angles in the trench.
13.2 All cables from bay cable trench to equipment’s including and all interpole cables
(both power and control) for all equipment, shall be laid in PVC pipes of minimum
50 mm nominal outside diameter which shall be buried in the ground at a depth of
250mm below finish formation level. Separate PVC pipes shall be laid for control
and power cables. Cable pull boxes of adequate size shall be provided if required.
13.3 Cables shall be generally located adjoining the electrical equipment through the pipe
insert embedded in the floor. In the case of equipments located away from cable
trench either pipe inserts shall be embedded in the floor connecting the cable trench
and the equipment or in case the distance is small, notch/opening on the wall shall be
provided. In all these cases necessary bending radius as recommended by the cable
manufacturer shall be maintained.
13.4 Cable racks and supports shall be painted after installation with two coats of metal
primer (comprising of red oxide and zinc chromate in a synthetic medium) followed
by two finishing coats of aluminium paint.
13.5 Suitable arrangement should be used between fixed pipe / cable trays and equipment
terminal boxes, where vibration is anticipated.
13.6 Power and control cables in the cable trench shall be laid in separate tiers. The order
of laying of various cables shall be as follows, for cables other than directly buried.
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 27 – Switchyard Erection Page 27-35
13.7 Single core cables in trefoil formation shall be laid with a distance of three times the
diameter of cable between trefoil centre lines. All power cables shall be laid with a
minimum centre to centre distance equal to twice the diameter of the cable of higher
size of cables.
13.8 Trefoil clamps for single core cables shall be of pressure die cast aluminium (LM-6),
Nylon -6 or fibre glass and shall include necessary fixing GI nuts, bolts, washer etc.
These are required at every 2 metre of cable runs.
13.9 Power and control cables shall be securely fixed to the trays/supports with self
locking type nylon ties with deinterlocking facility at every 5 metre interval for
horizontal run. Vertical and inclined cable runs shall be secured with 25 mm wide
and 2 mm thick aluminium strip clamps at every 2m.
13.10 Cables shall not be bent below the minimum permissible limit. The permissible
limits are as follows:
13.11 Where cables cross roads, drains and rail tracks, these shall be laid in reinforced spun
concrete or steel pipes buried at not less than one metre depth.
13.12 In each cable run some extra length shall be kept at a suitable point to enable one (for
LT cables)/two (for H.T. cables) straight through joints to be made in case the cable
develop fault at a later date.
13.13 Selection of cable drums for each run shall be so planned as to avoid using straight
through joints. Cable splices will not be permitted except where called for by the
drawings, unavoidable or where permitted by the Owner. If straight through joints
are unavoidable, the Contractor shall use the straight through joints kit of reputed
make.
13.14 Control cable terminations inside equipment enclosures shall have sufficient lengths
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 27 – Switchyard Erection Page 27-36
so that changing of termination in terminal blocks can be done without requiring any
splicing.
13.15 Metal screen and armour of the cable shall be bonded to the earthing system of the
station, wherever required by the Owner.
13.16 Rollers shall be used at intervals of about two metres while pulling cables.
13.17 All due care shall be taken during unreeling, laying and termination of cable to avoid
damage due to twist, kinks, sharp bends, etc.
13.18 Cable ends shall be kept sealed to prevent damage. In cable vault, fire resistant seal
shall be provided underneath the panels.
13.20 Wherever cable pass through floor or through wall openings or other partitions,
GI/PVC wall sleeves with bushes having a smooth curved internal surface so as not
to damage the cable, shall be supplied, installed and properly sealed by the
Contractor at no extra charges.
13.21 Contractor shall remove the RCC/Steel trench covers before taking up the work and
shall replace all the trench covers after the erection-work in that particular area is
completed or when further work is not likely to be taken up for some time.
13.22 Contractor shall furnish three copies of the report on work carried out in a particular
week, indicating cable numbers, date on which laid, ual length and route, testing
carried out, terminations carried out, along with the marked up copy of the cable
schedule and interconnection drawing wherever any modifications are made.
13.23 Contractor shall paint the tray identification number on each run of trays at an
interval of 10 m.
13.24 In case the outer sheath of a cable is damaged during handling/installation, the
Contractor shall repair it at his own cost to the satisfaction of the Owner. In case any
other part of a cable is damaged, the same shall be replaced by a healthy cable at no
extra cost to the Owner, i.e. the Contractor shall not be paid for installation and
removal of the damaged cable.
13.25 All cable terminations shall be appropriately tightened to ensure secure and reliable
connections. The Contractor shall cover the exposed part of all cable lugs whether
supplied by him or not with insulating tape, sleeve or paint.
i) The cable trays shall be of G.S.sheet and minimum thickness of sheet shall be
2mm.
ii) The Contractor shall perform all tests and inspection to ensure that material
and workmanship are according to the relevant standards.
A 2.5 metre straight section of 300mm, 600mm wide cable tray shall be simply
supported at two ends. A uniform distributed load of 76 kg/m shall be applied along
the length of the tray. The maximum deflection at the mid-span shall not exceed
7mm.
13.27.1 Contractor shall supply and install all rigid conduits, mild steel pipes,flexible
conduits, hume pipes etc. including all necessary sundry materials such as tees,
elbows, check nuts, bushing, reducers, enlargers, coupling cap, nipples, gland sealing
fittings, pull boxes etc as specified and to be shown in detailed drawing. The size of
the conduit/pipe shall be selected on the basis of 40% fill criterion.
13.27.2 Contractor shall have his own facility for bending, cutting and threading the conduits
at site. Cold bending should be used. All cuts & threaded ends shall be made
smooth without leaving any sharp edges. Anticorrosive paint shall be applied at all
field threaded portions.
13.27.3 All conduit/pipes shall be extended on both sides of wall/floor openings. The
fabrication and installation of supports and the clamping shall be included in the
scope of work by Contractor.
13.27.4 When two lengths of conduits are joined together through a coupling, running
threads equal to twice the length of coupling shall be provided on each conduit to
facilitate easy dismantling of two conduits.
13.27.6 Each conduit run shall be painted with its designation as indicated on the drawings
such that it can be identified at each end.
13.27.8 Conduit run sleeves shall be provided with the bushings at each end.
13.27.9 Metallic conduit runs at termination shall have two locknuts and a bushing for
connection. Flexible conduits shall also be suitably clamped at each end with the
help of bushings. Bushings shall have rounded edges so as not to damage the cables.
13.27.10 Where embedded conduits turn upwards from a slab or fill, the termination
dimensions shown on the drawings, if any, shall be taken to represent the position of
the straight extension of the conduit external to and immediately following the bend.
At least one half of the arc length of the bend shall be embedded.
13.27.11 All conduits/pipes shall have their ends closed by caps until cables are pulled. After
cables are pulled, the ends of conduits/pipes shall be sealed in an approved manner to
prevent damage to threaded portions and entrance of moisture and foreign material.
13.27.12 For underground runs, Contractor shall excavate and back fill as necessary.
13.27.13 Contractor shall supply, unload, store and install conduits required for the lighting
installation as specified. All accessories/fittings required for making the installation
complete, including but not limited to pull out boxes, ordinary and inspection tees
and elbow, checknuts, male and female bushings (brass or galvanised steel), caps,
square headed male plugs, nipples, gland sealing fittings ,pull boxes, conduits
terminal boxes, gaskets and box covers, saddle terminal boxes, and all steel
supporting work shall be supplied by the Contractor. The conduit fittings shall be of
the same material as conduits.
13.27.14 All unarmoured cables shall run within the conduits from lighting panels to lighting
fixtures, receptacles etc.
13.27.15 Size of conduit for lighting shall be selected by the Contractor during detailed
engineering.
13.27.16 Exposed conduits shall be run in straight lines parallel to building columns, beams
and walls. Unnecessary bends and crossings shall be avoided to present a neat
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 27 – Switchyard Erection Page 27-39
appearance.
13.27.17 Conduit supports shall be provided at an interval of 750mm for horizontal runs and
1000mm for vertical runs.
13.27.18 Conduit supports shall be clamped on the approved type spacer plates or brackets by
saddles or U- bolts. The spacer plates or brackets in turn, shall be securely fixed to
the building steel by welding and to concrete or brick work by grouting or by nylon
rawl plugs. Wooden plug inserted in the masonary or concrete for conduit support is
not acceptable.
13.27.19 Embedded conduits shall be securely fixed in position to preclude any movement. In
fixing embedded conduit, if welding or brazing is used, extreme care should be taken
to avoid any injury to the inner surface of the conduit.
13.27.20 Spacing of embedded conduits shall be such as to permit flow of concrete between
them.
13.27.21 Where conduits are placed alongwith cable trays, they shall be clamped to supporting
steel at an interval of 600mm.
13.27.22 For directly embedding in soil, the conduits shall be coated with an asphalt-base
compound. Concrete pier or anchor shall be provided wherever necessary to support
the conduit rigidly and to hold it in place.
13.27.23 Conduit shall be installed in such a way as to ensure against trouble from trapped
condensation.
13.27.24 Conduits shall be kept, wherever possible, at least 300mm away from hot pipes,
heating devices etc. when it is evident that such proximity may reduce the service
life of cables.
13.27.25 Slip joints shall be provided when conduits cross structural expansion joints or where
long run of exposed conduits are installed, so that temperature change will cause no
distortion due to expansion or contrion of conduit run.
13.27.26 For long conduit run, pull boxes shall be provided at suitable intervals to facilitate
wiring.
13.27.27 Conduit shall be securely fastened to junction boxes or cabinets, each with a lock nut
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 27 – Switchyard Erection Page 27-40
13.27.28 Conduits joints and connections shall be made thoroughly water-tight and rust proof
by application of a thread compound which insulates the joints. White lead is
suitable for application on embedded conduit and red lead for exposed conduit.
13.27.29 Field bends shall have a minimum radius of four (4) times the conduit diameter. All
bends shall be free of kinks, indentations of flattened surfaces. Heat shall not be
applied in making any conduit bend. Separate bends may be used for this purpose.
13.27.30 The entire metallic conduit system, whether embedded or exposed, shall be
electrically continuous and thoroughly grounded. Where slip joints are used, suitable
bounding shall be provided around the joint to ensure a continuous ground circuit.
13.27.31 After installation, the conduits shall be thoroughly cleaned by compressed air before
pulling in the wire.
13.27.32 Lighting fixtures shall not be suspended directly from the junction box in the main
conduit run.
a) The Contractor shall supply and install junction boxes complete with
terminals as required. The brackets, bolts, nuts, screws etc required for
erection are also included in the scope of the Contractor.
b) Junction boxes having volume less than 1600 cubic centimeters may be
installed without any support other than that resulting from connecting
conduits where two or more rigid metallic conduits enter and accurately
position the box. Boxes shall be installed so that they are level, plumb and
properly aligned to present a pleasing appearance.
c) Boxes with volumes equal to or greater than 1600 cubic cm, and smaller
boxes terminating on less than two rigid metallic conduits or for other
reasons not rigidly held, shall be adequately supported by auxiliary steel of
standard steel shapes or plates to be fabricated and installed. The Contractor
shall perform all drilling, cutting, welding, shimming and bolting required for
attachment of supports.
15.1 An indicative list of tests for testing and commissioning is given below. Contractor
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 27 – Switchyard Erection Page 27-41
shall perform any additional test based on specialities of the items as per the field
Q.P./instructions of the equipment Contractor or Owner without any extra cost to the
Owner. The Contractor shall arrange all equipments instruments and auxiliaries
required for testing and commissioning of equipments alongwith calibration
certificates and shall furnish the list of instruments to the Owner for approval.
15.4 AAC/ ACSR STRINGING WORK, TUBULAR BUS WORK AND POWER
CONNECTORS
other accessories.
d) Millivolt drop test on all power connectors.
e) Sag and tension check on conductors.
a) Physical check
b) Millivolt drop test on all joints.
c) Dye penetration test & Radiography test on 10% sample basis on weld joints.
c) Test check on 5% sample joints after cutting the weld piece to
observe any voids etc.
15.6 INSULATOR
15.7 All pre/commissioning invitees and works for substation equipment shall be carried
out in accordance with owner's ''Pre- Commissioning procedures and formats for
substation bay equipments" by the contractor. This document shall be provided to the
successful Contractor during detailed engineering stage.
CHAPTER - 28
CIVIL AND ARCHITECTURAL SUBSTATION WORKS
1. GENERAL
This specification covers the general requirements for exploration, design, manufacture,
factory test, supply, construction and field testing of civil and architectural works, air-
conditioning system in the control buildings of the substations.
The Contractor shall perform all the works to meet the requirements of these Specifications,
the attached drawings and all the relevant Articles in these Contract Documents.
Contractor shall make the arrangement of water supply for construction work as well as for
future use also.
change and shall submit complete specifications of the materials, as well as copies of
pertinent standards, for the approval of Employer and decision of Employer in the matter of
quality shall be final.
2.2 Protection
The Contractor shall be responsible for prevention of damage to structures and other objects,
which are not included in the clearing work. No objects of any kind outside the indicated
limits of the work shall be removed or damaged. The Contractor shall protect existing
utilities, which are not specifically included in the work. The Contractor shall be responsible
for employment of safe methods of demolition and clearing.
2.3 Payment:
Payment for the Contract item "Clearing and Stripping" will be made at the unit / lump sum
price bid. Therefore, in the Price Schedule, the unit / lump sum price shall include full
compensation for all costs incurred in performing the clearing and stripping, including but
not limited to, removal and disposal of houses, fences, bushes, splash, roots and debris; and
stripping, cutting, stockpiling and disposal of topsoil, exposed rocks or unsuitable earth
material etc.
NEA. The Contractor shall provide all assistance in instruments, materials and personnel to
NEA for checking the detailed layout and shall be solely responsible for the correctness of
the layout and levels.
3.1 Scope
This clause covers clearance of site, contour survey, site levelling, maintaining finished
ground level by cutting/filling in all types of soil and soft/ disintegrated rock, supplying and
compaction of fill material if required. Cutting/felling of trees and their disposal has not
been envisaged under the present scope.
The Contractor shall provide and compact fill materials within the limits of the work to the
lines, grades and elevations to be specified by the Employer. The Contractor shall provide
details of filling materials to the Employer for approval. Site grading shall also include
cutting of slopes. Site grading shall also cover areas as directed by the Employer including
that for future bays. Each level shall be plain throughout. The Contractor shall submit detail
calculations of cut and fill areas and total volume.
3.2 Common Fill
The Contractor may use fill materials available from cut areas, if suitable. This material
shall be well-graded bank run gravel, relatively free from clay, loam or vegetable matter and
with no stones over 10 cm in maximum dimensions, or material of equivalent strength and
characteristics. Representative samples from proposed borrow sources shall be submitted to
the Employer for approval. Approval of borrow source shall not mean automatic approval of
all materials obtained from that source. All fill materials will be subject to approval of
Employer. If any material is rejected by Employer, the Contractor shall remove it from site
without any extra cost to the Employer.
3.3 The Contractor shall, at his option, use areas approved by the Employer for production of
select borrow or, at his own expense, make arrangements for obtaining select borrow at
other sources with prior approval of the Employer.
3.4 Unless otherwise specified by the Employer, compaction shall be to the following densities
at optimum moisture content, as determined by ASTM D 1557, Method-D.
(a) Fill locations and required density.
1) Under building and yard foundations 95 percent
2) Sub base for roadways 90 percent
3) All other locations 90 percent
(b) It is the Contractor's responsibility to select his method for attaining the required
compaction and obtain approval of the Employer for the proposed method. If the
method of compaction proves unsatisfactory, it is the Contractor's responsibility to
take remedial measures and obtain the approval of the Employer for the changes
made. For the compaction of fill, 10 ton vibrating roller is preferable.
(c) The Employer reserves the right to have compaction tests performed by an
independent laboratory, with all testing costs borne by the Contractor. Any additional
compaction or replacement of fill required to meet the specified density, as
evidenced by the tests, shall be done by and at the expenses of the Contractor.
(d) Failure of the compacted fill to reach the required density as evidenced by these
tests, shall be the cause of rejection by the Employer of the work in the affected
area(s). Unless the Contractor can rework and compact the fill to the required
density, he shall remove the fill in the areas affected. Subsequently the Contractor
shall replace the fill material, which he can compact to the required density.
(e) Compaction shall be carried out in layer wise, each layer not exceeding 300 mm
loose thickness.
3.5 Payment:
Measurements for payment for the Contract item "Site Grading" shall be cubic meters of site
grading, filled of bank run gravel furnished and placed in accordance with the
Specifications, as shown on drawings, or as directed by the Employer.
Payment for the Contract item "Site Grading" will be made at the unit price for cubic meter
bid. Therefore, in the Price Schedule, the unit price shall include full compensation for all
costs incurred in furnishing all materials and all other operations related to fill including but
not limited to:
(a) Obtaining materials from cutting zone of switchyard as well as from the Employer's
approved source.
(b) Transporting materials to job site from source, to temporary stockpiles and/or points of
final disposition.
(c) Placing and compacting material.
(d) Leveling the top surface of both cut and fill areas to the finished grade.
No payment will be made for any site grading on cut areas.
4. GEOTECHNICAL INVESTIGATION
4.1 GENERAL
The Contractor shall perform a detailed soil investigation to arrive at sufficiently accurate,
general as well as specific information about the soil profile and the necessary soil
parameters of the site in order that the foundation of the various structures can be designed
and constructed safely and rationally.
A detailed soil report including field data duly certified by site engineers of NEA will be
submitted by the Contractor for specific approval of NEA. The report shall contain all soil
parameters for type of foundation i.e. pile or open type, soil treatment if any etc. to be used
for the design of civil foundations.
The Contractor may visit the site to ascertain the soil parameters. Any variation in soil data
shall not constitute a valid reason for any additional cost & shall not affect the terms &
conditions of the contract. Field tests must be conducted covering entire substation area
including all the critical locations i.e. Control Room and other Buildings, Lightning Mast,
Towers, transformers etc.
sufficient quantity for chemical analysis to be carried out and shall be stored in air-tight
containers.
Prior to proceeding with the design work, design conditions or design values which shall
include other allowable stress, safety factor, load conditions and applicable standards, shall
be approved by the Employer.
The Contractor shall submit to the Employer for approval the Contractor's drawing,
structural and other calculation sheets, bill of materials, construction method and schedule
for the construction of civil works.
In case modification of detailed design of civil work is required, the Contractor shall
promptly inform the Employer and shall submit modified drawings to the Employer for
approval.
No separate or direct payment will be made to the Contractor for design works. All costs
incurred in connections therewith shall be included in the unit/lump sum bid prices for the
construction of various structures, foundations, etc.
c. After compaction, the second spraying of chemical compound shall be done and
allowed at least 24 hours before the first application of surfacing is spread thereon. In
case of rain during spraying, the chemical compound shall be re-sprayed.
d. The first application of surfacing shall be spread uniformly with a layer of 1/2 inches
(13mm) size aggregate approximately 40mm thick.
e. After the first application of surfacing has been applied, the third spraying of chemical
compound shall be taken on the layer of 1/2 inches (13mm) size aggregate. However,
the chemical compound shall be re-sprayed in case of rain during spraying.
f. The aggregate for the second application of surfacing shall be composed of one part of
1 inch (25mm) size aggregate and two parts of 2 inches (50mm) size aggregate by loose
volume and shall be mixed on the switchyard area before spreading. The thickness of
the second application shall be 60mm to furnish a total thickness of 100mm of
surfacing.
g. After spreading of second surfacing, the fourth spraying of chemical compound shall be
applied throughout the whole area of surfacing. As in previous sprayings, the
application of chemical compound shall be re-taken in case of rain during spray. The
thickness of the third course surfacing shall be 50mm to furnish a total thickness of
150mmof the surfacing.
6.3 Payment
Measurements for payment for Contract item "Crushed Rock Surfacing" shall be on square
meters of crushed stone furnished and placed in accordance with Specifications, as shown
on the drawings or as directed by the Employer and shall be measured net by deducting area
covered by permanent structure and fixtures.
Payment for the Contract item "Crushed Rock Surfacing" will be made at the unit price per
square meter bid. Therefore, in the Price Schedule, unit price shall include full compensation
for all costs incurred in furnishing all materials and all other operations related to the fill
including but not limited to:
a) Obtaining and application of chemicals
b) Obtaining materials (crushed rock) from the Employer's approved source
c) Transporting materials to job site from source, to temporary stockpiles and/or to point
of final disposition
d) Placing and spreading material
Bearing loads
The Contractor shall use an ultimate soil bearing pressure of 2.0 kg/sq.cm for the design of
the foundation for the purpose of bidding, but this is only reference value. After award of the
Contract, the Contractor shall carryout geotechnical exploration works based on which the
RCC foundations shall be designed by the Contractor. There may be variation in the volume
of work in final design as compared to the bidding design, for which the Contractor will not
get any extra payment.
Oil Containment
The transformer foundations shall be designed with oil containment systems meeting the
following requirements:
Total Capacity – 100 percent of total transformer oil
Calculated Volume – Based on void ratio of stone fill
Stone Fill – Stone fill shall consist of crushed granite, gneiss of equal 50 to 75 mm in size.
Water drainage shall be provided to connect the oil containment to the oil sump of
appropriate size and overflow from the oil sump shall be connected to the switchyard
drainage system in accordance with the drawings and as directed by the Employer/Engineer.
No separate or direct payment will be made to the Contractor for oil containment, oil sump
and fire walls. All costs incurred in connection therewith shall be included in the unit price
for the concrete foundation for 63 MVA Power Transformers.
7.1.2 Details.
Detail Calculation. Detail calculations for each type of foundation shall be submitted to the
Employer for approval. Such details shall show the following requirements:
1. Calculation of loads acting on foundation under different conditions.
2. Calculated safety factor for each type of stability and condition.
3. Maximum stresses in concrete and in steel reinforcement at any critical section.
Detail Drawings.
Details of each type of foundation submitted for Employer's approval shall be as shown on
the approved design drawings and shall conform to the requirements described hereafter. No
change shall be made without the written approval of Employer. The detail drawings shall at
least include:
1. Detail dimensions of foundation.
2. Detail dimensions of anchor bolts, template settings etc in the foundations.
3. Details of placing of all reinforcing steel which shall conform to the Building Code
Requirements for Reinforced Concrete (ACI 318) and the Manual of Standard
Practice of Detailing Reinforced Concrete Structure (ACI 315) unless otherwise as
specified herein.
4. Details of type, size and length of each reinforcing steel including details of bar
bending schedule.
7.2.1 Excavation
Excavation shall conform to the dimensions and elevations as shown on the approved
drawings. The general cut slope shall not be steeper than 1: 1.5; however, where the
Contractor shall not excavate the slope to satisfy the condition above, temporary supports to
the sides of excavations shall be required by means of timbering, sheet piling or shoring.
When foundations rest on an excavated surface other than rock, special care shall be taken
not to disturb the bottom of the excavation. When subsoil for foundations become mucky on
top due to construction operation or any other reason, such subsoil shall be removed and
replaced by one or more layers of compacted sand or compacted crushed rock, as directed
by the Employer.
Excavated materials, suitable for use as backfill, shall be deposited by the Contractor in
storage piles at the area approved by the Employer. However, surplus excavated materials
shall also be hauled and transported to the disposal area designated by the Employer.
Payment:
No separate or direct payment will be made to the Contractor for earthwork in excavation of
foundation works. All costs incurred in connection therewith shall be included in the unit bid
prices for the construction of the various foundations and other civil works.
7.2.2 Dewatering
This specification covers the general requirements of dewatering excavations in general. All
excavations shall be kept free of water. Grading in the vicinity of excavations shall be
controlled to prevent surface water running into excavated areas.
The Contractor shall remove, by pumping or other means approved by the Employer, any
water inclusive of rainwater and subsoil water accumulated in excavation and keep all
excavations/trenches free of water required for further work.
The Employer shall approve the method of pumping; but in any case, the pumping
arrangement shall be such that there shall be no movement of subsoil or blowing in due to
differential head of water during pumping. Pumping arrangements shall be adequate to
ensure no delays in construction.
When there is a continuous inflow of water and quantum of water to be handled is
considered, in the opinion of the Employer, as large, well point system (dewatering), single
stage or multistage shall be adopted. The Contractor shall submit to the Employer his
scheme of well point system including the stages, the spacing number and diameter of well-
points, headers, etc., and the number, capacity and location of pumps for approval.
Payment:
No separate or direct payment will be made to the Contractor for dewatering of foundation
works. All costs incurred in connection therewith shall be included in the unit bid prices for
the construction of the various foundations and other civil works.
which in turn shall be suitably strutted. The lowest boards supporting the sides of the trench
or pit shall remain exposed, so as to render the earth liable to slip out.
Timber shoring shall be 'close' or 'open' type, depending on the nature of soil and the depth
of pit. The type of timbering shall be as approved by the Employer. It shall be the
responsibility of the Contractor to take all necessary steps to prevent the sides of
excavations, pits, etc., from collapsing.
Timber shoring may be required to keep the sides of excavations vertical to ensure safety of
adjoining structures, or to limit the slope of excavations, or due to space restrictions or for
other reasons. Such shoring shall be carried out, except in an emergency, only under
instructions from the Employer.
Payment:
No separate payment will be made to the Contractor for timber shoring. All costs incurred in
connection therewith shall be included in the unit bid prices for the construction of the
various foundation types and other civil works.
7.2.4 Backfill
The Contractor shall place and compact the backfill materials to the lines, grades and
dimensions to be shown on the approved drawings. The materials to be used for backfill, the
amount thereof and the manner of depositing the materials shall be approved by the
Employer.
Payment:
No separate or direct payment will be made to the Contractor for earthwork in foundations.
All costs incurred in connections therewith shall be included in the unit/lump sum bid prices
for the construction of various foundations, etc.
Soling Layer
Soling layer of mixed gravel or pebble of 10 cm thickness shall be used under lean concrete
layer of all foundations.
Lean Concrete
Lean concrete of minimum 5 cm. thickness (7.5 cm for tower and gantries) shall be used
under all foundations with the ratio of cement: fine aggregate: coarse aggregate equal to
1:3:5 (by volume).
7.3.2 Cement
Quality
The Contractor shall furnish Ordinary Portland Cement (OPC) in fifty (50) kg net-weight
sacks. The cement for the civil work shall conform to the requirements of "Portland cement,
Type I" designated in ASTM C150.Where conditions require the use of high sulphate
resistance cement, cement conforming to the requirements of ASTM CISO Type V shall be
used without any cost to Employer.
The fine aggregate as batched shall be well graded, and when tested shall conform to the
following limits:
Sieve size Percentage Passing By Wt.
9.51mm (3/8 inch) 100
4.76 mm (No.4) 95 to 100
2.38 mm (No.8) 80 to 100
1.19 mm (No.16) 50 to 85
595 micron (No.30) 25 to 60
297 micron (No.50) 10 to 30
149 micron (No.100) 2 to 10
7.3.5 Admixture
The Contractor shall use admixture, if required, listed below in order to improve the quality
of concrete or mortar such as workability and finish ability and water tightness.
Air entraining agent ASTM C260
Water reducing and set retarding agent ASTM C494
Plasticizer
The cost of the material and all costs incidental to their use shall be included in the unit price
bid in the Price Schedule for concrete in which the materials are used.
Placing
After the surface of unformed construction joint has been cleaned and the placing of
concrete has been approved by the Employer in accordance with the provisions of the
preceding Sub articles, surface of unformed construction joint shall be covered with a layer
of mortar approximately 1.5 cm thick. The Contractor shall place concrete upon the fresh
mortar before it begins to set. The mortar shall be of richer cement content than the concrete
without coarse aggregate. The cost of the mortar shall be included in the unit bid price for
the foundation lot.
Concrete shall be deposited in all cases, as nearly as practicable, directly in its final position
and shall not be caused to flow such that it will permit lateral movement or cause
segregation of the coarse aggregate, mortar or water from the concrete mass.
Consolidation
Immediately after placing, every layer of concrete shall be consolidated to the maximum
practicable density so that it closes snugly against all surfaces of reinforcement bars and
embedded fixtures and against all corners of the forms. Consolidation of concrete shall be
done by electric or pneumatic power driven, immersion type vibrators or other approved
means.
7.3.10 Curing
Prior to placing concrete, the Contractor shall obtain Employer's approval in respect of the
method to protect and cure concrete and the facilities he proposes to use. After concrete has
been placed, it shall be protected and cured strictly in accordance with the method approved
by the Employer.
All costs for the curing of concrete shall be included in the unit price bid for foundation lot.
7.3.11 Forms.
General Conditions
Forms shall be used, wherever necessary, to confine and shape the concrete to the required
lines, and as directed by the Employer. Forms shall have sufficient strength to withstand the
pressure resulting from placing and vibrating of the concrete, and shall be maintained rigidly
in positions. Forms shall be sufficiently tight to prevent loss of mortar from the concrete.
Each form shall be so prepared that each section may be removed individually without
injuring the concrete.
The costs of all labor and materials for forms and for any necessary treatment of coating of
forms shall be included in the unit price bid for foundation lot, for which the forms are to be
used. No separate payment will be made for form.
Removal of Forms. Forms shall not be removed without the approval of the Employer. As a
rule, the forms shall be removed at the following minimum times after concrete has been
placed:
Side forms of column and walls 2 days (48 Hours)
Supporting forms of floors and beams 28 days
7.3.12 Grouting
Grouting for seating structural steel members and equipment on foundations shall be non-
shrink (not-setting) Portland cement mortar grout, or a suitable commercially available
grout, at the Contractor's option. Grouting shall be done under pressure by means of an
expanding agent or by means of a static head. Proportioning and mixing of grout shall
conform to the following:
(a) Mortar grout containing aluminum powder as an expansive agent, mixture of 1 part
cement and 2 parts sand, by weight, with a water-cement ratio not exceeding 0.55.
The quantity of aluminum powder used shall be approximately 0.005 percent of the
weight of cement, the actual quantity to be determined from tests with materials to be
used, and at the temperature and under the conditions of placement. Aluminum
powder shall be blended with cement in proportions of one part powder to 50 parts
cement, by weight, and the blend shall be sprinkled over the dry batch. After all
ingredients are added, the batch shall be mixed for 3 minutes. Grout, which has not
been placed within 45 minutes, shall be wasted/rejected.
(b) In lieu of use of an expansive agent, settlement shall be reduced by extending the
mixing period or by delaying final mixture to minimize the interval between time of
placement and initial set and placement the under static header pressure. The mortar
grout shall be a mixture of one part cement and 2.5 parts sand, with a minimum
necessary, to enable placement.
Payment:
No separate or direct payment will be made to the Contractor for Grouting. All costs
incurred in connection therewith shall be included in the unit bid price for the construction
of various foundation types.
7.3.13 Tests.
The Contractor shall make all necessary tests for determining the mixed proportions of each
type of concrete, including tests of aggregates, so as to produce the concrete specified in
item 7.3.1
In order to control the quality of concrete to be placed, the Contractor shall perform the
following field tests:
Slump Test
A slump test will be made from each of the first three batches mixed each day. An additional
slump test will be made for each additional 40 cubic meters of concrete placed in any one
day. Slump will be determined in accordance with ASTM C 143.
Compression Test
Three sets of three concrete compression test cubes/ cylinders will be made each day when
concrete is placed or as directed by the Employer. One set of each group will be tested at an
age of 7 days and the other set will be tested at an age of 28 days. The third set will be an
extra set to be tested only if needed. If the compressive strength indicates a compressive
strength of less than 210 kg/sq.cm. Employer will determine what remedial measures are
necessary and the Contractor shall perform these remedial measures at his own expense.
Concrete test cubes/cylinders will be made, cured, and stored in accordance with ASTM
C31. Concrete cubes/cylinders will be tested in accordance with ASTM C39.
No separate or direct payment will be made to the Contractor for tests. All costs for the tests
shall be included in the unit bid price for the construction of various foundation types.
8.2 Materials
The materials shall conform to the following requirements as regards to the quality of steel
used for support members:
Item Description Unit Minimum Value
1.1 Mild steel Grade E250 to ISO630 or equivalent
(a) Tensile strength kg/mm2 24
(b) Yield strength kg/mm2 14
b) Human Load
240 kg at the center of the beam.
c) Load due to conductor and weight of equipment and accessories:
Load due to the ACSR CARDINAL conductor shall be wind load, dead weight and short
circuit forces.
Weight of equipment including insulator string shall be according to actual installation.
Normal Working Condition
The normal working condition for various loads shall be deemed to work simultaneously.
The take off structures shall be subjected to a vertical uplift of 500 kg at each supporting
point of overhead ground wire and conductor. The tension for conductor and ground wire
will be 750 and 350 kg respectively and angle of deviation will be 150.
Combination of loads
The Contractor shall calculate the maximum and minimum stresses at any combinations of
loading conditions.
Safety Factors
The safety factors shall be not less than two (2) times that the normal working conditions
and 1.5 in combination with short circuit forces.
Design and Ultimate Stresses Allowed in Design
For tensile members of steel structures the design stresses shall not exceed the yield point of
materials even under test loading conditions. For compressive members, the design stresses
shall not exceed the value of the ultimate buckling stress.
Ultimate stress allowed in design shall be as follows:
Members
Buckling: As per ASCE Manuals and Reports on Engineering Practice No. 52.
Tension: less than 1.00 Fy
Bearing: Less than 1.80 Fy
Bolts
Shear: less than 0.60 Fu
Bearing: less than 1.00 Fu
All other stressed members and secondary Not less than 40mm x 4mm
member
In computing the net section of tension members, the diameter of the boltholes shall be
taken as 3.0 mm greater than the nominal diameter of the bolts. Net section on both straight
and zigzag sections across the members shall be as specified in ASCE or BS.
Connections
a. Bolts: All connections shall be bolted and all stressed members shall be connected by
at least one (1) bolt. For structural connections, a maximum of two bolt sizes may be
used for each tower type, provided the quantity of each size is not less than 20 per
cent of the total requirement for the tower and the bolts in any one connection are
uniform in size.
b. Splices: The number of splices shall be practically minimum. Splices shall develop
the maximum stress in member or seventy (70%) per cent of compressive strength of
gross section or tensile stress of net section. No credit shall be allowed for bearing on
abutting areas.
Calculations showing:
a. Total stresses in each member for each loading case and the critical case.
b. The effective slenderness ratio, calculated stress ratio of maximum total stress to
calculated stress for each member and strength of connection.
c. The estimated weight of the complete galvanized steel structures.
d. Size and type of steel for each member and number of bolts required for its
connection.
e. The compression and uplift reactions and corresponding horizontal shears at each leg
of all steel structures (column and equipment supports) for all loading cases.
8.4 Detailing
Detailing shall be as follows:
General
Steel structure dimensions, framing, member sizes and length, number, size and length of
bolts, thickness of each filler, and other necessary details to fabricate each piece shall be
shown on the approved detail drawings. No change shall be made without the written
approval of Employer.
All web members shall be in one piece where practicable. All double-diagonal web system
members shall be connected at their point of intersection by at least one bolt.
Step Bolts
Step bolts shall be of 16 mm diameter and shall have round or hexagonal head. Each step
bolt shall be provided with two hexagonal nuts. The minimum bolt length and length of
unthreaded portion shall be 180 and 125 mm respectively. Step bolts shall not be used as
connection bolts.
The step bolts shall be spaced alternately on the inner gauge line on each face of the angle
about 40 cm centers. They shall be furnished for one leg of each steel tower from the base
elevation of the steel tower.
Step bolts for lattice single pole or H frames are not required.
U Bolts
U bolts shall be suitably furnished on steel structures to suspend or terminate insulator
strings or ground wire assemblies. Size of U bolts shall withstand all loads acting on it.
Detail Drawings
Detail drawings shall be complete with sizes and detail dimensions of all steel structure
members. At each joint, there shall be the number, size and length of bolts, number and size
of fillers and detail dimensions of gusset plate, if any.
Bill of Material
Bill of materials shall give the size length and galvanized weight of each member and the
total weights of steel structures. It shall also include the number of bolts, nuts and washer
per structure.
8.5 Fabrications
Workmanship
Workmanship shall be first class throughout. All pieces must be straight, true to detail
drawings and free from lamination flaws and other defects. All clipping, back cuts,
grindings, bends, holes and etc. must be true to detail drawings and free of burrs.
All identical pieces bearing the same erection number must be exactly interchangeable with
each other and interchangeable in their relative position in all towers or structures of which
they form a part.
Threads of bolts and nuts shall be cleanly rolled or cut and the face and head of nut shall be
truly at right angle to the axis of the bolt.
b. Galvanizing:
All materials shall be hot dip galvanized after fabrication and cleaning. Retapping of
nuts after galvanizing is not required.
Galvanizing for structural mild steel products shall meet the requirements of ASTM
A123. All holes in materials shall be free of excess shelter after galvanizing.
Galvanizing for bolts, nuts, washers, lock nuts, step bolts and similar hardware shall
meet requirements of ASTM A153. Excess shelter on bolts, nuts, washers, locknuts,
step bolts and similar hardwares shall be removed by appropriate means acceptable
to the Employer.
Finished materials shall be dipped into the solution of dichromate after galvanizing
for white rust protection during sea transportation.
c. Uniformity of Coating:
The uniformity of coating test shall be made in accordance with ASTM A239. The
minimum repetition times for one minute dip in uniformity test shall be as follows:
Steel shapes and plates......................... 6
Bolts, nuts and similar hardware............4
Materials on which galvanizing has been damaged, shall be acid stripped and re-
galvanized, unless, in the opinion of Employer, the damage is local and can be
repaired by zinc spraying or by applying a coating of galvanizing repair compound.
Where re-galvanizing is required, any member which becomes damaged after having
been dipped twice shall be rejected.
f. Shop Assembly:
One of each type of steel structures shall be assembled in the shop to such an extent
as to insure proper field erection. Reaming of untrue holes will not be permitted. A
reasonable amount of drifting will be allowed in assembling. Shop assembled parts
shall be dismantled for shipment.
8.7 Payment
Payment for the Contract item “Steel Structures” will be made at the unit/lump sum price
per steel structures type bid. Therefore, in the Price Schedule, such unit/lump sum price shall
include full compensation for all costs incurred in furnishing all materials, equipment and
labor and all other operations related to steel structure design, fabrication, installation etc.
The rooms within the control building shall have area sufficient to install the equipment
supposed to be installed (including for the spare bays) with adequate space for service. In
any case the plinth area shall not be less than 320 Sq.m. and clear height (below false
ceiling) not less than 3.5 m height.
No separate or direct payment will be made to the Contractor for 'Excavation and
Backfilling works' separately. All costs incurred in connection therewith shall be included in
the unit bid price for the construction of the control building.
(c) Lay brick in running bond with joints approximately 10mm wide.
(d) When brick masonry walls cross the recessed floor cable trenches provide and install
cast-in-situ concrete lintels of sufficient size and strength to support and carry
masonry walls across the trench sprays.
(e) Reinforce all masonry walls with cast-in-situ reinforced concrete formed flush with
the masonry surfaces for cement plaster-finish.
(f) Provide concrete pilasters and horizontal tie for every 9 square meters of masonry
wall surface, plus at all corners and door jambs.
(g) Size of Wall
i) The entire periphery wall shall be constructed in 360mmthickness.
ii) The entire partition wall shall be constructed in 240mm and 110mm thickness.
But the latter one shall be constructed at less than 2.0 m span only.
9.6.4 Curing
Spray masonry surfaces with water twice daily for a period of 10 days, or until the surface
receives a plaster finish.
9.6.5 Protection
Where exposed to weather, protect top of masonry with water tied material in such a way
that it will protect the completed work. Masonry wall shall set for 48 hours before any load
is applied on the completed work.
Payment
No separate or direct payment will be made to the Contractor for 'Brick Masonry Work'
separately. All costs incurred in connection therewith shall be included in the unit bid price
for the construction of the control building.
9.7 Flooring
9.7.1 Scope of Work
Perform all flooring work required as per drawings and as specified herein.
1) Glazed ceramic tile shall be used for the flooring of battery room, kitchen and bath
room, and their size shall not be less than 30 x 30 x 0.9 cm. The size of ceramic tile
skirting shall not be less than 30 x 12 x 0.9 cm.
2) Cast in situ mosaic flooring shall be used for all other rooms in control building (i.e.
132kV control room,33 kV control room, equipment rooms (communication room),
corridor and other circulation areas and front entrance petty of control building). Mosaic
Skirting shall not be less than 10cm high. Mosaic Floor shall be prepared with 12.5mm
plaster in 1:2 cement mortar in bottom layer and 6mm thick white cement and marble
chips 1:1 in top layer including rubbing and polishing.
Construction
(a) Preparation of earth
The earth is properly rammed and leveled by rammer, before gravel soling, water is
sprinkled during ramming.
(b) Gravel Soling
Above the rammed earth well graded gravel is laid and coarse sand is spread over the
gravel bed. Water is sprinkled and compaction is done properly. The top surface is
properly leveled and compacted before concrete laying.
(c) Concrete Laying
Concrete work shall be done as specified under Concrete and Foundation works.
The flooring shall consist of minimum (For each square meter)
(b) Installation
Joints shall be straight, level, perpendicular, and of even width not exceeding 1.6mm.
Wainscots shall be built of full courses. That may extend to a greater height but in no
case lower than the height shown.
Vertical joints shall be maintained plumb for the entire height of the tile work.
Damaged or defective tiles shall be replaced.
Setting bed of ceramic tile shall be of cement sand mortar 1:1 of 10mm thickness.
The entire joint shall be provided with white cement.
(c) Grouting
Tiles shall have the edges wetted and shall be grouted full with a plastic mix of neat,
white cement immediately after a suitable area of tiles has been set. The joints shall
be tooled slightly concave, and the excess mortar shall be cut off and wiped from the
face of the tiles. Interstices or depression left in the mortar joints after the grout has
been cleaned from the surface shall be roughened at once and filled to the spring line
of the cushion edge before the mortar begins to harden.
(d) Cleaning and Protecting
Upon completion, wall surfaces shall be thoroughly cleaned. Acid shall not be used
for cleaning of glazed tiles. After the grout has set, tile wall surfaces shall be given a
protective coat of a non-corrosive soap or other approved methods of protection.
(e) Samples
Samples of materials proposed for use shall be submitted to the Employer for
approval before materials represented by the samples are delivered to the site.
Payment
No separate or direct payment will be made to the Contractor for 'Tile Works' separately. All
costs incurred in connection therewith shall be included in the unit bid price for the
construction of the control building.
No separate or direct payment will be made to the Contractor for 'Flooring Concrete'
separately. All costs incurred in connection therewith shall be included in the unit bid price
for the construction of the control building.
9.8.2 Construction
(a) Thickness of Plaster
Thickness of plaster from the face of the plaster base to the finish plaster surface shall
be 20 mm.
Should it be necessary, the Employer can require that temporary metal grounds be used
to assure a full true finish surface. Voids left by removal of ground shall be filled flush
with plaster.
(b) Preparation for Plastering
Concrete surfaces shall be thoroughly cleaned and free of paint, efflorescence, oil,
grease, acids and other loose or foreign matter prior to application of base coats.
No plasterwork shall be applied on masonry works less than 2 weeks old.
(c) Mortar
Mortar shall consist of one part Portland cement and two parts of sand.
(d) Sand
Sand shall be hard, clean, and free from mud and other material not desirable for setting
mortar.
(e) Cement
Cement shall be as specified in Concrete and Foundation works.
(f) Water
Water shall be fresh, clean and free from acids, alkali, sewage and other organic matter.
(g) Installation
(1) Setting Beds
Setting beds shall be composed by volume of 1 part Portland cement to 2 parts damp
sand, and mixed with the minimum amount of water necessary to produce a workable
mass.
Areas of setting bed spread at one time shall be only as large as can be covered with
tiles before the mortar has obtained its initial set. Surplus mortar shall be removed.
Setting beds shall be spread and tampered to force out air pockets screened to a true
plane, and sloped to drain or leveled as required.
The average thickness of setting bed in any room or space shall be less than 30 mm, but
in no case shall the setting beds be less than 20mm or more than 30 mm thick.
(2) Mixing of Plaster
Plaster shall be mixed in mechanical mixers where hand mixing is approved for small
quantities. Caked, or lamped material shall not be used. Each batch shall be
proportioned by volume, accurately measured by manual or mechanical devices, and
thoroughly mixed with the minimum amount of water until uniformity in color and
consistency is obtained. Retempering will not be permitted and plaster that has begun to
stiffen shall be discarded. Mortar 90 minutes after mixing shall be rejected for the
plastering work.
(3) Proportions
These are to be differentiated into 2 types:
(a) 1: 3 by ratio (to be used on all external walls, ceiling and floors) (b)
1: 4 by ratio (to be used everywhere else)
(4) Plastering
Plaster shall be done in two coatings, both shall be proportioned as mentioned above
but sand to be used in the finish coating shall be of the finest grade.
The first coating shall be applied with a spatter-dash, which is to be done by forcibly
throwing the wet mix on the surface and making no attempt to level it.
The second coating will be applied after the first coating has hardened. After this, a wet
soaked sponge shall be rubbed on the finish surface.
Payment
No separate or direct payment will be made to the Contractor for 'Plastering' separately. All
costs incurred in connection therewith shall be included in the unit bid price for the
construction of the control building.
shall be of size and design to suit the window assembly, be compatible with the
windows, and conform with the requirements for these sub-assemblies as specified in
Section 1, General Requirements, Part A, in ANSI A134.1.
(d) Anchors and Clips
Anchors, clips, bolt and screws necessary to secure doors, windows and mullions
shall be provided and shall be, at manufacturer's option, either aluminum non-
magnetic stainless steel, or zinc coated steel.
(e) Installation
Doors, windows and louvers shall be installed without forcing or distortion so that
sills and heads are level and jambs are plumb.
Window frames shall be securely anchored into the supporting construction. Joints
between metal windows and metal members including mullions shall be set in mastic
of the type recommended by the window manufacturer. Excess mastic shall be
removed before hardening. Metal surface shall be cleaned and any staining or
discoloring of the finish shall be restored or the unit replaced.
9.9.2 Carpentry
Materials
Lumber shall be subjected to Employer's approval.
(a) Salwood
(1) Sizes and Pattern
Lumber shall be surfaced- four-sides, and worked according to patterns as are
indicated or specified on the drawings. Exposed members for transparent finish shall
be matched for compatibility of grain and color between adjoining members; for paint
finish, is not required.
(c) Veneers
Veneers on wood doors, panels and other exposed wood works shall be of 4mm
thick.
The Bidder shall furnish satisfactorily functioning installations. All items of labor,
material of equipment not specifically mentioned herein, but incidental to or required
for a complete installation and proper operation of the above-mentioned systems,
shall be included.
Payment
No separate or direct payment will be made to the Contractor for 'Doors and windows'
separately. All costs incurred in connection therewith shall be included in the unit bid price
for the construction of the control building.
9.10.1 General
Any materials to be used for false ceiling works under this Contract shall be of such quality
and properties as to withstand the extreme climatic weather conditions of local regions,
particularly the high ambient temperatures.
The Contractor shall furnish samples and catalogues, certificates from acceptable
manufacturer on all materials, stating its conformity with the specified quality and test
results.
9.12 Paint
All surfaces shall be painted except the following:
(a) Exterior:Roofing, paving, concrete, nonferrous metals, glass, pre-finished items.
(b) Interior:Ceramic tile, glass, pre-finished surfaces, non-ferrous metals, stainless steel,
attic surfaces.
Scope
i) Control rooms, Communication room, office rooms, corridors etc. shall be finished
with 1 coat of Plaster of Paris/wall putting, two coats of cement primer whitening
and filling up and finally 2 coats of acrylic emulsion.
ii) All other interior and exterior plastered surface excluding mentioned above shall be
finished with one coat of cement primer and two coats of acrylic emulsion.
iii) Gloss finish woodwork shall be finished with 1 coat of wood primer and finally 2
coats of synthetic super gloss.
iv) Interior transparent finish wood shall be finished with 1 coat of wood primer and 2
coats of teak oil.
v) Metal Surfaces shall be finished with 1 coat of metal primer chromate and 2 coats of
aluminum paint
Materials
A list of the painting materials and their colors which are to be applied to the specified
surfaces shall be submitted to the Employer for approval.
Paint Application
The finished surface shall be free from runs, drops, ridges, waves, pales, brush marks, and
variations in color, texture, and finish. The hiding shall be complete, and coat shall be so
applied as to produce firm of uniform thickness. Special attention shall be given to insure
that all surfaces including edges, corners, crevices, welds, and rivets receive a film thickness
equivalent to that of adjacent painted surfaces.
Adjacent areas and installations shall be protected by the use of drop clothes or other
approved precautionary measures.
Metal or wood surfaces adjacent to surface to receive water-thinned paints shall be primed
and/or touched up prior to the application of water-thinned paints. The first coat on plaster
shall include such repeated touching up of suction spots or overall applications of primer
sealer as necessary to produce a uniform color and gloss. The first coat on both faces of
wood doors shall be applied at essentially the same time.
(a) Coating Progress
Sufficient time shall elapse between successive coats to permit proper drying. This
period shall be modified as necessary to suit adverse weather conditions.
Oil base or oleo-resinous solvent-type paints shall be considered dry for recoating
when the paints feel firm, does not deform or feel sticky under moderate pressure of
the thumb, and the application of another coat of paint does not cause lifting or less
of adhesion of the undercoat.
At time of application, paint shall show no signs of hard settling, excessive skinning,
livering, or other deterioration. Paint shall be thoroughly stirred, strained, and kept at
a uniform consistency during application.
Where necessary to suit conditions of surface, temperature, weather, and method of
application, package paint may be thinned immediately prior to application in
accordance with the manufacturer's directions, but not excess of 0.5 liter of suitable
thinner per 4 liter. The use of thinner for any reason shall not relieve Contractor from
obtaining complete hiding.
Samples shall be clearly identified by designated name, specification number, batch
number, project Contract number, intended use, and quantity involved. At the
discretion of the Employer, samples may be tested before approval, or materials may
be approved for use based on the test reports furnished. In the latter case, the samples
will be retained by the Employer for possible future testing should the material
appear to be defective during or after application.
Payment:
No separate or direct payment will be made to the Contractor for 'Paint and Glazing'
separately. All costs incurred in connection therewith shall be included in the unit bid price
for the construction of the control building.
Payment:
No separate or direct payment will be made to the Contractor for 'Glass and Glazing'
separately. All costs incurred in connection therewith shall be included in the unit bid price
for the construction of the control building.
Design Criteria
(a) Cooling/Heating Load Calculations
(1) Contractor shall calculate the cooling loads independently based on actual
equipment heat load, lighting load, occupancy load, solar heat gain, transmission
heat gain, duct heat gain, etc. Heat energy imparted by the supply fan and the drive
motor shall be considered for the cooling load estimation.
(2) Cooling loads at different hours of the day shall be estimated and the maximum load
shall be used to determine the size of units.
(b) Equipment Sizing
(1) Cooling Coil Capacity of the packaged air conditioner shall be selected on the basis
of total sensible and latent heat loads. A 10% margin shall be provided over the
calculated cooling load.
(2) For sizing of all fans, a minimum of 10% margin shall be provided over calculated
capacity and a minimum of 5% margin shall be provided in static pressure over
calculated pressure drop.
(c) General
All penetration through the walls shall be well sealed.
(b) Set of roof exhausters with back draft dampers, rain hoods, bird screens, etc. wherever
required.
(c) Insulation for the equipment, piping and air ducting.
(d) Unit mounted control panel.
(e) Installation, testing and commissioning of all equipment and systems.
(f) Supply of special tools and tackles.
(g) Supply of spare parts.
(h) Set of Central air conditioner system.
(f) Filter
Medium efficiency, throw away type 50mm thick fiberglass filter, shall be provided in
the air path before the cooling coils in a draw-through construction to filter out the lint
and other particles from the return air. The filter shall have an efficiency of 40%
minimum. The filter shall be easily accessible for removal and replacement.
(g) Compressor
The compressor shall be hermetic or semi-hermetic, reciprocating type operating on R-
22 refrigerant.
(h) Condenser
(1) The condenser shall be complete with supporting casing with stand, and cooling
fans vibration isolator.
(2) Condenser fans shall be direct driven statically and dynamically balanced with
vertical or horizontal discharge. Fan motors shall be weatherproof totally
enclosed type with permanently lubricated ball bearings. The condenser shall be
enclosed in an 1.2 mm (minimum) hot dipped galvanized steel sheet metal
enclosure, adequately reinforced and braced, with factory mounted
grilles/louvers to provide protection to coil surface and other unit components
from exterior damage. The enclosure shall be provided with access panels as
required and shall be painted with rust- inhibitive coating.
Exhaust Fans
(a) All exhausters shall be axial flow types.
(b) The fan impeller shall be multi-blade, cast in one piece, finished all over and carefully
balanced both statically and dynamically. Finally the assembled rotor shall be
dynamically balanced. All axial flow fan impeller shall consist of high efficiency
aerofoil section blades.
(c) Material
In general, the fan impeller, casing, motor bracket, etc., shall be of mild steel. For the
battery room exhauster, all components coming in contact with the exhausted air/gas
shall be of stainless steel.
Duct Work
(d) All diffusers shall have vane assemblies. Inner vane assembly to be removable
without use of tools. The inner vane assembly shall be adjustable to provide proper air
distribution. All outlets to be selected to conform with NC-35 curve as explained in
ASHRAE Guide.
(e) All supply air diffusers and grilles shall be with air volume extractors where needed.
Return air grilles shall match supply air outlet in the area. The face bars shall be either
horizontal or vertical either 0 or 450. The damper blades shall be gang operated by
means of a key.
Electric Motor
(a) Motor shall be of constant speed, squirrel cage, 3 phase, induction type.
(b) Motors shall be capable of continuous operation at full load with an ambient
temperature of 45o C.
(c) Motors shall be rated for 400V, 3 phase, 50 Hz in a neutral grounded system.
(d) Installation
(1) Ductwork systems shall, in general, be installed in accordance with details and
recommendations of the SMACNA Duct Construction Standards.
(2) All ductwork shall be supported from the building structure. Supporting arrangement
shall be guided by SMACNA recommendations.
(3) Duct connections to fans or any other rotating or vibrating equipment shall be by
means of flexible connectors as per SMACNA details.
(4) However, use of flexible duct shall be kept to a minimum. Where it is essential or
required by design, the flexible ducts shall be non-collapsible type.
(e) Inspection
After the ductwork is installed, inspect it to make sure that:
(1) The general construction is of the type shown in the applicable SMACNA Duct
Construction Standards.
(2) All flexible connections are supplied and of the construction specified.
(3) All ducts, registers, diffusers and grilles are of the size and in the location shown on
the drawings.
(4) All elbows are of the size shown on the drawings and provided with vanes when
required.
(5) All joints are tight. All audible leaks shall be sealed.
(6) All ducts are supported as per the applicable SMACNA Duct Construction
Standards.
9.14.7 Testing
Shop Testing
All equipment and material shall be subjected to manufacturer's standard shop tests as per
relevant standards for various equipment.
Field Test
(a) Upon completion of the air conditioning system, capacities and general functional tests
shall be conducted at the expense of the Contractor. The tests shall demonstrate the
specified capacities of various pieces of equipment.
(b) All fans shall be run to demonstrate smooth operation without undue vibration in actual
position. Balancing required to be done in flows shall be completed as described under
balancing & Adjustments.
(c) All necessary instruments and temporary attachments as necessary for conducting the
tests shall be arranged by the Contractor.
9.15.2 Fixtures
The Contractor shall provide sanitary fixtures for control building (bathroom, toilet and
kitchen) using products of high quality. Employer shall approve the type, size color, etc.
Sanitary Fixtures should include, but not limited to,
One Western type WC (Commode) including integrated flushing unit, one ½ inch tap
and soap holder at bathroom in control building.
One Washbasin including soap holder, towel holder, mirror and a rack at toilet in control
building.
One shower and one tap point in toilets of control building
One dish wash basin with one heavy duty tap (quarter turn) at kitchen room in control
building.
Standards
The work shall be carried out in accordance with the latest revision of relevant standards.
Workmanship
The installation shall be made in neat, orderly and workmanlike manner, conforming in
every way to the accepted standards of the best commercial practice.
Payment:
No separate or direct payment will be made to the Contractor for 'Water Supply and
Plumbing & Sanitary Fixtures' separately. All costs incurred in connection therewith shall be
included in the unit bid price for the construction of the control building.
9.16.1 Furnitures
The Contractor shall provide furniture and office equipment for control building. Without
limiting the generality of the foregoing, the following shall be provided for the substation.
(a) Desk shall be approximately 1651mm x 746mm high, double pedestal, double wall
construction, and plastic laminate on steel top construction with glass top. Provide two (2)
sets.
(b) Two (2) sets of steel swivel chairs.
(c) One (1) set of minimum 4 shelves vertical filing cabinet.
(d) One (1) set of minimum 4 shelves drawing cabinet.
(e) Two (2) sets of electric clocks, quartz wall hung type.
(f) Two (2) sets of desk telephones
(g) One (1) Steel cupboard of six feet x four feet size.
(h) One set (1) 32 inch LED SMART TV SAMSUNG or LG or SONY or TOSHIBA make or
equivalent with dish home/city cable.
(i) One (1) automatic electric kittle with one (1) dozen cup set and (1) dozen plate.
(j) One (1) 1600 W Vacuum Cleaner.
(k) Kitchen pantry.
(l) One foldable aluminum/steel ladder for the maintenance of lighting fixture.
(m) One wall mounted steel ladder with door on roof.
Payment
No separate or direct payment will be made to the Contractor for Furnishing and
Miscellaneous Facilities separately. All costs incurred in connection therewith shall be
included in the unit bid price for the construction of the control building.
b) Concrete Pipes
Concrete pipes shall be of Np-3 class or equivalent in required size. Closed pipes
shall be used at road crossing.
The perforated type pipes of 150mm dia shall be used for switchyard area. Perforated
pipes shall be made of R.C.C hume pipe Np-2 class or equivalent. These pipes shall
be protected with screened gravel of 25mm-4-mm size.
c) Mortars for drainage channel shall be a mixture of cement and sand mortar with a
ratio of 1:3.
11.6 Payment
Payment for the Contract item "Drainage system" will be made at lump sum bid price.
Therefore, in the Price Schedule, the bid price shall include full compensation for all costs
incurred in furnishing all material, equipment and labor and other operations related to the
scope of work.
12. OUTDOOR CABLE TRENCH, DUCT BANK CONDUITS AND HAND HOLE.
12.4 Payment
Payment for the Contract item, "Cable Trenches", will be made at the lump sum bid price.
Therefore, in the Price Schedule, such lump sum price shall include full compensation for all
costs incurred in furnishing all materials, equipment and labor and all other operations
related to cable trench design and construction, including but not limited to:
a) Performing detail designs and preparation of construction drawings.
b) Supplying transporting all materials to job site.
c) Excavating and backfilling for the cable trenches
d) Constructing the cable trenches with floor drains, reinforced concrete wall, base, cable
tray and removable cover.
e) Providing road crossing conduit and conduit pipe at foundation block.
13.1 General.
The proposal shall include all miscellaneous outdoor facilities. The miscellaneous outdoor
facilities shall comprise of switchyard fence with entrance gate, road, etc.
Prior to execution of the works, the Contractor shall prepare and submit design and detailed
drawings of such works to Employer for approval. All works shall be executed in
accordance with the stipulations of the relevant articles of the Specifications.
Payment
Payment for the Contract item "Switchyard fence including entrance gate" shall be made at
lump sum bid price. Therefore, in the Price Schedule, the bid price shall include full
compensation for all costs incurred in procurement of all materials, structural steel supports,
Gates (double & single leaf), labor and all other operations, tools and tackles, and other
operations related to the scope of work.
16.1.1FIRE RESISTANCE
The firewall shall have a minimum fire resistance of 3 hours. The partitions, which are made
to reduce the noise level, shall have the same fire resistance. The walls of the building, which
are used as firewalls, shall also have a minimum fire resistance of 3 hours.The firewall shall
be designed to protect against the effect of radiant heat and flying debris from an adjacent fire.
16.1.2 DIMENSIONS
The firewall shall extend 600 mm on each side of the Transformer and 600 mm above the
conservator tank or safety vent.
These dimensions might be reduced in special cases, as per the approval of owner where
there is lack of space. A minimum of 2.0 meter clearance shall be provided between the
equipments (e.g. Transformer and firewalls).
The building walls, which act as firewalls, shall extend at least 1 m above the roof in order
to protect it.
16.1.3 MATERIALS
The firewall will be made of reinforced cement concrete as per the relevant IS/ BS/
equivalentInternational Standards.
No separate measurement and payment for fire wall/ partition wall shall be made.
17 PAYMENTS
17.1 Payment for Civil Works
Payment for the civil works shall be made on the basis of actual quantity approved by
Employer as shown on approved drawings. The method of measurement shall be of required
accuracy and shall be approved by Employer.
Payments will be made in the following manner:
a) Payment for the exploration work shall be made after the test results of all work have
been submitted to and approved by the Employer.
b) Payment for the items that can be measured shall be made on monthly progress basis
according to the unit cost quoted in the Price Schedule.
c) i) Payment against unit price for foundation work shall be made upon completion of
each foundation including setting, excavation, reinforcement concrete works and
backfilling complete.
ii) Payment against unit price for foundation work for slope protection works (gabion,
stone masonry etc.) shall be made upon completion of each foundation including
CHAPTER - 29
BUILDING AND MISCELLANEOUS WORKS
1. GENERAL NOTES
This specification covers the general requirements for exploration, design, manufacture,
factory test, supply, construction and field testing of staff quarter building, guard cum store
house building, substructure and superstructure of compound wall and gate, septic tanks,
soak pits, plinth protection works and other civil works on the substations.
The Contractor shall perform all the works to meet the requirements of these Specifications,
the attached drawings and all the relevant Articles in these Contract Documents.
a) The work shall be carried out according to the specifications whether specifically mentioned
in it or not. No extra in any form shall be paid unless it is definitely stated as an item in the
Bill of Quantities. Whenever the specifications are not given or ambiguous, the relevant
International Standards and further amendments or decision of the Employer/Engineer shall
be considered as final and binding.
b) The work shall be carried out simultaneously with the electrical, plumbing, sanitary and
other services and in cooperation with the contractors of the above services. The work shall
be carried on till it is completed satisfactorily along with the completion of essential portion
of other services. The contractor shall keep the other contractors informed well in advance
of the proposed program of the work so that the proposed work is not hindered. The
contractor shall further cooperate with other contractors in respect of any facilities required
by them e.g. making holes in shuttering for pipes, electric conduits, fan hooks etc. However,
nothing extra shall be admissible to him for such reasonable assistance and facilities
afforded to other contractors and the contractor shall be deemed to have taken factor into
consideration while quoting his rates.
c) The work shall be related to the drawings which the contractor is presumed to have studied.
All the engineering construction drawings as required for construction shall be prepared by
the Contractor and submitted to the employer for approval. Nothing extra will be paid for
preparation of construction drawing and any item because of its shape, location or other
difficult circumstances, even if the schedule makes no distinction as long as the item is
shown in the drawing.
d) The source of materials stated in the specifications are those from which materials are
generally available. However, materials not conforming to the specifications shall be
rejected even if they come from the stated sources. The contractor should satisfy himself that
sufficient quantity of material of acceptable specification is available from the stated or
other sources.
Where terms “Resident Engineer/Employer ", "Representative", "Contractor", "Works" etc.
are used, they shall have the meaning defined in the Conditions of Contract or defined in the
subsequent specification.
e) The requirements of specifications for the materials shall be fulfilled by the Contractor
without extra charge including transportation or any other taxes involved that is the item
rates quoted shall be deemed to have taken these into account.
f) "Owner" shall mean,
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV transmission Line Project
Grid Development Department
Transmission Directorate
Nepal Electricity Authority
2.2 Boards
A board of size of 1.5m x 1.0m shall be made and put at an approved place on the site. This
board shall be painted in approved colour with names of (a) The proposed construction and
owner (b) The Contractor (c) The Engineer/Employerand (d) any other specialist consultant,
as directed by the Employer/ Engineer. This shall be provided by the Employer/Engineer.
2.5 Trees
No trees shall be cut without prior permission. If any trees have to be cut, this shall form an
extra item. For the purpose of the specification a tree shall be defined as growth whose
circumference of the trunk at 300mm from the base is not less than 900mm.
2.10 Samples
Samples of each class of work required shall be submitted by the Contractor for the approval
of the Employer/ Engineerand after such approval these samples shall be deposited at a
place chosen by the Employer/ Engineer. The Contractor will be required to perform all
works under the contract in accordance with these approved samples.
2.12 Storage
Safe, dry and proper storage shall be provided for all materials, particularly for cement. The
capacity of the cement storage shall be equal to one-fourth of the total quantity to be used
but may not exceed 200 tones at the site of work.
3 MATERIALS
3.1 GENERAL
The materials supplied and used in the works shall comply with the requirements of these
Specifications. They shall be new, except as may be provided elsewhere in the Contract or
permitted by the Employer/ Engineer in writing. The materials shall be manufactured,
handled and used in a workmanlike manner to ensure completed work in accordance with
the Contract. Where an Indian Standard is specified, the latest version of the standard quoted
shall be considered to apply.
3.2 SOURCES
The source of materials should be selected and notified to the Employer/ Engineer and
approved by him. The use of any one kind or class of material from more than one source is
prohibited, except by written permission of the Employer/ Engineer. Such permission, if
granted, will set forth the conditions under which the change may be made. The source or
kind of materials shall not be changed at any time without written permission of the
Employer/ Engineer. If the product from any source proves unacceptable at any time, the
Contractor shall make such arrangements as may be necessary to assure acceptable material,
either by alterations in plant operations or by a change of source. Claims for increased costs
which may be occasioned by such alterations or changes will not be given consideration,
unless the source of the unacceptable material was designated in the Contract as a source of
material.
When any manufactured product, either new or used, is furnished by the owner, the location
at which such material will be delivered to the Contractor will be designated in the contract.
In such cases the contractor shall haul the materials from the designated delivery point to
point of use, and compensation for such hauling will be considered to be included in the
Contract unit price for placing the materials in the finished work.
4.2.1 Excavation
The foundation rafts etc. shall be excavated to the dimensions shown on the drawings and to
depth, at which in the opinion of the Employer/ Engineer stratum of good hard soil is
observed.
The excavation shall be carefully carried out to the levels, shapes and dimensions as
shownin the drawings or as directed by the Employer/ Engineer to receive the concrete
work. Should any of the excavation be taken down below the specified levels, the Contractor
shall fill in such excavation at his own expense with concrete well rammed in position until
it is brought upto the proper levels. Filling in with excavated materials will not be allowed
for this purpose. No extra charge will be given for the lift of the excavated materials upto
2.0m. The excavated earth shall be stacked at least 4m from the edge of foundation. The
Contractor, at his own cost, shall dispose off all surplus excavated soil as directed by the
Employer/ Engineer within a lead of 200m.
If foundations are made broader or longer than directed, the extra length and breadth shall be
filled in after the foundations are built with earth rammed hard, by the Contractor at his own
cost. The Contractor shall at his own expense and without extra charge, make provision for
all extra excavation in slope, pumping, dredging or bailing out water and these trenches shall
be kept free from water while the foundation work is in progress. The Contractor shall also
at his own cost remove such portions of boulders or rocks, as are required to make the
bottom of the trench horizontal and level. Nothing extra shall be admissible for pumping
and/or bailing out water unless otherwise taken separately in the Bill of Quantities.
The trenches, rafts shall be inspected by the Employer/ Engineer before the concrete is laid
therein, when the trench level shall be recorded. The filling in of side of trench excavations
can be done in not more than 0.15m layers. Each layer shall be well watered and rammed
hard before adding the next layer. Such fillings shall be brought up to the ground level
without extra charge and shall form part of the item of excavation.
4.2.4 Disposal
Disposal of the surplus earth shall be done within the site as directed by the Employer/
Engineer. Nothing extra shall be paid for such disposal within the lead of 200m. The earth
excavated shall be used for filling and terracing.
4.2.5 Measurement
Measurement shall be the product of the exact length and width of the lowest step of the
footings according to the drawing or the Employer/ Engineer's instructions and the depth
measured vertically. Where the ground is not level, average depth shall be taken. Rate shall
be inclusive of all the works described above.
4.3.1 Measurement
The measurement shall be taken for the consolidated thickness of earth/sand and paid in
cubic meter. Pit or stack measurement shall not be done for payment. Quantity of earth fill
under this item shall be calculated as the sum total of earth filling required in trenches
around foundations, over raft, under floors or any other filling less the total quantity
involved in foundation excavation. It shall include excavation of earth/sand, transportation,
screening if necessary, filling and the cost of labour etc. all complete.
5 CONCRETE WORK
5.1 Plain Cement Concrete (P.C.C.) WORKS
Providing and laying plain cement concrete excluding cost of formwork complete as
required
i) M10, PCC 1:3:6 (1cement: 3 sand: 6 stone aggregate)
ii) M15, PCC 1:2:4 (1cement: 2 sand: 4 stone aggregate)
5.1.1 Materials
Cement, sand and stone aggregate shall conform to the specifications as under plain Cement
Concrete work for RCC works.
5.1.2 Mixing
All proportions shall be by volume except cement which shall be proportioned by weight
and as specified. Mixing shall be done in a mechanical mixer as per specifications of
reinforced cement concrete work. However, in special cases, hand mixing may be allowed
by the Employer/ Engineer when the following procedure shall be adopted. The several
materials shall be accurately gauged in boxes and thoroughly mixed on a water tight
platform of adequate size, being turned over at least thrice till the color is uniform and then
twice wet. Water shall be added gradually and not more than necessary or specified by
Employer/ Engineer that much concrete shall be mixed which can be used within half an
hour. Each stack shall however be not larger than consuming one bag of cement. All such
stacks shall be placed distinct from each other.
5.1.3 Laying
Concrete shall be laid in horizontal layers of not more than 0.15 m thick and gently rammed.
5.1.4 Curing
After laying, the concrete shall be kept wet for seven days constantly by ponding. If cast in
hot weather, it shall be covered with gunny bags which shall be kept constantly wet. Other
work on concrete shall not start until 3 days after laying of concrete. Concrete curing shall
be done strictly for seven days. Any failure of keeping the concrete work in constant wet
condition,the work will be done by Employer/ Engineer and cost of above work shall be
deducted from Contractor's bill.
5.1.5 Measurement
Measurement shall be in cubic metre of exact length, breadth and depth. This shall be
exclusive of any form work required to complete the item. Rate shall include all materials
and labour.
6.1 Materials
The materials used in the works shall be of the qualities and kinds specified. Materials
delivered to the works shall be equal to the approved samples which shall be deposited with
the Employer/ Engineer at least 30 days before it is required for use in work. The quantity of
all necessary materials should be checked by the Employer/ Engineer for any casting.
Delivery shall be made sufficiently in advance of constructional requirements to enable
further samples to be selected and tested if so desired by the Employer/ Engineer. No
material shall be used in the works until approved. Materials failing to comply with the
approved samples and specification shall be immediately removed from the works at the
Contractor's Cost.
6.1.1 Water
Water used in mixing concrete shall be free from injurious amounts of oils, acids, alkalis,
organic materials or other deleterious substances. It should be clean as drinking water.
6.1.2 Cement
The cement shall be ordinary Portland cement of approved brand and manufacture and shall
comply in all respects with the I.S. 269-1967 for ordinary Portland Cement. It shall be
delivered on the site in packages with an unbroken seal fixed by the manufacturer and
plainly marked with the name of brand and the manufacture. It shall be stored in a dry place,
in regular piles not exceeding six bags high and in such a manner that it will be efficiently
protected from moisture and contamination, and that the consignments can be used up in the
order in which they are received. Set cement shall be immediately removed from the work
and replaced by the Contractor at his own expense. If desired, tests shall be made by taking
samples of cement from stores or elsewhere from the works. The selection of samples and
procedure for testing shall comply with appropriate I.S. specification.
6.1.3 Aggregate
All aggregates shall conform to I.S. 383 - 1970. Aggregate shall, where possible, be derived
from a source that normally produces aggregate satisfactory for concrete, and if requested by
the Employer/ Engineer, the Contractor shall supply evidence to this effect. If instructed to
do so, the contractor shall supply samples of the aggregate for the purpose of making
preliminary concrete test cubes as herein-after specified.
Aggregate shall consist of naturally occurring sand and gravel or stone crushed or
uncrushed, or a combination thereof. They shall be hard, strong, dense, durable, clean and
free from veins and adherent coating. As far as possible, flaky and elongated pieces should
be avoided.
Aggregate shall not contain any harmful materials, such as iron pyrites, coal, mica, shale or
similar laminated materials, clay, alkali, soft fragments, organic impurities etc. in such
quantity as to affect the strength or durability of the concrete or in addition to the above for
reinforced concrete, any material which attack the reinforcement. Aggregate which are
chemically reactive with the alkalis of cement are harmful, as cracking of concrete may take
place. These aggregate shall be protected from spilling oils, mobiles, diesels over it on site.
2) Only after getting the formwork checked, reinforcement should be placed properly as
according to the drawing and detailing.
3) The date and time of any casting of concrete should be informed to the Engineer/Employer's
2 days in advance.
No concrete work shall be cast in the absence of the Employer/ Engineer. The Contractor
shall personally check that both the formwork and reinforcement have been correctly placed
and fixed and satisfy himself that all work preparatory to casting is completely ready, before
requesting the Employer/ Engineer for final inspection and approval.
6.1.6 Admixtures
The use of admixtures to improve the workability is allowed only if there is proved evidence
that neither the strength nor the other requisite qualities of concrete and/or steel accessories
grout, etc. are impaired by their use. The use of admixtures containing calcium chloride,
fluorides, nitrates and sulphates is prohibited. The decision of the Employer/ Engineer on all
matters relating to the use of admixtures shall be final.
Admixtures shall be stored in suitable waterproof building. Any material which has
deteriorated or which has been contaminated whether during transit to the site, at the site or
otherwise, shall not be used in the work and shall be immediately removed from the site and
replaced at the expense of the contractor.
be taken from a source approved by the Employer/Engineer and if required by him it shall
be thoroughly washed, screened and graded by the contractor at no extra cost and to the
satisfaction of the Employer/ Engineer.
The whole of the ingredients of the coarse aggregate shall consist of hard stones and shall
contain no soft or elongated pieces. If it is considered necessary, the Employer/ Engineer
may instruct it to be washed, screened and graded at no extra cost.
by mechanical vibration. The slump test shall be made on concrete actually being placed in
the works at the commencement of each grade of concrete placing and such other times as
instructed.
The apparatus used for the slump test shall be standard cone. When cone is filled, it shall be
raised vertically clear of the concrete and the measurement of the slump shall be measured.
Care shall be taken to prevent vibration of the sample being tested. If the Employer/
Engineer requires the use of other means for testing the consistency of the concrete it shall
be done as instructed without any extra charge. For this standard I.S. Method shall be
followed.
6.4 Vibration
6.4.1 Appearance
The concrete that is to be compacted by vibration should appear anything from earth dry to
slightly glistening. The mix should have the appearance of lacking in fines.
6.4.2 Vibrators
The contractor must use vibrator on beams and slabs to compact the newly laid concrete.
Generally two types of vibrator shall be used.
a) Needle Or Immersion Type Of Vibrator
Casting fall beams and columns shall be compacted by means of needle type of vibrator.
4" dia needle type vibrator shall be used over beam section more than 350mm x 400mm
and rest of section need only 2" dia needle type vibrator.
b) Flat Bottom Vibrator For Slabs
The contractor shall require flat bottom type of vibrator to compact all concrete over
slabs. No immersion type of vibrator will be allowed to compact the concrete over slab.
Moreover, the contractor shall require at least two number of vibrator for one casting and
other should kept in standby position. In case vibrator got damaged or not in working
condition during casting, the vibrator shall be immediately replaced. If the contractor shall
fail to replace another vibrator during casting, no further casting of concrete will be
permitted. The contractor shall in that case, immediately remove the remaining concrete mix
from the site of work.
6.4.3 Placing
Segregation is likely to take place when the concrete is tipped into the form work and this
should be avoided. The concrete mix should not contain surplus water and sand which will
develop segregation under influence of vibratory compaction. The distribution of new
concrete should be uniform over the whole section and the surface kept horizontal all the
time thus ensuring the movement of concrete is downward only. Vibrators shall not be used
as a spreading or distributing agent.
The vibrators shall be of rotary out of balance immersion type or the electro-magnetic type
and operate at a frequency of not less than 4,000 cycles per minute. The vibration shall be of
such a power - input as to produce an acceleration of 1 to 3 m/sec in the mass of the
compacted concrete. The vibrators shall be provided for continuous operation.
6.4.6 Compactness
The concrete shall be judged to be compacted when the mortar fills the spaces between the
coarse aggregate so as to form a glistening and even surface except for slight irregularities
where the coarse aggregate breaks this smooth surface. When this condition has been
attained, the vibrators shall be withdrawn slowly.
The vibrator must not be placed against the steel or the formwork, the minimum distance
being 8 mm. It must be placed in such a position that formwork, reinforcement and recently
laid concrete are subjected to the minimum amount of vibration.
Construction joints in slabs shall be made parallel to the main reinforcement, and where
required at right angles to the main reinforcement, they shall be made at a place previously
approved by the Employer/ Engineer.
Before placing new concrete against concrete already set, the face of the old concrete shall
be cleaned and scum removed. The face shall be roughened and any loose aggregate
removed there from. Immediately before placing the new concrete the face of the old
concrete shall be thoroughly wetted and a coating of neat cement grout applied. The new
concrete shall be well rammed against the prepared face before the grout sets. Construction
joints will not be paid separately.
considered the water-impervious paper for purposes of interpretation of this item. No liquid
curing compound may be used without specific written approval oftheEmployer/ Engineer
regarding type, manufacturer, location and extent of use and application procedures.
6.4.9 Finishes
The concrete surface shall in general be smooth finish. However, immediately after stripping
form work, minor defects and honey combed areas shall be patched and holes filled before
the concrete is thoroughly dry, patch areas shall be chipped away to 2.5 mm depth, with
regular edges perpendicular to the surface. Area to be patched shall be thoroughly wet
including the areas at least 150 mm. wide entirely surrounding them, just prior to placing the
patching mortar. Mortar shall be of the same material and proportions as used for the
concrete, without coarse aggregate. A sufficient quantity of white cement shall be
substituted for part of the ordinary cement so that the patching mortar, when dry, will match
the surrounding concrete. Water in the mix shall be kept to a minimum and mortar shall be
re-tempered without adding water and shall be allowed to stand for one hour prior to use
during which time it shall be mixed to prevent setting. The mortar shall be thoroughly
compacted into place, screeded so as to leave the patch slightly higher than surrounding
surfaces, left undisturbed for one to two hours to permit initial shrinkage and finished to
match the adjoining work. Where patches exceed 2.5 mm. deep, they shall be trimmed and
wet as specified, after which the opening shall be filled to within 2.5 mm. of the surface.
After sufficient shrinkage time has elapsed, the patching shall proceed as described above.
Patches shall be kept wet for five days. Tie holes left by the withdrawal of rods, or holes left
by removal of ends of ties shall be filled solidly with mortar. For holes passing entirely
through the wall, plunger-type grease gun or other device to force mortar through the wall,
starting at the back face, shall be used. When a hole is completely filled, excess mortar shall
be struck off with a cloth flush with the surface. Holes not passing entirely through walls
shall be filled solidly with mortar. Any excess mortar shall be struck off with a cloth on the
wall surface. The surface of non-shuttered faces concrete work other than slabs shall be
smoothed with a wooden float (or if approved with a steel trowel) to give a finish equal to
that of the rubbed down shuttered faces. Concealed concrete faces shall be left as it is except
that honeycombed surfaces shall be made good.
The top faces of slabs not intended to be surfaced shall be leveled and floated to a smooth
finish at the levels or falls shown on the drawings or elsewhere.
The floating shall not be executed to the extent of bringing excess fine material to the
surface. Ribbed surfaces of slabs shall where instructed be formed at the time of taming and
leveling. Indentation in slab or stair surfaces shall be formed by approved implements giving
the depth and patterns instructed. The top faces of slabs intended to be covered with screed,
granolithic or similar surfacing shall be left with a spade finish.
The soffits of slabs and faces of walls intended to be rendered shall be roughened by
approved means to form a key. Concrete surfaces to take finishes other than those
specifically referred to herein shall be prepared in an approved manner to suit the finish as
instructed.
inclusive as herein before specified, the Contractor shall take down or remove and
reconstruct the defective work or shall take the remedial measures instructed at his own cost.
6.5.1 Measurement
In calculating the contents of any R.C.C. member, for measurement proposes the dimensions
adopted shall be structural concrete members exclusive of any finish,
Beams
Measurement shall be between R.C.C. columns or resting on walls cubic metre of the work
done as shown on the drawing. The depth shall be taken from the bottom of the stem to the
top of the slab or projections if any. Lintels when connected to main RCC structure shall be
measured as beams.
Columns
These shall be measured in cu.m. of work done according to the drawings from top of the
footing or raft slab to the top of slab in case of ground floor and from top of slab to the top
of slab for all other floors. Unless specified otherwise nothing extra shall be admissible for
any odd size and for any special section and shape of column i.e. square, rectangular, round,
elliptical etc. and laid at any angle as may be shown on drawings.
Slabs
These shall be measured in cubic metre of the work done as per drawings. These shall be
measured from beam to beam, wall to wall or beam to wall including bearing part on the
wall. Unless otherwise specified in the schedule nothing extra shall be admissible for slabs
laid to slope, canopy slabs or those of any shape or section any cantilevered part of any
projections small or big beyond the bearing beam or wall as may be shown on drawings or
the slabs sunk for lavatory. Plaster shall be paid for separately.
Walls
These shall be measured from end of slab/column/beam, termed wall. It shall be paid in
cubic metre excluding the finish.
Lintels
All lintels spanning over independent openings unrelated to main RCC structure shall be
measured under lintels, in cubic metre of the work done according to drawing. Width of the
lintels shall be taken according to wall thickness specified unless set back or projected from
wall as shown on the drawing. Unless otherwise described or shown on the drawings,
bearing over the openings shall be depth of the lintel or 150 mm whichever is higher.
Stairs
These shall be measured in cu.m. of the concrete work done as per drawing. Unless
specified otherwise nothing extra shall be admissible for steps laid in any shape or not
straight in plan.
Folded Staircase
The folded staircase shall be measured excluding the vertical main column. It shall be
measured for step of any shape size and paid in cubic metre excluding the finish.
Mullions
The RCC mullions shall be measured in cubic metre. Nothing extra shall be admissible for
its location, shape or size.
Water Tank
These shall be measured in cu.m. of concrete work done for all the slab, walls etc. forming
the water tank. Nothing extra shall be allowed for its shape, size and location. It shall be
paid in cubic metre of the concrete work.
Column Footings
These shall be measured in cu.m. of the concrete work done as per design, drawing. Unless
specified otherwise, nothing extra shall be admissible for any particular shape of the footing.
7 BAR REINFORCEMENT
7.1 Installment Of Reinforcement Steel
Supplying and fixing tor steel reinforcement in RCC work including bending, binding with
GI wire, placing in position including the cost of binding wire, as per drawing
Reinforcement shall be free from pitting due to corrosion, loose rust, mill scale, paint, oil,
grease, adhering earth, or other materials that may impair the bond between the concrete and
the reinforcement or that may in the opinion of the Employer/ Engineer cause corrosion of
the reinforcement or disintegration of the concrete.
The reinforcements supplied for which the Manufacturer's test sheets or other records are not
available, or where in the opinion of the Employer/ Engineer has been subject to corrosion
or other bad effects, the Employer/ Engineer shall select as many test pieces as he deems
necessary, and the Contractor shall supply and deliver the test pieces free of cost without
reimbursement and pay the cost of preparing and testing them as well. This test shall be
performed in presence oftheEmployer/ Engineer.
in the moulds or formwork. For this, all lapping bar on beams and slabs shall be scattered
i.e. as far as possible minimum number of laps shall be permitted in one section of slab and
only one lap will be permitted at one section in case of beams. In case of columns the
lapping of bar shall be permitted only at the centre zone of column.
7.11 Measurement
For the purpose of ascertaining payments due to the Contractor the basis of measurements of
bar or wire reinforcement used in the works shall be the calculated weight in kg which shall
be computed from the sizes and lengths of the bars or wires described on the working
drawings or elsewhere. No allowance in the weight shall be made for cutting to waste,
rolling margin, extra length, lapping of bars or other tolerances. Nothing extra shall be
admissible on reinforcement bars, rolled by the Contractor directly from the market on
actual weight basis. The Contractor is deemed to have taken this factor into consideration
and quoted his rate accordingly in the tender. The Contractor's rate for unit weight of bar
reinforcement shall be deemed to include all allowances omitted in calculating the weight
and for any other tolerances, and for providing tying wire, spacer bars, chairs and cover
blocks as specified hereinafter for carriage and handling, for bending hooking, cranking, and
for fixing and maintaining in the correct position in the works. Standard hooks (9 times the
dia. for each hook for tor steel) shall be added to the finished length to arrive at the length of
the bar for cutting and measurement. No hooks are required for ribbed or tor steel.
8 FORMWORK
8.1 Centering And Shuttering
Centering and shuttering of plywood and steel formwork in slabs, walls, beams etc.
including propping, strutting etc. and removal of forms including applying form oil to
shuttering.
8.2 Design
Formwork shall be designed and constructed for removal so that the concrete can be
properly placed and thoroughly compacted. Formwork shall be firmly supported and
adequately strutted, braced, or tied. It shall be capable of adjustment to the lines and
dimensions of the finished concrete and it shall be sufficiently strong to resist without
distortion, the pressure of concrete during its placing and compaction, and other loads to
which it may be subjected. It shall not be liable to suffer distortion under the influence of the
weather. When concrete is to be vibrated, special care shall be taken to ensure that the
formwork will remain stable and the joints tight.The safety and adequacy of centering and
shuttering shall be the sole responsibility of the Contractor. The Contractor shall if required
supply to the Employer/ Engineer drawings and calculations for the formwork he proposes
to use, for the concrete work.
8.5 Supports
Formwork shall be constructed so that the formwork to the sides of members can be
removed without disturbing the soffit formwork or its supports. Props and supports shall be
designed to allow the formwork to be adjusted accurately to line and level and to be erected
and removed in an approved sequence without damage to the concrete. Supports shall be
carried out which is sufficiently strong to afford the necessary support without damage to
any portion of the structure. This may mean in some cases that it be carried down to the
foundations or other suitable base. Props and bracing shall be provided for the temporary
support of composite construction where separately specified.
8.7 Sundries
Formwork shall be provided to the top surface of concrete where the slope or the nature of
the work requires it. Provision shall be made for forming holes and chases for services and
for building in pipes, conduits and other fixings, as shown on the drawings. The material and
position of any ties passing through the concrete shall be as directedbytheEmployer/
Engineer. Except where corrosion of a metal tie is unimportant, it shall be possible to
remove a tie so that no part of it remaining embedded in the concrete shall be nearer to the
finished surface of the concrete than the specified thickness of cover to the reinforcement.
Any holes left after the removal of ties shall be filled with concrete or mortar of approved
mix.
repellent compound shall be applied so as to effect quick removal of form work. It shall be
applied as per the manufacture's direction. No compound shall be used which will adversely
affect the concrete work or surface. No form repellent compound may be used without
specific written approval of the Employer/ Engineer regarding type, manufactures, location
and extent of use and application procedures.
8.11 Measurement
Measurement for payment shall be done of the area on which centering shuttering has been
done. It shall include the application of the form oil and removal of the formwork as well.
9 BRICKWORK
9.1 Materials and Workmanship
9.1.1 Bricks
The bricks shall be table molded with sand from good brick earth and shall be of uniform
size, unless otherwise specified. They shall be uniform deep red, cherry or copper color,
thoroughly well burnt without being vitrified, regular in shape and size, and shall have sharp
and square sides and edges and parallel faces to ensure uniformity in the thickness of the
courses of brick work. The bricks shall be free from cracks, chips, flaws stones or humps of
any kind. They shall not show appreciable signs of efflorescence either dry or subsequent to
soaking in water. The bricks shall be sound, hard, and homogeneous in texture and produce
a clear ringing sound when struck with a trowel. In no case, the minimum crushing strength
of bricks shall be less than 1000 lbs/sq. inch. The bricks shall be provided with frogs. All
bricks which absorb water more than one-sixth of their own dry weight after being soaked
for one hour by immersion in water shall be rejected.
9.1.3 Mortars
All brick work shall be laid with specified mortar of good workable consistency.
Cement mortar shall be prepared by mixing cement and sand in the specified proportions the
mixing shall be done in a mechanical mixer or by hand mixing as directed by Employer/
Engineer. Water shall be added as required during mixing. Care shall be taken not to add
more water than what is actually needed to bring the mortar to the consistency of a stiff
paste. Only the quantity of mortar, which can be used within 2 hours of its mixing shall be
prepared at a time. Mortar unused for more than 2 hours shall be rejected and removed from
the site of work.
9.1.5 Laying
a) Bricks shall be laid in English bond, unless otherwise specified. Half or cut bricks shall not
be used except where necessary to complete the bond. Closer in such cases shall be cut to
the required size and used near the ends of the walls.
b) The walls shall be taken up truly plumb. All courses shall be laid truly horizontal and all
vertical joints shall be truly vertical. Vertical joints in alternate courses shall come directly
one over the other. The thickness of brick courses shall be kept uniform and for this purpose
straight edge with graduations showing the thickness of each brick course including joint
shall be used. Bricks shall be laid with frogs upwards.
c) The walls of a structure shall be carried up regularly and nearly at one level and no portion
of the work shall be left more than 3 ft. below the rest of the work. Where this is not
possible, the work shall be raked back according to bond (and not left toothed) at an angle
not exceeding 45 degree.
d) All iron fixtures, pipes, outlets of water, hold fasts of doors and windows, etc. which are
required to be built in walls, shall be embedded in cement mortar or in cement concrete bed
as specified, in their correct positions as the work proceeds. Nothing extra shall be paid for
such extra cement mortar or cement concrete to be used for embedding the fixtures of the
nature stated above.
9.1.6 Joints
Bricks shall be so laid that joints are quite full of mortar. The thickness of the bed joints
shall in no case exceed 10 mm unless otherwise specified. The face of joints shall be raked
to a minimum depth of 10 mm by raking tool daily during the progress of work when the
mortar is still green, so as to provide proper key for the plaster or pointing to be done.
Where plastering or pointing is not required to be done, the joints shall be struck flush and
finished at the time of laying. The face of brick work shall be cleaned daily and all mortar
drippings removed.
9.1.8 Curing
Green work shall be protected from rain by suitable covering. Brick masonry with cement
mortar shall be kept constantly moist on all faces for a minimum period of 7(seven) days.
9.1.9 Protection
Where exposed to weather, protect top of masonry with water tied material in such a way
that it will protect the completed work. Masonry wall shall set for 48 hours before any load
is applied on the completed work.
9.2.1 Measurements
The measurements of work shall be the product of the length, height and thickness.
Deductions for doors, windows and other openings including lintels shall be made to arrive
at the net quantity of work. Nothing shall be paid extra for forming such openings. However,
no deductions shall be made for areas less than 0.1 sq.m. overall, bearing of lintels, beams,
girders and holdfast blocks but nothing extra like formwork shall be paid for embedding
these. Unless otherwise specified nothing extra shall be admissible for cutting in brickwork
or brick to suit RCC structures, walls in any shape other than straight or any cutting
necessary for shaping the walls to the structural design. Rate shall be inclusive of providing
weep holes of PVC pipes and all necessary scaffolding, watering, cutting of bricks, curing,
materials and labour.
9.3.1 Scaffolding
Double scaffolding having two sets of vertical supports shall be provided. The supports shall
be sound and strong, tied together with horizontal pieces over which the scaffolding planks
shall be fixed. In buildings upto two stories, single scaffolding shall be allowed. In this case,
the inner end of the horizontal scaffolding pole shall rest in a hole provided in the header
course only. Only one header for each pole shall be left out. The holes left in masonry work
for supporting the scaffolding shall be filled and made good, before plastering. The
contractor shall be responsible for providing and maintaining sufficiently strong scaffolding
so as to withstand all loads likely to come upon it.
9.3.2 Measurement
It shall be done as specified in clause 9.1 inclusive of scaffolding.
9.4.1 Mortar
Mortar shall be 1:4 (1 cement: 4 sand) mixed as per specification of clause 9.1.3
9.4.2 Measurement
Measurement shall be done in cubic metre, width of brick x lenth x height of the wall
inclusive of the reinforcement. Deduction shall be made as for brickwork stated in clause
9.1.6.
9.5.1 Measurement
The measurement shall be the net area of length and breadth of the work done and the rate
shall be for all the material and labour.
10.1.1 Workmanship
Material
The stone shall be hard, tough, sound and durable. Stone shall not be less than 15 cm and
more than 45 cm. Face stones shall be larger and uniform in size and colour to give a good
appearance. Breadth of face stones shall be greater than the height. Face stones should tail
into wall to a sufficient depth to bond well. Stone shall be laid with broader face downwards
to give good bedding. Face joints shall be broken and face of wall shall be truly in plumb.
Corner stone or quoins should be of good stones and dressed correct to angle and laid as
headers and stretchers. All stones shall be wetted thoroughly before laying.
Mortar
The rubble stone shall be placed with 1:4 cement sand mortar after having joints thoroughly
moistened. The surface joints shall be finished by flush pointing with 1:2 cement sand
mortar. The ingredient shall be accurately gauged by measure and shall be well and evenly
mixed together in a mechanical plant mixer care being taken not to add more water than is
required. No mortar that has been set shall be used. River sand shall be used unless
otherwise specified. If hand mixing is allowed then it shall be done in masonry tanks. The
gauged materials shall be put on the platform and mixed dry. Water will be then added and
whole mixed again until it is homogeneous and of uniform colour. Mortar shall be prepared
in such quantity, at one time, which shall be consumed within half an hour of its mixing.
The work shall be well watered for a fortnight.
Joints
Joints shall not be thicker than 19 mm. Face joints shall be thinner. Interstices, if any may be
filled with pieces of spalls of stones embedded in mortar. No pointing shall be allowed
afterwards. In the corners, the stones should be chiseled at both sides and also on the top of
the stone walls where the wall is ending and such surfaces being built up. Not more than 60
cm height of masonry shall be constructed at one time.
Bond Stone
Through bond stones of one piece shall be provided one for every 0.5 m2 (5sq.ft.) of face.
For walls thicker than 75 cm bond stones may be of two pieces placed side by side over
lapping at least 25 cm. Breadth of lap stones shall not be less than 1.5 times the height. All
stones shall be thoroughly wetted before laying. At the end of day’s work masonry shall be
flooded with 2.5 cm water at the upper surface with the help of fillets of mortar about 38
mm high, made round in edges. The masonry shall be protected from sun, rain, frost and
other weather effect.
10.1.2 Measurement
Measurement for payment of stone masonry works shall be made on the basis of actual
volume of stone masonry in cubic meters. The measurement of work shall be the product of
the length, thickness and height. Payment shall be made for the number of cubic meters
measured as provided at the unit price specified in the schedule. The unit price shall include
all labors, equipment, materials, fixing required weep holes,scaffolding and all other cost
necessary for the performance and completion of the works.
11.1.1 Scaffolding
For plastering work on walls, unless otherwise specified, double scaffolding having two sets
of vertical supports shall be provided. The Contractor shall be responsible for providing and
maintaining sufficiently strong scaffolding so as to withstand all loads likely to come upon
it.
11.1.2 Mortar
The type of mortar mix to be used shall be as specified in the description of the item.
11.1.3 Workmanship
All joints in the masonry shall be raked out properly to a minimum depth of 1/2". Dust and
mortar shall be brushed out. The surface shall then be thoroughly washed with water,
cleaned and kept wet before plastering is commenced. The thickness of the plaster shall be
as specified. The plaster may be applied in 1, 2 or 3 coats as specified or as directed by the
Employer/ Engineer, but no single coat shall exceed 1/2" thickness.
Ceiling plaster shall be completed before the commencement of wall plaster. All wall plaster
shall be started from the top and work down towards floor.
Gauges of plaster 6" x 6" shall be first applied horizontally and vertically, at not more than 6
ft. intervals over the entire surface to serve as guides for plastering and to ensure even
thickness and a true surface. The surfaces of these gauged areas shall be truly in the plane of
the finished plaster surface. The surface shall be finally given the type of finish as specified
in the description of the item or as directed by the Employer/ Engineer. All corners, arises,
angles and junctions shall be truly vertical or horizontal as the case may be and shall be
carefully finished. Rounding or chamfering corners, arises, junctions etc. where required
shall be done without any extra payment.
In suspending work at the end of the day, the plaster shall be left, cut clean to line both
horizontally and vertically. The work shall be closed on the body of wall and not nearer than
6" to any corners on arises. When recommencing, the edge of the old work shall be scraped
clean and wetted before plaster is applied to the adjacent areas.
Curing shall be started 24 hours after finishing the plaster. The plaster shall be kept wet for a
minimum period of 7 days. The dates of plaster shall be legibly marked on the various
sections of the wall so that curing for the specified period thereafter can be watched. Any
cracks which appear in the surface and all portions, which sound hollow when tapped or are
found to be soft or otherwise defective, shall be cut out in rectangular shape and redone as
directed by the Employer/Engineer.
11.1.4 Measurement
It shall be done in square metre of the surface over which the plaster has been done. The
thickness of the plaster shall not be taken into account except for independent columns
where the measurement shall be of finished surface allowing 12mm over the designed
dimensions. Opening shall be deducted in full, and jambs and soffits shall be allowed.
Openings less than 1 sq.mshall not be deducted and nothing extra shall be paid for finishing
jambs, soffits and the sides of such openings. Unless otherwise specified, nothing extra shall
be allowed for plaster on independent columns and beams, short with or on curved surface.
11.2 Cement Sand Plastering On Ceiling In Cement Sand (C/S) Mortar (1:4)
11.2.1 Scaffolding
Stage scaffolding independent of the walls shall be provided for all ceiling plaster.
11.2.2 Mortar
The mix of mortar to be used shall be as specified in the description of the item.
11.2.3 Workmanship
Projecting burns of mortar formed due to the gaps at joints in shuttering shall be removed.
The surface shall be scrubbed clean with wire brushes. In addition, concrete surfaces shall
be pack marked with a pointed tool at spacing of not more than 2" centres to ensure proper
key for the plaster. The surface shall then be cleaned of all oil, grease, etc. and well wetted
before the plaster is applied. The thickness of the ceiling plaster shall be 1/4" to 1/2" unless
otherwise specified. The plaster may be applied in one or two coats as specified.
Ceiling plaster shall commence only after the slab above has been finished and the centering
removed. In the case of ceiling of roof slabs, plaster shall commence only after the terrace
work has been completed. Gauges of plaster 6" x 6" shall be first applied at not more than
5ft. intervals in both directions to serve as guides for the plastering and to ensure even
thickness and a true surface. The surfaces of these gauged areas shall be truly in the plane of
the finished plaster surface.
The surface shall be finally given a smooth finish, unless otherwise specified, when the
work is in progress all horizontal lines and surfaces shall be frequently tested for their
accuracy. Curing shall be started 24 hours after finishing the plaster and shall be continued
for a minimum period of 7 days. The dates of plaster shall be marked so that curing for the
specified period thereafter can be watched.
Any cracks which appear in the surface and all portions, which sound hallow when tapped
or are found to be soft or otherwise defective, shall be cut out in rectangular shape and
remedied as directed by the Employer/ Engineer.
11.2.4 Measurement
Measurement shall be done in square metre of the surface over which the plaster has been
done. The rate shall include materials and labour etc.
11.3.1 Scope
This specification covers supplying materials and executing the pointing works on outside of
stone work.
11.3.2 Preparation
The joints of the brick work/stone work shall be raked out to a depth of 3/4" and the wall
surface washed and cleaned and kept wet for two days before pointing.
11.3.3 Scaffolding
Wooden ballies, planks, trestles, G.I. pipes, ply board and other scaffolding material shall be
sound and erected in accordance with the specification given under Brick Work or as
directed by the Construction Manager.
11.3.4 Materials
The materials for mortar-cement and sand as specified shall be of standard specifications as
mentioned in the beginning, (see concrete works). The materials shall be first mixed by
measuring with boxes to give the required proportion as specified (1:2); and then mixed by
adding water slowly and gradually to give a working consistency.
11.3.5 Operations
The mortar shall be pressed into the raked, cleaned and wet joints and a groove of shape and
size of 5 to 6 mm deep shall be formed running a forming tool of steel along the centre line
of the joint. The vertical joints also shall be finished in a similar way at right angles to the
horizontal lines. The finished work shall give a neat and clean appearance with straight
edges.
11.3.6 Curing
The finished work surface shall be cured for seven days and shall be protected by hanging
mattings or gunny bags on the pointing keeping them wet.
Curing shall be done in a way to avoid or minimize overflow or seepage to the existing
surface below.
11.3.7 Measurement
Measurement and payment shall be done in square meter as in item. Measurement shall be
done nearest to two decimal places separately for various mixes of the work for the net
quantity executed. All openings shall be deducted and any jambs, soffits etc. measurements
shall be allowed. The rate includes all labour, materials, erection and removal of scaffolding,
preparation of background, finishing etc.
12. FLOORING
12.1 CEMENT SCRREDING/PUNNING
Providing and laying 3mm neat cement punning on floor, with 38mm screed of specified
ratio including wetting the surface, mixing, laying and rubbing with steel trowel to a hard
smooth and shining surface and curing.
12.1.1 WORKMANSHIP
The base surface shall be properly watered and cleaned of dust and dirt. A screed of
cement/sand in the specified ratio shall be laid over it. Upon which punning shall be done.
Before applying cement sand punning, the first coat should be swept clean of any dust or
loose particles. The average thickness of punning shall not be less than 3mm. The pattern of
the surface should be as per instruction of the Employer/ Engineer. The coat shall be
finished by rubbing with a steel trowel and any depression shall be filled in and rubbed to a
shining surface. All corners and edges shall be rounded. The Contractor shall prepare a
sample square metre of the punning as per instruction of the Employer/ Engineer until the
quality, texture and finish required is obtained and approved by the Employer/ Engineer,
after which all punning executed, shall conform to the respective approved sample. All
punning shall be finished smooth, even and truly level and as per instructions of the
Employer/ Engineer. The punning shall be kept wet for 7 days.
12.1.2 MEASUREMENT
The measurement shall be taken in square metre for the finished surface. The rate shall
include all the materials and labour.
12.2.2 Materials
Cement and Sand shall confirm to “STANDARD CONSTRUCTION MATERIALS”
12.2.3 Workmanship
All workmanship shall be according to the latest and best possible standards.
Cement sand punning l used shall be in the ratio of 1:1 over and including 20 mm base
screed 1:4, it shall placed on floor, skirting, dado etc. The entire surface, in advance, shall be
thoroughly cleaned of any loose materials, mortar and other foreign materials. Surface shall
be thoroughly wetted with water. Laying & rubbing shall be carried out with steel trowel to
a hard, smooth & shining surface. Curing shall be carried out for at least seven days
Before applying cement sand punning, the surface shall be cleaned of any dust or loose
particles. The average thickness of punning shall not be less than 3mm .The pattern of the
surface should be as per instruction of the Engineer. The surface shall be finished by rubbing
with a steel trowel & any depression shall be filled in & rubbed to a shining surface. All
corners & edges shall be rounded. The contractor shall prepare a 3 square feet of the
punning as per instruction of the Engineer, after which all punning executed shall confirm
with the respective approved sample. All punning shall be finished smooth, even & truly
level. It shall be kept wet for 7 days.
12.2.4 Measurement
Measurement shall be done in Running Metre (or square meter only if specified in BOQ) as
per exact dimensions shown in the drawing. The rates for items shall include cost of all
materials consumed in the work at all level, hire charges of materials, tools and plants, cost
of labour, insurance, all transport, services, etc, complete.
12.3.2 Materials
The tile material for Glazed/Non-glazed Vitrified Porcelain (Granite Viglacera-Vietnam,
Portebello-Brazil or equivalent make)/Glazed/Non-glazed Ceramic tiles (Somany, Kajaria or
equivalent make), shall confirm to IS:777 (respective IS standards) or Equivalent approved
by the Engineer.
Glazed Ceramic Tiles shall be used for tiling walls, Non-Skidding Tiles shall be used for
tiling floors and Double Charged Tiles shall be used for tiling the counter slab for kitchen.
The tiles shall be of approved color, size and shape or as shown in the drawings. And shall
be laid to the pattern approved by the Engineer. The tiles shall be of uniform colour, true to
size and shape and free from cracks, twists, uneven edges, crazing and other defects. The
size and thickness of the tiles shall be as specified. The contractor shall submit samples of
tile for selection and approval by the Engineer In-charge and all tiles delivered to the site
shall confirm to the approved samples with regard to size, quality, texture and color.
12.3.3 Mixing
Mixing shall be done as per specification for mortar mixing of brick masonry work.
12.3.8 Measurement
The measurement shall be in square meters of the work done including the setting mortar.
The rate shall be for the material and labor, all complete.
12.4.1 Material
Cement, Sand shall be of standard construction materials. Marble chips of 3 mm gauge.
12.4.2 Proportion
Base course cement mortar (1:4), 1 part cement and 4 parts sand. Upper course marble chips
and cement of specified approved colour (1:1), 1 part marble chips and 1 part cement.
12.4.3 Mixing
Cement mortar shall be prepared as per specification. The marble chips and cement shall be
mixed by measuring with boxes to have the required proportion, first dry mixed and then
thoroughly mixed by adding water gradually to have a uniform plastic mix.
12.4.4 Laying
The floor shall be made rough and watered and given a cement wash and then the cement
mortar shall be laid in layers in panels of 90 cm by 90 cm or as per instruction of the
Employer. Panels shall be rounded by glass dividing strips 6 mm thick and 25 mm deep.
After lying, the cement mortar shall be compacted by beating and tampering and levelled
with wooden floats. Proper slope for draining water shall be provided as per instruction of
the site Engineer. Within 2 hours of laying of the bottom layer of cement mortar the upper
layer of marble chips and cement shall be laid, and the surface tampered lightly and finished
perfectly level with straight edge loafs and trowel. Additional aggregates may be spread on
the finished surface while compacting or rolling so that the final surface is covered with
chips to extent of about 70 to 80% of the exposed area.
12.4.5 Curing
After about 2 hours of laying, the surface shall be covered with wet bags and kept wet and
left undisturbed for 2 days.
12.4.6 Finish
The surface shall be grounded by rubbing with sandstone blocks and all the cement in the
surface removed. A neat cement wash shall then be given in the surface and left undisturbed
for 6 days and the surface shall be grounded with carborundum stones of different grades
starting with coarse one and successively with finer ones, and rubbing shall be continued
until the entire surface shows a uniform granular appearance. The surface should be kept wet
during all these days. After final rubbing, the surface shall be thoroughly cleaned by
washing with soft soap water and then with clean water.
Finally, when the surface is absolutely dry, oxalic acid powder shall be rubbed well on the
surface with pieces of felt with a few drops of water, and this operation shall be repeated
until the surface becomes perfectly smooth and glossy. The surface shall be rubbed with so
as to give a glazing surface. White cement or coloured cement shall be used to have the
required colour as per specified or as per instruction of the site Engineer.
If instructed by the Site Engineer, the grinding and polishing shall be done by grinding
machine in 3 operations, first grinding with machine fitted with coarse carborundum stone,
second grinding with medium grade carbourndum stone and final grinding with fine grade
carborundum stone.
13.1.1 Timber
Wherever Timber is to be used it shall be from the heart of a sound tree of mature growth,
the sapwood being entirely removed. It shall be uniform in substance, straight in fibre, free
from large, loose, deed or cluster knots, flaws, shakes, wasp, cup spring, twist, bends and
defects of any kind. It should be free from spongy, brittle, flaky or brushy condition,
sapwood and barer holes.
All timber shall be seasoned and be free from decay, rot, harmful fungi and insect attacks
and from any other damage of harmful nature which will affect the strength, durability,
appearance or its usefulness for the purpose for which it is required. The timber shall be of
best quality timber as specified. The samples of the approved timber to be used shall be kept
in the office of the Employer/ Engineer for the purpose of comparison.
The colour shall be uniform as far as possible, the darkness of colour amongst colour species
of timber being generally a sign of strength and durability. The moisture content for timber
shall not exceed 12 percent of dry weight of timber. As soon as the foundation of buildings
are laid all necessary timber scantlings shall be brought to site and stacked and kept under
cover and allowed to remain till required.
Timbers for the work shall not be brought to site of work until inspected and approved by
the Employer/ Engineer who may reject the defective timber/timber works. Any effort like
plugging, painting, using any adhesives or resinous materials to hide defects shall render the
pieces rejectable by the Employer/ Engineer. Timber presented for inspection shall be clean
and free from dust, mud, paint or other material which may conceal the defects. Cut off ends
for protection can be done after inspection with raw linseed oil or any other materials
approved by the Employer/ Engineer. No timber be painted, tarred or oiled primed without
the previous approval of the Employer/ Engineer.
All scantlings shall be sawn in straight lines, planes and of uniform thickness with full
measurement from end to end and shall be sawn in the direction of the grain. They shall be
sawn with such sufficient margin as to secure specified dimensions, lines and planes after
being brought and dressed. Any timber rejected shall at once be removed from the site of
work.
13.1.2 WORKMANSHIP
The joints shall be simple, neat and strong. Framed joints shall be coated with white lead
before the frames are put together. All mortise and tendon joints shall fit in fully and
accurately without wedging or filling. The joints shall be pinned with hard wood or bamboo
pins of 3/8" to 1/2" diameter, after the frames are put together and pressed in position by
means of a press. Joints in the frame vertical style or horizontal rail shall not be allowed.
The unrelated edges of the frame in the opening shall be rounded or beaded uniformly.
When ventilator is provided above the door, full length of the vertical post shall be provided.
The rebate and the plaster key grooves shall be provided as shown in the drawing. Vertical
part of the frame shall be embedded at least 30 mm. in the masonry or concrete or flooring.
Holdfasts shall be provided as specified and any adjustment of spacing necessary shall be
erected in position and held in plumb with proper supports from both sides and built in
masonry as it is being built.
The work shall be carried out as per the drawing. Timber shall be properly planed wrought
and dressed in a workmanlike manner. Joints shall be true to fit properly and as directed by
theEmployer/ Engineer. The rate of woodwork shall include the cost of all sawing, planning,
jointing, framing, labour and materials for raising and fixing and all workmanship and the
fitting, fixing and supplying of all straps, bolts, nails, spikes, keys wedges, pins, screws etc.
necessary for the framing and fixing. Joints and portions inserted in masonry or floor shall
be allowed for in the measurement. Plugging in of holes for holdfasts shall be done in neat
manner. Any defects observed after installation shall be rejected. Sample of workmanship
shall be submitted for approval.
Holdfasts shall be of 20mmx6mmx300mm long mild steel(M.S.) flat one end split and
fishtailed at another end for anchorage into cement concrete blocks 1:2:4 (1 cement: 2 sand:
4 stone aggregate 20mm and down gauge) and the flat end is bent up for fixing to the frame
with three screws. The holdfasts shall be as shown on the drawings. Holdfasts shall be fixed
to the door or window frames with 40mm M.S. screw. The M.S. flat of the holdfast shall be
fitted to the frame in the recess of required size and thickness. There shall be 2 such
holdfasts on each side of the frame for frames upto 1.25 m height (four in all) and 3 on each
side of the frame above 1.25 m (six in all). The positions of the holdfasts shall be as shown
on the drawings with minor adjustments for brick/stone masonry. It shall be fixed as the
work proceeds.
The mild steel holdfast for RCC columns shall be made of 12mm diameter rod fishtailed at
one end and threaded at the other. The split length shall be 25 mm and threading shall be at
least 50 mm where a nut for 12 mm dia. shall be provided. It shall be total 175 mm long.
The M.S. bolt holdfast as shown in the drawing shall be provided in the RCC column
structure at required places as the casting progresses.
The timber frame shall be fitted with M.S. bolt holdfast through square holes provided at
required places in the frame. The nut shall then be tightened properly. Care shall be taken
that the threaded bolt is at least 12mm inside exposed frame face. Plugging of the bolt hole
in the frame shall be done with timber matching the graining of the timber. The finished
surface shall be smooth and matching after plugging the bolt hole. All door, window and
ventilator embedded or in contact with masonry or concrete works shall be coated with two
coats of bitumen emulsion or solignum. Care shall be taken that such preservatives not drip
on the dressed faces.
13.1.3 Measurement
The measurement of the timber frame shall be taken in its net length and section and worked
out correct upto two places of decimals in cubic metre. Total tolerance of 3mm is admissible
in sections of dressed timber. This shall include M.S. holdfast of 20mmx 6mmx 300mm size
embedded on PCC bed 1:3:6 or 12mm dia. holdfast to RCC column.
13.2.1 Timber
Timber as per clause13.1.1.
13.2.3 Louvers
The timber louvers shall be 12 mm thick of the size and fixing as shown in the drawing.
Vertical slats if required shall be provided as per instruction of the Employer/ Engineer.
13.2.4 Construction
The item shall be carried out in conformity with IS 1003 Part I-1966 for door shutters.
Construction and workmanship finished dimension of the components being entirely as per
clause there in and as shown in the drawing. When ventilator is included it shall be provided
by having full length one piece posts for door or window and ventilator extending the frame
on the tap to the head to the required extent. The shutters shall be of finished dimensions
with ornamental mouldings and glaze and other components as specified in the drawings or
as directed by the Employer/ Engineer for the particular type but adjusted for the absence of
rebates in the frames and shutters by reducing the glaze. The clearance between the finished
shutter and the door frame and between the shutters themselves shall not exceed 3 mm
unless otherwise specified in the drawing. The fixing and size of the hinge shall be as
specified by cutting the necessary racess corresponding to the thickness of the flaps in the
sides of the shutter style and the door frame.
11.2.5 Measurement
The measurement of the door shutter shall be taken in its net area of full length and breadth
from rebates. Tolerance in size shall be 6 mm and 3 mm in thickness. Overlaps of two
shutters shall not be measured. The rate shall be for complete work including hanging and
fixing in position. The rate shall include cost of materials and labour.
13.3.1 Shutters
The shutters shall conform to the relevant specification for the type and grade to IS 2202-
1973. The flush door shutters as specified shall be manufactured by a reputed factory such
as The Indian Plywood Manufacturing Co. Ltd., Bombay or equivalent having hot press and
all modern equipment. Samples shall be produced for the approval of the Employer/
Engineer.
13.3.2 Construction
The lapping of frame (style and rail) shall be 50 mm wide of required thickness. There shall
be three numbers of horizontal wooden spacers of 100 mm width with one in middle, lock
block of 50 mm width shall be provided vertically on both sides between the wooden
spacers. Wooden batten shall also be provided. The shutter shall be as per the drawing.
13.3.3 Timber
The shutter frames shall be of Sal wood, Sissum or Agrakh or any other hardwood variety of
approved quality.
13.3.4 Plywood
It shall be commercial plywood quality for commercial play shutter facing and shall be teak
wood play of matching veneers for the teak ply face, as approved by the Employer/
Engineer.
13.3.6 Finish
There shall be no clear joint/junction of the plywood on the finish side. Chipped ply, cracked
or other defective workmanship shall be rejected. The door shutters shall be hung in position
with 3 nos. 150 mm M.S. butt hinges.
13.3.7 Measurement
It shall be measured in net area of overall shutter. The rate shall be inclusive of providing
and fixing the shutter with 3 nos. of hinges per shutter leaf.
of the work, the Contractor shall in the presence of the Employer/Engineer show that all the
fixtures and fastening work freely.
Payment
No measurement and Payment shall be done separately for door and window accessories and
fixtures. The cost for supply, installation shall be included for cost of door/window shutter
item.
13.5.2 Materials
Aluminum doors, windows etc. shall be of sizes, sections and details as shown in the
drawings opening schedule list. The details shown in the drawings may be varied slightly to
suit the standards adopted by the manufacturers of the aluminum work, with the approval of
Engineer. Before proceeding with any fabrication work, the contractor shall prepare and
submit, complete fabrication and installation drawings for each type of doors, windows,
ventilators and partition etc. for the approval of Engineer and nothing extra shall be paid on
this account.
Windows shall be made up of aluminum frame sections as required for heavy intermediate
units where operating sash are indicated. For fixed units, use standard intermediate weight.
Materials and building components which the Contractor has to supply and build in, i.e. they
go into the permanent works, must be new and unused. They must comply with standards
and dimensions.
Aluminum frame shall be required 101*38*1.3 mm size or equivalent section. Materials and
building components which the Contractor has to supply and build in, i.e. they go into the
permanent works, must be new and unused. They must comply with standards and
dimensions. The colour of aluminum frame shall be dark brown. Shop drawing shall be
prepared and submitted to the employer for approval.
Aluminum Sheet: Aluminum Sheets for use as panels shall be 1.25 mm thick aluminum
alloy sheet conforming to ASTM B 209. Aluminum alloy sheet for use in general paneling
work shall be of types and thickness as specified and conforming to the requirement of
ASTM B 209. Aluminum sheets shall be of approved make and manufacturer, Aluminum
panel may be prefabricated units manufacture on modular or non-modular dimension.
Glass: unless otherwise stated, the glass shall be clear float glass and should be approved by
the Engineer. All glass shall be of the best quality, free from specks, bubbles, smokes, veins,
air holes, blisters and other defects. Opaque Glass shall be used in case of windows for
toilet bathroom. The thickness of glass shall be 5mm. The kind of glass supplied by the
contractor shall be as mentioned in the item or in the special provision or as shown on the
drawings. The float glass shall conform to the IS 14900.
No products or suppliers are indicated in this Specification. The Contractor shall propose
suitable materials and systems which comply with the intent and performance criteria stated,
whilst remaining fully responsible for the detailed design / co-ordination of the works
including all fixings and associated works to provide a safe and warranted installation.
13.5.3 Measurement
Measurement for payments shall be made in square meter for the completed work as
indicated in the Bill of Quantities. Dimensions shall be measured correct to the nearest 0.01
m i.e. 1 cm. Areas shall be calculated to the nearest 0.01 sq. m. The elevation, height and
width shall be measured out to out of the frame.
The completed aluminum door and window shall be paid at their respective contract unit
rate which shall be the full and the final compensation to the Contractor to complete the
work as per these Specifications.
This specification covers supply, fabrication and fitting of Flywiremesh shutter with timber
frame / MS folded plate on door / window of wooden frames. Flywire mesh of aluminium
windows shall not be included under this item.
13.6.2 Materials
Timber
All timber used for the work shall be seasoned and free from decay, free from any harmful
fungies and insects attacks and from any other damage of harmful nature which will affect
the strength, durability, appearance and usefulness for the purpose for which it is required.
Mild Steel Plate
Mild Steel Plate used for the work shall conform to the relevant IS specification and of size
and section provided as per the drawing.
Fixers and fastening
Providing and fixing in position fixers and fastening per every leaf as per instruction of
Engineer.
Galvanized Iron Wire Gauge
Wire gauge shall be of woven wire webbing. It shall be of 14 to 16 mesh to liner 25 mm
with 28 to 30 gauge GI wire or as approved by Engineer.
13.6.3 Fabrication
The stiles, rails etc. shall be rebated 12 mm(½") along the side to receive the wire gauge.
The galvanized iron fly proof webbing of 14 to 16 mesh to 25 mm linear length shall be
used unless otherwise specified. The webbing shall be bent at 90o at 12 mm (½") along both
side to rebate and fixed securely to stiles, rails and mountings by 12 mm (½") galvanized
Iron staples at about 15 cm (6") intervals, staggered spacing. Fillet shall be of salwood or
shishaum wood or specified timber of size 10 mm x 10 mm (3/8" x 3/8") which shall be
securely and neatly fixed with small screws spaced at 75 mm (3") centres round the rebate
for each hand of webbing after the filets are pressed well into the rebate to hold the wire
mesh. The wire mesh shall be tightly stretched during fixing. The space between filet and
the rebate where the webbing is bent shall be neatly finished with putty so that the cut ends
of the webbing may not be visible. Each shutter shall be fitted with necessary fittings of
approved quality as shown on the drawing.
13.6.4 Measurement
The flywire mesh shutter shall be measured net including the beading in square meter.
Nothing extra shall be admissible for putty, accessories, fixtures etc.
13.7.1 Materials
Glass
All glass shall be of the best quality, free from specks, bubbles, smokes, veins, air holes,
blisters and other defects. The kind of glass supplied by the Contractor shall be as mentioned
in the item or in the special provisions or as shown on the detailed drawings. The thickness
of glass panes shall be uniform. The specifications for different kinds of glasses shall be as
under:
Sheet Glass
This shall be patent float sheet glass of the best quality, weighing 7.5 kg. persq.mupto 60cm
x 60cm panes. For panes larger than 60cm x 60cm and up to 80cm x 80cm the glass
weighing not less than 8.75 kg/sq.m shall be used. For bigger panes upto 90cm x 90cm glass
weighing not less than 1125 kg./sq.m shall be used. Sheet glass for glazing and framing
purposes shall conform to IS 1761:1960. Sheet glass of the specified colours shall be used if
so shown on the detailed drawings or specified in special provisions. For important
buildings and for panes with dimension of over 90cm. plate glass of specified thickness shall
be used.
Float Glass
When float glass is specified, it shall be "polished patent float glass" of the best quality, it
shall have both surface ground flat and parallel and polished to obtain clear undistorted
vision and reflection. The plate shall be of the thickness mentioned in the item, shown in the
detailed drawings or specified in the special provisions. In the absence of any specified
thickness, the thickness of plate glass to be supplied shall be 6mm. A tolerance of 0.50 to
0.80mm shall be admissible on the nominal thickness of polished plate glass.
Obscured Glass
This type of glass transmits light so that the vision is partially or almost completely obscure.
Principal types are plain rolled or doubles rolled, figured, rolled ribbed, fluted frosted glass
on one or both sides and rough cast. The thickness and type shall be as mentioned in the
item or special provisions or detailed drawings. The ribbed or fluted type of glass shall be
used when more diffused types of obscured glass. The thickness and type of glass shall be as
detailed on drawings or as specified in the special provisions and as directed by the
Employer/ Engineer.
Wired Glass
In this type of glass, wire netting is embedded in a sheet or plate glass. Wire mesh is inserted
during rolling. Electrically welded 13mm Georgian square mesh or 22mm hexagonal mesh
is used. The thickness of glass shall not be less than 6mm. Two varieties are:
1. Cast wired which is a transparent wired glass and
2.Polished wired which is a transparent wired glass with both surfaces ground and polished.
Glass Blocks
These may also be called glass bricks. These are used in glass brick panels. These are
hollow glass blocks formed by fusing together two halves of pressed glass and partially
evacuated. The sizes of the bricks shall be shown on the drawings or as specified in the
special provisions. The glass bricks shall be of approved make like those of Pilkington. Ribs,
flutes or prisms shall be cast on one or both of the blocks if specified in the special
provisions for obscuring the glass and to diffuse lights.
Putty
The putty to be used for fixing the glass in wooden frames shall conform to IS 419-1967.
The putty may be coloured to suit the colour of door or window etc. For glaring in metal
sashes putty to be used shall conform to IS 420-1953. Putty shall be composed of best
quality whiting mixed with double boiled linseed oil, properly kneaded to workable
consistency.
Mastic
For glazing in metal sashes, patent mastic shall be used instead of putty, when so specified
in the special provisions or directed by the Employer/ Engineer. Glass bricks shall be laid in
mastic specified by the manufacturers of glass blocks or in 1:3 cement mortar if so specified
in the special provisions.
If the glazier's work is an independent item of work or forms a sub-item combined with any
other item of work, the glazing rate shall include the following
a)Providing the specified type of glass panes of the required dimensions and fixing material.
b)Fixing the glass in the frame as specified, including cutting and waste.
c)Cleaning the glazed work,
d)Repairing of any work damaged during,
e)All labour, material, scaffolding and equipment to carry out the item.
Workmanship
All glass shall be cut to size accurately to suit all openings to be glazed with a slight margin
of about 1.5mm. on all sides as directed, shall be fixed by means of T.W. beads to wooden
and steel windows and by metal spring clips to metal windows and by Rubber/ P.V.C. fillet
in aluminium windows.
Where dry glazing is specified, the glass shall be held in place by moulded wooden fillets
fixed with brass screws,round the end of the glass and between it and wooden fillets, a piece
of chamois or wash leather shall be inserted to act as a cushion.
The mode of fixing shall be specified in the special provision. If not so specified, panes up
to 0.25 sq.m shall be fixed without edge and larger panes shall be fixed with the use of
wooden beads. Unless otherwise specified, all plate glass exceeding 0.5 sq.m in area shall be
fixed with the use of wash leather, felt, valvet, etc., and beads.
No glazing shall be considered complete until all stains have been removed from the surface
of glass and wood work or metal frame.
The Contractor shall make good any glass broken by his work people while fixing or
cleaning. All doors and windows shall be cleaned, all damaged putty or glazing shall be
repaired and the whole left perfect on the completion of the work.
If glazier works is not combined with any other item of work, and is to be paid
independently, the Contract rate shall be per square metre of glazed area fixed and
completed in all respects. The panes shall be measured from rebate to rebate. Each pane of
glass shall be measured to the neatest 0.5cm both in width and height. The curved or
irregularly shaped pieces shall be measured net. The area of each pane shall be worked out
correct up to 2 places of decimals of a square metre and the areas of each class of blazing
shall be worked out separately.
When glazing is included in a composite item of glazing and framework, no separate
measurements for glazier's work shall be made. The composite item for glazing and frame
work will be paid for separately at an inclusive rate.
Payment
No measurement and Payment shall be done separately for glass at door and windows. The
cost for supply, installation shall be included for cost of door/window shutter item.
14 PAINTING WORKS
14.1 General
All paints shall be approved by the Employer/ Engineer, ready mixed paints as received
from the manufacturer without any admixture shall be used. If thinner is necessary in the
case of ready mixed paints, the same shall be recommended by the manufacturers.
The Contractor shall bring all the approved paints to the site of work in their original
containers in sealed condition. Paints which will be sufficient for the entire work or atleast
for a fortnight's work shall be brought in at a time. The empties shall be removed from the
site only when the item of work has been completed and permission obtained from the
Employer/ Engineer. Painting shall be started only when the Employer/ Engineer has
inspected the items of work to be painted, satisfied himself about their proper quality and
given his approval to commence the painting work. Painting, except the priming coat, shall
be taken in hand only after all other builder's work is practically completed. The rooms shall
be thoroughly swiped out and the entire building cleaned up atleast one day in advance of
the paint work being started.
The surface to be painted shall be thoroughly cleaned and dusted. All rust, dirt, scales,
grease etc. shall be removed before painting is started. The prepared surface shall be
approved by the Employer/ Engineer before painting work can commence.
The painting shall be thoroughly stirred in their original containers before pouring them into
smaller tins for use. While applying also, the paint shall be continuously stirred in the
smaller tins so that the consistency is kept uniform. If required, a thinner shall be used to
bring the paint to the required consistency. Two or more coats of painting shall be done
either with brushes or by spraying as stipulated in the item of work.
Each coat shall be allowed to dry out thoroughly before the next coat is applied. Each coat
except the last coat, shall be thoroughly rubbed down with sand paper or fine pumic stone
and cleaned of dust before the next coat is applied. The finished surface shall present a
smooth and even surface without any hair marks from the brush or clogging of paint
puddles. While painting doors and windows, the putty round the glass panes shall also be
painted and care being taken to see that no paint stains etc. are left on the glass. Tops of
shutters and other similar hidden locations shall not be left out in painting.
All painting work shall be measured in sq.m unless otherwise specified. In measuring
painting of joinery and steel work, etc. the co-efficients as given in IS:1200-1964 shall be
used to obtain the areas payable. Unless otherwise specified in the description of the item.
All furniture, fixtures, glazing, floors etc. shall be protected by covering and stains, smears,
splashing if any shall be removed and any damage done shall be made good by the
Contractor at his own cost. The rate shall include the cost of all labour and materials
involved in all the operations described above and any other specifications given under the
relevant it.
The surface to be painted shall be dry and free from moisture. All unevenness shall be
rubbed down smooth with sand paper and shall be well dusted, knots, if any shall be covered
with a preparation of red lead made by grinding red lead in water and mixing with strong
glue size and used hot. The surface treated for knotting shall be dry before the primer is
applied. After the priming coat is applied, the holes etc. on the surface shall be stopped with
putty or wood putty. Stopping shall not be done before the priming cost is applied as the
wood will absorb the oil in the stopping and the later is therefore liable to crack.
14.3.1 Material
The weather coat paint shall be of approved quality and make and it shall be of approved
quality and make and it shall be of approved colour and shade. The contractor shall bring
them to the site in original airtight containers with seals intact.
14.3.2 Workmanship
The dry cement paint shall be thoroughly mixed with clean fresh water so as to produce
paint of required consistency which for normal work shall be that of ordinary paint. In
mixing and application, the Contractor shall follow the manufacturer's instructions. Paint for
application by brush shall be stained through paint strainer. The paint shall be kept stirred
and used within the specified time of the manufacturer. Hardened or damaged paint shall not
be used.
The paint shall be applied by means of brushes and in the manner specified by the
manufacturer. The number of coats shall be as mentioned in the item. The subsequent coats
shall be applied after the preceding coat is properly cured and has thoroughly hardened,
inspected and approved and as per manufacturer's specification. Absorbent surface shall be
evenly damped so as to give even suction. In dry weather, freshly painted surfaces shall be
kept damp for atleast two days and protected from direct sun.
14.3.3 Measurement
The work shall be measured in sq.mof the finished area and shall be in accordance with
IS:1200-1964. The rate shall include the cost of all labour and materials involved in all the
operations described above.
Measurement shall be as follows:
Description of works Measurement Multiplying coefficient
Flush door Flat including frame 1.0 each side
Fully paneled Flat including frame 1.5 each side
Fully glazed Flat including frame 0.5 each side
Part panel/part glazed Flat including frame 1.4 each side
Railing with balusters, 1.0 for painting
guard bars all over-
shall then be allowed to dry for at least 48 hours. It shall then be prepared to give a smooth
and even surface. Any unevenness shall be made good by applying putty made of plaster of
paris mixed with water on the entire surface including filling up the undulations and then
sand papering the same after it is dry.
Two or more coats of emulsion paint as stipulated in the item shall be applied in the usual
manner with brushes and with the interval of minimum three hours between consecutive
coats. The thinner of emulsion shall be done with water as per manufacturer's instructions.
The finished surface shall present a wet velvety smooth finish. If necessary, more coats shall
be applied till the entire surface presents a uniform appearance.
The precautions to be observed in painting walls with emulsion paints are: (a) oil base
putties shall not be used in filling cracks, holes, etc. while preparing the surface (b) Slashes
on floors etc. shall be cleaned immediately as they will be difficult to remove after
hardening surfaces treated with emulsion paints shall not be washed within 3 to 4 weeks of
application.
Measurement
Measurement shall be in accordance with clause 14.3.3.The rate shall include the cost of all
labour and materials involved in all the operations described above.
Measurement
Measurement shall be in accordance with clause 14.3.3.The work shall be measured in sq.m
of the finished area. The rate shall include the cost of all labour and materials involved in all
the operations described above.
15 Steel Works
15.1 Fabrication of Fencing above boundary Wall
The work included under this item includes supplying, fabricating, fixing and painting of
fence above the whole length of boundary wall.
The work shall be fencing with 50mm diameter iron black pipe post erecting in spacing of
2/2 meter cross section connecting by 25x25x4mm angle frame and welding 10mm square
grill @ 80 mm c/c and welding of 2x10mm square grill of height 0.15 mm including primer
as per drawing attached.
Payment
Measurement for payment of fence shall be made on square metre on the basis of actual
measurements. Payment shall be made for the quantity as provided at the unit price specified
in the schedule. The unit price shall include all labors, equipment, materials, paints and all
other cost necessary for the performance and completion of the works.
Measurement for payment of spiral staircase shall be made on the basis of vertical floor to
floor height of building in metre. Payment shall be made for running meter measured
vertically as provided at the unit price specified in the schedule. The unit price shall include
all labors, equipment, materials and all other cost necessary for the performance and
completion of the works.
15.2 Materials
Stainless steel pipes (heavy) and fittings as specified shall comply with relevant IS code
specification.
15.4 Paint
The railing shall be finished with one coat of red lead followed by one coat of aluminum
paint and fixed in position as per instruction of Engineer.
15.5 Measurement
Measurement and payment shall be done in Running Metre along the length as in
construction. The rate for the item shall include all labour, materials, paints, use of tools and
machinery inclusive.
17.2 Measurement
The work shall be measured in lump sum unit or lot of all items explained in 17.1. The rate
shall include the cost of all labour and materials involved in all the operations described
above.
1. WATER SUPPLY
This section covers the basic requirements for water supply, general requirement of
plumbing connection of water supply systems from external RCC water tank to overhead
water tanks and then each taps outlets.
Staff Quarter building shall require 3 x 1000 ltr of overhead tank and Guard cum Store
House shall require 1 x 1000 ltr overhead tank.
All pipe work shall be so laid or fixed and maintained as to be and to remain watertight
thereby avoiding waste of water, damage too properly and the risk of contamination of water
conveyed.
Underground piping shall be laid at such a depth that it is unlikely to be damaged by frost of
traffic loads and vibrations. Special precautions shall be taken to avoid damage to the piping
by corrosion, water hammering. No bend shall be made abrupt to avoid friction loss.
1.2 Materials
All plumbing works shall be concealed and performed with 3/4", 1" & 2" PPR or UPVC
pipes to the approval of the Employer. Two ½" tap points for external use shall be provided
outside the staff quarter and guard house as directed by the Employer.
All fittings for pipe shall be PPR or UPVC. All pipes shall be tested before use in laying. In
general, the pipe diameter shall be in the range of 3/4"-2". Stop-cock, valve etc. shall be of
appropriate diameter and capacity made from gun metal of approved quality and make.
Jointing of pipes shall be as per good practice and or as directed.
No bend or curve in any line shall be made as it shall diminish the water way or internal
diameter of pipe. Water pipes are cut to size ends to be connected shall be threaded and
screwed with sockets, joints of pipes to make all of them completely water tight. All
branching or bend shall be done with the help of T or U bends connected with couplings and
sockets.
Where no method of disposal is possible, foul water may be collected and dispersed into
subsoil, the general sub-soil water level and the sub-soil conditions shall be ascertained
including the absorptive capacity of the soil.
If the sub-soil dispersed or soak pit system would be followed, the pit shall not be in the
vicinity of water supply source at least by 50 m.
The efficient and adequate system shall be proposed by the Contractor for approval of the
Employer/ Engineer.
2.3 TESTING
All soil pipes, waste pipes, vent pipes, and all other pipes when above ground shall be
approved by the Employer/ Engineer. Smoke test may be conducted under pressure or
25mm of water maintained for 15 minutes after all trap seals have been filled with water.
Any leakage will be visible and the defective part of work shall be made good by the
contractor on his own cost.
3.2 MATERIALS
All sanitary fittings shall be of Commercial Perryware, Hindustan Neycer, or similar as
approved by the Employer/ Engineer. Alternatively a schedule of other manufactured
fittings may be submitted for approval of the Employer/Engineer and these shall be
indicated in detail along with the tender.
3.3 FITTINGS
ASIAN W.C.
The W.C. shall be of white vitreous China Orissa pattern with 100mm dia. H.C.C. syphone
with vent arm S or P trap with ISI mark. The Orrissa pattern pane shall be fitted with C. P.
flush valve of standard make.
WASH BASIN
The wash basin shall be of white vitreous China lavatory basin of size 560mm x 456mm
with one or double tap as per direction, 32mm chrome plate waste pipe 1 meter chain stay
and plug, pair of C.P. built in brackets, 32mm C.P. bottle trap, 'S' or 'P' trap,12mm lead
connecting .5m long with both end coupling joint.
KITCHEN SINK
Sink for kitchen shall be of 60 x 45 x 22 cm with drain board; stainless steel with 12mm
C.P. bibcock, 45cm long lead connector, 32mm C.P. wasteline shall be provided with
1m long lead waste pipe.
SOAP DISC
The soap disc shall be of white glazed porcelain or C.P. wall mounted as directed by the
Employer/ Engineer.
GLASS SELF
The glass self shall be specified size with C.P. guard rail and bracket with C.P. sorews glass
shall be 6mm thick with edge round off.
TOWEL RAIL
Towel rail shall be one arm, two or multiple arm fixed on fixed on wall and shall be C.P.
MIRROR
The mirror shall be of at least 6 mm thick silver backed, best quality as approved by the
Employer/ Engineer. The mirror shall be with backlight frame.
The fixing and fitting of the sanitary wares and fixtures to the plate shall be in accordance
with the good practice. The material used shall be as specified or as directed by the
Employer/ Engineer.
The rate also include painting, chase cutting, and making good the damage with
required materials up to the civil work specification.The rate shall be inclusive of bib cocks,
stop-cocks, accessories needed for fixing fitting and to run the fixtures in good condition as
directed and approved by the Employer/ Engineer.
I ELECTRICAL INSTALLATION
1 GENERAL
1.1 The following specifications will apply under all circumstance to the equipments and fittings
to be supplied and installed against this contract and it is to be insured that the Contractor
shall obtain for himself at his own expenses and his own responsibility all the purpose of
making the tender and for entering into a contract keeping in view the specifications detailed
hereunder, drawings and design of the electrical installation and inspection of site etc. All
electrical works to be executed under this contract shall be carried out of a highest degree of
technical quality and workmanship. Installation shall be safe, simple, systematic order so
that a general electrician can easily solve the problem arises during the maintenance of the
system.
1.2 The tender rates shall include for the cost of material, erection, connection, testing and
commissioning, supervision, transport, tools, all taxes, breakage, wastage, sundries,
scaffolding, and maintenance of installation works for guarantee period of one year etc.
2 SCOPE OF WORK
2.1 The scope of work under this contract shall under due consideration of the
requirements as stipulated in the specification include;
a) Supply and installation of the main panel board, distribution boards, sub distribution
boards and energy meter after getting approval from the Employer.
b) Supply and Installation of minimum 25 sq. mm three phase copper cable with cable shoes
from control room to staff quarter having total length of 100m, if supply cannot be provided
from control building, it is the responsibility of contractor to take the supply from service
mains.
c) Supply and laying of 1100 V grade multi core PVC insulated copper cable.
d) Supply and wiring of Light/Fan and Power points with PVC insulated copper conductor
cables in concealed HDP pipe in wall, ceiling and floors as per drawings.
e) Supply and erection of Telephone Distribution Board and Telephone junction boxes as per
drawings.
f) Supply and fixing of lighting fixtures, power & telephone sockets, switches etc. as per
drawings.
g) Supply and embedding of Earthing Materials and connections to Main & Sub Distribution
Boards with bare copper conductor in concealed HDP pipe wherever applicable.
h) Excavation, backfill, cutting and patching, brick-work and concrete work, sleeves, inserts,
anchors, etc. as required for proper installation in accordance with the requirements
drawings and specifications.
i) Testing and commissioning of the electrical equipment's including Main and Sub
distribution Boards, lighting fixtures, power and telephone sockets etc.
j) Where the electrical work is associated with the work of the others, the contractors
shall confer with the persons affected and shall furnish them with all necessary information,
drawings, dimensions etc. andshall coordinate the electrical work with the work of other
trades to insure a satisfactory installation, in accordance with the drawings and
specifications and with the high standards of trade practices base on I.S. code of practice.
k) Whenever recessed fittings are required to be provided the electrical contractor shall be
responsible for informing the building contractor to keep the necessary recesses in the slab,
columns, beams and in the false ceiling.
3 DESCRIPTION OF WORK
The description of work includes the following:
- L.V. electrical installation of Quarter Building and Compound for Kirtipur 132 kV
Substation Project.
- Supply and laying of PVC insulated copper cable armoured and unarmoured of
different sizes laid in ground, PVC duct, HDP conduit as mention in the BOQ.
- Supply and laying of PVC insulated telephone indoor pair type cables of different sizes laid
in PVC duct and HDP conduit as mentioned in the BOQ.
- Laying PVC type conduits for computer networking and smoke detector.
- Supply and installation of Main Panel Board, Distribution Board and Sub Distribution
Board, lighting fixtures, power and telephone sockets, switches, earthing and Telephone
Distribution Boards, Telephone junction boxes as per drawings and specifications.
- Laying of HDP pipe in wall, ceiling and floors and drawing of conductor through HDP pipe
as per drawing and specifications.
- Testing and commissioning.
1.2. All wiring shall be installed in accordance with British or Indian standards and shall be
conduit wiring or as instructed by the Employer/ Engineer.
1.3. The system shall have 230V, 50Hz, single phase two wire AC supply or 400 V,50Hz three
phase system four wire AC supply whichever applicable as per drawing or as
instructed by the Employer/ Engineer.
1.4. The notation R, Y and B in the three phase system indicate three different phases to be
connected in the circuits and while connecting the circuits the color codes of different
phases should be strictly followed.
1.5. The incoming section of three-phase main distribution board shall be provided with suitable
barriers to maintain phase segregation.
1.6. All electrical fittings and wiring accessories shall be installed in accordance withIS – 1963.
1.7. The system should provide ease to fittings for maintenance and repair and for any possible
modification to the system.
1.8. There shall be two distinct circuits, one for lights and fans and the other for power
appliances.
1.9. Prior to the installation of the lighting, fans and plug points and distribution boards, switches
etc. final positions shall be ascertained by the Contractor with the Employer/ Engineer.
5 SWITCHES
5.1 A switch shall be provided adjacent to the normal entrance to any area for controlling the
general lighting in that area; the switches should be fixed in a usable wall space and should
not be obstructed by a door or window in its fully open position. One light shall be
connected to both switch and separate electronic solid fan regulator. Only in some cases two
lights with one switch and three lights with one switch shall be connected as shown in the
drawings.
6 FLEXIBLE CORDS
6.1 Flexible cords shall be used only for pendants and for connection of fixtures only.
Flexible cords shall not be used in the following cases.
(a) As a substitute for the fixed wiring.
(b) For concealed wiring.
(c) If attached permanently to the walls, ceiling. etc.
7 MATERIALS
7.1 The contractor has to get approval of the drawing if applicable and the samples of all the
materials and equipments to be supplied and installed under this contract. Non approval
given by the Employer/ Engineer to any drawings or samples submitted by the contractor
shall in any way exonerate the Contractor from his liability to carry out the work in
accordance with the terms of the contract.
7.2 All materials and equipments shall be new and shall be in accordance with the standard as
established by the Indian standard. Where material or equipment are specified or shown on
the drawings by name of the other manufactures may be considered for use if of equal
quality appearance and electrical and mechanical characteristics and approved by the
Employer/ Engineer. If the Contractor wishes to use any other materials or equipment, he
must obtain permission of the Employer/ Engineer in writing.
7.3 Any material supplied by the Employer, if damaged in any way during the execution of
work or otherwise, shall be replaced by the Contractor at his own cost.
8 INSTALLATION
8.1 Installation of all lighting shall be done experienced electricians and supervised by the
Employer/ Engineer. Lighting fixtures shall not be done installed until wall and ceiling
finishing work is completed.
8.2 All pendent type fixtures in the same room shall be installed at a uniform height from the
floor level. Mounted fixtures shall be properly aligned and mounted as indicated on the
drawings or as directed by the Employer/ Engineer. Where the fixtures does not itself
provide a suitable cover for the fixture outlet box, suitable cover plate on canopy shall be
provided.
10 QUALITY OF WORK
10.1 The work shall be carried out in the best workman like manner and any defect or minor
changes in the design etc. If pointed out shall be carried out by the contractor without any
extra charge.
10.2 Workmanship and good appearance of the installation shall be of equal, and all portions of
the work shall be so laid and installed that the work as whole is of uniform quality and shall
present a neat appearance in a manner meeting the approval of the Employer/ Engineer.
10.3 The Contractor shall verify in the field all measurements necessary for the electrical work
and shall assume responsibility.
11.3 The Contractor/Engineer shall employ adequate labours to complete the work within the
schedule time and shall make his own arrangement for housing labor and materials
etc. A whole time electrical supervisor shall be employed by the Contractor who will remain
at site to receive orders or any other instructions from the Employer/ Engineer.
11.4 Materials which are defective or damaged during the progress of work shall be
replaced or repaired in as approved manner at the expense of the Contractor. The installation
shall comply with all applicable laws and ordinances and with the requirements of Indian
codes and as specified herein or shown on the drawings. The progress of the electrical works
shall be carried out so as to conform to the progress of the work and entire installation shall
be completed as soon as the condition of the building will permit.
11.5 Upon completion of the installation of the lighting fixtures and lighting equipments, they
must be in first class operation condition and in perfect conditions. At the time of final
inspection, all fixtures and equipment must be complete, with lamps and required
glassware or reflector, which must be clean and free from defects. Any fixtures, reflectors or
glassware brown prior to the time of final inspection and acceptance, shall be replaced at the
Contractor’s expense.
presence of the Employer/ Engineer. Any defect or damages in way during testing and
commissioning shall be corrected or replaced by the Contractor at his own cost.
175 Amp, TP 36 kA 1 No
60 Amp, TP 36 kA 2 No
15.1 Provisions for connecting the incoming outgoing cables mentioned in the Bill Of Quantities,
all accessories including connections, fixing cable lugs, insulating materials etc. all
complete.
15.2 The panel board shall be Himalaya BijuliUdhyog or Hyonjan Electrical Fabricator or
equivalent and tested according to the BS or IS specifications.
23 LAYING OF CABLES
The cable shall be so laid that they will not interfere with other structures. All water pipes,
sewerage line or other facilities if exposed during the excavation in laying the cable shall be
properly supported and protected until the back filling and compaction around the these
facilities is completed. Sufficient clearances of electrical cable from other facilities line
should be maintained as per BS or IS specification.
Where cables are laid directly in the ground cable trenches of sufficient width, it shall be
excavated at least below 3 ft from the ground level. Cable shall be covered by fine sand at
least 3" both above and below of the cable and protected on top by bricks across the trench
cross section. Road crossing should be avoided where possible, if a cable has to be laid
across the road / drain a suitable size of RCC hume pipe shall be used to protect the cable.
If two or more cables are laid in the same trench care should be taken in maintaining proper
spacing between them as mentioned in BS/IEE regulations or IS specification so that current
carrying capacities of the cables will not be affected
Care should be taken not to damage or unnecessary strain in cable .In case of
installing the cable in PVC duct and HDP excessive bends should be avoided.
24 CONDUIT
Electrical conduit used in the final sub-circuits of the electrical services shall be rigid, non-
metallic HDP conduit of an approved manufacturer conforming to IS: 2509 and shall be
used only with corresponding approved accessories.
The size of the conduit shall be in accordance with the number and size of electrical cables
to be drawn into the conduit. The number of cables that may be drawn in a conduit shall be
as specified in the table below or as stipulated in the appropriate section of the IS code or
equivalent. Conduit sizes shall not be less than 19 mm diameter.
Conduit shall be embedded in building structural works and conduit runs shall be straight
and shall follow the shortest route between points or as shown in electrical drawings.
Wherever necessary bends or diversion may be achieved by bending the conduit or by
employing approved bends, inspection boxes, elbows or similar fitting. Conduit accessories
such as ceiling outlets, junction boxes shall be of approved quality. The physical
integrity or the conduit and accessories as an integral electrical component shall be ensured
by approved means such as the use of water-resistant cement bonding on all unscrewed
conduit joints and termination and use of rubber gasket in entry points to junction boxes or
outlets or other approved means.
Conduit embedded in civil works shall include an 18 SWG galvanized 'fish' wire inserted
during the time of conduit laying to facilitate drawing in cables a later stage.
26 POWER POINTS
26.1 Concealed wiring to power socket outlets shall be by means of 2x7/22 SWG PVC+1x3/22
SWG or 2x7/20 SWG PVC +1x3/20 SWG PVC insulated 600 V grade,single core, standard
copper conductor cables in a concealed rigid 3/4 diameter HDPpipe in the floor, slab or
brickwork and terminated in 18 SWG thick GI sheet metal boxes conforming to the relevant
Indian or British standards to meet the approval of the Employer/ Engineer.
26.2 The power points include the materials required for the connection of socket outlets to the
MCB’s installed on the sub-distribution boards as shown on the drawings.
30 POWER SOCKETS
30.1 All the power outlet shall be 230 V, 50 Hz 5/15A, 3 pin Switch socket SP Dyna type switch
suitable for recessed mounting and flush finish on wall including 18 SWG thick GI sheet
metal box and screws and shall be installed 20 cm above the finished floor level.
30.2 The type of power outlets shall be CPL/Anchor Dyna type or equivalent as approved by the
Employer/ Engineer.
30.3 The power outlets shall be switched and earthed with 1*3/20 SWG or 1x3/22 SWG PVC
insulated stranded copper wire.
32 TELEPHONE SOCKETS
The entire telephone sockets outlet shall be 230 V, 50Hz, 2 pin, suitable for recessed
mounting and flush finish on wall with 18 SWG thick GI sheet metal box and screws and
shall be installed 20 cm. above the finished floor level.
The type of telephone socket outlets shall be CPL/Anchor or equivalent as approved by the
Employer/ Engineer.
Telephone sockets shall be 2 gang and one gang as mentioned in the bill of quantities.
The telephone distribution board shall include the connection of all telephone sockets to the
main supply as instructed by the Employer/ Engineer.
100 Pair box shall be with three incoming 20 pair cable and five outgoing cable (4x20 pair
cable +1x10 pair cable) total pair in DB shall be 60 pair. In case of 50 pair boxes there will
be three incoming 2x 20 pair cable +1x10 pair cable and four outgoing cable (3x 20
pair+1x10 pair cable).total pair in DB shall be 40 pairs.
spring loaded prismatic polystyrene louver assembly. It shall be BJSL418 Bajaj or TBS
74/418 Phillips or equivalent.
Industrial type luminaires shall be comprising of 2x36 W tube light, copper wound polyester
filled ballast,starters etc. it shall have a mounting channel and covers madefrom CRCA
sheet steel ,stove enameled. Vitreous enameled reflector which can be installed and removed
without aid of any tools. It shall be TKC 24/236 Phillips type or equivalent.
Decorative 1x18 W wall mounted tube light luminaires shall consist of CRCA sheet steel
stove enameled white inside & outside, copper wound polyester filled ballast, starters,1x18
W tube light and other accessories. A guiding stud and two number of end caps shall be
provided.
Garden light shall be of decorative post top lanterns consisting of aluminum canopy, opal
acrylic bottom cover and cast spigot, suitable for use with 150W GLS lamps/HPMV 125
W/70 W HPSV lamp. It shall be fitted with 150 W GLS lamp and also inclusive of 75 mm
dia galvanized pipe of 2.0 meter long and other accessories.
37 INTERCOM CABLES
The type of intercom cables shall be as specified in price schedule and bill of quantity but if
the contractor has to supply equivalent quality in such a case it has to be approved by the
Employer/ Engineer. Before installation the contractor has to approve the samples by the
Employer/ Engineer.
Intercom cable shall connect PABX to telephone distribution boards(TDB) and TDB to
telephone junction boxes. Main telephone cable shall be laid in PVC duct and HDP pipe as
mention in the BOQ. PVC duct shall be of 4"x3"& 4"x4" size depending upon the number
of the cable as shown in the drawing.
The intercom cables shall be connected to all telephone distribution boards from PABX
system through a concealed rigid 1” dia. HDP pipe in wall, floors and ceiling as shown on
the drawing or as instructed by the Employer/ Engineer.
Split type wall mounted room air conditioners shall be operated on 230 V, 50 Hz. The
heating and cooling capacity shall be minimum 22000 BTU/hr and 27000 BTU/hr
respectively. It shall be highly efficient and shall have at least following features:
- low vibration twin rotary compressor
- power select function
- power level monitor
- auto change over (cooling/heating)
- auto restart function
- 24 hr on off programmable timer
- 1 hr off timer
- Auto swing louver & auto air swing
- LCD wireless remote control
- Detachable & washable front panel & air filter.
38 EARTHING
38.1 EARTHING SET
The earthing shall be done as per IS 3043-1966. The earthing set shall consist of the
following:
a) 600x600x3.15 mm electrolytic copper plate as earth electrode;
b) The hard drawn copper earth strip of size 25x3.15 mm shall connect the earth electrode,
main panel, and distribution boards as per drawing and instruction;
c) 1/4"dia,1"long electroplated copper nuts & bolts;
d) 1.5 meter long,19mm dia, GI pipe and other required accessories for watering;
e) Cement concrete work of ratio 1:4:8 for watering arrangement as per drawing;
f) Charcoal and salt;
g) 600x600x50 mm concrete slab cover
Codes of Practice:
(a) Wiring BS 3346
(b) Cables BS 2004
(c) Earthing IS 3043-1966
(d) Electrical wiring installation IS 732-1963
(e) Switchgear installation IS 3072-1965 Part I
(f) Light protection IS 2309-1969
(g) Fixtures IEC Lighting hand book (5th edition.)
(h) Emergency lights BS 5266
(i) Luminaries IEC 598
CHAPTER - 30
INSPECTION, TESTING AND COMMISSIONING
1 SCOPE OF WORK
The whole of the Works supplied under the Contract shall be subject to inspections and
tests by the Employer or their Representatives during manufacture, erection and after
completion. The inspections and tests shall include, but not be limited to, the
requirements of this section of the Specifications.
The Contractor shall provide all costs, appliances, apparatus, supervision, labor and
services necessary to carry out all tests, unless specifically stated otherwise.
The Contractor shall furnish the detailed schedule of his commissioning plan at least
one month prior to the scheduled date. The schedule shall include the commissioning
procedures, testing sequences and details of special testing equipment, tests and
commissioning record formats, information about relevant standards etc.
The scope of the commissioning program includes the site testing and putting into
successful operation of all the equipment supplied under the Contract for
132kVtransmission line and substation. Testing of energy meters and certification of
their accuracy shall also be included.
2 OBJECTIVES
- Review workmanship.
To assure that the supply and services under the scope of this Contract whether
manufactured or performed within the Contractor’s works or at his subcontractor’s
premises or at the Site or at any other place of work, are in accordance with the
Specifications, the Contractor shall adopt suitable quality assurance program to control
such activities at all points necessary. Such program shall be outlined by the Contractor
and shall be finally accepted by the Employer after discussions before the award of the
Contract. A quality assurance program of the Contractor shall generally cover, but not be
limited to the following:
(a) His organization structure for the management and implementation of the
proposed quality assurance program.
(d) The procedure for purchases of materials, parts, components, and selection of
sub-contractors’ services including vendor analysis, source inspection, incoming
raw materials inspection, and verification of materials purchases.
(e) System for shop manufacturing including process controls and fabrication and
assembly controls.
(n) A quality plan detailing out the specific quality control procedure adopting for
controlling the quality characteristics relevant to each item of supply.
The quality plan shall be mutually discussed and approved by the Employer after
incorporating necessary corrections by the Contractor as may be required.
The Contractor shall be required to submit all the Quality Assurance Documents as
stipulated in the Quality Plan at the time of Employer’s inspection of
material/equipment.
The Employer, through his duly authorized representatives, reserves the right to
carry out Quality Audit and Quality Surveillance of the systems and the procedures
of the Contractor’s and the subcontractor’s Quality Management and Control
Activities.
The provisions of the clauses on Test and Inspection of the General Conditions of
Contract and Special Conditions of Contract shall be applicable to the supply and erection
portions of the Works. The Employer shall have the right to re-inspect at his expenses,
any material though it would have been previously inspected and approved by him at the
Contractor’s works before, and if, after the same are inspected at Site following the latter,
material is found defective, then the Contractor shall bear the cost of this inspection and
reinstatement according to specification.
4.1 General
Where no specific test is specified, then the various items of materials and equipment
shall be tested in accordance with the relevant IEC Standards. Where no appropriate
standard is available, tests shall be carried out in accordance with the maker's standard
practice, which shall be subject to the Employer’s approval.
At least fourteen days’ prior notice, in writing or by telefax, shall be given to the
Employer of the readiness of the plant for test or inspection and every facility shall be
provided by the Contractor and subcontractor (s) to enable the Employer or their
Representative to carry out the inspections and witness the tests. This includes progress,
test rig and packing inspections also.
Inspection of equipment will not be carried out unless the Employer has approved copies
of the relevant sub-orders, drawings and test procedures.
No equipment shall be packed, prepared for shipment, or dismantled for the purpose of
packing for shipment, unless it has been satisfactorily inspected, or inspection has been
waived by the Employer.
Functional electrical and mechanical tests shall be carried out on the completed plant
after assembly in the Works. The extent and method of recording the results shall be
agreed by the Employer in sufficient time to enable the tests to be satisfactorily
witnessed or to make any changes to the proposed program of tests.
All instruments and apparatus used in the performance of the tests shall be subject to the
approval of the Employer and, if required by the Employer, shall be calibrated to an
agreed standard at a laboratory of national standing to be nominated by the Contractor
and approved by the Employer.
The costs of carrying out such calibration shall be borne by the Contractor in all cases.
The costs of making any test shall be borne by the Contractor. This shall apply to tests
performed at the site or elsewhere.
After receiving the prior information about the completion of manufacturing at the
factory, the Employer will depute his personnel to the Contractor’s factory to witness the
fabrication, assembly and testing of any or all parts of major equipment. The number of
the Employer's personnel and equipment to be witnessed will be as listed below. The
duration of such visits shall be as per inspection/testing requirements.
The daily allowances and travelling expenses of the inspectors nominated by the
Employer will be borne by Employer. However, the Contractor shall bear all the
expenses occurred due to the repetition of the tests required due to:
Within30 days of the completion of any test, triplicate sets of all principal test
records, test certificates and performance curves shall be supplied to the
Employer.
These test records, certificates and performance curves shall be supplied for all
tests, whether or not they have been witnessed by the Employer or his
representative. The information given on such test certificates and curves shall be
sufficient to identify the material or equipment to which the certificate refers and
should also bear the Contract reference title. Specified requirements shall be
shown on each certificate for comparison with actual test results.
When all equipment has been tested, test certificates of all factory and site
tests shall be compiled by the Contractor into volumes and bound in an
approved form complete with index. Two copies of each volume shall be
supplied to the Consultant and five copies to the Employer.
Type tests are required to prove the general design of the equipment and the
Contractor may submit certificates of such design tests, which have been carried
out on identical equipment. Notwithstanding any provision in BS, IEC or ANSI
Standards, the Employer shall have the right to accept such certificates in lieu of
the specified type tests or to reject them.
The type tests prescribed shall be carried out at the Contractor's cost in all cases,
where either such certificates are not available or are rejected by the Employer.
5 RESPONSIBILITIES
The Employer shall retain full jurisdiction over all commissioning activities,
which may affect the operation of the existing system. In these circumstances
and when so requested, shall provide technical advices and assistances.
6 SAFETY PROCEDURES
The Contractor shall share the responsibility for safety procedures with the
Employer.
The Contractor shall establish and implement a work permit and tagging
system and associated safety procedures (subject to the review of Employer)
for all equipment, systems and areas not covered by the Employer’s safety
procedures.
The Contractor shall plan for the Employer’s staffs’ participation, either
continuously or on a regularly recurring basis, in the commissioning work
and:
Allow the Employer’s staffs to become familiar with the operating and
maintenance aspects of the new equipment supplied by him,
Allow for the above two necessary objectives in the preparation of schedules.
The Contractor shall station at site, at least, one technical expert for a
minimum of six months continuously after commissioning to rectify any
problems, as well as train the Employer's attending staffs. If required, the
length of his stay shall be extended as per requirement, which shall be at the
Employer's discretion.
8 COMMISSIONING STAFF
Ensure that only staffs assigned to commissioning fulfills that duty for the
duration of the assignment.
9 TEST EQUIPMENT
The Contractor shall ensure that all instruments, tools and other equipment
required for testing and commissioning are available on site, ensure that the
test equipment is of satisfactory quality and condition and, where necessary, is
calibrated by an approved authority or standard.
Make arrangements for the provision of power supplies for testing with
necessary vector configuration, voltage and current rating.
10 COMMISSIONING PROGRAM
Carry out all testing during normal working hours as far as practicable. Tests,
which involve existing apparatus and system outages, may be carried out
outside normal working hours. Give the Employer sufficient notice to allow
for the necessary outage arrangements to be made in conformity with the
testing program.
Note that no tests listed in the agreed program will be waived except upon the
instructions or consent of the Employer in writing.
The field tests shall be carried out in presence of Employer under the
following conditions:
The field tests shall be carried out by the Contractor after adjustment of all the
equipment have been completed.
Expandable and lead wires and other materials required for the field tests shall
be arranged by the Contractor. The Contractor shall be responsible for
providing all measuring instruments, test equipment and tools required for the
tests.
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage-Two Envelope
Chapter 30 – Inspection, Testing and Commissioning Page 30-9
Preparation of the test record sheets and test reports shall be the responsibility
of the Contractor and the results of the field tests shall be submitted by the
Contractor for Employer’s approval.
Measurement of insulation resistance of the equipment shall be performed by
at least 1000 V Insulation tester.
- 11, 33 and 132 kV Main Circuit: The 11 kV, 33 kV and 132 kV circuit
breakers and disconnecting switches, except for circuit breakers
receiving power for the test from the existing power system through a
transmission line, shall be closed, succeeding, normal operation
voltage shall be charged on the equipment and bus conductors for ten
(10) minutes for ac withstand voltage test. The indication value of
meters mounted on the board during the ac withstand voltage test shall
be recorded on the test record sheets prepared by the Contractor.
Submit test procedures, consisting of detailed test methods and samples of the
related test record forms, for all equipment to be tested, to the Employer for
approval along with the commissioning program. Strictly adhere to these
procedures for the commissioning tests.
10.3 Records
Record the results of the tests clearly on forms and formats approved by the
Employer and with clear references to the equipment and items tested, so that
the record can be used as the basis for maintenance tests, in future. Submit the
required number of site test records to the Employer as soon as possible after
completion of the tests.
Record the details of the test equipment and instruments used in the test
sheets, in those cases where the instrument or equipment characteristics can
have a bearing on the test results.
Carry out all necessary tests for commissioning the transmission line and
substation. The following clauses detail the tests which are considered to
represent the minimum required in addition to those specified under the
appropriate IEC Publications, other approved standards and the
manufacturer’s instructions for each item of equipment.
General Checks
Check for oil and gas leaks and that insulators are clean and free from
external damage. Check that loose items, which are to be handed over
to the Employer, e.g., blanking plates, tools, spares, etc. are in order
and are correctly stored or handed over.
Power Transformers
Check and set pressure switches settings when required. Also test
mechanical operating systems.
Test local and remote trip/close operation and perform circuit breaker
and auxiliary contact timing tests on all circuit breakers.
Carry out a high voltage 50 Hz dielectric test on each bus at 75% of the
specified value for the equivalent factory test.
Check the local and remote indications and the operation of auxiliary
contacts. Check the earthing mat at the operating positions and check
the availability of connecting points for maintenance earthing
arrangements.
Lightning Arresters
Check rigid busbars and connections to ensure that the busbars will not
cause overloading of the supporting insulators under load conditions
and under the range of climatic variations applicable to the Site.
Ensure that expansion and contraction of the equipment is fully
accommodated by flexible connections.
Perform high voltage DC tests on all HV cables and isolated phase bus
bars at 75% of the specified value for the equivalent factory test. Carry
out with at least 1000 V DC megger the insulation measurement test,
before and after high voltage tests.
Record the specific gravity and cell voltages of the batteries during the
initial charge and when fully charged and maintain proper regular
records until the battery is taken over by the Employer.
Interlocking
B) Earthing System
C) Area Lighting
Tests on completion
Acceptance tests shall be carried out on Site by the Contractor on each section of the
Works. These tests shall immediately follow the commissioning of each section of the
Works.
The lines shall be energized at full working voltage before handing over and the
arrangement for this, and such other tests as the Employer shall desire to make on the
complete line, shall be assisted by the Contractor who shall provide such labor,
transport and other assistance as is required without any extra charge. Apparatus for
special tests shall be provided by the Contractor.
The Contractor shall submit to the Employer at least two months before the
anticipated commencement of acceptance tests his detailed proposal for carrying out
acceptance tests.
Test instrumentation
The method of measuring all quantities and qualities and the measurement tolerances
shall be in accordance with the appropriate BS, ISO or ANSI.
The terminal conditions required for establishing whether the guarantees are met shall
be measured by precision test equipment to be installed by the Contractor in addition
to the permanent measuring equipment where supplied under the contract.
The overall design of the Works shall provide for the installation and use of test
equipment so as not to interfere with the plant loading or delay the guarantee
completion dates.
All the precision test equipment to be used for carrying out tests shall be calibrated
against standard instruments before the tests, and if required by the Employer, also
after the tests. Calibration records shall be available for inspection by the Employer or
his Representative.
During the design stage of the plant, the contractor shall give details of measurements
to be made to substantiate that the performance of the plant meets the requirements of
the specification and in particular shall submit for approval a schedule of performance
test instrumentation necessary to demonstrate the guarantees.
Test reports
For each of the specified tests the contractor shall agree the test figures with the
Employer and shall submit for approval triplicate copies of the test report containing a
complete analysis of the test results within one month of the completion of the
relevant test. Eight copies of the final approved report shall be submitted to the
Employer.
Commissioning Test
The contractor shall be responsible for checking that total and relative sags of
conductors are within the specified tolerances. Such checks shall be carried out at
positions along the route selected by the Employer and the contractor shall provide
the necessary surveying instruments to enable the checks to be carried out with the
line in service without any extra charge.
The commissioning tests are as follows:
Measurement of line parameters
The line insulation resistance shall be measured on each individual section of the lines
before the jumper loops are closed and again on the whole lines when they are
completed.
The electrical parameters of the lines such as resistance, reactance, suspectance etc.
shall be measured in a manner to be approved by the Employer, sufficiently
The electric power necessary for the tests at Site shall be supplied by the Employer.
The contractor shall satisfy himself that all connections are good before switching
power and shall be responsible for, and make good any damage that may arise
because of faulty connections.
All D.C. measuring apparatus, instruments including D.C. high voltage testing unit
will be subject to checking and calibration by the Employer before starting the high
voltage D.C. current test, catalogues and details to be submitted with offer. Full
details and catalogue of the proposed high voltage D.C. testing equipment shall be
submitted for approval before shipping the test equipment.
Field test quality plan
A field test quality plan is given in the appendix-10.1. The Contractor shall provide
necessary information to the Employer / site engineer so that the tests are conducted
and results recorded well.
5. Angle of Devn.
2. Check Tower i) Alignment a. Route Contractor 100% at Field i) All angle towers To be notified
Survey Location & ii) Final Length alignment -do- in plains and 50% by the Employer
Final Length b. Tower Schedule -do- in hilly terrains.
1. Definition
2. Overall Procedures
3. Safety procedures
4. Inspection
5. Statutory Requirements
6. Handing over
7. Protective system
8. Dispatch procedures
9. Switching procedures
10. Testing
11. Energization
12. De-energization
13. Observations and duration
14. Passing criteria
15. Documentation
1.2 Definition
"Main Transmission Lines" means all high pressure cables and overhead lines (not being an
essential part of the distribution system of a licensee) transmitting electricity from a
generating station to another generating station or a sub-station, together with any step-up
and step-down transformers, switch-gear and other works necessary to and used for the
control of such cables or overhead lines, and such buildings or part thereof as may be
required to accommodate such transformers, switch-gear and other works and the operating
staff thereof;
"Power System" means a system under the control of the Government or any other statutory
body of Generating Company or other agency and having one or more:-
Generating station;
Or
Main transmission lines and sub-stations;
Or
Generating stations and main transmission lines and substations;
"Load Dispatch Centre" means the Centre so designated where the operation of Integrated
Nepal Power System constituting the country's power system is coordinated;
"Sub-Station" means a station for transforming or converting electricity for the transmission
or distribution thereof and includes transformers, convertors, switch-gear, capacitors,
synchronous condensers, structures cables and other appurtenant equipments and any
buildings used for that purpose and the site thereof, a site intended to be used for any such
purpose and any buildings used for housing the staff of the sub section;
"Tie-Line" means a line for the transfer of electricity between two power systems together
with switchgear and other works necessary to, and used for the control of such line.
1.3 Overall Procedure
First it is to be ascertained that the transmission line to be energized is ready for operation
and has been properly handed over (released) in writing. This will include all safety aspects,
statutory clearance, and final inspection by the Employer and regulatory body, if any.
Instructions for the work and supervision are given by the test leader (Line in charge).
However all switching and all operational activities will be executed by the regular operators.
Line charging instructions received from LDC are clearly understood by the Line in charge
and doubts, if any, are to be got clarified prior to the Energization of the line.
Once the line is handed over for charging no work shall be permitted without a valid
WORKPERMIT.
When the whole system has been energized, including the AC line, it will be kept in this state
for 8 hours or more for "soaking" with continuous inspection and monitoring.
1.4 Safety Procedures
Energization implies an abrupt and serious change of the working conditions in the plant. In
order to avoid serious accidents, thorough information must be imparted to all personnel
involved in the construction of transmission line. It should be ensured that due publicity has
been made to the public in all the villages/areas along the line route cautioning them against
climbing the towers etc. and that the line is proposed to be charged on so and so date. It is
also to be confirmed that the AGENCIES involved in the construction activities shall not
carry out any job on the said line without a valid WORK PERMIT.
It shall be ensured before charging that all men, material, Tools and plants and any temporary
earthing on any part of the entire length of line are removed.
It must be ensured that any power supply / low voltage charging used as anti-theft measure
must be disconnected and isolated to avoid accidental connection.
All equipment tests and pre-commissioning tests must have been completed, reterminated (in
case cables were isolated for testing purpose) and documented.
The system must be formally declared ready for energization and handed over for operation
in writing.
1.5 Inspection
Before the line is scheduled to be handed over for the pre-commissioning/energization the
same shall be inspected by representatives of EMPLOYER and Construction Agency as
follows:
Jumpers in the tension tower are properly intact with conductor and form a parabolic shape in
order to achieve adequate clearance from super steel structure.
It is to be ensured that no members are bend, deformed or rusted have been used in towers
and if so, the same shall be replaced.
If any members is found missing, a new member shall be Fixed as per erection drawing of
Towers.
Nuts shall be sufficiently tightened for the required Torque specified in the Approved
Drawing. Minimum 2/3 complete threads shall be projected outside the nut. All bolts shall
have their nuts facing outside of the tower for Horizontal connection and Downwards for
Vertical connections.
Nuts & bolts shall be properly tack welded/punched as per the specification and proper zinc
rich paint shall be applied. It shall be ensured that the circular length of each welding shall be
at least 10mm.
It shall also be ensured that all extra blank holes provided on tower members are filled with
correct size of nuts & bolts.
1.7.2 SpecialTowers
In addition to the above checks for towers, ladders and platforms provided in special towers
shall be properly tightened and no foreign material shall be left out on such platforms.
1.7.3 Earthing of Towers
Ensure that proper earthing of tower has been done and earthing strip is neither damaged nor
broken and is properly fixed to the stub.
In case of counter poise earthing, it is to be ensured that earthwire is sufficiently buried in the
ground and no where it has drag out during cultivation. The length of counter-poise is
normally 30 mtrs as per Technical Specification.
Before charging of the line, ensure that resistance is below 10 ohms. If the value (before
stringing) has been recorded higher than 10 ohm earthing shall be changed to counterpoise
type.
Earthing of special towers shall be verified as per approved drawings applicable for special
towers/special foundation. (In case of anchor foundation bolt/anchor plate welded with last
leg of special tower.)
1.7.4 Tower accessories
All the danger plates, number plates, circuit plates, and phase plates shall be in position &
and as per the specification.
All plates shall be properly tightened.
It shall be ensured that phase plates are fixed in correct phase sequence. Specially at
transposition towers, the phase plates in the correct phase sequence shall be provided at each
towers or end tower as per the specification of the line.
It shall be ensured that the anti-climbing device (ACD) is provided, at the suit-able height of
tower. In case of barbed wire ACD, barbed wire shall be tightly fixed.
It shall be ensured that the step bolts (for normal towers) are provided upto the peak of tower.
Any missing step bolts shall be replaced.
Fixing of birds guards (wherever applicable) shall be ensured.
1.8 Hardware Fittings
Tightening of all bolts and nuts are to be checked upto specified torque.
Check the fixing of all security clips (W/R type clips).
Surface condition of corona control rings and distance/alignment between Tower side arcing
horn (wherever applicable) and line side arcing horn/corona control ring to be checked as per
approved drawings.
To restrict the swing of jumpers, the provision of Pilot strings in case of Tension Towers
shall be verified from the approved drawings.
1.9 Insulators
All the damaged/broken insulator discs shall be replaced. Unusual deflection in suspension
strings if observed shall be rectified using appropriate counter weights.
The insulators shall be cleaned before charging.
IR value of insulators of at least 5 insulators at random shall be checked by 5/10 kV Megger.
1.10 Conductors and Earth Wires
Surface of the conductors shall be free from scratches/rubs. Ensure that conductor strands are
not cut and opened up. Wherever strands are found cut/damaged/scratched, they must be
repaired with repair sleeves/repair protective rods in case the nos. of damaged strands are
within specified limits (normally upto 1/6th nos. of strands in the outer layer).
1.11 Accessories for Conductor and Earth Wires
1.11.1 Joints
All joints on conductor/earth wires shall be away from the tower at a distance of at least 30
metres or as provided in the Technical specification (TS).
Ensure that no more than one joint in a conductor is provided in one span.
Ensure that no mid span joint is provided in major crossings for main roads, railway crossing
and major rivers etc. or as provided in Technical Specification.
Ensure that all mid span joints on conductors/earthwire and repair sleeves of compression
type are free from sharp edges, rust and dust. Wherever grease are specified the same shall be
applied in the joints.
1.11.2 Clipping
It shall be ensured that following measures have been taken in the line/ Towers falling within
obstruction zone of civil aviation and defence establishments as per their requirement and the
specification.
1.12.1 Day markers
Painting of Full/Top portion of Towers with Red/Orange and White Paints.
Globules on earthwires have been provided.
1.12.2 Night markers
It shall be ensured that proper aviation lights at the peak level/at specified heights of towers
have been provided along with Solar panels/Battery banks/Control cubicles and other
accessories as per specification. The functioning of lights with simulation to be
checked/verified.
1.13 Statutory Requirement
The concerned authorities shall be informed before commissioning the lines and their
approval obtained in accordance with Statutory Provisions.
1.14 Handing Over
The transmission line shall be inspected prior to energization and a formal handing over
document to be jointly signed by the Employer and Employer’s representative. However all
contractual taking over has to be resolved separately as per the terms and conditions of the
contract. The Handing over shall be limited to the completion of Erection and ready for
Energization.
Any outstanding points or remaining activities are to be listed jointly. The remaining
activities/outstanding points are classified in the following category:
Details of the Sections:
Before energization it must be ascertained that all protective systems for the unit to be
energized are operative.
This includes confirmation that the protections have been properly tested and that the tests
have been documented.
It also includes verification by inspection or otherwise, if necessary by repetition of trip test,
that the protections are actually functionally enabled. This verification serves to prevent that
energization takes place of a unit where a protection has been disabled for test or other
reason.
1.16 Switching Procedure
For each activity the instructions to the operators and the communications to the dispatchers
will be made in writing or by confirmed telephone messages. The switching procedures first
to be properly documented step by step and understood by everybody involved in the
switching operation prior to the energization. Any clarification required in the procedures
must be resolved. The format established by the Employer for switching orders and
operational data logging shall be followed.
The implication of this is that each and every activity must be listed and described, so that
complete information is available for detail investigation, if required in future.
1.17 Testing and Measurement Procedures
Prior to the testing of soil resistivity and earth resistance the operation manual of the testing
instrument available at site may be referred and procedures to be adopted for measurement of
soil resistivity and earth resistance.
A typical Earth tester has 4 terminals. C1, P1, C2, P2 and 4 similar electrodes are driven in
the ground at equal distances and connected to the instruments in the order of C1' P1 and P2,
C2. Then the handle is rotated or button is pressed and the reading of the resistance is read on
the instrument scale. If R is the resistance measured then the
Specific resistivity = 2 aR
Where “a” is the distance between the electrode and R is the resistance in ohms measured on
the instrument.
b. Earth resistance
If the above test results are OK it confirms the continuity of the line.
The continuity Test of the line with proper phase indication or phase marking can be checked
by continuity test as described below:
If the test results are OK it confirms that marking of the phases are in order.
Phase Sequence
Once the line is charged from one end, without closing the Breaker at the other end the Phase
sequence is to be checked from the CVT/PT output by the help of Phase Sequence Meter.
In case there are other feeders available Phase sequence is to be RECHECKED by the
measurement of secondary voltage of both the Feeders (New line & available charged line).
Let the secondary Voltage of CVT/PT is 110 volts (ph to ph) for both the Circuit. In case of
correct Phase Sequence the voltage reading shall be as follows:
NEW CIRCUIT OLD CIRCUIT VOLTAGE
R-Phase R-Phase 0
R-Phase Y-Phase 110
R-Phase B-Phase 110
Y-Phase R-Phase 110
Y-Phase Y-Phase 0
Y-Phase B-Phase 110
B-Phase R-Phase 110
B-Phase Y-Phase 110
B-Phase B-Phase 0
In case the results are not matching the phase sequence in to be rechecked and reconfirmed
before closing the breaker.
1.18 Energization
Execution of the energization is simply the last event in the switching sequence, switching of
the close control button for the relevant circuit breaker.
1.19 De-Energization
Instructions about de-energization will be given only if this is part of the test. Otherwise de-
energization will be considered part of regular operation.
1.20 Observation and Duration
Visual and audible inspection (look and listen) of the relevant equipment and reading of
permanent instrumentation will be made.
The system shall be charged at least for 8 hours. During this time continuous monitoring and
inspection will be maintained in control room, auxiliary systems areas and switch yards.
This will include frequent, scheduled inspection of all equipment and reading of all
permanent instruments and recorders, and surge arrester counters, especially system
parameters as per standard procedures adopted by the Employer.
1.21 Passing Criteria
Neither insulation breakdown nor protective system actions must occur. No irregular
equipment behaviour (noise, vibration, high temperature) is permitted.
Corona discharges may not be “unreasonable”. Local discharges that may be attributable to
sharp points shall be carefully located and recorded. After termination of the energization the
equipment shall be closely inspected and the points rounded or covered.
No unscheduled changes of system nor of equipment parameters is permitted during the 8
hour energized condition.
Measurement of Line Parameters
The Contractor shall conduct measurement of Line parameters as per international practice.
(Bidder’s Name)
Sl.No. CONTENTS
1.0 Power Transformer
2.0 Isolators/Grounding switches
3.0 Circuit Breakers
4.0 Surge Arresters
5.0 Current Transformers
6.0 Voltage Transformers
7.0 Battery and Battery Chargers
8.0 Lighting System
9.0 1.1 kV Power and Control Cables
10.0 11 and 33 kV XLPE cable
11.0 Air Conditioning System
12.0 Control and Relay Panel
13.0 Substation Automation System
14.0 Communication Equipments
15.0 LT Transformer
16.0 Insulator, Hardwares & Accessories
17.0 LT Switchgear
18.0 12 kV switchgear
19.0 Bay Control Unit
20.0 Tower
21.0 ACSR Conductor
22.0 Insulator and fittings for TL
23.0 OPGW
Page 1 of 61
TDS-Power Transformer ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
(Bidder’s Name)
Page 2 of 61
TDS-Power Transformer ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
Page 3 of 61
TDS-Power Transformer ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
Page 4 of 61
TDS-Power Transformer ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
Page 5 of 61
TDS-Power Transformer ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
Page 6 of 61
TDS-Power Transformer ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
Page 7 of 61
TDS-Isolator ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
(Bidder’s Name)
Page 8 of 61
TDS-Isolator ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
Page 9 of 61
TDS-Circuit Breaker ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
(Bidder’s Name)
i). Maximum total break time under any duty condition for
any current upto rated breaking current with limiting
conditions of voltage and pressure (ms)
Page 10 of 61
TDS-Circuit Breaker ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
Offered Data
S.No Description
145 KV 36 KV 12 KV
Maximum line charging breaking current with temporary over
17
voltage upto 1.4 p.u (kA)
.i) Maximum period between closing of first contact & last
18
contact in a pole (ms)
19 Pre-insertion resistor
Page 11 of 61
TDS-Circuit Breaker ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
Offered Data
S.No Description
145 KV 36 KV 12 KV
ii) Opening
27
c)Rated pressure of SF6 in operating chamber (kg/sq.cm)
Page 12 of 61
TDS-Circuit Breaker ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
Offered Data
S.No Description
145 KV 36 KV 12 KV
i)Control Cabinet
ii)Bushing/support Insulator
iii)Terminal connector.
Page 13 of 61
TDS-Surge Arrestors ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
(Bidder’s Name)
Page 14 of 61
TDS-Surge Arrestors ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
Page 15 of 61
TDS-CT ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
(Bidder’s Name)
Page 16 of 61
TDS-CVT ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
(Bidder’s Name)
Offered Data
S.No Description
132 KV CVT 33 KV PT 11 KV PT
1. Name and address of Manufacturer
2. Manufacturer's type designation
3. Standards applicable
6. Number of secondaries
14. Capacitance
i. of high voltage capacitor (pF)
17 of 61
TDS-CVT ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
Offered Data
S.No Description
132 KV CVT 33 KV PT 11 KV PT
One minute power frequency test voltage of H.F.
20.
terminal (kV rms)
One minute power frequency test voltage of
21
capacitor (kV rms) (dry & wet)
1.2/50 micro s impulse withstand test voltage of
22
Capacitor (kVp)
18 of 61
TDS-Battery and Battery Chargers ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
(Bidder’s Name)
19 of 61
TDS-Lighting System ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
(Bidder’s Name)
20 of 61
TDS-Power and Control Cable ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
(Bidder’s Name)
iii. Conductor temp. allowed for the short circuit duty ( Deg. C)
9 Insulation
i. Composition of insulation
ii. Nominal thickness of insulation (mm)
10 Inner Sheath
i. Material
21 of 61
TDS-Power and Control Cable ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
22 of 61
TDS-XLPE Cables ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
(Bidder’s Name)
4 Electrical Data
a Rated Voltage (Volts)
b Suitable for earthed or unearthed system?
c Maximum working voltage(Um)
d Frequency (Hz)
e Temperature of conductor ( )
℃
Normal operation
Short circuit
f Suitable cable section
g AC voltage test for 5 minutes
h AC voltage test for 1 minutes in rain
i Partial discharge at room temperature
Load cycle test at constant
j voltage(23 kV for 11 kV), conductor temperature
between 95 and 100 cycle 60 times)
℃ test(±95kV
Impulse voltage ℃ for 11 kV each 10
k times,conductor temperature between
95 and 100 )
l ℃ test for
Voltage ℃ 15 minutes after impulse
m Salt fog test for 1000h
5 ENVIRONMENTAL DATA
a Allowed Environmental temperature
b Allowed Sea level
Creep distance of outer insulation of
c
accessory
d Life expectancy
6 Conductor(Circular)
i. Material (Copper or aluminium) as per BoQ
ii. Grade
iii. Normal cross section area (Sq.mm)
Approx.Number and diameter of wire before
iv
stranding(No./mm)
7 Insulation
23 of 61
TDS-XLPE Cables ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
24 of 61
TDS-Air Conditioning System ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
(Bidder’s Name)
25 of 61
TDS-CRP ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
(Bidder’s Name)
(iii)Sides
5 Degree of protection
26 of 61
TDS-CRP ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
a)Disturbance recorder
b)Fault locator
5 Directional sensitivity
27 of 61
TDS-CRP ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
5 Operating time
6 Resetting time
28 of 61
TDS-CRP ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
C Additional facilities
D Details of printer
Details of power supply arrangement for Acquisition unit
5
(including printer)
G AUTO RECLOSE RELAY
1 Name and address of Manufacturer
3 Electromechanical /static/numerical
29 of 61
TDS-CRP ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
II TRANSFORMER PROTECTION
A Differential relay
1 Name and address of Manufacturer
8 Resetting time
How ratio / phase angle corrections are being done (inter posing
9
transformer/internal feature in the relay)
B Restricted Earth Fault Protection
30 of 61
TDS-CRP ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
6 Resetting time
4 Directional sensitivity
a) Inverse time
b) High set
a) Inverse time
b) High set
GENERAL PROTECTION /MONITORING EQUIPMENT
Trip Circuit Supervision relay
1 Name and address of Manufacturer
31 of 61
TDS-CRP ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
3 Contact ratings
c) Break
i). Resistive load
ii) Inductive load (With L/R=40milli sec.)
5 Resetting time
3 Operating time
4 Resetting time
5 Setting ranges
a) Current
b) Time
III Bus bar Protection
32 of 61
TDS-CRP ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
5 Operating time
6 Resetting time
7 Setting ranges
i)Current
ii)Time
Whether will it cause tripping for the differential current below
8 the load current of heavily loaded feeder (Bidder shall submit
application check for the same)
33 of 61
TDS-SAS ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
(Bidder’s Name)
Page 34 of 61
TDS-SAS ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
VII
Page 35 of 61
TDS-SAS ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
Page 36 of 61
TDS-Communication and SCADA ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
(Bidder’s Name)
Page 37 of 61
TDS-LT Transformer ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
(Bidder’s Name)
38 of 61
TDS-LT Transformer ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
39 of 61
TDS-LT Transformer ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
40 of 61
TDS-LT Transformer ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
41 of 61
TDS-LT Transformer ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
42 of 61
TDS-LT Transformer ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
43 of 61
TDS-LT Transformer ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
44 of 61
TDS-Insulator and Hardware for SS ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
(Bidder’s Name)
Page 45 of 61
TDS-Insulator and Hardware for SS ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
3 Material
Size of Tubular Bus
i.Standard pipe size- IPS (mm)
ii.Outside diameter (mm)
4
iii.Tolerance on outside
iv.Thickness (mm)
v.Tolerance on Thickness
7
Short circuit current rating for 1 sec. duration (kA)
8 Radio Interference at rated voltage (micro volts )
9 10.Weight (kg/m)
Final allowable tubular bus conductor temperature
10
due to short circuit
D. MARSHALLING KIOSK
Page 46 of 61
TDS-Insulator and Hardware for SS ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
15 Torsional Strength(Kg.m)
16 Compression Strength (Kg)
Confirm whether type tested as per IEC and are in
17
successful operation for at least 2 (Two) years.
F. ACSR CONDUCTOR
1 Name and address of manufacturer
2 Standards Applicable
Page 47 of 61
TDS-Insulator and Hardware for SS ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
Page 48 of 61
TDS-LT Switchgear ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
(Bidder’s Name)
17.0 LT Switchgear
49 of 61
TDS-12 kV Switchgear ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
(Bidder’s Name)
18.0 12 kV Switchgear
Offered Data
S.N. Description Unit
Incommer/Bus tie Feeder
A Switchgear Manufacturer
Years of manufacturing experience Years
Manufacture's designation as per submitted
catalogue/ModelNo.
B Busbar
1 Material
2 Size
a)main bus mm2
b)ground bus mm2
3 Minimum clearance
a)Phase to phase mm
b)Phase to ground mm
4 Rated current
a)Continuous at 40°C ambient A
b)Short time current for 3 sec. kA
5 Rated voltage kV
6 Bus support insulators
a) Manufacturer
b) Type
c) Impulse withstand voltage kV
d)Power frequency withstand voltage (1min. rms) kV
7 Busbar joint silver-plated? Yes/No
C Circuit breakers
1 Manufacturer
2 Type
3 Manufacture's designation as per submitted catalogue/Model No.
4 Rated voltage kV
5 Number of possible operations without maintenanance
for contacts
- Rated short circuit breaking current No.
-Rated normal current No.
for mechanism No.
6 Frequency Hz
7 Rated current
a)normal current A
b)short circuit current for 3sec. kA
8 Vacuum Interrupter
a) Make
b) Rating A
9 Interrupting current (rms.sym.) kA
10 Interrupting time ms
11 Making current peak kA
12 Closing time, max ms
13 Insulation level
a)Impulse withstand voltage kV
b)Power frequency withstand kV
Page 50 of 61
TDS-12 kV Switchgear ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
18.0 12 kV Switchgear
Offered Data
S.N. Description Unit
Incommer/Bus tie Feeder
voltage(1min.rms.)
14 Operating mechanism
a)Type
b)Operating voltage range
- closing % of 110
V
- tripping % of 110
V
c)Closing and tripping coils current A
d)Duty cycle
15 Spring charging motor
a)Type and manufacturer
b) Voltage V
c)Rating kW
d)Spring charging time sec
16 Total no of auxiliary contacts
a)Normally open No.
b)Normally closed No.
c)Contact ratings (make and continuous current)
-AC at 230 volt A
-DC inductive at 110 volt A
17 Overalldimensions(L*W*H) mm
D Current transformers
1 Manufacturer
2 Type
Manufacture's designation as per submitted catalogue/ModelNo.
3 Frequency Hz
4 Voltage class kV
5 Reference standard
6 Current transformer rating
7 Insulation level
8 a)Impulse withstand (BIL) kV,crest
b)Power frequency withstand (1min.rms.) kV
9 Burden per phase VA
10 No.of cores No.
11 Accuracy class
E Voltage transformer
1 Manufacturer
2 Type
3 Manufacture's designation as per submitted
catalogue/ModelNo.
4 Frequency Hz
5 Voltageclass kV
6 Referencestandard
7 Ratedvoltage
a)Primary V
b)Secondary V
8 Rated burden VA
9 Accuracy class
10 Insulation level
Page 51 of 61
TDS-12 kV Switchgear ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
18.0 12 kV Switchgear
Offered Data
S.N. Description Unit
Incommer/Bus tie Feeder
a)Impulse withstand voltage (BIL) kV, crest
b)Power frequency withstand voltage (1min. rms.) kV
11 Overall dimensions (L*W*H) mm
12 Weight kg
13 Fuses (HV/LV)
a)Type
b)Continuous rating A
c)Symmetrical fault rating kA
F Switchgear assembly
1 Type of switchgear
2 Enclosure
a)Type
b)Thickness of metal sheet (min) mm
c)Degree of protection provided by the enclosure
3 Breaker assembly
a)Breaker provided with service test and with drawn position Yes/No
b)Type of indication provided for breaker position
c)Cubicle door can be closed with breaker in service or test position Yes/No
4 Space heater
a)Thermostat controlled space heater furnished for each cubicle? Yes/No
b)Rating
-Voltage V, AC
-Watts W
5 Overall dimension (L*W*H) (of complete panel) mm
6 Approximate weight (complete panel) kg
7 Shipping dimension (L*W*H) (ofcomplete panel) mm
G Relays
1 Manufacturer & country of origin
2 Manufacture's designation as per submitted catalogue/ModelNo.
b) Highset (Instantaneous)
c) Earth Fault % of rated
current
d) High set(Instantaneous)
7 Characteristics
8 Reset time ms
9 Insulation test according to IEC Yes/No
10 Indication
-lightemittingdiodesprovided? Yes/No
H Annunciator type
Page 52 of 61
TDS-BCU ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
(Bidder’s Name)
53 of 61
TDS-Transmission Line Towers ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
(Bidder’s Name)
20.0 TOWERS
Sl. No. Description Unit DA DB DC DD/DDE
Manufacturer’s Name
Country of origin
Applicable Standard
Years of Manufacturing Experience Years Minimum 10
ISO Certificate submitted yes/no
Manufacturer sales record submitted yes/no
Overall length of suspension insulator string
1 from point of suspension to bottom of phase mm
conductor clamp.
Vertical distance between underside of
2 supporting cross arm and point about which mm
live metal is connected
Overall length of tension insulator measured
from point of attachment on cross arm to
3 mm
point where jumper, loop parabola leaves
conductor
Minimum clearance from live metal to
4 structure steelwork and earthed fitting when
tension insulator is used
4.1 Jumper loop in still air mm
4.2 Down comer in slack spans in still air mm
5 Max working stress in tension members :
2
5.1 Mild steel Kg/mm
2
5.2 High tensile steel Kg/mm
Maximum ratio of unsupported length of
6 steel compression members to their least
radius of gyration
6.1 Main members
6.2 Redundant
6.3 Bracing loaded in tension only
Steel to ASTM A 36/IS 2062 or other
7
proposed standard
2
7.1 Elastic limit stress in tension members kg/mm
Ultimate stress in compression members 2
7.2 kg/mm
(expressed as a function of L/R)
Steel to ASTM A 572/IS 8500 or other
8
proposed standard
2
8.1 Elastic limit stress in tension members kg/mm
9 Bolts
Page 54 of 61
TDS-Transmission Line Towers ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
Page 55 of 61
TDS-Transmission Line Towers ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
Note: Maximum working stress and max. Stress when structure is subjected to normal loading at any
temperature or wind loads within the range specified.
Page 56 of 61
TDS-ACSR Conductor ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
(Bidder’s Name)
Page 57 of 61
TDS-ACSR Conductor ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
Page 58 of 61
TDS-Insulators and Fittings ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
(Bidder’s Name)
Page 59 of 61
TDS-OPGW ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
(Bidder’s Name)
Page 60 of 61
TDS-OPGW ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01
Page 61 of 61
For Bidding Purpose Only
6 (1/2.8),(7/1.4*) - 3 5 9 11 -
(1/3.55- #),(7/1.4*) - - 4 7 9 -
10
Scale = NTS
Unit = mm.
For Bidding Purpose Only
l aB
t
' k| f Sheet. No.
n
lw
s DHALKEBAR LOHARPATTI 132 KV TL PROJECT Title
f
g]k
/0
l aB
t
' k| f Sheet. No.
n
lw
s DHALKEBAR LOHARPATTI 132 KV TL PROJECT Title
f
g]k
/0
l aB
t
' k| f Sheet. No.
n
lw
s DHALKEBAR LOHARPATTI 132 KV TL PROJECT Title
f
g]k
/0
TOWER TYPE -- -- -- --
LEGEND:
RIVER CROSSING
For Bidding Purpose Only
POWER LINE CROSSING
ROAD CROSSING
Bidding Document
for
Procurement of Plant for Design, Supply, Installation, Testing and
Commissioning of Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line and
Loharpatti 132/33/11 kV Substation
December, 2019
BIDDING DOCUMENT
PRICE BID
PROCUREMENT OF WORKS
International Competitive Bidding (ICB)
Single Stage, Two Envelope
Table of Contents
Date: .........................................................
Name of the contract: .........................................................
Invitation for Bid No.: .......................................................
To:
……………………………………………………………………………………………………
….....
We, the undersigned, declare that:
(a) We have examined and have no reservations to the Bidding Documents, including
Addenda issued in accordance with Instructions to Bidders (ITB) Clause 8;
(b) We offer to execute in conformity with the Bidding Documents the following Works:
(c) The total price of our Bid, excluding any discounts offered in item (d) below is:
(d) The discounts offered and the methodology for their application are:
(e) Our bid shall be valid for a period of [insert validity period as specified in ITB 18.1] days
from the date fixed for the bid submission deadline in accordance with the Bidding
Documents, and it shall remain binding upon us and may be accepted at any time before
the expiration of that period;
(f) If our bid is accepted, we commit to obtain a performance security in accordance with
the Bidding Document;
(g) We understand that this bid, together with your written acceptance thereof included in
your notification of award, shall constitute a binding contract between us, until a formal
contract is prepared and executed;
(h) We understand that you are not bound to accept the lowest evaluated bid or any other bid
that you may receive;
(i) We agree to permit the Employer/DP or its representative to inspect our accounts and
records and other documents relating to the bid submission and to have them audited by
auditors appointed by the Employer; and
(j) If awarded the contract, the person named below shall act as our Representative:
Name: .................................................................................................
In the capacity of ...............................................................................
Signed …………………………………………………………...
Duly authorized to sign the Bid for and on behalf of …………….
Date …………………………………………………………......
(c) if there is a discrepancy between words and figures, the amount in words shall prevail,
unless the amount expressed in words is related to an arithmetic errors, in which case
the amount in figures shall prevail subject to (a) and (b) above.
Schedule No. 1.Plant, Equipment and Mandatory Spare Parts Supplied from Abroad
CIP Border (Excluding Taxex and Duties)
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price Total Amount Remarks
(USD) (USD)
A 132 kV Transmission Line
1
Design, Fabrication, galvanising & supply of various types of towers & tower parts, tower/leg extensions (complete) including stubs, step
bolts and bolts & nuts , hangers, D-Shackles, pack washers ( 132 kV Double Circuit Tower for Cardinal Conductor)
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 1 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 2 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Schedule No. 1.Plant, Equipment and Mandatory Spare Parts Supplied from Abroad
CIP Border (Excluding Taxex and Duties)
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price Total Amount Remarks
(USD) (USD)
iii) + 6.0 M Body Extension No. 1
iv) + 9.0 M Body Extension No. 1
b) Stub (set of 4) for above Set 9
Total of Sub Total 1.3
1.4 Large Angle (DD type) tension towers (30°-60°)/ Dead-end towers
a) Super Structure
i) DD + 0 M Standrad Towers No. 9
ii) + 3.0 M Body Extension No. 2
iii) + 6.0 M Body Extension No. 1
iv) + 9.0 M Body Extension No. 1
b) Stub (set of 4) for above Set 9
Total of Sub Total 1.4
Total of 1
Total of 2
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 1 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 3 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Schedule No. 1.Plant, Equipment and Mandatory Spare Parts Supplied from Abroad
CIP Border (Excluding Taxex and Duties)
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price Total Amount Remarks
(USD) (USD)
c Anti Climbing Device Set 73
d Phase Plate (Set of 3) Sets 146
e Circuit plate (sets of 2) Sets 73
f Bird Guards Sets 7
g Aviation Signal Sets 5
Total of Sub Total 3.1
3.2 Earthing of Towers with necessary bolts, nuts & washers
Pipe Type earthing complete with pipe, flat, salt, sand &
a Nos. 60
charcoal.
b Counterpoise Type
i) Counterpoise Type-30 m Nos. 7
ii) Counterpoise Type-45m Nos. 3
iii) Counterpoise Type-60m Nos. 3
Total of Sub Total 3.2
Total of 3
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 1 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 4 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Schedule No. 1.Plant, Equipment and Mandatory Spare Parts Supplied from Abroad
CIP Border (Excluding Taxex and Duties)
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price Total Amount Remarks
(USD) (USD)
iv) Repair sleeve for ACSR "CARDINAL" conductor Nos. 30
Total of Sub Total 4.1
4.2 Optical Fiber ground wire (OPGW) and accessories
Optical fiber ground wire including approach cable,
a intermediate splice boxes, terminal splice boxes and km 21
additional length as required
Stockbridge Vibration damper for OPGW overhead
b ground wire with preformed armour rods complete with all Nos. 144
fittings.
Total of Sub Total 4.2
Insulator strings with insulators, attachment
assemblies and arcing horns all complete for ACSR
4.3
"CARDINAL" conductor and attachment assemblies
all complete for OPGW
Single suspension strings with 1 composite long rod
i) Sets 198
insulator complete for "Cardinal" conductor
Single suspension pilot insulator strings with 1 composite
ii) Sets 15
long rod insulator complete for "Cardinal" conductor
Single tension strings with 1 composite long rod insulator
ii) Sets 264
complete for "Cardinal" conductor
Double tension strings with 2x1 composite long rod
iii) Sets 84
insulator complete for "Cardinal" conductor
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 1 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 5 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Schedule No. 1.Plant, Equipment and Mandatory Spare Parts Supplied from Abroad
CIP Border (Excluding Taxex and Duties)
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price Total Amount Remarks
(USD) (USD)
Double suspension strings with 2x1 composite long rod
iv) Sets 66
insulator complete for "Cardinal" conductor
OPGW suspension preformed assembly complete for
v) Sets 44
one tower
OPGW tension preformed assembly complete for one
vi) Sets 29
tower (one set/tower)
Total of Sub Total 4.3
Total of 4
5.0 Supply of Spares
Supply of Basic Tower with extension + 9m including
5.1
Stub
i) Tower Type DA+9M Complete Nos. 1
ii) Tower Type DB+9M Complete Nos. 1
iii) Tower Type DC+9M Complete Nos. 1
iv) Tower Type DD+9M Complete Nos. 1
Total of Sub Total 5.1
5.2 Conductor and OPGW accessories
Mid span compression joints for ACSR "CARDINAL"
i) Nos. 10
conductor
ii) Repair sleeve for ACSR "CARDINAL" conductor Nos. 10
iii) Insulator 70kN 650kV BIL long rod polymer insulator Nos. 10
Insulator 120kN capacity 650kV BIL long rod polymer
iv) Nos. 10
insulator
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 1 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 6 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Schedule No. 1.Plant, Equipment and Mandatory Spare Parts Supplied from Abroad
CIP Border (Excluding Taxex and Duties)
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price Total Amount Remarks
(USD) (USD)
Stockbridge vibration damper for ACSR "CARDINAL"
v) Nos. 24
conductor with accessories
vi) Vibration damper for OPGW Nos. 12
Total of Sub Total 5.2
Total of 5 ( Spares)
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 1 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 7 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Schedule No. 1.Plant, Equipment and Mandatory Spare Parts Supplied from Abroad
CIP Border (Excluding Taxex and Duties)
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price Total Amount Remarks
(USD) (USD)
6.14 Earthing resistance tester Nos. 1
Double sheeve pulley block 5 MT capacity with all
6.15 Sets 1
accessories
6.16 Sagging Winch 10 MT capacity hand operated Sets 1
6.17 Grip suitable for ACSR "CARDINAL" Conductor Sets 4
6.18 Grip suitable for "OPGW" Ground Wire Sets 4
Total of 6
TOTAL of A
B Loharpatti 132/33/11 kV Substation
Design, Manufacture and Supply of Electrical
1
Works
1.1 Power transformer
132/33 kV, Three Phase 24/27/30 MVA, ONAN/ONAF
Power Transfromer complete with On load Tap Changer
1.1.1 (OLTC) and RTCC facility with Tank Mounted LA at LV no. 2
side and Bushing CT on both sides, complete with all
accessories as specified
132/11 kV, Three phase 18/22.5 MVA, ONAN/ONAF
Power Transformer complete with On load Tap Changer
1.1.2 (OLTC) and RTCC facility with Tank Mounted LA at LV no. 1
side and Bushing CT on both sides complete with all
accessories as specified
1.2. Circuit breakers
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 1 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 8 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Schedule No. 1.Plant, Equipment and Mandatory Spare Parts Supplied from Abroad
CIP Border (Excluding Taxex and Duties)
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price Total Amount Remarks
(USD) (USD)
145 kV, 1250 A, 3 phase, SF6 Circuit Breaker, individual
1.2.1 pole operation type, complete with all accessories as per set 2
specification for lines
145 kV, 1250 A, 3 phase, SF6 Circuit Breaker, three pole
1.2.2 operation type, complete with all accessories as per set 3
specification for Transformer HT.
145 kV, 2000 A, 3 phase, SF6 Circuit Breaker, three pole
1.2.3 operation type, complete with all accessories as per set 1
specification for Bus Coupler
36 kV, 1250 A, 3 phase, Vaccum Circuit Breaker for
1.2.4 incomer, three pole operation type, complete with all set 2
accessories as per specification
36 kV, 800 A, 3 phase, Vaccum Circuit Breaker for
1.2.5 outgoing feeders, three pole operation type, complete with set 4
all accessories as per specification
1.3. Disconnecting switches
145 kV, 1250 A, 3 phase Center Break Disconnecting
1.3.1 Switch with Grounding Switch complete with all set 2
accessories as per specification
145 kV, 2000 A, 3 phase, Center Break Disconnecting
1.3.2 Switch without Grounding Switch complete with all set 2
accessories as per specification
145 kV, 1250 A, 3 phase Center Break Disconnecting
1.3.3 Switch without Grounding Switch complete with all set 10
accessories as per specification
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 1 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 9 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Schedule No. 1.Plant, Equipment and Mandatory Spare Parts Supplied from Abroad
CIP Border (Excluding Taxex and Duties)
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price Total Amount Remarks
(USD) (USD)
36 KV, 1250 A, 3 phase disconnecting switch without
1.3.4 grounding switch complete with all accessories as per set 2
specification
36 KV, 800A, 3 phase disconnecting switch without
1.3.5 grounding switch complete with all accessories as per set 5
specification
36KV, 800A, 3 phase disconnecting switch with grounding
1.3.6 set 4
switch complete with all accessories as per specification
1.4 Instrument transformers
145 kV, 50 VA, 132/ √3 /110/√3 kV, Class 0.5/3P Capacitor
1.4.1 Voltage Transformer complete with all accessories as per no. 12
specification
145 kV, 30 VA, 5 core Current Transformer complete with
1.4.2 no. 18
all accessories as per specification
36 kV, 30 VA, 33/ √3/110/√3 kV Voltage Transformer
1.4.3 no. 3
complete with all accessories asp per specification
36 kV, 30 VA, 3 core Current Transformer complete with
1.4.4 no. 18
all accessories as per specification
1.5 Lightning Arrester
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 1 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 10 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Schedule No. 1.Plant, Equipment and Mandatory Spare Parts Supplied from Abroad
CIP Border (Excluding Taxex and Duties)
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price Total Amount Remarks
(USD) (USD)
30 kV, 10 kA lightning arrestor including discharge
1.5.2 counter for cable protection complete with all accessories no. 15
as per specification
9 kV, 10 kA lightening arrestor including discharge
1.5.3 no. 12
counter complete with all accessories as per specification
1.6 Control and relay panel
132/33 kV transformer control and relay panel complete
1.6.1 set 2
with all accessories as per specification
132/11 kV transformer control and relay panel complete
1.6.2 set 1
with all accessories as per specification
132 kV transmission line control and relay panel complete
1.6.3 set 2
with all accessories as per specification
132 kV bus coupler cum bus bar protection control and
1.6.4 relay panel complete with all accessories as per set 1
specification
33kV line control and relay panel complete with all
1.6.5 set 4
accessories as per specification
1.7 Grounding
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 1 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 11 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Schedule No. 1.Plant, Equipment and Mandatory Spare Parts Supplied from Abroad
CIP Border (Excluding Taxex and Duties)
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price Total Amount Remarks
(USD) (USD)
Earthing of substation with conductors, electrode
1.7.2 grounding materials and accessories to complete the lot 1
specified scope of works :
12 KV VCB Switchgear Panel with all accessories as
1.8
per specified
12 kV Transformer incomer module (2000A) (IP-2) with all
1.8.1 no 1
accessories as per specification
12 kV Line Module(630A) (IP-1) with all accessories as
1.8.2 no. 4
per specification
12 kV PT module (IP-3) with all accessories as per
1.8.3 no. 1
specification
1.9 Station supply
150 kVA, 33/0.4 kV station service transformer with
1.9.1 current limiting fuse, power cable and all other lot 1
accessories as required
400V AC Distribution Board including Cable for the
1.9.2 lot 1
specified scope of the work
110 V DC distribution board including cable and
1.9.3 lot 1
accessories to complete the specified scope of work:
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 1 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 12 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Schedule No. 1.Plant, Equipment and Mandatory Spare Parts Supplied from Abroad
CIP Border (Excluding Taxex and Duties)
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price Total Amount Remarks
(USD) (USD)
Battery charger for 110 V battery complete with all
1.10.1 no. 1
accessorie to complete the specified scope of work:
110 V, 400 AH maintenance free lead acid sealed type
1.10.2 battery complete with all accessories to complete the set 1
specified scope of work:
Battery charger for 48 V battery complete with all
1.10.3 no. 1
accessories to complete the specified scope of work:
48 V, 200 AH maintenance free lead acid sealed type
1.10.4 battery complete with all accessories to complete the set 1
specified scope of work
1.11 Control and Power cables
600 V power and lighting cable for all works to complete
1.11.1 lot 1
the specified scope of work:
600 V control cable to complete the specified scope of
1.11.2 lot 1
works including that for communication works:
12 kV, 400 sq. mm single core XLPE Copper Power
Cable including termination joints for both ends, double
1.11.3 pole structure and with all accessories complete from LV m 450
sides of 132/11 kV Power Transformers to indoor 11 kV
Switchgear Room
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 1 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 13 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Schedule No. 1.Plant, Equipment and Mandatory Spare Parts Supplied from Abroad
CIP Border (Excluding Taxex and Duties)
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price Total Amount Remarks
(USD) (USD)
12 kV, 240 sq.mm 3 core XLPE Copper Power Cable
including termination joints for both ends, double pole
1.11.4 m 400
structure and with all accessories complete for 4 nos of
outgoing feeder
1.12 Miscellaneous material
132kV and 33 kV Insulator strings with necessary
hardwares, clamps for substation works and connection
1.12.1 lot 1
between gantry & Tower, complete as per the specified
scope of works:
ACSR "CARDINAL" conductors for 132kV switchyard with
necessary hardwares, clamps for connecting, with all
1.12.2 accessories for substation works and connection between lot 1
tower & gantry, complete as per the specified scope of
works:
Tubular bus and Bus Support Insulator for 132 kV Bus
1.12.3 including all other accessories and hardwares required to lot 1
complete the specified scope of works:
Tubular bus and Bus Support Insulator for 33 kV Bus
1.12.4 including all other accessories and hardwares required to lot 1
complete the specified scope of work:
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 1 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 14 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Schedule No. 1.Plant, Equipment and Mandatory Spare Parts Supplied from Abroad
CIP Border (Excluding Taxex and Duties)
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price Total Amount Remarks
(USD) (USD)
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 1 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 15 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Schedule No. 1.Plant, Equipment and Mandatory Spare Parts Supplied from Abroad
CIP Border (Excluding Taxex and Duties)
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price Total Amount Remarks
(USD) (USD)
Complete Substation automation system including
hardware and software for the substation & remote control
a.
stations alongwith associated equipments for the
followings as per Technical Specification.
i. 132 kV System Bays 6
ii. 33kV system Bays 4
iii. 11 kV System (Indoor Switchgear) lot 1
Integration of all 132kV ,33 kV and 11 kV kV Bays under
present scope with the SCADA of SIEMENS (SINAUT
b. Spectrum) at Load Dispatch Centre, Kathmandu including Lot 1
supply of Hardware, Software, accessories etc. as per
technical specification
2.2 COMMUNICATION / SCADA
2.2.1 Digital Protection Coupler Nos. 2
Optical Distribution Frame complete in all respects as per
2.2.2 Lot 1
technical specifications
Optical Approach Cable -24 Fibre (DWSM -G.652D) along
with Installation hardware set for above 24 Fibre, Fibre
2.2.3 Lot 1
Optic Approach Cable complete in all respects as per
technical specifications
2.2.4 (A) Telecommunication Equipments
SDH Equipment (STM-4 MADM upto 3 MSP protected
2.2.4.1
directions)
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 1 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 16 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Schedule No. 1.Plant, Equipment and Mandatory Spare Parts Supplied from Abroad
CIP Border (Excluding Taxex and Duties)
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price Total Amount Remarks
(USD) (USD)
Base Equipment (Common cards, Cross Connect/control
cards, optical base cards, power supply cards, power
(i) cabling, other hardware and accessories including sub Nos. 1
racks, patch cord, DDF etc fully equiped excluding (ii) &
(iii) below
(ii) Optical Interface Cards/SFP
(a) L4.1 SFP Nos. 4
(iii) Tributary cards
(a) E1 Interface card (Min.8 interfaces per card) Set 2
Giga -Ethernet Interface 10/100/1000 Mbps Base T with
(b) Nos. 2
Layer-2 switching (Min 4 Interfaces per card)
2.2.2.2 Equipment Cabinets No. 1
VOIP telephone instrument with one common switch (min.
2.2.2.3 Nos. 2
8 port)
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 1 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 17 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Schedule No. 1.Plant, Equipment and Mandatory Spare Parts Supplied from Abroad
CIP Border (Excluding Taxex and Duties)
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price Total Amount Remarks
(USD) (USD)
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 1 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 18 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Schedule No. 1.Plant, Equipment and Mandatory Spare Parts Supplied from Abroad
CIP Border (Excluding Taxex and Duties)
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price Total Amount Remarks
(USD) (USD)
4.1.2 Dial type thermometer(OTI, WTI) nos 1
4.1.3 Insulating oil ( 10% of total supply) lot 1
4.1.4 Indicating lamps (25% of used) lot 1
4.1.5 All types at fuses (25% of used ) lot 1
All type of auxillary current, voltage and thermal relays,
4.1.6 contactors for control, protection and cooling circuit (one set 1
of each type)
4.1.7 OLTC motor contactor set 1
4.1.8 Oil level gauge nos 1
4.1.9 Complete set of gaskets for 132/33 kV transformer set 1
4.1.10 Complete set of Pressure Relief Devices sets 1
4.1.11 Complete set of Bucholz relay (for 63 MVA transformer) sets 1
4.2 For 132/11 kV Power Transformer
Phase & neutral bushing (1 no. each for 132/11 kV
4.2.1 Set 1
transformer)
4.2.2 Dial type thermometer(OTI, WTI) Set 1
4.2.3 Oil Level Gauges Set 1
4.2.4 Insulating Oil (10% of total supply) Lot 1
4.2.5 Indicating Lamps (25% of used) Lot 1
4.2.6 All types of Fuses (25% of used) Lot 1
4.2.7 Complete set of Gaskets of each type Set 1
4.2.8 Complete set of Pressure Relief Devices Set 1
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 1 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 19 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Schedule No. 1.Plant, Equipment and Mandatory Spare Parts Supplied from Abroad
CIP Border (Excluding Taxex and Duties)
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price Total Amount Remarks
(USD) (USD)
All type of Auxiliary, Current, Voltage and Thermal Relays,
4.2.9 Contactors and Timers for control, protection and cooling Set 1
circuit(one of each type)
4.2.10 OLTC Motor Contactor Set 1
4.2.11 Complete set of Buchholz relay Set 1
4.3 For 132 kV SF6 circucit breaker
4.3.1 Tripping coils nos. 2
4.3.2 Closing coils nos. 2
4.3.3 Pressure switch, relays and contactors (one of each type) sets 1
4.3.4 Motor for mechanism nos. 1
4.3.5 Gas in sealed non returnable bottles ,net kgs 50
4.3.6 Complete set of Sealing rings & Gaskets sets 1
4.3.7 SF6 gas filling nozzle & adaptor sets 1
4.4 For 33 kV Vacuum circucit breaker
4.4.1 complete set of interrupter nos. 1
4.4.2 Tripping coils nos. 1
4.4.3 Closing coils nos. 1
4.4.4 Relays and contactors (one of each type) sets 1
4.4.5 Motor for mechanism nos. 1
4.4.6 Complete set of Sealing rings & Gaskets sets 1
4.5 For 12 kV VCB Switchgears
4.5.1 complete set of interrupter Nos. 1
4.5.2 Tripping Coils Nos. 1
4.5.3 Closing Coils Nos. 1
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 1 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 20 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Schedule No. 1.Plant, Equipment and Mandatory Spare Parts Supplied from Abroad
CIP Border (Excluding Taxex and Duties)
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price Total Amount Remarks
(USD) (USD)
4.5.4 Spring Charging Motor Set 1
3 Phase Overcurrent Relay with ground fault for 11kV
4.5.5 Sets 1
Side
4.5.6 Ammeter Nos. 1
4.5.7 Voltmeter Nos. 1
4.5.8 kVA Meter Nos. 1
4.5.9 11 kV CTs as in Outgoing Feeder Sets 1
4.5.10 Operating Handle Sets 1
4.5.11 Indicating Lamps (100% of used) Set 1
4.6 For 132 kV disconnecting switches
4.6.1 Porcelain insulator nos. 2
4.6.2 Main contact assemblies sets 2
4.6.3 Auxiliary contacts sets 2
4.6.4 Interlocking coil nos 2
4.6.5 Motor for driving mechanism nos 2
4.6.6 Contactor for the mechanism nos. 2
4.7 For 33 kV disconnecting switches
4.7.1 Porcelain insulator nos. 1
4.7.2 Main contact assemblies sets 1
4.7.3 Auxiliary contacts sets 1
4.7.4 Interlocking coil nos 1
4.8 Instrument transformers of used type
4.8.1 132 kV Current transformer nos. 1
4.8.2 132 kV Capacitive voltage transformer nos. 1
4.8.3 33 kV Current Transformer nos. 1
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 1 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 21 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Schedule No. 1.Plant, Equipment and Mandatory Spare Parts Supplied from Abroad
CIP Border (Excluding Taxex and Duties)
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price Total Amount Remarks
(USD) (USD)
4.8.4 33 kV Voltage transformer nos. 1
4.9. Lighting Arrestor
120 kV, 10 kA lightning arrestor including discharge
4.9.1 nos. 3
counter complete with all accessories as per specification
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 1 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 22 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Schedule No. 1.Plant, Equipment and Mandatory Spare Parts Supplied from Abroad
CIP Border (Excluding Taxex and Duties)
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price Total Amount Remarks
(USD) (USD)
4.10.12 Ammeter with double scale nos 1
4.10.13 Voltmeter nos 1
4.10.14 Watt meter nos 1
4.10.15 MVAR meter nos 1
4.10.16 Frequency meter nos 1
4.10.17 Energy meter nos 1
4.11 For 33 kV control and relay panel
4.11.1 Indicating lamps no. 50
4.11.2 Fuses for each type (300% of used) lot 1
4.11.3 Color caps of each color for indicating lamps no. 30
One of each type of switch, relay, timer and other special
4.11.4 lot 1
devices
4.11.5 Each type of auxiliary relays lot 1
4.11.6 3 phase overcurrent protection relay lot 1
4.11.7 3 Phase Transformer Differential Relays no. 1
4.11.8 Tripping circuit control relay no. 1
4.11.9 Ammeter with double scale no 1
4.11.10 Voltmeter no. 1
4.11.11 Watt meter no. 1
4.11.12 MVAR meter no. 1
4.11.13 Energy meter no. 1
4.12 132 kV post insulator no. 10
4.13 33 kV post insulator no. 10
4.14 Battery charger (48 V & 110 V)
4.14.1 Fuses of each type (300% of used) lot 1
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 1 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 23 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Schedule No. 1.Plant, Equipment and Mandatory Spare Parts Supplied from Abroad
CIP Border (Excluding Taxex and Duties)
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price Total Amount Remarks
(USD) (USD)
4.14.2 Indicating lamp no. 20
One of each type of switch, relay and other special
4.14.3 lot 1
devices
4.14.4 Ammeter no. 1
4.14.5 Voltmeter no. 1
4.15 Communication Cards
4.15.1 Digital Protection Coupler set 2
4.15.2 SDH Equipment
Common cards, Cross Connect/control cards, optical
(i) base cards, power supply cards, power cabling, other Set 1
hardware and accessories (each)
(ii) Optical Interface Cards/SFP
(a) L4.1 SFP Nos. 1
(iii) Tributary cards
(a) E1 Interface card (Min.8 interfaces per card) Nos 1
Giga -Ethernet Interface 10/100/1000 Mbps Base T with
(b) Nos. 1
Layer-2 switching (Min 4 Interfaces per card)
VOIP telephone instrument with one common switch (min.
4.15.3 Nos. 1
8 port)
Sub total of spare Parts
5 Testing Equipments
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 1 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 24 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Schedule No. 1.Plant, Equipment and Mandatory Spare Parts Supplied from Abroad
CIP Border (Excluding Taxex and Duties)
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price Total Amount Remarks
(USD) (USD)
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 1 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 25 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Schedule No. 1.Plant, Equipment and Mandatory Spare Parts Supplied from Abroad
CIP Border (Excluding Taxex and Duties)
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price Total Amount Remarks
(USD) (USD)
145 kV, 50 VA, 132/ √3 /110/√3 kV, Class 0.5/3P Capacitor
1.3.1 Voltage Transformer complete with all accessories as per no. 6
specification
145 kV, 30 VA, 5 core Current Transformer complete with
1.3.2 no. 6
all accessories as per specification
1.4 Lightning Arrester
120 kV, 10 kA, lightning arrestor including discharge
1.4.1 no. 6
counter complete with all accessories as per specification
1.5 Control and relay panel
132 kV transmission line control and relay panel complete
1.5.1 set 2
with all accessories as per specification
1.6 Grounding
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 1 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 26 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Schedule No. 1.Plant, Equipment and Mandatory Spare Parts Supplied from Abroad
CIP Border (Excluding Taxex and Duties)
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price Total Amount Remarks
(USD) (USD)
Battery charger for 110 V battery complete with all
1.7.1 no. 1
accessorie to complete the specified scope of work:
110 V, 600 AH maintenance free lead acid sealed type
1.7.2 battery complete with all accessories to complete the set 1
specified scope of work:
Battery charger for 48 V battery complete with all
1.7.3 no. 1
accessories to complete the specified scope of work:
48 V, 300 AH maintenance free lead acid sealed type
1.7.4 battery complete with all accessories to complete the set 1
specified scope of work
1.8 Control and Power cables
600 V power and lighting cable for all works to complete
1.8.1 lot 1
the specified scope of work:
600 V control cable to complete the specified scope of
1.8.2 lot 1
works including that for communication works:
33 kV, 185 sq.mm 3 core XLPE Copper Power Cable
including termination joints and outdoor type cable
1.8.3 meter 250
terminations/Sealing-ends and accessories complete for
both ends for 5 nos of 33 kV lines
1.9 Miscellaneous material
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 1 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 27 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Schedule No. 1.Plant, Equipment and Mandatory Spare Parts Supplied from Abroad
CIP Border (Excluding Taxex and Duties)
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price Total Amount Remarks
(USD) (USD)
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 1 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 28 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Schedule No. 1.Plant, Equipment and Mandatory Spare Parts Supplied from Abroad
CIP Border (Excluding Taxex and Duties)
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price Total Amount Remarks
(USD) (USD)
Design, manufacture and Supply of RTU/
2
COMMUNICATION / SCADA
2.1 RTU
RTU cards (including cable, connectors, relays, transducers
and other hardware and software required for data
a. Lot 1
transmission and remote operation to complete the specified
works) compatible to existing system
2.2 COMMUNICATION / SCADA
2.2.1 Digital Protection Coupler Nos. 2
Optical Distribution Frame complete in all respects as per
2.2.2 Lot 1
technical specifications
Optical Approach Cable -24 Fibre (DWSM -G.652D) along
with Installation hardware set for above 24 Fibre, Fibre
2.2.3 Lot 1
Optic Approach Cable complete in all respects as per
technical specifications
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 1 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 29 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Schedule No. 1.Plant, Equipment and Mandatory Spare Parts Supplied from Abroad
CIP Border (Excluding Taxex and Duties)
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price Total Amount Remarks
(USD) (USD)
3.1.3 145 kV disconnecting switch Nos 10
3.1.4 132 kV capacitive voltage transformer Nos 6
3.1.5 132 kV current Transformer Nos 6
3.1.6 120 kV lighting arrestor Nos 6
3.1.7 Identification plate, danger notice etc Lot 1
Sub total of Civil and Architectureal works
Total of C
Grand Total
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 2 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 30 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Schedule No. 2: Plant, Equipment and Mandatory Spare Parts Supplied from within the Employer's Country
Ex-Factory Price (Excluding VAT)
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price Total Amount Remarks
(NRs) (NRs)
Grand Total
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 3 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 31 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 3 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 32 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Total of 2
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 3 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 33 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 3 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 34 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 3 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 35 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 3 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 36 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 3 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 37 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 3 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 38 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 3 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 39 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 3 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 40 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 3 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 41 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 3 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 42 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 3 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 43 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 3 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 44 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 3 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 45 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 3 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 46 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 3 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 47 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 3 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 48 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 3 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 49 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 3 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 50 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 3 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 51 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 3 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 52 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 3 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 53 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 3 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 54 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 3 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 55 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 3 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 56 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 3 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 57 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement Of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 4 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 58 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price (NRs) Total Amount (NRs) Remarks
A 132 kV Transmission Line
1 Survey, tree enemuration, bush cutting including all associated works
Check survey, Profiling & tower spotting, pegging of
tower centres, pit marking at site etc including all
a) KM 20
associated works viz reading levels at tower locations
for the purpose of earthwork
Cadastral survey including the identification of all the
land plot for tower foundation, land plot along the ROW
b) for the purpose of paying compensation, Tree lot 1
enemureation, Bush cutting etc including all associated
works
c) Deatiled survey including associated works KM 4
Total of 1
2 Geotechnical Investigation including all associated works
2.1 Geotechnical Investigation
Geotechnical Investigation at designated tower
locations by Auger boring upto a depth of 10 m below
ground level and conducted SPT test as per IS:6403,
a) collection of distrubed and undistuebed soil samples Loc 29
from various depths including conducting all necessary
laboratory tests on soil samples etc.
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 4 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 59 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price (NRs) Total Amount (NRs) Remarks
Geotechnical Investigation at tower locations where
pile foundation are to be provided by Auger boring upto
a depth of 30 m below ground level and conducted
b) SPT test as per IS:6403, collection of distrubed and Loc 5
undistuebed soil samples from various depths including
conducting all necessary laboratory tests on soil
samples etc.
Total of Sub Total 2.1
2.2 Benching
a) All type of soil Cu m 10,000.00
Total of Sub Total 2.2
Total of 2
3 Measurements of soil resistivity/ground resistance Loc 73
Total of 3
Erection of various types of towers, tower parts and its body & leg extensions (Complete) including bolts & nuts, steps bolts,
4
hangers, D Shackles etc including tack welding and supply and application zinc rich primer and two coats of enamel paint
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 4 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 60 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price (NRs) Total Amount (NRs) Remarks
Total of Sub Total 4.1
4.2 Tower Type DB
a) Setting of Stubs (Set of 4) Sets 11
b) DA +/-0 M Ext. type of Tower Nos. 11
c) DA +3 M Ext. type of Tower Nos. 4
d) DA +6 M Ext. type of Tower Nos. 2
e) DA +9 M Ext. type of Tower Nos. 2
Total of Sub Total 4.2
4.3 Tower Type DC
a) Setting of Stubs (Set of 4) Sets 9
b) DA +/-0 M Ext. type of Tower Nos. 9
c) DA +3 M Ext. type of Tower Nos. 2
d) DA +6 M Ext. type of Tower Nos. 1
e) DA +9 M Ext. type of Tower Nos. 1
Total of Sub Total 4.3
4.4 Tower Type DD/DDE
a) Setting of Stubs (Set of 4) Sets 9
b) DA +/-0 M Ext. type of Tower Nos. 9
c) DA +3 M Ext. type of Tower Nos. 3
d) DA +6 M Ext. type of Tower Nos. 1
e) DA +9 M Ext. type of Tower Nos. 1
Total of Sub Total 4.4
Total of 4
5 Work associated with construction of tower foundations including stub setting
5.1 Tower Type DA (for all type of body and leg extensions)
a) Normal Dry Soil Nos. 4
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 4 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 61 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price (NRs) Total Amount (NRs) Remarks
b) Wet Soil Nos. 9
c) Partially Submerged Soil Nos. 14
d) Fully Submerged Soil Nos. 12
e) Sandy Soil Nos. 5
Total of Sub Total 5.1
5.2 Tower Type DB (for all type of body and leg extensions)
a) Normail Dry Soil Nos. 1
b) Wet Soil Nos. 4
c) Partially Submerged Soil Nos. 3
d) Fully Submerged Soil Nos. 2
e) Sandy Soil Nos. 1
Total of Sub Total 5.2
5.3 Tower type DC (for all type of body and leg extensions)
a) Normail Dry Soil Nos. 1
b) Wet Soil Nos. 2
c) Partially Submerged Soil Nos. 3
d) Fully Submerged Soil Nos. 2
e) Sandy Soil Nos. 1
Total of Sub Total 5.3
5.4 Tower type DD/DDE (for all type of body and leg extensions)
a) Normail Dry Soil Nos. 1
b) Wet Soil Nos. 3
c) Partially Submerged Soil Nos. 2
d) Fully Submerged Soil Nos. 2
e) Sandy Soil Nos. 1
Total of Sub Total 5.4
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 4 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 62 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price (NRs) Total Amount (NRs) Remarks
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 4 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 63 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price (NRs) Total Amount (NRs) Remarks
Total of 7
8 Installation of line materials
8.1 Stringing of conductor and ground wire
Stringing of ACSR CARDINAL Conductor including
Installation of Insulator complete with arcing horns and
Phase
a) necessary hardwares, fixing of conductor accessories 126
km
including armour rod, mid span joints, repair sleeves,
etc (single wire)
Steel ground wire with optical fibre (24 fiber) including
b) intermediate splice boxes and necessary terminal KM 21
splice boxes etc.
Total of 8
9 Protection of tower footing
Random rubble stone masnory including excavation,
a) Cum 1000
stone soling and PCC (1:4 cement : concrete)
Stone bound in galvanizing wire netting including
b) Cum 1000
excavation
Back filling and leveling of volumes enclosed by
c) Cum 1000
revetment
d) M15 concrete nominal mix 1:2:4 for top seal cover Cum 100
M20 Conc. Nominal Mix 1:1.5:3 for foundation of
e) Cum 100
miscellaneous works
f) Reinforcement bar T 10
Total of 9
Total of A
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 4 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 64 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price (NRs) Total Amount (NRs) Remarks
B Loharpatti 132/33/11 kV Substation
1 ELECTRICAL WORKS
1.1 Power transformer
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 4 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 65 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price (NRs) Total Amount (NRs) Remarks
1.2.4 36 kV, 1250 A, 3 phase, Vaccum Circuit Breaker for set 2
1.2.5 incomer,
36 kV, 800 three
A, 3pole operation
phase, Vaccum type, complete
Circuit with
Breaker forall set 4
1.3. outgoing feeders,
Disconnecting three pole operation type, complete
switches
145 kV, 1250 A, 3 phase Center Break Disconnecting
1.3.1 Switch with Grounding Switch complete with all set 2
accessories as per specification
145 kV, 2000 A, 3 phase, Center Break Disconnecting
1.3.2 Switch without Grounding Switch complete with all set 2
accessories as per specification
145 kV, 1250 A, 3 phase Center Break Disconnecting
1.3.3 Switch without Grounding Switch complete with all set 10
accessories as per specification
1.3.4 36 KV, 1250 A, 3 phase disconnecting switch without set 2
1.3.5 grounding
36 KV, 800A, switch complete
3 phase with all accessories
disconnecting as per
switch without set 5
1.3.6 grounding
36KV, 800A,switch complete
3 phase with all accessories
disconnecting switch with as per set 4
1.4 grounding switch complete
Instrument transformers with all accessories as per
145 kV, 50 VA, 132/√3 /110/√3 kV, Class 0.5/3P
1.4.1 Capacitor Voltage Transformer complete with all no. 12
accessories as per specification
145 kV, 30 VA, 5 core Current Transformer complete
1.4.2 no. 18
with all accessories as per specification
1.4.3 36 kV, 30 VA, 33/√3/110/√3 kV Voltage Transformer no. 3
1.4.4 complete
36 kV, 30 with
VA, 3allcore
accessories asp per specification
Current Transformer complete no. 18
1.5 with all accessories
Lightning Arrester as per specification
1.5.1 120 kV, 10 kA, lightning arrestor including discharge no. 15
1.5.2 counter
30 kV, 10 complete with arrestor
kA lightning all accessories
including asdischarge
per no. 15
counter for cable protection complete with all
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 4 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 66 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price (NRs) Total Amount (NRs) Remarks
1.5.3 9 kV, 10 kA lightening arrestor including discharge no. 12
1.6 counter
Control complete
and relaywith all accessories as per
panel
1.6.1 132/33 kV transformer control and relay panel set 2
complete
132/11 kVwith all accessories
transformer control as
andper specification
relay panel
1.6.2 set 1
complete with all accessories as per specification
132 kV transmission line control and relay panel
1.6.3 set 2
complete with all accessories as per specification
132 kV bus coupler cum bus bar protection control and
1.6.4 relay panel complete with all accessories as per set 1
specification
33kV line control and relay panel complete with all
1.6.5 set 4
accessories as per specification
1.7 Grounding
1.7.1 Galvanized E.H.S. steel wires of size 7/3.35 for lot 1
lightning shield
Earthing of wire in with
substation take conductors,
off and internal structures,
electrode
1.7.2 grounding materials and accessories to complete the lot 1
specified scope of works :
12 KV VCB Switchgear Panel with all accessories
1.8
as per specified
12 kV Transformer incomer module (2000A) (IP-2) with
1.8.1 no 1
all accessories as per specification
12 kV Line Module(630A) (IP-1) with all accessories as
1.8.2 no. 4
per specification
1.8.3 12 kV PT module (IP-3) with all accessories as per no. 1
1.9 specification
Station supply
1.9.1 150 kVA, 33/0.4 kV station service transformer with lot 1
current limiting fuse, power cable and all other
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 4 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 67 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price (NRs) Total Amount (NRs) Remarks
400V AC Distribution Board including Cable for the
1.9.2 lot 1
specified scope of the work
110 V DC distribution board including cable and
1.9.3 lot 1
accessories to complete the specified scope of work:
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 4 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 68 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price (NRs) Total Amount (NRs) Remarks
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 4 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 69 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price (NRs) Total Amount (NRs) Remarks
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 4 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 70 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price (NRs) Total Amount (NRs) Remarks
2.1 SUBSTATION AUTOMATION
Complete Substation automation system including
hardware and software for the substation & remote
a.
control stations alongwith associated equipments for
the followings as per Technical Specification.
i. 132 kV System Bays 6
ii. 33kV system Bays 4
iii. 11 kV System (Indoor Switchgear) lot 1
Integration of all 132kV ,33 kV and 11 kV kV Bays
under present scope with the SCADA of SIEMENS
b. (SINAUT Spectrum) at Load Dispatch Centre, Lot 1
Kathmandu including supply of Hardware, Software,
accessories etc. as per TS Section Project.
2.2 COMMUNICATION / SCADA
2.2.1 Digital Protection Coupler Nos. 2
Optical Distribution Frame complete in all respects as
2.2.2 Lot 1
per technical specifications
Optical Approach Cable -24 Fibre (DWSM -G.652D)
along with Installation hardware set for above 24 Fibre,
2.2.3 Lot 1
Fibre Optic Approach Cable complete in all respects
as per technical specifications
2.2.4 Telecommunication Equipments
SDH Equipment (STM-4 MADM upto 3 MSP protected
2.2.4.1
directions)
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 4 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 71 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price (NRs) Total Amount (NRs) Remarks
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 4 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 72 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price (NRs) Total Amount (NRs) Remarks
33 kV take off and internal gantry structures(including
3.1.4 Lot 1
busbar supports )
3.1.5 145 kV SF6 circuit breaker Nos 6
3.1.6 36 kV Vacuum circuit breaker Nos 6
3.1.7 145 kV disconnecting switch Nos 14
3.1.8 36kV disconnecting switch Nos 11
3.1.9 132 kV capacitive voltage transformer Nos 12
3.1.10 33 kV voltage transformer Nos 3
3.1.11 132 kV current Transformer Nos 18
3.1.12 33 kV current Transformer Nos 18
3.1.13 120 kV lighting arrestor Nos 15
3.1.14 30 kV lighting arrestor Nos 12
3.1.15 Earth mast Lot 1
3.1.16 Identification plate, danger notice etc Lot 1
Concrete Foundation for Equipment and Steel
Structures complete with excavation, backfilling,
3.2
form works, concrete works and reinforcement
bars
132/33 kV , Three Phase 24/27/30 MVA, Power
3.2.1 Nos 2
Transformer (complete with rails & etc.)
132/11 kV, Three phase 15 MVA Power Transformer
3.2.2 Nos 1
complete (Complete with rails and etc.)
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 4 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 73 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price (NRs) Total Amount (NRs) Remarks
132 kV take off and internal gantry structures(including
3.2.4 Lot 1
busbar support)
33 kV take off and internal gantry structures(including
3.2.5 Lot 1
busbar supports )
3.2.6 145 kV SF6 circuit breaker Nos 6
3.2.7 36 kV Vacuum circuit breaker Nos 6
3.2.8 145 kV disconnecting switch Nos 14
3.2.9 36kV disconnecting switch Nos 11
3.2.10 132 kV capacitive voltage transformer Nos 12
3.2.11 33 kV voltage transformer Nos 3
3.2.12 132 kV current Transformer Nos 18
3.2.13 33 kV current Transformer Nos 18
3.2.14 120 kV lighting arrestor Nos 15
3.2.15 30 kV lighting arrestor Nos 12
3.2.16 Earth mast Lot 1
Construction of boundary wall,entrance gate,Staff
Quarter Building, Guard cum Store House, Sanitary
3.3
Works as per Drawings & Specifications
3.3.1 Earthworks
Earthwork in excavation of ordinary soil for trenches
including strutting, bracing, sheeting, dewatering and
3.3.1.1 m³ 1569.43
disposal/backfill works all complete
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 4 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 74 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price (NRs) Total Amount (NRs) Remarks
Earthwork in filling and compaction of quarry soil in
foundation and floor with consolidation in layers of 15
3.3.1.2 m³ 481.53
cm and watering as per instructions all complete
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 4 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 75 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price (NRs) Total Amount (NRs) Remarks
Providing, Laying, Compacting and Curing Cement
concrete M15 (1:2:4) work with cement, sand and
crushed stone ballast 20mm guage finishing to
3.3.3.2 m³ 267.98
approved level, lines and dimensions all complete as
per drawings, specifications and instructions all
complete
Providing, Laying, Compacting and Curing M20
(1:1.5:3) work for all kinds of R.C.C. works with
cement, sand and crushed stone ballast 20mm down
3.3.3.3 finishing to approved level, line and dimensions using m³ 1868.43
mixer machine and vibrator all complete as per
drawings, specifications and instructions all complete
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 4 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 76 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price (NRs) Total Amount (NRs) Remarks
Providing & Laying first class brickwork in 1:4 cement
sand Mortar in perfect lines and level, shape and
plumb including settingout, soaking of bricks,
3.3.4.1 m³ 1528.44
scaffolding, raking of joints, curing etc as per
specifications, drawings and instructons all complete
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 4 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 77 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price (NRs) Total Amount (NRs) Remarks
Providing, Laying and Curing of 20 mm thick edge strip
3.3.5.3 (pani patti) in edge of slab in 1:4 C/S as per Rm 425.00
specifications and instructions all complete
3.3.6 Flooring Works
Providing, Laying and Curing 38 mm thick IPS floor
finish of cement concrete screeding(1:2:4) in floor on
3.3.6.1 m² 1138.15
perfect line,level and slope as per design, specificatons
and instructions all complete
Providing, Laying and Curing 3mm thick cement
punning in floor on perfect line and level as per
3.3.6.2 m² 1326.33
specifications, drawings and instructions all complete
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 4 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 78 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price (NRs) Total Amount (NRs) Remarks
Supplying and fixing Sal wood work for frame of doors,
windows and ventelators including nails, holdfasts,
3.3.7.1 screws etc as approved by site incharge , the timber m³ 3.123
shall be matured, free from wraps, knot holes and
other defects all complete
Supplying and fixing panel door shutter including fixing
with approved size, heavy duty hinges, brass tower
3.3.7.2 bolts handle, locking set, door stopper, shock absorber m² 22.50
as per design and instruction all complete
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 4 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 79 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price (NRs) Total Amount (NRs) Remarks
Providing and Painting two coat of weather apex coat
or equivalent over primer coats on exterior exposed
3.3.8.1 plaster surface in buildings of approved brand and m² 5885.14
colour as per specificatons and instructions all
complete
Providing and application of two coat acrylic emulsion
paints over primer coats on interior plasters and
3.3.8.2 ceilings inside buildings of approved brand and colour m² 2649.97
as per specificatons and instructions all complete
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 4 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 80 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price (NRs) Total Amount (NRs) Remarks
Construction and painting of compound gate with fixing
3.3.9.2 16 gauge iron sheet in frame angle 50x50x5 mm m² 18.90
external and 40x40x5 internal as per drawing
Supply and Fabrication of 4'6" dia. Spiral staircase
using 20x20 mm square pipes and handle 30 mm dia
3.3.9.3 R.m. 8.30
black pipe handle with enamel paint finish as per
specification and instruction all complete
Supply and Fabrication of Rolling shutter with 16-18
gauge strip sheet in store house with enamel paint
3.3.9.4 m² 7.84
finish as per specification and instruction all complete
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 4 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 81 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price (NRs) Total Amount (NRs) Remarks
3.6.2 For Guard cum Store House Lot 1
3.3.12 Furniture and miscellaneous indoor facilities
3.3.12.1 For Staff Quarter and Guard cum Store House Lot 1
3.3.12.2 For Control Room Lot 1
3.3.13 Damp Proofing Works
Supply and apply water proofing two coats Dr. Fixit
3.3.13.1 m² 542.11
super create
3.4 Miscellaneous Works
3.4.1 Clearing and stripping of Substation Area sq.m. 26300.00
3.4.2 Survey of Substation area as per specified lot 1
Exploration works for soil strength of foundations
3.4.3 including laboratory tests for Substation as per lot 1
specified
3.4.4 Soil Resistivity test lot 1
Site Grading with earth cutting and filling by borrow pit
3.4.5 earth, including compaction and leveling etc all cu.m. 52600.00
complete
3.4.6 Crushed Rock Surfacing sq.m. 10000.00
3.4.7 Drainage system lot 1
3.4.8 Switchyard fence including entrance gate as specified lot 1
Cable Trench, Duct Bank, Conduit and Hand hole and
3.4.9 lot 1
cable trays to complete the specified job
Construction of Water tank (24000 ltr) & Water supply
3.4.10 from source to storage tank all complete as lot 1
specification
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 4 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 82 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price (NRs) Total Amount (NRs) Remarks
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 4 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 83 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price (NRs) Total Amount (NRs) Remarks
120 kV, 10 kA, lightning arrestor including discharge
1.4.1 counter complete with all accessories as per no. 6
specification
1.5 Control and relay panel
132 kV transmission line control and relay panel
1.5.1 set 2
complete with all accessories as per specification
1.6 Grounding
Galvanized E.H.S. steel wires of size 7/3.35 for
lightning shield wire in take off and internal structures
1.6.1 and connection with the existing 132 kV switchyard, lot 1
with accessories to complete the specified scope of
works:
Earthing of switchyard and connection with the existing
grounding mat with conductors, electrode grounding
1.6.2 lot 1
materials and accessories to complete the specified
scope of works :
1.7 Battery & Battery Charger
Battery charger for 110 V battery complete with all
1.7.1 no. 1
accessorie to complete the specified scope of work:
110 V, 600 AH maintenance free lead acid sealed type
1.7.2 battery complete with all accessories to complete the set 1
specified scope of work:
Battery charger for 48 V battery complete with all
1.7.3 no. 1
accessories to complete the specified scope of work:
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 4 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 84 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price (NRs) Total Amount (NRs) Remarks
48 V, 300 AH maintenance free lead acid sealed type
1.7.4 battery complete with all accessories to complete the set 1
specified scope of work
1.8 Control and Power cables
600 V power and lighting cable for all works to
1.8.1 lot 1
complete the specified scope of work:
600 V control cable to complete the specified scope of
1.8.2 lot 1
works including that for communication works:
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 4 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 85 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price (NRs) Total Amount (NRs) Remarks
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 4 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 86 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price (NRs) Total Amount (NRs) Remarks
Integration of all 132kV Bays under present scope with
the SCADA of SIEMENS (SINAUT Spectrum) at Load
b Dispatch Centre, Kathmandu including supply of 1
Hardware, Software, accessories etc. as per TS
Section Project. Lot
2.2 COMMUNICATION / SCADA
2.2.1 Digital Protection Coupler Nos. 2
Optical Distribution Frame complete in all respects as
2.2.2 Lot 1
per technical specifications
Optical Approach Cable -24 Fibre (DWSM -G.652D)
along with Installation hardware set for above 24 Fibre,
2.2.3 Lot 1
Fibre Optic Approach Cable complete in all respects
as per technical specifications
Integration of SDH Equipment (Loharpatti SS) with the
2.2.4 existing SDH communication Network at Dhalkebar Lot 1
upto LDC
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 4 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 87 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price (NRs) Total Amount (NRs) Remarks
3.1.4 132 kV capacitive voltage transformer Nos 6
3.1.5 132 kV current transformer Nos 6
3.1.6 120 kV lighting arrestor Nos 6
3.1.7 Identification plate, danger notice etc Lot 1
Concrete Foundation for Equipment and Steel
Structures complete with excavation, backfilling,
3.2
form works, concrete works and reinforcement
bars
132 kV take off and internal gantry structures(including
3.2.1 Lot 1
busbar support)
3.2.2 145 kV SF6 circuit breaker Nos 2
3.2.3 145 kV disconnecting switch Nos 10
3.2.4 132 kV capacitive voltage transformer Nos 6
3.2.5 132 kV current transformer Nos 6
3.2.6 120 kV lighting arrestor Nos 6
Control room extension Works, Construction of
3.3 boundary wall as per Drawings & Specifications
3.3.1 Earthworks
Earthwork in excavation of ordinary soil for trenches
including strutting, bracing, sheeting, dewatering and
3.3.1.1 m³ 772.13
disposal/backfill works all complete
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 4 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 88 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price (NRs) Total Amount (NRs) Remarks
Earthwork in filling and compaction of quarry soil in
foundation and floor with consolidation in layers of 15
3.3.1.2 m³ 110.98
cm and watering as per instructions all complete
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 4 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 89 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price (NRs) Total Amount (NRs) Remarks
Providing, Laying, Compacting and Curing M20
(1:1.5:3) work for all kinds of R.C.C. works with
cement, sand and crushed stone ballast 20mm down
3.3.3.3 finishing to approved level, line and dimensions using m³ 316.05
mixer machine and vibrator all complete as per
drawings, specifications and instructions all complete
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 4 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 90 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price (NRs) Total Amount (NRs) Remarks
Providing, Laying and Curing 20 mm Thick Plaster in
1:4 C/S Mortar on inside wall, floor and inside staircase
3.3.5.1 room cover to perfect plumb, lines and level all m² 1708.44
complete as per drawings, specifications and
instructions all complete
Providing, Laying and Curing 12.5 mm Thick Plaster in
1:4 C/S Mortar outside wall, ceiling of room and
projected slab(inclined surface as
3.3.5.2 well),parapet(including top of it) and outside staircase m² 1481.66
cover to perfect plumb, lines and level all complete as
per drawings, specifications and instructions all
complete
Providing, Laying and Curing of 20 mm thick edge strip
3.3.5.3 (pani patti) in edge of slab in 1:4 C/S as per Rm 65.50
specifications and instructions all complete
3.3.6 Flooring Works
Providing, Laying and Curing 38 mm thick IPS floor
finish of cement concrete screeding(1:2:4) in floor on
3.3.6.1 m² 291.5
perfect line,level and slope as per design, specificatons
and instructions all complete
Providing, Laying and Curing 3mm thick cement
punning in floor on perfect line and level as per
3.3.6.2 m² 366.83
specifications, drawings and instructions all complete
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 4 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 91 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price (NRs) Total Amount (NRs) Remarks
Preparation of mosaic floor with 12.5 mm plaster in 1:2
C/S in bottom layer and 6 mm thick white cement and
marble chips 1:1 in top layer including rubbing and
3.3.6.3 m² 178.50
polishing on perfect line and level as per drawings and
specificatons all complete in staff quarter all complete
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 4 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 92 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price (NRs) Total Amount (NRs) Remarks
Supply and Fabrication of fencing with 50 mm dia pipe
post erecting spacing 2m c/c connected by 25x25x4
mm angle frame and welding 10mm squaregrill @ 80
3.3.9.1 mm c/c and welding 2x100mm grill of height 0.15mm m² 340.00
with enamel paint finish as per drawing and instructions
all complete
3.3.10 Dismantling works
Dismantling cement mortar masonary with deposition in
3.3.10.1 m³ 14.69
stacks
3.3.10.2 Dismantling RCC work with deposition in stacks m³ 2.60
3.3.11 Damp Proofing Works
Supply and apply water proofing two coats Dr. Fixit
3.3.11.1 m² 180.25
super create
Providing, chipping and plaster with mixing perma bond
SBR modified mortar on level all complete. Providing
and laying thermacol in the hole. Providing masking
3.3.11.2 m² 40.32
tape on thermacol and covering with aluminium V
shaped member all complete.
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 4 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 93 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Item No Description Unit Qty Unit Price (NRs) Total Amount (NRs) Remarks
Exploration works for soil strength of foundations
3.4.3 including laboratory tests for Substation as per lot 1
specified
3.4.4 Soil Resistivity test lot 1
Site Grading with earth cutting and filling by borrow pit
3.4.5 earth, including compaction and leveling etc all cu.m. 2000.00
complete
3.4.6 Crushed Rock Surfacing sq.m. 500.00
3.4.7 Switchyard fence lot 1
Cable Trench, Duct Bank, Conduit and Hand hole and
3.4.8 lot 1
cable trays to complete the specified job
Underground Cable Trench for 33 kV XLPE cable all
3.4.9 meter 100
complete as per specifications and drawings
Supply and installation of Air Conditioning system (2
3.4.10 Nos 2
Tons) as per specified all complete
Total of C
Grand Total
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 5 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 94 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
Price Schedule 6 Nepal Electricity Authority Page 95 of 95
Dhalkebar Loharpatti 132 kV Transmission Line Project
4 Installation Services
Bidding Document for ICB-DL-TLSS-076/77-01 Procurement of Works Single Stage Two Envelope
SECTION-VI
Bill of Quantities
Bill of Quantities
1 Provisional Sum
Procument Item Details
SL.
Item Description Unit Quantity Unit Rate(NPR) Amount(NPR)
No
2 Construction work
Procument Item Details
Installation Services
3 nos 1.0
VAT
Grand Total